Socomec 2013
Socomec 2013
Socomec 2013
2013
2014
Contents
Introduction pages
An independent manufacturer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . p. 4
Four key applications: the benefit of a specialist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . p. 5
Adapted solutions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . p. 6
Services & Technical Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . p. 8
A cutting-edge laboratory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . p. 10
For a high quality power supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . p. 11
A worldwide presence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . p. 12
A new website . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . p. 13
Application Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . p. 14
SIRCO M and
MV
p. 26
IDE
p. 44
FUSERBLOC
p. 188
SIDERMAT
combination
p. 230
COMO C
p. 316
SIRCOVER and
SIRCOVER BY-PASS
p. 328
COUNTIS E
p. 420
DIRIS A
p. 436
Core balance
WUDQVIRUPHU,&
p. 522
COMBIESTER
p. 550
CADRYS
enclosures
p. 551
Enclosed
switches
p. 600
Safety enclosures
p. 608
Fuse protection
Fuses, fuse bases
and fuse combination switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . p. 182
Changeover switches
Changeover switches, control relays
and configuration software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . p. 308
Electronic protection
Differential protection, voltage surge protection,
current protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . p. 508
SIRCO and
SIRCO AC
p. 52
SIDER
p. 74
SIDERMAT
p. 88
SIRCO PV
p. 116
FUSOMAT
p. 238
RM - RMS
p. 262
Fuse bases
p. 266
,QGXVWULDOIXVHV
p. 278
ATyS M
p. 366
ATyS S
p. 374
ATyS p
p. 388
Control relays
RETROFIT Line
p. 468
Supervision
and interfaces
p. 482
Current transformers
p. 488
Surge arrester
SURGYS
G50-FE
p. 532
Surge arrester
SURGYS
D40
p. 538
Surge arrester
SURGYS
Low currents
p. 542
CADRYS DELTA
modular
p. 552
Busbar supports
p. 562
Enclosed changeover
switches
p. 622
PV enclosures
p. 646
Customised design
and solutions
p. 648
p. 404
,QGLFDWRUVDQG
transducers
p. 506
An independent manufacturer
the benefit of a specialist
CORPO 308 A
A flexible manufacturing
structure
Backed by two European centres of
excellence (France and Italy), the Group also
benefits from competitive production sites,
such as in Tunisia, and locations in the major
emerging markets (India and China).
All sites have implemented a policy of
continuing development based on 'Lean
management' principles; this ensures they are
in a position to offer the quality, lead times and
cost expected by our customers.
Responsible growth
As a Group which is open to all cultures
and firmly committed to human values,
SOCOMEC promotes employee initiative
and commitment. Working relationships are
based on the idea of partnerships and respect
for shared ethics. Through the companys
commitment to achieving harmonious, lasting
development, SOCOMEC fully embraces
its responsibilities not only towards its
shareholders, employees, customers and
partners, but also towards society as a whole
and its environment.
SOCOMEC has been a signatory to the Global
Compact since 2003.
Solar Power
Guaranteeing the safety and durability of
photovoltaic (PV) facilities.
Energy Efficiency
Improving building and facility energy
efficiency.
Adapted solutions
energy objectives met
Smart PowerPort
container solution
STATYS
static transfer systems
ATyS
automatic transfer switch
2(1".
KN@CAQD@JRVHSBGDR
".4-3(2$DMDQFXLDSDQR
#(1(2 LTKSHETMBSHNMLD@RTQDLDMSTMHSR
#(1(2-MDSVNQJ@M@KXRDQR
5$13$+(2$MDQFX/NVDQ,NMHSNQHMF2XRSDLRNESV@QD
industry
bui l di ng
Commercial buildings,
Residential buildings,
Hotel & Leisure.
infrastructure
Transport,
Telecommunications,
Public distribution, Military,
Water treatment.
renewable energy
STATYS
static transfer systems
2(1".
KN@CAQD@JRVHSBGDR
".4-3(2$DMDQFXLDSDQR
#(1(2 LTKSHETMBSHNMLD@RTQDLDMSTMHSR
#(1(2-MDSVNQJ@M@KXRDQR
5$13$+(2$MDQFX/NVDQ,NMHSNQHMF2XRSDLRNESV@QD
APPLI 566 A
Customised support
Assessment and sizing
Depending on your requirements, our experts
collect and analyse all the relevant data in
order to recommend the system best adapted
to your installation.
Commissioning
Installation of your equipment is carried out by
a specialist, and is totally compatible with and
adapted to your use.
Maintenance
A wide range of preventive or corrective
maintenance options designed to suit your
installation and its environment, and to
ensure continuity of service of your electrical
networks.
Training
You will receive training, specially adapted to
your needs, in order to familiarise yourself with
our equipment and enable you to use it to
your best advantage.
Customer-oriented service
True to our own principles, we encourage
direct and friendly contact. Our interventions
offer solutions targeted to a single problem:
Yours. Our engineers are always very attentive
to your needs, to ensure that we provide the
most relevant technical support and advice.
So you can plan your investments with
confidence.
SITES EN FRANCE
CORPO 164A
Effective insulation
monitoring for your electrical
installation
APPLI 540 A
A cutting-edge laboratory
the backing of an expert
CORPO 342 A
A decisive link
Ongoing commitment
Customised services
Global scale
This totally independent laboratory is
recognised by the major certification bodies
worldwide: A member of ASEFA(1) and
LOVAG(2), it is accredited by COFRAC(3), UL
(CTDP(4)), CSA (shared certification) and KEMA
(SMT / WMT(5)). It also works in partnership
with numerous international certification
organisations(6). The quality and safety
requirements specific to each country are
therefore fully taken into account.
Specialist facilities
With its 100 MVA (Idc 100 kA rms 1 s) shortcircuit platform, three 10 kA overload platforms
and numerous other test instruments, in
facilities covering 1500 m2, the Pierre Siat
laboratory is currently the 2nd largest French
power laboratory. It combines expertise in
electricity and mechanics, pneumatics and
computing.
10
We issue certificates
of conformity
and performance
declarations upon
request.
For more information, visit our web site:
www.socomec.fr/laboratoire-essais_fr.html
(1) Association des Stations dEssais Franaises
dAppareils lectriques basse tension (French
association of low voltage electrical equipment test
stations)
(2) Low Voltage Agreement Group
(3) Comit Franais dAccrditation (French accreditation body)
(4) Client test data programme
(5) Supervised Manufacturers testing / Witnessed
manufacturers testing
(6) KEMA, CEBEC, UL, CSA, ASTA, Lloyds Register
of Shipping, Bureau Vritas, BBJ-SEP, EZU,
GOST-R, etc.
GAMME 008 W
High availability
Recognised expertise
Continuing innovation
Customer-oriented service
Our sales and after-sales network means
we are always there for you. Our partnercustomers recognise the quality of our
products, availability and flexibility in meeting
requirements and commitment.
ISO 9001
FM 28237
ISO14001
EMS 553476
11
A worldwide presence
Key
International Sales Department
Sales, Marketing and Service
Management
CARTE 062 A
1DOQDRDMS@SHUDNEjBDR
Subsidiaries
Distributors
For your needs in Power Control & Safety and Energy Efficiency
Representative offices
Austria
info.scp.at@socomec.com
United Arab Emirates
info.scp.ae@socomec.com
Subsidiaries
Belgium - info.scp.be@socomec.com
France - info.scp.fr@socomec.com
Germany - info.scp.de@socomec.com
Italy - info.scp.it@socomec.com
North East Asia info.scp.cn@socomec.com
Poland - info.scp.pl@socomec.com
Slovenia - info.scp.si@socomec.com
Spain - info.scp.es@socomec.com
Representative offices
United Arab Emirates
info.ups.ae@socomec.com
12
Subsidiaries
Australia - info.ups.au@socomec.com
Belgium - info.ups.be@socomec.com
China - info.ups.cn@socomec.com
France - dcm.ups.fr@socomec.com
Germany - info.ups.de@socomec.com
India - info.ups.in@socomec.com
Italy - info.ups.it@socomec.com
Malaysia - info.ups.my@socomec.com
Poland - info.ups.pl@socomec.com
Portugal - info.ups.pt@socomec.com
Romania - info.ups.ro@socomec.com
Russia - info.ups.ru@socomec.com
Singapore - info.ups.sg@socomec.com
Slovenia - info.ups.si@socomec.com
Spain - info.ups.sib@socomec.com
Thailand - info.ups.th@socomec.com
The Netherlands - info.ups.nl@socomec.com
The United Kingdom info.ups.uk@socomec.com
Turkey - info.ups.tr@socomec.com
Vietnam - info.ups.vn@socomec.com
Other countries (Europe) info.ups.europe@socomec.com
(EMEA) info.ups.emea@socomec.com
(Latin America) info.ups.sib@socomec.com
(Asia Pacific) info.ups.apac@socomec.com
www.socomec.com
to be directly connected to our solutions
100% mobility
How?
1. Download
a QR code application from your
mobile phone (QR Code Sanner Pro,
Mobiletag, ScanLife flashcode, etc.).
2. Scan
3. Browse!
A few examples:
FLCD_URL_048_A_GB
Download section
on the Socomec
website
Banners
FLCD_URL_004_A_GB
Software
Videos
13
Application Guide
Monitor your electrical installation
CORPO 286A
FLCD_URL_010_A_GB
www.socomec.com/application-guide-scp_en
14
Contents
qL.V. distribution
qOverload currents
qShort circuit currents
qDirect and indirect contact
qVoltage drops
qSwitching and isolating devices
qFuse protection
qControl and energy management
qIndustrial communication networks
qElectrical measurement
qDigital protection of networks
qDifferential protection
qInsulation Monitoring
qOvervoltage limitor
qSurge arresters
qReactive energy power factor
correction
qEnclosures
qBusbars
qUninterruptible Power Systems (UPS)
Alphabetical index
D
Differential protection ____________________________________ 508
Digital meters ___________________________________________ 506
DIRIS A10 ______________________________________________ 436
B
Bar or cable-through saturation current transformer ___________ 504
BS88 fuses _____________________________________________ 182
BS88 industrial fuselinks __________________________________ 272
BS88, NFC and DIN fuses ________________________________ 182
Busbar ________________________________________________ 546
Busbar supports ________________________________________ 562
C
Cable clamps and cage terminals __________________________ 584
CADRYS DELTA modular_________________________________ 552
15
Alphabetical index
N
NFC and DIN fuses ______________________________________ 182
IDE______________________________________________________44
Indicators and transducers ________________________________ 418
Insulated flat copper braids _______________________________ 560
Insulated flexible copper bars _____________________________ 558
O
Other electrical measurement devices ______________________ 506
P
Plug-in ranges __________________________________________ 182
16
RM PV_________________________________________________ 304
T
S
U
UL/CSA range (Load break switches) _________________________24
UL/CSA range (Fuse protection) ___________________________ 182
UL/CSA range (Changeover switches) ______________________ 308
V
Voltage transformer BTV 25 _______________________________ 504
VERTELIS VISION software _______________________________ 482
17
Specific applications
new
SIRCO M/MV
IDE
SIRCO
SIRCO AC
16 to 160 A
p. 26
32 to 160 A
p. 44
125 to 5000 A
p. 52
SIDER
SIDERMAT
125 to 1600 A
p. 74
250 to 1800 A
p. 88
new
SIRCO MC PV
SIRCO MV PV
SIRCO PV
25 to 40 A
p. 98
63 to 160 A
p. 110
100 to 3200 A
p. 116
SIRCO DC
UL98B
SIRCO MOT PV
SN
p. 158
200 to 630 A
p. 128
p. 180
SIRCO M
UL98
SIRCO UL98
16 to 80 A
p. 134
30 to 100 A
p. 144
100 to 1200 A
p. 150
SIRCO DC
UL98B
TVSS SURGE
SWITCH
100 to 2000 A
p. 158
2ODBH@KCDRHFMR
p. 178
p. 596
Special requests
2.".,$"@KRNL@JDR
RODBHjBNQBTRSNLHRDC
OQNCTBSR
6DVHKKGDKOXNTjMCSGD
QHFGSRNKTSHNMENQXNTQ
@OOKHB@SHNM
Please feel free to consult us.
19
Load break
switches
+N@CAQD@JRVHSBGDRENQ@KKXNTQ
applications
,@BGHMDBNMSQNKONVDQCHRSQHATSHNM@MCOGNSNUNKS@HBHMRS@KK@SHNMR
.TQQ@MFDNEKN@CAQD@JRVHSBGDRHR
BTQQDMSKXNMDNESGDVHCDRSNMSGDL@QJDS
KSGNTFGSGD2(1".,@MC2(1".
OQNCTBSR@KNMDLDDSSGDL@INQHSXNE
QDPTHQDLDMSR2.".,$"G@RRDSNTSSN
BNUDQSGDDMSHQDQ@MFDNE@OOKHB@SHNMR
Discover all our products in the selection
guides in the following pages.
.ODQ@SHMFHMSGDDKDBSQHB@KAQD@JHMF
SDBGMNKNFXL@QJDSRHMBD2.".,$"
HRANSG@FKNA@KKD@CDQ@MCTMQHU@KKDC
ADMBGL@QJ
A specific need?
6DG@UDCDUDKNODCMTLDQNTRRODBH@K
OQNCTBSRRVHSBGDRVHSGNUDQQ@SDC
MDTSQ@KGHFGRGNQSBHQBTHSB@O@AHKHSX
RVHSBGDRLTKSHONK@QRVHSBGDRD@QSGHMF
RVHSBGDRRVHSBGDRENQ5MDSVNQJR
RODBH@KLNSNQHRDCRVHSBGDRDSB
6G@SDUDQXNTQQDPTHQDLDMSRXNTVHKK
EHMCSGDQHFGSRNKTSHNMHMSGDMDWSEDV
O@FDR
I
I
I
O
//+(>>
2(1",>>$>&!
Junction box
SIRCO
PV
SIRCO
PV
20
Junction box
SIRCO
PV
& ,,$>>
Safe operations
3NDMRTQDDKDBSQHB@KRDO@Q@SHNMCTQHMF
L@HMSDM@MBDNODQ@SHNMRNQENQDLDQFDMBX
AQD@JHMFSNOQDUDMS@QHRJNEEHQDNQDKDBSQHB@K
RGNBJHSHRDRRDMSH@KSG@SCDCHB@SDC
OGNSNUNKS@HBRVHSBGDR@QDTRDC
3GDRDCDUHBDRLTRSADHMRS@KKDC@SD@BG
ETMBSHNM@KKDUDKNESGDHMRS@KK@SHNMA@RDCNMHSR
@QBGHSDBSTQD
(MNQCDQSNCHRBNMMDBS@CHQDBSBTQQDMS
OGNSNUNKS@HBRSQHMFFDMDQ@SNQNQ4/2NMKX
2(1"./5NQ2(1".,"/5CDUHBDRB@M
q (RNK@SDSGD@RRNBH@SDCGHFG#"UNKS@FDR
q &T@Q@MSDDR@EDNMKN@CCHRBNMMDBSHNM
RDUDQ@KSGNTR@MCSHLDR@BQNRRSGDETKKQ@MFD
NE#"BTQQDMSRKHMJDCSNC@HKXEKTBST@SHNMRHM
RTMKHFGSTOSN5#"
Back-to-back design,
an innovative solution
2(1".RG@UDADDMCDRHFMDCENQHMCTRSQH@K
TRD
3GDX@QDDWSQDLDKXQNATRSVHSGB@RHMFR
L@CDEQNLFK@RREHAQDQDHMENQBDCSGDQLNRDS
L@SDQH@KRAQHMFHMFMTLDQNTRADMDEHSR
q 2S@AKDSDLODQ@STQDRTMKHJDRNLD
SGDQLNOK@RSHBR
q $WBDKKDMSQDRHRS@MBDSNGHFGSDLODQ@STQDR
q &NNCDKDBSQHB@KBG@Q@BSDQHRSHBR QB@MC
HMRTK@SHNMQDRHRS@MBD
q &NNCLDBG@MHB@KBG@Q@BSDQHRSHBR
#HLDMRHNM@KRS@AHKHSX@MCQHFHCHSXNUDQSHLD
3GDRDADMDEHSR@QDO@QSHBTK@QKXHLONQS@MS
HMOGNSNUNKS@HBHMRS@KK@SHNMRVGDQDSGD
SDLODQ@STQDL@XADADKNV"NQ@ANUD"
3GD2.".,$"Q@MFDNEOGNSNUNKS@HBKN@C
AQD@JRVHSBGDRDM@AKDRRHLTKS@MDNTRNMKN@C
CHRBNMMDBSHNMNESVNBHQBTHSRTRHMF@RHMFKD
G@MCKD
Advantages
q Space saving:3GDNUDQ@KKVHCSGHRSGD
R@LD@RSG@SNENQONKDCDUHBDR
3GHR
DM@AKDRRHFMHEHB@MSR@UHMFR@RBNLO@QDCSN
SGDTRDNESVNRDO@Q@SDCDUHBDR
q Simple connection@MCHMSDFQ@SHNM
q Increasing the voltage:"NMMDBSHMF
SGDSVNCDUHBDRHMRDQHDR@KKNVRNMKN@C
CHRBNMMDBSHNMNEUNKS@FDR@ANUD5#"
q Doubling the rating:!XBNMMDBSHMFSGDSVN
CDUHBDRHMO@Q@KKDK
21
Selection guide
Load break switches
Load break
switches
Which
application?
Which
function?
Machine control
Power distribution
new
SIRCO M
WRb$
SIRCO MV
WR$
IDE
WRb$
SIRCO
WRb$
SIRCO AC
WRb$
p. 26
p. 26
p. 44
p. 52
p. 52
Main switchboard
Distribution panel
Genset output
Network coupling
Machine control
(1)
p. 328
p. 328
p. 328
p. 328
p. 181
p. 181
Applications
Functions
Characteristics
Operation
Manual (rotating)
Manual toggle
Trippable
Motorised
Direct operation handle
Front
Right side
Left side
Front
Side
External operation handle
Indication of breaking
Positive break indication
Visible contacts
Switch body
Modular
(1) Please consult us.
22
Selection guide
Load break switches
Which operation
handle?
Which type of
breaking?
Power distribution
Which switch
body?
Photovoltaic
new
n ew
SIDER
WRb$
SIDERMAT
WR$
SIRCO MC PV
WRb$
SIRCO MV PV
WR$
SIRCO PV
WR$
SIRCO DC PV UL
WRb$
SIRCO MOT PV
WRb$
p. 74
p. 88
p. 98
p. 110
p. 116
p. 158
p. 128
p. 328
p. 328
(1)
(1)
23
Selection guide
UL 508
Non fusible switches
SIRCO M1 and M2
24
sirco-ul_022_b_1_cat
sircom_174_a
Load break
switches
Selection guide
Which
application?
Which
function?
Which operation
handle?
Which type of
breaking?
Machine control
Power distribution
new
SIRCO M UL 508
WRb$
SIRCO M UL 98
WR$
SIRCO UL 98
WRb$
SIRCO DC UL 98B
WRb$
TVSS UL 98
p. 134
p. 144
p. 150
p. 158
p. 178
Main switchboard
Distribution panel
Applications
Genset output
Machine control
Network coupling
Surge protection
Functions
3/4 pole load break switch
Characteristics
Operation
Manual (rotating)
Manual toggle
Motorised
Front
Right side
Front
External operation handle
Indication of breaking
Positive break indication
Switch body
Modular
25
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
The solution for
Main incoming load break.
Distribution load break.
Machine control.
Local safety load break.
sircm_132_a
sircm_099_a
Load break
switches
>
>
>
>
4 pole SIRCO MV
direct operation
4 pole SIRCO M
direct operation
Strong points
Function
SIRCO M and MV are manually operated and
modular multipolar load break switches.
They make and break under load conditions
and provide safety isolation for any low voltage
circuit, particularly for machine control circuits.
26
Total integration.
Wide range of accessories.
Upgradeability.
Compliance to major
certifications and approvals.
> Specific characteristics.
Conformity to standards
Advantages
Total integration
3GD2(1".,@MC,5ETKKXHMSDFQ@SDHRNK@SHNM
breaking and switching functions.
6HSGHM@RHMFKDOQNCTBS2(1".,NEEDQREQNMS
right side or left side operation. Their highly
ETMBSHNM@KCDRHFMDM@AKDR2(1".,SNAD
easily transformed from a load break switch
to a changeover switch, offering a highly
innovative modular solution for numerous
applications.
>
>
>
>
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
sircm_030_a_1_x_cat
sircm_029_c_2_x_cat
sircm_028_a_2_x_cat
SIRCO M
q 2(1".,B@MADNODQ@SDCHMCHEEDQDMSV@XR
External operation
front, left side or right side
sircm_173_a_1_cat
q3
GD2(1".,HR@3 pole load break switch which is available
from 16 to 125 A. It can be combined with a switched 4th
pole, an unswitched neutral or PE pole and pre-break and
signalling auxiliary contacts.
q The basic 3 pole device is available enclosed in a
polycarbonate enclosure from 16 to 100 A (see page 600).
Changeover switches I - 0 - II
sircm_033_a_1_x_cat
sircm_034_a_2_x_cat
sircm_032_c_1_x_cat
SIRCO MV
q 3 operations are available:
27
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
References
2(1".,
Rating
(A)
Complete switch
No. of
body with toggle
poles
operation
16 A
3P
2205 3000
2200 3000(1)(2)(3)
20 A
3P
2205 3001
2200 3001(1)(2)(3)
25 A
3P
2205 3002
2200 3002(1)(2)(3)
2205 3003
(1)(2)(3)
Switch body
Direct handle
3P
2200 3003
3P
2205 3004
2200 3004(1)(2)(3)
63 A
3P
2205 3006
2200 3006(1)(2)(3)
80 A
3P
2205 3008
2200 3008(1)(2)(3)
100 A
3P
Black
IP65
Black
IP65
147A 5111
2299 5013
1473 1111(4)
Red/Yellow
IP65
Red/Yellow
IP65
147B 5111
I - 0 - II
Black IP65
1473 1113
1473 1114(4)
S0 type
S0 type
I -0
Black IP55
1481 1111(4)
I -0
Black
IP65
Black IP65
148A 5111
Red/Yellow
IP65
Red/Yellow
IP65
1484 1111
148B 5111
1483 1111(4)
(4)
2200 1003
S00 type
I - I+II - II
Black IP65
2299 5032
28
2200 1002
1407 0515
2200 1004
(4)
1474 1111(4)
2200 3010(1)(2)(3)
2200 3011(1)(2)(3)
4th pole
2200 1001
1471 1111(4)
2299 5012
Blue
3P
Shaft for
external front
and side
handle(5)
S00 type
I -0
Black
IP55
,SXOD
,SXOD
125 A
External front
handle
for changeover
switch(5)
S00 type
I -0
Red
40 A
External left
side handle(5)
2200 1000
Blue
32 A
Door
interlocked
external front
and right side
handle(5)
200 mm
1407 0520
2200 1006
320 mm
1407 0532
2200 1008
2200 1010
2200 1011
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
2(1".,
Complete switch
body toggle
operation
Switch body
3P
2205 3000
2200 3000(1)(2)(3)
20 A
3P
2205 3001
2200 3001(1)(2)(3)
25 A
3P
2205 3002
2200 3002(1)(2)(3)
Rating
(A)
No. of
poles
16 A
Unswitched
neutral pole
Unswitched
protective earth Auxiliary contact
module
Terminal
shrouds
3/4 P
1P
32 A
40 A
63 A
3P
3P
3P
80 A
3P
100 A
3P
125 A
3P
1P
1P
2200 5005
2200 9005
2294 1005(4)
3P
2205 3003
2200 3003(1)(2)(3)
,SXOD
contact
2205 3004
(1)(2)(3)
-.
-"
2205 3006
2205 3008
2200 3004
-.
2200 3006
1P
1P
2200 5009
2200 9009
1P
1P
2200 5011
2200 9011
2200 3010(1)(2)(3)
2200 3011(1)(2)(3)
2294 3005(4)
2299 0011
2299 3309(5)
2209 3409(5)
1P
2294 1009(4)
6/8 P
Steel support
2299 3609(5)
3P
2294 3009(4)
1P
Complete
protection
IP2X
Compact design
2299 0001
(1)(2)(3)
2200 3008(1)(2)(3)
Door mounting
kit
2294 1011(4)
3P
2294 3016(4)
3/4 P
Steel support
2299 3609(5)
29
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
References (continued)
2(1".,5
Rating (A)
No. of
poles
Switch
body
3P
2200 3110
4P
2200 4110
Direct handle
External
Shaft for external
front and right
External
front and side Auxiliary signal
(4)
(4)
side handle
left side handle
contact
handle(4)
Pre-break
auxiliary
contact
Terminal
shrouds
100 A
S0 type
I -0
3P
2200 3012
,ASXOD
Blue
(1)
2299 5042
125 A
4P
2200 4012
,SXOD
Blue
2299 5022
S0 type
I -0
S0 type
1491 0111(2)
Black
IP65
1409 0615
Black
IP65
149A 9111
Black
IP55
2200 3016
4P
2200 4016
160 A
(1) Standard.
(2) Defeatable handle.
(3) Top and bottom.
(4) Other handles are available. Please see accessory pages.
30
200 mm
1409 0620
1493 0111(2)
Red/Yellow
IP65
320 mm
Red/Yellow
IP65
149B 9111
1409 0632
1494 0111(2)
3P
150 mm
,SXODBNMS@BS
U type
-.
-"
BNMS@BS-"
2299 0001
3999 0701
-.
BNMS@BS-.
2299 0011
3999 0702
3P
2294 3016(3)
4P
2294 4016(3)
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
Accessories
Direct operation handle
SIRCO M
Handle
Blue
,SXOD
16 80
Red
,SXOD
100 125
Blue
,SXOD
Reference
2299 5012(1)
2200 5013
2200 5032(1)
,G@MCKD
(1) Standard.
acces_352_a
Handle colour
16 80
acces_347_a
Rating (A)
,G@MCKD
SIRCO MV
Handle
Blue
,ASXOD
100 160
Blue
,SXOD
Reference
2299 5042(1)
2299 5022
,G@MCKD
(1) Standard.
acces_359_a
Handle colour
100 160
acces_344_a
Rating (A)
,AG@MCKD
2(1".,$WSDQM@KNODQ@SHNMG@MCKD
S000 type handle
Switch
No. of
poles
3/4 P
Handle
colour
Black
IP65
Defeatable
handle
no
Switch
3/4 P
Red/Yellow
IP65
no
1464 5111
3/4 P
Front
Black
IP65
no
1463 5113
3/4 P
%QNMS
Black
IP65
no
1463 5114
16 80
16 80
16 80
16 80
Changeover
switches I - 0 - II
Changeover
switches I - I+II - II
Operation
External IP
Reference
1463 5111
S000 handle
Type
16 80
16 80
16 80
16 80
16 80
100 125
100 125
100 125
Switch
Switch
Switch
Switch
Switch
Switch
Switch
Switch
Changeover
switches I - 0 - II
Changeover
16 80
switches I - I+II - II
Changeover
100 125
switches I - 0 - II
Changeover
100 125
switches I - I+II - II
16 80
acces_307_a_1_cat
Type
No. of
poles
3/4 P(1)
3/4 P(1)
3/4 P(1)
3/4 P
3/4 P
6/8 P
6/8 P
6/8 P
3/4 P
Front
Black
IP65
yes
1473 1113
3/4 P
Front
Black
IP65
yes
1473 1114
3/4 P
Front
Black
IP65
yes
1473 0113
3/4 P
Front
Black
IP65
yes
1473 0114
Operation
Handle
External IP
colour
Black
IP55
Black
IP65
Red/Yellow
IP65
Black
IP65
Red/Yellow
IP65
Black
IP55
Black
IP65
Red/Yellow
IP65
Defeatable
handle
yes
yes
yes
no
no
yes
yes
yes
Reference
1471 1111
1473 1111
1474 1111
147A 5111
147B 5111
1471 0111
1473 0111
1474 0111
acces_341_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
S00 handle
(1) Can also be used with 6 and 8 poles with front operation.
100 125
100 125
100 125
100 125
100 125
Switch
Switch
Switch
Switch
Switch
No. of
poles
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
Operation
Front and side operation
Front and side operation
Front and side operation
Left side
Left side
Handle
External IP
colour
Black
IP55
Black
IP65
Red/Yellow
IP65
Black
IP65
Red/Yellow
IP65
Defeatable
handle
yes
yes
yes
no
no
Reference
1481 1111
1483 1111
1484 1111
148A 5111
148B 5111
S0 handle
Type
16 125
16 125
Switch
Switch
16 125
16 125
16 125
16 125
Changeover
switches I - 0 - II
Changeover
switches I - 0 - II
Changeover
switches I - I+II - II
Changeover
switches I - I+II - II
No. of
poles
3/4 P(2)
3/4 P(2)
3/4 P
Front
Black
IP65
yes
1403 2113
3/4 P
Front
Black
IP65
yes
1403 2813(1)
3/4 P
Front
Black
IP65
yes
1403 2114
3/4 P
Front
Black
IP65
yes
1403 2814(1)
Operation
Handle
External IP
colour
Black
IP65
Red/Yellow
IP65
Defeatable
handle
yes
yes
Reference
1403 2111
1404 2111
acces_304_a_1_cat
Type
access_343_a
S0 type handle
Rating (A)
S01 handle
31
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
Accessories (continued)
2(1".,5$WSDQM@KNODQ@SHNMG@MCKD
Rating (A)
Type
No. of
poles
Operation
Handle
colour
External
IP
Defeatable
handle
Reference
Black
IP55
yes
1491 0111
1493 0111
100 160
Switch
3/4 P
100 160
Switch
3/4 P
Black
IP65
yes
100 160
Switch
3/4 P
Red/Yellow
IP65
yes
1494 0111
100 160
Switch
3/4 P
Left side
Black
IP65
no
100 160
Switch
3/4 P
Left side
Red/Yellow
IP65
no
149A 9111
149B 9111
acces_343_a
S0 type handle
S0 handle
S1 type handle
Type
No. of
poles
Operation
Handle
colour
External
IP
Defeatable
handle
100 160
Switch
3/4 P
Front
Black
IP55
yes
100 160
Switch
3/4 P
Front
Black
IP65
yes
100 160
Switch
3/4 P
Front
Red/Yellow
IP65
yes
100 160
Switch
3/4 P
Right side
Black
IP55
no
100 160
Switch
3/4 P
Right side
Black
IP65
no
100 160
Switch
3/4 P
Right side
Red/Yellow
IP65
no
100 160
Switch
3/4 P
Left side
Black
IP65
no
100 160
Switch
3/4 P
Left side
Red/Yellow
IP65
no
Reference
1411 2111
1413 2111
1414 2111
1415 2111
1517 2111
1418 2111
141A 2111
141B 2111
acces_284_a_2_cat
Rating (A)
S1 Handle
Type
Length (mm)
Reference
16 ... 125
S000/S00/S0 type
Switch
150 mm
16 ... 125
S000/S00/S0 type
Switch
200 mm
16 ... 125
S000/S00/S0 type
Switch
320 mm
16 ... 125
S01 type
Switch
200 mm
16 ... 125
S01 type
Switch
320 mm
16 ... 125
S01 type
Switch
400 mm
1407 0515
1407 0520
1407 0532
1404 0520
1404 0532
1404 0540
Handle
Type
Length (mm)
Reference
16 80
150 mm
16 80
200 mm
16 80
320 mm
100 125
S00 type
150 mm
100 125
S00 type
200 mm
100 125
S00 type
320 mm
16 40
S01 type
6/8 P
200 mm
16 40
S01 type
6/8 P
320 mm
16 40
S01 type
6/8 P
400 mm
16 80
S01 type
Changeover switch
200 mm
16 80
S01 type
Changeover switch
320 mm
16 80
S01 type
Changeover switch
400 mm
100 125
S01 type
Changeover switch
150 mm
100 125
S01 type
Changeover switch
200 mm
100 125
S01 type
Changeover switch
320 mm
1407 0515
1407 0520
1407 0532
1409 0615
1409 0620
1409 0632
1404 0520
1404 0532
1404 0540
1404 0520
1404 0532
1404 0540
1409 0615
1409 0620
1409 0632
For SIRCO MV
32
Rating (A)
Handle
Type
Length (mm)
Reference
S0 type
Switch
150 mm
S0 type
Switch
200 mm
S0 type
Switch
320 mm
S1 type
Switch
200 mm
S1 type
Switch
320 mm
S1 type
Switch
400 mm
1409 0615
1409 0620
1409 0632
1401 0620
1401 0632
1401 0640
acces_346_a_1_cat
SIRCO M 3/4 P
Rating (A)
Use
Standard lengths:
- 150 mm,
- 200 mm,
- 320 mm,
- 400 mm.
Other lengths: Please consult us.
For 3/4 pole switches, shaft extensions are
for external front and side operation.
For 6/8 pole switches and changeover
switches, shaft extensions are for front
operation only.
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
Description
Handle type
To be ordered in
multiples of
Shaft guide
10 pieces
Shaft guide
S01 and S1
1 piece
acces_260_a_2_cat
Use
To guide the shaft extension into the
external handle.
Reference
1419 0000
1429 0000
SGONKD CCHSHNM@KONKDENQ2(1".,
Use
Installation of this switched pole converts:
@ONKD2(1".,HMSN@ONKDKN@CAQD@JRVHSBG
@ONKD2(1".,HMSN@MONKDKN@CAQD@JRVHSBG
@ONKD2(1".,BG@MFDNUDQRVHSBGHMSN@ONKD
changeover switch..
Reference
2200 1000
2200 1001
2200 1002
2200 1003
2200 1004
2200 1006
2200 1008
2200 1010
2200 1011
4th pole
acces_324_a
Type
switched
switched
switched
switched
switched
switched
switched
switched
switched
acces_323_a
No. of poles
1P
1P
1P
1P
1P
1P
1P
1P
1P
acces_322_a
Rating (A)
16
20
25
32
40
63
80
100
125
-DTSQ@KONKD
Protective
earth module
1P
unswitched
100 125
1P
unswitched
2200 5005
2200 5009
2200 5011
Type
Reference
16 40
Rating (A)
1P
unswitched
63 80
1P
unswitched
100 125
1P
unswitched
2200 9005
2200 9009
2200 9011
N or PE
63 80
N or PE
Reference
unswitched
N or PE
Type
1P
N or PE
No. of poles
16 40
N or PE
Rating (A)
N or PE
Use
/QNUHCDR@RNKHCMDTSQ@KONKDENQ@ONKD2(1".,
sircm_078_a_1_gb_cat
-DTSQ@KONKD
Terminal shrouds
For SIRCO M
No. of poles
1P
3P
1P
3P
1P
3P
Position
top and bottom
top and bottom
top and bottom
top and bottom
top and bottom
top and bottom
Reference
2(1".,/
2294 1005
2294 3005
2294 1009
2294 3009
2294 1011
2294 3016
No. of poles
Position
Reference
100 160
3P
100 160
4P
2294 3016
2294 4016
acces_327_a
For SIRCO MV
Rating (A)
2(1".,/
2(1".,5/
2(1".,5/
acces_326_a
Rating (A)
16 40
16 40
63 80
63 80
100 125
100 125
acces_329_a
acces_328_a
Use
Top and bottom protection against direct contact with the terminals or connection parts.
U@HK@AKDHMNQONKDUDQRHNMRENQ2(1".,@MCHMNQONKDUDQRHNMRENQ2(1".,5
An opening on each terminal cover makes it possible to insert a temperature measurement probe.
33
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
Accessories (continued)
,SXOD@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR
M type
acces_320_a
,@W@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSRLNCTKDR
Pre-break is not guaranteed on the
2(1".,5
Characteristics
-.
-"@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR(/VHSGEQNMS
operation.
Use
Pre-break and signalisation of positions 0
@MC(AX-.
-"NQ-.@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR
They allow to anticipate the switching of the
main poles. They can be mounted on the
KDESNQNMSGDQHFGSRHCDNESGDCDUHBD
SIRCO M
Rating (A)
Number of AC
Type of AC
16 125
1 AC
-.
-"
16 125
1 AC
-.
2299 0001
2299 0011
SIRCO MV
Rating (A)
Number of AC
-.
Reference
Type of AC
Reference
100 160
1 AC
-.
-"
100 160
1 AC
-.
2299 0001
2299 0011
-.
-"
,@WAKNBJR,@W "
-N/QDAQD@J
Characteristics
Operating current Ie (A)
Nominal current
(A)
-.
-"
230 VAC
AC-13
AC-15
10
10
sircm_188_a_1_gb_cat
Contact type
sircm_098_a_1_cat
,@WHLTL4SXOD
auxiliary contacts.
,@WHLTL,SXOD
auxiliary contact modules.
sircm_048_a_1_x_cat
U type
For SIRCO MV
Rating (A)
Number of AC
Type of AC
Reference
100 160
1 AC
-"
100 160
1 AC
-.
3999 0701
3999 0702
Characteristics
Contact Nominal
type
current (A)
400 VAC
24 VDC
48 VDC
AC-15
AC-15
DC-13
DC-13
-"
10
1.8
2.8
1.4
-.
10
1.8
2.8
1.4
Use
/QDAQD@J@MCRHFM@KHR@SHNMAX-.NQ-"@TWHKH@QX
contact.
,@WHLTL@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR
.MKX@U@HK@AKDENQ
2(1".,5RVHSBGDR
Conversion kit
Conversion kit
for 6 or 8 pole
load break
switches
acces_348_a
2(1".,BG@MFDNUDQRVHSBGDROQNUHCDNM
load changeover switching between two
sources or two low voltage power circuits,
as well as their safety isolation (I - 0 - II);
transfer without interruption of the supply is
also possible (I - I+II - II).
Conversion kits are supplied with a direct
front operation handle. For external operation
the appropriate handle needs to be ordered.
Conversion kit
for changeover
switches I - 0 - II
acces_49_a
Use
This accessory enables the assembly of two
3 pole switches (+ additional pole) in order
to create a:
NQONKD2(1".,KN@CAQD@JRVHSBG
@NQONKD2(1".,BG@MFDNUDQRVHSBG
Reference
2269 6009
2269 6011
Changeover switches I - 0 - II
Rating (A)
Type
16 80
Changeover switches I - 0 - II
100 125 Changeover switches I - 0 - II
34
acces_350_a
Rating (A)
16 80
100 125
2209 6009
2209 6011
Rating (A)
Type
16 80
Changeover switches I - I+II - II
100 125 Changeover switches I - I+II - II
Reference
2299 6009
2299 6011
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
acces_331_a
Use
This kit enables the direct mounting of the
switch on the panel door, or on the left or
right side of the panel.
The connection clamps of the switch are
always accessible.
acces_330_a
3/4 pole
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Description
Reference
16 80
3/4 P
16 80
3/4 P
Compact version
16 80
6/8 P
Steel support
3/4 P
Steel support
2299 3309
2299 3409
2299 3609
2299 3609
acces_332_a
For SIRCO M
6/8 pole
Use
This accessory enables the front face of the
2(1".,SNADB@OODCVGDMSGDRVHSBGHR
side operated. 20 pieces supplied per pack.
For SIRCO M
Rating (A)
Pack
Reference
16 125
20 pieces
2299 9409
Use
This accessory enables two 3/4 pole
switches to be coupled in order to provide
a 6 or 8 pole switch for external side
operation.40 pieces supplied per pack.
For SIRCO M
Rating (A)
16 80
Pack
Reference
40 pieces
2299 9909
#(-Q@HKKNBJHMFBKHO
Use
3GHRKNBJHMFBKHOOQDUDMSRSGD2(1".,5EQNLRKHCHMFVGDM
#(-Q@HKLNTMSDC
Type
Reference
100 160
+NBJHMFBKHO,
100 160
+NBJHMFBKHO,
5000 0041
5000 0051
acces_337_a
For SIRCO MV
Rating (A)
5NKS@FDRDMRHMF@MCONVDQRTOOKXS@O
acces_336_a
Use
3GHRRHMFKDONKDUNKS@FDRDMRHMFS@O@KKNVRSGDBNMMDBSHNMNEW
LL
UNKS@FDRDMRHMFNQONVDQB@AKDRSN@MX2(1".,5ONVDQSDQLHM@KVHSGNTS
reducing its connection capacity.
For SIRCO MV
Rating (A)
Pack
Reference
100 160
2 pieces
1399 4006
35
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
16 A
20 A
25 A
32 A
40 A
63 A
80 A
100 A
125 A
800
800
800
800
800
800
800
800
800
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
5 "
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
32/32
40/40
63/63
80/80
100/100
125/125
5 "
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
32/32
40/40
63/63
80/80
100/100
125/125
5 "
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
32/32
40/40
63/63
80/80
100/100
125/125
5 "
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
32/32
40/40
63/63
80/80
100/100
125/125
5 "
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
32/32
40/40
63/63
80/80
100/100
125/125
5 "
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
32/32
40/40
63/63
80/80
100/100
125/125
5 "
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
32/32
40/40
63/63
80/80
100/100
125/125
5 "
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
25/25
25/25
63/63
63/63
80/80
100/100
5 "
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
32/32
40/40
63/63
80/80
100/100
125/125
5 "
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
32/32
40/40
63/63
80/80
100/100
125/125
5 "
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
32/32
32/40
40/63
63/80
80/100
100/125
5 "
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
25/25
25/25
40/40
40/40
63/63
63/63
5#"
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
32/32
40/40
63/63
80/80
100/100
125/125
5#"
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
16/16(2)
20/20(2)
25/25(2)
32/32(2)
40/40(2)
63/63(2)
80/80(2)
5#"
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
32/32
40/40
63/63
80/80
5#"
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
16/16(3)
20/20(3)
25/25(3)
32/32(3)
40/40(3)
63/63(3)
80/80(3)
5#"
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
32/32
40/40
63/63
80/80
100/100
125/125
5#"
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
16/16(4)
20/20(4)
25/25(4)
25/25(4)
25/25(4)
40/40(4)
40/40(4)
63/63(4)
63/63(4)
7.5
11
15
18.5
30
37
45
55
7.5
11
15
18.5
30
37
45
55
7.5
11
15
15
15
30
37
45
55
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
25
25
16
20
25
32
40
63
80
100
125
Rated voltage
100/100(2) 125/125(2)
100/100
125/125
100/100(3) 125/125(3)
Circuit breaker protected short-circuit withstand with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s
Rated short-time withstand current 0.3s. Icw (kA rms)
2.5
2.5
2.5
2.5
2.5
1.26
1.26
1.26
1.26
1.26
1.5
1.5
2.75
2.75
1.8
1.8
1.8
1.8
1.8
2.1
2.1
3.9
3.9
,@WHLTL"TB@AKDBQNRRRDBSHNMLL
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
2.5
2.5
10
10
,@WHLTL"TB@AKDBQNRRRDBSHNMLL
16
16
16
16
16
35
35
70
70
2 / 2.2
2 / 2.2
2 / 2.2
2 / 2.2
2 / 2.2
4/4.4
4/4.4
Connection
3HFGSDMHMFSNQPTDLHML@W-L
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
100 000
100 000
100 000
100 000
100 000
100 000
100 000
100 000
100 000
.ODQ@SHMFDEENQSONKDCDUHBD-L
1.4
1.4
1.6
1.6
.ODQ@SHMFDEENQSONKDCDUHBD-L
1.2
1.2
1.2
1.2
1.2
1.6
1.6
0.18
0.18
0.18
0.18
0.18
0.27
0.27
0.55
0.55
0.23
0.23
0.23
0.23
0.23
0.33
0.33
0.72
0.72
0.40
0.40
0.40
0.40
0.40
0.59
0.59
1.30
1.30
0.50
0.50
0.50
0.50
0.50
0.69
0.69
1.65
1.65
0.40
0.40
0.40
0.40
0.40
0.59
0.59
1.30
1.30
0.50
0.50
0.50
0.50
0.50
0.69
0.69
1.65
1.65
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) one pole per polarity.
(3) 3-pole device with 2 poles in series for the "+" and 1 pole for the "-".
(4) 4-pole device with 2 poles in series per polarity.
36
(5) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer
to another.
(6) For a rated operational voltage Ue = 415 VAC
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
100 A
125 A
160 A
800
800
800
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
5 "
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
100/100
125/125
160/160
5 "
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
100/100
125/125
160/160
5 "
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
100/100
125/125
160/160
5 "
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
100/100
125/125
125/160
5 "
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
100/100
125/125
160/160
5 "
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
100/100
125/125
160/160
5 "
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
100/100
125/125
125/160
5 "
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
80/80
100/100
100/100
5 "
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
100/100
125/125
160/160
5 "
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
100/100
125/125
160/160
5 "
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
63/80
80/100
100/125
5 "
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
63/63
80/80
80/80
5#"
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
100/100
125/125
160/160
5#"
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
100/100(2)
125/125(2)
160/160(2)
5#"
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
100/100
125/125
160/160
5#"
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
100/100(3)
125/125(3)
160/160(3)
5#"
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
100/100
125/125
160/160
5#"
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
100/100(4)
125/125(4)
160/160(4)
45
55
75
45
55
75
45
75
75
Rated voltage
(6)
100
65
50
100
125
160
Circuit breaker protected short-circuit withstand with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s
Rated short-time withstand current 0.3s. Icw (kA rms)
,@WHLTL"TB@AKDBQNRRRDBSHNMLL
10
10
10
,@WHLTL"TB@AKDBQNRRRDBSHNMLL
70
70
70
4 / 4.4
4 / 4.4
4 / 4.4
50 000
Connection
3HFGSDMHMFSNQPTDLHML@W-L
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
50 000
50 000
.ODQ@SHMFDEENQSONKDCDUHBD-L
.ODQ@SHMFDEENQSONKDCDUHBD-L
4.2
4.2
4.2
0.68
0.68
0.68
0.85
0.85
0.85
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) One pole per polarity.
(3) 2 poles in series for the "+" and 1 pole for the "-".
(4) 2 poles in series per polarity.
(5) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer to another.
(6) For a rated operational voltage Ue = 415 VAC.
37
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
Dimensions
2(1".,
SIRCO M 16 to 80 A
Direct operation with handle
F
M
1
G
68
N
AC
8.8 F1
M5
F
M
F1 8.8
50
1. Location for: 1 switched fourth pole module (1 per device max.) or 1 unswitched
neutral pole or 1 protective earth module or 1 auxiliary contact.
2. Position for 1 auxiliary contact module only.
Note: max 2 additional blocks.
8.8
F1
M5
F1
8.8
1. Location for: 1 switched fourth pole module (1 per device max.) or 1 unswitched
neutral pole or 1 protective earth module or 1 auxiliary contact.
2. Position for 1 auxiliary contact module only.
Note: max 2 additional blocks.
36
E
D
36
81
64
50.6
B
F
M
J
36
sircm_054_e_1_x_cat
50
75
64
G
68
90
sircm_052_b_1_x_cat
N
AC
81
73
64
44
71
T
M5
1. Location for: 1 switched fourth pole module (1 per device max.) or 1 unswitched
neutral pole or 1 protective earth module or 1 auxiliary contact.
2. Position for 1 auxiliary contact only.
Note: max 2 additional blocks.
A. S000 Handle
B. S01 Handle.
C. S00 Handle.
Terminal
shrouds
Overall dimensions
Rating (A)
F1 8.8
8.8 F1
6
50
38
N
AC
G
68
41
80
45
25
sircm_053_b_1_x_cat
Toggle operation
Switch body
Switch mounting
Connection
D min
D max
E min
E max
AC
F1
1640
30
235
100
372
110
45
15
68
15
30
75
15
6380
30
235
100
372
110
52.5
17.5
76
17.5
35
85
17.5
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
2(1".,
SIRCO M 16 to 80 A (continued)
Direct front operation for 6/8 pole load break switches
or 3/4 pole changeover switches.
45
25
6
8,8
F1
F1
T
44
36
34,7
7,5
T
52,5
Overall dimensions
E min
E max
105
372
105
372
1640
6380
43
8,8
Rating (A)
sircm_182_d_1_x_cat
80
78
68
N
G
52,5
71
89
1
45
J
F2
M
A. S000 Handle.
B. S00 Handle.
C. S01 Handle.
F
97.5
105
F1
15
17.5
F
M
Switch body
F2
45
52.5
G
68
76
Switch mounting
M
N
30
75
35
85
J
48.75
52.5
Connection
T
X
15
7.5
17.5
8.75
N
AC
1. Location for: 1 switched fourth pole module (1 per device max.) or 1 unswitched
neutral pole or 1 protective earth module or 1 auxiliary contact.
2. Position for 1 auxiliary contact module only.
Note: max 2 additional blocks.
sircm_056_d_1_x_cat
8.8
53
F1
F1
8.8
M5
37
F
M
J
41
N
AC
71
88
80
sircm_057_d_1_x_cat
37
44
6
8.8
F1
53
100 125
D min
30
Overall dimensions
D max
E min
201
100
F1
8.8
M5
Rating (A)
E max
372
A. S01 Handle.
Terminal shrouds
AC
189
F
78
Switch body
F1
G
26
124.6
B. S0 Handle.
J
13
Switch mounting
M
N
26
131.4
Connection
T
26
39
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
Dimensions (continued)
2(1".,SN /@MC/BG@MFDNUDQRVHSBG
Direct front operation for 3/4 pole changeover switches
84.5
79.6
M
50
13.8
36
F1
100
8.8
79.6
Overall dimensions
100 125
1. Location for: 1 main pole or 1 auxiliary contact (See accessories page 33 and 34).
2. Position for 1 auxiliary contact module only
Note: max 2 additional blocks.
Rating (A)
sircm_183_e_1_x_cat
71
68
Switch body
Switch mounting
Connection
E min
E max
F1
105
372
159
26
124.5
52.8
131.5
26
2(1".,5
SIRCO MV - 100 to 160 A
Direct front operation
A
109
35 26
B
135
61
8,8
70
71
88
131,4
189
124,6
8,8
D
44
sircm_058_c_1_x_cat
2
76
64
1
6
26
M5
A. 3 poles
B. 4 poles
,@WHLTL,SXOD@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR
,@WHLTL4SXOD@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR
C. S0 type handle
D. S1 type handle
B
109
26
57
C
135
30 min.
300 max.
D
37
F
69,9
E
44
83
8,8
70
71
88
124,6
189
131,4
8,8
1
6
53
26
M5
40
2
D. S0 type handle
E. S1 type handle
F. Left side operation
,@WHLTL,SXOD@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR
,@WHLTL4SXOD@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR
sircm_059_d_1_x_cat
53
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
Front operation
Side operation
Direction of operation
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S000 type
I
90
90
3.2
45
22.5
13.5
22
45
27
poign_016_a_1_gb_cat
16 to 80 A
25
3.2
36
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
0
or
I+II
S000 type
Changeover switches
I-0-II and I - I+II - II
90
90
22.5
25
poign_017_b_1_gb_cat
27
II
3.2
45
22
45
Door drilling
3.2
13.5
36
Front operation
Side operation
Direction of operation
Direction of operation
S00 type
Load break switches
Door drilling
I
90
90
40
40
27
47
28
71
71
36
28
Handle type
31
37
I
13.5
poign_024_a_1_gb_cat
90
0
22.5
Front operation
Direction of operation
Door drilling
IP55 with 2 xing clips
0
or
I+II
13.5
37
37
22.5
90
71
40
90
71
I
36
II
28
27
28
poign_025_b_1_gb_cat
S00 type
Changeover switches
I-0-II and I - I+II - II
40
Handle type
47
41
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
Front operation
Side operation
Direction of operation
Direction of operation
I
9
90
37
poign_018_a_1_gb_cat
41
80
40
78
Door drilling
S01 type
47
44
28
Front operation
Direction of operation
S01 type
Door drilling
0
or
I+II
40
90
90
Changeover switches
I-0-II and I - I+II - II
78
47
28
II
41
80
poign_019_b_1_gb_cat
Handle type
37
44
100 to 125 A
Front operation
Side operation
Direction of operation
Direction of operation
S0 type
Load break switches
Door drilling
90
27
47
28
88
71
40
40
28
Handle type
31
37
37
poign_026_a_1_gb_cat
13.5
90
0
22.5
Front operation
Side operation
Direction of operation
Direction of operation
Right side operation
I
S01 type
Load break switches
90
90
37
41
80
40
78
Door drilling
47
44
42
28
poign_018_a_1_gb_cat
Handle type
SIRCO M and MV
Universal load break switches
from 16 to 160 A
2(1".,5
100 to 160 A
Front operation
Side operation
Direction of operation
Direction of operation
S0 type
Load break switches
Door drilling
90
90
27
71
47
28
88
40
40
28
Handle type
31
37
37
13.5
poign_026_a_1_gb_cat
90
0
22.5
Handle type
S1 type
Load break switches
Front operation
Side operation
Direction of operation
Direction of operation
Door drilling
IP55 with 2 xing clips
40
40
I
90
90
27
47
78
28
28
70
37
31
poign_027_a_1_gb_cat
44
I
90
43
IDE
Load break switches for machine control
Remotely trippable switch from 32 to 160 A
The solution for
Industry.
Non critical buildings.
Public Access Sites.
High Rise Buildings.
ide_021_a_1_cat
Load break
switches
>
>
>
>
ide_022_a_1_cat
IDE 4x40 A
Direct operation
Strong points
> Safety.
> Easy to install.
> Low consumption.
IDE 4x40 A
External operation
Function
IDE are manually operated multipolar load
break switches with a remote tripping
function.
They make and break under load conditions
and provide safety isolation for any low
voltage electric circuit, particularly for
compliance with the machine directive.
General characteristics
q Positive break indication.
q IP2X protection with terminal shrouds
(accessory).
q Shunt trip or undervoltage trip coil.
Advantages
Safety
Remote tripping is especially adapted for
protection against automatic machine restart
after isolation and restoration of the mains
voltage (EN 60204.1 7.5).
Low consumption
The device coils (including undervoltage)
have a low consumption, providing increased
reliability.
44
Easy to install
As standard the IDE is supplied with its
tripping coil factory fitted and with its
connections made internally.
For IDE 125 and 160A a factory fitted auxiliary
contact is supplied as standard, simplifying
product installation.The various fixing systems
(front or rear mount with direct or external
operation) enable easy device implementation.
IDE
Load break switches for machine control
Remotely trippable switch from 32 to 160 A
ide_009_c_1_x_cat
ide_008_b_1_x_cat
Direct operation
2
1. Base mounted
1. Base mounted
2. Door mounted
q Available in 230 or 400 VAC versions, the IDEs can be tripped remotely via a shunt trip or undervoltage coil.
They are used to protect against automatic restarting and to prevent damage caused if the network
malfunctions and is then re-established.
IDE 32 A
D2
14
L1
L2
L3
L1
L2 L3
OI
OI
PE
T1
T2
T3
ide_019_b_1_x_cat
ide_018_c_1_x_cat
U >
N1 T1 T1
24
T1
14
45
IDE
Load break switches for machine control
Remotely trippable switch from 32 to 160 A
References
Base mounted
Rating (A)
32 A
No. of poles
3P
Switch body
Undervoltage
coil
Switch body
Shunt trip coil
1260 3003(1)
1270 3003(2)
4P
3P
40 A
4P
3P
63 A
4P
3P
125 A
4P
3P
160 A
4P
1260 3004(1)(3)
1270 3004(2)(3)
1260 4004(1)(3)
1270 4004(2)(3)
1260 3007(1)(3)
1270 3007(2)(3)
1260 4007(1)(3)
1270 4007(2)(3)
1260 3013(1)
1270 3013(2)
1260 4013(1)
1270 4013(2)
1260 3016(1)
1270 3016(2)
1260 4016(1)
1270 4016(2)
1280 3004(1)(3)
1290 3004(2)(3)
1280 4004(1)(3)
1290 4004(2)(3)
1280 3007(1)(3)
1290 3007(2)(3)
1280 4007(1)(3)
1290 4007(2)(3)
1280 3013(1)
1290 3013(2)
1280 4013(1)
1290 4013(2)
1280 3016(1)
1290 3016(2)
1280 4016(1)
1290 4016(2)
Direct handle
Terminal
covers top/
bottom
(2 sets)
Black IP65
Black IP65
1299 5012
1299 6022
1 contact NO+NC
3/4 P
1299 5001
1299 8003
1299 5013
1299 6023
Black IP65
1299 6032
1 contact NO+NC
3/4 P
1299 0031
1299 8007
1299 6143(4)
Empty
enclosure
1295 9001(5)
Black IP65
1299 6142(4)
1299 6033
Please consult us
Black IP65
Black IP65
1299 5032
1299 6042
1 contact NO+NC
3/4 P
1299 0021
1299 8013
1299 5033
1299 6043
46
External operation
200 mm
Position
auxiliary
contact
IDE
Load break switches for machine control
Remotely trippable switch from 32 to 160 A
Door mounted
Rating (A)
32 A
No. of poles
3P
Switch body
Undervoltage coil
Switch body
Shunt trip coil
1210 3003(1)
1220 3003(2)
3P
4P
3P
63 A
4P
3P
125 A
4P
3P
160 A
4P
Auxiliary contact
position
Black IP65
4P
40 A
Direct handle
1299 5012
1 contact NO+NC
3/4 P
1299 5001
1299 8003
1299 5013
1210 3004(1)
1220 3004(2)
1210 4004(1)
1220 4004(2)
1210 3007(1)
1220 3007(2)
1210 4007(1)
1220 4007(2)
1210 3013(1)
1220 3013(2)
1210 4013(1)
1220 4013(2)
1210 3016(1)
1220 3016(2)
1210 4016(1)
1220 4016(2)
1230 3004(1)
1240 3004(2)
1230 4004(1)
1240 4004(2)
1230 3007(1)
1240 3007(2)
1230 4007(1)
1240 4007(2)
1230 3013(1)
1240 3013(2)
1230 4013(1)
1240 4013(2)
1230 3016(1)
1240 3016(2)
1230 4016(1)
1240 4016(2)
Black IP65
1299 5022
1 contact NO+NC
3/4 P
1299 0031
1299 8007
1299 5023
Black IP65
1299 5032
1 contact NO+NC
3/4 P
1299 0021
1299 8013
1299 5033
47
IDE
Load break switches for machine control
Remotely trippable switch from 32 to 160 A
Accessories
Direct operation handle for base mounting
Rating (A)
Handle colour
External IP
32
Black
IP65
32
Red/Yellow
IP65
40 63
Black
IP65
40 63
Red/Yellow
IP65
125 160
Black
IP65
125 160
Red/Yellow
IP65
Reference
1299 5012
1299 5013
1299 6142(1)
1299 6143(1)
1299 5032
1299 5033
Handle colour
External IP
Reference
32
Black
IP65
32
Red/Yellow
IP65
1299 5012
1299 5013
1299 5022
1299 5023
1299 5032
1299 5033
40 63
Black
IP65
40 63
Red/Yellow
IP65
125 160
Black
IP65
125 160
Red/Yellow
IP65
External IP
Reference
32
200
IP65
40 63
200
IP65
125 160
200
IP65
1299 6022
1299 6032
1299 6042
48
External IP
Reference
32
200
IP65
40 63
200
IP65
125 160
200
IP65
1299 6023
1299 6033
1299 6043
IDE
Load break switches for machine control
Remotely trippable switch from 32 to 160 A
ide_023_b_1_cat
Use
1 NO+NC auxiliary contact for position 0
and I signalling.
Characteristics
Rating (A)
Contact type
32 63
NO + NC
12
125 160
NO + NC
Rating (A)
Mounting
Contact(s)
Reference
32
by customer
1 NO+NC
40 63
by customer
1 NO+NC
125 160
by customer
1 NO+NC
125 160
factory fitted
1 NO+NC
1299 5001
1299 0031
1299 0021
1299 0121
Terminal shrouds
Rating (A)
Position
Reference
32
top / bottom
40 63
top / bottom
125 160
top / bottom
1299 8003(1)
1299 8007(1)
1299 8013(1)
ide_035_a_1_cat
Use
Top or bottom protection against direct contact with
terminals or connection parts.
Top and bottom pair.
Reference
1295 9001
Please consult us
49
IDE
Load break switches for machine control
Remotely trippable switch from 32 to 160 A
Characteristics
Characteristics according to IEC 60947-3
IDE - 32 to 160 A
Thermal current Ith (40 C)
32 A
40 A
63 A
125 A
160 A
690
690
690
690
690
Utilisation category
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
415 VAC
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
32/32
40/40
63/63
125/125
160/160
415 VAC
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
32/32
40/40
63/63
125/125
160/160
415 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
32/32
40/40
63/63
125/125
160/160
415 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
14/14
40/40
63/63
125/125
160/160
Uimp (kV)
415 VAC
AC-3
14
30
44
100
100
690 VAC
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
32/32
40/40
63/63
125/125
160/160
690 VAC
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
32/32
40/40
63/63
125/125
160/160
690 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
13/13
32/32
40/40
125/125
160/160
690 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
4.9/4.9
17.5/17.5
21/21
42/42
49/49
7.5
22
30
63
80
7.5
15
22
55
55
(2)
(2)
(3)
10
10
32
40
63
125
1.5
1.5
2.5
2.5
5.2
5.2
6.6
6.6
2.5
2.5
10
10
70
70
1.2/1.5
2/2.5
2/2.5
6/12
6/12
30 000
Connection
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
100 000
50 000
50 000
30 000
0.35
0.38
0.45
1.6
0.26
0.35
0.39
1.35
1.45
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer to another.
(3) For a rated operational voltage Ue = 415 VAC.
50
IDE
Load break switches for machine control
Remotely trippable switch from 32 to 160 A
Dimensions
IDE 32 A
Direct operation with door or
panel mounting
47
34 55.5
4 max.
7.3
67
79
min. 52
63
ide_031_a_1_x_cat
4.5
72
58.5
92
M4
4.5
34
75
91
ide_024_a_1_x_cat
106
72
121
76
1. For PE 16 mm
IDE 40 to 63 A
Direct operation with door or
panel mounting
47
72
83
92
M4
76
100
72
34
68
4 max.
ide_032_a_1_x_cat
35
4.3
18
min. 76
73
65
110
min. 76
ide_033_a_1_x_cat
38
67
80
90
5.2 max.
M5
115
144
96
44
88
4 max.
125
51
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
from 125 to 5000 A
sirco_456_a_1
Load break
switches
new
>
>
>
>
>
Main switchboard.
Distribution panel.
Emergency breaking.
Network coupling.
Local safety breaking.
sirco_273_a_1_cat
SIRCO 3 x 250 A
direct handle
Strong points
> Reliability and performance.
> Safety of property
and personnel.
> Simplicity.
> Easy to install.
SIRCO AC 3 x 250 A
direct handle
Enclosures
Function
SIRCO and SIRCO AC are manually operated multipolar load break switches.
They make and break under load conditions and provide safety isolation.
SIRCO are designed for 415 VAC and DC low voltage electrical circuits.
SIRCO AC are designed for heavy duty applications up to 690 VAC - AC 23.
General characteristics
q Double positive break indication given through a position indication window, located directly
on the product, and by the operating handle.
q Severe utilisation categories (AC-22 and AC-23).
q High resistance to damp heat (supplied "tropicalised").
Advantages
Reliability and performance
The SIRCOs double breaking per pole,
achieved through its sliding bar contact
system, is a proven design that offers very
high durability and short-circuit withstand.
The quick opening and rapid closure of the
SIRCOs contacts, combined with specifically
designed arcing chambers, provides
the SIRCO AC with improved breaking
performance.
Safety of property and personnel
The position indicator is located directly on
the sliding bar contact mechanism, ensuring it
can be seen in all circumstances.
The use of glass fibre reinforced polyester
gives the SIRCO and SIRCO AC both high
mechanical and thermal resistance.
52
Simplicity
The standardisation of the SIRCO and
2(1". "Q@MFDDM@AKDR@BNRSQDCTBSHNM
in stock management and storage thanks to
their shared accessories.
Easy to install
Easy installation is facilitated thanks to:
q A good centre-to-centre distance
(up to 120 mm).
q Connection up to 6x185 mm.
q Connection accessories which facilitate
connection, both flat and edgewise
connections.
> 7KH6,5&2DQG6,5&2}$&
range can be easily fitted in
our enclosures and cabinets
designed for electrical
distribution.
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
sirco_372_b_1_cat
For ratings 2000, 2500 and 3200A, a copper bar connection kit enables the
connection between the two power terminals of one pole.
acces_223_b_2_cat
Edgewise connection
Top or bottom
acces_220_c_2_cat
Flat connection
Top or bottom
53
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
SIRCO - References
Front operation - 3 & 4 pole
Rating (A)
No. of poles
3P
125 A
4P
3P
160 A
4P
3P
200 A
4P
3P
250 A
4P
3P
315 A
4P
3P
400 A
4P
3P
500 A
4P
3P
630 A
4P
3P
800 A
4P
1000 A
CD 1250 A
1250 A
1600 A
1800 A
2000 A
2500 A
3200 A
4000 A
5000 A
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
Switch body
only(1)
2600 3014
2600 4014
2600 3017
2600 4017
2600 3021
2600 4021
2600 3026
2600 4026
2600 3032
2600 4032
2600 3041
2600 4041
2600 3051
2600 4051
2600 3064
2600 4064
2600 3081
2600 4081
2600 3099
2600 4099
2600 3119
2600 4119
2600 3121
2600 4121
2600 3161
2600 4161
2600 3181
2600 4181
2600 3200
2600 4200
2600 3250
2600 4250
2600 3320
2600 4320
2600 3401
2600 4401
2600 3500
2600 4500
Direct handle
B1 type
Black
Terminal
shrouds
3P
2694 3014(3)
2699 5042(2)
4P
Red
2694 4014(3)
2699 5043
3P
S2 type
Black IP55
B2 type
Black
1400 1020
Black IP65
1400 1032(2)
Red
Red IP65
1424 2111
2694 3021(3)
200 mm
1421 2111(2)
1423 2111
2699 5052(2)
4P
2694 4021(3)
320 mm
Terminal screens
3P
2698 3012(3)
4P
2698 4012(3)
3P
2698 3020(3)
4P
2698 4020(3)
500 mm
1400 1050
3P
2699 5053
2694 3051(3)
4P
2694 4051(3)
3P
2698 3050(3)
4P
2698 4050(3)
2699 0031
2nd contact NO/NC
2699 0032
3P
2698 3080(3)
4P
S4 type
Black IP65
1443 3111(2)
Red IP65
C2 type
Black
1444 3111
2698 4080(3)
200 mm
1401 1520
320 mm
1401 1532(2)
400 mm
1401 1540
3P
2698 3120(3)
(2)
2799 7012
4P
2698 4120(3)
Red
2799 7013
V2 type
Black IP65
2799 7136(2)
Red IP65
2799 7134
3P
2698 3200(3)
200 mm
4P
2799 3015
2698 4200(3)
320 mm
2799 3018(2)
450 mm
V0 type
Black
2799 7072(2)
(1) Device available enclosed (see "Enclosed load break switches" page 600).
(2) Standard.
(3) Top or bottom.
54
External handle
V0 type
Black IP65
2799 7155(2)
2799b
1st/2nd contact
NO/NC
included
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
SIRCO AC - References
Heavy duty applications - Front operation 3 & 4 pole
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Switch body
3P
26AC 3020
4P
26AC 4020
3P
26AC 3025
4P
26AC 4025
3P
26AC 3031
4P
26AC 4031
1112 1111
3P
26AC 3040
J1 type
Red
4P
26AC 4040
1113 1111
3P
26AC 3050
4P
26AC 4050
3P
26AC 3063
200 A
250 A
315 A
400 A
500 A
CD 630 A
4P
26AC 4063
3P
26AC 3064
4P
26AC 4064
3P
26AC 3080
4P
26AC 4080
3P
26AC 3100
630 A
800 A
1000 A
4P
26AC 4100
3P
26AC 3120
4P
26AC 4120
3P
26AC 3121
4P
26AC 4121
3P
26AC 3160
4P
26AC 4160
3P
26AC 3200
CD 1250 A
1250 A
1600 A
Direct handle
4P
26AC 4200
3P
26AC 3400
4000 A
4P
26AC 4400
Terminal
shrouds
3P
2694 3021(2)(3)
J1 type
Black
S2 type
Black
IP55
(1)
1421 2111(1)
Black
IP65
4P
2694 4021(2)(3)
Terminal screens
3P
2698 3020(3)
4P
2698 4020(3)
200 mm
1400 1020
320 mm
1400 1032(1)
1423 2111
500 mm
Red
IP65
1400 1050
3P
1424 2111
2694 3051(2)(3)
4P
2694 4051(2)(3)
3P
2698 3050(3)
4P
2698 4050(3)
2699 0031
2nd contact NO/NC
2699 0032
3P
2698 3080(2)(3)
J4 type
Black
1142 1111(1)
Red
S4 type
Black
IP65
1443 3111(1)
Red
IP65
1143 1111
4P
200 mm
2698 4080(2)(3)
1401 1520
320 mm
1401 1532(1)
400 mm
1444 3111
1401 1540
3P
2698 3120(2)(3)
4P
2698 4120(2)(3)
S5 type
Black
(1)
2799 7042
2000 A
External handle
S5 type
Black IP65
1453 8111(1)
Red
Red IP65
2799 7043
1454 8111
V0 type
Black
V0 type
Black
(1)
2799 7072
(1)
2799 7155
3P
2698 3200(2)(3)
200 mm
2799 3015
320 mm
4P
2698 4200(2)(3)
(1)
2799 3018
450 mm
2799 3019
1st / 2nd
included
3/4P
1509 4200(4)
(1) Standard.
(2) Mandatory for voltage greater than 415 VAC.
(3) Top or bottom.
(4) Top and bottom.
55
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
SIRCO - References
Standard applications - Front operation - 6 & 8 pole
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Switch body
6P
2601 6013
8P
2601 8013
Direct handle
125 A
6P
2601 6016
8P
2601 8016
6P
2601 6025
8P
2601 8025
6P
2601 6040
B3 type
Black
4199 5012(1)
External handle
S2 Type
Black IP55
1421 2111(1)
Red IP65
1424 2111
160 A
200 mm
Terminal
shrouds
6P
2694 3014(2)(3)
1400 1020
320 mm
8P
1400 1032(1)
2694 4014(2)(3)
6P
2694 3021(2)(3)
250 A
8P
2694 4021(2)(3)
C1 type
Black
(1)
2799 7052
400 A
8P
2601 8040
6P
2601 6063
Red
2799 7053
S4 type
Black IP65
1443 3111(1)
Red IP65
1444 3111
Terminal screens
6P
1509 3012(4)
8P
1509 4012(4)
6P
1509 3025(4)
8P
1509 4025(4)
200 mm
1401 1520
320 mm
6P
1401 1532(1)
2694 3051(2)(3)
1st contact NO/NC
2699 0061
630 A
8P
2694 4051(2)(3)
6P
1509 3063(4)
8P
1509 4063(4)
2601 8063
6P
2601 6080
8P
2601 8080
6P
2601 6100
8P
2601 8100
2699 0062
800 A
1000 A
6P
1509 3080(4)
C1 type
Black
2799 7012(1)
6P
2601 6120
8P
2601 8120
6P
2601 6160
8P
2601 8160
1250 A
1600 A
2799 7145(1)
320 mm
1509 4080(4)
2799 3018(1)
2799 7013
6P
1509 3160(4)
8P
(1) Standard.
(2) Upstream or downstream at the front or rear of the device.
(3) Select 2 sets for front or rear.
(4) Upstream or downstream at the front of the device.
56
Red
8P
V1 type
Black IP65
1509 4160(4)
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
Accessories
Reference
Black
Red
Black
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
2699 5042(1)
2699 5043
4199 5012(1)
2699 5052(1)
2699 5053
2799 7052(1)
2799 7053
2799 7012(1)
2799 7013
2799 7012(1)
2799 7013
2799 7072(1)
Handle colour
Reference
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
1112 1111(1)
1113 1111
1142 1111(1)
1143 1111
2799 7042(1)
2799 7043
2799 7072(1)
J1 type
handle
B2 type
handle
C2 type
handle
acces_286_a_2_cat
Handle colour
B1 type
B1 type
B3 type
B2 type
B2 type
C1 type
C1 type
C2 type
C2 type
C2 type
C2 type
V0 type
acces_153_a_2_cat
Handle
access_355_a
acces_114_a_2_cat
S5 type
handle
(1) Standard.
S2 type handle
S3 type handle
S4 type handle
acces_286_a_1_cat
1421 2111(2)(3)
1423 2111
1424 2111
1421 2111(2)
1423 2111
1424 2111
1443 3111
1444 3111
2799 7145(2)
1443 3111(2)(3)
1444 3111
2799 7136(2)
2799 7134
1453 8111(3)
1454 8111
2799 7155(2)(3)
acces_150_a_2_cat
IP55
IP65
IP65
IP55
IP65
IP65
IP65
IP65
IP65
IP65
IP65
IP65
IP65
IP65
IP65
IP65
Reference
acces_152_a_2_cat
External
IP(1)
Use
Door interlocked external operation handles include an
escutcheon, are padlockable and must be utilised with
an extension shaft.
acces_151_a_2_cat
S5 type handle
57
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
125 160
200 250
315 630
800 1800
200 315
400 CD 630
630 1600
2000 3200
4000 5000
2000
4000
Dimension X
(mm)
Length (mm)
Reference
125 250
200
125 300
250
125 370
320
125 550
500
1400 1020
1400 1025
1400 1032
1400 1050
1400 1075
1400 1020
1400 1025
1400 1032
1400 1050
1400 1075
1400 1020
1400 1025
1400 1032
1400 1050
1400 1075
1401 1520
1401 1532
1401 1540
2799 3015
2799 3018
2799 3019
2799 3015
2799 3018
125 850
750
135 265
200
135 315
250
135 385
320
135 565
500
135 880
750
165 295
200
165 345
250
165 415
320
165 595
500
165 940
750
221 343
200
221 463
320
221 543
400
415 570
200
415 690
320
415 820
450
550 680
200
651 921
320
Use
Standard lengths:
- 200 mm
- 250 mm
- 300 mm
- 400 mm
- 500 mm
- 750 mm
acces_368_a_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
SIRCO
acces_144_b_1_cat
58
Rating (A)
Dimension X (mm)
Length (mm)
Reference
125 160
270 436
200
125 160
270 556
320
250 630
221 308
200
250 630
221 428
320
250 630
221 508
400
1400 1020
1400 1032
1400 1520
1400 1532
1400 1540
acces_202_a_1_x_cat
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
Accessories (continued)
Alternative S-type handle cover colours
To be ordered
in multiples of
Handle
Reference
Light grey
50
S2, S3 type
Dark grey
50
S2, S3 type
Light grey
50
S4 type
Dark grey
50
S4 type
1401 0001
1401 0011
1401 0031
1401 0041
Handle colour
acces_198_a_2_cat
Use
For single lever handles S1, S2, S3 type and
for double lever handle S4 type.
Other colours: Please consult us.
S-type cover
Handle colour
Black
To be ordered
in multiples of
External IP(1)
Reference
IP65
1493 0000
acces_187_a_1_cat
Use
Enables S-type handles to be fitted in place of older style
Socomec handles. Adapter can be utilised as a spacer to
increase the distance between the panel door and the handle
lever.
Adds 12 mm to the depth.
Description
Reference
Shaft guide
1429 0000
acces_260_a_2_cat
Use
For utilisation with S-type handles, to guide the shaft extension into the external handle.
This accessory enables the handle to engage the extension shaft with a misalignment
NETOSNLL
Required for shaft lengths over 320 mm.
59
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
Auxiliary contact
acces_065_a_1_cat
Characteristics
NO/NC A/C: IP2 with front operation.
Connection to the control circuit
6.35 mm fast-on terminal.
Electrical characteristics
30 000 operations.
Use
Pre-break and signalling of positions 0 and I:
- 1 to 2 NO/NC auxiliary contacts.
- 1 to 4 NO+NC auxiliary contacts.
- 1 to 2 low level NO/NC auxiliary contacts.
Reference
acces_076_a_1_cat
2699 0031
2699 0032
included
Reference
2699 0061
2699 0062
Reference
2699 0141
2699 0142
NO/NC low level contact for 3/4 pole SIRCO and SIRCO AC
Rating (A)
Position A/C
Reference
125 3200
1st
2699 0301
125 3200
2nd
2699 0302
Characteristics
Rating (A)
125 3200
125 3200
Contact type
NO/NC
NO + NC
230 VAC
AC-12
AC-13/15
16
4
16
4
Current
nominal (A)
16
16
DC-12
2.5
2.5
48 VDC
DC-13
1.2
1.2
DC-14
0.2
0.2
Inter-phase barrier
60
Rating (A)
SIRCO AC
200 315
200 315
315 CD 360
315 CD 360
630 4000
630 4000
No. of poles
Reference
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
2998 0033
2998 0034
2998 0023
2998 0024
2998 0013
2998 0014
included
included
acces_036_a_1_cat
Use
Safety isolation between the terminals, essential
for use at 690 VAC or in a polluted or dusty
atmosphere.
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
Terminal shrouds
Rating (A)
SIRCO AC
200 315
200 315
400 CD 630
400 CD 630
No. of
poles
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
Position
top or bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
acces_077_a_1_cat
Advantage
Perforations allow remote thermographic
inspection without the need to remove the
shrouds.The terminal shrouds also provide
phase separation for SIRCO and SIRCO AC
125 to 630 A.
Use
Top or bottom protection against direct
contact with terminals or connection parts.
Reference
2694 3014(1)
2694 4014(2)
2694 3021(1)
2694 4021(2)
2694 3051(1)
2694 4051(2)
No. of poles
6P
8P
6P
8P
6P
8P
Position
top or bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
Reference
2694 3014(1)(3)
2694 4014(2)(3)
2694 3021(1)(3)
2694 4021(2)(3)
2694 3051(1)(3)
2694 4051(2)(3)
(1) Reference includes 3 parts for top or bottom protection on the front or rear of the device.
(2) Reference includes 4 parts for top or bottom protection on the front or rear of the device.
(3) Select 2 sets for front or rear.
Distribution block
Use
Easy connection of several cables, downstream of the
SIRCO.
Rating
(A)
No. of
poles
No of feeders per
section (mm)
Reference
160
3P
1x95 + 8x25
10
160
4P
1x95 + 8x25
10
250
3P
1x150 + 8x50
15
250
4P
1x150 + 8x50
15
400
3P
1x240 + 8x95
21
400
4P
1x240 + 8x95
21
630
3P
1x300 + 8x150
21
630
4P
1x300 + 8x150
21
5411 3016
5411 6016
5411 3025
5411 4025
5411 3040
5411 4040
5411 3063
5411 4063
repar_020_c_2_cat
3P
154
286
73
46.5
261.5
36
20
54
160
4P
190
286
73
46.5
261.5
36
20
54
250
3P
210
307
83
57.5
279
50
25
56
250
4P
260
307
83
57.5
279
50
25
56
400
3P
281
375
116
82.5
340
65
32
82
400
4P
346
375
116
82.5
340
65
32
82
630
3P
271
438
117
90.5
410.5
65
40
83
630
4P
346
438
117
90.5
410.5
65
40
83
repar_003_c_1_x_cat
160
No. of
poles
Rating
(A)
Dimensions
R
P
P P
A
T
Y
E
61
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
Terminal screens
Use
Top and bottom protection against direct contact
with terminals or connection parts.
Rating (A)
SIRCO
Rating (A)
SIRCO AC
No. of
poles
Position
Reference
125 160
3P
top or bottom
125 160
4P
top or bottom
2698 3012
2698 4012
2698 3020
2698 4020
2698 3050
2698 4050
2698 3080
2698 4080
2698 3120
2698 4120
2698 3200
2698 4200
1509 4200
200 250
200 315
3P
top or bottom
200 250
200 315
4P
top or bottom
315 630
400 CD 630
3P
top or bottom
315 630
400 CD 630
4P
top or bottom
800 CD 1250
630 CD 1250
3P
top or bottom
800 CD 1250
630 CD 1250
4P
top or bottom
1250 1800
1250 1600
3P
top or bottom
1250 1800
1250 1600
4P
top or bottom
2000 3200
2000
3P
top or bottom
2000 3200
2000
4P
top or bottom
4000 5000
4000
3/4 P
top or bottom
acces_079_a_1_cat
No. of poles
Position
Reference
125 160
6P
top or bottom
125 160
8P
top or bottom
250
6P
top or bottom
250
8P
top or bottom
400 630
6P
1509 3012
1509 4012
1509 3025
1509 4025
1509 3063
1509 4063
1509 3080
1509 4080
1509 3160
1509 4160
400 630
8P
800 1250
6P
800 1250
8P
1600
6P
1600
8P
Cage terminals
Material: tin-plated aluminium.
X1
X
Dimensions
Rating (A)
A1
X1
125 160
47.5
22.5
25
12
20
3.5
8.5
M12
10
200 250
62
31.5
31.5
16.5
25
2.5
10.5
M16
14
315 400
71.5
32
38
32
10.5
M20
15
500 630
76.5
37
38
40
12.5
M20
15
References
62
Rating (A)
Tightening
capacity
(mm)
No. of
poles
Tightening
torque (Nm)
Width of
flexible bar
(mm)
125 160
16 95
3P
14
13
125 160
16 95
4P
14
13
200 250
16 185
3P
25
18
200 250
16 185
4P
25
18
315 400
50 240
3P
45
20
315 400
50 240
4P
45
20
500 630
70 300
3P
45
24
500 630
70 300
4P
45
24
Reference
5400 3016
5400 4016
5400 3025
5400 4025
5400 3040
5400 4040
5400 3063
5400 4063
Z
R
A1
born_019_a_1_x_cat
Use
They enable a direct terminal-free connection
to rigid copper and aluminium conductors
with integration under the IP2X protective
cover.
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
Accessories (continued)
Copper bar connection kits
Use
To allow connection between the two power terminals of the same pole for 2000 to 3200 A
ratings (Fig. 1 and Fig 2).
For 3200 A rating, the connection pieces (part A) are delivered bridged from factory.1
Bolt sets must be ordered separately.
Further details for these specific accessories are available in the user guide downloadable from
www.socomec.com.
Fig. 1
Reference
2000 2500
Connection - part A
2000 2500
2619 1200
2699 1200
2699 1200
3200
Connection - part A
3200
included
(1) Example for a 3 pole device equipped upstream only: Order 3 times
the indicated quantities.
133.5
96.5
5
59.5
Fig. 1
120
Fig.2
Piece
Quantity to order
per pole(1)
2000 2500
Connection - part A
2000 2 500
T piece - part C
2000 2500
Bracket- part D
Rating (A)
acces_222_b_1_x_cat
310
120
258
120
3200
Connection - part A
3200
T piece - part C
3200
Bracket- part D
Reference
2619 1200
2629 1200(2)
2639 1200(2)
acces_220_c_1_x_cat
Piece
acces_224_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
included
2629 1200
2639 1200
156.5
126.5
96.5
66.5
Fig.2
120
120
36.5
420
120
acces_225_a_1_cat
(1) Example for a 3 pole device equipped upstream only: Order 3 times
the indicated quantities.
(2) Bolt set is provided with the accessories.
63
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
For SIRCO
Locking using RONIS EL11AP lock (not supplied)
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Operation
Figure
Reference
125 630
3/4 P
front direct
125 1800
3/4 P
external front
800 3200
3/4 P
front direct
1250 5000
3/4 P
external front
2699 6008(1)
1499 7701
2699 6027
2799 7002
Fig.2
Fig. 3
acces_005_a_1_x_cat
the door,
- using lock (not supplied):
see diagrams opposite,
- using undervoltage coil: the SIRCO can
only be closed if the coil is live.
acces_001_a_1_x_cat
Use
Locking in position 0 of the front operation
handle:
- using a padlock (not supplied) - function
is available as standard on the handle.
From 125 to 1800 A, the padlock on the
external front operation handle also locks
Fig.4
No. of poles
Operation
Figure
Reference
200 CD 630
Rating (A)
3/4 P
front direct
630 1600
3/4 P
front direct
2699 6011(1)
2699 6028
For SIRCO
Locking using 230 VAC undervoltage coil
(other voltages: please consult us)
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Operation
Reference
125 630
3/4 P
external front
800 3200
3/4 P
front direct
2699 9063(1)
2699 9315(1)
No. of
poles
Handle
Lock
type
Operation
Figure
Reference
125 160
6/8 P
S2 type
External front
125 1 800
3/4 P
S2, S4 type
FS
External front
125 1 800
3/4 P
S2, S4 type
External front
250 630
6/8 P
S4 type
External front
800 1 600
6/8 P
S5 type
External front
1 250 4 000
3/4 P
S5, S0 type
External front
4109 8507
1499 7703
1499 7702
2999 8707
2799 7003
2799 7003
bd_03_01_01
q Mechanical coupling device for making switches with "n" poles of the
same or different ratings.
q Mechanical interlocking device.
64
acces_004_c_1_x_cat
For SIRCO AC
Locking using RONIS EL11AP lock (not supplied)
acces_158_a_1_x_cat
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
125 A
160 A
200 A
250 A
315 A
400 A
500 A
630 A
800 A
800
800
800
800
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
12
12
12
12
12
Utilisation category
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
125/125
160/160
200/200
250/250
315/315
400/400
500/500
630/630
800/800
415 VAC
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
125/125
160/160
200/200
250/250
315/315
400/400
500/500
630/630
800/800
415 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
125/125
160/160
200/200
250/250
315/315
400/400
500/500
630/630
800/800
415 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
125/125
160/160
200/200
250/250
315/315
400/400
500/500
500/500
800/800
220 VDC
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
125/125
160/160
200/200
250/250
315/315
400/400
500/500
630/630
800/800
220 VDC
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
125/125
160/160
160/200
250/250
315/315
400/400
500/500
630/630
800/800
220 VDC
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
125/125
160/160
160/200
250/250
315/315
400/400
400/500
500/500
800/800
220 VDC
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
125/125
125/125
160/160
200/200
315/315
400/400
400/400
500/500
800/800
440 VDC
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
125/125
160/160
200/200
250/250
315/315
400/400
500/500
630/630
800/800
440 VDC
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
200(3)/200(3)
315(3)/315(3)
400(3)/400(3)
440 VDC
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
125(3)/125(3)
200(3)/200(3)
315(3)/315(3)
400(3)/400(3)
(4)
(4)
125(3)/125(3)
(4)
(4)
160(3)/160(3)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
440 VDC
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
125 /125
125 /125
160 /160
200 /200
315 /315
400 /400
400(4)/400(4)
500/500
800(4)/800(4)
500 VDC
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
125/125
160/160
200/200
250/250
315/315
400/400
500/500
630/630
800/800
500 VDC
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
125(3)/125(3)
125(3)/125(3)
160(3)/200(3)
200(3)/200(3)
315(3)/315(3)
400(3)/400(3)
500 VDC
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
125(4)/125(4)
125(4)/125(4)
160(4)/160(4)
200(4)/200(4)
315(4)/315(4)
315(4)/400(4)
500 VDC
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
125(4)/125(4) 125(4)/125(4)
160(4)/160(4)
200(4)/200(4)
315(4)/315(4)
315(4)/400(4)
(1)(5)
2SHUDWLRQDOSRZHULQ$&$N:
At 415 VAC without pre-break in AC(1)
63/63
80/80
100/100
132/132
160/160
220/220
280/280
280/280
450/450
55
75
90
115
145
185
230
290
365
5HDFWLYHSRZHUNYDU
At 400 VAC (kvar)(5)
)XVHSURWHFWHGVKRUWFLUFXLWZLWKVWDQGN$UPVSURVSHFWLYH
Prospective short-circuit current (kA rms)
100
100
80
50
100
100
100
70
50
125
160
200
250
315
400
500
630
800
25
50
&LUFXLWEUHDNHUSURWHFWHGVKRUWFLUFXLWZLWKVWDQGZLWKDQ\FLUFXLWEUHDNHUWKDWHQVXUHVWULSSLQJLQOHVVWKDQVDW9$&
Rated short-time withstand current 0.3s. Icw (kA rms)
15
15
17
17
25
25
25
6KRUWFLUFXLWFDSDFLW\ZLWKRXWSURWHFWLRQ
Rated short-time withstand current 1s. Icw (kA rms)
Rated short-circuit making capacity without fuses Icm
(kA peak)
13
13
13
13
35
11.9
11.9
15.3
15.3
26
26
26
26
73.5
35
50
70
95
150
185
240
2 x 150
2 x 185
Connection
Maximum Cu cable cross-section (mm)
Minimum Cu busbar cross-section (mm)
2 x 30 x 5 2 x 40 x 5
50
95
95
150
240
240
240
2 x 300
25
25
32
32
40
40
40
50
2 x 300
63
9/-
9/-
20/-
20/-
20/-
20/-
20/-
20/-
40/45
10 000
10 000
10 000
10 000
10 000
10 000
10 000
10 000
3 000
6.5
6.5
10
10
10
14.5
14.5
14.5
37
1.5
3.5
3.5
3.5
3.5
1.5
1.5
4.5
4.5
10
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
Operating effort (Nm)
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) With terminal shrouds or phase barrier.
(3) 3-pole device with 2 pole in series for the "+" and 1 pole for the "-".
(4) 4-pole device with 2 poles in series per polarity.
(5) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer to another.
(6) For a rated operational voltage Ue = 415 VAC.
65
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
1000 A
CD 1250 A
1250 A
1600 A
1800 A
2000 A
2500 A
3200 A
4000 A
5000 A
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
12
12
12
12
12
12
12
12
12
12
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
Utilisation category
415 VAC
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
1000/1000 1250/1250 1250/1250 1600/1600 1800/1800 2000/2000 2500/2500 3200/3200 4000/4000 5000/5000
415 VAC
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
1000/1000 1250/1250 1250/1250 1600/1600 1800/1800 2000/2000 2500/2500 3200/3200 4000/4000 5000/5000
415 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
1000/1000 1250/1250 1250/1250 1600/1600 1800/1800 2000/2000 2500/2500 2500/3200 2500/3200 2500/3200
415 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
1000/1000 1250/1250 1250/1250 1250/1250 1250/1250 1600/1600 1600/1600 1600/1600 1800/2000 1800/2000
220 VDC
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
1000/1000 1250/1250 1250/1250 1600/1600 1800/1800 2000/2000 2500/2500 3200/3200 4000/4000 5000/5000
220 VDC
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
1000/1000 1250/1250 1250/1250 1250/1600 1250/1600 2000/2000 2000/2500 2000/2500 2500/3200 2500/3200
220 VDC
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
1000/1000 1250/1250 1250/1250 1250/1250 1250/1250 1250/1600 1250/1600 1250/1600 1800/2000 1800/2000
220 VDC
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
1000/1000 1250/1250 1250/1250 1250/1250 1250/1250 1250/1250 1250/1250 1250/1250 1250/1600 1250/1600
440 VDC
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
1000/1000 1250/1250 1250/1250 1600/1600 1800/1800 2000/2000 2500/2500 3200/3200 4000/4000 5000/5000
440 VDC
DC-21 A / DC-21 B 1000(4)/1000(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1600(4) 1250(4)/1600(4) 2000(4)/2000(4) 2000(4)/2500(4) 2500(4)/3200(4) 3200(4)/4000(4) 3200(4)/5000(4)
440 VDC
DC-22 A / DC-22 B 1000(4)/1000(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1600(4)/1800(4) 1600(4)/1800(4)
440 VDC
DC-23 A / DC-23 B 1000(4)/1000(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4)
500 VDC
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
500 VDC
DC-21 A / DC-21 B 1000(4)/1000(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1600(4) 1250(4)/1600(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1600(4)/1800(4) 1600(4)/1800(4)
1000/1000
1250/1250
1250/1250
1600/1600
1800/1800
2000/2000
2500/2500
3250/3250
4000/4000
5000/5000
500 VDC
DC-22 A / DC-22 B 1000(4)/1000(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1600(4) 1250(4)/1600(4)
500 VDC
DC-23 A / DC-23 B 1000(4)/1000(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1250(4)/1250(4) 1000(4)/1000(4) 1000(4)/1000(4) 1000(4)/1000(4) 1000(4)/1000(4) 1000(4)/1000(4)
2SHUDWLRQDOSRZHULQ$&$N:(1)(5)
At 415 VAC without pre-break in AC(1)
560/560
710/710
710/710
710/710
710/710
710/710
710/710
710/710
710/710
710/710
5HDFWLYHSRZHUNYDU
At 400 VAC (kvar)(5)
460
100
100
100
100
100
100
100
1000
1250
1250
2 x 800
2 x 800
2 x 1000
2 x 1250
&LUFXLWEUHDNHUSURWHFWHGVKRUWFLUFXLWZLWKVWDQGZLWKDQ\FLUFXLWEUHDNHUWKDWHQVXUHVWULSSLQJLQOHVVWKDQVDW9$&
Rated short-time withstand current 0.3s.
Icw (kA rms)
65
65
100
100
100
100
100
100
35
35
50
50
50
50
50
50
75
75
73.5
73.5
75
75
75
80
80
80
165
165
6KRUWFLUFXLWFDSDFLW\ZLWKRXWSURWHFWLRQ
Rated short-time withstand current 1s.
Icw (kA rms)
Rated short-circuit making capacity
without fuses Icm (kA peak)
Connection
Maximum Cu cable cross-section (mm)
2 x 240
2 x 50 x 5
2 x 60 x 5
2 x 60 x 5
2 x 80 x 5
4 x 185
4 x 185
4 x 185
6 x 185
63
63
100
100
100
100
100
100
40/45
40/45
40/45
40/45
40/45
40/45
40/-
40/-
40/-
40/-
Mechanical characteristics
3000
3000
4000
4000
4000
3000
3000
3000
2000
2000
37
37
56
56
56
75
75
75
105
105
12
12
12
22
22
22
45
45
10
10
15
15
15
25
25
25
50
50
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) With terminal shrouds or phase barrier.
(3) 3-pole device with 2 pole in series for the "+" and 1 pole for the "-".
(4) 4-pole device with 2 poles in series per polarity.
(5) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer to another.
(6) For a rated operational voltage Ue = 415 VAC.
66
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
200 A
250 A
315 A
400 A
500 A
CD 630 A
630 A
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
12
12
12
12
12
12
12
Utilisation category
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
200/200
250/250
315/315
400/400
500/500
630/630
630/630
500 VAC
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
200/200
250/250
315/315
400/400
500/500
630/630
630/630
500 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
200/200
250/250
315/315
400/400
500/500
630/630
630/630
500 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
200/200
250/250
315/315
400/400
500/500
630/630
630/630
690 VAC
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
200/200
250/250
315/315
400/400
500/500
630/630
630/630
690 VAC
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
200/200
250/250
315/315
690 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
200/200
250/250
315/315
690 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
200/200
250/250
315/315
160
220
250
400
500
500
630
190
250
325
400
400
450
2SHUDWLRQDOSRZHULQ$&$N:(5)
At 690 VAC without pre-break AC
5HDFWLYHSRZHUNYDU
At 690 VAC (kvar)
160
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
200
250
315
400
500
630
630
&LUFXLWEUHDNHUSURWHFWHGVKRUWFLUFXLWZLWKVWDQGZLWKDQ\FLUFXLWEUHDNHUWKDWHQVXUHVWULSSLQJLQOHVVWKDQVDW9$&
Rated short-time withstand current 0.3s. Icw (kA rms)
15
15
15
15
15
15
28
6KRUWFLUFXLWFDSDFLW\ZLWKRXWSURWHFWLRQ
Rated short-time withstand current 1s. Icw (kA rms)
11
11
11
20
22
22
22
22
22
22
40
70
70
70
185
240
Connection
Maximum Cu cable cross-section (mm)
Minimum Cu busbar cross-section (mm)
2 x 150
2 x 185
2 x 30 x 5
2 x 40 x 5
2 x 300
95
95
95
240
240
2 x 300
32
32
32
40
40
63
63
20/-
20/-
20/-
20/-
20/-
20/-
40/45
Mechanical characteristics
10 000
10 000
10 000
5000
5000
5000
4000
10
10
10
14.5
14.5
14.5
48
3.5
3.5
3.5
10
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) With terminal shrouds or phase barrier.
(3) 3-pole device with 2 poles in series for the "+" and 1 pole for the "-".
(4) 4-pole device with 2 poles in series per polarity.
(5) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer to another.
(6) For a rated operational voltage Ue = 690 VAC.
67
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
800 A
1000A
CD 1250 A
1250 A
1600 A
2000 A
4000 A
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
12
12
12
12
12
12
12
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
500 VAC
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
800/800
1000/1000
1250/1250
1250/1250
1600/1600
2000/2000
4000/4000
500 VAC
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
800/800
1000/1000
1250/1250
1250/1250
1600/1600
2000/2000
-/3200
500 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
800/800
1000/1000
1250/1250
1250/1250
1600/1600
2000/2000
500 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
800/800
1000/1000
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1600/1600
690 VAC
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
800/800
1000/1000
1250/1250
1250/1250
1600/1600
2000/2000
4000/4000
690 VAC
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
800/800
1000/1000
1250/1250
1250/1250
1600/1600
2000/2000
-/3200
690 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
800/800
1000/1000
1250/1250
1250/1250
1600/1600
2000/2000
-/-
690 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
800/800
1000/1000
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1600/1600
-/-
900
900
750
950
950
Rated voltage
(5)
2SHUDWLRQDOSRZHULQ$&$N:
At 690 VAC without pre-break AC
5HDFWLYHSRZHUNYDU
At 690 VAC (kvar)
550
(6)
50
50
50
50
50
800
800
2 x 500
1250
2 x 800
&LUFXLWEUHDNHUSURWHFWHGVKRUWFLUFXLWZLWKVWDQGZLWKDQ\FLUFXLWEUHDNHUWKDWHQVXUHVWULSSLQJLQOHVVWKDQVDW9$&
Rated short-time withstand current 0.3s. Icw (kA rms)
28
55
55
53
53
53
53
20
30
30
35
35
35
35
40
80
80
75
75
75
75
3 x 100 x 5
1 x 100 x 5
Connection
Maximum Cu cable cross-section (mm)
2 x 185
2 x 240
2 x 40 x 5
2 x 50 x 5
2 x 60 x 5
2 x 60 x 5
2 x 80 x 5
2 x 300
4 x 185
4 x 185
4 x 185
6 x 185
63
63
63
100
100
100
40/45
40/45
40/45
40
40
40
40
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
4000
4000
3000
4000
4000
3000
2000
48
48
48
55
55
75
100
12
12
22
45
10
10
10
15
15
25
50
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) With terminal shrouds or phase barrier.
(3) 3-pole device with 2 poles in series for the "+" and 1 pole for the "-".
(4) 4-pole device with 2 poles in series per polarity.
(5) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer to another.
(6) For a rated operational voltage Ue = 690 VAC.
68
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
Y
U
90
sirco_198_i_1_x_cat
I
T
F
X1 T
BC
CA
U1
125
AC
AA
BA
N
CA
AD
H
T X2
D min.
45
18
1. Terminal shrouds
A. S2 type handle
Overall
Terminal
dimensions shrouds
Rating (A) Rating (A)
SIRCO
2(1". "
D
min
125160
Switch
mounting
Switch body
F F
AC AD 3p. 4p. G
J1 J1
H 3p. 4p. J2
M M
K BC 3p. 4p. N
Connection
R
U1
200250
200250 115
125
315
315400
400500
500
630
CD 630
160
165
280 60 180 230 108 75 55 105 105 34 115 160 210 80 5.5 50
401 89 230 290 170 110 75 135 135 55 115 210 270 140 7
65
20
35
32
X1 X1
W 3p. 4p.
X2
AA BA CA
28
22
25.5 21.5 11 33
33
45.5
45
29
41.5
11
13
36
235 205 15
260 220 20
A
M
=
Z
=
Y 1
221 min.
I
T
F
86
140 26
166
49
215
14
X2
1. Terminal screens
60
61
71
A. Single lever S3 type handle
B. Double lever S4 type handle
C. Double lever S5 type handle
Rating (A)
SIRCO
Rating (A)
SIRCO AC
800 1000
630 1000
CD 1250
CD 1250
1250 1800
1250 1600
498
350
28
Switch body
F 3p.
F 4p.
sirco_325_d_1_x_cat
X1
210
90
470
AA
175
330
= =
102
Switch mounting
M 3p.
M 4p.
Connection
T
280
360
255
335
80
372
492
492
467
120
50
60.5
60
65
90
44
X1
X2
47.5
47.5
46.5
53.5
53.5
47.5
AA
321
330
288
69
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
226
Y
sirco_448_a_1_x_cat
498
498
380
BA
250
97
L = x-295 mm
71
181
71
Rating (A)
SIRCO
SIRCO AC
rating (A)
2000 3200
2000
Switch body
Overall dimensions
A 3p.
A 4p.
372
492
Switch mounting
Connection
J 3p.
J 4p.
M 3p.
M 4p.
BA
173.5
233.5
347
367
120
90
258
97.5
30 (4x)
162.5
V
70
BA
AA
344
sirco_421_c_1_x_cat
AC
AB
X
N
35.5
Rating (A)
SIRCO
Rating (A)
SIRCO AC
4000 5000
4000
L = X - 501 2
Overall
dimensions
Switch body
Switch mounting
122
Connection
F 3p.
F 4p.
M 3p.
M 4p.
AA
AB
AC
BA
514
695
695
660
660
98
115.5
75
120
86
160
292
482
452
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
Direction of operation
With lock
RONIS EL11AP
S2 type
40
78
90
26
37
47
73
5
3.
45
37
.5
45
26
14 14
24
28
poign_010_a_1_gb_cat
125
28
4 5.5
47
20 20
Direction of operation
S2 type
78
With lock
RONIS EL11AP
40
26
90
47
125
37
24
73
5
3.
45
.5
37
26
14 14
45
47
28
poign_028_a_1_gb_cat
28
4 5.5
20 20
Direction of operation
S4 type
With lock
RONIS EL11AP
O
26
37
40
350
28
4 5.5
90
78
37
47
24
73
.5
26
20 20
47
28
5
3.
45
poign_011_a_1_gb_cat
28
60
Direction of operation
S3 type
With lock
RONIS EL11AP
78
90
37
26
40
24
26
.5
47
73
28
20 20
210
poign_029_a_1_gb_cat
37
47
5
3.
45
61
28
4 5.5
28
71
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
Direction of operation
V2 Type
50
4 6,5
50
330
poign_055_a_1_gb_cat
90
31
SIRCO AC 2000 A
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S5 type
50
with V Escutcheon
50
4 6,5
498
poign_020_a_1_gb_cat
90
31
71
102
Direction of operation
Door drilling
V0 type
50
122
50
334
180
poign_009_a_1_gb_cat
4 6,5
31
Connection terminal
SIRCO 125 to 630 A and SIRCO AC 200 to CD 630 A
72
Rating (A)
W
V
sirco_451_b_1_x_cat
SIRCO AC
W
sirco_454_b_1_x_cat
SIRCO
SIRCO
125 160
200 250
315 400
500
630
SIRCO AC
200 250
315
400 500
CD 630
U
20
25
35
V
25
21.5
32
29
45
41.5
W
9
11
13
SIRCO
Load break switches for power distribution
IURPWR$
SIRCO AC
4x W1
W2
X2
X1
X2
V
Y
sirco_453_b_1_x_cat
V
Y
sirco_452_b_1_x_cat
4x W1
W2
X1
X2
X2
Rating (A)
SIRCO
SIRCO AC
W1
W1
X1
X2
800 1000
630 1000
50
60.5
28.5
16
28.5
11
33
SIRCO AC
4x W
X1
X1
sirco-ac_002
V2
V1
V2
V1
sirco_270_c_1_x_cat
4x W
Rating (A)
SIRCO
SIRCO AC
V1
V2
X1
CD 1250 A
CD 1250 A
60
65
28.5
16
28.5
11
V1
V2
sirco_455_b_1_x_cat
X1 X1
X2
X2
X3
X3
U
Rating (A)
SIRCO
SIRCO AC
V1
V2
X1
X2
X3
1250 3200
1250 1600
90
35.8
15
12.5
25
30
45
12.5
X1
X2
X3
X3
X3
X3
X2
X1
5 x W
V3
V1
V2
sirco_450_b_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
SIRCO
SIRCO AC
4000 5000
4000
X1
X2
X3
V1
V2
V3
286
13
48
35
30
86
15
15
73
SIDER
Load break switches for power distribution
with visible breaking from 125 to 1600 A
SIDER_102_a_1_cat
Load break
switches
SIDER W
$WSDQM@KEQNMSNODQ@SHNM
SIDER_089_b_1_cat
Strong points
> Safety thanks to visible
breaking.
> Modular product.
SIDER ND W
$WSDQM@KQHFGSRHCDNODQ@SHNM
Function
Functional diagram
For further details see the installation instructions supplied with the product.
4
SIDER_091_b_1_x_cat
Advantages
Safety thanks to visible breaking
Visible breaking and positive break indication
ensure safe switching. The user can assess
the condition of the device either during a
preventive check or before an operation.
3GD2(#$1@MC2(#$1-#KN@CAQD@J
switches are particularly suited for use in
safety enclosures for explosive atmospheres
(zone 21 and 22). The addition of a
mechanical flag indicator, directly connected
to the device's breaking system (SIDER only),
provides reliable position information on the
front of the enclosure.
Modular product
3GDLNCTK@QCDRHFMNESGD2(#$1-#@KKNVRSGD
product to be easily adapted to suit your needs:
- mixed ratings,
- defining the number of poles,
- centring or offsetting the operating
mechanism.
74
SIDER
Load break switches for power distribution
with visible breaking from 125 to 1600 A
References
Front operation
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Switch body
Direct operation
Switch body
External operation
3P
2915 3012
2921 3012
4P
2915 4012
2921 4012
3P
2915 3021
2921 3020
4P
2915 4021
2921 4020
3P
2915 3025
2921 3025
-#
-#
-#
4P
-#
-#
-#
3P
2915 4025
2915 3031
2921 4025
2921 3031
4P
2915 4031
2921 4031
3P
2915 3041
2921 3041
4P
2915 4041
2921 4041
3P
2915 3051
2921 3051
4P
2915 4051
2921 4051
3P
2900 3063
2900 3063
4P
2900 4063
2900 4063
3P
2900 3080
2900 3080
630 A
800 A
Direct handle
S2 type
Black IP55
(1)
Black
3629 7901(1)
Black IP65
1423 2111
1424 2111
Black
2900 4080
2900 4080
2799 7012(1)
3P
2900 3120
2900 3120
Red
4P
2900 4120
2900 4120
3P
2900 3160
2900 3160
4P
2900 4160
2900 4160
1600 A
1421 2111
Red IP65
4P
1250 A
External handle
2799 7013
S4 type
Black IP65
1443 3111(1)
1DC8DKKNV(/
1444 3111
Auxiliary contact
1stBNMS@BS-.-"
200 mm
3999 0021(2)(3)
1400 1020
BNMS@BSR-.-"
320 mm
1400 1032(1)
500 mm
3999 0701(4)(5)
1400 1050
200 mm
1401 1520
320 mm
3999 0022(2)(3)
BNMS@BS-"
BNMS@BS-.
3999 0702(4)(5)
1stBNMS@BS-.-"
2799 0001
1401 1532(1)
2ndBNMS@BS-.-"
400 mm
2799 0002
1401 1540
2S@MC@QC
TWHKH@QXRHFM@KBNMS@BS3XOD2
%NQCHQDBSNODQ@SHNM
%NQDWSDQM@KNODQ@SHNM
TWHKH@QXRHFM@KBNMS@BS3XOD4
75
SIDER
Load break switches for power distribution
with visible breaking from 125 to 1600 A
References (continued)
Side operation
Rating (A)
-#
-#
-#
-#
-#
-#
No. of poles
Switch body
Direct operation
Switch body
External right side
operation
3P
2915 3012
2921 3012
4P
2915 4012
2921 4012
3P
2915 3021
2921 3020
4P
2915 4021
2921 4020
3P
2915 3025
2921 3025
4P
2915 4025
2921 4025
3P
2915 3031
2921 3031
4P
2915 4031
2921 4031
3P
2915 3041
2921 3041
4P
2915 4041
2921 4041
3P
2915 3051
2921 3051
4P
2915 4051
2921 4051
3P
2905 3063
2905 3063
4P
2905 4063
2905 4063
3P
2905 3080
2905 3080
4P
2905 4080
2905 4080
3P
2905 3120
2905 3120
4P
2905 4120
2905 4120
3P
2905 3160
2905 3160
4P
2905 4160
2905 4160
630 A
800 A
1250 A
1600 A
2S@MC@QC
TWHKH@QXRHFM@KBNMS@BS3XOD2
%NQCHQDBSNODQ@SHNM
%NQDWSDQM@KNODQ@SHNM
"NMUDQRHNMJHSMDBDRR@QXENQ@MXCHQDBSNODQ@SHNM
TWHKH@QXRHFM@KBNMS@BS3XOD4
76
Direct handle
External handle
1stBNMS@BS-.-"
S2 type
Black IP55
3999 0021(2)(3)
BNMS@BSR-.-"
(1)
1425 2111
Black
3629 7901(1)
Black IP65
1427 2111
200 mm
1400 1020(1)
1DC8DKKNV(/
3999 0022(2)(3)
BNMS@BS-"
3999 0701(4)(6)
BNMS@BS-.
1428 2111
3999 0702(4)(6)
Black
2799 7052(1)
"NMUDQRHNMJHS
2799 7070(5)
Red
2799 7053
"NMUDQRHNMJHS
(5)
2799 7070
S3 type
Black IP65
(1)
1437 3111
1DC8DKKNV(/
1438 3111
1stBNMS@BS-.-"
200 mm
1404 1520(1)
2799 0011
2ndBNMS@BS-.-"
2799 0012
SIDER
Load break switches for power distribution
with visible breaking from 125 to 1600 A
Accessories
Direct operation handle
Handle colour
Black
Black
Red
Reference
Handle colour
Black
Black
Red
Reference
External IP
Reference
3629 7901
2799 7012(1)
2799 7013
acces_153_a_1_cat
acces_148_a_1_cat
2S@MC@QC
3629 7901
2799 7052
2799 7053
2799 7070(1)
IP54
3NADNQCDQDCSNFDSGDQVHSGSGDCHQDBSRHCDNODQ@SHNMG@MCKDR
Black
S2 type
IP55
-#-#
Black
S2 type
IP65
-#v-#
Red
S2 type
IP65
v
Black
S4 type
IP65
v
Red
S4 type
IP65
(/OQNSDBSHNMCDFQDD@BBNQCHMFSN($"RS@MC@QC
Reference
1421 2111(2)
1423 2111
1424 2111
1443 3111(2)
1444 3111
2S@MC@QC
acces_151_a_1_cat
Handle
-#v-#
acces_150_a_1_cat
Handle
colour
Rating (A)
S2 type handle
External IP(1)
Reference
Black
S2 type
IP55
-#v-#
Red
S2 type
IP65
v
Black
S3 type
IP65
v
Red
S3 type
IP65
1425 2111
1428 2111
1437 3111
1438 3111
-#v-#
S3 type handle
acces_152_a_1_cat
Handle
colour
Rating (A)
(/OQNSDBSHNMCDFQDD@BBNQCHMFSN($"RS@MC@QC
S4 type handle
Description
Reference
Shaft guide
1429 0000
acces_260_a_2_cat
Use
To guide the shaft extension into the
external handle. This accessory enables the
handle to engage the extension shaft with a
misalignment of up to 15 mm.
Handle colour
Black
Dimensions
Adds 12 mm to the depth.
To be ordered
in multiples of
External IP(1)
Reference
IP65
1493 0000
acces_187_a_1_cat
Use
Enables S type handles to be fitted in place
of existing older style Socomec handles.
Adapter can also be utilised as a spacer to
increase the distance between the panel
door and the handle lever.
(/OQNSDBSHNMCDFQDD@BBNQCHMFSN($"RS@MC@QC
77
SIDER
Load break switches for power distribution
with visible breaking from 125 to 1600 A
Accessories (continued)
Alternative S type handle cover colours
Use
For single lever handles S1, S2 and S3
types and double lever handle, S4 type.
To be ordered
in multiples of
50
50
50
50
Handle
Type S1, S2
Type S1, S2
S4 type
S4 type
acces_198_a_1_cat
Handle colour
Light grey
Dark grey
Light grey
Dark grey
.SGDQBNKNTQR/KD@RDBNMRTKSTR
Reference
14010001
1401 0011
1401 0031
1401 0041
Type
Reference
-#v-#
v
200 mm
10 x 10
-#v-#
v
320 mm
10 x 10
-#v-#
v
500 mm
10 x 10
v
v
200 mm
15 x 12
v
v
320 mm
15 x 12
v
v
400 mm
15 x 12
1400 1020
1400 1032
1400 1050
1401 1520
1401 1532
1401 1540
Type
Reference
Rating (A)
-#v-#
v
80 mm
10 x 10
included
-#v-#
v
200 mm
10 x 10
v
v
200 mm
15 x 12
1400 1020
1404 1520
acces_202_a_1_x_cat
acces_203_a_1_x_cat
acces_369_a_1_cat
acces_144_b_1_cat
- 400 mm,
- 500 mm.
.SGDQKDMFSGR/KD@RDBNMRTKSTR
NO/NC contact
Rating (A)
-#v-#
-#v-#
v
v
Position AC
1st
2nd
1st
2nd
NO contact
Rating (A)
-#v-#
Reference
3999 0021(1)
3999 0022(1)
2799 0001
2799 0002
Position AC
1 to 4
acces_056_a_1_cat
Position AC
1 to 4
Reference
3999 0702(1)
%NQDWSDQM@KNODQ@SHNM
NO + NC contact
Rating (A)
v
%NQCHQDBSNODQ@SHNM
NC contact
Rating (A)
-#v-#
acces_047_a_2_cat
Use
Pre-break and signalling of positions 0
and I:
SN-.-"@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR
SN-.NQ-"@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR
SN-.
-"@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR
Position AC
1
Reference
2799 0005
Reference
(1)
3999 0701
Reference
2699 0101
%NQDWSDQM@KNODQ@SHNM
Characteristics
Operating current Ie (A)
Contact type
Current
nominal (A)
-#v-#
BG@MFDNUDQ-.-"
16
-#v-#
-"
10
Rating (A)
-#v-#
78
250 VAC
400 VAC
24 VDC
48 VDC
AC-13
AC-13
DC-13
DC-13
12
-.
10
v
BG@MFDNUDQ-.-"
16
12
14
v
-.
-"
15
10
15
12
SIDER
Load break switches for power distribution
with visible breaking from 125 to 1600 A
NO/NC contact
Rating (A)
Position AC
Reference
-#v-#
1st
-#v-#
v
1st
v
2nd
3999 0021
3999 0022
2799 0011
2799 0012
Position AC
Reference
1 to 4
3999 0701
NC contact
Rating (A)
-#v-#
Characteristics
Operating current Ie (A)
400
24
48
Current 250
nominal VAC VAC VDC VDC
(A)
AC-13 AC-13 DC-13 DC-13
NO contact
Rating (A)
-#v-#
Position AC
Reference
1 to 4
3999 0702
acces_056_a_1_cat
acces_047_a_2_cat
Use
Pre-break and signalling of positions 0 and I:
SN-.-"@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR
SN-.NQ-"@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR
Rating (A)
Contact type
-#v-# BG@MFDNUDQ-.-"
16
-#v-#
10
Position AC
Reference
-#v-#
2799 0111
v
-"
12
-.
10
BG@MFDNUDQ-.-"
16
12
14
S type auxiliary contacts for signalisation - Front and right side operation
Electrical principle
3GD-.
-"2SXOD@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSRB@M
ADBNMEHFTQDC@R-.NQ-"
Electrical characteristics
30 000 operations.
acces_051_a_2_cat
Use
Signalling of positions 0 and I,
SN-.
-"@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR
Connection to the control circuit
By terminals with a max. cross-section of
10 mm.
Characteristics
NO+NC contact
Rating (A)
Position AC
Reference
-#v-#
-#v-#
-#v-#
-#v-#
3999 0041
3999 0042
3999 0043
3999 0044
400 VAC
Rating (A)
Contact
type
Current
nominal (A)
AC-13
AC-13
-#v-#
-.
-"
20
10
Terminal shrouds
Use
Top or bottom protection against direct
contact with terminals or connection parts.
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Position
Reference
-#v-#
3P
top or bottom
-#v-#
4P
top or bottom
-#v-#
3P
top or bottom
-#v-#
4P
top or bottom
3998 3016(1)
3998 4016(2)
3998 3025(1)
3998 4025(2)
acces_093_a_1_cat
Advantage
1DEDQDMBDBNLONRDCNEOHDBDR
1DEDQDMBDBNLONRDCNEOHDBDR
79
SIDER
Load break switches for power distribution
with visible breaking from 125 to 1600 A
Accessories (continued)
Terminal screens
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Position
Reference
v
3P
top or bottom
v
4P
top or bottom
v
3P
top or bottom
v
4P
top or bottom
2998 3080
2998 4080
2998 3120
2998 4120
acces_058_a_1_cat
Use
Top or bottom protection against direct contact with terminals or connection parts.
"@FDSDQLHM@KR
Use
"NMMDBSHNMNEA@QDBNOODQB@AKDRNMSNSGDSDQLHM@KRVHSGNTSKTFR
Connections
-#
v
v
13
22
-#v-#
v
v
18
27
-#v-#
v
v
20
34
-#v
v
v
24
34
acces_053_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
X1
Dimensions
-#v-#
A1
X1
47.5
22.5
25
20
8.5
M12
10
62
31.5
31.5
25
10.5
M16
14
-#v-#
71.5
32
38
32
10.5
M20
15
-#v
76.5
37
38
40
12.5
M20
15
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Reference
-#
3P
-#
4P
-#v-#
3P
-#v-#
4P
-#v-#
3P
-#v-#
4P
-#v
3P
-#v
4P
5400 3016
5400 4016
5400 3025
5400 4025
5400 3040
5400 4040
5400 3063
5400 4063
X
acces_091_a_1_x_cat
-#
A1
R
C
acces_092_a_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
Inter-phase barrier
Rating (A)
80
No. of poles
Reference
v
3P
v
4P
2998 0003
2998 0004
acces_036_a_1_cat
Use
Safety isolation between the terminals,
DRRDMSH@KENQTRD@S5 "NQHM@ONKKTSDC
or dusty atmosphere.
SIDER
Load break switches for power distribution
with visible breaking from 125 to 1600 A
Use
Locking in position 0 of the front or side
operation handle:
TRHMF1.-(2$+ /KNBJHMCHQDBS
right-side operation (Fig. 1),
TRHMF1.-(2$+ /KNBJHMCHQDBSEQNMS
operation (Fig. 2),
acces_042_a_1_x_cat
Operation
Figure
Reference
-#v-#
front direct
v
front direct
external front
3629 7913(1)
2799 7007(2)
1499 7701
3629 7913(1)
1499 7701
-#v
-#v-#
-#v
Fig. 1
acces_084_a_1_x_cat
Fig.2
'@MCKDHMBKTCDC
%@BSNQXLNTMSHMFNMKX
-#v-#
Operation
Figure
Reference
external front
1499 7702
Operation
Figure
Reference
external front
1499 7703
Fig. 3
acces_157_a_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
acces_158_a_1_x_cat
Fig.4
.SGDQRODBHEHB@BBDRRNQHDR
q Mechanical coupling device for combining switches of the same or different ratings.
q Mechanical interlocking device.
q Mechanical plates and escutcheon for standard systems.
81
SIDER
Load break switches for power distribution
with visible breaking from 125 to 1600 A
"G@Q@BSDQHRSHBR@BBNQCHMFSN($"
-#SN-#
Thermal current Ith at 40C
Rated insulation voltage Ui (V)
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp (kV)
ND 125 A
800
8
ND 200 A
800
8
ND 250 A
800
8
ND 315 A
800
8
ND 400 A
800
8
ND 500 A
800
8
A/B(1)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
A/B(1)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
A/B(1)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
A/B(1)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
A/B(1)
(3)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
A/B(1)
(3)
(3)
(3)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
55
90
115
145
185
230
100
125
60
200
100
150
60
315
50
400
30
500
Utilisation category
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
Circuit breaker protected short-circuit withstand with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s
Prospective short-circuit 0.3s (kA rms)
15
15
17
17
17
17
7
11.9
7
11.9
9
15.3
9
15.3
9
15.3
9
15.3
120
20
9
120
20
9
240
32
20
240
32
20
2 x 150
45
20
2 x 150
45
20
10 000
10
1.8
2.3
10 000
10
1.8
2.3
10 000
12
3.2
4.5
10 000
12
3.2
4.5
10 000
15
4.8
6.1
10 000
15
4.8
6.1
Connection
,HMHLTL"TB@AKDBQNRRRDBSHNMLL2)
,HMHLTL"TATRA@QBQNRRRDBSHNMLL2)
,@WHLTL"TB@AKDBQNRRRDBSHNMLL2)
,@WHLTL"TATRA@QVHCSGLL
3HFGSDMHMFSNQPTDLHM-L
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)(6)
.ODQ@SHMFDEENQS-L
6DHFGSNE@ONKDCDUHBDJF
6DHFGSNE@ONKDCDUHBDJF
"@SDFNQXVHSGHMCDW EQDPTDMSNODQ@SHNM"@SDFNQXVHSGHMCDW!HMEQDPTDMSNODQ@SHNM
6HSGSDQLHM@KRGQNTCRNQOG@RDA@QQHDQ
ONKDCDUHBDVHSGONKDRHMRDQHDRENQSGD
@MCONKDENQSGD
ONKDCDUHBDVHSGONKDRHMRDQHDRODQONK@QHSX
82
3GDONVDQU@KTDHRFHUDMENQHMENQL@SHNMNMKXSGDBTQQDMSU@KTDRU@QXEQNL
NMDL@MTE@BSTQDQSN@MNSGDQ
%NQ@Q@SDCNODQ@SHNM@KUNKS@FD4D5 "
SIDER
Load break switches for power distribution
with visible breaking from 125 to 1600 A
630 to 1600 A
Thermal current Ith at 40C
Rated insulation voltage Ui (V)
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp (kV)
630 A
1000
12
800 A
1000
12
1250 A
1000
12
1600 A
1000
12
A/B(1)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
A/B(1)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
A/B(1)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
A/B(1)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
290
365
575
100
630
70
800
100
1250
120
2 x 800
Utilisation category
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
Circuit breaker protected short-circuit withstand with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s
Prospective short-circuit 0.3s (kA rms)
50
50
100
100
26
50
26
50
50
70
50
70
2 x 150
2 x 30 x 5
2 x 300
63
20
2 x 185
2 x 40 x 5
2 x 300
63
20
2 x 60 x 5
4 x 185
100
20
2 x 80 x 5
6 x 240
100
40
5 000
45
8
9.5
4 000
45
8.5
10
4 000
45
11
14
3 000
65
16.5
20.5
Connection
,HMHLTL"TB@AKDBQNRRRDBSHNMLL2)
,HMHLTL"TATRA@QBQNRRRDBSHNMLL2)
,@WHLTL"TB@AKDBQNRRRDBSHNMLL2)
,@WHLTL"TATRA@QVHCSGLL
3HFGSDMHMFSNQPTDLHML@W-L
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)(6)
.ODQ@SHMFDEENQS-L
6DHFGSNE@ONKDCDUHBDJF
6DHFGSNE@ONKDCDUHBDJF
"@SDFNQXVHSGHMCDW EQDPTDMSNODQ@SHNM"@SDFNQXVHSGHMCDW!HMEQDPTDMSNODQ@SHNM
6HSGSDQLHM@KRGQNTCRNQOG@RDA@QQHDQ
ONKDCDUHBDVHSGONKDRHMRDQHDRENQSGD
@MCONKDENQSGD
ONKDCDUHBDVHSGONKDRHMRDQHDRODQONK@QHSX
3GDONVDQU@KTDHRFHUDMENQHMENQL@SHNMNMKXSGDBTQQDMSU@KTDRU@QXEQNL
NMDL@MTE@BSTQDQSN@MNSGDQ
%NQ@Q@SDCNODQ@SHNM@KUNKS@FD4D5 "
83
SIDER
Load break switches for power distribution
with visible breaking from 125 to 1600 A
Dimensions
Front operation
SIDER ND 125 to ND 500 A
Direct front operation
L
R
2
sider_059_b_1_x_cat
AC
AA
BA
N
70
Y
Z
1. Terminal shrouds
NQ-.-" "RENQOQDAQD@J@MCRHFM@KKHMF
T
A
C
Terminal
shrouds
Overall dimensions
Switch body
Switch mounting
Connection
Rating
(A)
A 3p.
A 4p.
AC
AA
BA
-#
160
196
178
268
82
36
130
36
20
162
141
-#
160
196
178
268
82
36
130
36
20
162
141
-#
232
322
173
350
77
31
162
60
10
20
195
165
-#
232
322
173
350
77
31
162
60
10
20
195
165
-#
280
346
173
360
77
31
172
66
10
20
214
175
-#
280
346
173
360
77
31
172
66
10
20
214
175
95 min.
4
T1
T2
25
78
AA
W
K
45
sider_103_c_1_x_cat
125
BA
AC
3 20
Rating (A)
-#
-#
-#
-#
-#
-#
84
Terminal shrouds
AC
268
268
350
350
360
360
F 3p.
148
148
234
234
252
252
T
F
F 4p.
184
184
294
294
318
318
Switch body
H
137
137
132
132
132
132
J
54
54
85
85
91
91
K
53
53
77.5
77.5
73
73
Switch mounting
N
R
130
5
130
5
162
6
162
6
172
6
172
6
T
36
36
60
60
66
66
W
8
8
10
10
10
10
Connection
AA
BA
162
141
162
141
195
165
195
165
214
175
214
175
T1
36
36
60
60
66
66
T2
36
36
60
60
66
66
SIDER
Load break switches for power distribution
with visible breaking from 125 to 1600 A
Front operation
SIDER 630 to 1600 A
External front operation
A
F
M
70.6
1
60
80
350
11
295 min.
X2 30
90
X1
CA
sider_061_f_1_x_cat
460
AA
BA
220
CA
U W
330
12.5
240
14
1. Terminal screens
Rating
(A)
Overall
dimensions
Switch body
Switch mounting
Connection
A 3p.
A 4p.
F 3p.
F 4p.
M 3p.
M 4p.
X1
X2
AA
BA
AC
630
463
543
358
438
255
335
80
40
50
13
42.5
52.5
106
300
260
20
800
463
543
358
438
255
335
80
50
60
47.5
47.5
106
320
1250
555
675
430
550
347
467
120
63
65
46.5
60.5
107
330
1600
555
675
430
550
347
467
120
80
80
46.5
60.5
15
111
360
85
SIDER
Load break switches for power distribution
with visible breaking from 125 to 1600 A
Dimensions (continued)
Side operation
SIDER ND 125 to ND 500 A
External side operation
H
4
T1
T2
25
125
BA
AA
AC
sider_090_d_1_x_cat
2
K
3 20
45
NQ-.-" "RENQOQDAQD@J@MCRHFM@KKHMF
2. Terminal shrouds
3. Max. length with shaft extension: 230 mm
T
F
Rating (A)
-#
-#
-#
-#
-#
-#
Terminal
shrouds
AC
268
268
350
350
360
360
Overall dimensions
F 3p.
F 4p.
148
184
148
184
234
294
234
294
252
318
252
318
Switch body
J
K
54
53
54
53
85
77.5
85
77.5
91
73
91
73
H
137
137
132
132
132
132
Switch mounting
N
R
130
5
130
5
162
6
162
6
172
6
172
6
L
36
36
31
31
31
31
T
36
36
60
60
66
66
W
8
8
10
10
10
10
Connection
AA
BA
162
141
162
141
195
165
195
165
214
175
214
175
T1
36
36
60
60
66
66
T2
36
36
60
60
66
66
201
Z
Y
F
M
72
2
=
1
CA
30
240
X1
210
sider_065_d_1_x_cat
11
CA
460
AA
BA
220
90
28
X2
A
61
1. Terminal screen
2. Max length with shaft extension: 111 mm
Rating (A)
630
800
1250
1600
86
Overall dimensions
A 3p.
A 4p.
395
475
395
475
480
600
480
600
Switch body
F 3p.
F 4p.
280
360
280
360
372
492
372
492
Switch mounting
M 3p.
M 4p.
255
335
255
335
347
467
347
467
T
80
80
120
120
U
40
50
63
80
V
50
60
65
80
W
13
15
16x11
13
Connection
X1
X2
Y
42.5
52.5
6
47.5
47.5
6
46.5
60.5
7
46.5
60.5
15
Z
147
147
148
152
AA
300
320
330
360
BA
260
AC
20
SIDER
Load break switches for power distribution
with visible breaking from 125 to 1600 A
Front operation
Side operation
Direction of operation
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S2 type
0
90
78
I
9
40
47
45
28
S3 type
poign_012_b_1_gb_cat
78
210
37
61
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S4 type
37
I
28
poign_012_b_1_gb_cat
350
90
40
78
47
60
"NMMDBSHNMSDQLHM@K
SIDER 1250 A
SIDER 1600 A
13
33
50
8.5
19 25 19
63
sider_075_a_1_x_cat
8.5
17 25
15
sider_074_a_1_x_cat
10 33
sider_073_a_1_x_cat
16 x 11
20 40
SIDER 800 A
20 40 20
80
87
SIDERMAT
Load break switches for power distribution
Remotely trippable switch from 250 to 1800 A
The solution for
sdmat_066_a_1_cat
Load break
switches
SIDERMATW
$WSDQM@KEQNMSNODQ@SHNM
Strong points
> Remote tripping.
> Safety thanks to visible
double breaking.
> Utilisation in harsh
operating conditions.
Function
SIDERMAT are manually operated 3 or 4 pole load break switches with visible breaking and a
remote tripping function.
They make and break under load conditions and provide safety isolation for any low voltage circuit.
The tripping function is used to provide the following functions:
- personal protection against insulation faults when utilised in combination with toroids and
differential relays,
- protection against overloads when utilised in combination with CTs and thermal relays,
Check it out!
> SIDERMAT combination
and IDE are manually
operated multipolar load
break switches which can be
tripped remotely.
Available with integrated fuse protection, the SIDERMAT combination provides protection
against short-circuits (see SIDERMAT combination on page 230).
Advantages
Functional diagram
Remote tripping
Disconnection by a shunt trip device enables
the power to the installation to be switched off
with a remote pushbutton.
For further details see the installation instructions supplied with the product.
sdmat_063_b_2_x_cat
2
1
88
SIDERMAT
Load break switches for power distribution
Remotely trippable switch from 250 to 1800 A
References
Front operation - Switch body with a shunt trip coil 230 VAC
Rating
(A)
Auxiliary
contact
position
Auxiliary
contact
tripping
Switch body
3P
3500 3026
4P
3500 4026
3P
3500 3041
3998 3040(2)
4P
3500 4041
3998 4040(2)
3P
3500 3064
4P
3500 4064
3P
3500 3081
4P
3500 4081
3P
3500 3121
4P
3500 4121
3P
3500 3161
2998 3120(2)
4P
3500 4161
2998 4120(2)
3P
3500 3180
4P
3500 4180
Direct handle
External
handle
Shaft for
external
handle
No. of
poles
Terminal
shrouds
Terminal
screens
Inter phase
barrier
250 A
3P
400 A
4P
630 A
800 A
S3 type
Black
IP55
Black
3999 6203
1431 3511(1)
S3 type
Red/Yellow
IP55
200 mm
1st contact
NO/NC
1401 1520
3999 0051
320 mm
2nd contact
NO/NC
1401 1532(1)
3P
1 contact
NO/NC
3998 3063(2)
3999 0031
3998 4063(2)
4P
3999 0052
1432 3511
1250 A
3P
2998 0003
3P
1600 A
4P
2998 0004
4P
1800 A
included
2S@MC@QC
3NOANSSNL
Side operation - Switch body with a shunt trip coil 230 VAC
Rating
(A)
No. of
poles
250 A
400 A
630 A
800 A
1250 A
1600 A
1800 A
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
Switch body
3505 3026
3505 4026
3505 3041
3505 4041
3505 3064
3505 4064
3505 3081
3505 4081
3505 3121
3505 4121
3505 3161
3505 4161
3505 3180
3505 4180
Direct handle
External
handle
Shaft for
external
handle
Auxiliary
contact
position
Auxiliary
contact
tripping
Terminal
shrouds
Terminal
screens
Inter phase
barrier
3P
2998 0003
4P
2998 0004
3P
3998 3040(2)
4P
Black
3999 6012(1)
Red
3999 6013
3998 4040(2)
S3 type
Black
IP55
1435 3511(1)
S3 type
Red
IP55
1436 3511
1st contact
NO/NC
200 mm
3999 0051
1403 1520
2nd contact
NO/NC
1 contact
NO/NC
3999 0031
3998 3063(2)
3998 4063(2)
3999 0052
3P
2998 3120(2)
4P
2998 4120(2)
included
2S@MC@QC
3NOANSSNL
89
SIDERMAT
Load break switches for power distribution
Remotely trippable switch from 250 to 1800 A
Accessories
Door interlocked external operation
Handle
S3 type
S3 type
External IP(1)
IP55
IP55
Handle colour
Black
Red/Yellow
1431 3511(2)
1432 3511
2S@MC@QC
External IP(1)
IP55
IP55
Handle colour
Black
Red
(/OQNSDBSHNMCDFQDD@BBNQCHMF
SN($"RS@MC@QC
acces_166_a_2_cat
(/OQNSDBSHNMCDFQDD@BBNQCHMF
SN($"RS@MC@QC
Reference
acces_151_a_2_cat
Reference
1435 3511(2)
1436 3511
2S@MC@QC
S3 type handles
Reference
250 1800
Black
3999 6203
250 1800
Red
Please consult us
acces_156_a_2_cat
Rating (A)
Handle colour
Reference
250 1800
Black
250 1800
Red
3999 6012
3999 6013
Use
For single lever S3 type handles.
Colour
acces_198_a_2_cat
To be ordered in multiples of
Handle
Reference
Light grey
50
S3
Dark grey
50
S3
1401 0001
1401 0011
Handle colour
Dimensions
Adds 12 mm to the depth.
To be ordered in multiples of
External IP(1)
Reference
IP65
1493 0000
Black
acces_187_a_1_cat
Use
Enables S-type handles to be fitted in place
of existing older style Socomec handles.
Adapter can be utilised as a spacer to
increase the distance between the panel
door and the handle lever.
(/OQNSDBSHNMCDFQDD@BBNQCHMFSN($"RS@MC@QC
Reference
1401 1520
1401 1532(1)
1401 1520
1401 1532(1)
1401 1520
1401 1532(1)
2S@MC@QC
90
Shaft length
(mm)
200 mm
Reference
1403 1520
acces_203_a_1_x_cat
Shaft length
(mm)
200 mm
320 mm
200 mm
320 mm
200 mm
320 mm
acces_202_a_1_x_cat
acces_144_b_1_cat
Use
Standard lengths:
- 200 mm,
- 320 mm.
SIDERMAT
Load break switches for power distribution
Remotely trippable switch from 250 to 1800 A
acces_050_a_1_cat
Use
Omnipolar breaking remotely controlled by
shunt trip or undervoltage voltage release coil.
Note: the shunt trip coil must not be supplied
for more than 5 s.
A 230 VAC shunt trip coil is fitted as
standard to the switch body. To have
an alternative coil, one of the references
opposite must be added to the switch
reference.
acces_049_a_1_cat
Characteristics
References
Replacement
tripping coil
Alternative
factory fitted coil
24
48
110
230
400
Voltage
Reference
Reference
80
100
100
120
120
24 VAC
12
24
48
110
220
48 VAC
80
100
100
120
120
3990 1024
3990 1048
3990 1110
3990 1220
3990 1380
3991 1024(1)
3991 1048(1)
3991 1110(1)
110 VAC
-NSD3GDRGTMSSQHOBNHK5 "LTRSMNSADRTOOKHDCENQLNQDSG@MR
RGTMSSQHOBNHKHRRTHSDCENQSGDRS@MC@QCCDUHBD
230 VAC
400 VAC
12 VDC
3990 2024
3990 2048
3990 2220
24 VDC
48 VDC
110 VDC
24
48
110
230
400
13
13
13
13
20
13
13
13
13
20
15
25
60
140
200
220 VDC
3NADNQCDQDC@SSGDR@LDSHLD@RSGDRVHSBG
Undervoltage trip coil
Replacement
tripping coil
Reference
Reference
24 VAC
3990 3024
3990 3048
3990 3110
3990 3220
3990 3380
3990 4012
3990 4024
3990 4048
3990 4110
3990 4220
3991 3024(1)
3991 3048(1)
3991 3110(1)
3991 3220(1)
3991 3380(1)
3991 4012(1)
3991 4024(1)
3991 4048(1)
3991 4110(1)
3991 4220(1)
12
24
48
110
220
48 VAC
13
13
13
13
13
110 VAC
13
13
13
13
13
230 VAC
15
25
60
140
400 VAC
12 VDC
24 VDC
Voltage
Time (ms)
Reference
48 VDC
230 VAC
430
110 VDC
400 VAC
410
3993 3230(1)
3993 3400(1)
3NADNQCDQDC@SSGDR@LDSHLD@RSGDRVHSBG
Alternative
factory fitted coil
Voltage
included
3991 1380(1)
3991 2012(1)
3991 2024(1)
3991 2048(1)
3991 2220(1)
3991 2220(1)
220 VDC
3NADNQCDQDC@SSGDR@LDSHLD@RSGDRVHSBG
Voltage
Reference
110 VAC
3999 3112
3999 3230
3999 3400
3999 4110
230 VAC
400 VAC
110 VDC
91
SIDERMAT
Load break switches for power distribution
Remotely trippable switch from 250 to 1800 A
Accessories (continued)
Auxiliary contact
Characteristics
NO/NC auxiliary contact: IP2X.
Electrical characteristics:
30 000 operations.
acces_048_a_1_cat
Use
Pre-break and signalling of positions 0 and I:
1 to 2 NO/NC auxiliary contacts.
Coil tripping
1 to 2 NO/NC auxiliary contacts.
Connection to the control circuit
By 6.35 mm fast-on terminal.
References
Characteristics
NO/NC position contact
Rating (A)
Position AC
Reference
Current
nominal (A)
250 VAC
400 VAC
24 VDC
48 VDC
250 1800
1st
AC-13
AC-13
DC-13
DC-13
250 1800
2nd
3999 0051
3999 0052
16
12
14
250 1800
Rating (A)
Position AC
Reference
250 1800
1st
250 1800
2nd
3999 0111
3999 0112
Position AC
Reference
3999 0031
Current
nominal (A)
250 VAC
400 VAC
24 VDC
48 VDC
AC-13
AC-13
DC-13
DC-13
Rating (A)
16
12
12
250 1800
250 1800
Terminal shrouds
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Position
Reference
250 630
3P
top or bottom
250 630
4P
top or bottom
800
3P
top or bottom
800
4P
top or bottom
3998 3040
3998 4040
3998 3063
3998 4063
acces_212_a_2_cat
Use
Top or bottom protection against direct
contact with terminals or connection parts.
Advantage
Terminal screens
Use
Top or bottom protection against direct
contact with terminals or connection parts.
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Position
Reference
1250 1800
3P
top or bottom
1250 1800
4P
top or bottom
2998 3120
2998 4120
Inter-phase barrier
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Reference
1250 1600
3P
1250 1600
4P
2998 0003
2998 0004
3/4 P
included
1800
92
acces_036_a_2_cat
Use
Safety isolation between the terminals, essential for use at 690 VAC or in
a polluted or dusty atmosphere.
SIDERMAT
Load break switches for power distribution
Remotely trippable switch from 250 to 1800 A
Use
Locking in position 0 of the front or side
operation handle:
- using a padlock (not supplied) and factory
integrated into the handle. Padlocking, in
external front operation, locks the door.
Operation
Reference
direct
3999 8104
acces_010_b_1_x_cat
Operation
Reference
250 630
direct
800 1800
direct
3999 6107
3999 7007
Operation
Reference
external
1499 7701
Cage terminals
Use
Connection of bare copper cables onto the terminals (without lugs).
Connections
Rating (A)
Rigid cable
cross-section
(mm)
Flexible bar
width (mm)
Stripped
over (mm)
250
16 185
16 185
18
27
400
50 240
50 300
20
34
630
70 300
70 300
24
34
acces_053_a_2_cat
Flexible cable
cross-section
(mm2)
Dimensions
X1
A1
250
62
31.5
31.5
25
10.5
M16
14
400
71.5
32
38
32
10.5
M20
15
630
76.5
37
38
40
12.5
X1
M20
15
acces_091_a_1_x_cat
X
Z
References
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Reference
250
3P
250
4P
400
3P
400
4P
630
3P
630
4P
5400 3025
5400 4025
5400 3040
5400 4040
5400 3063
5400 4063
A1
R
C
A
acces_092_a_1_x_cat
Rating
(A)
93
SIDERMAT
Load break switches for power distribution
Remotely trippable switch from 250 to 1800 A
250 A
400 A
630 A
800 A
1250 A
1600 A
1800 A
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
12
12
12
12
12
12
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
400 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
250/250
400/400
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1600/1600
1600/1800
400 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
250/250
400/400
630/630
630/630
1250/1250
1600/1600
1600/1600
500 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
250/250
400/400
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1600/1600
1600/1600
500 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
200/250
315/400
500/630
630/630
1000/1000
1250/1250
1250/1250
690 VAC(2)
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
250/250
400/400
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1600/1600
1600/1600
690 VAC(2)
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
250/250
400/400
500/630
630/800
1000/1000
1250/1250
1250/1250
690 VAC(2)
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
200/250
315/400
400/500
500/500
800/800
1000/1000
1000/1000
400 VDC
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
250/250
400/400
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1600/1600
1800/1800
400 VDC
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
250/250
400/400
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1600/1600
1600/1600
400 VDC
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
250/250
400/400(3)
630/630(3)
800/800(3)
400 VDC
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
200/250
315/400(3)
500/630(3)
630/800(3)
132/132
220/220
355/355
355/355
710/710
900/900
900/900
185/220
295/400
400/475
475/475
750/750
900/900
900/900
115
185
290
365
575
100
100
100
100
100
120
120
250
400
630
800
1250
2 x 800
2 x 900
Rated voltage
17
25
50
65
65
80
80
30
45
55
80
100
120
120
95
185
Connection
Minimum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Minimum Cu busbar cross-section (mm2)
2 x 150
2 x 185
2 x 30 x 5
2 x 40 x 5
2 x 60 x 5
2 x 80 x 5
4 x 240
240
240
2 x 300
2 x 300
4 x 185
6 x 240
8 x 240
40
40
50
63
100
100
100
20
40
40
20
40
40
3000
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
8000
8000
5000
5000
5000
3000
6.5
11
14
19
21
7.5
9.5
13
16
21.5
23.5
94
SIDERMAT
Load break switches for power distribution
Remotely trippable switch from 250 to 1800 A
F
M
1
W
V1
190
V2
X T
210
AA
AC
B
sdmat_061_b_1_x_cat
Y
K1
C
E min.
1. Terminal shrouds
61
2. Reset fuse 70
Terminal
shrouds
Overall dimensions
Rating (A)
A
3p.
A
4p.
250
435
495
400
435
495
630
435
495
800
491
570
Switch body
AC
309
248
275
388
70 7 65 32 35 43 11
31
46 3 67 238
309
248
275
388
70 7 65 32 35 43 13
31
46 5 69 238
318.5 248
275
388
70 7 65 32 35 43 13
31
46 8 72 257
296
470
36
65 7 72 320
262
J
3p.
J
4p. K1
Connection
F
3p.
350
F
4p.
Switch mounting
E
min
P
P
3p. 4p. R T
V1 V2
X
X
3p. 4p. Y
AA
160
Z
F
M
16
250
U
sdmat_062_b_1_x_cat
210
190
250
AC
B
AA
59 120
1
256,5
E min.
61
1. Reset fuse 70
2. Terminal screens
Terminal
shrouds
Overall dimensions
Switch body
Switch mounting
Connection
Rating (A)
A 3p.
A 4p.
E min
AC
F 3p.
F 4p.
J 3p.
J 4p.
M 3p.
M 4p.
AA
1250
582
702
355
291
480
437
557
400
520
345
465
63
65
106
330
1600
582
702
370
291
479
437
557
400
520
345
465
80
80
15
110
360
1800
582
702
370
291
479
437
557
400
520
345
465
100
80
15
110
360
95
SIDERMAT
Load break switches for power distribution
Remotely trippable switch from 250 to 1800 A
J1
2
W
K1
V2
210
372,5
AC
AA
V1
90
U
190
sdmat_036_c_1_x_cat
F
M
Y
X T
279,5
61
1. Reset fuse 70
2. Terminal shrouds
Overall dimensions
Rating (A)
250
Terminal
shrouds
425
357
417
Switch body
AC
F 3p. F 4p.
388
285
345
Switch mounting
K1
P
3p.
148
115
210
180
10
Connection
P
4p.
V1
V2
X
X
3p. 4p.
70
65
32
35
43
11
31
67 238
46
AA
400
365
425
357
417
388
285
345
148
115
210
180
10
70
65
32
35
43
13
31
46
69 238
630
365
425
357
417
388
285
345
148
129
210
180
10
70
65
45
49
49
13
31
46
72 257
800
421
501
413
493
470
346
426
178
160
250
250
20
100
80
50
60
60
15
36
65
72 320
16
sdmat_037_d_1_x_cat
160
Z
250
90
R 9
250
==
210
70
AC
AA
372,5
190
Y
43 120 120 120 62
A
1
279,5
61
1. Reset fuse 70
2. Terminal screens
Terminal
shrouds
Overall dimensions
Rating (A)
1250
96
Switch body
Switch mounting
Connection
A 3p.
A 4p.
D 3p.
D 4p.
AC
F 3p.
F 4p.
M 3p.
M 4p.
AA
522
641
504
624
480
437
557
345
465
63
65
106
330
1600
522
641
504
624
479
437
557
345
465
80
80
15
110
360
1800
522
641
504
624
479
437
557
345
465
100
80
15
110
360
SIDERMAT
Load break switches for power distribution
Remotely trippable switch from 250 to 1800 A
S3 type
70
90
37
47
210
sdmat_075_a_1_gb_cat
90
47
Door drilling
1414
RESET
Direction of operation
20 20
78
Side operation
Door drilling
20 20
Handle type
70
37
61
1414
RESET
Connection terminal
13
20 40 20
80
20 40
sdmat_045_a_1_x_cat
17 25
sdmat_044_a_1_x_cat
19 25 19
63
SIDERMAT 1800 A
13
16 x 11
10
30
33
50
SIDERMAT 1600 A
sdmat_057_a_1_x_cat
15
30
33
sdmat_043_a_1_x_cat
19x11
SIDERMAT 1250 A
20 40
SIDERMAT 800 A
25 50 25
100
97
SIRCO MC PV
The solution for
new
sirco-mc_003_a_1_cat
sirco-mc_002_a_1_cat
Load break
switches
Strong points
> Compact.
> High breaking capacity
up to 1000 VDC.
> Safety.
> Easy assembling.
SIRCO MC PV 25 A - 1000 VDC
Door mounting
Function
SIRCO MC PV are DC load break switches. They make and break under load conditions and
provide optimum safety isolation for any PV circuit.
Check it out!
> Need an enclosed switch?
No problem with our specific
product department. We
have solutions for any
requirement.
Advantages
Safety
q Pre-bridging is factory-achieved for easier,
quicker and safer connection.
q Direct access to connection terminals for
adequate tightening.
Easy mounting
Three mounting possibilities are available for
optimum integration and time saving:
q DIN rail or back plate mounting.
q Door mounting.
q Quick Fix mounting to save time when
integrating into solar inverters.
coff_380_a_1_cat
Compact
Thanks to its compact design, the limitation
of space within the combiner box or the solar
inverter is greatly reduced.
Conformity to standards
> IEC 60947-3
> UL508i(1)
SIRCO MC PV
DIN-rail mounting
98
SIRCO MC PV
Door mounting
SIRCO MC PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
up to 1000 VDC and 40 A
Multi-circuit breaking
q The SIRCO MC PV for double circuits (2 MPPT: Maximum Power Point Tracking) enables connection of two independent photovoltaic panel strings
to a single switch in order to reduce the costs of the global solution.
sirco-mc_045_a_1_gb_cat
RHQBNLB>>@
sirco-mc_024_a_1_x_cat
Inverter 1
Inverter 2
Panel 1
Panel 2
Inverter
sirco-mc_013_b_1_gb_cat
sirco-mc_020_a
sirco-mc_025_a_1_x_cat
+
3
AC
AC
Panel
RHQBNLB>>@>>W>B@S
RHQBNLB>>@>>W>B@S
99
SIRCO MC PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
up to 1000 VDC and 40 A
References
2(1".,"/55#"#(-Q@HKNQA@BJOK@SDLNTMSHMF
Rating (A)
30 A
Number of poles
by PV polarity(3)
No of poles
AC current
Switch body
Single PV circuit
1 P+, 1 P-
21PV 2102
PV + AC circuit
1 P+, 1P-
2P
21PV 2162
Double PV circuit
2 x (1P+, 1P-)
21PV 5102
Single PV circuit
2 P+, 1 P-
21PV 3124
Circuit type
Direct
handle(1)
External
handle
MC0 type
Blue
2119 0012(2)
PV + AC circuit
40 A
Double PV circuit
2 P+, 1 P-
2P
21PV 3184
2 x (1P+, 1P-)
21PV 6124
Blue MC01
type
2119 1012
Shaft for
external handle
Auxiliary
contact
vLL
1 contact
NC+NO
MC1 type
Black
(/
2119 3312(2)
2107 0516
Red / Yellow
(/
2119 0001
2119 3313
Blue MC01
type
2119 1412
(1) 45 mm modular DIN front plate included.
(2) Standard handle.
(3) Default connected device (see "Connection of poles" page 108).
Rating (A)
Circuit type
Number of poles
by PV polarity(3)
No of poles
AC current
Switch body
Direct
handle(1)
External
handle
Shaft for
external
handle
Auxiliary
contact
Blue MC0
type
2119 0012(2)
Single PV circuit
21PV 3722
2 P+, 1 P-
Blue MC01
type
25 A
2119 1012
Double PV circuit
21PV 6722
2 x (1P+, 1P-)
Blue MC01
type
2119 1412
Please consult us
(2)
2119 0012
Single PV circuit
2P+, 2P
21PV 4754
Blue MC01
type
2119 1012
100
2119 3312(2)
vLL
2107 0516
Blue MC0
type
40 A
Black
MC1 type
(/
Red / Yellow
(/
2119 3313
1 contact
NO + NC
2119 0001
SIRCO MC PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
up to 1000 VDC and 40 A
2(1".,"/55#"#NNQLNTMSHMF
Rating (A)
30 A
Circuit type
Number of poles
by PV polarity(1)
No of poles
AC current
Switch body
Single PV circuit
1 P+, 1 P-
21PV 2202
21PV 2302
PV + AC circuit
1 P+, 1 P-
2P
21PV 2262
21PV 2362
External
handle
"Quick Fix"
Auxiliary
contact
Blue
MC3 type
(/
2139 1212(2)
Double PV circuit
2 x (1P+, 1P-)
21PV 5202
Single PV circuit
2 P+, 1 P-
21PV 3224
Blue MC2
type
IP55
2129 0112(2)
21PV 5302
Black
MC4 type
(/
21PV 3324
2139 3312
1 contact
NC+NO
2129 0001
Red/Yellow
(/
40 A
PV + AC circuit
2 P+, 1 P-
2P
21PV 3284
21PV 3384
2139 3313
25 A
Circuit type
Number of poles
by PV polarity(1)
Single PV circuit
2 P+, 1 P-
No of poles
AC current
Switch body
External
handle
Switch body
"switch body" "Quick Fix"
21PV 3822
21PV 3922
External
handle
"Quick Fix"
Auxiliary
contact
MC3 type
!KTD(/
2139 1212(2)
Please consult us
40 A
Single PV circuit
2 P+, 1 P-
21PV 4854
Blue MC2
type
IP55
Black
MC4 type
(/
2129 0112
2139 3312
21PV 4954
1 contact
NC+NO
2129 0001
Red/Yellow
(/
2139 3313
101
SIRCO MC PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
up to 1000 VDC and 40 A
Accessories
Direct operation handle
Handle
colour
Type of locking
Handle
45 mm modular
DIN front plate
Reference
v
Blue
MC0 type
yes
2119 0012(1)
v
Blue
O@CKNBJ
mm
MC01 type
yes
2119 1012
Rating (A)
acces_305_a_1_cat
Use
The direct operation conversion kit requires an additional
LLCHRS@MBDNMD@BGRHCDNESGD@MCONKDCDUHBD
MC0 handle
Handle
colour
Type of locking
Handle
45 mm modular
DIN front plate
Reference
30
Blue
MC0 type
yes
2119 0012
30
Blue
O@CKNBJ
mm
MC01 type
yes
2119 1012
Blue
O@CKNBJ
mm
MC01 type
yes
2119 1412
Type of locking
Handle
45 mm modular
DIN front plate
Reference
O@CKNBJ
mm
MC01 type
yes
2119 1412
Rating (A)
40
@BBDR>>@>>B@S
2 MPPT 600 V
2 MPPT 1000 V
Handle
colour
Rating (A)
25
Blue
MC01 handle
@BBDR>>@>>B@S
Handle colour
Type of locking
External IP(1)
v
MC1 type
Black
O@CKNBJRLL
(/
v
MC1 type
Red/Yellow
O@CKNBJRLL
(/
v
S000 type
Black
O@CKNBJRLL
IP55
v
S000 type
Black
O@CKNBJRLL
(/
v
S000 type
Red/Yellow
O@CKNBJRLL
(/
Reference
2119 3312(2)(3)
2119 3313(3)
1461 5111
1463 5111
1464 5111
S000 handle
Reference
MC4 handle
acces_302_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
Door mounting
v
Handle
Handle colour
MC2 type
Type of locking
Blue
External IP(1)
(2)
IP55
2129 0112
Reference
@BBDR>>@>>B@S
Rating (A)
Handle colour
Type of locking
External IP(1)
v
MC3 type
Blue
1 padlock 5 mm
(/
v
MC4 type
Black
O@CKNBJRLL
(/
v
MC4 type
Red/Yellow
O@CKNBJRLL
(/
Rating (A)
102
2139 1212(2)
2139 3312
2139 3313
MC2 handle
SIRCO MC PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
up to 1000 VDC and 40 A
Shaft length
MC1 type:
q LL@ITRS@AKDTOSNLL
S000 type:
q 150 mm
q 200 mm
q 320 mm
Use
MC1 and S000 shafts can be adjusted and
cut depending on the need.
Handle
Dimension X (mm)
Length (mm)
Reference
v
MC1 type
v
v
S000 type
v
150
v
S000 type
v
200
v
S000 type
v
320
2107 0516
2107 0515
2107 0520
2107 0532
Terminal shrouds
acces_300_a_1_cat
For SIRCO MC PV
Rating (A)
Type of mounting
No. of poles
Position
Reference
v
1P
top or bottom
v
3P
top or bottom
2194 1004
2194 3004
+ +
+ + -
+ + + + -
sirco-mc_011_d_1_cat
@BBDR>>@>>B@S
Use
Top or bottom protection against direct contact
with the terminals or connection parts. 1 and 3
poles are available.
The SIRCO MC PV load break switch is prebridged. Terminal covers are mounted on the
top or bottom free space of the device.
Possibility to assemble a terminal shroud on the
bridge side by removing the insulating material
of the series connection bar (irreversible step).
+
Terminal shrouds 3 pole
103
SIRCO MC PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
up to 1000 VDC and 40 A
Accessories (continued)
Auxiliary contact
Use
These auxiliary contacts signalling position 0 and 1 can be normally
open or normally closed contacts. They can be fixed on the left or
right side of the switch body and/or on the power additional pole.
Connections
Min./max cross-sections: 1 mm/4 mm
3HFGSDMHMFSNQPTD
-L
Rating (A)
Type of mounting
Contact(s)
Contact type
Reference
v
1 contact
NO + NC
2119 0001
v
Door mounted
1 contact
NO + NC
2129 0001
400 VAC
690 VAC
Rating (A)
Contact
type
AC-15
AC-15
AC-15
v
NO + NC
sirco-mc_012_a_1_cat
@BBDR>>@>>B@S
"G@Q@BSDQHRSHBR@BBNQCHMFSN($"
25 to 40 A
Thermal current Ith at 40C(1)
25 A
30 A
40 A
1000
1000
1000
(A)
Circuit type
Number of poles
of the device
Number of pole(s)
in series per polarity
(A)
(A)
5#"
DC-21 B
Single PV circuit
2P
1 P+ and 1 P-
30
5#"
DC-21 B
Single PV circuit
3P
2 P + and 1 P -
40
Rated voltage
5#"
DC-21 B
Double PV circuit
4P
2 x (1 P+ and 1 P-)
30
5#"
DC-21 B
Double PV circuit
/
2 x (2 P+ and 1 P-)
40
1000 VDC
DC-21 B
Single PV circuit
3P
2 P + and 1 P -
25
1000 VDC
DC-21 B
Single PV circuit
4P
2 P + and 2 P -
40
1000 VDC
DC-21 B
Double PV circuit
/
2 x (2 P+ and 1 P-)
25
1.5
1.5
1.5
10
10
10
1.2
1.2
1.2
30 000
30 000
30 000
0.8
0.8
0.8
0.110
0.110
0.125
0.125
0.125
0.180
0.180
Connection
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
Operating effort (Nm)
0.145
0.145
6DHFGSNE@ONKD/5CDUHBDCNTAKD/5BHQBTHSJF
0.250
104
SIRCO MC PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
up to 1000 VDC and 40 A
Dimensions
DIN rail mounting - Direct operation
73.5
91.5
52
91.5
42
42
5
sirco-mc_004_b_1_x_cat
78
60
65
70
3.8
4
2
48.5
67.5
25
1. Terminal shrouds 1P.
2. Terminal shrouds 3P.
3. Auxiliary contact.
48.5
67.5
4. AC power pole.
5. AC or PV power pole.
A. MC0 handle.
B. MC01 handle.
88 - 98
44.5
42
5
max. 5
sirco-mc_005_b_1_x_cat
66
78
60
65
70
3.8
55
25
1. Terminal shrouds 1P.
2. Terminal shrouds 3P.
32
3. Auxiliary contact.
4. AC power pole.
5. AC or PV power pole.
A. MC1 handle.
Door mounting
51
34
55
37
RHQBNLB>>A>>W>B@S
44.5
max. 5
37
105
SIRCO MC PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
up to 1000 VDC and 40 A
Dimensions
"Quick Fix" door mounting
60
44.5
35
B
RHQBNLB>>A>>W>B@S
55
60
50
55
36
50
17
37
1. Terminal shrouds 1P.
2. Terminal shrouds 3P.
3. Auxiliary contact.
4. AC power pole.
5. AC or PV power pole.
A. MC3 handle
B. MC4 handle
A
RHQBNLB>>@>>W>B@S
78
60
65
70
3.8
4.65
1
48
71
25
1. Terminal shrouds 3P.
2. Auxiliary contact.
A. MC01 handle.
42
89
max. 5
66.5
25
1. Terminal shrouds 3P.
106
2. Auxiliary contact.
A. MC01 handle.
32
RHQBNLB>>@>>W>B@S
66
78
60
65
70
3.8
SIRCO MC PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
up to 1000 VDC and 40 A
Direction of operation
Door drilling
MC1 type
90
32
4.5
66
14
0
OFF
33
0
OFF
66
36
S000 type
45
13
27
45
36
25
3.2
ONHFM>>@>>FA>B@S
90
Door mounting
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
MC2 type
Door drilling
39
16.5
37
90
10
24
12.5
MC3 type
Quick Fix
90
3.2
12.5
48
22.5
36
48
55
56
MC4 type
Quick Fix
90
32
3.2
0
OFF
66
ONHFM>>@>>FA>B@S
0
33
0
OFF
12.5
66
22.5
107
SIRCO MC PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
up to 1000 VDC and 40 A
Poles connections
Switching of polarities + and -
sirco-mc_024_a_1_x_cat
Double PV circuit
sirco-mc_025_a_1_x_cat
PV and AC circuit
RHQBNLB>>@>>W>B@S
Single PV circuit
Direct operation
PV and AC circuit
21PV 2162
21PV 5102
Inverter
Inverter
5#"
25 A - 1000 VDC
sirco-mc_044_a_1_gb_cat
Panel
21PV 3421
21PV 3722
Inverter 1
AC
AC
Panel
21PV 3184
Inverter 2
Panel 1
Panel 2
21PV 6124
21PV 6722
Inverter 1
Inverter 2
108
Inverter
Panel
Inverter
sirco-mc_048_a_1_gb_cat
+
Panel 2
Inverter
Inverter 2
21PV 4754
AC
Panel
Panel
Panel 2
Panel 1
Inverter
AC
Panel
RHQBNLB>>@>>FA>B@S
Panel
40 A - 1000 VDC
Inverter 1
Panel
RHQBNLB>>@>>FA>B@S
Panel 1
Inverter
Inverter
sirco-mc_045_a_1_gb_cat
21PV 2102
Double PV circuit
RHQBNLB>>@>>FA>B@S
5#"
Single PV circuit
sirco-mc_013_a_1_gb_cat
Rating
SIRCO MC PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
up to 1000 VDC and 40 A
sirco-mc_025_a_1_x_cat
sirco-mc_024_a_1_x_cat
PV and AC circuit
RHQBNLB>>@>>W>B@S
Single PV circuit
Door mounting
Panel
AC
AC
21PV 3224
21PV 3324
Inverter
Panel
sirco-mc_008_a_1_gb_cat
Inverter
Inverter 1
Inverter 2
Panel 1
Panel 2
21PV 3284
21PV 3384
Panel
Inverter
sirco-mc_051_a_1_gb_cat
Panel
Inverter
AC
Panel
Panel
AC
Inverter
sirco-mc_052_a_1_gb_cat
Inverter
Panel
Inverter
21PV 4854
21PV 4954
Panel
40 A - 1000 VDC
Double PV circuit
21PV 5202
21PV 5302
sirco-mc_010_a_1_gb_cat
5#"
25 A - 1000 VDC
PV and AC circuit
21PV 2262
21PV 2362
sirco-mc_050_a_1_gb_cat
Single PV circuit
21PV 2202
21PV 2302
RHQBNLB>>@>>FA>B@S
Rating
5#"
109
SIRCO MV PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1000 VDC from 63 to 160 A
The solution for
sircm-pv_010_a_1_cat
Load break
switches
Strong points
SIRCO MV PV 1000 V - 80 A
direct operation
Conformity to standards
Function
SIRCO MV PV are manually operated multipolar load break switches. They make and break
under load conditions and provide optimum safety isolation for any PV circuit.
Advantages
Modular device
SIRCO MV PV are devices whichare DIN-rail or
backplate mountable and can be integrated into
a modular panel with a 45 mm front cut-out.
A complete solution
110
SIRCO MV PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1000 VDC from 63 to 160 A
References
SIRCO MV PV 800 VDC - DIN rail or back plate mounting
Rating
(A)
Circuit
type
63 A
No. of
poles
Switch body
3P
22PV 3106
Direct handle
S0 Type
Black IP55
S0 type
150 mm
(1)(2)
80 A
3P
1491 0111
22PV 3108
Black IP65
(2)
1493 0111
Blue M0b
100 A
Single PV
circuit
(1)
3P
22PV 3110
2299 5042
Blue M0 type
2299 5022
3P
2299 0001(3)
1 contact 2 NC
S1 type
Black IP55
S1 type
200 mm
1 contact NO
1401 0620
1 contact NC
320 mm
3999 0702
1413 2111(2)
1414 2111(2)
3P
1 contact
NC+NO
320 mm
200 mm
1409 0620
1409 0632
Black IP65
22PV 3012
Bridging bar
1409 0615
1494 0111(2)
1411 2111(2)
125 A
Auxiliary contact
2299 0011(3)
1 piece
2209 0016
3999 0701
1401 0632
400 mm
1401 0640
22PV 3016
(1) Standard.
(2) Defeatable handle.
(3) Signalling contact only.
Circuit
type
63 A
No. of
poles
Switch body
4P
22PV 4106
Direct handle
S0 Type
Black IP55
S0 type
150 mm
(1)(2)
80 A
4P
1491 0111
22PV 4108
Black IP65
(2)
1493 0111
Blue M0b
100 A
Single PV
circuit
(1)
4P
22PV 4110
2299 5042
Blue M0 type
2299 5022
4P
22PV 4012
2299 0001(3)
1 contact 2 NC
S1 Type
Black IP55
S1 type
200 mm
1 contact NO
1401 0620
1 contact NC
320 mm
3999 0702
Black IP65
1414 2111(2)
4P
1 contact
NC+NO
320 mm
200 mm
1409 0620
1409 0632
1413 2111(2)
Bridging bar
1409 0615
1494 0111(2)
1411 2111(2)
125 A
Auxiliary contact
2299 0011(3)
2 pieces
2209 2016
3999 0701
1401 0632
400 mm
1401 0640
22PV 4016
(1) Standard.
(2) Defeatable handle.
(3) Signalling contact only.
111
SIRCO MV PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1000 VDC from 63 to 160 A
Accessories
Rating (A)
Handle colour
Reference
63 ... 160
Blue
2299 5042(1)
(1) Standard.
M0b handle
Handle colour
Reference
63 ... 160
Blue
2299 5022
M0 handle
acces_285_a_2_cat
acces_268_a_2_cat
Use
Door interlocked external operation handles
include an escutcheon, are padlockable and
must be utilised with an extension shaft.
In a combiner box, located close to the
solar cell strings, or located close to the
inverter, we recommend the use of a door
interlocked external handle for safety.
Example
The locking function of the enclosure in
the "ON" position will force the operator to
safely disconnect and isolate the solar cell
strings prior to any intervention.
Opening the door when the switch is on
"ON" position is possible by defeating the
interlocking function with the use of a tool
(authorised persons only). The interlocking
function is restored when the door is
re-closed.
acces_279_a_2_cat
S0 type handle
Rating (A)
Handle
Handle
colour
External IP(1)
Reference
63 ... 160
S0 type
Black
IP55
63 ... 160
S0 type
Black
IP65
63 ... 160
S0 type
Red/Yellow
IP65
1491 0111(2)
1493 0111(2)
1494 0111(2)
External IP(1)
Reference
1411 2111(2)
1413 2111(2)
1414 2111(2)
acces_284_a_2_cat
Handle
Handle
colour
63 ... 160
S1 type
Black
IP55
63 ... 160
S1 type
Black
IP65
63 ... 160
S1 type
Red/Yellow
IP65
S1 type handle
acces_280_a_2_cat
- 320 mm
- 400 mm
Use
Standard lengths:
- 150 mm
- 200 mm
For SIRCO MV PV
Handle type
Length (mm)
Reference
63 ... 160
S0 type
150 mm
63 ... 160
S0 type
200 mm
63 ... 160
S0 type
320 mm
63 ... 160
S1 type
200 mm
63 ... 160
S1 type
320 mm
63 ... 160
S1 type
400 mm
1409 0615
1409 0620
1409 0632
1401 0620
1401 0632
1401 0640
Rating (A)
112
SIRCO MV PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1000 VDC from 63 to 160 A
Auxiliary contact
M type
Rating (A)
Contact(s)
Contact type
Reference
63 ... 160
1 contact
NO + NC
63 ... 160
1 contact
2 NC
2299 0001(1)
2299 0011(1)
sircm_048_a_1_x_cat
U-type
Pre-break and signalisation by NO or NC
auxiliary contact.
Max 2 auxiliary contacts.
sircm_075_b_2_cat
Use
M-type
Signalisation of positions 0 and I by
NO+NC or 2 NO auxiliary contacts. They
can be mounted on the right side on the
2(1".,5/5
4OSN@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BS
modules can be installed.
M type
U type
Rating (A)
Contact(s)
Contact type
Reference
63 ... 160
1 AC
NO
63 ... 160
1 AC
NC
3999 0701
3999 0702
sircm_098_a_1_cat
U type
M type
Auxiliary contact configurations for SIRCO MV PV
1. Maximum 2 "U" type auxiliary contacts.
2. Maximum 2 "M" type auxiliary contacts modules (4 A/C).
Terminal shrouds
Use
Top and bottom protection against direct contact
with the connection parts (set of 2 units).
Advantage
Perforations allow remote thermographic
inspection without the need to remove the
shrouds. The terminal shrouds also provide phase
separation.
For SIRCO MV PV
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Position
Reference
63 ... 160
3P
63 ... 160
4P
2294 3016
2294 4016
For SIRCO MV PV
Rating (A)
Pack
Reference
63 ... 160
1 piece
63 ... 160
2 pieces
2209 0016
2209 2016
Enclosed switches
Our SIRCO MV PV can be delivered
enclosed, please consult us. Close to the
installation, they guarantee:
Disconnection under DC load between the
inverters and PV generators (necessary
according to the IEC 60364-712 standard).
Available on request:
- Enclosures made of steel or stainless steel
sheet metal (painted for sea environments
or brushed), or insulating materials
- Specific colours (enclosure paint, handle)
- Specific dimensions
- Specific connections: class II quick
connectors
For any request of customised products,
please consult us.
113
SIRCO MV PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1000 VDC from 63 to 160 A
63 A
80 A
100 A
125 A
160 A
1@SDCHMRTK@SHNMUNKS@FD4i (V)
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1@SDCHLOTKRDVHSGRS@MCUNKS@FD4imp (kV)
Circuit type
No. of
poles
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
800 VDC
DC-21 B
Single PV circuit
3P
2 P + and 1 P -
63
80
100
125
160
1000 VDC
DC-21 B
Single PV circuit
4P
2 P + and 2 P -
63
80
100
125
160
70
Rated voltage
Connection
Maximum Cu rigid cable cross-section (mm)
70
70
70
70
Mechanical characteristics
Operating effort (Nm)
4.2
4.2
4.2
4.2
4.2
0.7
0.7
0.7
0.7
0.7
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
0.9
Dimensions
SIRCO MV PV 63 to 160 A
Direct front operation
76
64
A
109
35 26
8,8
D
44
C
37
8,8
70
71
88
131,4
189
124,6
110 min.
357 max.
69,9
29,5
B
135
61
1
53
26
M5
A. 3 poles
B. 4 poles
114
C. S0 type handle
D. S1 type handle
sircm_058_c_1_x_cat
SIRCO MV PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1000 VDC from 63 to 160 A
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S0 type
40
40
28
28
88
47
sircm_038_a_1_gb_cat
27
13.5
90
71
22.5
37
37
31
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
Door drilling
IP65 with 4 xing screws
S1 type
40
40
0
90
27
47
70
28
28
poign_039_a_1_gb_cat
78
37
44
31
Load
Load
SIRCO_307_b_1_gb_cat
SIRCO_305_b_1_gb_cat
115
SIRCO PV
The solution for
new
SIRCO-pv_023_a_1_cat
Load break
switches
Strong points
Function
Conformity to standards
Advantages
Performance
A glass fibre reinforced polyester break
chamber with an arc extinguishing system
provides a patented safety disconnection
system offering rapid extinguishing of the
electric arc up to 1500 VDC and current
interruption up to 3200 A.
>
>
>
>
IEC 60947-3
IEC 60364-4-410
IEC 60364-7-712
UL 98B(1)
116
SIRCO PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1500 VDC from 100 to 3200 A
References
Single PV circuit 750 VDC - Back plate mounting
Rating (A)
Circuit type
Number of
poles of the
device
Number of
pole(s) in series
per polarity
Switch body
100 A
26PV 3010
125 A
26PV 3012
160 A
26PV 3016
200 A
26PV 3020
250 A
26PV 3025
315 A
26PV 3031
400 A
26PV 3040
500 A
26PV 3050
3P
S2 type
Black IP55
J1 type
Black
1112 1111(1)
1113 1111
2609 0025
1421 2111(1)
1400 1020
Black IP65
1400 1032(1)
1423 2111
Red
Red IP65
1424 2111
2P+, 1P-
800 A
26PV 3080
1000 A
26PV 3100
1250 A
26PV 3120
26PV 3160
1600 A
26PV 3200
2000 A
Bridging bars
200 mm
320 mm
500 mm
1400 1050
2609 2050
26PV 3063
630 A
Single PV circuit
Shaft for
Direct handle(2) External handle external handle
2609 0080
J4 type
Black
1142 1111(1)
S4 type
Black IP65
1443 3111(1)
Red
Red IP65
1143 1111
1444 3111
200 mm
1401 1520
320 mm
(1)
1401 1532
400 mm
1401 1540
2609 1100
2609 1160
2609 1200
2500 A
Please consult us
3200 A
(1) Standard.
(2) Other types of operation handle available. see "Accessories" pages.
Rating (A)
Circuit type
Number of
poles of the
device
Number of
pole(s) in series
per polarity
Switch body
100 A
26PV 6010
125 A
26PV 6012
160 A
26PV 6016
200 A
26PV 6020
250 A
26PV 6025
315 A
26PV 6031
400 A
26PV 6041
500 A
26PV 6051
630 A
800 A
Dual PV circuit
6P
1000 A
2x (2P+, 1P-)
Shaft for
Direct handle(2) External handle external handle
2x
S3 type
Black IP55
J3 type
Black
1132 1111(1)
1133 1111
200 mm
1431 3111(1)
1401 1520
Black IP65
1401 1532(1)
1433 3111
Red
Red IP65
1434 3111
2609 0025
320 mm
400 mm
1401 1540
2x
2609 2050
26PV 6063
2x
Please consult us
2609 0080
26PV 6100
J4 type
Black
(1)
1142 1111
1250 A
Bridging bars
26PV 6120
S4 type
Black IP65
2x
1443 3111(1)
Red
Red IP65
200 mm
1143 1111
1444 3111
2799 3015
2609 1100
320 mm
2799 3018(1)
1600 A
2000 A
26PV 6160
26PV 6200
V1 type
Black
2799 7074
S5 type
Black IP65
1453 8111
Red IP65
450 mm
2799 3019
2x
2609 1200
1454 8111
(1) Standard.
(2) Other types of operation handle available. see "Accessories" pages.
117
SIRCO PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1500 VDC from 100 to 3200 A
References (continued)
Single PV circuit 1000 VDC - Back plate mounting
Rating (A)
Circuit type
Number of
poles of the
device
Number of
pole(s) in series
per polarity
Switch body
100 A
26PV 4010
125 A
26PV 4012
160 A
26PV 4016
200 A
26PV 4020
250 A
26PV 4025
315 A
26PV 4031
400 A
26PV 4040
500 A
26PV 4050
Shaft for
Direct handle(2) External handle external handle
J1 type
Black
1112 1111(1)
Red
1113 1111
S2 type
Black IP55
2609 2025
200 mm
1421 2111(1)
1400 1020
Black IP65
1400 1032(1)
1423 2111
Red IP65
1424 2111
320 mm
500 mm
1400 1050
2609 4050
26PV 4063
630 A
Single PV circuit
800 A
4P
2 P+, 2 P-
2609 2080
26PV 4080
1000 A
26PV 4100
1250 A
26PV 4120
1600 A
26PV 4160
J4 type
Black
S4 type
Black IP65
1142 1111(1)
1443 3111(1)
Red
Red IP65
1143 1111
1444 3111
26PV 4200
2000 A
Bridging bars
200 mm
1401 1520
320 mm
1401 1532(1)
400 mm
1401 1540
2x
2609 1100
2x
2609 1160
2x
26091200
2500 A
Please consult us
3200 A
(1) Standard.
(2) Other types of operation handle available. see "Accessories" pages.
Rating (A)
Circuit type
Number of
poles of the
device
Number of
pole(s) in series
per polarity
Switch body
100 A
26PV 8010
125 A
26PV 8012
160 A
26PV 8016
200 A
26PV 8020
250 A
26PV 8025
315 A
26PV 8031
400 A
26PV 8041
500 A
26PV 8051
Shaft for
Direct handle(2) External handle external handle
Bridging bars
2x
J3 type
Black
1132 1111(1)
Red
1133 1111
S3 type
Black IP55
200 mm
1431 3111(1)
1401 1520
Black IP65
1401 1532(1)
1433 3111
Red IP65
1434 3111
2609 2025
320 mm
400 mm
1401 1540
2x
2609 4050
26PV 8063
2x
800 A
Please consult us
2609 2080
1000 A
26PV 8100
630 A
Dual PV circuit
8P
1250 A
2x (2P+, 2P-)
26PV 8120
J4 type
Black
S4 type
Black IP65
1142 1111(1)
1443 3111(1)
Red
Red IP65
1143 1111
1444 3111
4x
200 mm
2609 1100
2799 3015
320 mm
2799 3018(1)
1600 A
2000 A
(1) Standard.
(2) Other types of operation handle available. see "Accessories" pages.
118
26PV 8160
26PV 8200
V1 type
Black
2799 7074
S5 type
Black IP65
1453 8111
Red IP65
1454 8111
450 mm
2799 3019
4x
2609 1200
SIRCO PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1500 VDC from 100 to 3200 A
Rating (A)
Circuit type
Number of
poles of the
device (1)
Number of
pole(s) in series
per polarity
Switch body
100 A
26PV 6010
125 A
26PV 6012
160 A
26PV 6016
200 A
26PV 6020
250 A
26PV 6025
315 A
26PV 6031
400 A
26PV 6041
500 A
26PV 6051
630 A
800 A
Single PV circuit
6P
3P+, 3P-(1)
2x
S3 type
Black IP55
J3 type
Black
1132 1111(3)
1133 1111
200 mm
1431 3111(3)
1401 1520
Black IP65
1401 1532(3)
1433 3111
Red
Red IP65
1434 3111
2609 2025
320 mm
400 mm
1401 1540
2x
2609 4050
26PV 6063
2x
2609 0080
J4 type
Black
(3)
1142 1111
26PV 6120
1250 A
Bridging bars
Please consult us
26PV 6100
1000 A
Shaft for
Direct handle(2) External handle external handle
S4 type
Black IP65
4x
1443 3111(3)
Red
Red IP65
200 mm
1143 1111
1444 3111
2799 3015
2609 1100
320 mm
2799 3018(1)
26PV 6160
1600 A
26PV 6200
2000 A
V1 type
Black
2799 7074
S5 type
Black IP65
450 mm
2799 3019
1453 8111
2x
2609 1200
Red IP65
1454 8111
(1) For an operating voltage of 1200 VDC, the 3 poles at the front of the device must be connected in series for one polarity, and the 3 poles at the rear must be connected in series for the other.
(2) Other types of operation handle available. See "Accessories" pages.
(3) Standard.
Rating (A)
Circuit type
Number of
poles of the
device (1)
Number of
pole(s) in series
per polarity
Switch body
100 A
26PV 8010
125 A
26PV 8012
160 A
26PV 8016
200 A
26PV 8020
250 A
26PV 8025
315 A
26PV 8031
400 A
26PV 8041
500 A
26PV 8051
630 A
800 A
1000 A
1250 A
Single PV circuit
8P
4P+, 4P-(1)
Direct handle
Shaft for
External handle external handle
Bridging bars
3x
J3 type
Black
1132 1111(1)
Red
1133 1111
S3 type
Black IP55
200 mm
1431 3111(1)
1401 1520
Black IP65
1401 1532(1)
1433 3111
Red IP65
1434 3111
2609 2025
320 mm
400 mm
1401 1540
3x
2609 4050
26PV 8063
3x
Please consult us
2609 2080
26PV 8100
26PV 8120
J4 type
Black
S4 type
Black IP65
6x
1142 1111(2)
1443 3111(1)
Red
Red IP65
200 mm
1143 1111
1444 3111
2799 3015
2609 1100
320 mm
2799 3018(1)
1600 A
2000 A
26PV 8160
26PV 8200
V1 type
Black
2799 7074
S5 type
Black IP65
1453 8111
Red IP65
450 mm
2799 3019
6x
2609 1200
1454 8111
(1) For an operating voltage of 1500 VDC, the 4 poles at the front of the device must be connected in series for one polarity, and the 4 poles at the rear must be connected in series for the other.
119
SIRCO PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1500 VDC from 100 to 3200 A
Accessories
Direct operation handle
B2 type
3/4 P
J1 type
100 800
C1 type
6/8 P
J3 type
C2 type
1000 1250
3/4/6/8 P
J4 type
C2 type
1600 2000
3/4 P
J4 type
6/8 P
V1 type
Handle colour
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
Reference
2699 5052
2699 5053
1112 1111(1)
1113 1111
2799 7052
2799 7053
1132 1111(1)
1133 1111
2799 7012
2799 7013
1142 1111(1)
1143 1111
2799 7012
2799 7013
1142 1111(1)
1143 1111
2799 7074(1)
B2 type handle
acces_153_a_1_cat
Handle
acces_129_b_1_cat
No. of poles
acces_114_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
C1-type handle
C2-type handle
acces_355_a
(1) Standard.
J1 type handle
S2 type handle
acces_152_a_2_cat
Example
The locking function of the enclosure in the
.-ONRHSHNMVHKKENQBDSGDNODQ@SNQSNR@EDKX
disconnect and isolate the solar cell strings
prior to any intervention.
.ODMHMFSGDCNNQVGDMSGDRVHSBGHRNM.-
position is possible by defeating the locking
function using a tool (authorised persons only).
The interlocking function is restored when the
door is re-closed.
acces_151_a_2_cat
Use
Door interlocked external operation handles
include an escutcheon, are padlockable and
must be utilised with an extension shaft.
In a combiner box, located close to the
solar cell strings, or located close to the
inverter, we recommend to use a door
interlocked external handle for safety.
acces_150_a_2_cat
S3 type handle
Front operation
No. of poles
Handle
3/4/6/8 P
S2 type
6/8 P
S3 type
3/4 P
S4 type
6/8 P
S5 type
100 800
1000 2000
(1) Standard.
120
Handle colour
Black
Black
Red
Black
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
Red
External IP(1)
IP55
IP65
IP65
IP55
IP65
IP65
IP65
IP65
IP65
IP65
Reference
1421 2111(1)
1423 2111
1424 2111
1431 3111(1)
1433 3111
1434 3111
1443 3111(1)
1444 3111
1453 8111(1)
1454 8111
S4 type handle
acces_286_a_2_cat
Rating (A)
S5 type handle
SIRCO PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1500 VDC from 100 to 3200 A
Reference
Shaft guide
1429 0000
acces_260_a_2_cat
Handle colour
Dimensions
Adds 12 mm to the depth.
External IP(1)
To be ordered
in multiples of
Reference
IP65
1493 0000
Black
acces_187_a_1_cat
Use
Enables S type handles to be fitted in place
of existing older style SOCOMEC handles.
Adapter can also be utilised as a spacer to
increase the distance between the panel
door and the handle lever.
Handle
Reference
Light grey
50
Dark grey
50
1401 0001
1401 0011
acces_198_a_1_cat
Handle
colour
Use
Standard lengths:
- 200 mm
- 320 mm
- 400 mm
- 450 mm
acces_369_a_1_cat
3/4P
100 800
6/8 P
3/4P
1000 2000
6/8 P
Dimension X
(mm)
125 250
125 370
125 550
221 343
221 463
221 543
221 343
221 463
221 543
415 570
415 690
415 820
Length (mm)
200 mm
320 mm
500 mm
200 mm
320 mm
400 mm
200 mm
320 mm
400 mm
200 mm
320 mm
450 mm
Reference
1400 1020
1400 1032
1400 1050
1401 1520
1401 1532
1401 1540
1401 1520
1401 1532
1401 1540
2799 3015
2799 3018
2799 3019
acces_202_a_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
Number of
poles of the
device
121
SIRCO PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1500 VDC from 100 to 3200 A
Accessories (continued)
Auxiliary contact
acces_076_a_1_cat
Characteristics
-.-" "(/VHSGEQNMSNODQ@SHNM
Connection to the control circuit
6.35 mm fast-on terminal.
Electrical characteristics
30 000 operations.
Use
Pre-break and signalling of positions 0 and I:
SN-.-"@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR
SN-.
-"@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR
SNKNVKDUDK-.-"@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR
NO/NC contact for 3/4 poles
Rating (A)
100 3200
Position A/C
Reference
1st
2699 0031
2699 0032
2nd
Position A/C
Reference
1st
2nd
2699 0301
2699 0302
Position A/C
Reference
1st
2nd
2699 0141
2699 0143
Position A/C
Reference
1st
2699 0061
2699 0062
2nd
Characteristics
Operating current Ie (A)
230 VAC
Contact type
400 VAC
24 VDC
48 VDC
AC-12
AC-15
AC-12
AC-15
DC-12
DC-14
DC-12
DC-14
-.-"
16
12
16
2.5
0.2
-"+NVKDUDK
16
12
16
0.3
-.
-"
16
12
16
0.3
Terminal shrouds
Single PV circuit
750 VDC
122
Rating (A)
Quantity to be
ordered
100 500
630 800
Reference
2694 3021
2694 3051
Advantage
Perforations allow remote thermographic
inspection without the need to remove the
shrouds.
The terminal shrouds also provide phase
separation for SIRCO PV from
SN
Single PV circuit
1000 VDC
Quantity to be
ordered
1
1
Reference
2694 4021
2694 4051
acces_077_a_1_cat
Use
Top or bottom protection against direct
contact with terminals or connection parts.
Reference
2694 3021
2694 3051
Reference
2694 4021
2694 4051
SIRCO PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1500 VDC from 100 to 3200 A
Terminal screens
Single PV circuit
750 VDC
Rating (A)
Position
Single PV circuit
1000 VDC
Reference
Position
Reference
Position
100 500
Top or bottom
630 800
Top or bottom
1000 1250 Top or bottom 2698 3080 Top or bottom 2698 4080 Top and bottom
1600
2000
acces_079_a_1_cat
Use
Top and bottom protection against direct contact with terminals or connection parts.
Dual PV circuit 1000 VDC or
single PV circuit 1500 VDC
Reference
Position
Reference
1509 4025
1509 4063
1509 4080
2698 3199
2698 4199
Top and
bottom
2698 3199
2698 4199
Top or bottom
Top or bottom
Inter-phase barrier
For 100 to 800 A SIRCO PV, the inter-phase
barriers allow insulation between poles
connected in series.
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Pack
Reference
100 500
3P
2 pieces
100 500
4P
3 pieces
630 800
3P
2 pieces
630 800
4P
3 pieces
2998 0023
2998 0024
2998 0013
2998 0014
3P/4P
included
1000 3200
acces_036_a_1_cat
Use
Safety isolation between the terminals.
Rating (A)
100 315
400 500
q!NSSNL!NSSNL
q3NO3NO
q3NO!NSSNL
q!NSSNL3NO
acces_334_a_1_cat
Use
The bridging bars facilitate the
connection of poles in series, allowing
the following configurations:
Single PV circuit
Single PV circuit
Dual PV circuit 750 VDC or
Dual PV circuit 1000 VDC or
750 VDC
1000 VDC
single PV circuit 1200 VDC
single PV circuit 1500 VDC
Quantity to be
Quantity to be
Quantity to be
Quantity to be
ordered
Reference
ordered
Reference
ordered
Reference
ordered
Reference
1
1
2
2
2609 0025
2609 0025
2609 0025
2609 0025
1
1
2
2
2609 2050
2609 4050
2609 2050
2609 4050
630 800
1000 1250
1600
2000
2609 0080
2609 1100
2609 1160
2609 1200
2609 2080
2609 1100
2609 1160
2609 1200
1
2
2
2
2609 0080
2609 1100
2609 2080
2609 1100
2(1)
2609 1200
4(1)
2609 1200
(1) For 1200 VDC products, order 4 times reference 2609 1200. For 1500 VDC products, order 6 times reference 2609 12000.
Figure
Reference
front direct
100 800
3/4 P
external front
2699 6008
1499 7701
Locking using 230 VAC undervoltage coil (other voltages: please consult us)
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Operation
Reference
125 630
3/4 P
external front
800 2000
3/4 P
front direct
2699 9063
2699 9315
Fig. 3
acces_005_a_1_x_cat
Operation
3/4 P
acces_158_a_1_x_cat
No. of poles
100 800
Fig.2
Fig.4
acces_004_c_1_x_cat
Fig. 1
acces_001_a_1_x_cat
Use
Locking in position 0 of the front or side
operation handle:
- using a padlock (not supplied) - function is
incorporated into the handle. From 125 to
1800 A, the padlock on the external front
operation handle also locks the door,
123
SIRCO PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1500 VDC from 100 to 3200 A
Characteristics
Characteristics according to IEC 60947-3
SIRCO PV - 100 to 400 A
Rated current I (A)
Rated insulation voltage Ui (V) - 3/4 P device
100 A
1200
125 A
1200
160 A
1200
200 A
1200
250 A
1200
315 A
1200
400 A
1200
1500
1500
1500
1500
1500
1500
1500
12(1)
12(1)
12(1)
12(1)
12(1)
12(1)
12(1)
Utilisation category
DC-22 B
Circuit type
Single PV circuit
No. of poles
3P
(A)
100
(A)
125
(A)
160
(A)
200
(A)
250
(A)
315
(A)
400
750 VDC
DC-22 B
Double PV circuit
6P
100
125
160
200
250
315
400
1000 VDC
DC-22 B
Single PV circuit
4P
100
125
160
200
250
315
400
1000 VDC
DC-22 B
Double PV circuit
8P
100
125
160
200
250
315
400
1200 VDC
DC-21 B
Single PV circuit
6P
100
125
160
200
250
315
400
1500 VDC
DC-21 B
Single PV circuit
8P
100
125
160
200
250
315
400
35
50
70
95
120
185
240
32
32
32
32
32
32
32
3HFGSDMHMFSNQPTDLHM-L
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
3HFGSDMHMFSNQPTDL@W-L
26
26
26
26
26
26
26
Connection
Mechanical characteristics
.ODQ@SHMFDEENQS-L
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
3.5
3.5
2.5
2.5
2.5
2.5
2.5
500 A
1200
630 A
1200
800 A
1200
1000 A
1200
1250 A
1200
1600 A
1200
2000 A
1200
1500
1500
1500
1500
1500
1500
1500
12(1)
12(1)
12(1)
12
12
12
12
(A)
800
(A)
1000
(A)
1250
(A)
1600
(A)
2000
Utilisation category
DC-22 B
Circuit type
Single PV circuit
No. of poles
3P
(A)
500
(A)
630
750 VDC
DC-22 B
Double PV circuit
6P
500
630
1000
1250
1600
2000
1000 VDC
DC-22 B
Single PV circuit
4P
500
630
800
1000
1250
1600
2000
1000 VDC
DC-22 B
Double PV circuit
8P
500
630
1000
1250
1600
2000
1200 VDC
DC-21 B
Single PV circuit
6P
500
630
1000
1250
1600
2000
1500 VDC
DC-21 B
Single PV circuit
8P
500
630
1000
1250
1600
2000
Connection
Maximum Cu rigid cable cross-section (mm)
2x150
2x185
2x240
2x240
2x240
32
40
50
63
63
100
100
3HFGSDMHMFSNQPTDLHM-L
20
40
40
40
40
40
40
3HFGSDMHMFSNQPTDL@W-L
26
45
45
45
45
45
45
Mechanical characteristics
.ODQ@SHMFDEENQS-L
10
14.5
14.5
37
37
56
56
3.5
3.5
3.5
12
12
10
10
15
15
124
SIRCO PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1500 VDC from 100 to 3200 A
Dimensions
100 to 2000 A - Single PV circuit
Direct front operation
J1
J2
U
90
AD
H
T X2
Overall Terminal
dimensions shrouds
Rating (A)
100 250
315 500
630 800
Switch mounting
J1
M M
3p. J1 4p. K BC 3p. 4p.
125
80
105
34
160
75
135
55
215
221 470
1600 2000
140
127.5 167.5
115
Connection
T U U1
25 25 21.5
11
35 35 26.5
- 165
255 335
50
175 9
- 60
492 467
90
X1
3p.
173.5 233.05
45
18
Switch body
F F
AC AD 3p. 4p. G
1000
1250
D min.
C
D
min
1. Terminal shrouds
A. S2 type handle
sirco_198_i_1_x_cat
I
T
F
X1 T
BC
CA
U1
125
AC
AA
BA
N
CA
33
13
61
15
65
16x11
X1
4p.
33
X2
27
AA BA CA
3.5 22.5
160 130
170 140
15
47.5 47.5
46.5
53.5 53.5
47.5 288
44 12.5x5
321
330
100 to 2000 A - Dual PV circuit and single PV circuit from 1200 to 1500 VDC
Direct front operation
A
M
10
Z
Y
8.5
CA
125
CA
HA
H
X
Rating (A)
100 250
315 500
630 800
1000
1250
1600 2000
A
4p.
E min
Terminal
shrouds
AC
280
148
401
225
386 466
478 598
459
461
Switch
mounting
Switch body
HA J 3p.
25
298 29
J 4p.
45
60
18
Overall dimensions
A
3p.
E min.
sirco-pv_029_b_1_x_cat
350
I
L1
AC
AA
BA
II
M
3p.
M
4p.
Connection
T
223
273
50
272
332
65
250
80
120
25 21.5
35 26.5
X
3p.
X
4p.
11
61
61 3.5 30 124
65
15
48
48
90
44 12.5 54
54
Z1
43 180
66.5
AA
BA
CA
160 130
15
260 220
20
253.5
321
25.5
255.5
288
15
125
SIRCO PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1500 VDC from 100 to 3200 A
Direction of operation
With lock
RONIS EL11AP
S2 type
40
78
90
26
37
47
73
5
3.
45
37
.5
45
26
14 14
24
28
poign_010_a_1_gb_cat
125
28
4 5.5
47
20 20
S3 type
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S3 type
90
78
37
40
210
poign_035_a_1_gb_cat
47
28
61
S4 type
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
S4 type
With lock
RONIS EL11AP
O
26
37
40
350
37
47
24
.5
26
20 20
47
73
28
5
3.
45
poign_011_a_1_gb_cat
28
60
S5 type
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S5 type
50
with V Escutcheon
498
poign_037_a_1_gb_cat
4 6,5
50
90
31
71
102
126
28
4 5.5
90
78
SIRCO PV
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1500 VDC from 100 to 3200 A
V1 type
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
Door drilling
V1 type
50
50
poign_011_a_1_gb_cat
545
4 6,5
31
122
12.5
81
15
12
sirco_031_a_1_x_cat
50
sirco_030_a_1_x_cat
12.5
13
19
11
65
22.5
1000 - 1250 A
22.5
1600 A
210
33
47
130
8,5
15
30 5
5
60
sirco_033_a_1_x_cat
128,5
12,5
12,5
22,95
11
33
sirco_032_a_1_x_cat
100
60
128,5
75
210
sirco_034_a_1_x_cat
22,95
12,5
12,5
15
30 5
5
60
60
8
71
127
SIRCO MOT PV
Motorised load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1000 VDC from 200 to 630 A
The solution for
sirco-pv_016_a_1_cat
Load break
switches
> Buildings.
> Solar parks.
Strong points
> Patented safety disconnection
system for firefighters.
> Manual emergency
operation.
SIRCO MOT PV 4x400 A
Function
A complete solution
Advantages
General characteristics
q 2 stable positions (I, 0).
q /NRHSHUDAQD@JHMCHB@SHNM
q 43., -4RDKDBSNQ
q /@CKNBJHMFHMONRHSHNMONRHSHNM(VHSGNOSHNM
q Up to 1000 VDC.
q (/CDUHBDR@MC@BBDRRNQHDR
coff_380_a_1_cat
SIRCO MOT PV are three or four pole motorised load break switches.
They make and break under load conditions and provide safety isolation for any low voltage
circuit dedicated to photovoltaic applications.
128
Conformity to standards
SIRCO MOT PV
Motorised load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1000 VDC from 200 to 630 A
References
2(1".,.3/55#"
Rating (A)
Circuit type
No. of poles
Switch body
19PV 3020
2609 0025(1)
19PV 3025
2609 2025(1)
400 A
2HMFKD/5BHQBTHS
/
19PV 3040
/
2609 0063(1)
1509 3025(2)
/
1stBNMS@BS-.-"
included
2ndBNMS@BS-.-"
1509 4025(2)
4109 0021
1509 3063
/
/
/
2609 2063(1)
19PV 3063
Terminal screens
/
/
19PV 3050
630 A
Auxiliary contact
/
200 A
Terminal shrouds
/
2694 3021(3)
/
2694 4021(3)
/
2694 3051(3)
/
1509 4063
2694 4051(3)
Terminal screens
/
Terminal shrouds
/
2(1".,.3/55#"
Rating (A)
Circuit type
No. of poles
Switch body
200 A
19PV 4020
19PV 4025
400 A
2HMFKD/5BHQBTHS
/
19PV 4040
19PV 4050
630 A
19PV 4063
Auxiliary contact
2609 0025(1)
1509 3025(2)
/
2609 2025(1)
/
2609 0063(1)
/
2609 2063(1)
/
1stBNMS@BS-.-"
included
2ndBNMS@BS-.-"
1509 4025(2)
4109 0021
1509 3063
/
/
1509 4063
2694 3021(3)
/
2694 4021(3)
/
2694 3051(3)
/
2694 4051(3)
129
SIRCO MOT PV
Motorised load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1000 VDC from 200 to 630 A
Accessories
Bridging bars for connecting poles in series
q
q
q
q
Use
The bridging bars facilitate the connection
of poles in series, allowing the below
configurations:
Bottom/Bottom
Top/Top
Top/Bottom
Top/Bottom
"NMMDBSHNMCH@FQ@LR2DD/NKDR
connections in serie", page 133.
Rating (A)
Number of poles of
the device in series
Pack
Reference
1 piece
2 pieces
1 piece
2 pieces
2609 0025
2609 2025
2609 0063
2609 2063
Auxiliary contact
Characteristics
Operating current Ie (A)
Rating (A)
Nominal
current (A)
250 VAC
AC-13
400 VAC
AC-13
24 VDC
AC-13
48 VDC
AC-13
200 630
16
12
14
@BBDR>>@>>B@S
Use
/QDAQD@J@MCRHFM@KHR@SHNMNEONRHSHNM(
SN-.-"@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR@R
standard).
Low level auxiliary contacts:
/KD@RDBNMRTKSTR
130
Rating (A)
Contact(s)
Reference
200 630
2nd
4109 0021
RUQ>>@>>B@S
References
SIRCO MOT PV
Motorised load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1000 VDC from 200 to 630 A
Terminal shrouds
Advantage of terminal shrouds
/DQENQ@SHNMR@KKNVQDLNSDSGDQLNFQ@OGHB
inspection without the need to remove the
shrouds.
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Position
Reference
/
/
/
/
2694 3021
2694 4021
2694 3051
2694 4051
acces_206_a_2_cat
Use
/QNSDBSHNM@F@HMRSCHQDBSBNMS@BSVHSG
terminals or connecting parts.
-NSBNLO@SHAKDENQSDQLHM@KRVHSGAQHCFHMF
bars connected.
Terminal screens
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Position
Reference
/
/
/
/
1509 3025
1509 4025
1509 3063
1509 4063
@BBDR>>@>>B@S
Use
Top and bottom protection against direct contact with
terminals or connection parts.
Rating (A)
Reference
200 630
1599 0003
@SXR>>@>>B@S
Use
Enables padlocking in position I (product can be padlocked in
position 0 as standard).
131
SIRCO MOT PV
Motorised load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1000 VDC from 200 to 630 A
Accessories (continued)
Key handle interlocking system
Locking in both positions (I-0) requires,
in addition, the 2 position padlocking
accessory.
Rating (A)
Reference
200 630
1509 1006
atys_101_a_1_cat
Use
With the product in manual mode, it enables
KNBJHMFHMONRHSHNMTRHMF@1.-(2$+ /
lock. Factory fitted.
"G@Q@BSDQHRSHBR@BBNQCHMFSN($"
200 to 630 A
Thermal current Ith at 40C
200 A
250 A
400 A
500 A
630 A
1200
1200
1200
1200
1200
12
12
12
Circuit type
Number of poles
of the device
Number of pole(s)
in series per polarity
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
5#"
DC-21 B
2HMFKD/5BHQBTHS
/
/
@MC/
200
400
630
1000 VDC
DC-21 B
2HMFKD/5BHQBTHS
/
/
@MC/
200
400
630
420/100
420/100
420/100
420/110
120
240
W
W
,@WHLTL"TATRA@QVHCSGLL
32
32
40
40
40
3HFGSDMHMFSNQPTDLHM-L
20
20
40
40
40
Rated voltage
Power supply
230 VAC min./max. (VAC)
Connection
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)(1)
8000
8000
132
SIRCO MOT PV
Motorised load break switches for photovoltaic applications
for use up to 1000 VDC from 200 to 630 A
Dimensions
2(1".,.3/5SN
J
M
J1
U
3
223
101
Fix. 180
CA
140
BA
Fix. 195
AA
10.5
2
10
85
11
Z2
Fix. 180
sirco_311_b_1_x_cat
C
Fix. 195
138
20
CA
1. Locking bracket
2. Maximum handle radius, operating angle 2 x 90.
3. Mounting spacers.
Rating (A)
Overall dimensions
A 3p. A 4p.
50.5
101
4. Terminal shrouds
5. Dimension of the cut-out
6. Handle
Terminal
shrouds
Switch
mounting
Switch body
H
Connection
AC
F 3p. F 4p.
M 4p.
AA
BA
200
280
328
184
160
210
30
11
33
33
160
130
280
328
184
160
210
30
11
33
33
160
130
X 3p. X 4p.
Z1
CA
400
394
400
221
244
304
210
13
190
260
220
20
394
400
221
244
304
210
13
190
260
220
20
630
394
400
221
244
304
210
13
190
260
220
20
/NKDBNMMDBSHNMRHMRDQHDR(1)
3 poles - bottom / top
+
Load
Load
RHQBN>>A>>FA>B@S
RHQBN>>A>>FA>B@S
AC
CA
133
SIRCO M UL508
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
16 to 80 A
The solution for
> Industrial control systems
sircm_133_a
sircm_132_a
Load break
switches
new
Rotary switch
SIRCO M 3 x 80 A
Strong points
Toggle switch
SIRCO M 3 x 80 A + 2 auxyliary contacts
>
>
>
>
Total integration.
Wide range of accessories.
Upgradeability.
Compliance to major
certifications and approvals.
> Specific characteristics.
sircm_175_a
sircm_174_a
Conformity to standards(1)
Rotary switch
SIRCO M 3 x 80 A
Function
SIRCO M UL/CSA non fusible disconnect switches are compact modulable and modular
switches. They make and break under load conditions and provide safety isolation for any low
voltage circuit, particularly for machine and control circuits.
sircm_003_a
134
sircm_005_a_1_cat
General characteristics
q
q
q
q
q
q
UL508 non-metallic
polycarbonate 4.4x enclosed
SIRCO M
SIRCO M UL508
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
16 to 80 A
16 A
No. of
poles
Toggle switch
(direct handle
included)
Rotary
switch
3P
2205 3000
2200 3000
External front
and right side
Direct handle
handles(4)
Shaft for
external
handles
S00 type I - 0
Black
3R, 12(1)
Switched
fourth pole
module
Auxiliary
contacts
Terminal
shrouds
Door
mounting kit
1P
2200 1000
1473 1111
20 A
3P
2205 3001
Red/Yellow
3R, 12(1)
2200 3001
Black
4, 4X(1)
25 A
3P
2205 3002
147D 1111
2200 3002
Red/Yellow
4, 4X(1)
32 A
40 A
3P
3P
2205 3003
2205 3004
2200 3003
1P
2200 1001
1474 1111
S00 and
S0 type
150 mm
5.9 in
1407 0515
147E 1111
Blue
2299 5012
S0 type
I-0
Black
1, 3R, 12(1)
2200 3004
1483 1111
200 mm
7.9 in
1P
1P
2294 1005(3)
2200 1002
1P
2200 1003
1407 0520
3P
M type
1 AC
NO + NC
2294 3005(3)
2299 3409
2299 0001
1 AC 2 NC
2299 0011
320 mm
12.6 in
1407 0532(2)
1P
2200 1004
Red/Yellow
1, 3R, 12(1)
1484 1111
63 A
3P
2205 3006
2200 3006
Black 4, 4X(1)
1P
2200 1006
148D 1111
80 A
3P
2205 3008
2200 3008
Red/Yellow
4, 4X(1)
148E 1111
1P
2294 1009(3)
3P
1P
2294 3009(3)
2200 1008
135
SIRCO M UL508
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
16 to 80 A
Conformity to standards(1)
General characteristics
q
q
q
q
coff_368_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
No. of
poles
Enclosed
switches
Enclosure size
3P
2214 3503
Size 1
Switched fourth
pole module
Unswitched
neutral pole
1P
1P
63 A
2224 3503
Size 2
3P
2224 3506
Size 2
Unswitched
protective earth
module
Auxiliary contacts Terminal shrouds
1P
32 A
3P
2200 1003
(1)
2200 5005
1P
(1)
2200 9005
M type
1 AC NO + NC
2299 0001
1P
1P
(1)
2200 1006
(1)
2200 5009
1P
1 AC 2 NC
(1)
2200 9009
2299 0011
2294 1005(2)
3P
2294 3005(2)
1P
2294 1009(2)
3P
2294 3009(2)
Configuration
1
sircm-ul_012_a_1_cat
136
4.94
125.5
Size 2
sircm-ul_008_a_1_x_cat
0.02
0.4
0.16
4
3.9
99
Size 1
4.37
111
3.62
92
7.32
186
7.8
198
8.27
210
sircm-ul_007_a_1_x_cat
2.67
68
0.02
0.4
6.38
162
5.9
150
4.37
3.62 111
0.13 92
3.4
2.68
68
6
152.5
0.79
20
4.45
113 0.59
15
SIRCO M UL508
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
16 to 80 A
Accessories
Rating (A)
Handle colour
Handle
Reference
Blue
M00 type
2299 5012
16 80
acces_277_a_2_cat
M00 handle
acces_264_a_2_cat
Use
The handle locking function prevents the
user from opening the door of the enclosure
when the switch is in the "ON" position (only
if the handle is fitted on the door).
Handle
S00 type
S00 type
S00 type
S00 type
S0 type
S0 type
S0 type
S0 type
Nema type
3R, 12
3R, 12
4, 4X
4, 4X
1, 3R, 12
1, 3R, 12
4, 4X
4, 4X
Reference
Nema type
4, 4X
Reference
Nema type
4, 4X
Reference
1473 1111
1474 1111
147D 1111
147E 1111
1483 1111
1484 1111
148D 1111
148E 1111
S00 handle
acces_279_a_2_cat
Rating (A)
16 80
16 80
16 80
16 80
16 80
16 80
16 80
16 80
Handle colour
Black
Handle
S00 type
1473 1113
S0 handle
Handle colour
Black
Handle
S00 type
1473 1114
acces_280_a_2_cat
Handle
Length (inches)
Length (mm)
Reference
16 ... 80
S00 type
5.9 in
150 mm
16 ... 80
S00 type
7.9 in
200 mm
16 ... 80
S00 type
12.6 in
320 mm
1407 0515
1407 0520
1407 0532
Rating (A)
Handle
Length (inches)
Length (mm)
Reference
16 ... 80
S00 type
5.9 in
150 mm
16 ... 80
S00 type
7.9 in
200 mm
16 ... 80
S00 type
12.6 in
320 mm
1407 0515
1407 0520
1407 0532
137
SIRCO M UL508
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
16 to 80 A
Accessories (continued)
Shaft guide for external handle
Handle type
Reference
S00 and S0
1419 0000
acces_260_a_2_cat
Use
This accessory enables handle to engage extension shaft with a misalignment of
up to 15 mm.
Required for a shaft lenght from 320 mm.
Type
switched
switched
switched
switched
switched
switched
switched
Reference
2200 1000
2200 1001
2200 1002
2200 1003
2200 1004
2200 1006(1)
2200 1008(1)
Use
Transforms:
- 3 pole SIRCO M load break switches
HMSN@ONKD
- 3 pole SIRCOVER M changeover
switches into a 4 pole.
sircm_072_b_1_cat
Rating (A)
16
20
25
32
40
63
80
(1) Not UL.
2200 5005(1)
2200 5009(1)
Use
Transforms the 3-pole
switch into a 3-pole + solid
neutral.
N or PE
Type
unswitched
unswitched
Reference
unswitched
63 80
1P
unswitched
2200 9005(1)
2200 9009(1)
Use
Adds 1 protective earth module
pole to the switch-disconnector.
N or PE
Type
1P
N or PE
No. of poles
16 40
N or PE
Rating (A)
N or PE
Earth module
sircm_078_a_1_gb_cat
No. of poles
1P
1P
N or PE
Rating (A)
16 40
63 80
Terminal shrouds
Rating (A)
138
No. of poles
Position
Reference
16 40
1P
16 40
3P
63 80
1P
63 80
3P
2294 1005
2294 3005
2294 1009
2294 3009
sircm_049_a_1_cat
Use
Top and bottom additional protection
against direct contact with the
terminals or connection parts. 1 or 3
pole are available.
SIRCO M UL508
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
16 to 80 A
AC type
Reference
1 AC
NO + NC
16 80
1 AC
2 NC
2299 0001
2299 0011
sircm_075_b_2_cat
Nb de CA
16 80
sircm_081_a_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
Conversion kit
Type
Reference
16 80
16 80
16 80
2269 6009
2209 6009
2299 6009
sircm_097_b_2_x_cat
sircm_086_b_1_cat
Rating (A)
sircm_050_c_2_cat
Use
These accessories enable the assembly of
2 switches in order to achieve:
- 6 or 8 pole switches
- 3 or 4 pole open or close transition
changeover switches.
Rating (A)
16 80
Reference
3/4 P
2299 3409
sircm_051_b_2_cat
Use
This kit enables direct mounting of
the switch on the panel door or on
the right or left side of the panel.
139
SIRCO M UL508
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
16 to 80 A
Characteristics
Characteristics according to UL508/CSA22.2#14 suitable as motor disconnect
SIRCO M UL508 - 16 to 80 A
General use rating
Short circuit rating at 600 VAC (kA)
16 A
65
20 A
65
25 A
65
32 A
65
40 A
10/65
63 A
50/65
80 A
50/65
Type of fuse
30
30
30
30
60/30
100/60
100/60
208 VAC
3 / 10.6
5 / 16.7
7.5 / 24.2
7.5 / 24.2
7.5 / 24.2
15 / 46.2
15 / 46.2
220-240 VAC
5 / 15.2
5 / 15.2
7.5 / 22
7.5 / 22
7,5 / 22
20 / 54
20 / 54
440-480 VAC
10 / 14
10 / 14
15 / 21
20 / 27
20 / 27
40 / 52
40 / 52
600 VAC
10 / 11
15 / 17
20 / 22
25 / 27
25 / 27
40 / 41
40 / 41
Solid - 1 wire
#14 - #10
#14 - #10
#14 - #10
#14 - #10
#14 - #10
#14 - #10
#14 - #10
Solid - 2 wires
2x #12
2x #12
2x #12
2x #12
2x #12
2x #12
2x #12
Stranded - 1 wire
#14 - #4
#14 - #4
#14 - #4
#14 - #4
#14 - #4
#14 - #1
#14 - #1
Stranded - 2 wires
2x (#14 - #12)
2x (#14 - #12)
2x (#14 - #12)
2x (#14 - #12)
2x (#14 - #12)
2x (#10 - #6)
2x (#10 - #6)
A300
A300
A300
A300
A300
A300
A300
100 000
100 000
100 000
100 000
100 000
100 000
100 000
7/0.8
7/0.8
7/0.8
7/0.8
7/0.8
8.9/1
8.9/1
Connection terminals
Auxiliary contacts
Electrical characteristics
Mechanical characteristics
Endurance (number of operating cycles)
Operating torque (lbs.in/Nm)
140
SIRCO M UL508
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
16 to 80 A
16 A
16
20 A
20
25 A
25
32 A
32
40 A
40
63 A
63
80 A
80
800
800
800
800
800
800
800
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
415 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
32/32
40/40
63/63
80/80
500 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
32/32
40/40
63/63
80/80
500 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
25/25
25/25
63/63
63/63
690 VAC
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
32/32
40/40
63/63
80/80
690 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
32/32
32/40
40/63
63/80
690 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
16/16
20/20
25/25
25/25
25/25
40/40
40/40
7.5
11
15
18.5
30
37
7.5
11
15
15
30
37
7.5
11
15
18.5
18.5
30
37
Rated voltage
50
50
50
50
50
50
50
16
20
25
32
40
63
80
2.5
2.5
2.5
2.5
2.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
2.5
2.5
16
16
16
16
16
35
35
2 / 2.2
2 / 2.2
2 / 2.2
2 / 2.2
2 / 2.2
3.5 / 3.85
3.5 / 3.85
Connection
(1) A/B: Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer to another.
(3) For a rated operating voltage Ue = 400 VAC.
141
SIRCO M UL508
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
16 to 80 A
1.97
50
0.24
6
N
AC
0.35 F1
8.8 M5
F1 0.35
8.8
F
M
0.35
8.8
0.24
6
1.97
50
N
AC
G
2.68
68
90
sircm_052_b_1_gb_cat
2.95
75
2.52
64
G
2.67
68
F
M
sircm_053_b_1_gb_cat
3.19
81
2.87
73
2.52
64
F1
M5
0.35
8.8
F1
1. Position for 1 switched fourth pole module (1 per device max.) or 1 unswitched neutral pole or 1 protective earth module or 1 auxiliary contact.
2. Position for 1 auxiliary contact only.
Note: Maximum of 4 additional blocks.
External front handle
3.19
81
2.52
64
1.99
50.6
1.42
36
1
2
1.73
44
N
AC
G
2.68
68
3.15
80
1.61
41
sircm-ul_002_a_1_gb_cat
0.98
25
2.79
71
1.77
45
0.35
8.8
F1
F1
T
0.23
6
0.35
8.8
M5
1.96
50
1. Position for 1 switched fourth pole module (1 per device max.) or 1 unswitched neutral pole or 1 earth module or 1 auxiliary contact.
2. Position for 1 auxiliary contact only.
Note: Maximum of 4 additional blocks.
Rating (A)
16 to 40
63 to 80
Units
in
mm
in
mm
D min
1.18
30
1.18
30
Overall dimensions
D max
E min
9.25
3.94
235
100
9.25
3.93
235
100
E max
14.64
372
14.64
372
Terminal shrouds
AC
4.33
110
4.33
110
F
1.77
45
2.06
52.5
Switch body
F1
G
0.59
2.67
15
68
0.69
2.99
17.5
76
Switch mounting
M
N
1.18
2.95
30
75
1.38
3.35
35
85
J
0.59
15
0.69
17.5
Connection
T
0.59
15
0.69
17.5
F
2.06
52.5
3.50
89
3.07
78
1.42
36
1.77
45
2.79
71
N
G
2.67
68
sircm_055_c_1_gb_cat
J
F2
X M
0.35 F1
T T
8.8
2.06
52.5
0.29
7.5
0.24
6
F1 0.35
8.8
1.69
43
1.36
34.7
1. Position for 1 switched fourth pole module (1 per device max.) or 1 unswitched neutral pole or 1 earth module or 1 auxiliary contact.
2. Position for 1 auxiliary contact only.
Note: Maximum of 4 additional blocks.
Rating (A)
16 to 40
63 to 80
142
Units
in
mm
in
mm
Overall dimensions
E min
E max
4.13
14.64
105
372
4.13
14.65
105
372
F
3.83
97.5
4.13
105
F1
0.59
15
0.69
17.5
Switch body
F2
G
1.77
2.67
45
68
2.06
2.99
52.5
76
J
1.92
48.75
2.06
52.5
Switch mounting
M
N
1.18
2.95
30
75
1.38
3.35
35
85
Connection
T
X
0.59
0.29
15
7.5
0.69
0.34
17.5
8.75
SIRCO M UL508
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
16 to 80 A
Front operation
Side operation
Direction of operation
Direction of operation
S00 type
Load break switches
Door drilling
IP65 with 4 xing screws
1.57
40
90
90
4 0.27
47
1.10
28
2.79
71
3.07
78
1.42
36
1.22
31
With xing nut
0.53
13.5
sircm-ul_015_a_1_gb_cat
0.12
3
0.88
22.5
Front operation
Side operation
Direction of operation
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S00 type
90
90
0.11
3
4 0.27
47
1.10
28
2.79
71
3.07
78
1.57
40
0.53
13.5
1.42
36
1.22
31
0.88
22.5
poign_048_b_1_gb_cat
Handle type
Front operation
Direction of operation
Typ S00
Changeover switches
Door drilling
With 4 xing screws
0
or
I+II
90
1.45
37
0.88
22.5
2.79
71
40
90
2.79
71
1.41
36
0.53
13.5
0.12
3
II
1.10
28
4 0.27
47
sircm_013_b_1_gb_cat
Handle type
143
SIRCO M UL98
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
30 to 100 A
The solution for
sircm_100_a_1_cat
Load break
switches
Strong points
>
>
>
>
Total integration.
Wide range of accessories.
Upgradeability.
Compliance to major
certifications and approvals.
> Specific characteristics.
Rotary switch
SIRCO M 3 x 100 A
Conformity to standards(1)
Function
SIRCO M non fusible disconnect switches are compact switches that break and make power
circuits on and off load and provide safety isolation.
These switches are extremely durable and are tested and approved for use in the most
demanding applications.
144
General characteristics
Specific characteristics
q
q
q
q
SIRCO M UL98
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
30 to 100 A
References
UL98 Non Fusible Disconnect switches
Rating (A)
30 A
No. of
poles
3P
Switch
body
Direct
handle
Shafts for
external front
and side handles
Unswitched
neutral pole
Earth
module
Auxiliary
contacts
Terminal
shrouds
1P
S00 type I - 0
Black
4, 4X
2201 3003
Switched
fourth pole
module
2201 1003
147D 1111
150 mm 5.9 in
60 A
3P
2201 3006
Blue
M type
1 AC
NO + NC
Red/Yellow
4, 4X
1407 0515
147E 1111
200 mm 7.9 in
1P
1P
1P
1407 0520
2201 1006
2200 5011(2)
2200 9011(2)
2299 5032
S0 type I - 0
Black
4, 4X
2299 0001
320 mm 12.6 in
M type
1 AC 2 NC
1407 0532(1)
2299 0011
1P
2294 1011(3)
3P
2294 3016(3)
148D 1111
100 A
3P
2200 3010
Red/Yellow 4, 4X
148E 1111
1P
2200 1010
(1) Shaft guide reference 14190000, is required for shaft length over 15.7 inches (400 mm).
(2) Not UL.
(3) Top and bottom.
145
SIRCO M UL98
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
30 to 100 A
Accessories
Rating (A)
Colour
Handle
Reference
30 ... 100
Blue
M01 type
2299 5032
acces_283_a_2_cat
M01 handle
S00 handle
Handle
S00 type
S00 type
S00 type
S00 type
S0 type
S0 type
S0 type
S0 type
Nema type
3R, 12
3R, 12
4, 4X
4, 4X
1, 3R, 12
1, 3R, 12
4, 4X
4, 4X
Reference
acces_279_a_2_cat
Rating (A)
16 80
16 80
16 80
16 80
16 80
16 80
16 80
16 80
acces_264_a_2_cat
1473 1111
1474 1111
147D 1111
147E 1111
1483 1111
1484 1111
148D 1111
148E 1111
S0 handle
Length (inches)
Length (mm)
Reference
30 ... 100
5.9 in
150 mm
30 ... 100
7.9 in
200 mm
30 ... 100
12.6 in
320 mm
1407 0515
1407 0520
1407 0532
acces_280_a_2_cat
Use
This accessory makes shaft introduction easier with up to 15 mm misalignement.
Required for a shaft length from 320 mm.
146
Handle type
Reference
S0
1419 0000
acces_260_a_2_cat
SIRCO M UL98
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
30 to 100 A
Type
Reference
30
1P
switched
60
1P
switched
100
1P
switched
2201 1003
2201 1006
2200 1010
Reference
Use
Adding one or two additional poles
transforms a load break switch from
3 poles to 4 poles.
sircm_072_b_1_cat
Rating (A)
Use
Transforms the 3-pole
switch into a 3-pole + solid
neutral.
2200 5011(1)
N or PE
Type
1P
unswitched
Use
Adds 1 earth module pole to the
switch-disconnector.
Reference
2200 9011(1)
N or PE
Type
1P
N or PE
No. of poles
30 100
N or PE
Rating (A)
N or PE
Earth module
sircm_078_a_1_gb_cat
No. of poles
30 100
N or PE
Rating (A)
Terminal shrouds
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Position
Reference
30 100
1P
30 ... 100
3P
2294 1011
2294 3016
sircm_049_a_1_cat
Use
Top and bottom additional
protection against direct contact
with the terminals or connection
parts. 1 or 3 pole are available.
Characteristics
A300.
sircm_075_b_2_cat
Use
Pre-break and signalisation of positions 0
and I by NO+NC or 2 NO auxiliary contacts.
Rating (A)
Nb de CA
AC type
Reference
30 ... 100
1 AC
NO + NC
30 ... 100
1 AC
2 NC
2299 0001
2299 0011
sircm_081_a_1_x_cat
147
SIRCO M UL98
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
30 to 100 A
Characteristics
Characteristics according to UL98/CSA22.2#4
SIRCO M UL98 - 30 to 100 A
General use rating
30 A
60 A
100 A
100
100
100
100
100
25
Type of fuse
30
60
100
220-240 VAC
10 / 28
20 / 54
20 / 54
440-480 VAC
20 / 27
40 / 52
50 / 65
600 VAC
25 / 27
50 / 52
50 / 52
2 / 24
3 / 34
5 / 56
240 VAC
5 / 28
10 / 50
10 / 50
Solid - 1 wire
#12 - #10
#12 - #10
#12 - #10
Stranded - 1 wire
#12 - 2/0
#12 - 2/0
#12 - 2/0
Connection terminals
Mechanical characteristics
Endurance (number of operating cycles)
Operating torque (lbs.in/Nm)
10000
10000
10000
12.4/1.4
12.4/1.4
12.4/1.4
A300
A300
A300
Auxiliary contacts
Electrical characteristics
30 A
60 A
100 A
800
800
800
A(1)
A(1)
400 VAC
AC-22 A
32
63
100
400 VAC
AC-23 A
32
63
100
690 VAC
AC-22 A
32
63
80
690 VAC
AC-23 A
32
63
63
15
30
45
15
30
45
18.5
30
45
12
12
12
2.5
2.5
10
70
70
70
Rated voltage
Utilisation category
Connection
148
SIRCO M UL98
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
30 to 100 A
F
1
0.35
8.8
F1
F1
AC
sircm_056_c_1_gb_cat
0.24
6
2.09
53
0.35
8.8
M5
36
3.07
78
1.02
26
0.51
13
1.99
50.6
1
1.42
36
1
2
sircm-ul_003_a_1_gb_cat
71
5.17
131.4
7.44
189
3.15
80
1.61
41
4.90
124.6
1.73
44
2.08
53
0.34 1.02
8.8 26
0.26
6
1.02
26
M5
1.02
26
0.34
8.8
Side operation
Direction of operation
Direction of operation
S00 type
Door drilling
With 4 xing screws
0.11
3
4 0.27
47
1.10
28
2.79
71
1.42
36
90
1.22
31
0.53
13.5
90
3.07
78
1.57
40
0.88
22.5
poign_048_b_1_gb_cat
Handle type
149
SIRCO UL98
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
100 to 1200 A
The solution for
sirco-ul_022_b_1_cat
Load break
switches
Strong points
sirco_093_b_1_cat
SIRCO 3 x 200 A
> Reliability.
> Safety of property
and personnel.
> Simplicity.
> Easy assembling.
Conformity to standards(1)
SIRCO 3 x 600 A
Function
SIRCO non fusible disconnect switches are heavy duty switches that break and make power
circuits on and off load and provide safety isolation.
These switches are extremely durable and are tested and approved for use in the most
demanding applications.
General characteristics
q
q
q
q
q
150
Customised solutions
> Please consult us.
SIRCO UL98
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
100 to 1200 A
References
Rating (A)
No. of
poles
Switch body
3P
2700 3011
4P
2700 4011
Direct handle
External handle
S2 type
Black
1, 3R, 12
100 A
3P
3P
142F 2111
2700 3021
200 A
4P
(1)
2700 4021
Red/Yellow
1, 3R, 12
142G 2111(1)
Black
2699 5052
Black
4, 4X
2700 3041
4P
2700 4041
3P
2700 3060
4P
2700 4060
3P
2700 3080
Terminal
Auxiliary contacts protection screens Terminal Lugs kits
3P
200 mm
7.9 inches
Red/Yellow
4, 4X
2799 0021
1400 1032
400 mm
15.7 inches
1400 1040
142E 2111
4P
3P
2700 4080
2700 3100
143D 3111(1)
Black
3799 6012
Red/Yellow
4, 4X
1000 A
4P
143E 3111(1)
2700 4100
200 mm
7.9 inches
1401 1520
320 mm
12.6 Inches
1401 1532
400 mm
15.7 Inches
1401 1540
3P
2700 3120
4P
2700 4120
3954 3020(4)
4P
3954 4020(4)
4P
(4)
2798 4021
3P
2798 3041(2)
3P
3P
3954 3040(4)
2798 8041(3)
4P
4P
3954 4040(4)
2798 4041(4)
600 A
800 A
3P
3P
2798 8021
1400 1020
(1)
S3 type
Black
4, 4X
2798 3021(2)
(3)
2799 0022
142D 2111(1)
400 A
3P
3P
2798 3060(4)
3954 3060
4P
4P
2798 4060(4)
3954 4060
Contact holder
3999 0720(5)
Contact NO
3999 0701
Contact NC
3999 0702
3P
3P
2798 3120(4)
3954 3120
4P
4P
2798 4120(4)
3954 4120
1200 A
Accessories
Colour
Handle
Reference
Black
B type
Black
H type
2699 5052
3799 6012
H type handle
acces_114_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
acces_135_a_2_cat
B type handle
151
SIRCO UL98
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
100 to 1200 A
Accessories (continued)
External operation handle
Use
The interlocking function of the front
external handle prevents the user from
opening the door of the enclosure when the
switch is in the "ON" position or when the
switch is padlocked in the "OFF" position
(S1, S2, S3 and S4 type handles only).
acces_150_a_1_cat
Front handle I - 0
Colour
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
Red/Yellow
Nema type
1, 3R, 12
1, 3R, 12
4, 4X
4, 4X
4, 4X
4, 4X
4, 4X
4, 4X
Reference
Nema type
4, 4X
4, 4X
4, 4X
4, 4X
4, 4X
4, 4X
Reference
142F 2111
142G 2111
142D 2111
142E 2111
143D 3111
143E 3111
144D 3111
144E 3111
S3 type handle
Colour
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
Red/Yellow
S4 type handle
acces_236_a_2_cat
Rating (A)
100 ... 400
100 ... 400
600 1200
600 1200
600 .... 1200
600 1200
acces_152_a_2_cat
Handle
S2 type
S2 type
S2 type
S2 type
S3 type
S3 type
S4 type
S4 type
acces_166_a_2_cat
Rating (A)
100 ... 400
100 ... 400
100 ... 400
100 ... 400
600 1200
600 1200
600 1200
600 1200
142D 2911
142E 2911
143D 3911
143E 3911
144D 3911
144E 3911
Rating (A)
100 400
100 400
100 400
600 1200
600 1200
600 1200
acces_369_a_1_cat
Dimension Dimension
Length Length
X (in)
X (mm)
Handle
(inches) (mm)
5.31 ... 10.43 135 ... 265
S2 type
7.9
200
5.31 ... 15.16 135 ... 385
S2 type
12.6
320
5.31 ... 18.31 135 ... 465
S2 type
15.7
400
8.70 ... 13.50 221 343 S3, S4 type
7.9
200
8.70 ... 18.23 221 ... 463 S3, S4 type
12.6
320
8.70 ... 21.38 221 543 S3, S4 type
15.7
400
acces_144_b_1_cat
Reference
1400 1020
1400 1032
1400 1040
1401 1520
1401 1532
1401 1540
acces_202_a
Use
Standard lengths:
- 7.9 in / 200 mm,
- 12.6 in / 320 mm,
- 15.7 in / 400 mm.
Handle colour
Light grey
Dark grey
Light grey
Dark grey
Pack qty
50
50
50
50
Reference
1401 0001
1401 0011
1401 0031
1401 0041
acces_198_a_1_cat
Use
For single lever handles type S1, S2, S3 and
double lever handle, type S4.
Handle colour
Black
152
Dimensions
Adds 12 mm to the depth.
Pack qty
Nema type
Reference
10
1, 3R, 12
1493 0000
acces_187_a_1_cat
Use
Enables S-type handles to be fitted in place
of existing older style Socomec handles.
Adapter can also be utilised as a spacer to
increase the distance between the panel
door and the handle lever.
SIRCO UL98
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
100 to 1200 A
Description
Reference
Shaft guide
1429 0000
acces_260_a_2_cat
Use
This accessory makes shaft introduction
easier with up to 15 mm misalignment.
Auxiliary Contacts
Electrical characteristics
A300 for 100 to 400 A.
A600 for 600 to 1200 A.
No. of AC
1st
2nd
Reference
No. of AC
1st
2nd
Reference
Type
Holder
NO
NC
Reference
2799 0021
2799 0022
acces_076_a_1_cat
Use
Pre-break and signalling of positions 0 and I.
2799 0121
2699 0122
Rating (A)
600 ... 1200
600 ... 1200
600 ... 1200
acces_045_a_1_cat
Terminal screens
Use
Top or bottom protection against direct contact with terminals or connection parts.
No. of poles
3P
3P
4P
3P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
Position
top
bottom
top / bottom
top
bottom
top / bottom
bottom
bottom
bottom
bottom
Reference
2798 3021
2798 8021
2798 4021
2798 3041
2798 8041
2798 4041
2798 3060(1)
2798 4060(1)
2798 3120(1)
2798 4120(1)
acces_079_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
100 ... 200
100 ... 200
100 ... 200
400
400
400
600
600
800 1200
800 1200
(1) Load side screen, the line side is included with the switch.
Terminal lugs
Use
Connection of bare copper cables onto the lugs (without lugs).
Wires range
6 - 300MCM
6 - 300MCM
6 - 300MCM
2 - 600MCM
2 - 600MCM
2 - 600MCM
2x (#6 - 350MCM)
2x (#6 - 350MCM)
2x (#6 - 350MCM)
2x (#2 - 600MCM)
2x (#2 - 600MCM)
2x (#2 - 600MCM)
4x (#2 - 600MCM)
4x (#2 - 600MCM)
No wires
per lug
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
1
2
2
2
2
Lugs per
kit
2
3
4
2
3
4
2
3
4
2
3
4
6
8
Wires
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Reference
3954 2020
3954 3020
3954 4020
3954 2040
3954 3040
3954 4040
3954 2041
3954 3041
3954 4041
3954 2060
3954 3060
3954 4060
3954 3120
3954 4120
ul_032_a
153
SIRCO UL98
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
100 to 1200 A
Characteristics
Characteristics according to UL98/CSA22.2#4
SIRCO UL98 - 100 to 1200 A
General use rating (A)
Short circuit rating at 600 VAC (kA)
Type of fuse
Max. fuse rating (A)
100 A
200
J
100
200 A
200
J
200
400 A
200
J
400
600 A
200
J
600
800 A
100
L
800
1000 A
100
L
1000
1200 A
100
L
1200
30 / 80
75 / 96
100 / 99
75 / 196
150 / 180
200 / 192
125 / 312
250 / 302
350 / 336
200 / 480
400 / 477
350 / 336
200 / 480
500 / 590
500 / 472
200 / 480
500 / 590
500 / 472
200 / 480
500 / 590
500 / 472
10 / 76
15 / 55
15 / 112
15 / 55
20 / 148
50 / 173
20 / 148
50 / 173
2x #6 / #2
2x 350 /
600MCM
Connection terminals
Min. connection section / AWG
#6
#6
300MCM
300MCM
2x #2
4x #2
4x #2
4x #2
2x 600MCM
4x 600MCM
4x 600MCM
4x 600MCM
10000
88.5/10
8000
88.5/10
6000
128.3/14.5
6000
327.5/37
3500
442.5/50
3500
442.5/50
3500
442.5/50
A300
A300
A300
A600
A600
A600
A600
100 A
1000
200 A
1000
400 A
1000
600 A
1000
800 A
1000
1000 A
1000
1200 A
1000
12
12
12
12
12
12
12
Mechanical characteristics
Endurance (number of operating cycles)
Operating torque (lbs.in/Nm)
Auxiliary contacts
Electrical characteristics
(1) 2 pole in series.
(2) 3 pole in series.
A(1)
A(1)
A(1)
A(1)
A(1)
A(1)
A(1)
400 VAC
AC-22 A
100
200
400
630
800
1000
1200
400 VAC
AC-23 A
100
200
400
630
800
1000
1000
690 VAC
AC-22 A
100
200
400
500
630
630
630
690 VAC
AC-23 A
100
200
315
200
400
400
400
35
70
185
Rated voltage
Connection
Min. Cu cable cross section (mm)
Min. Cu busbar section (mm)
2 x 150
2 x 185
2 x 240
2 x 30 x 5
2 x 40 x 5
2 x 50 x 5
2 x 60 x 5
51
100
220
355
450
560
560
63
140
280
450
560
560
560
90
185
185
185
400
400
400
17,6
32
48
48
75
48
75
154
SIRCO UL98
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
100 to 1200 A
Z
Y
AC
sirco-ul_011_a_2_x_cat
AA
V
CA
R1
R2
Overall
dimensions
Rating
(A)
100
200
400
1. Terminal shrouds
AD
C
Terminal
shrouds
Switch body
Unit
AC
AD F 3p. F 4p.
in
3.72
10.1
mm
94.6
256
in
3.72
10.1
mm
94.6
256
in
4.92
16
mm
128
406
115
230 290
Switch mounting
J1
3p.
J1
4p.
2.17
4.13
55
2.17
H
107
107
Connection
M
3p.
M
4p.
1.8
6.3
8.7
105
45.6
160
210
135
4.13
1.8
6.3
8.27 5.31 0.35 0.27 1.97 0.98 1,18 0,43 0,14 1,35
210
R1
9
50
25
45.6
160
2.65
75
135
67,5
210
25
65
45
30
11
105
50
30
5.31
195
55
270
2.95
166
135
R2
50
11
13
Y
3.5
AA
CA
6.3
0.6
34.4 160
15
6,3
0,6
3,5
34,4 160
15
0.2
53
260
20
600 A
M
H
Z
J
0.51
13
sirco_107_d_1_x_cat
AC
AA
N1
3.15
80
F
Terminal
shrouds
Rating (A)
600
Switch body
Switch mounting
Connection
Unit
AC
F 3p.
F 4p.
J 3p.
J 4p.
M 3p.
M 4p.
N1
AA
in
18.12
11
14.17
5.5
6.59
10.03
13.19
6.88
2.34
12.6
1.85
mm
460
280
360
140
127.5
167.5
255
335
175
59.5
320
47
155
SIRCO UL98
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
100 to 1200 A
1.57
40
J
0.78 0.78
20 20
Z
0.43
11
8.85
225
sirco_228_d_1_x_cat
N2
AC
N1
4.72
120
F
Terminal shrouds
1 000
1 200
Connection
F 3p.
F 4p.
J 3p.
J 4p.
M 3p.
M 4p.
N1
AA
in
18.12
14.64
19.37
5.5
6.83
9.19
13.66
18.38
6.88
2.34
1.10
1.85
mm
460
372
492
140
173.5
233.5
347
467
175
59.5
28
47
in
18.12
14.64
19.37
5.5
6.83
9.19
13.66
18.38
6.88
2.34
1.10
1.85
mm
460
372
492
140
173.5
233.5
347
467
175
59.5
28
47
in
18.12
14.64
19.37
5.5
6.83
9.19
13.66
18.38
6.88
2.34
13
1.85
mm
460
372
492
140
173.5
233.5
347
467
175
59.5
330
47
100 to 400 A
600 to 1200 A
sirco-ul_027_a_1_x_cat
1.79
45.5
5.31
135
1.57
40
3.35
85
Mounting orientation
sirco-ul_028_a_1_x_cat
3/4 pole
156
Switch mounting
AC
sirco_267_b_1_x_cat
800
Switch body
Unit
7.48
190
Rating (A)
SIRCO UL98
Load break switches standards UL and CSA
100 to 1200 A
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S2 type
0
40
90
78
sircm-pv_006_b_1_gb_cat
47
125
28
37
45
600 to 1200 A
Front operation
Direction of operation
S1 type
Load break switches
40
40
0
90
27
47
sircm-ul_007_b_1_gb_cat
Handle type
78
70
28
28
31
37
44
600 to 1200 A
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S4 type
I
37
sircm-ul_006_a_1_gb_cat
28
350
90
78
47
40
60
0.45
11.6
2.8
71.5
600 to 1200 A
2
51
0.63
15.88
2.88
73.15
0.53
13.46
1.94
49.30
1.52
38.8
400 A
1.3
35
1
25
400 A
1.49
38
100 to 200 A
0.40
10.2
300 kcmil
600 kcmil
2 x 350 kcmil
sirco_116_b_1_x_cat
2.87
73
0.25
6.35
sirco-ul_026_a_1_cat
1.19
30.23
1.25
31.75
sirco-ul_010_a_1_x_cat
0.44
11.13
1.8
46
sirco_115_b_1_x_cat
1.12
28.6
3.15
80
2 x 600 kcmil
157
SIRCO DC UL98B
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
from 100 to 2000 A - up to 1000 VDC
Strong points
sirco-ul_004_b_cat
sirco-ul_022_b_cat
Load break
switches
Conformity to standards
Function
SIRCO DC UL98B are manual multipolar
load switches. They break and close
photovoltaic circuits under load conditions
up to 1000 VDC. They comply with NEC Atr.
690 (US National Electrical Code) concerning
photovoltaic installations. They are compliant
for use within solar UPS and enclosures
meeting standard UL1741.
General characteristics
q Patented switching technology.
q Positive break indication.
q Up to 1000 VDC as per characteristics by
UL98B
Junction box
SIRCO
PV
sirco_028_a_1_gb_cat
SIRCO
PV
158
Junction box
SIRCO
PV
SIRCO DC UL98B
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
from 100 to 2000 A - up to 1000 VDC
References
3/4-pole load break switches
Rating (A)
Rated voltage
(VDC)
No. of poles
Switch body
600
3P
27DC 3011
100 A
250 A
1000
4P
27DC 4011
600
3P
27DC 3021
1000
27DC 4021
4P
Direct operation
handle
External operation
S2 type
Black
1, 3R, 12
1 piece
142G 2111(1)
600
3P
27DC 3041
1000
4P
27DC 4041
600
3P
27PV 3060
S3 type
Black 4, 4X
1000
4P
27PV 4060
Red/Yellow 4, 4X
Red/Yellow
4, 4X
143E 3111(1)
800 A
1200 A
1600 A
2000 A
750
3P
1000
4P
750
3P
27DC 3081
27DC 4081
27DC 3121
1000
4P
27DC 4121
750
3P
1000
4P
750
3P
1000
4P
27DC 3162
27DC 4162
27DC 3201
27DC 4201
(250A)
400 mm
15.7 inches
2709 0041
200 mm
7.9 inches
2709 0061
1 piece
1 piece
1401 1520
320 mm
12.6 inches
S4 type
Black
4, 4X
2799 7012
2709 0025
1400 1040(2)
143D 3111(1)
Black
2 pieces
2x
1400 1032
Black
4, 4X
142E 2111(1)
600 A
(100 to 200A)
320 mm
12.6 inches
142D 2111(1)
400 A
2709 0021
1400 1020
Red/Yellow
1, 3R, 12
Black
200 mm
7.9 inches
142F 2111(1)
2699 5052
1 piece
2709 0081
1401 1532
400 mm
15.7 Inches
144D 3111(1)
1 piece
Red/Yellow
4, 4X
1401 1540(2)
V1 type
Black 3R, 12
320 mm
12.6 inches
2 pieces
2x
2799 7145
4199 3018
2709 0121
2709 0121
144E 3111(1)
2799 7062
Accessories
Example
The locking function of the enclosure in
the "ON" position will force the operator to
safely disconnect and isolate the solar cell
strings prior to any intervention. Opening the
door when the switch is on "ON" position is
possible by defeating the locking function
using a tool (authorized persons only).The
interlocking function is restored when the
door is closed back.
acces_236_a_2_cat
Use
The door interlocked external operation handle
includes a padlockable handle, a conversion kit
and must be combined with a shaft extension.
In a combiner box, located close to the solar
cell strings, or located close to the inverter, we
recommend to use a door interlocked external
handle for its safety features.
acces_150_a_1_cat
External operation
S2 type handle
100 400
100 400
100 400
100 400
600
600
800 1200
800 1200
1600 2000
S2 type
S2 type
S2 type
S2 type
S3 type
S3 type
S4 type
S4 type
V1 type
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
Nema degree of
protection
1, 3R, 12
1, 3R, 12
4, 4X
4, 4X
4.4X
4.4X
4, 4X
4, 4X
1, 3R, 12
Reference
142F 2111(1)
142G 2111(1)
142D 2111(1)
142E 2111(1)
143D 3111(1)
143E 3111
144D 3111(1)
144E 3111(1)
2799 7145
Defeatable handle.
(1)
Rating (A)
Handle
Handle colour
100 400
100 400
600
600
800 1200
800 1200
1600 2000
S2 type
S2 type
S3 type
S3 type
S4 type
S4 type
V1 type
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
(2)
Nema degree of
protection
4, 4X
4, 4X
4.4X
4.4X
4.4X
4.4X
1, 3R, 12
Reference
142D 2911(1)(2)
142E 2911(1)(2)
143D 3911(1)(2)
143E 3911(1)(2)
144D 3911(1)(2)
144E 3911(1)(2)
2799 7145
S3 type handle
access_189_a
Handle colour
acces_152_a_2_cat
Handle
acces_166_a_2_cat
(1)
Rating (A)
S4 type handle
V1 type handle
Defeatable handle.
159
SIRCO DC UL98B
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
from 100 to 2000 A - up to 1000 VDC
Accessories (continued)
Dimension
Handle
Y (mm)
295
S2 type
415
S2 type
495
S2 type
203 328 S2 type
203 448 S2 type
203 528 S2 type
221 343 S3 type
221 463 S3 type
221 543 S3 type
221 366 S4 type
221 486 S4 type
221 566 S4 type
508 714 S5, V1 type
508 794 S5, V1 type
Length
(inches)
7.9
12.6
15.7
7.9
12.6
15.7
7.9
12.6
15.7
7.9
12.6
15.7
12.6
15.7
Length
(mm)
200
320
400
200
320
400
200
320
400
200
320
400
320
400
acces_144_b_1_cat
Reference
1400 1020
1400 1032
1400 1040
1400 1020
1400 1032
1400 1040
1401 1520
1401 1532
1401 1540
1401 1520
1401 1532
1401 1540
4199 3018
4199 3019
acces_202_a_1_x_cat
Use
Standard lengths:
- 7.9 in / 200 mm,
- 12.6 in / 320 mm,
- 15.7 in / 400 mm.
acces_369_a_1_cat
Colour
To be ordered
in multiples of
Reference
1, 3R, 12
10
1493 0000
acces_187_a_3_cat
Black
Dimensions
Increases the distance between the handle
grip and the door by 12 mm, for better
handling.
Use
For handles S2, S3 and S4.
Handle
colour
Light grey
Dark grey
Light grey
Dark grey
160
Handle
S2, S3 type
S2, S3 type
S4 type
S4 type
Reference
1401 0001
1401 0011
1401 0031
1401 0041
acces_198_a_3_cat
SIRCO DC UL98B
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
from 100 to 2000 A - up to 1000 VDC
Auxiliary contact
Type
NO/NC
NO/NC
NO/NC
Reference
2799 0021
2799 0022
4159b
Reference
2799 0121
2799 0122
4159b
acces_076_a_1_cat
Electrical characteristics
A300.
Use
Pre-break and signalling of positions 0 and I:
- 1 to 2 NO/NC auxiliary contacts,
- 1 to 2 low level NO/NC auxiliary contacts.
Terminal screen
No. of poles
3P
3P
4P
3P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
Operating principle
top
bottom
top or bottom
top
bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
acces_079_a_1_cat
Use
Top or bottom protection against direct contact with terminals or connection parts.
Reference
2798 3021
2798 8021
2798 4021
2798 3041
2798 8041
2798 4041
2798 3060
2798 4060
2798 3120
2798 4120
2798 6122
2798 8122
Cage terminals
Rating max
(A)
Max. number
Type of
Numbrer and size of cables of connections
cable
per terminal
Quantity
Reference
3954 2020
3954 2025
3954 2040
3954 2041
3954 2060
3954 2060
3954 3060
3954 2060
3954 3060
100 250
1 conductorr (#6-300MCM)
Cu / Al
2 lugs
100 250
2 conductors (#4-2/0)
Cu / Al
2 lugs
400
1 conductor (#2-600MCM)
Cu / Al
2 lugs
400
2 conductors (#6-350MCM)
Cu / Al
2 lugs
600
2 conductors (#2-600MCM)
Cu / Al
2 lugs
800 1200
2 conductors (#2-600MCM)
Cu / Al
2 lugs
800 1200
2 conductors (#2-600MCM)
3(1)
Cu / Al
3 lugs
1600 2000
2 conductors (#2-600MCM)
2(2)
Cu / Al
2 lugs
1600 2000
2 conductors (#2-600MCM)
3(3)
Cu / Al
3 lugs
ul_032_a
Use
Connection of bare copper cables onto the terminals (without lugs).
.OSHNM@KE@MNTSJHSENQQ@SHMFRNESN ENQBNMMDBSHMFRDUDQ@KB@AKDRSNSGDRVHSBG
(1) Order a fan out kit reference 2709 1203 for connecting 3 connectors per terminal (6 in total for the switch).
(2) 2 connectors per terminal with the connection kit 2729 1200.
(3) 3 connectors per terminal with the connection kits 2729 1201 and 2709 1202.
Rating (A)
100
250
400
400
600
800
1200 2000
Reference
2709 0021(1)
2709 0025
2709 0040(2)
2709 0041
2709 0062
2709 0081
2709 0121(3)
(1) from 100 to 200 A: 1 piece per pole in series. For 250 A: 2 pieces per pole in series.
(2) Compact version with radiator (availability to be confirmed).
(3) For 2000 A: 2 units per pole en series.
Connection diagrams:
(1)
Load
+
sirco-ul_012_a_1_gb_cat
Use
The bridging bars will make easy the connection of the poles in
series, allowing the following configurations(1).
161
SIRCO DC UL98B
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
from 100 to 2000 A - up to 1000 VDC
Accessories (continued)
Copper bars connection kits
Use
To allow connection between the two power terminals from a same
pole for 2000 A ratings. (Fig. 1, Fig. 2 and Fig. 3)
Fig. 1
Rating (A)
Figure
Quantity to order
per pole
Number of
terminals
1600 2000
1600 2000
Reference
2729 1200
2729 1202
acces_314_b_1_x_cat
acces_312_b_1_x_cat
Fig. 3
Fig.2
Rating (A)
Figure
Quantity to order
per pole
Number of
terminals
Reference
2729 1201
1600 2000
acces_313_b_1_x_cat
Characteristics
as per standards UL98/CSA22.4#4 and UL98B(6)
Rating (A)
100 A
250 A
400 A
600 A
800 A
1200 A
1600 A
2000 A
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
(4)
(4)
(4)
2000(4)
2000
100
100
250
250
400
400
600
600
800
800
1200
1200
1600
1600
20
A70P100
200
20
A70P100
200
20
LDC
400
20
A6D600R
600
10(1)
10(1)
10(1)
10(1)
10(1)
10(1)
10(1)
#6
300MCM
#6
300MCM
2x#6
600MCM
2x#2
2x 600MCM
10 000
88.5/10
10 000
88.5/10
6 000
128.3/14.5
6 000
327.5/37
495.7/56
663.9/75
663.9/75
663.9/75
A300
A300
A300
A300
A300
A300
A300
A300
160 A
1 200
12
250 A
1 200
12
630 A
1 200
12
800 A
1 200
12
1000 A
12
1400 A
12
1400 A
12
2200 A
12
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
160
160
250
250
630
630
800
800
10(1)
Connection terminals
Min. connection wire range/ AWG (2)
Max. connection wire range/ AWG (2)
4x#2
4x#2
4x#2
4x#2
6x 600MCM(5) 6x 600MCM(5) 6x 600MCM(5) 6x 600MCM(5)
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
Operating effort (lbs.in/Nm)
Auxiliary contact
Electrical characteristics
162
SIRCO DC UL98B
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
from 100 to 2000 A - up to 1000 VDC
Dimensions (in/mm)
100 to 400 A
M
J1
Z
Y
sirco-ul_011_a_1_x_cat
AA
AC
CA
R1
R2
AD
Rating (A)
Measurement
1. Terminal shrouds
Overall
dimensions
Terminal
shrouds
AC
AD
Switch body
F
3p.
F
4p.
J1
3p.
Switch mounting
J1
4p.
M
4p.
R1
Connection
R1
AA AC
100 250
in
3.72
10.1
100 250
mm
94.6
256
400
in
4.92
16
4.51 9.05 11.4 6.53 2.95 5.31 2.65 8.26 10.6 7.6 0.35 0.27 2.56 1.77 1.97 0.43 0.2 2.08 10.2 0.8
400
mm
128
406
115
55
75
1.8
M
3p.
6.3 8.27 5.31 0.35 0.27 1.97 0.98 1.18 0.43 0.14 1.35 6.3 0.6
9
9
7
7
50
25
65
45
30
50
11
13
53
260 20
600 A
M
AD
1
Z
Y
AC
sirco-ul_005_c_1_x_cat
AA
CA
1. Terminal screens.
Rating (A)
Measurement
Terminal
shrouds
Switch body
Switch mounting
Connection
AC
AD
J 4p.
M 3p.
M 4p.
600
in
18.12
5.5
11.02 14.17
6.59
2.34
10.04
13.19
6.88
3.15
1.97
2.38
0.41
0.28
600
mm
460
140
59.5
255
335
175
80
50
60.5
10.5
280
AA
AC
321
20.9
163
SIRCO DC UL98B
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
from 100 to 2000 A - up to 1000 VDC
M
=
0.41
10.5
Z
=
X1
Rating (A)
I
T
F
7.87 / 200
8.90 / 226
X2
0.82
21
1.49
38
13 / 330
= =
1.02
26
0.35
9
Switch body
1.49 1.02
38
26
sirco-ul_040_b_1_x_cat
90
1.10
28
23.78 / 604
AA
= 0.28 / 7 =
3.54
90
1.02 / 26
Switch mounting
Connection
F 3p.
F 4p.
M 3p.
M 4p.
X1
X1
AA
800 1200
393
513
347
467
120
90
44
53.5
53.5
107.5
288
800 1200
15.47
20.20
13.66
18.39
4.72
3.54
1.73
0.31
2.11
2.11
4.23
11.34
1600 to 2000 A
0.82
21
1.49
38
13.5
343
11.65
296
4.24
107
1.02
26
1.49
38
1.02
26
svr-ul_004_b_x_cat
0.41
10.5
2.02
51.5
11.85
301
9.84
250
11.34
288
4.92
125
11.85
301
3.54
90
15.31
389
164
SIRCO DC UL98B
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
from 100 to 2000 A - up to 1000 VDC
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S2 type
0
40
90
78
47
125
poign_013_a_1_gb_cat
28
37
45
600 A
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
Door drilling
I
90
S3 type
37
40
0
210
poign_035_a_1_gb_cat
78
47
28
61
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S4 type
78
poign_036_a_1_gb_cat
28
350
90
37
47
40
60
1200 to 2000 A
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
Door drilling
V1 type
50
31
poign_037_a_1_ca_cat
50
545
4 6,5
122
165
SIRCO DC UL98B
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
from 100 to 2000 A - up to 1000 VDC
Jumpers (in/mm)
100 to 250 A
400 A
0.16
4
0.75
19
sirco-ul_008_a_1_x_cat
0.43
11
sirco-ul_009_a_1_x_cat
0.49
12.5
3.19
81
1.97
50
0.47 0.59
12
15
0.49
12.5
0.89
22.5
600 A
2.56
65
0.89
22.5
0.2
5
800 A
0.98
25
3.15
80
0.55
14
0.98
25
0.41
10.5
1.02
26
8.27
210
1.49
38
0.315
8
1.69
43
sirco-ul_048_b_1_x_cat
0.2
5
sirco-ul_047_a_1_x_cat
3.94
100
3.44
87.5
0.43
11
sirco-ul_049_b_1_x_cat
4.82
122.5
1200 to 2000 A
0.41
10.5
1.02
26
166
8.27
210
1.49
38
0.315
8
2.8
71
SIRCO DC UL98B
Load break switches for photovoltaic applications
from 100 to 2000 A - up to 1000 VDC
Mounting orientation
sirco-ul_028_a_1_x_cat
3/4 poles
0.27
7
2.8
71.5
2/0
400 A
1.8
46
sirco-ul_038_a_1_x_cat
0.2
5
0.79
20
1.26
32
sirco_115_b_1_x_cat
1.12
28.6
300MCM
0.4
4.7
1.3
35
1
25
1.476
0.63 37.5
16
0.45
11.6
1.52
38.8
400 A
0.63
15.88
sirco-ul_010_a_1_x_cat
100 to 250 A
0.44
11.13
100 to 250 A
600MCM
600 to 2000 A
1.49
38
2.88
73.15
0.53
13.46
1.94
49.30
2
51
0.40
10.2
3.15
80
2 x 350MCM
sirco_116_b_1_x_cat
2.87
73
sirco-ul_026_b_1_cat
0.25
6.35
1.25
31.75
1.19
30.23
2 x 600MCM
167
SIRCO DC
Double Stacker UL98B
Load break switches for solar applications
Strong points
sirco-ul_023_a_1_cat
sirco-pv_026_a
Load break
switches
Function
It is possible to operate on load two switches
with one handle.
Space saving: the overall footprint is similar to
the footprint of a standard 3 or 4 pole device.
Thus providing significant space saving
opportunities within the overall assembly
and specifically compared to using separate
switches.
General characteristics
q Patended switching technology.
q Positive break indication.
q Up to 1000 VDC according to
UL98B/CSA C22.2#4.
168
Conformity to standards
SIRCO DC
Double Stacker UL98B
Load break switches for solar applications
sirco-ul_044_a_1_gb_cat
Switch 2
- +
LOAD /
CHARG
CARGA E /
q The double stack disconnect from SOCOMEC interlocks mechanically 2 disconnects 3 or 4 poles.
With one handle the user can operate on load both disconnects synchronously.
q Each disconnect are fully rated.
q Disconnect two 600VDC networks on load with a 6 poles double stacked disconnect or two
1000VDC networks with a 8 poles.
q Perfect product for BIPOLAR SYSTEMS. The user can disconnect on the same device two legs with
opposite polarities.
+/- 600VDC on a 6 poles disconnect to get a 1200VDC bipolar network.
+/- 1000VDC on a 8 poles disconnect to get a 2000VDC bipolar network.
sirco-ul_045_a_1_gb_cat
Switch 2
- +
LOAD /
CHARG
q As both disconnects are operating synchronously the user can link the output of each device.
q Following the Kirchhoffs law "At any node (junction) in an electrical circuit, the sum of currents
flowing into that node is equal to the sum of currents flowing out of that node" or in our case
Iswitch1 + Iswitch2 = Ioutput.
q R@MDW@LOKD@TRDQBNTKCCHRBNMMDBS VHSG@CNTAKD
q This solution really reduces the footprint of the disconnect.
E / CAR
GA
Switch 2
sirco-ul_046_a_1_gb_cat
Switch 1+2
- +
+
LOAD /
CHARG
E / CAR
GA
q Following the second Kirchhoffs law "The principle of conservation of energy implies that the
directed sum of the electrical potential differences (voltage) around any closed network is zero".
q On the schematic above this would mean that Vswitch1 + Vswitch2 = Vtotal.
q And this implies that more poles are in series, higher is the achievable voltage.
q Following this principle SOCOMEC created a disconnect with 8 poles in series which allows
SGDTRDQSNCHRBNMMDBS.-+. #5#"
q RUNKS@FDRGHFGDQSG@M5#"@QDMNSQDBNFMHYDCAX4+2.".,$"RDKEBDQSHEHDCSGHR
configuration in its laboratory in France.
169
SIRCO DC
Double Stacker UL98B
Load break switches for solar applications
References
6 & 8 poles switches
Rating (A)
Max Number
of circuits Max Breaking Voltage (VDC)
2
2 x 600 VDC
No. of
poles
Switch body
External handle
6P
27DC 6011
S2 type
Black
1, 3R, 12
200 mm
7.9 inches
100 A
Frame 2x4
142F 2111(1)
2
8P
27DC 8011
Red/Yellow
1, 3R, 12
142G 2111(1)
2
2 x 600 VDC
6P
27DC 6021
8P
27DC 8021
2 x 600 VDC
6P
27DC 6041
8P
27DC 8041
2 x 600 VDC
6P
27PV 6060
(100 to 200 A)
320 mm
12.6 inches
400 mm /
15.7 inches
2 pieces
2 x 2709 0021
Red/Yellow
4, 4X
1400 1040(2)
S3 type
Black 4, 4X
200 mm
7.9 inches
143D 3111
1401 1520
1 piece
Red/Yellow
4, 4X
320 mm
12.6 inches
2709 0041
142E 2111(1)
(1)
400 A
Frame 2x5
1 piece
2709 0021
1400 1032
Black
4, 4X
142D 2111(1)
250 A
Frame 2x4
1400 1020
143E 3111(1)
(250 A)
1401 1532
600 A
Frame 2x6
1 piece
2709 0061
2
8P
27PV 6060
2 x 750 VDC
6P
27DC 6080
800 A
Frame 2x7
2
8P
27DC 8080
2 x 750 VDC
6P
27DC 6100
1000 A
Frame 2x7
V1 type
Black
1,3R,12
2799 7145
320 mm
12.6 inches
4199 3018
1 piece
2709
1 piece
2709 0121
2
8P
27DC 8100
Accessories
S type handle Raiser
Colour
Black
170
Dimensions
Adds 12 mm to the depth.
To be ordered
in multiples of
Reference
1, 3R, 12
10
1493 0000
acces_187_a_3_cat
Use
S type handle raiser.
Handle raiser for S1 to S4 handles.
SIRCO DC
Double Stacker UL98B
Load break switches for solar applications
Accessories
Handle
S2 type
S2 type
S2 type
S2 type
S3 type
S3 type
S5 Type
V1 type
Handle colour
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
Black
Nema degree of
protection
1, 3R, 12
1, 3R, 12
4, 4X
4, 4X
4, 4X
4, 4X
1, 3R, 12
1, 3R, 12
142F 2111(1)
142G 2111(1)
142D 2111(1)
142E 2111(1)
143D 3111(1)
143E 3111(1)
145F 8113(1)
2799 7145(1)
Nema degree of
protection
4, 4X
4, 4X
4,4X
4,4X
1, 3R, 12
142D 2911(1)(2)
142E 2911(1)(2)
143D 3911(1)(2)
143E 3911(1)(2)
2799 7145(1)
acces_236_a_2_cat
acces_150_a_1_cat
Use
The interlocking function of the front
external handle prevents the user from
opening the door of the enclosure when the
switch is in the "ON" position (if the handle
is door mounted S-type handles only).
S2 type handle
Reference
acces_166_a_2_cat
External handle
S3 type handle
Reference
acces_286_a_2_cat
Handle
S2 type
S2 type
S3 type
S3 type
V1 type
acces_152_a_2_cat
Rating (A)
100 250
100 250
400
400
600 1000
S4 type handle
S5 type handle
To be ordered
by multiples of
Light grey
S1 to S3 type
50
Dark grey
S1 to S3 type
50
Light grey
S4 type
50
Dark grey
S4 type
50
acces_198_a_3_cat
Handle
colour
1401 0001
1401 0011
1401 0031
1401 0041
Length
(inches)
7.9
12.6
15.7
7.9
12.6
15.7
12.6
15.7
Length
(mm)
200
320
400
200
320
400
320
400
acces_144_b_1_cat
Reference
1400 1020
1400 1032
1400 1040
1401 1520
1401 1532
1401 1540
4199 3018
4199 3019
acces_202_a_1_x_cat
Use
Standard lengths:
- 7.9 in / 200 mm,
- 12.6 in / 320 mm,
- 15.7 in / 400 mm.
acces_369_a_1_cat
171
SIRCO DC
Double Stacker UL98B
Load break switches for solar applications
Accessories (continued)
Shaft guide for external handle
Use
To guide the detachable external control shaft in the handle.
This accessory enables handle to engage shaft with a misalignment of up to 15 mm.
Required for a shaft lenght over 320 mm.
Description
Reference
1429 0000
Auxiliary contact
Use
Pre-break and signalling of positions 0 and I:
- 1 to 2 NO/NC auxiliary contacts,
- 1 to 2 low level NO/NC auxiliary contacts.
Electrical characteristics
A300.
Rating (A)
Position AC
Type
Reference
NO/NC
4159 0021
Position AC
Type
Reference
1st contact
NO/NC
4159 0022
100 1000
acces_076_a_1_cat
Terminal screen
Use
Top or bottom protection against direct contact with terminals or connection parts.
No. of poles
6P
8P
6P
8P
6P
8P
6P
8P
Position
top and bottom
top and bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
top or bottom
Reference
4158 3021
4158 4021
4158 3041(1)
4158 4041(1)
1609 3063(1)
1609 4063(1)
2798 6120
2798 8120
acces_079_a_1_cat
Terminal lugs
Use
Connection of bare copper cables onto the terminals (without lugs).
Type of luge
1 conductor (#6-300MCM)
2 conductors (#4-2/0)
1 conductor (#2-600MCM)
2 conductors (#6-350MCM)
2 conductors (#2-600MCM)
2 conductors (#2-600MCM)
2 conductors (#2-600MCM)
Number of lugs
per terminal
1
1
1
1
1
2(1)
3(2)
Type of
cable
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Package
2 lugs
2 lugs
2 lugs
2 lugs
2 lugs
2 lugs
3 lugs
Reference
3954 2020
3954 2025
3954 2040
3954 2041
3954 2060
3954 2060
3954 3060
ul_032_a
(2) 3 lugs per terminal with connection kits 2729 1201 and 2709 1202.
Rating (A)
Nb lug capacity
Reference
800...1000 Fig. 2
2729 1200
2729 1202
Nb lug capacity
Reference
2729 1201
172
Fig. 3
Fig. 2
acces_314_b_1_x_cat
800...1000 Fig. 1
acces_312_b_1_x_cat
Fig. 1
acces_313_b_1_x_cat
Use
3N@KKNVBNMMDBSHNMADSVDDMSGDSVNONVDQSDQLHM@KREQNL@R@LDONKDENQSN
ratings (Fig. 1, Fig. 2 and Fig. 3).
SIRCO DC
Double Stacker UL98B
Load break switches for solar applications
sirco-ul_012_a_1_gb_cat
Use
The jumpers will make easy the connection of the pole in series,
allowing the following configurations(1).
Connection diagrams:
(1) Other connections: refer to mounting instructions.
Rating (A)
Reference
100 250
2709 0021(1)
2709 0040
2709 0041
2709 0062
2709 0081
Load
(1) For 100 to 200 A: 1 piece per pole in series. For 250 A: 2 pieces per pole in series.
Characteristics
Characteristics according UL98/CSA22.4#4 and UL98B
Rating (A)
100 A
250 A
400 A
600 A
800 A
1000 A
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
600 VDC
3P
100
250
400
600
800
1000
1000 VDC
4P
100
250
400
600
800
1000
20
20
20
A70P100
A70P100
LDC
200
200
400
10(1)
10(1)
10(1)
10(1)
10(1)
10(1)
Connection terminals
Min. connection section / AWG(2)
#6
#6
2x #6
2x #2
4x #2
4x #2
300MCM
300MCM
600MCM
2x 600
6x 600MCM(4)
6x 600MCM(4)
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
10 000
10 000
6 000
6 000
88.5/10
88.5/10
128.3/14.5
327.5/37
495.7/56
495.7/56
A300
A300
A300
A300
A300
A300
Auxiliary contacts
Electrical characteristics
(1) 50 ms without fuse.
(2) AWG : dimensions of the American cable.
160 A
250 A
630 A
800 A
1000 A
1200 A
1 200
1 200
1 200
1 200
1 200
1 200
12
12
12
12
12
12
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
750 VDC
3P
160
250
630
800
1 000 VDC
4P
160
250
630
800
1 500 VDC
8P
100
250
400
600
800
1000
173
SIRCO DC
Double Stacker UL98B
Load break switches for solar applications
0.98
25
6.37
162
5.21
132.5
1.51
38.5
1.18
30
1.37
35
0.53
13.3
100 to 250 A
2.67
68
5.21
132.5
0.43
11
0.29
7.5
6.30
160
5.31
1.35
0.35
9
5.21
132.5
5.21
132.5
sirco-ul_042_b_1_x_cat
0.27
7
1.97
50
9.60 (3P) - 11.57 (4P)
244 (3P) - 294 (4P)
6.93
176
400 A
Z1
T
CA
U
W
R1
AC
BA
AA
sirco-ul_016_a_1_x_cat
R2
X
M
AD
C
K
1. Terminal shrouds.
A. S2 type handle.
Overall
dimensions
Rating
(A)
Mesurement
C
174
400
in
10.39
400
mm
264
Terminal
shrouds
AC
AD
15.75 9.72
400
247
Case
Switch mounting
11.97
244
304
270
195
R1
0.35
9
Connection
R2
Z1
AA
BA
AC
0.27 2.56 1.77 1.97 0.50 0.43 0.20 2.07 7.48 10.24 8.66 0.79
7
65
45
50
12.7 11
52.6
190
260 220
20
SIRCO DC
Double Stacker UL98B
Load break switches for solar applications
600 A
15.19 (3P) - 18.34 (4P)
386 (3P) - 466 (4P)
13.66
347
13.38
340
9.84
250
1.96
50
4.92
125
9.09
231
0.98
25
1.12 0.82
28.5 21
sirco-ul_017_a_1_x_cat
9.09
231
9.05
230
3.15
80
2.02
51.5
2.61
66.5
9.98
253.5
14.56
370
0.41
10.5
800 to 1000 A
0.41
10.5
13.5
343
1.49
38
0.82
21
2.02
51.5
11.65
296
1.02
26
1.49
38
4.24
107
1.02
26
4.92
125
11.85
301
11.34
288
9.84
250
sirco-ul_043_b_1_x_cat
11.85
301
3.54
90
15.31
389
175
SIRCO DC
Double Stacker UL98B
Load break switches for solar applications
0.75
19
3.19
81
0.89
22.5
2.56
65
0.43
11
0.2
5
0.2
5
4.82
122.5
1000 A
3.44
87.5
800 A
0.89
22.5
0.98
25
0.55
14
sirco-ul_009_a_1_x_cat
0.43
11
1.02
26
1.49
38
8.27
210
0.315
8
0.41
10.5
sirco-ul_049_b_1_x_cat
0.41
10.5
sirco-ul_048_b_1_x_cat
3.15
80
0.98
25
0.16
4
3.94
100
0.49
12.5
600 A
sirco-ul_047_a_1_x_cat
1.97
50
0.47 0.59
12
15
sirco-ul_008_a_1_x_cat
0.49
12.5
400 A
1.69
43
1.02
26
8.27
210
1.49
38
0.315
8
2.8
71
1.49
38
2 x 350MCM
sirco-ul_029_a_1_x_cat
2.87
73
3.15
80
sirco-ul_030_a_1_x_cat
2x 600MCM
176
1.8
46
Mounting orientation
0.40
10.2
1.25
31.75
sirco-ul_010_a_1_x_cat
600 to 1000 A
0.53
13.46
1.19
30.23
0.63
15.88
600MCM
2.88
73.15
0.25
6.35
2.8
71.5
2/0
sirco_116_b_1_x_cat
sirco-ul_026_b_1_cat
0.79
20
0.2
5
1.94
49.30
2
51
0.27
7
1.26
32
400 A
sirco-ul_038_a_1_x_cat
1.12
28.6
sirco_115_b_1_x_cat
300MCM
0.4
4.7
1.3
35
1
25
1.476
0.63 37.5
16
0.45
11.6
1.52
38.8
400 A
0.44
11.13
100 to 250 A
SIRCO DC
Double Stacker UL98B
Load break switches for solar applications
Direction of operation
S2 type
Door drilling
I
1.46
37
1.57
40
4.92
125
sirco-ul_032_a_1_gb_cat
90
3.07
78
1.77
45
1.10
28
4 0.27
47
400 A
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
Door drilling
I
90
S3 type
78
37
poign_035_a_1_gb_cat
210
40
47
28
61
600 to 1000 A
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
Door drilling
1.97
50
V1 type
4 0.25
4 6.5
1.97
50
poign_037_a_1_us_cat
21.46
545
1.22
31
4.80
122
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S5 type
1.97
50
with V Escutcheon
poign_020_a_1_us_cat
4 0.25
4 6.50
1.97
50
19.6
498
90
1.22
31
2.80
71
4
102
177
Load break
switches
Conformity to standards(1)
sirco_123_a_2_cat
> UL508,
Guide NRNT,
File E224992
> IEC 60947-3
(1) Product reference on request.
SIRCO
3 pole
Function
The TVSS Surge Switch is an extremely compact, high performance, manually operated,
non-fused switch. It is specifically designed to withstand the high surge current of 200 kA
VHSG@MWRV@UDENQLRDDMHMSNC@XRSQ@MRHDMSUNKS@FD2TQFD/QNSDBSHUD#DUHBD2/#
applications. Socomec Surge Switch uses a unique contact design that actually clamp contacts
tighter during a surge.
General characteristics
q J RRGNBJV@UDVHSGRS@MC
q Rated 100 A 600 VAC UL508 general use.
q High electrical and mechanical endurance.
L1
L2
L3
L4
sirco-ul_021_a_1_x_cat
Surge switch
178
TVSS
Customised solutions
> Please consult us.
References
TVSS SURGE SWITCH - Front operation - 3/4 pole
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Switch body
Direct handle
Terminal shrouds
S1 type
Black
141F 2111
/
2700 3017
R
200 KA
600 VAC
Black
S1 type
Red/Yellow
2699 5042
141G 2111
Red
S1 type
Black
2699 5043
/
200 mm
1400 1020
1400 1032
/
2694 4014(1)
400 mm
141D 2111
2700 4017
/
2694 3014(1)
320 mm
1400 1040
S1 type
Red/Yellow
141E 2111
(1) Top or bottom.
UL characteristics
UL 508 100 A 600 VAC General use
#HLDMRHNMRHMLL
4 pole
3.62
92
3.62
92
3 pole
2.95
75
0.39
10
2.95
75
0.79
20
2.56
65
0.39
10
0.35
9
2.16
5.5
0.39
10
0.1
2.5
4.53
3.35 115
85
2.56
65
1.42
1.1 36
28
5.51
140
2.95
0.79 75
20
1.37
3.5
2.16
5.5
4.52
3.35 115
85
sirco-ul_020_a_1_gb_cat
2.56
65
0.83
21
0.35
9
sirco-ul_019_a_1_gb_cat
1.77
45
0.79
20
0.4
10
0.83
21
1.38
3.5
1.42
0.86 36
22
6.69
170
0.78
20
179
Load break
switches
Despite already offering a wide range of load break switches, SOCOMEC also
manufactures specific products suitable for all your requirements. Some of these
products can be seen on these two pages, however this list does not include them all.
Please, feel free to consult us.
sirco_353_a_1_cat
q 80 kA rms 1 s.
q 110 kA rms 0.1 s.
q 240 kA peak.
Multipolar SIRCO
sirco_256_a_1_cat
12 pole SIRCO.
sider_078_a_1_cat
180
Conformity to standards
>
>
>
>
>
IEC 60947-3
BS EN 60947-3
EN 60947-3
NBN EN 60947-3
VDE 0660-107 (1992)
sirco_338_a_1_x_cat
sirco_363_a_2_cat
q
q
q
q
atysm_213_a_1_cat
Function
SIRCO MOT AT M are 40 to 160 A motorised load
break switches that can be remotely operated via a
volt-free contact. They make and break under load
and provide safety isolation.
References
Rating (A)
No. of poles
4P
40
63
80
100
125
160
Power supply
voltage
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
230 VAC
1923 4004
1923 4006
1923 4008
1923 4010
1923 4012
1923 4016
sirco_310_b
Function
SIRCO MOT AT are 125 to 3200 A motorised load
break switches that can be remotely operated via a
volt-free contact. They make and break under load
and provide safety isolation.
References
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Power supply
voltage
3P
230 VAC
4P
230 VAC
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Power supply
voltage
3P
230 VAC
4P
230 VAC
125
160
250
400
630
800
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
1915 3012
1915 4012
1915 3016
1915 4016
1915 3025
1915 4025
1915 3040
1915 4040
1915 3063
1915 4063
1915 3080
1915 4080
1000
1250
1600
2000
2500
3200
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
1915 3100
1915 4100
1915 3120
1915 4120
1915 3160
1915 4160
1915 3200
1915 4200
1915 3250
1915 4250
1915 3320
1915 4320
181
Fuse protection
p. 184
p. 185
Selection guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
p. 186
FUSERBLOC
Plug-in range
FUSERBLOC
FUSERBLOC
BS88
20 to 1250 A
p. 188
NFC/DIN
25 to 1250 A
p. 188
FUSERBLOC
UR fuses
FUSERBLOC
UL
50 to 1250 A
p. 224
30 to 800 A
p. 248
160 to 400 A
Contact us
FUSOMAT
FUSOMAT
SIDERMAT
combination
250 to 1250 A
p. 238
1600 to 1800 A
p. 230
Fuses
Distribution protection
Semiconductor protection
BS88
NFC/DIN
gG fuses
gG fuses
UR fuses
2 to 1250 A
p. 272
0.16 to 1250 A
p. 278
10 to 2000 A
p. 224
BS88
NFC/DIN
gM fuses
aM fuses
2 to 1250 A
p. 272
0.16 to 1250 A
p. 278
Motor protection
Fuse bases
new
Fuse base
RM - RMS
160 to 2500 A
p. 266
p. 604
p. 262
6SHFLFSURGXFWV
6DVHKKGDKOXNTjMCSGD
right solution for your
application.
Photovoltaic applications
new
n ew
n ew
gPV Fuses
RM PV
PV Fuse bases
p. 298
p. 304
p. 306
183
Fuse protection
q Simplified discrimination
Fuses allow total discrimination, regardless
of the short circuit level. This is ensured as
soon as the ratio of ratings between the
upstream and downstream fuse is at least
1:6. This characteristic guarantees perfect
continuity of the energy supplied
(see an example in fig. 2).
q Visible breaking
When eliminating a short circuit, the energy
generated is absorbed by the silica and
remains confined in the body of the fuse,
stopping the propagation of the arc or even
the projection of white-hot materials.
Circuit breaker
Fuse
High speed fuses (UR)
fuser_489_c_gb
kA
Useful information
q"NMSQNKKDCAXSGD'5+5SQ@MRENQLDQ
sensor, the fuse breaker switches
with tripping function are the best
way of ensuring its general breaking
and protection functions.
q/QNSDBSHNMVHSGGHFGRODDC41
fuses is the only way to effectively
protect the semiconductors used in
electronic equipment (variable speed
drives, etc.) against short circuits.
Photovoltaic applications
SOCOMEC provides solutions based
on fuse disconnects or fuse breaker
switches.
Please consult us.
ms
fuser_641_b
Mini x 1.6
Time (s)
Current
Fig. 2 : Example of total discrimination
184
appli_563_a
160 A
fuser_493_c_gb
100 A
With over 90 years' experience, SOCOMEC offers a range of switches and components for
building a complete fuse protection solution. Our partnership also brings you additional benefits:
High-quality
products
SOCOMEC is renowned among its customers
for the reliability of its fuse solutions.
Customised
solutions
Are your requirements outside
of the standard offering? As a specialist
manufacturer, we can adapt our devices to
suit your specific requirements. Get in touch
with us or your usual contact to discuss your
options.
sgys_076_a_1_cat
A wide
range
Whatever your area of activity (industry,
data centre, photovoltaics, etc.), you'll find
the solution to your electrical protection
requirements in this product family.
resys_081_a
A responsive commercial
network
Our teams of engineers have built their
reputation on a reassuring closeness,
specialist expertise and a commitment to
listening.
Additional products
flcd-url_051_a
We're certain you'll find the answers to your questions about electrical protection on the Profuse
International website: www.profuseinternational.com
The site includes a detailed presentation of the customer benefits of fuse technology:
q4RDQR@EDSX
q1DKH@AKDHMRS@KK@SHNMR
q"NRSR@UHMFR
q$MUHQNMLDMS@KKXEQHDMCKXRNKTSHNM
INTERNATIONAL
185
Selection guide
Fuse protection
Fuse protection
Which
application?
Which type of
operation?
Industry
new
FUSERBLOC
BS88
NFC/DIN
20 to 1250 A
p. 188
FUSERBLOC
UL
30 to 800 A
p. 248
SIDERMAT
combination &
FUSOMAT
250 to 1800 A
p. 230 - 238
RM - RMS
Fuse bases
Industrial fuses
BS88
Industrial fuses
NFC/DIN
32 to 100 A
p. 262
160 to 2500 A
p. 266
0,16 to 1250 A
p. 272
2 to 1250 A
p. 278
Applications
Transformer output
Distribution panels
Main switchboards
Cable ducting
Motor circuits
Semiconductor protection
Photovoltaic installations
Operation
Manual
Trippable
Side
XSWRb$
XSWRb$
XSWRb$
Panel mounting
Right side
XSWRb$
Left side
Centred operation
Please consult us
Please consult us
Indication of breaking
Positive break indication
Visible contacts
Fuse
NFC/DIN
BS
UL
Other
186
Selection guide
Fuse protection
Positive break
indication or
visible breaking?
Which handle
location?
Which type of
fuse?
Power electronics
(variable speed drives, inverters)
Photovoltaic
n ew
FUSERBLOC
UR
new
new
UR fuses
gPV Fuses
RM PV
PV Fuse bases
50 to 1250 A
p. 224
p. 288
p. 298
32 to 50 A
p. 304
32 to 600 A
p. 306
gPV
gPV
gPV
187
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
Fuse protection
fuser_548_a_1_cat
FUSERBLOC
630 to 1250 A
Strong points
fuser_539_a_1_cat
fuser_532_a_1_cat
A complete range.
> Centred or left side
operation, rear connections,
plug-in connections.
Please consult us.
FUSERBLOC
32 to 400 A
FUSERBLOC
20 to 32 A
Function
FUSERBLOC are manually operated multipolar fuse combination switches. They make and
break on load and provide safety isolation and protection against overcurrent for any low
voltage electrical circuit.
Advantages
Improved safety
q Complete isolation of the fuse with double
breaking per pole (top and bottom of fuse).
q Positive break indication.
q IP2X protection with terminal
shrouds front panel.
IEC 60947-3
EN 60947-3
BS EN 60947-3
NBN EN 60947-3
IEC 60269-1
DIN EN 60269-1
NF EN 60269-1
IEC 60269-2
VDE 0636-1
VDE 0660-107
Standards UL: see
FUSERBLOC UL
fuser_552_a
fuser_597_a
188
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
Customised solutions
Multipolar FUSERBLOC
Conformity to standards
Centred operation
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
fuser_704_a_1_cat
fuser-lm_002_a
fuser_702_a_2_cat
fuser_703_a_1_cat
fuser_706_a_2_cat
fuser_705_a_1_cat
189
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
References
BS 88 - External front and side operation - 20 to 160 A
Rating (A)
Fuse size
Frame size
20 A
A1
0
CD 32 A
A1
0
32 A
A1
11
Number of
poles
Reference
Switch I-0
TEST
Changeover
Reference
External
External
Shaft
External
external
Changeover
front
right side
extensions
front handle
front handle
I - 0 - II
handle I-0
handle I -0
for handle
I-0 TEST
I - 0 - II
3P
3641 3000
3680 3000
3 P + switched
neutral
3641 4000
3680 4000
3 P+solid
neutral
3641 5000
Terminal
shrouds(3)
U type
A/C (2)
Integrated
solid
neutral link
320 mm
1401 0532
3P
3641 3001
3680 3001
3 P + switched
neutral
3641 4001
3680 4001
3 P + solid
neutral
3641 5001
1415 2111(1)
1411 2113(1)
2P
3841 2003
3P
3841 3003
3880 3003
Red/Yellow Red/Yellow
S1 type
S1 type
1414 2111
IP65
Red/Yellow
S1 type
IP65
Red/Yellow
S1 type
IP65
1414 2115
1418 2111
1414 2113
4P
3841 6003
3880 6003
2P
3841 2006
3P
3841 3006
3880 3006
4P
3841 6006
3880 6006
2P
3841 2010
3P
3841 3010
3880 3010
4P
3841 6010
3880 6010
Black
S1 type
IP55
Black
S1 type
IP65
Black
S1 type
IP55
Black
S1 type
IP55
Standard
63 A
A2-A3
12
100 A
A4 (4)
13
CD 160 A
A3-A4 (4)
13 A
160 A
B1-B2
14
3999 0702
3829 9310
320 mm
1400 1032
3841 2014
3P
3841 3014
3880 3014
4P
3841 6014
3880 6014
3841 2015
3P
3841 3015
3880 3015
4P
3841 6015
3880 6015
2P
3841 2016
3P
3841 3016
3880 3016
4P
3841 6016
3880 6016
(1) Standard.
(2) 4 auxiliary contacts as standard without additional contact holder.
(3) Top/bottom.
(4) For fuse size A4: max diameter 31 mm.
190
3999 0701
1 contact
NC
2P
2P
160 A
A4
14
1 contact
NO
Black
S2 type
IP55
Black
S2 type
IP65
Red/Yellow
S2 type
IP65
Red/Yellow
S2 type
IP65
1424 2111
1424 2115
Black
S2 type
IP55
1425 2111(1)
Black
S2 type
IP55
1421 2113(1)
2P
3998 2016
3P
3998 3016
Red/Yellow
S2 type
Red/Yellow
IP65
1428 2111
1424 2113
4P
3998 4016
3829 9320
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
CD 200 A
A3-A4 (5)
13 A
200 A
B1-B2
15
250 A
B1-B2-B3
15
Number of
poles
Reference
Switch I-0
2P
3841 2019
3P
3841 3019
3P
3880 3019
2P
3841 2021
3P
3841 3021
3880 3021
4P
3841 6021
3880 6021
2P
3841 2024
3P
3841 3024
2P
U type
A/C (2)
Integrated
solid
neutral link
2P
3841 6019
3841 6024
Terminal
shrouds(3)
3998 2016
4P
4P
315 A
B1-B2-B3
16
TEST
Changeover
Reference
External
External
Shaft
External
external
Changeover
front
right side
extensions
front handle
front handle
I - 0 - II
handle I-0
handle I -0
for handle
I-0 TEST
I - 0 - II
4P
3880 6019
3998 4016
Black
S2 type
IP55
Black
S2 type
IP65
Black
S2 type
IP55
1425 2111(1)
1421 2113(1)
Red/Yellow
S2 type
IP65
Red/Yellow
S2 type
IP65
Red/Yellow
S2 type
IP65
Red/Yellow
S2 type
IP65
1424 2111
1424 2115
1428 2111
1424 2113
3841 2032
3829 9325
Black
S2 type
IP55
3880 3024
3880 6024
3829 9320
3998 3016
320 mm
1400 1032
2P
3998 2025
3P
3998 3025
4P
3998 4025
3P
3841 3032
3880 3032
4P
3841 6032
3880 6032
2P
3841 2038
3P
3841 3038
4P
3841 6038
2P
3821 2063
3P
3821 3063
4P
3821 6063
1433 3111(1)
2P
3821 2080
3P
3821 3080
Red/Yellow
S3 type
IP65
4P
3821 6080
2P
3821 2120
3P
3821 3120
1 contact
NO
3999 0701
3829 9339
400 A
B1-B2B3-B4
16
630 A
C1-C2
17
800 A
C1-C2-C3
17
1250 A
D1
18
4P
3821 6120
1 contact
NC
3999 0702
Black
S3 type
IP65
1434 3111
2P
3898 2080
Black
S3 type
IP65
1437 3111(1)
Red/Yellow
S3 type
IP65
1438 3111
Black
S4 type
IP65
1443 3111(1)
3P
3898 3080
3829 9308
4P
320 mm
3898 4080
1400 1232
3898 2120
3898 3120
3829 9312
3898 4120
(1) Standard.
(2) 4 auxiliary contacts as standard without additional contact holder.
(3) Top/bottom.
(4) 8 AC as standard without support (the support is for 8 additional auxiliary contacts).
(5) For fuse size A4: max diameter 31mm
191
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
References (continued)
BS 88 - Direct operation - 20 to 160 A
Rating (A)
Fuse size
Frame size
20 A
A1
0
CD 32 A
A1
0
32 A
A1
1
63 A
A2-A3
2
100 A
A4 (4)
3
CD 160 A
A3-A4 (4)
3A
Number of
poles
Reference
Side direct
operation
3P
3641 3000
3 P + switched
neutral
3641 4000
3 P + solid
neutral
3641 5000
3P
3641 3001
3 P + switched
neutral
3641 4001
3 P + solid
neutral
3641 5001
Side direct
handle
operation
switch
Direct front
handle
Auxiliary
contacts
Terminal
shrouds(3)
Cage
terminals
Standard
Standard
160 A
B1-B2
4
Black
3629 4012
3999 0001(1)
2 contacts
NO/NC
A-type
3999 0002(1)
2P
3625 2003
consult us
3P
3625 3003
consult us
4P
3625 6003
consult us
2P
3625 2006
consult us
3P
3625 3006
consult us
4P
3625 6006
consult us
2P
3625 2010
consult us
3P
3625 3010
consult us
4P
3625 6010
consult us
3999 0021(1)
2P
3625 2014
consult us
3P
3625 3014
consult us
2 contacts
NO/NC
A-type
4P
3625 6014
consult us
2P
3625 2015
consult us
3P
3625 3015
consult us
4P
3625 6015
consult us
2P
3625 2016
consult us
3P
3625 3016
consult us
4P
3625 6016
consult us
Handle key
interlocking
accessories(2)
1 contact
NO/NC
A-type
Black
3629 7903
3629 7900
1 contact
NO/NC
A-type
3999 0022(1)
2P
3998 2016
3P
Black
3P
5400 3016
3629 7901
3998 3016
4P
4P
5400 4016
3998 4016
160 A
A4
4
192
Reference
Direct front
operation
3629 7913
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
Number of
poles
Reference
Side direct
operation
Reference
Direct front
operation
2P
3625 2019
consult us
3P
3625 3019
consult us
4P
3625 6019
consult us
2P
3625 2021
consult us
3P
3625 3021
consult us
4P
3625 6021
consult us
2P
3625 2024
consult us
3P
3625 3024
consult us
4P
3625 6024
consult us
2P
3625 2032
consult us
3P
3625 3032
consult us
4P
3625 6032
consult us
2P
3625 2039
consult us
3P
3625 3039
consult us
4P
3625 6039
consult us
Side direct
handle
operation
switch
Direct front
handle
Auxiliary
contacts
Terminal
shrouds(3)
Cage
terminals
Handle key
interlocking
accessories(2)
2P
1 contact
NO/NC
A-type
3P
3P
5400 3016
3998 3016
4P
4P
5400 4016
3998 4016
3P
3999 0021(1)
Black
3629 7901
3998 2016
5400 3025
consult us
2 contacts
NO/NC
A-type
3999 0022(1)
4P
3629 7913
5400 4025
2P
3998 2025
3P
3998 3025
4P
3998 4025
3P
5400 3040
4P
5400 4040
Number of
poles
630 A
C1-C2
17
2P
800 A
C1-C2-C3
17
2P
1250 A
D1
18
2P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
Reference
Side direct
operation
Reference
Direct front
operation
3821 2063
3821 3063
3821 6063
3821 2080
3821 3080
3821 6080
3821 2120
3821 3120
3821 6120
3821 2063
3821 3063
3821 6063
3821 2080
3821 3080
3821 6080
3821 2120
3821 3120
3821 6120
Side direct
handle
operation
switch
Direct front
handle
Auxiliary
contacts
Terminal
shrouds(3)
3898 2080
Black
1 contact
NO
U-type
3899 6011
Black
3899 7911
Black
3899 7011
3999 0701(1)
1 contact
NC
U-type
3999 0702(1)
Cage
terminals
Handle key
interlocking
accessories(2)
2P
3P
3898 3080
4P
3898 4080
3898 2120
3898 3120
3898 4120
193
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
References
NFC and DIN - External front and right side operation - 25 to 125 A
Rating (A) /
Fuse /
Frame size
25 A
10 x 38
0
CD 32 A
10 x 38
0
32 A
14 x 51
0
50 A
14 x 51
11
63 A
00C
12
100 A
22 x 58
13
125 A
22 x 58
13
No. of poles
Switch
I-0-TEST
Changeover
switch I-0-II
3P
3631 3002(1)
3670 3002
3 P + switched
3631 4002(1)
neutral
3670 4002
3 P + solid
neutral
3631 5002(1)
3P
3631 3003
3670 3003
3 P + switched
neutral
3631 4003
3670 4003
3 P + solid
neutral
3631 5003
3P
3631 3004(1)
3670 3004
3 P + switched
3631 4004(1)
neutral
3670 4004
3 P + solid
neutral
3631 5004(1)
2P
3831 2005
3P
3831 3005(1)
3870 3005
4P
3831 6005(1)
3870 6005
2P
3831 2006
3P
3831 3006(1)
3870 3006
4P
3831 6006(1)
3870 6006
2P
3831 2010
3P
3831 3010(1)
3870 3010
4P
3831 6010(1)
3870 6010
2P
3831 2011
3P
3831 3011
4P
125 A
00
13
3831 6011
TEST
External Changeover Shaft for
external front right side external front external
handle
handle
handle
handle
S1 type
S1 type
Black
IP55
Black
IP65
1411 2111
1413 2115
U-type
1401 0532
Red/Yellow
IP65
S1 type
S1 type
1414 2111
1414 2115
Black
IP55
Black
IP55
1415 2111
1411 2113
Red/Yellow
IP65
Red/Yellow
IP65
1418 2111
1414 2113
S1 type
Black
IP65
Black
IP65
1411 2111
1413 2115
Red/Yellow
IP65
Red/Yellow
IP65
1414 2111
1414 2115
Integrated
Terminal
solid neutral
shrouds(1)
link
320 mm
Red/Yellow
IP65
S1 type
Auxiliary
contacts(2)
1 contact
3999 0710
Standard
U-type
3870 3010
3870 6010
2P
3831 2012
3P
3831 3012
3870 3011
4P
3831 6012
3870 6011
(1) Available enclosed (see page "Enclosed fuse switches" page XXX).
(2) Top/bottom.
(3) Maximum 4 contacts.
194
External
front
handle
320 mm
(2)
1400 1032
S2 type
S2 type
S2 type
S2 type
Black
IP65
Black
IP55
Black
IP55
Black
IP55
1421 2111
1423 2115
14252111
1421 2113
Red/Yellow
IP65
Red/Yellow
IP65
Red/Yellow
IP65
Red/Yellow
IP65
1424 2111
1424 2115
1428 2111
1424 2113
1 contact
3999 0600
2P
3998 2016
3P
3998 3016
4P
3998 4016
3829 9310
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
NFC and DIN - External front and right side operation - 160 to 1250 A
Rating (A) /
Fuse /
Frame size
160 A
00
13
160 A
0
14
250 A
1
15
400 A
2
16
630 A
3
17
800 A
3
17
800 A
4
18
1250 A
4
18
TEST
Changeover
External
external front
switch I-0-II front handle
handle
No. of
poles
Switch I-0
2P
3831 2015
3P
3831 3015
3870 3015
4P
3831 6015
3870 6015
2P
3831 2016
3P
3831 3016(1)
3870 3016
4P
3831 6016(1)
3870 6016
2P
3831 2024
3P
3831 3024(1)
4P
3831 6024(1)
2P
3831 2039
3P
3831 3039(1)
3870 3039
4P
(1)
3870 6039
3831 6039
Changeover
external
front handle
Shaft for
external
handle
Auxiliary
contacts
Terminal
shrouds(2)
U-type
3998 2016
Integrated
solid neutral
link
2P
3P
S2 type
S2 type
S2 type
S2 type
Black
IP55
Black
IP65
Black
IP55
Black
IP55
1421 2111
1423 2115
1425 2111
1421 2113
3870 3024
Red/Yellow
IP65
Red/Yellow
IP65
Red/Yellow
IP65
Red/Yellow
IP65
3870 6024
1424 2111
1424 2115
1428 2111
1424 2113
1 contact
(3)
3999 0600
3998 3016
320 mm
1400 1032
2P
3P
3999 0600
3998 3025
4P
3998 4025
3P
3811 3063(1)
4P
3811 6063(1)
2P
3811 2080
3P
3811 3080
Red/Yellow
IP65
3829 9325
3998 2025
U-type
(4)
3811 2063
3829 9320
4P
3998 4016
1 contact
2P
3829 9339
S3 type
2P
Black
IP65
3898 2080
3P
1433 3111
4P
3811 6080
1434 3111
2P
3811 2081
S4 type
3P
3811 3081
Black
IP65
4P
3811 6081
3811 2120
3P
3811 3120
Red/Yellow
IP65
3811 6120
1444 3111
1443 3111
3898 3080
S3 type
Black
IP65
1437 3111
2P
4P
External
right side
handle
Red/Yellow
IP65
1438 3111
3829 9308
4P
3898 4080
320 mm
1400 1232
2P
3898 2120
3P
3898 3120
3829 9312
4P
3898 4120
195
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
References (continued)
NFC and DIN - Direct operation - 25 to 125 A
Rating (A)
Fuse size
Frame size
25 A
10 x 38
0
CD 32 A
10 x 38
0
32 A
14 x 51
0
50 A
14 x 51
1
63 A
00C
2
100 A
22 x 58
3
125 A
22 x 58
3
125 A
00
3
No. of poles
Direct side
operation
3P
3631 3002
3 P + switched
neutral
3631 4002
3 P + solid
neutral
3631 5002
3P
3631 3003
3 P + switched
neutral
3631 4003
3 P + solid
neutral
3631 5003
3P
3631 3004
3 P + switched
neutral
3631 4004
3 P + solid
neutral
3631 5004
Direct handle
Auxiliary
contacts
Terminal
shrouds
Cage
terminals
2P
3615 2005
consult us
3P
3615 3005
consult us
4P
3615 6005
consult us
2P
3615 2006
consult us
3P
3615 3006
consult us
4P
3615 6006
consult us
2P
3615 2010
consult us
3P
3615 3010
consult us
4P
3615 6010
consult us
2P
3615 2011
consult us
Handle key
interlocking
accessories(6)
A-type
1 contact
NO/NC
Black
3999 0001(3)
(1)(2)
3629 4012
A-type
2 contacts
NO/NC
Standard
3999 0002(3)
Standard
Standard
Black
3629 7903
3629 7900(5)(2)
3999 8906
A-type
1 contact
NO/NC
3999 0021(3)
3P
3615 3011
consult us
4P
3615 6011
consult us
2P
3615 2012
consult us
3P
3615 3012
consult us
4P
3615 6012
consult us
196
Direct front
operation
A-type
2 contacts
NO/NC
3999 0022(3)
Black
3629 7901(5)(2)
2P
3998 2016(4)
3P
3998 3016(4)
4P
3998 4016(4)
3P
5400 3016
3999 8912
4P
5400 4016
3629 7913
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
No. of poles
Direct side
operation
Direct front
operation
2P
3615 2015
consult us
3P
3615 3015
consult us
160 A
00
3
4P
2P
160 A
0
4
3P
3615 6015
3615 2016
3615 3016
Direct handle
Auxiliary
contacts
Terminal
shrouds
Cage terminals
2P
Black
3998 2016(3)
3629 7901(4)(1)
consult us
3P
3998 3016(3)
consult us
A-type
1 contact
NO/NC
consult us
4P
3999 8912
3P
5400 3016
3999 8216
4P
5400 4016
3999 8316
3998 4016(3)
(2)
4P
3615 6016
consult us
3999 0021
2P
3615 2024
consult us
3P
3615 3024
consult us
A-type
2 contacts
NO/NC
Handle key
interlocking
accessories(5)
3999 8416
3629 7913
250 A
1
5
4P
2P
400 A
2
6
3P
4P
3615 6024
3615 2039
3615 3039
3615 6039
Black
3629 7901(4)(1)
consult us
(2)
3999 0022
2P
3998 2025(3)
3999 8225
3P
5400 3025
4P
5400 4025
3P
3998 3025(3)
consult us
4P
3998 4025(3)
consult us
3999 8425
3999 8240
3P
consult us
3999 8325
5400 3040
4P
5400 4040
3999 8340
3999 8440
(1) Standard.
(2) Maximum 2 contacts.
(3) Top/bottom.
630 A
3
17
800 A
3
17
800 A
4
18
1250 A
4
18
No. of poles
2P
3811 2063
3P
3811 3063
4P
3811 6063
2P
3811 2080
3P
3811 3080
4P
3811 6080
2P
3811 2081
3P
3811 3081
4P
3811 6081
2P
3811 2120
3P
3811 3120
4P
3811 6120
Auxiliary contacts
Terminal shrouds
2P
3898 2080(3)
Black
3P
3899 6011(1)(2)
3898 3080(3)
4P
U-type
Black
3899 7911
3898 4080(3)
1 contact NO
3999 0701(4)
1 contact NC
3999 0702(4)
Black
3899 7011(1)(2)
2P
3898 2120(3)
3P
3898 3120(3)
4P
3898 4120(3)
(3) Top/bottom.
(4) Maximum 8 contacts.
197
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
Accessories
Direct operation handle
Frame size
Figure no.
Handle colour
Reference
20 ... 32
Black
20 ... 32
Red
32 ... 400
11 ... 16
Black
17
Black
18
Black
3629 4012
3629 4013
3629 7910
3899 6011
3899 7011
acces_261_a
Rating (A)
acces_147_a_2_cat
Fig. 1
Fig.2
Figure no.
Handle colour
Reference
1/2
Black
36
Black
17 ... 18
Black
3629 7900
3629 7901
1437 7911
Fig. 3
fuser_707_a
Frame size
32 ... 63
acces_148_a_2_cat
Rating (A)
acces_262_a
Fig.4
Fig. 5
Handle
colour
Black
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
Red/Yellow
100 400
100 400
100 400
100 400
100 400
13 16
13 16
13 16
13 16
13 16
S2
S2
S2
S2
S2
630 800
630 800
17
17
800 1250
800 1250
18
18
Operation
External IP(1)
I-0
I-0
I-0
I - 0 - Test
I - 0 - Test
IP55
IP65
IP65
IP65
IP65
Defeatable
handle
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Black
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
Red/Yellow
I-0
I-0
I-0
I - 0 - Test
I - 0 - Test
IP55
IP65
IP65
IP55
IP65
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
1421 2111
1423 2111
1424 2111
1423 2115
1424 2115
S3
S3
Black
Red/Yellow
I-0
I-0
IP65
IP65
Yes
Yes
1433 3111
1434 3111
S4
S4
Black
Red/Yellow
I-0
I-0
IP65
IP65
Yes
Yes
1443 3111
1444 3111
Reference
1411 2111
1413 2111
1414 2111
1413 2115
1414 2115
acces_164_a_2_cat
acces_149_a_2_cat
S1 type handle
S2 type handle
Handle colour
Black
Black
External IP(1)
IP65
IP65
acces_151_a_2_cat
acces_152_a_2_cat
Reference
1413 2311
1423 2311
S4 type handle
S3 type handle
Handle type
Handle colour
External IP(1)
Reference
0/11/12
S1
Black
IP55
CD 25 63
0/11/12
S1
Black
IP65
CD 25 63
0/11/12
S1
Red/Yellow
IP65
1415 2111
1417 2111
1418 2111
100 400
13 16
S2
Black
IP55
100 400
13 16
S2
Black
IP65
100 400
13 16
S2
Red/Yellow
IP65
630 1250
17/18
S3
Black
IP65
630 1250
17/18
S3
Red/Yellow
IP65
1425 2111
1427 2111
1428 2111
S1 type handle
acces_166_a_2_cat
Frame size
CD 25 63
Rating (A)
acces_149_a_2_cat
1437 3111
1438 3111
S3 type handle
198
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
S1
S1
100 400
100 400
13 16
13 16
S2
S2
Black
Red/Yellow
IP65
IP65
Yes
Yes
142D 2911
142E 2911
600 800
600 800
17
17
S3
S3
Black
Red/Yellow
IP65
IP65
Yes
Yes
143D 3911
143E 3911
800 1250
800 1250
18
18
S4
S4
Black
Red/Yellow
IP65
IP65
Yes
Yes
144D 3911
144E 3911
Reference
141D 2911
141E 2911
S2 type handle
acces_235_a_2_cat
IP65
IP65
Defeatable
handle
Yes
Yes
CD 25 63
CD 25 63
acces_236_a_2_cat
External IP(1)
Handle
colour
Black
Red/Yellow
Rating (A)
S3 type handle
Handle colour
To be ordered
in multiples of
External IP(1)
Reference
IP65
1493 0000
Black
acces_187_a_1_cat
Use
Handle colour
Light grey
Dark grey
Light grey
Dark grey
To be ordered
in multiples of
50
50
50
50
Handle
Reference
Type S1, S2
Type S1, S2
S4 type
S4 type
1401 0001
1401 0011
1401 0031
1401 0041
acces_198_a_1_cat
For single lever handles S1, S2, S3 types and double lever handle, S4 type.
Other colours: please consult us.
Rating (A)
CD 25 CD 32
50 400
Frame size
Type
Reference
11 16
1429 7709
1429 7710
fuser_535_a_1_cat
Use
The flat mounting providing compact solution ideally suited to withdrawable applications.
Kit to be used with a handle for flat mounting.
Handle colour
Black
Red/Yellow
Black
Red/Yellow
External IP(1)
IP55
IP65
IP55
IP65
Reference
fuser_536_a_1_cat
1411 2111(2)
1414 2111(2)
1421 2111(2)
1424 2111(2)
S2 type handle.
199
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
Accessories (continued)
Front operation shaft support accessory
Use
Rating (A)
Frame size
Reference
50 400
11 16
3899 0400
fuser_698_a_2_cat
This support maintains shaft position for extension shafts greater than 320 mm in length.
Description
Reference
Shaft guide
1429 0000
acces_260_a_2_cat
32 400
32 400
32 400
630 800
630 1250
630 1250
Reference
11 16
11 16
11 16
200
320
500
1400 1020
1400 1032
1400 1050(2)
17
17/18
17/18
200
320
500
1400 1220
1400 1232
1400 1250(1)
1401 0520
1401 0532
1401 0540(1)
acces_369_a_1_cat
Frame size
0
0
0
acces_202_a_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
CD 20 CD 32
CD 20 CD 32
CD 20 CD 32
acces_145_b_1_cat
Standard lengths:
- 200 mm
- 320 mm
- 400 mm
- 500 mm.
CD 20 CD 32
A1
0
102 245
102 365
102 445
32
A1
11
100 230
100 350
63 160
A2-A3/A4
12/13/14
125 230
125 350
CD160 CD200
A3-A4
13 A
150 230
150 350
160 200
B1-B2
14/15
135 230
135 350
250 315
B1-B2-B3
15/16
160 230
160 350
630 800
C1-C2-C3
17
270 304
270 424
1250
D1
18
304 424
100 530
125 530
150 530
135 530
160 530
270 600
304 600
200
CD 25 CD 32
10x38/14x51
0
102 245
102 365
102 445
50
14x51
11
100 230
100 350
100 ... 430
100 530
63
00C
12
125 230
125 350
125 ... 430
125 530
100 160
22x58/00
13
135 230
135 350
135 ... 430
135 530
160
0
14
145 230
145 350
145 ... 430
145 530
250 400
1/2
15/16
160 230
160 350
160 ... 430
160 530
630 800
3
17
270 304
270 424
270 ... 504
270 604
800 1250
4
18
304 ... 424
304 ... 504
304 ... 604
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
CD 25 CD 32
50 400
630 1250
0
11 16
17/18
Handle
type
S
S
S
Reference
acces_203_a_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
1401 0520
1400 1020
1400 1220
Reference
3829 9310
3829 9320
3829 9320
3829 9325
3829 9339
3829 9308
3829 9312
acces_130_a_1_cat
acces_131_a_1_cat
Fixing the solid neutral onto the mechanism produces a device with a solid neutral of
the same size as a standard three-pole device (+ 6 mm).
32
11
32
27
63
12
63
32
100
13
100
36
3629 9227
3629 9232
3629 9236
13 a
200
36
3629 9237
160
14
160
50
200 250
15
250
60
315 400
16
400
66
630 800
17
800
94
1250
18
1250
120
3629 9250
3629 9260
3629 9266
3629 9294
3629 9212
CD 160
CD 200
Reference
acces_199_a_2_cat
Rating (A)
3629 9227
3629 9232
3629 9236
3629 9250
3629 9260
3629 9266
3629 9294
3629 9212
BS88 switches
Rating (A) Frame size Fuse size
32
11
A1
63
12
A2-A3
100
13
A4
CD 160
13a
A3-A4
160
14
A4
160
14
B1-B2
CD 200
13a
A3-A4
200
15
B1-B2
250
15
B1-B2-B3
315
16
B1-B2-B3
400
16
B1-B2-B3-B4
630 800
17
C1-C3
1250
18
D1
Imax (A)
32
63
160
160
160
200
160
200
315
315
400
800
1250
Reference
3629 9003
3629 9006
3629 9010
3629 9010
3629 9010
3629 9016
3629 9010
3629 9016
3629 9025
3629 9025
3629 9040
3629 9063
3629 9120
Imax(A)
50
160
125
160
160
250
400
630
1250
fusib_124_a_2_cat
fusib_123_a_2_cat
Solid links
Reference
6029 0000
6420 0000
6039 0000
6420 0000
6421 0000
6421 0001
6421 0002
6421 0003
6441 0005
201
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
Accessories (continued)
A-type auxiliary contacts
Use
Electrical characteristics
30 000 operations.
NO / NC auxiliary contacts
Rating (A)
Frame size
CD 20 CD 32
0
CD 20 CD 32
0
32 400(1)
16
32 400(1)
16
Contact(s)
1
2
1
2
acces_046_a_1_cat
References
Reference
3999 0001
3999 0002
3999 0021(2)
3999 0022(2)
Rating (A)
acces_047_a_2_cat
Characteristics
Operating current Ie (A)
Current
250 VAC 400 VAC 24 VDC 48 VDC
nominal (A)
AC-13
AC-13
DC-13
DC-13
CD 20 400
16
12
Use
acces_056_a_1_cat
References
NC auxiliary contacts
Rating (A)
Frame size
CD 20 1250
0 18
Contact(s)
1
Reference
Frame size
Contact(s)
Reference
0 18
3999 0701
Reference(1)
3999 0702
NO auxiliary contacts
Rating (A)
CD 20 1250
Frame size
Contact(s)
CD 20 160
0 14
4 (2 x 2 max)
included
250 400
15/16
8 (4 x 2 max)
included
630 1250
17/18
8 (4 x 2 max)
included
Contact(s)
Reference
4 (2 x 2 max)
11 16
4 (2 x 2 max)
3999 0710
3999 0600
CD 20 CD 32
32 400
A
B
Characteristics
Operating current Ie (A)
Rating (A)
CD 20 1250
250 VAC
400 VAC
24 VDC
48 VDC
AC-15
AC-15
DC-13
DC-13
1.8
2.8
1.4
(1) U-type auxiliary contacts cannot be mounted
with an integrated solid neutral.
202
acces_043_a_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
Connection
Electrical principle
30 000 operations.
acces_051_a_2_cat
Mechanical characteristics
References
S-type auxiliary contacts 0-I
for external front and right-side operation (Standard operation)
Rating (A) Frame size
Contact type
Reference
32 1250
11 18
NC+NO
3999 0041
acces_083_a_1_cat
Characteristics
Switch body for signalling auxiliary contact
Contact type
Operation type
S-type
Standard
ST-type
TEST
Rating (A)
Current
nominal (A)
32 1250
20
Important:
Reference
3999 0003
3999 0103
Frame size
0 11
12
13
13
14
14
14
15
15
15
16
16
16
Fuse size
10 x 38 / 14 x 51
00C
22 x 58
00
0
0
0
1
1
1
2
2
2
No. of poles
2/3/4
2/3/4
2/3/4
2/3/4
2P
3P
4P
2P
3P
4P
2P
3P
4P
Reference
included
3999 8906
3999 8912
3999 8912
3999 8216
3999 8316
3999 8416
3999 8225
3999 8325
3999 8425
3999 8240
3999 8340
3999 8440
Terminal shrouds
Rating (A)
CD 20 63
100 CD 200
100 CD 200
100 CD 200
200 400
200 400
200 400
630 800
630 800
630 800
800 1250
800 1250
800 1250
Frame size
0 12
13/14
13/14
13/14
15/16
15/16
15/16
17
17
17
18
18
18
Position
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
No. of poles
2/3/4P
2P
3P
4P
2P
3P
4P
2P
3P
4P
2P
3P
4P
Reference
integrated
3998 2016
3998 3016
3998 4016
3998 2025
3998 3025
3998 4025
3898 2080
3898 3080
3898 4080
3898 2120
3898 3120
3898 4120
fuser_314_a_1_cat
Use
Top or bottom IP20 protection (on the front)
against direct contact with terminals or
connection parts.
203
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
Accessories (continued)
NFC and DIN fuse blown indication
Use
Electrical principle
30 000 operations.
Mechanical characteristics
References
NO/NC type auxiliary contacts for 2 pole
Rating (A)
Frame size
Fuses
50
11
14 x 51
100 125
13
22 x 58
160
14
0
250
15/16
1-2
400
16
2
630
17
3
800 1250
18
4
Contact(s)
1st
1st
1st
1st
1st
1st
1st
Reference
Contact(s)
1st
1st
1st
1st
1st
1st
1st
1st
2nd
2nd
2
Reference
fuser_311_a_1_cat
3994 0303
3994 0405
3994 0310
3994 0316
3994 0325
3894 0440
3894 1306
3894 1312
3994 1901
3994 1902
3994 1901
Reference
3994 0405
3994 0410
3994 0416
3994 0425
3894 0440
3894 1406
3894 1412
3994 1901
3994 1902
3994 1901
fuser_312_a_1_cat
3994 0405
3994 0210
3994 0216
3994 0225
3894 0440
3894 1206
3894 1212
Characteristics
Rating (A)
CD 32 ... 1250
Current
nominal (A)
16
250 VAC
AC-13
4
48 VDC
DC-13
2
Principle
The Fuse Melting Device (FMD) detects the
operation of a fuse and provides a signal via:
a relay and 1 LED (FMD10) or a bi-stable relay
and 3 LEDs (FMD30).
The FMD can be DIN rail or back plate mounted
close to the Fuserbloc, directly mounted on the
FUSERBLOC, or it can be door mounted to provide
information directly on the front of a panel.
References
3899 1120
3899 1380
3899 3120
3899 3380
Reference
Standard
Door mounted
3819 9120
3829 9120
Relay characteristics
Rating (A)
63 ... 1250
204
acces_310_a
Accessories
Kit for connection accessories
Kit for connection accessories
Reference
acces_319_a
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
Cage terminals
Use
Connection of bare copper cables onto the terminals (without lugs).
References
Frame size
0 12
13/14
13/14
15
15
16
16
No. of poles
2/3/4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
Reference
integrated
5400 3016
5400 4016
5400 3025
5400 4025
5400 3040
5400 4040
acces_053_a_1_cat
Connections
Rigid cable
Flexible bar Stripped over
Flexible cable
(mm)
Rating (A) cross-section (mm2) cross-section (mm) width (mm)
16 95
16 185
50 300
13
18
20
22
27
34
Dimensions
Rating (A)
A1
X1
100 160
47.5
22.5
25
20
8.5
M12
10
250
62
31.5
31.5
25
10.5
M16
14
400
71.5
32
38
32
10.5
M20
15
A1
C
A
acces_092_a_1_x_cat
16 95
16 185
50 240
acces_091_a_1_x_cat
100 160
250
400
X1
Rating (A)
Frame size
Operation
Figure n
Reference
0 18
external front
1/2
direct
100 400
3 6
direct
630 1250
17 18
direct
1499 7701
3629 7903
3629 7913
3829 7923
CD 20 1250
32 63
acces_042_a_1_x_cat
Fig. 1
Frame size
Operation
Figure n
Reference
0 18
external front
1499 7702
CD 20 1250
Frame size
Operation
Figure n
Reference
0 18
external front
1499 7703
Frame size
Operation
Reference
0 18
external front
1499 7702
Fig.2
acces_157_a_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
acces_158_a_1_x_cat
Fig. 3
Label holder
Use
Dimensions W x H (mm)
18 x 13
To be ordered
in multiples of
Reference
50
7769 9999
acces_044_a_1_cat
205
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
20 A
25 A
CD 32 A
CD 32 A
32 A
50 A
A1/-
-/10 x 38
-/10 x 38
A1/14 x 51
A1/-
-/14 x 51
63 A
100 A
A2-A3/00C A4*/22 x 58
11
11
12
13
800
800
800
800
750
750
750
750
Utilisation category
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
20/20
20/20
20/20
20/20
25/25
25/25
25/25
25/25
32/32
32/32
32/32
32/32
-/32
32/32
32/32
32/32
32/32
32/32
32/32
32/32
32/32
32/32
32/32
32(3)/32(3)
32(3)/32(3)
50/50
50/50
50/50
50/50
50/50
40/40
50(3)/50(3)
40(3)/40(3)
63/63
63/63
63/63
63/63
63/63
40/40
63(3)/63(3)
40(3)/40(3)
100/100
100/100
100(4)/100(4)
100(4)/100(4)
100/100
100/100
100(3)/100(3)
100(3) / 100(3)
-/25(2)
9/9
11/11
15/15
15/15
15/15
25/25
30/30
51/51
15/15
22/22
25/25
25/25
25/25
45/45
55/55
90/90
11
15
15
15
23
28
45
80/-
-/100
-/100
80/100
80/100
-/100
80/100
80/100
20/-
-/25
-/32
32/32
32/32
-/50
63/63
100/100
5.5
5.5
5.5
5.5
7.6
10.6
20
SOCOMEC BS88
SOCOMEC BS88
SOCOMEC DIN
SOCOMEC DIN
BUSSMANN
6A10 0020
6A1M 0032
6012 0025
6013 0025
6012 0032
6013 0032
BUSSMANN
NITD 20M32
2.5
16
2.5
16
2.5
16
2.5
16
6
25
6
25
10
25
2/-
2/-
2/3
2.5/3
2.5/3
2.5/3
25
95
20
8.3/13
20 000
0.48
0.50
20 000
0.48
0.50
20 000
0.48
0.50
20 000
0.50
0.52
10 000
0.80
1
0.2
32
10 000
0.80
1
0.2
27
10 000
1
1.3
0.3
32
10 000
1.5
2
0.5
36
Short-circuit capacity
Rated peak withstand current (kA peak)(6)
NITD 20
LAWSON
NIT 20
LAWSON
NIT 20M32
GE
NIT 20
GE
NIT 20M32
Connection
Minimum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Maximum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Maximum busbar width (mm)
Min. / Max. tightening torque min (Nm)
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
Weight of 3 P switch (kg)
Weight of 4 P switch (kg)
Weight of 1 P extra (kg)
Frame pitch (mm)
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) With terminal shrouds or terminal screen.
(3) 4-pole device with 2 pole in series by polarity.
(4) Poles cannot be juxtaposed.
(5) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer to another.
(6) For a rated operational voltage Ue = 400 VAC.
(7) Fuse 800 A, 690 VAC does not exist, tests conducted with bars.
* For fuse size A4: max diameter 31 mm.
** Please ensure that fuse let through current does not exceed short-circuit capacity of the switch (kA peak).
206
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
125 to 200 A
Thermal current Ith (40C)
NFC/DIN fuse size
125 A
125 A
160 A
CD 160 A
160 A
160 A
CD 200 A
200 A
-/22 x 58
-/00
-/00
A3-A4*/-
A4/0
B1-B2/-
A3-A4*/-
B1-B2/-
13
13
13
13 A
14
14
13 A
15
750
750
750
750
750
750
750
750
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
400 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
125/125
125/125
160/160
160/160
160/160
160/160
200/200
200/200
400 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
125/125
125/125
160/160
160/160
160/160
160/160
200/200
200/200
690 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
160(2/160(2)
160(2)/160(2)
160(2)/160(2)
160(2)/160(2)
200(2)/200(2)
690 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
125(2)/125(2)
125(2)/125(2)
125(2)/125(2)
125(2)/125(2)
200(2)/160(2)
220 VDC
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
125/125
125/125
160/160
160/160
160/160
160/160
160/160
200/200
220 VDC
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
100/100
100/100
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
200/200
440 VDC
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
160(3)/160(3)
160(3)/160(3)
160(3)/160(3)
160(3)/160(3)
200(3)/200(3)
440 VDC
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
160(3)/160(3)
125(3)/125(3)
125(3)/125(3)
125(3)/125(3)
200(3)/200(3)
Rated voltage
63/63
63/63
80/80
80/80
80/80
80/80
80/80
100/100
90/90
90/90
110/110
110/110
110/110
110/110
110/110
150/185
55
55
75
70
75
75
90
90
-/100
-/100
-/100 (50)
50/-
80/100
80/100
50/-
80/-
-/125
-/125
-/125 (160)
160/-
160/160
160/160
200/-
200/-
20
20
20
20
22.7
22.7
20
32.5
Short-circuit capacity
Rated peak withstand current (kA peak)(6)
6A40 0160
6A4M 0160
6A40 0160
6B20 0160
6A40 0200
6B20 0200
6A4M 0160
6B1M 0200
6A4M 0315
6B2M 0315
6032 0125 6692 0125 6692 0160
6702 0160
6033 0125 6693 0125 6693 0160
6703 0160
DEO 160
DEO 160
DD 160
DEO 200
DD 200
CEO 100M160 DEO 100M200 CD 100M200 DEO 200M315 DD 200M315
CTFP 160
TFP 160
TF 160
TF 200
TF 200
CTCP 100M160 TCP 100M200 TCP 100M200 TC 200M315 TC 200M315
TCP 100
TFP 160
TF 160
TF 200
TF 200
OCP 100M160 TCP 100M201 TC 100M200 TF 200M315 TF 200M315
Connection
Minimum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Maximum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Maximum busbar width (mm)
Tightening torque min (Nm)
35
95
20
8.3/13
35
95
20
8.3/13
35
95
20
8.3/13
35
95
20
8.3/13
50
95
20
8.3/13
50
95
20
8.3/13
35
95
20
8.3/13
95
240
32
20/26
10 000
1.5
2
0.5
36
10 000
1.5
2
0.5
36
10 000
1.8
2.3
0.5
36
10 000
1.8
2.3
0.5
36
10 000
1.8
2.3
0.5
50
10 000
1.8
2.3
0.5
50
10 000
1.8
2.3
0.5
36
10 000
3.2
4.5
1.3
60
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
Weight of 3 P switch (kg)
Weight of 4 P switch (kg)
Weight of 1 P extra (kg)
Frame pitch (mm)
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) With terminal shrouds or phase barrier.
(3) Poles cannot be juxtaposed.
(4) 4-pole device with 2 poles in series per polarity.
(5) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer to another.
(6) For a rated operational voltage Ue = 400 VAC.
(7) Fuse 800 A, 690 Vac does not exist, tests conducted with bars.
207
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
250 A
315 A
400 A
630 A
800 A
800 A
1250 A
B1-B2-B3/1
B1-B2-B3/-
B1-B2-B3-B4/2
C1-C2/3
C1-C2-C3/3
-/4
D1/4
17
17
18
18
15
16
16
17
17
18
18
750
800
800
1000
1000
1000
1000
12
12
12
12
Utilisation category
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
400 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
250/250
315/315
400/400
630/630
800/800
800/800
1250/1250
400 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
250/250
315/315
400/400
630/630
800/800
800/800
1000/1250
690 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
250(2)/250(2)
315(2)/315(2)
400/400
500/630
800/800
800/800(7)
800/1250
690 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
250(2)/250(2)
250(2)/315(2)
400/400
315/400
630/630
800/800(7)
800/630
220 VDC
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
250/250
250/250
315/315
315/630
800/800
800/800
1250/1250
220 VDC
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
200/200
200/200
200/315
400/630
800/800
800/800
1250/1250
440 VDC
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
250(3) / 250(3)
250(3) / 250(3)
315(4)/315(4)
315/630(4)
800(3) / 800(3)
800/800
1000(3) / 1000(3)
440 VDC
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
200(3) / 200(3)
200(3) / 200(3)
250(4) / 315(4)
400(4)/630(4)
800(3) / 800(3)
800/800(3)
1000(3) / 1000(3)
132/132
160/160
220/220
355/355
450/450
450/450
560/560
220/220
220/295
220/295
295/400
400/400
400/400
400/475
115
145
185
290
365
355
460
80/100
80/-
80/50
80/100
80/100
-/100
-/100
250/250
315/-
400/400
630/630
800/800
-/800
-/1250
32.5
40
40
70
80
80
90
6C20 0630
6C30 0800
6746 0800
6747 0800
6746 1200
6747 1200
4 x 185
Short-circuit capacity
Rated peak withstand current (kA peak)(6)
6B20 0250
6B30 0315
6B40 0400
6B2M 3015
6B3M 0400
6B4M 0500
6712 0250
6722 0400
6713 0250
6723 0400
ED 250
ED 315
ED 400
DD 200M315 ED 315M400 ED 400M500
TKF 250
TKF 315
TMF 400
TF 200M315 TKF 315M400 TMF 400M500
TKF 250
TKF 315
TMF 400
TF 200M315 TKF 315M355 TMF 400M450
6732 0400
6733 0400
FF 630
GF 800
TTM 630
TLM 800
TTM 630
TLM 800
Connection
Minimum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
95
185
185
2 x 150
2 x 185
240
240
240
2 x 300
2 x 300
4 x 185
32
45
45
63
63
80
80
20/26
20/26
20/26
40/45
40/45
40/45
40/45
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
10 000
10 000
10 000
8 000
8 000
5 000
5 000
3.2
4.8
4.8
16
17
25
25
4.5
6.1
6.1
20
21.5
30
30
1.3
1.3
1.3
60
66
66
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) With terminal shrouds or terminal screen.
(3) 4-pole device with 2 pole in series by polarity.
(4) Poles cannot be juxtaposed.
(5) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer to another.
(6) For a rated operational voltage Ue = 400 VAC.
(7) Fuse 800 A, 690 VAC does not exist, tests conducted with bars.
** Please ensure that fuse let through current does not exceed short-circuit capacity of the switch (kA peak).
208
94
94
120
120
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
External operation
BS88 - FUSERBLOC CD 20 to CD 32 A in size A1
External front operation
102 min.
44
96
37.5
6.5
44
19
15
5.2
65
98
vfuser_292_d_1_x_cat
70
98
79.5
14
35
83
6.5
44
19
36 min.
96
36 min.
70
83
fuser_295_c_1_x_cat
98
79.5
70
45
5.2
65
98
44
52.5
44
192
105 min.
96
105
6.5
37.5 15
65
98
83
5.2
fuser_440_b_1_x_cat
70
98
79.5
14
44
19
209
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
External operation
NFC and DIN - FUSERBLOC 25 to 32 A in size 10 x 38
External front operation
102 min.
44
96
44
36 mini
96
36 mini
44
52.5
6.5
44
19
35
5.2
21.5
45
70
70
fuser_291_d_1_x_cat
98
79.5
45
70
21.5
65
79.5
14
35
21.5
65
21.5
17
5.2
17
fuser_294_c_1_x_cat
15
98
37.5
6.5
44
19
102 min.
96
37.5
6.5
44
19
192
105 min.
96
105
6.5
14
98
79.5
65
83
5.2
fuser_440_b_1_x_cat
37.5 15
44
19
70
5.2
fuser_295_c_1_x_cat
83
70
44
98
79.5
65
98
210
36 min.
70
45
fuser_292_d_1_x_cat
14
98
79.5
70
5.2
83
98
96
52.5
44
36 min.
35
65
98
44
6.5
44
19
15
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
min 50
max 230
29
4.8
15 24
68
14.5
1
2
12
6.2
27
27
121 (3P)
148 (4P)
31
45
35
18
23.5*
4
118
126.5
x 106
*x 52.5
fuser_624_b_1_x_cat
59
6
27
27
S1 type
Box size 0
TEST
65
Side operation
Door drilling
Direction of operation
0.78 0.78
20 20
0
90
1.46
37
4 0.27
47
14
0.55
3.07
78
1.73
44
0.78
20
0.55
1.46
37
14
2.75
70
fuser_712_a_1_gb_cat
90
4 0.27
47
Door drilling
0.78
20
Handle type
0.55
14
0.55
14
211
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
min 50
max 230
14.5
15 24
68
4.8
29
1
2
12
32
6.2
32
136 (3P)
168 (4P)
min W
max X
132
36
31
x 32
50
18
35
118
126.5
x 106
*x 52.5
fuser_625_b_1_x_cat
59
5.4
32
32
Z
* to use if pre-break auxiliary contact number > 4
W: 124 + N x 23.5 for BS88; 139 for NFC and DIN
X: 145 + N x 23.5 for BS88; 145 for NFC and DIN
Y: 159 only for DIN
Z: 145 only for DIN
212
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
* x 5.5
29
14.5
min 50
max 230
68
4.8
41
1
2
20
8.7
36
36
148 (3P)
184 (4P)
min 139
max 145
132
40
31
54
18 35
53
162
141
x 127
126.5
x 52.5*
141
2.5
62
2.5
fuser_626_a_1_x_cat
x 36
5.4
53
8.5
5
2.5
19.5
20
36
36
213
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
B
14.5
4.8
68
min 50
max 230
39
10
2
18
8.7
36
36
148 (3P)
184 (4P)
min 145
max 225
139
36
x. 36
54
18
35
53
40
162
x. 52.5*
141
x. 130
126.5
78
18
3
20
214
53
fuser_627_b_1_x_cat
8.5
36
36
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
29
14.5
min 50
max 23
68
4.8
41
1
8
2
20
8.7
50
50
190 (3P)
240 (4P)
min 145
max 225
54
136.5
31
68
18 35
141
x 140
126.5
x 52.5*
174
fuser_628_b_1_x_cat
2.5
62
2.5
x 50
5.4
8.5
20
215
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
*x 5.5
14.5
min 50
max 230
68
4.8
29
17
52
1
2
32
11
60
60
234 (3P)
294 (4P)
min 154
max 225
146
64
x 60
3P 86
4P 146
25 35
6.4
75
3
31
195
166
x 162
126.5
*x 52.5
75
fuser_629_b_1_x_cat
185
2.5
84
2.5
11
2.5
19.5
32
60
60
251
* to use if pre-break auxiliary contact number > 4
1. S-type auxiliary contact NO + NC to use if block number > 4
2. Rear connection (option)
3. 1 to 8 pre-break auxiliary contact for signalisation
216
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
*x 5.5 29
4.8
14.5
min 50
max 230
68
54
50
14.5
2
11
66
66
252 (3P)
318 (4P)
min 157
max 225
x 66
70
91
25
35
6.4
149
31
75
205
175
75
fuser_630_b_1_cat
200
84
x 172
126.5
*x 52.5
11
3
50
20
66
66
260
TEST
65
Direction of operation
0
90
90
4 0.27
47
14
0.55
3.07
78
1.46
37
4 0.27
47
1.46
37
14
0.55
4.92
125
1.77
45
Door drilling
0.78 0.78
20 20
0.55
14
0.55
14
fuser_713_a_1_gb_cat
S2 type
Box size 11-16
Side operation
Door drilling
0.78
20
Direction of operation
0.78
20
Handle type
217
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
F
A
fuser_634_e_1_x_cat
E min.
J1
H
14
AC
AA
DA
BA
8.2
20
W
2
DB
1. Fuse blown indicaion not available for BS88
2. Terminal shrouds
A. S1 handle: 32 and 63 A
B. S1 handle: 100 to 400 A
C. Door drilling
Rating
(A)
Fuse size
Dimensions
Frame
size A 3 A 4
E
E
P
P min max
AC
Switch
mounting
Switch body
Connection
F3 F4
P
P
J3 J4
P
P
J1
3P
J1
4P
DA DB
T U
242 296
87
165
85 153
90
27
118
118
AA
BA
32
A1
11
63
A2-A3
12
145
90
32
100
A4
13
145
268
128
CD
160
A3-A4
13 A
225
268
296 368
205
128
36 18 8.5
160
A4
14
225
268
128
160
B1-B2
14
225
268
128
CD
200
A3-A4
13 A
225
268
296 368
139
205
128
36 18 8.5
200
B1-B2
15
225
345
468 588
146
155
60 32 11
250
B1-B2-B3
15
225
345
468 588
146
155
60 32 11
315
B1-B2-B3
16
225
355
504 636
149
168
66 50 11
20
205 175
400
B1-B2-B3-B4
16
225
355
504 636
149
168
66 50 11
20
205 175
218
Terminal
shrouds
139
20
20
162 141
162 141
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
F
A
fuser_634_e_1_x_cat
E min.
J1
H
14
AA
AC
AA
BA
DA
BA
8.2
20
W
2
DB
1. Fuse blown indicaion not available for BS88
2. Terminal shrouds
A. S1 handle: 50 and 63 A
B. S2 handle: 100 to 400 A
C. Door drilling
Rating Fuse
(A)
size
50
14 x
51
Frame
size
11
12
Overall dimensions
A
3p
A
4p
264
294
358
E
E
min max
125
Terminal
shrouds
AC
F
F
3P 4P
121 148
87(1)
(2)
63
00C
100
22 x
58
145
13
318
390
135
145
268
125
22 x
58
13
318
390
135
145
125
00
13
318
390
135
160
00
13
318
390
135
160
14
402
502
250
15
490
400
16
526
Switch
mounting
Switch body
Connection
J
J
J1 J1
DA
3P 4P 3P 4P
DB
153
90
27
118
118
85
90
32
148 184
(2)
116
128
36
20
8.5
268
148 184
116(2)
128
36
20
8.5
145
268
128
36
20
8.5
145
268
128
36
20
8.5
145
225
268
128
50
20
8.5
610
154
225
345
234 294
146
155
60
32
11
658
157
225
355
252 318
149
168
66
50
11
20
205 175
219
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
96
91.5
44
37.5
6.5
15
fuser_148_c_1_x_cat
45
98
79.5
14
19
5.2
65
98
83
FUSERBLOC 32 to 400 A
T
AD
fuser_064_b_1_x_cat
AA
DA
BA
70
1
AC
Z
W
31
T
AB
DB
1. Protection screen lockable in position I
2. 1 or 2 fuse blown indication.
3. 1 or 2 A type ACs
Dimensions
Rating
(A)
Frame
size
32
A1
133
165
63
A2-A3
133
165
100
A4
150
186
173
108
144
268
A3-A4
3A
152
188
173
108
144
268
CD 160
220
Terminal shrouds
Fuse size
A
A
4
3
/WWW /WWW
AB
3P
AB
4P
AC
AD
Switch body
Switch mounting
Connection
DA
DB
AA
BA
134
116.5
36
159
145
106
5.4
6.5
27
134
116.5
36
159
145
106
5.4
6.5
32
44
116
38
127
5.4
36
20
8.5
2.5
19.5 162
141
44
139
38
130
5.4
36
20
8.5
19.5 162
141
118
118
160
A4
150
186
173
108
144
268
44
116
38
127
5.4
50
20
8.5
2.5
19.5 162
141
160
B1-B2
192
242
173
136
172
268
44
123
45
140
5.4
50
20
8.5
2.5
19.5 162
141
CD 200
A3-A4
3A
152
188
173
108
144
268
44
139
38
130
5.4
36
20
8.5
19.5 162
141
200
B1-B2
192
242
173
136
172
345
44
123
45
140
5.4
60
20
8.5
2.5
19.5 195
166
250
B1-B2-B3
253
313
173
180
240
345
65
146
81
185
251
162
6.4
60
32
11
2.5
19.5 195
166
315
B1-B2-B3
253
313
173
180
240
355
65
146
81
185
251
162
6.4
66
32
11
2.5
19.5 195
175
400
B1-B2-B3-B4
271
337
173
192
258
355
65
149
86
200
260
172
6.4
66
50
11
20
205
175
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
112
96
91.5
37.5
6.5
15
96
91.5
44
44
15
19
98
79.5
79.5
45
5.2
65
5.2
21.5
65
fuser_148_c_1_x_cat
fuser_138_c_1_x_cat
45
98
14
14
35
19
37.5
6.5
98
21.5
83
17
FUSERBLOC 50 to 400 A
T
AD
AA
DA
BA
70
1
AC
Z
W
fuser_064_b_1_x_cat
31
T
AB
DB
Rating
Frame
Fuse size
(A)
size
50
14 x 51
Overall dimensions
A3P A4P
118
145
Terminal shrouds
AB
3P
AB 4 P
AC
Switch body
AD
134
87
33.5
116.5
36
116
38
DA
159
Switch mounting
DB
63
00C
133
165
134
100
22 x 58
150
186
173
108
144
268
44
145
125
22 x 58
150
186
173
108
144
268
44
116
38
125
00
150
186
173
108
144
268
44
126.5
38
141
193
160
00
150
186
173
108
144
268
44
126.5
38
141
160
192
242
173
136
172
268
44
136.5
45
250
253
313
173
180
240
345
65
146
400
271
337
173
192
258
355
65
149
Connection
106
5.4
6.5
27
6.5
32
AA
BA
118
106
5.4
127
5.4
36
118
127
5.4
36
127
5.4
36
189
127
5.4
36
174
229
140
5.4
50
81
185
251
162
6.4
60
32
86
200
260
172
6.4
66
50
11
20
205 175
221
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
85.5
1
11.5
68
min 265
10.5
46
2
20
3
51
min 15
94
94
364 (3P)
458 (4P)
min 265
Fix 284 (3P)
Fix 378 (4P)
65
250
85.5
155
11
235.5
85.5
300
fuser_631_b
90
300
260
x 250
22
235.5
79.5
34
13
59
9
51
94
380
94
1. Direct operation
2. S-type auxiliary contact NO + NC
3. Rear connection (option)
4. 1 to 8 pre-break auxiliary contact for signalisation
5. Terminal shrouds
Direction of operation
S3 type
Box size 17
4 0.27
47
14
0.55
0.78
20
90
0
1.46
37
1.46
37
4 0.27
47
14
0.55
210
fuser_714_a_1_gb_cat
222
Door drilling
0.78
20
61
Direction of operation
0.78 0.78
20 20
90
3.07
78
Side operation
Door drilling
0.55
14
0.55
14
FUSERBLOC
Fuse combination switches
for industrial fuses up to 1250 A
85.5
1. Direct operation
2. S-type auxiliary contact NO + NC
3. Rear connection (option)
4. 1 to 8 pre-break auxiliary contact for signalisation
5. Terminal shrouds
11.5
10.5
68
min 304
46
2
3
120
min 15
120
442 (3P)
562 (4P)
x 362 (3P)
x 482 (4P)
88
min 304
289
87.5
160
11
34
22
300
260
x 250
237.5
87.5
355
fuser_632_b_1_x_cat
90
237.5
79.5
59
120
120
295
Front operation
Side operation
Direction of operation
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S3 type
Box size 18
3.07
78
210
90
0
37
47
20 20
61
S4 type
1414
0
90
350
78
fuser_715_a_1_gb_cat
60
223
fuser_437_a_1_cat
Fuse protection
Strong points
FUSERBLOC
630 to 1250 A
fuser_439_a_1_cat
Large range
> Contact us for any other
combinations (1250 V UR
fuses, notched fuses with
}RUPPGLVWDQFH
between centres, other sizes,
etc.)
FUSERBLOC
from 25 to 400 A
224
Function
Advantages
Characteristics
FUSERBLOC for 690 VAC UR cylindrical fuses
FUSERBLOC CD 50 A for fuse size 14 x 51
Fuse rating (A)
10
12
16
20
25
32
40
50
10
12
16
20
25
29
36
40
20
25
32
40
50
63
80
100
20
25
32
40
50
63
71
85
References
Direct side operation
Fuse rating (A)
Frame size
No. of poles
Switch body
50 A / 14 x 51
1
125 A / 22 x 58
3
2P
3615 2005
3P
3615 3005
4P
3615 6005
2P
3615 2011
3P
3615 3011
4P
3615 6011
Direct handle
Black
3629 7900
1 contact NO/NC
3999 0021
2 contacts NO/NC
3999 0022
Black
3629 7901
125 A / 22 x 58
13
No. of poles
Switch body
2P
3831 2005
3P
3831 3005
4P
Black IP55
1411 2111
1415 2111
3831 6005
1414 2111
1418 2111
2P
3831 2011
Black IP55
Black IP55
3P
3831 3011
4P
3831 6011
1421 2111
1425 2111
Red IP65
1424 2111
1428 2111
1 contact NC
320 mm
3999 0701
1400 1032
1 contact NO
3999 0702
Accessories
Other accessories: See the FUSERBLOC pages
225
Characteristics
FUSERBLOC for DIN 43620 UR knife-edge fuses
FUSERBLOC 160 A for fuse size 000 and 00
Fuse rating (A)
10
16
20
25
32
40
50
63
80
100
125
160
200
250
315
10
16
20
25
32
32
37
44
51
92
105
121
140
140
140
40
50
63
80
100
125
160
200
250
315
350
400
40
50
63
80
100
125
155
178
205
210
215
220
200
250
315
350
400
450
500
550
630
700
200
250
285
310
330
330
340
340
350
350
500
550
630
700
800
900
1000
360
380
420
450
480
500
510
References
Direct side operation
Fuse rating (A)
Frame size
No. of poles
2P
3615 2015
3990 7015(1)
160 A / 00
3
3P
3615 3015
3990 8015(1)
4P
3615 6015
3990 9015(1)
2P
3615 2016
3990 7016(1)
3P
3615 3016
4P
3615 6016
Black
3999 0021
3990 9016(1)
3629 7901
2 contacts NO/NC
3990 7024(1)
160 A / 0
4
250 A / 1
5
400 A / 2
6
630 A / 3
17
Switch body
1 contact NO/NC
3990 8016(1)
2P
3615 2024
3P
3615 3024
4P
3615 6024
3990 9024(1)
2P
3615 2039
3990 7039(1)
3P
3615 3039
3990 8039(1)
4P
3615 6039
3990 9039(1)
2P
3811 2063
3P
3811 3063
4P
3811 6063
226
Direct handle
3999 0022
3990 8024(1)
1 contact NC
Black
3999 0701
3899 6011
1 contact NO
3999 0702
3890 8063(1)
3890 9063(1)
No. of poles
160 A / 00
13
160 A / 0
14
250 A / 1
15
400 A / 2
16
630 A / 3
17
External front
handle
Switch body
External side
handle
Auxiliary contact
pre-break and
position
Fuse protection
covers
2P
3831 2015
3990 7015(1)
3P
3831 3015
3990 8015(1)
4P
3831 6015
3990 9015(1)
2P
3831 2016
3990 7016(1)
3P
3831 3016
3990 8016(1)
4P
3831 6016
2P
3831 2024
3P
3831 3024
4P
3831 6024
2P
3831 2039
3990 7039(1)
3P
3831 3039
3990 8039(1)
4P
3831 6039
3990 9039(1)
2P
3811 2063
3811 3063
3P
Black IP55
Black IP55
200 mm
1421 2111
1425 2111
1400 1020
320 mm
1424 2111
1428 2111
1400 1032
1 contact NC
3999 0701
1 contact NO
3999 0702
Black IP65
Black IP65
200 mm
1433 3111
1437 3111
1400 1220
320 mm
1434 3111
1438 3111
1400 1232
3811 6063
4P
3990 9016(1)
3990 7024(1)
3990 8024(1)
3990 9024(1)
3890 8063(1)
3890 9063(1)
Accessories
FUSERBLOC for DIN 43620 UR knife-edge fuses
Terminal shrouds for FUSERBLOC fitted fuse blown microswitch
Rating (A)
Fuses (1)
No. of
poles
160
00
2P
160
00
3P
160
00
4P
160
2P
160
3P
160
4P
250
2P
250
3P
250
4P
400
2P
400
3P
400
4P
630
3P
630
4P
Accessories(2)
Options(3)
References
References
3990 7015
3990 8015
3990 9015
3990 7016
3990 8016
3990 9016
3990 7024
3990 8024
3990 9024
3990 7039
3990 8039
3990 9039
3890 8063
3890 9063
3999 7015
3999 8015
3999 9015
3999 7016
3999 8016
3999 9016
3999 7024
3999 8024
3999 9024
3999 7039
3999 8039
3999 9039
3899 8063
3899 9063
acces_221_a
Use
Protection against direct contact with live parts situated in the fuse
compartment for FUSERBLOC fitted with UR fuses with fuse blown
auxiliary contacts.
(1) For the fuses: see "UR fuses 10 to 2000 A" page
(2) If ordered at the same time as the standard device.
(3) If ordered later.
227
Characteristics
FUSERBLOC for UR fuses type K/50
FUSERBLOC V 800 A for BK fuses size 2
Fuse rating (A)
Max. I for the FUSERBLOC (A)
FUSERBLOC 1250 A for fuse size 3
400
380
450
420
500
440
550
450
630
500
700
520
800
530
900
530
1000
530
1100
540
1250
550
500
550
630
700
800
900
1000
1100
1250
1400
1500
1600
1800
2000
500
550
620
630
720
790
870
940
1050
1100
1100
1100
1100
1100
References
Front operation
Rating (A) /
Fuse
800 A /
2
1250 A /
3
No. of poles
3680 3081
3680 6081
3680 3121
3680 6121
3P
4P
3P
4P
Shaft for
external handle
Black IP55
Please consult
us
Fuse
protection
covers
Auxiliary
contact prebreak and
position
Terminal
shrouds
Please consult
us
Please consult
us
Please consult
us
200 mm
1443 3111(2)
1400 1220
Red / Yellow
IP65
320 mm
1400 1232
1444 3111
Characteristics
FUSERBLOC for UR fuses type K/110
FUSERBLOC 250 A for fuse size 1* (690 VAC)(1)
Fuse rating (A)
40
50
63
80
100
125
160
200
250
315
350
400
450
500
550
630
40
50
63
80
100
120
140
165
195
215
230
240
240
240
230
240
200
250
315
350
400
450
500
550
630
700
800
900
145
165
200
220
240
265
290
310
340
370
395
395
(1)
400
450
500
550
630
700
320
345
370
390
425
460
800
900
1000
1100
1250
495
545
590
610
620
500
550
630
700
800
900
1000
1100
1250
1400
1500
1600
1800
2000
370
395
440
480
535
590
645
695
760
800
800
800
800
800
References
External right side or front operation switch
Rating (A) /
Fuse
No. of poles
Switch body
2P
36U1 2024
3P
36U1 3024
Black
400 A /
1
2P
36U1 2039
3629 7901
3P
36U1 3039
500 A /
2
2P
38U1 2050
3P
38U1 3050
630 A /
2
2P
38U1 2063
3P
38U1 3063
Black
800 A /
3
2P
38U1 2080
1437 7911
3P
38U1 3080
250 A /
1*
1250 A /
3
Direct front
handle
Auxiliary contact
pre-break and Terminal shrouds
signalisation
2P
3990 2839(1)
1 contact NO/NC
3P
3999 0021
3990 3839(1)
3899 6011
3890 2U63(1)
3P
3890 3U63(1)
3998 2025
3P
3998 3025
2P
Black
2P
1 contact NC
3999 0701
1 contact NO
3898 2080
3P
3898 3080
3999 0702
38U1 2120
Black
3P
38U1 3120
3899 7011
Fuse protection
covers
2P
2P
228
Direct side
handle
(1)
3890 2U12
3898 2120
3890 3U12(1)
3898 3120
No. of
poles
Switch body
2P
38U1 2024
3P
38U1 3024
External front
handle
External side
handle
S2 type
Black IP55
S2 type
Black IP55
1421 2111
1425 2111
320 mm
S2 type
Red IP65
S2 type
Red/yellow IP65
1400 1032
1424 2111
1428 2111
250 A /
1*
2P
38U1 2039
400 A /
1
3P
38U1 3039
2P
38U1 2050
3P
38U1 3050
2P
38U1 2063
Auxiliary contact
pre-break and Terminal shrouds
position
2P
2P
3990 2839(1)
3998 2025
3P
3P
3990 3839(1)
3998 3025
500 A /
2
630 A /
2
3P
38U1 3063
2P
38U1 2080
3P
38U1 3080
2P
38U1 2120
S3 type
Red/Yellow IP65
800 A /
3
3P
38U1 3120
2P
3890 2U63(1)
1433 3111
1434 3111
1250 A /
3
1 contact NC
S3 type
Black IP65
3P
3890 3U63(1)
S3 type
Black IP65
1437 3111
320 mm
S3 type
Red/Yellow IP65
1400 1232
3999 0701
1 contact NO
3999 0702
2P
3898 2080
3P
3898 3080
1438 3111
S4 type
Black IP65
2P
1443 3111
3890 2U12(1)
S4 type
Red/Yellow IP65
3890 3U12(1)
3P
2P
3898 2120
3P
3898 3120
1444 3111
Accessories
FUSERBLOC for UR fuses type K/110
Terminal shrouds for FUSERBLOC fitted fuse blown microswitch
Rating (A)
Fuses(3)
No. of
poles
250 400
1* / 1
2P
250 400
1* / 1
3P
500 800
2/3
2P
500 800
2/3
3P
1250
2P
1250
3P
500 800
2/3
2P
Accessories(1)
Option(2)
Reference
Reference
3999 2839
3999 3839
3899 2U63
3899 2U63
3899 2U12
3899 3U12
3990 2839
3990 3839
acces_221_a
Use
Protection against direct contact with live parts situated in the fuse
compartment for FUSERBLOC fitted with UR fuses with fuse blown
auxiliary contacts.
3890 3U63
3890 2U12
3890 3U12
3890 2U63
229
SIDERMAT combination
Visible breaking and tripping fuse switches
from 630 to 1800 A
Fuse protection
sdmat_048_b_1_cat
Strong points
> Tripping upon overload.
> High breaking capacity.
> Improved safety.
A complete range
Function
SIDERMAT combination are manually
operated tri- or tetrapolar fuse disconnecting
switches which can be triggered remotely.
They make and break under load conditions
and provide safety isolation and protection
against overcurrent for any low voltage
electrical circuit.
Advantages
Tripping upon overload.
Remote breaking by voltage release device
High breaking capacity
Protection against overloads and shortcircuits thanks to high breaking capacity fuses
(100 kA rms).
230
Improved safety
q Double break per phase (top and bottom of
fuse - 1600 and 1800 A excluded).
q Positive break indication.
q IP2X protection with
terminal shrouds front panel.
Conformity to standards
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
IEC 60947-3
EN 60947-3
BS EN 60947-3
NBN EN 60947-3
IEC 60269-1
IS 14947-3
DIN EN 60269-1
NF EN 60269-1
IEC 60269-2
VDE 0636-1
VDE 0660-107
SIDERMAT combination
References
NFC and DIN - Front operation - Switch body with a shunt trip coil - 230 VAC
Rating (A) /
Fuse(4)
630 A /
3
800 A /
4
1250 A /
4
1600 A / 2
x 4*
1800 A / 2
x 4*
Direct
handle
Switch body
3P
3520 3063
3998 3063
4P
3520 6063
3998 4063
3P
3520 3080
4P
3520 6080
3P
3520 3120
4P
3520 6120
3P
3520 3160
3 P + NC
3520 4160
4P
3520 6160
3P
3520 3180(3)
2998 3180(2)
3 P + NC
3520 4180(3)
included
4P
3520 6180(3)
2998 4180(2)
Black
3999 6203(1)
External
handle
S3 type
Black
IP55
1431 3511(1)
Red
IP55
1432 3511
Shaft for
external handle
1st position
AC
No. of
poles
1st contact
NO/NC
320 mm
3999 0051
1401 1532
2nd contact
NO/NC
Tripping AC
Terminal
shrouds top
Terminal
screens top
Inter phase
barrier
3P
1 contact
NO/NC
3999 0031
2998 3120(2)
4P
2998 4120(2)
3999 0052
3P
2998 0003
4P
2998 0004
(1) Standard.
231
SIDERMAT combination
Accessories
Direct front operation handle
Handle colour
Reference
630 1800
Black
3999 6203
630 1800
Red
consult us
acces_156_a_2_cat
Rating (A)
Reference
630 1800
Black
IP55
630 1800
Red
IP55
1431 3511
1432 3511
acces_166_a_2_cat
Handle colour
acces_151_a_2_cat
S3 type handle
Rating (A)
Colour
To be ordered by multiple
Reference
Light grey
50
Dark grey
50
1401 0001
1401 0011
acces_198_a_2_cat
Use
For single lever S3 type handles.
Other colours: consult us.
Rating (A)
Dimension X (mm)
Reference
630 800
350 450
200
630 800
350 570
320
1250 1800
370 570
320
1401 1520
1401 1532
1401 1532
acces_202_a_1_x_cat
acces_144_b_1_cat
Use
Standard lengths:
- 200 mm,
- 320 mm.
Other lengths: consult us.
232
Voltage
Reference
110 VAC
3999 3112
3999 3230
3999 3400
3999 4110
230 VAC
400 VAC
110 VDC
SIDERMAT combination
3990 1024
3990 1048
3990 1110
3990 1220
3990 1380
3990 2012
3990 2024
3990 2048
3990 2220
acces_049_a_1_cat
Original coil(1)
Reference
3991 1024
3991 1048
3991 1110
included
3991 1380
3991 2012
3991 2024
3991 2048
3991 2220
acces_050_a_1_cat
Voltage
24 VAC
48 VAC
110 VAC
230 VAC
400 VAC
12 VDC
24 VDC
48 VDC
110 / 200 VDC
Original coil(1)
Reference
3990 3024
3990 3048
3990 3110
3990 3220
3990 3380
3990 4012
3990 4024
3990 4048
3990 4110
3990 4220
3991 3024
3991 3048
3991 3110
3991 3220
3991 3380
3991 4012
3991 4024
3991 4048
3991 4110
3991 4220
Use
Omnipolar breaking remotely controlled by shunt trip or undervoltage
voltage release coil.
Note: the shunt trip coil must not be supplied for more than 5 s. A
5 "RGTMSSQHOBNHKHREHSSDCSNSGDRS@MC@QCRVHSBGANCX
To modify this coil, the reference opposite must be added to the switch
reference (use "original coil" reference).
Voltage
Reference
230 VAC
3992 3230
3992 3400
Voltage
24 VAC
48 VAC
110 VAC
230 VAC
400 VAC
12 VDC
24 VDC
48 VDC
110 VDC
220 VDC
400 VAC
Auxiliary contacts
References
Position AC
Reference
630 1800
1st
630 1800
2nd
3999 0051
3999 0052
acces_048_a_1_cat
Position AC
Reference
630 1800
1st
630 1800
2nd
3999 0111
3999 0112
Position AC
Reference
3999 0031
630 1800
Characteristics
Coil tripping
1 to 2 NO/NC auxiliary contacts
Rating (A)
630
1800
Current
nominal
(A)
250 VAC
400 VAC
24 VDC
48 VDC
AC-13
AC-13
DC-13
DC-13
16
12
14
Rating (A)
630
1800
Use
Pre-break and signalling of positions and I:
1 to 2 NO/NC auxiliary contacts
Current
nominal
(A)
250 VAC
400 VAC
24 VDC
48 VDC
AC-13
AC-13
DC-13
DC-13
16
12
12
233
SIDERMAT combination
Accessories (continued)
Fuse blown indication
Use
For DIN fuse cartridges with striker.
Electrical principle
A NO/ NC auxiliary contacts detects that the fuse has blown.
No. of poles
Position AC
Reference
3/4 P
1st
included
630 1800
Characteristics
Electrical characteristics
30 000 operations.
Nominal
current (A)
250 VAC
400 VAC
24 VDC
48 VDC
AC-13
AC-13
DC-13
DC-13
16
12
12
630 1800
Terminal shrouds
Rating (A)
Advantages
Perforations allowing remote thermographic
inspection without removal.
No. of poles
Position
Reference
630
3P
top
630
4P
top
3998 3063
3998 4063
acces_212_a_2_cat
Use
Top or bottom protection against direct
contact with terminals or connection parts.
Terminal screens
Use
Top or bottom protection against direct
contact with terminals or connection parts.
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Position
Reference
800 1600
3P
top
800 1600
4P
top
1800
3P
top
1800
4P
top
2998 3120
2998 4120
2998 3180
2998 4180
3/4 P
bottom
included
800 1800
Use
Safety isolation between the terminals,
essential for use at 690 VAC or in a polluted
or dusty atmosphere.
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Reference
1250 1800
3P
1250 1800
4P
2998 0003
2998 0004
acces_036_a_1_cat
Operation
Reference
630 1800
front direct
3999 8104
Operation
Reference
630 1250
front direct
1600 1800
front direct
630 1800
external front
3999 7007
3999 6117
1499 7701
234
acces_010_b_1_x_cat
Use
Locking in position 0 of the front
operation handle:
- using a padlock (not supplied) and the
factory integrated padlocking function
of the handle.
- using RONIS 1104 A lock
JDX!"SNADLNTMSDCCHQDBSKX
on the padlockable handle,
- locking using RONIS EL11AP lock
(not supplied).
SIDERMAT combination
630 A
800 A
1250 A
1600 A
2x4
1800 A
2x4
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
12
12
12
12
12
Utilisation category
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1600/1600
1600/1800
1600/1600
400 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
630/630
630/630
1250/1250
1600/1600
690 VAC(2)
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1600/1600
690 VAC(2)
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
500/630
630/800
1000/1000
1250/1250
690 VAC(2)
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
400/500
500/500
800/800
1000/1000
220 VDC
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1600/1600
220 VDC
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1600/1600
220 VDC
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
500/630
630/800
1250/1250
1250/1250
440 VDC
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1600/1600
440 VDC
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1600/1600
440 VDC
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
630/630(3)
800/800(3)
1250/1250(4)
1600/1600(4)
440 VDC
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
500/630(3)
630/800(3)
1250/1250(4)
1250/1250(4)
355/355
355/355
710/710
900/900
400/475
475/475
750/750
900/900
355/355
450/450
710/710
900/900
475/600
600/750
900/900
1100/1100
290
365
575
100
100
100
120
120
630
800
1250
2 x 800
2 x 900
55
80
100
120
120
Short-circuit capacity
Rated peak withstand current (kA peak)(6)
Connection
Minimum Cu cable section (mm2)
2 x 150
2 x 185
2 x 30 x 5
2 x 40 x 5
2 x 60 x 5
2 x 80 x 5
2 x 300
2 x 300
4 x 185
6 x 240
8 x 240
50
63
100
100
100
20
20
40
4 x 240
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
5000
5000
5000
3000
3000
20
25
27
54
59
24
30
32
70
75
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) With terminal shrouds or phase barrier.
(3) Poles cannot be juxtaposed.
(4) 4-pole device with 2 pole in series by polarity.
(5) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer to another.
(6) For a rated operational voltage Ue = 400 VAC.
235
SIDERMAT combination
Dimensions
SIDERMAT combination 630 A
Direct front operation
327
111
60
4 10
8 13 80 80 73.5
3p: 307 - 4p: 387
sdmat_006_c_1_x_cat
190
60 15
515
665
175
2
114
145
75
4 10
120
91
190
sdmat_005_a_1_x_cat
120
75 15
765
585
165
2
109
158
4 11
2
8
120
120
91
236
118
sdmat_013_a_1_x_cat
190
38
778
748
240
SIDERMAT combination
432
160
1
190
38
sdmat_014_e_1_x_cat
778
748
240
4 11
2
8
120
120
91
118
Connection terminals
40
90
17 25
19 25 19
63
SIDERMAT combination
1600 A - top
13
SIDERMAT combination
1800 A - top
80
100
40
50
13
40 20
20 40
13
16 x 11
sdmat_059_a_1_x_cat
SIDERMAT combination
1600 to 1800 A - bottom
sider_074_a_1_x_cat
30
33
50
sdmat_055_a_1_x_cat
10
30
33
sdmat_052_a_1_x_cat
15
19 x 11
sdmat_054_a_1_x_cat
SIDERMAT combination
800 to 1250 A
40 20
237
FUSOMAT
Visible breaking and tripping fuse switches
from 250 to 1250 A
Fuse protection
fusom_063_b_1_cat
Strong points
> Tripping upon overload.
> High breaking capacity.
> Improved safety.
A complete range
Function
FUSOMAT are manually controlled tri- or
tetrapolar fuse combination switches.
They can be tripped remotely.
They break or switch off on load and provide
safety isolation and protection against
overcurrent for any low voltage electrical
circuit.
Advantages
Tripping upon overload
Remote breaking by voltage release device.
High breaking capacity
Protection against overloads and shortcircuits thanks to high breaking capacity fuses
(100 kA rms).
Improved safety
q Double break per phase (top and bottom
of fuse - up to 630 A (NFC/DIN) and 800 A
(BS88).
q Positive break indication.
q IP2X protection with
terminal shrouds front panel.
Configurations
5
6
3
2
1
238
fusom_060_b_1_x_cat
Conformity to standards
>
>
>
>
>
IEC 60947-3
EN 60947-3
VDE 0660-107
NBN EN 60947-3
BS 88
FUSOMAT
Visible breaking and tripping fuse switches
from 250 to 1250 A
References
BS88 - Front and side operation - Switch body with a shunt trip coil - 230 VAC
Rating (A)
Fuse (1)
Front
No. of
operation
poles Switch body
Side
operation
Switch body
3P
3660 3026
3665 3026
4P
3660 6026
3665 6026
Direct
handle(2)
External
handle
Shaft for
external
handle
Auxiliary
contact
position
Auxiliary
contact
tripping
Terminal
shrouds(3)
Terminal
screens(4)
Inter phase
barrier
250 A
B1-B2-B3
400 A
B1-B2B3-B4
3P
3660 3041
3665 3041
4P
3660 6041
3665 6041
3P
3660 3064
4P
3998 4040
3999 6201
Side
operation
Black
3999 6012
3P
3998 3040
Front
operation
Black
3665 3064
S3 type
Front
operation
Black IP55
1431 3511(2)
630 A
C1-C2
Red IP55
4P
3P
3660 6064
3660 3080
3665 6064
3660 6080
3665 6080
3P
3660 3121
3665 3121
4P
3660 6121
3665 6121
1250 A
D1
1401 1520
320 mm
1401 1532(2)
Side operation
Side operation
200 mm
Black IP55
1435 3511(2)
3665 3080
800 A
C1-C2-C3
4P
1432 3511
Front
operation
200 mm
Front
operation
Black
3999 6012
Side
operation
Black
1st contact
NO/NC
3999 0051
1 contact
NO/NC
2nd contact
NO/NC
3999 0031
3998 3063
3998 4063
3999 0052
1403 1520
Red IP55
1436 3511
3P
3998 3120
4P
39984120
3P
2998 0003
4P
2998 0004
3999 6012
(1) For the fuses: see page 230 "BS88 industrial fuselinks".
(2) Standard.
(3) Top/bottom.
(4) Bottom terminals protection screen as standard.
239
FUSOMAT
Visible breaking and tripping fuse switches
from 250 to 1250 A
References
NFC and DIN - Front operation - Switch body with a shunt trip coil - 230 VAC
Rating (A)
Fuse
No. of
poles
Switch
body
3P
3650 3026
4P
3650 6026
3P
3650 3041
Direct
handle
External
handle
Shaft for
external
handle
Auxiliary
contact
position
Auxiliary
contact
tripping
1st Fuse
blown AC
Terminal
shrouds
(1 piece)
Terminal
screens
top
Inter
phase
barrier
250 A / 1
Black
400 A / 2
3P
3P
3994 1304
3998 3040(2)
4P
4P
3994 1404
3998 4040(2)
3999 6201(1)
4P
3650 6041
3P
3650 3064
4P
3650 6064
S3 type
Black
IP55
200 mm
1st contact
NO/NC
1431 3511(1)
1401 1520
3999 0051
1 contact
NO/NC
S3 type
Red/yellow
IP55
320 mm
2nd contact
NO/NC
3999 0031
1401 1532(1)
630 A / 3
3999 0052
3P
3994 1306
4P
3994 1406
3P
3998 3063(2)
4P
3998 4063(2)
1432 3511
3P
3650 3080
4P
3650 6080
800 A / 4
3P
Black
3999 6012(1)
3P
3650 3121
4P
3650 6121
1250 A / 4
(1) Standard.
(2) Top/bottom.
(3) Bottom terminals protection screen as standard.
240
3994 1312
4P
3994 1412
3P
3P
3998 3120(3)
2998 0003
4P
4P
3998 4120(3)
2998 0004
FUSOMAT
Visible breaking and tripping fuse switches
from 250 to 1250 A
NFC and DIN - Side operation - Switch body with a shunt trip coil - 230 VAC
Rating (A)
Fuse
No. of
poles Switch body Direct handle
3P
3655 3026
4P
3655 6026
3P
3655 3041
4P
3655 6041
External
handle
Shaft for
external
handle
Auxiliary
contact
position
Auxiliary
contact
tripping
1st Fuse
blown AC
Terminal
shrouds
(1 piece)
250 A
/1
400 A
/2
3P
S3 type
Black
IP55
3655 3064
Black
630 A
/3
3999 6012(1)
4P
3655 6064
1435 3511(1)
S3 type
Red
IP55
1st contact
NO/NC
200 mm
1403 1520
3999 0051
1 contact
NO/NC
2nd contact
NO/NC
3999 0031
3P
3P
3994 1304
3998 3040(2)
4P
4P
3994 1404
3998 4040(2)
3994 1306
3998 3063(2)
3994 1406
3998 4063(2)
3999 0052
1436 3511
3P
3655 3080
4P
3655 6080
3P
3655 3121
4P
3655 6121
800 A
/4
3P
3994 1312
4P
3994 1412
3P
3P
3998 3120(3)
2998 0003
4P
4P
3998 4120(3)
2998 0004
1250 A / 4
(1) Standard.
(2) Top/bottom.
(3) Bottom terminals protection screen as standard.
241
FUSOMAT
Visible breaking and tripping fuse switches
from 250 to 1250 A
Accessories
Direct handle
Front operation
Rating (A)
250 630
800 1250
250 1250
Handle colour
Black
Black
Red
Reference
Side operation
Rating (A)
250 1250
250 1250
Handle colour
Black
Red
Reference
acces_156_a_2_cat
3999 6201
3999 6012
consult us
3999 6012
3999 6013
External handle
Rating (A)
250 1250
250 1250
Handle
type
S3
S3
Handle colour
Black
Red
External IP
IP55
IP55
Reference
Handle
type
S3
S3
Handle colour
Black
Red
External IP
IP55
IP55
Reference
1431 3511
1432 3511
acces_151_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
250 1250
250 1250
Side operation
acces_166_a_2_cat
Front operation
1435 3511
1436 3511
S3 type handle
S3 type handle
Handle colour
To be ordered
in multiples of
External IP(1)
Reference
IP65
1493 0000
Black
acces_187_a_1_cat
Dimensions
Adds 12 mm to the depth.
Use
Enables S-type handles to be fitted in
place of existing older style Socomec
handles.
Handle
Reference
Light grey
50
S3 type
Dark grey
50
S3 type
Light grey
50
S4 type
Dark grey
50
S4 type
1401 0001
1401 0011
1401 0031
1401 0041
Colour
acces_198_a_2_cat
To be ordered
in multiples of
Use
Standard lengths:
- 200 mm
- 320 mm.
Type
15 x 12
15 x 12
15 x 12
15 x 12
Reference
1401 1520
1401 1532
1401 1520
1401 1532
Side operation
Rating (A)
250 1250
242
Dimension Y (mm)
Type
Reference
78 200
200
15 x 12
1403 1520
acces_203_a_1_x_cat
acces_202_a_1_x_cat
Front operation
Rating (A)
Dimension X (mm)
250 400
300 422
250 400
300 542
630 1250
345 467
630 1250
345 587
acces_144_b_1_cat
FUSOMAT
Visible breaking and tripping fuse switches
from 250 to 1250 A
Auxiliary contact
Connection to the control circuit
By 6.35 mm fast-on terminal.
Characteristics
Auxiliary contact NO/NC IP2.
Electrical characteristics
30 000 operations.
Use
Pre-break and signalling of positions 0 and I:
1 to 2 NO/NC auxiliary contacts.
Coil tripping
1 to 2 NO/NC auxiliary contacts.
Current
nominal (A)
16
250 VAC
AC-13
12
48 VDC
DC-13
6
48 VDC
DC-13
2
Current
nominal (A)
16
250 VAC
AC-13
12
Reference
3999 0051
3999 0052
consult us
Reference
3999 0111
3999 0112
acces_048_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
250 1250
250 1250
630 1250
Position AC
Reference
250 1250
1 AC
3999 0031
3990 1024
3990 1048
3990 1110
3990 1220
3990 1380
3990 2012
3990 2024
3990 2048
3990 2220
3990 2220
3991 1024
3991 1048
3991 1110
3990 3024
3990 3048
3990 3110
3990 3220
3990 3380
3990 4012
3990 4024
3990 4048
3990 4110
3990 4220
3991 3024
3991 3048
3991 3110
3991 3220
3991 3380
3991 4012
3991 4024
3991 4048
3991 4110
3991 4220
included
3991 1380
3991 2012
3991 2024
3991 2048
3991 2220
Voltage
24 VAC
48 VAC
110 VAC
230 VAC
400 VAC
12 VDC
24 VDC
48 VDC
110 / 200 VDC
220 VDC
Use
Omnipolar breaking remotely controlled by shunt trip or
undervoltage voltage release coil.
Note: the shunt trip coil must not be supplied for more
than 5 s.
A 230 VAC shunt trip coil is fitted to the standard switch
body. To modify this coil, the reference opposite must be
added to the switch reference.
Examples for ordering:
q FUSOMAT with shunt trip coil 230 VAC - 1 reference:
FUSOMAT 250 A, 3 pole, front operation,
reference 3650 3026.
q FUSOMAT fitted with a non standard coil - 2 references:
FUSOMAT 250 A, 3 pole, front operation, fitted with a
110 VAC undervoltage trip coil: 3650 3026 + 3991 3110.
acces_049_a_1_cat
Reference
3992 3230
3992 3400
243
FUSOMAT
Visible breaking and tripping fuse switches
from 250 to 1250 A
Accessories (continued)
Current-reducing resistor for undervoltage trip coil
Use
Reduces, by limiting the current, the effects
on the undervoltage coils used in continuous
processes or processes exposed to high
ambient temperatures.
Voltage
Reference
110 VAC
3999 3112
3999 3230
3999 3400
3999 4110
230 VAC
400 VAC
110 VDC
Use
For DIN fuse cartridge with striker.
Electrical principle
A NO/NC auxiliary contact detects that the fuse
has blown.
Connection to the control circuit
By 6.35 mm fast-on terminal.
Electrical characteristics
30 000 operations.
Current
nominal (A)
250 VAC
400 VAC
24 VDC
48 VDC
AC-13
AC-13
DC-13
DC-13
16
12
12
No. of poles
Position AC
Reference
250 400
3P
1st
250 400
4P
1st
630
3P
1st
630
4P
1st
800 1250
3P
1st
3994 1304
3994 1404
3994 1306
3994 1406
3994 1312
3994 1412
3994 1902
800 1250
4P
1st
250 1250
3/4 P
2nd
Terminal shrouds
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Position
Reference
250 400
3P
top or bottom
250 400
4P
top or bottom
630
3P
top or bottom
630
4P
top or bottom
3998 3040(1)
3998 4040(2)
3998 3063(1)
3998 4063(2)
acces_213_b_1_cat
Advantage
Perforations allowing
remote thermographic
inspection without removal.
Use
Top or bottom protection
against direct contact with
terminals or connection
parts.
Terminal screen
Rating (A)
244
No. of poles
Position
Reference
800 1250
3P
top
800 1250
4P
top
3998 3120
3998 4120
800 1250
3/4 P
bottom
included
fusom_059_a_1_cat
Use
Top or bottom protection against direct contact with
terminals or connecting parts.
FUSOMAT
Visible breaking and tripping fuse switches
from 250 to 1250 A
Cage terminals
Use
Connection of bare copper cables onto the terminals (without lugs).
References
No. of poles
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
Reference
5400 3025
5400 4025
5400 3040
5400 4040
5400 3063
5400 4063
acces_053_a_1_cat
Connections
Stripped
over (mm)
16 185
16 185
18
27
400
50 240
50 300
20
34
70 300
70 300
24
34
X1
Dimensions
Rating (A)
A1
X1
250
62
31.5
31.5
25
10.5
M16
14
400
71.5
32
38
32
10.5
M20
15
76.5
37
38
40
12.5
M20
15
acces_092_a_1_x_cat
250
acces_091_a_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
X
Z
R
C
A
A1
acces_010_b_1_x_cat
q
q
q
q
q
Operation
front direct
Reference
3999 8104
Operation
Reference
250 1800
external
1600 1800
front direct
1499 7701
3999 6117
Operation
Reference
external
1499 7702
250 1250
Label holder
Dimensions W x H (mm)
To be ordered in multiples of
Reference
50
7769 9999
18 x 13
acces_044_a_1_cat
Use
Recognisable self-adhesive label allowing identification of the devices.
245
FUSOMAT
Visible breaking and tripping fuse switches
from 250 to 1250 A
250 A
400 A
630 A
800 A
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
12
12
12
12
12
Utilisation category
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
400 VAC
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
250/250
400/400
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
400 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
250/250
400/400
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
400 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
250/250
400/400
630/630
800/800
1000/1000
690 VAC(2)
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
200/200
315/400
500/630
800/800
800/1250
690 VAC(2)
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
200/200
315/400
500/630
800/800
800/1000
690 VAC(2)
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
200/200
250/315
315/400
630/630
630/630
220 VDC
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
200/200
315/315
400/630
800/800
800/1250
220 VDC
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
200/200
315/315
315/630
800/800
800/1250
220 VDC
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
200/200
200/315
400/630
800/800
800/1000
440 VDC
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
200/200
315/315
400/630(3)
800/800(4)
800/1250(4)
440 VDC
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
200/200
315/315(3)
315/630(3)
800/800(4)
800/1250(4)
440 VDC
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
200/200
200/315(3)
400/630(3)
800/800(4)
800/1000(4)
132/132
220/220
355/355
450/450
560/560
185/185
220/295
295/400
400/400
600/600
115
185
290
365
575
80/100
80/100
80/100
80/100
80/100
250
400
630
800
1250
30
45
60
80
80
95
185
2 x 30 x 5
1250 A
Short-circuit capacity
Rated peak withstand current (kA peak)(6)
Connection
Min. connection wire range
Minimum Cu busbar section (mm2)
2 x 150
2 x 60 x 5
2 x 60 x 5
240
240
2 x 300
4 x 185
4 x 185
40
40
50
100
100
20
20
40
20
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
8000
8000
5000
5000
5000
16
28
28
8.5
9.5
19
33
33
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) With terminal shrouds or phase barrier.
(3) Poles cannot be juxtaposed.
(4) 4-pole device with 2 pole in series by polarity.
(5) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer to another.
(6) For a rated operational voltage Ue = 400 VAC.
246
FUSOMAT
Visible breaking and tripping fuse switches
from 250 to 1250 A
Dimensions
Front operation
BS88 - FUSOMAT 250 to 800 A
NFC and DIN - FUSOMAT 250 to 630 A
Direct front operation
F
M
P
U
210
190
V2
fusom_046_d_1_x_cat
AC
B
AA
BA
K1
V1
H
C
E min.
61
1. Terminal shrouds.
2. Reset 70.
Terminal
shrouds
Dimensions
Rating (A) A 3p. A 4p.
250
400
Switch body
X X
U V1 V2 W 3p. 4p. Y
F 3p. F 4p.
285
7 65 32 35 43 11 31 46 3 67 238 208
285
7 65 32 35 43 13 31 46 5 69 238 208
495
380
435
495
Connection
P P
N 3p. 4p. R T
AC
435
Switch mounting
J
J
3p. 4p. K1
AA BA
380
630
470
345,5 425,5 268 308 388 150 250 250 20 100 9 80 50 50 50 13 36 65 7 72 300 260
800
470
345,5 425,5 268 308 388 150 250 250 20 100 9 80 50 50 50 13 36 65 7 72 300
330
106
76
80
16
1
4
68
190
165
509
363
250
fusom_048_f_1_x_cat
210
F
M
9
43 120
59
250
187
3
E min.
61
433
Overall dimensions
Rating (A)
Switch body
Switch mounting
A 3p.
A 4p.
E min
F 3p.
F 4p.
J 3p.
J 4p.
M 3p.
M 4p.
800(1)
582
702
345
437
557
399.5
519.5
345
465
1250
582
702
345
437
557
399.5
519.5
345
465
247
FUSERBLOC UL
Fusible disconnect switches UL and CSA
30 to 800 A
Fuse protection
ul_004_a
fuser-ul_006_a
Strong points
Function
FUSERBLOC UL fusible disconnect switches are heavy duty switches that break and make
power circuits on and off load.
The switches employ double break contacts per pole that ensure complete isolation of the fuse
when the switch is in the OFF position. These switches are extremely durable and are tested
and approved for use in the most demanding applications.
The TEST position function is enabled with handles with the TEST position. This function tests
the control circuit auxiliaries without switching the main contacts. It is a simple alternative to a
separately wired push button.
Advantages
Improved safety
q On load make and break power circuit
applications.
q Double break by phase.
q Touch safe covers.
High breaking capacity.
q Up to 200 kA Short circuit rating.
248
Conformity to standards(1)
> IEC 60947-3
> NFPA79
(2002 Edition)
> UL489,
Guide WJAZ,
file E255272
(Frame size 1 and 2)
> UL98, Guide WHTY,
file E201138
(Frame sizes 3 to 8)
> CSA22.2 #5,
&ODVV}ILOH}
(Frame size 1 and 2)
> &6$&ODVV}
ILOH}
(Frame sizes 3 to 8)
(1) Product reference on request.
FUSERBLOC UL
Fusible disconnect switches UL and CSA
30 to 800 A
References
Fusible disconnect
Rating (A)
Fuses
Frame size
CD 30 A
CC
1
No. of poles
Switch body
3P
3710 3003
3 P + switched
neutral
3 P + solid
neutral
3710 4003
1405 0620
S0 type
Black IP65
I-0
1, 3R, 12
320 mm
12.6 inches
1405 0632
1493 0111
3710 5003
Terminal
shrouds
S0 type
200 mm
7.9 inches
Black
3729 4012
NFPA79 kit
U type
auxiliary
contacts
4, 4X
400 mm
15.7 inches
149D 0111
1405 0640
S1 type
Black IP65
I-0
1, 3R, 12
S1 type
200 mm
7.9 inches
141F 2111
4, 4X
320 mm
12.6 inches
141D 2111
1401 0532
3729 4532
3P
CD 30 A
J
2
3 P + switched
neutral
3710 3004
3710 4004
3729 4014
1401 0520
400 mm
15.7 inches
1401 0540
3 P + solid
neutral
3710 5004
1 contact NC
3999 0701
1 contact NO
standard
3999 0702
30 A
J
4
2P
3861 2004
3P
3861 3004
4P
3861 6004
Black
3629 7910
2P
3861 2005
S1 type
Black
I-0
1, 3R, 12
Defeatable
S1 type
Black I - 0 4, 4X
141F 2111
141H 6111
I-0
4, 4X
Defeatable
S1 type
Red / yellow
I-0
4, 4X
320 mm
12.6 inches
141I 6111
1400 1032
141D 2111
I - 0 - Test
4, 4X
Defeatable
60 A
J
4
3P
3861 3005
4P
3861 6005
S1 type
200 mm
7.9 inches
1400 1020
3729 7540
141D 2115
249
FUSERBLOC UL
Fusible disconnect switches UL and CSA
30 to 800 A
References (continued)
Rating (A)
fuses
Frame size
No. of
poles
Switch body
2P
3861 2006
3P
3861 3006
4P
3861 6006
2P
3861 2010
3P
3861 3010
60 A
J
5
100 A
J
5
Direct handle
Front external
handles
S2 type
Black
I-0
1, 3R, 12
Defeatable
142F 2111
4P
2P
200 A
J
6
3P
4P
3861 6010
3861 2020
Black
3629 7910
3861 3020
3861 6020
Black
I-0
4, 4X Defeatable
Shaft for
External right
side handle(1) external handle
NFPA79 kit
S2 type
Black
I-0
4, 4X
142H 6111
142D 2111
Red / yellow
I - 0 4, 4X
Black
I - 0 - Test
4, 4X Defeatable
142I 6111
S1 type
200 mm
7.9 inches
3729 7540
1400 1020
3898 2020
320 mm
12.6 inches
1400 1032
3898 3020
1 contact type
NC
3999 0701
1 contact type
NO
3861 2038
3898 4020
3898 2038
3999 0702
400 A
J
7
600 A
J
8
3P
3861 3038
4P
3861 6038
2P
3850 2060
3P
3850 3060
4P
3850 6060
2P
800 A
L
8
3850 2080
3P
3850 3080
4P
3850 6080
250
Terminal
shrouds
standard
142D 2115
2P
U type auxiliary
contacts
3729 7544
3898 3038
3898 4038
Black
3859 6011
S3 type
Black
I-0
1, 3R, 12
Defeatable
S3 type
200 mm
7.9 inches
143F 3111
4, 4X Defeatable
320 mm
12.6 inches
143D 3111
1400 1232
1400 1220
2P
3898 2080
3729 7552
3P
3898 3080
4P
3898 4080
FUSERBLOC UL
Fusible disconnect switches UL and CSA
30 to 800 A
NFPA79 accessories
Flange handle for flange operation
Rating (A)
Type
Nema type
Reference
30 200
Standard handle
1, 3, 3R, 4, 12
30 200
1, 3, 3R, 4, 4X, 12
3729 9002(1)
3729 9003(1)
sirco_246_a_1_cat
Use
Meets both UL508A and NFPA79 requirements.
The handle will operate the switch by cable or rod.
Cable operator
Description
Reference
30 ... 200 A
3729 9903
Reference
36
900
60
1500
120
3000
3729 9992
3729 9993
3729 9994
ul_042_b_1
Rating (A)
sirco_247_a_1_cat
Use
Link between the flange handle and the switch, please order the flange handle,
the mechanism and a cable length of your choice.
Rod operator
ul_043_a
Use
Link between the flange handle and the switch. The rod flange is an
economical solution, please order the flange handle and a rod kit.
Rating 30 ... 200 A
For enclosure depth (inches)
Reference
203 613
3729 9904
8 24
Rating (A)
Reference
CD 30, frame 1 - 2
3729 4532
3729 7540
3729 7544
3729 7552
30 200, frame 3 to 6
400, frame 7
600 800, frame 8
ul_121_b
Use
Meets both UL508A and NFPA79 requirements.
Allows retrofitt of your installations for ratings from 30 to 800 A.
Please order an S-type external handle separately.
251
FUSERBLOC UL
Fusible disconnect switches UL and CSA
30 to 800 A
Accessories
Colour
fuses
Fig.
Reference
CD 30
Black
CC
CD 30
Black
30 ... 400
Black
Black
J/L
3729 4012
3729 4014
3629 7910
3859 6011
acces_261_a
Rating (A)
acces_147_a_2_cat
Direct handle
Fig.1
Fig. 2
External handle
Use
The locking function of the front external
handle prevents the user from opening the
door of the enclosure when the switch is in
the "ON" position, and when the switch is
padlocked in the OFF position (S1, S2, S3
and S4 type handles only).
Front operation
S0 type handle
Standard
Heavy duty
Reference
Test
Handle colour
Reference
I-0
Black
1, 3R, 12
I-0
Red/Yellow
4, 4X
I-0
Black
S0 type
4, 4X
I-0
Red/Yellow
3/4
S1 type
1, 3R, 12
I-0
Black
3/4
S1 type
1, 3R, 12
I-0
Red/Yellow
CD 30 60
3/4
S1 type
4, 4X
I-0
Black
CD 30 60
3/4
S1 type
4, 4X
I-0
Red/Yellow
CD 30 60
3/4
S1 type
4, 4X
I - 0 - Test
Black
CD 30 60
3/4
S1 type
4, 4X
I - 0 - Test
Red/Yellow
5/6/7
S2 type
1, 3R, 12
I-0
Black
60400
5/6/7
S2 type
1, 3R, 12
I-0
Red/Yellow
60400
5/6/7
S2 type
4, 4X
I-0
Black
60400
5/6/7
S2 type
4, 4X
I-0
Red/Yellow
60400
5/6/7
S2 type
4, 4X
I - 0 - Test
Black
142D 2115
142D 2915
60400
5/6/7
S2 type
4, 4X
I - 0 - Test
Red/Yellow
142E 2915
600800
S3 type
1, 3R, 12
I-0
Black
600800
S3 type
1, 3R, 12
I-0
Red/Yellow
600800
S3 type
4, 4X
I-0
Black
600800
S3 type
4, 4X
I-0
Red/Yellow
142E 2115
143F 3111
143G 3111
143D 3111
143E 3111
S0 type
1, 3R, 12
CD 30
S0 type
CD 30
S0 type
CD 30
CD 30 60
CD 30 60
acces_149_a_2_cat
60400
1493 0111
1494 0111
149D 0111
149E 0111
141F 2111
141G 2111
141D 2111
141E 2111
141D 2115
141E 2115
142F 2111
142G 2111
142D 2111
142E 2111
CD 30
S1 type handle
141D 2911
141E 2911
141D 2915
141E 2915
acces_164_a_2_cat
Rating (A)
acces_263_a_2_cat
142D 2911
142E 2911
S2 type handle
143D 3911
143E 3911
252
Standard
Heavy duty
Reference
Reference
Red/Yellow
141H 6111
141I 6111
142H 6111
142I 6111
141H 6911
141I 6911
142H 6911
142I 6911
I-0
Black
consult us
consult us
I-0
Red/Yellow
consult us
consult us
Frame
size
Handle
Nema type
Test
Handle
colour
30 60
3/4
S1 type
4, 4X
I-0
Black
30 60
3/4
S1 type
4, 4X
I-0
Red/Yellow
100 400
5/6/7
S2 type
4, 4X
I-0
Black
100 400
5/6/7
S2 type
4, 4X
I-0
600 800
S3 type
4, 4X
600 800
S3 type
4, 4X
Rating (A)
acces_151_a_1_cat
S3 type handle
FUSERBLOC UL
Fusible disconnect switches UL and CSA
30 to 800 A
Handle colour
Dimensions
Increases distance to door by 12 mm.
Pack qty
Reference
10
IP65
1493 0000
Black
acces_187_a_1_cat
Use
Enables S-type handles to be fitted in place
of existing older style SOCOMEC handles.
Adapter can also be utilised as a spacer to
increase the distance between the panel
door and the handle lever.
Handle colour
Pack qty
Handle
Reference
Light grey
50
S2, S3 type
Dark grey
50
S2, S3 type
1401 0001
1401 0011
1401 0031
1401 0041
Light grey
50
S4 type
Dark grey
50
S4 type
acces_198_a_1_cat
Use
For single lever handleS-type S1, S2, S3 and double lever handle, type S4.
Other colours: please consult us.
Dimensions
X (in)
Dimensions
X (mm)
Handle
Length
(inches)
Length
(mm)
CD 30
S0-type
7.9
200
CD 30
S0-type
12.6
320
CD 30
S0-type
15.7
400
CD 30
S1 type
7.9
200
CD 30
S1 type
12.6
320
CD 30
S1 type
15.7
400
30 ... 100
S2, S3 Type
7.9
200
200
S2, S3 Type
7.9
200
400
S2, S3 Type
7.9
200
30 ... 100
S2, S3 Type
12.6
320
200
S2, S3 Type
12.6
320
400
S2, S3 Type
12.6
320
30 ... 100
S2, S3 Type
15.7
400
200
S2, S3 Type
15.7
400
400
S2, S3 Type
15.7
400
S3 Type
7.9
200
S3 Type
12.6
320
S3 Type
15.7
400
Reference
1405 0620
1405 0632
1405 0640
1401 0520
1401 0532
1401 0540
1400 1020
1400 1020
1400 1020
1400 1032
1400 1032
1400 1032
1400 1040
1400 1040
1400 1040
1400 1220
1400 1232
1400 1240
acces_369_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
acces_145_b_1_cat
acces_202_a_1_cat
Use
Standard lenghts:
- 7.9 in / 200 mm,
- 12.6 in / 320 mm,
- 15.7 in / 400 mm.
253
FUSERBLOC UL
Fusible disconnect switches UL and CSA
30 to 800 A
Accessories (continued)
Shaft guide for external handle
Description
Reference
1429 0000
1419 0000
acces_260_a_2_cat
Use
This accessory enables handle to engage shaft with a misalignment of up to 15 mm.
Required for a shaft length over 400 mm for S1 to S3 handles and for a shaft lenght
from 320 mm for S0 handle.
acces_056_a_1_cat
Use
U type AC can be configured to be
operated on both, standard and TEST
ONRHSHNMRVHSBGDREQNL"#SN
Each slot can accommodate up to
HMSDQKNBJDC "R
- For CD 30A/CC, a maximum of 4 ACs
(8 with an additional holder),
- For CD 30A/J, maximum 2 ACs
(6 with an additional holder),
- For 30 to 200A/J, maximum 4 ACs,
- For 400 to 800A/L, maximum 8 ACs.
Rating (A)
Number of contacts
Reference
3999 0701
Number of contacts
Reference
3999 0702
CD 30 800
NC auxiliary contacts
Rating (A)
CD 30 800
Contact holder for additional auxiliary contacts
Rating (A)
Fuses
Reference
CD 30
CC
CD 30
3999 0710
3999 0710
acces_043_a_1_x_cat
NO auxiliary contacts
Use
Side operated auxiliary contacts for
%42$1!+."SN ONRHSHNM.%%
@MC.-RHFM@KKDCAXSN-.
-"
auxiliary contacts.
NO+NC auxiliary contacts
Number of contacts
Reference
30 800
30 800
3999 U041
3999 U042
acces_083_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
254
FUSERBLOC UL
Fusible disconnect switches UL and CSA
30 to 800 A
Terminal shrouds
Use
Top or bottom protection against direct contact with terminals or connection parts.
2 sets required to fully shroud both line and load terminals.
Reference(1)
as standard
No. of poles
2/3/4 P
2P
3P
4P
2P
3P
4P
2P
3P
4P
3898 2020
3898 3020
3898 4020
3898 2038
3898 3038
3898 4038
3898 2080
3898 3080
3898 4080
fuser_314_a_1_cat
Terminals lugs
Use
Connection of cables to the terminals.
Wires range
#14 - #10
#14 - #10
#10 - #6
#12 - #1
#6 - 300MCM
#6 - 300MCM
#6 - 300MCM
#2 - 600MCM
#2 - 600MCM
#2 - 600MCM
2 x (#6 - 350 MCM)
2 x (#6 - 350 MCM)
2 x (#6 - 350 MCM)
2 x (#2 - 600MCM)
2 x (#2 - 600MCM)
2 x (#2 - 600MCM)
2
3
4
2
3
4
2
3
4
2
3
4
Wires
Cu
Cu
Cu
Cu
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Reference
as standard
as standard
as standard
as standard
ul_032_a
Rating (A)
CD 30
30
30 60
60 100
200
200
200
400
400
400
400
400
400
600
600
600
3954 2020
3954 3020
3954 4020
3954 2040
3954 3040
3954 4040
3954 2041
3954 3041
3954 4041
3954 2060
3954 3060
3954 4060
Solid links
Fuses
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J
J/L
J/L
Reference
3799 9006
3799 8006
3799 9010
3799 8010
3799 9020
3799 8020
3799 9040
3799 8040
3799 9080
3799 8080
fuser-ul_013_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
60
60
100
100
200
200
400
400
600 800
600 800
No. of poles
3P
3P
3P
3P
3P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
Reference
3729 8010
3729 8020
3729 8040
3729 8060
3729 8080
3729 9010
3729 9020
3729 9040
3729 9060
3729 9080
fuser-ul_014_b_1_cat
Rating (A)
100
200
400
600
800
100
200
400
600
800
255
FUSERBLOC UL
Fusible disconnect switches UL and CSA
30 to 800 A
CD 30A(3)
30A
60A
60A
100A
200A
400A
600A
800A
100
100
200
100
200
200
200
200
200
200
Type of fuse
CC
30
30
30
60
60
100
200
400
600
800
7.5 / 22
7.5 / 22
7.5 / 22
15 / 42
15 / 42
30 / 80
60 / 154
125 / 312
200 / 480
200 / 480
440-480 VAC
15 / 21
15 / 21
15 / 21
30 / 40
30 / 40
60 / 77
125 / 156
250 / 302
500 / 590
500 / 590
500 / 472
500 / 472
600 VAC
20 / 22
20 / 22
20 / 22
50 / 52
50 / 52
75 / 77
150 / 144
350 / 336
125 VDC(1)
3 / 25
3 / 25
3 / 25
3 / 25
3 / 25
7.5 / 58
15 / 112
20 / 148
250 VDC(2)
5 / 20
5 / 20
5 / 20
10 / 38
10 / 38
20 / 38
40 / 140
50 / 173
10 000
10 000
10 000
10 000
10 000
10 000
8 000
6 000
5 000
5 000
#14
#14
#10
#10
#12
#12
#6
#2 or 2 x #6
2 x #2
2 x #2
Mechanical endurance
Endurance (number of operating cycles)
Connection
Min. connection cross-section/ (mm2)(2)
2 (2)
#10
#10
#6
#6
#1
#1
600MCM or
2 x 600MCM 2 x 600MCM
2 x 350MCM
300MCM
Dimensions (in/mm)
FUSERBLOC CD 30 A / CC - Frame size 1
F
Z
J1
fuser_655_a_1_x_cat
AA
N1
H1
Switch body
Rating (A) / Fuse
CD 30 A / CC
256
Switch mounting
Connection
Unit
H1
J1
N1
AA
in
3.78
3.28
5.19
1.47
0.59
3.13
4.56
1.12
mm
96
83.5
132
37.5
15
79.5
25.5
116
28.5
FUSERBLOC UL
Fusible disconnect switches UL and CSA
30 to 800 A
J1
Switch body
Rating (A) / Fuse
CD 30 A / J
fuser_656_a_1_x_cat
AA
N1
Switch mounting
Connection
Unit
J1
N1
AA
in
4.13
3.89
1.47
0.59
3.30
4.56
1.12
mm
105
99
37.5
15
84
25.5
116
28.5
1.41
36
fuser-ul_001_a_1_x_cat
1.46
37.2
4.84
123
4.02
102.1
5.35
136
5.87
149.3
1.41
36
257
FUSERBLOC UL
Fusible disconnect switches UL and CSA
30 to 800 A
Dimensions (continued)
FUSERBLOC 60 to 100 A / J - Frame size 5
1.41
36
fuser-ul_002_a_1_x_cat
1.46
37.2
4.81
122.2
5.23
133
6.77
172
7.32
186
5.87
149.3
1.41
36
1.41
36
5.11
130
Note for width:
For 2 pole device decrease overall width by 1.96/50mm.
For 4 pole device increase overall width by 1.96/50mm.
258
1.96
50
fuser-ul_003_a_1_x_cat
11.46
291.3
7.67
195
6.50
165.2
5.28
134.2
6.18
157
FUSERBLOC UL
Fusible disconnect switches UL and CSA
30 to 800 A
66
66
fuser-ul_004_c_1_x_cat
194
209
240
75
24.9
101.25
390
202.5
101.25
75
111.1
83
6.10
155
3.36
85.5
min 10.43
min 265
9.84
250
0.43
11
2.32
59
14.96
380
Note for width:
For 2 pole device decrease overall 3 pole width by 3.7/94mm.
0.51
13
fuser_631_b_1_gb_cat
18.54
471
fix 9.84
fix 250
5
126.5
10.23
260
11.81
300
3.36
85.5
0.27
7
11.81
300
0.27
7
3.54
90
0.27
7
3.12
79.5
0.35
9
2
51 3.7
3.7
94
94
14.33 (3P) - 18.03 (4P)
364 (3P) - 458 (4P)
259
FUSERBLOC UL
Fusible disconnect switches UL and CSA
30 to 800 A
Dimensions (continued)
FUSERBLOC 30 to 400 A
sirco_267_b_1_x_cat
7.48
190
sirco-ul_027_a_1_x_cat
1.79
45.5
5.31
135
1.57
40
3.35
85
Front operation
Side operation
Direction of operation
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S0 type
I
3.07
78
90
3.46
88
I
90
40
47
0
28
1.45
37
31
With xing nut
0.53
13.5
fuser-ul_015_a_1_gb_cat
0.11
3
0.88
22.5
FUSERBLOC CD 30 to 60 A - Frames 1 / 2 / 4
Side operation(1)
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
Door drilling
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S1 type
1.73
44
TEST
260
0.78
20
0.55
14
0.55
14
0.78
20
0
65
2.75
70
1.46
37
4 0.27
47
0.55
14
0.55
14
fuser-ul_015_b_1_gb_cat
3.07
78
9
0.78
20
90
1.46
37
4 0.27
47
0.78
20
FUSERBLOC UL
Fusible disconnect switches UL and CSA
30 to 800 A
Direction of operation
Side operation
Door drilling
Direction of operation
S2 type
Door drilling
I
0.78
20
0.55
14
0.55
14
fuser-ul_016_b_1_gb_cat
0.78
20
0.55
14
0.55
14
1.77
45
0.78
20
65
4.92
125
1.46
37
4 0.27
47
0.78
20
90
4 0.27
47
3.07
78
90
1.46
37
TEST
Handle type
Door drilling
S3 type
1.46
37
fuser-ul_017_b_1_gb_cat
210
0.78
20
90
4 0.27
47
0.78
20
3.07
78
0.55
14
0.55
14
61
300 kcmil
2
51
2.88
73.15
0.53
13.46
0.40
10.2
2 x 350 kcmil
sirco_116_b_1_x_cat
0.25
6.35
2.87
73
1.19
30.23
sirco-ul_026_a_1_cat
3.15
80
1.25
31.75
sirco-ul_010_a_1_x_cat
1.94
49.30
0.63
15.88
0.44
11.13
sirco_115_b_1_x_cat
1.8
46
600 kcmil
FUSERBLOC 400 A
0.4
4.7
2.8
71.5
0.45
11.6
1.12
28.6
1.52
38.8
FUSERBLOC 400 A
1.3
35
1
25
FUSERBLOC 200 A
261
RM - RMS
new
Strong points
> Improved safety.
> High breaking capacity.
> Specific format and
accessories.
> Label holder.
rm_060_a_1_cat
rm_061_a_1_cat
Large range
RM
32 A
rm_062_a_1_cat
Fuse protection
RM
50 A
RMS
100 A
Function
RM and RMS are modular fuse disconnect switches for cylindrical fuses. They provide safety
disconnection and protection against overloads and short-circuits in any low voltage electrical circuit.
- RM: fuse disconnect switches without signalisation (for fuses without striker).
- RMS: fuse disconnect switches with pre-break, position signalisation and blown indication
auxiliary contact.
Advantages
Improved safety
q Omnipolar and simultaneous breaking.
q High dielectric strength. Protection IP2X.
High breaking capacity
Protection against overloads and shortcircuits thanks to high breaking capacity fuses
(100 kA rms).
262
Conformity to standards
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
IEC 60269-2-1
IEC 60269-1
IEC 60269-2
NF EN 60269-1
NF C 63-210
NF C 63211
VDE 0636-10
DIN 43620
RM - RMS
Fuse disconnect switches
for industrial and high speed cylindrical fuses up to 125 A
References
RM - Device without signalisation
Basic device
Fuse size
No. of poles
32 A
10 x 38
50 A
14 x 51
To be ordered
in multiples of
1P
12
1 P + N (1 module)
12
1 P + N (2 modules)
12
2P
3P
3P+N
Reference
To be ordered
in multiples of
Reference
To be ordered
in multiples of
Reference
5702 5001
5703 5001
5702 5005
5702 0011
5702 5002
5702 5003
5702 5004
5702 5006
5702 5000
5703 5005
5703 0011
5703 5002
5703 5003
5703 5004
5703 5006
5703 5000
5701 0015
5601 5005
5701 0017
5701 0011
5701 0020
5701 0018
5701 0019
6
3
2
1
4P
N
100 A
22 x 58
1
12
5701 0016
6
3
2
1
1
6
To be ordered
in multiples of
Reference
1 P with 1 AC
2 P with 2 AC
3 P with 1 AC
5702 5011
5702 5012
5702 5013
5702 5014
3 P with 1 AC N
3 P + N with 1 AC
4 P with 2 AC
To be ordered
in multiples of
Reference
5703 5011
5703 5012
5703 5013
5703 5014
5703 5016
6
3
2
(1) The signalisation auxiliary contact provides the pre-break, fuse presence and also signals a blown fuse.
Think about it
10x38 RMs equipped with 0.5A gG fuses provide effective protection for voltage inputs and auxiliary
supplies for all our electronic devices (DIRIS, COUNTIS, ISOM, RESYS differential relays, etc.).
263
RM - RMS
Fuse disconnect switches
for industrial and high speed cylindrical fuses up to 125 A
Accessories
Auxiliary contact
Contact type
NO/NC contact
Two level NO/NC contacts
References
NO/NC contact for RMS
Rating (A)
50
50
50
100
100
100
Contact(s)
1 P with 1 AC
3 P with 1 AC
3 P with 2 AC
1 P with 1 AC
3 P with 1 AC
3 P with 2 AC
acces_366_a
acces_367_a
Rating (A)
50 100
50 100
Operating
current Ie (A)
250 VAC
AC-13
5
0.1
Reference
5702 9901
5702 9903
5702 9030
5703 9901
5703 9903
5703 9030
Reference
5702 9911
5702 9913
5703 9911
5703 9913
acces_068_a_1_x_cat
Characteristics
acces_365_a
Use
q Pre-break, presence and fuse blown for RMS 50 and 100:
1 or 2 NO/NC auxiliary contacts
Connection
By 6.35 mm fast-on terminal.
Reference
32
5701 9040
5702 9040
5703 9040
50
100
rm_064_a_1
Rating (A)
rm_063_a_1
rm_058_a_1
Use
Padlocking of the handle (padlock not supplied).
Reference
5704 0003(1)(2)
5702 9020(1)(2)
CLIC !
rm_030_a_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
Rating (A)
Reference
32
5701 9010(3)
264
acces_227_a
RM - RMS
Fuse disconnect switches
for industrial and high speed cylindrical fuses up to 125 A
32 A
10 x 38
690
50 A
14 x 51
690
100 A
22 x 58
690
32
32
50
50
50
100/125
100/125
100/125
100
100
100
1
0.8
0.7
0.6
1
0.8
0.7
0.6
1
0.8
0.7
0.6
1.5
25(3)/16(4)
16(3)/10(4)
2.5
1.5
35(3)/25(4)
1.5
50(3)/35(4)
2.5 3
3.5 4
0.1
0.15
0.31
0.70
0.21
0.44
1.10
gG/aM
Connection
Minimum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Maximum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Maximum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)(2)
Tightening torque
Mechanical characteristics
Weight of 1 P or N (kg)
Weight of 1 P + N (kg)
Weight of 3 p + N (kg)
(1) For a rated operational voltage Ue = 400 VAC.
(2) Connection for RM32 1pole + N (1 module).
Dimensions
Single and multipolar RM / RMS 50 A
70
52,5
35
17,5
58
40
78
45
35,3
20
49,5
106
79,5
53
26,5
110
rm_047_b_1_x_cat
40
100,7
76
rm_027_a_1_x_cat
RM 32 A
40
74,8
49,5
126,5
45
47
rm_028_a_1_x_cat
35,5
49,5
265
Fuse bases
Fuse protection
For NH and high speed (UR) fuses 160 to 2500 A
Fuse protection
socle_066_b_1_cat
socle_046_b_1_cat
Base
size 1
Strong points
Base
IP2X
Function
SOCOMEC fuse bases provide fixed, unipolar or multipolar support for knife edge fuses.
Advantages
High electrical safety
q High dielectric strength.
q Protection IP2X (standard or optional
depending on models).
High breaking capacity
Protection against overloads and shortcircuits thanks to fuses with a high breaking
capacity (100 kA rms).
Functional diagram
Functional diagram
(for further details see
the installation
instructions supplied
with the product).
socle_016_c_1_x_cat
5
3
1. Fuse bases
2. Connecting block:
- block for assembling unipolar bases T00, T0, T1,
T2 and T3,
- screen support for phases T00, T1, T2 and T3
3. Phase separation shield
4. Terminal shrouds (mandatory for mounting
fuse covers)
5. Fuse cover (provides IP2 protection for
any brand of fuse).
266
IP20 kit:
- unipolar = 2 connecting blocks + 2 phase separation
shields + 2 terminal shrouds + 1 cover
- tripolar = 2 connecting blocks for the ends + 2 phase
RDO@Q@SHNMRGHDKCRENQSGDDMCR
SDQLHM@KRGQNTCR
+ 3 covers.
Conformity to standards
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
IEC 60269-1
IEC 60269-2
IEC 60269-2-1
NF EN 60269-1
NF C 63211
VDE 0636-10
DIN 43620
Fuse bases
Fuse protection
For NH and high speed (UR) fuses 160 to 2500 A
References
Fuse bases for fuses with or without a striker from 160 to 630 (U = 690 V)
Back plate mounted device
Rating
Fuse size
160 A
00
160 A
0
250 A
1
400 A
2
630 A
3
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
6500 1010
6500 1030
6501 1010
6501 1030
6501 1011
6501 1031
6501 1012
6501 1032
6501 1013
6501 1033
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
6500 1110
6500 1130
6501 1110
6501 1130
6501 1111
6501 1131
6501 1112
6501 1132
6501 1113
6501 1133
No. of poles
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
1 P (1)
6510 1010
6510 1030
6511 1010
6511 1030
6511 1011
6511 1031
6511 1012
6511 1032
6511 1013
6511 1033
To be ordered
in multiples of
No. of poles
1P
3P
No. of poles
1P
3P
3 P(2)
(1) IP20 single-pole kit consisting of 2 connecting blocks, 2 phase separation shields, 2 terminal shrouds and 1 fuse cover.
(2) IP20 three-pole kit consisting of 2 connecting blocks for the ends, 2 phase separation shields for the ends, 6 terminal shrouds and 3 fuse covers.
Accessories
To be ordered
in multiples of
Description of accessories
Connecting block - set of 1 piece
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
6500 0033
6500 0001
6500 0010
6500 0020
6500 0030
6500 0002
6500 0011
6500 0021
6500 0031
6500 0003
6500 0012
6500 0022
6500 0031
6500 0003
6500 0013
6500 0022
6500 0032
6500 0004
6500 0014
6500 0023
Dimensions
Fuse base 160 A size 00
F
9
18.5
C
D
C
D
N
B
A
Rating
(A)
Fuse
size
160
00
122
100
37
22
86
59.5
23
160
170
150
47
24
122
63
29
250
200
175
60
28
148
77.5
35
400
225
200
60
32
148
88
630
240
210
60
38
148
97
114
38.5
85
74
144
48.5
91.5
80
192
66
123
35
80
192
66
35
80
224
82
M8
25
185
25
7.5
15
250
10
25
30
10.5
20.5
123
250
12
25
30
10.5
20.5
143
270
12
25
30
10.5
20.5
socle_076_a_1_x_cat
P
Q
E
L
N
B
A
Q
E
L
socle_075_a_1_x_cat
267
Fuse bases
Fuse protection
For NH and high speed (UR) fuses 160 to 2500 A
References
Unipolar fuse bases for fuses with a striker from 160 to 630 A (U = 690 V)
Back plate mounted device without AC
Rating
Fuse size
160 A
0
250 A
1
400 A
2
630 A
3
No. of poles
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
1P
6501 1010
6501 1011
6501 1012
6501 1013
No. of poles
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
1P
6501 1110
6501 1111
6501 1112
6501 1113
No. of poles
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
1P
6500 0040
6500 0041
6500 0042
6500 0043
16
16
16
16
Accessories
Presence and fuse blown signalling AC (DDMM)
Characteristics
NO/NC contact
Nominal current In (A) 250 VAC
Dimensions
Fuse base 160 to 630 A size 0, 1, 2 and 3
B
268
socle_057_a_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
Fuse size
160
193
65,5
90
250
215
76
98
400
227
76
102
630
235
76
102
Fuse bases
Fuse protection
For NH and high speed (UR) fuses 160 to 2500 A
References
Multipolar fuse bases for fuses with a striker from 160 to 400 A (U = 690 V)
Back plate mounted device with presence and fuse blown signalling AC (DDMM)
Rating
Fuse size
160 A
0
250 A
1
400 A
2
No. of poles
Reference
Reference
Reference
2P
6301 2016
6301 3016
6301 4016
6301 2024
6301 3024
6301 4024
6301 2039
6301 3039
6301 4039
Reference
Reference
Reference
included
included
included
3994 1901
3994 1901
3994 1901
No. of poles
Reference
Reference
Reference
2P
3998 2016
3998 3016
3998 4016
3998 2025
3998 3025
3998 4025
3998 2025
3998 3025
3998 4025
3P
4P
Auxiliary contacts for fuse blown indication
Position AC
1st AC
2nd
Terminal shrouds (1 piece)
3P
4P
Dimensions
Fuse base 160 to 400 A size 0
socle_044_a_1_x_cat
C1
A
x. J
R
J1
J1
U
B
x. K
J2
J3
Rating
(A)
160
250
400
A 3p.
A 4p.
C1
J1
J2
J3
111
161
211
162
229
136,5
174
50
60
20,5
5,4
140
50
20
2,5
141
8,5
19,5
131
191
251
195
251
146
185
60
60
7,5
6,4
162
60
32
2,5
166
11
19,5
143
209
275
205
260
149
200
66
66
2,5
6,4
172
66
50
175
11
20
269
Fuse bases
Fuse protection
For NH and high speed (UR) fuses 160 to 2500 A
References
Fuse bases for fuses with or without a striker from 1000 to 2500 A (U = 690 V)
Device without presence and fuse blown signalling (DDMM)
Rating
Fuse size
1000 A
4
1250 A
4
2500 A
2x4
2500 A
2 x 4 (S)
No. of poles
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
1P
6431 0004
6431 0005
6431 0006
No. of poles
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
1P
7304 0001
7305 0001
7306 0001
6433 0005
2500 A
6
Reference
6431 0007(1)
Dimensions
Fuse base 1000 to 2500 A size 4
118
90
90
70
9
30
45 30
11
5 13
40
17
25
30
380
25
25
340
socle_006_d_1_x_cat
118
145/188*
125
socle_007_b_1_gb_cat
65
20
T
25
Rating (A)
1000
1250
50
10
31
Y (mm)
25
30
T (mm)
4
9
410
30
25
14
360
25
30
socle_008_b_1_x_cat
100
206
150
socle_024_a_1_x_cat
298
253
181
270
50
40
90
13
25
40
36
20
15
4
50
10
31
Fuse bases
Fuse protection
For NH and high speed (UR) fuses 160 to 2500 A
References
Unipolar fuse bases for UR fuses
L shape bracket 00/80 (distance between centres 80)
690 VAC
1000 VAC
1400 VAC
Type of fuse
Reference
Reference
Reference
200
00 bolted connection
170A 6080
400
00 bolted connection
170H 1007
Type of fuse
1250(1)
Reference
Reference
Reference
170H 3004
from 1* to 3
Type of fuse
1250(1)
Reference
Reference
Reference
170H 3006
from 1* to 3
Dimensions
Bracket 00/80 - 200 A - 1000 VAC
Ref: 170H 1007
M8
80
A-A
M10
145
27
43
A
A
77
60
85
205
126
80
40
4 x 7 (M6)
25
min. 14
socle_054_a_1_x_cat
150
25
socle_052_a_1_x_cat
64
19 6
40.5
50.5
M8
9
M10
110
A-A
M10
27
64
77
M8
A
A
60
85
180
40
socle_053_a_1_x_cat
205
9
M10
271
B2 TF/DD
C1 TM/EF
fusib_154_a_1_cat
A2 TIA/AAO
fusib_142_a_1_cat
fusib_141_a_1_cat
fusib_139_a_1_cat
A1 NIT/NITD
Strong points
fusib_135_a_1_cat
fusib_134_a_1_cat
Conformity to standards(1)
D1 TLU/GH
F2 ES/ESD
Function
SOCOMEC industrial fuses protect installations and people against overcurrents for any low
voltage electrical circuit.
High reliability
q Absolute protection over time guaranteed
by the simplicity of manufacture and
function (Joule effect).
Safety
q The energy given off whilst eliminating the
fault is contained within the cartridge.
272
IEC 60269-1
IEC 60269-2
IEC 60269-2-1
NF EN 60269-1
NF C 63-210
NF C 63211
VDE 0636-10
DIN 43620
Advantages
High level performance
q High breaking capacity 120 kA at 500 V,
80 kA at 690 V.
q High short-cicuit limitation capacity.
q Simple, reliable discrimination.
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
Available on request
> EDF application:
T2 fuses, in accordance
with standard HN 63 - S20.
> 690 V knife-edge fuses.
> UL and CSA fuses for
North American markets.
References
Distribution industrial fuselinks (type gG)
F1(1)
NS / NSD
Rating
(A)
Voltage
(VAC)
F2(1)
ES / ESD
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
6F10 0002
6F10 0004
6F10 0006
6F10 0010
6F10 0016
6F10 0020
6F10 0025
6F10 0032
550
550
6A10 0002
6A10 0004
6A10 0006
6A10 0010
6A10 0016
6A10 0020
6A10 0025
6A10 0032
550
6A20 0002
6A20 0004
6A20 0006
6A20 0010
6A20 0016
6A20 0020
6A20 0025
6A20 0032
40
550
50
550
63
550
6F20 0063
550
550
550
10
550
16
550
20
550
25
550
32
550
550
550
550
550
550
550
550
A3(1)
OS / OSD
Rating Voltage
(A)
(VAC)
A2(1)
TIA / AAO
Reference
6F20 0002
6F20 0004
6F20 0006
6F20 0010
6F20 0016
6F20 0020
6F20 0025
6F20 0032
6F20 0040
6F20 0050
A1(1)
NIT / NITD
Reference
550
550
550
550
550
550
550
Reference
550
550
550
550
550
550
A4(1)
TFP / DEO
Reference
550
550
550
10
550
16
550
20
550
6B10 0002
6B10 0004
6B10 0006
6B10 0010
6B10 0016
6B10 0020
6B10 0025
6B10 0032
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
25
550
40
550
50
550
63
550
80
550
100
550
6A30 0080
6A30 0100
550
550
6A40 0032
6A40 0040
6A40 0050
6A40 0063
6A40 0080
6A40 0100
550
B1(1)
TBC / BD
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
550
6B10 0040
6B10 0050
6B10 0063
550
415
160
415
200
415
6A40 0125
6A40 0160
6A40 0200
(3) Centre bolted tag type fuselinks.
Note: pack quantity 3 pieces for each product.
B1(1)
TC / CD
B2(1)
TF / DD
CI(1)
TKM / EFS
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
125
415
415
200
415
6B20 0125
6B20 0160
6B20 0200
415
160
6C10 0125
6C10 0160
6C10 0200
6C10 0250
6C10 0315
B3(1)
TKF / ED
Reference
355
415
400
415
6B40 0355
6B40 0400
550
100
550
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
415
6B30 0250
6B30 0315
B4(1)
TMF / ED
Voltage (VAC)
80
Reference
6A30 0040
6A30 0050
6A30 0063
550
125
Rating Voltage
(A)
(VAC)
550
B1(1)
TBC / AD
Voltage (VAC)
550
Reference
550
32
Voltage (VAC)
550
A4(1)
TCP / CEO
Voltage (VAC)
550
A3(1)
TIS / BAO
6B10 0080
6B10 0100
415
415
250
415
315
415
415
273
References (continued)
Distribution industrial fuselinks (type gG)
C1(1)
TM / EF
Rating Voltage
(A)
(VAC)
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
450
550
500
550
560
550
630
550
6C20 0450
6C20 0500
6C20 0560
6C20 0630
C3(1)
TLM / GF
D1(1)
TLU / GH
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
710
550
550
6C30 0710
6C30 0800
550
800
6D10 0710
6D10 0800
D1(1)
TXU / GH
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
1000
550
1250
550
6D10 1000
6D10 1250
355
415
400
415
Reference
C2(1)
TTM / FF
6C10 0355
6C10 0400
550
Voltage
(VAC)
20M25
415
20M32
415
32M36
415
32M40
415
32M50
415
32M63
415
Reference
F2(1)
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
6F1M 0025
6F1M 0032
6F1M 0036
6F1M 0040
6F1M 0050
6F1M 0063
A1(2)
NIT / NITD
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
550
6A1M 0025
6A1M 0032
550
550
550
550
63M80
415
63M100
415
Rating (A)
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
200M250
415
200M315
415
6B2M 0250
6B2M 0315
400M500
(1) Offset blade type fuselinks
(2) Offset bolted tag type fuselinks
(3) Centre bolted tag type fuselinks.
Note: pack quantity 3 pieces for each product.
274
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
550
6A2M 0040
6A2M 0050
6A2M 0063
550
550
6F2M 0080
6F2M 0100
A3(2)
TIS / BAO
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
550
6A3M 0080
6A3M 0100
550
B2(3)
TF / DD
315M400
6A1M 0040
6A1M 0050
6A1M 0063
A2(2)
TIA / AAO
B3(3)
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
415
6B3M 0400
B4(3)
TMF / ED
C1(3)
TM / EF
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
Voltage (VAC)
Reference
550
6B4M 0500
550
6C1M 0500
Accessories
Fuse holders for offset blade type fuselinks
Voltage
(VAC)
Color
Output
connection
Type
Pack qty
Reference
32
F1
550
black
front/rear
32NNSF
10
32
F1
550
black
front/rear
32NNNSFBS
10
32
F1
550
black
rear/rear
32NNSBS
10
32
F1
550
white
front/rear
32NNSFW
10
32
F1
550
white
front/rear
32NNSFBSW
10
32
F1
550
white
rear/rear
32NNSBSW
10
63
F2
550
black
front/rear
63ENSF
63
F2
550
black
front/rear
63ENSFBS
63
F2
550
black
rear/rear
63ENSBS
63
F2
550
white
front/rear
63ENSFW
63
F2
550
white
front/rear
63ENSFBSW
63
F2
550
white
rear/rear
63ENSBSW
5F10 0032
5F10 0132
5F10 0232
5F10 1032
5F10 1132
5F10 1232
5F20 0063
5F20 0163
5F20 0263
5F20 1063
5F20 1163
5F20 1263
fusib_144_a_1_cat
References
Rating
(A)
Size
Accessories
Rating (A)
Size
Output connection
Type
Pack qty
Reference
F1
busbar connecting
systems
32BCSNNS
5F10 0001
63
F2
busbar connecting
systems
63BCSENS
5F20 0001
32
F1
32NNL
63
F2
63ENL
5F10 0002
5F20 0002
32
Voltage
(VAC)
Color
Output
connection
Type
Pack qty
Reference
32
A1
660
black
front/front
CM32FC
10
32
A1
660
white
front/front
CM32FCW
10
32
A2
660
black
front/front
CM32F
10
32
A2
660
white
front/front
CM32FW
10
63
A3
660
black
front/front
CM63F
63
A3
660
white
front/front
CM63FW
100
as A3
660
black
front/front
CM100F
100
as A3
660
white
front/front
CM100FW
5A10 0032
5A10 1032
5A20 0032
5A20 1032
5A30 0063
5A30 1063
5A30 0100
5A30 1100
fusib_143_a_1_cat
References
Rating
(A)
Size
Accessories
Size
Output connection
Type
Pack qty
Reference
32
Rating (A)
A1
32BSC
10
32
A2
32BS
10
5A10 0001
5A20 0001
5A30 0001
5A20 0002
5A30 0002
5A30 0003
5A30 0004
5A30 0005
63 ... 100
A3
63 / 100BS
A1 - A2
32LSC
63 ... 100
A3
63 / 100LSC
32 ... 100
A1 - A3
GLP
32 ... 100
32 ... 100
A1 - A3
32
security clip
NI
CMSC
10
275
Characteristics
Distribution industrial fuselinks (type gG)
Fuse cut off current
Rating (A)
F1
NS / NSD
F2
ES / ESD
A1
NIT / NITD
A2
TIA / AAO
A3
TIS / BAO
A3
OS / OSD
A4
TCP / CEO
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
0.5 / 0.6
0.5 / 0.6
0.5 / 0.6
0.5 / 0.6
0.9 / 1.0
0.9 / 1.0
0.7 / 0.8
1.0 / 1.1
1.4 / 1.6
1.4 / 1.6
1.0 / 1.1
1.5 / 1.8
10
2.4 / 2.6
2.4 / 2.6
1.7 / 2.0
2.4 / 2.8
16
2.5 / 2.9
2.5 / 2.9
2.5 / 3.0
2.6 / 3.0
20
3.2 / 3.8
3.2 / 3.8
2.5 / 3.0
3.4 / 4.0
25
3.5 / 4.0
3.5 / 4.0
3.5 / 4.0
3.8 / 4.1
32
4.1 / 4.9
4.1 / 4.9
3.5 / 4.0
4.2 / 5.0
4.4 / 5.0
40
5.0 / 5.9
5.1 / 6.0
50
5.2 / 6.0
7.0 / 8.0
5.0 / 6.0
6.6 / 7.8
63
5.8 / 6.6
9.0 / 10.0
8.9 / 10.0
80
9.5 / 11.0
9.5 / 11.0
100
12.0 / 14.0
12.0 / 14.0
Rating (A)
A4
TFP / DEO
B1
TBC / AD
B1
TBC / BD
B1
TC / CD
B2
TF / DD
CI
TKF / ED
B3
TKF / ED
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
0.4 / 0.5
1.0 / 1.1
1.4 / 1.6
10
1.8 / 2.0
16
2.0 / 2.2
20
2.6 / 3.0
25
3.6 / 4.0
32
4.4 / 5.0
40
5.0 / 6.0
50
6.6 / 7.8
63
8.9 / 10.0
80
9.5 / 11.0
100
12.0 / 14.0
125
12.0 / 14.0
12.0 / 14.0
12.0 / 14.0
160
17.0 / 19.0
17.0 / 19.0
17.0 / 19.0
200
19.0 / 24.0
19.0 / 24.0
19.0 / 24.0
250
23.0 / 28.0
23.0 / 28.0
315
27.0 / 30.0
27.0 / 30.0
276
C1
TM / EF
C2
TTM / FF
C3
TLM / GF
D1
TLU / GH
D1
TXU / GH
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
710
55.0 / 64.0
55.0 / 64.0
800
55.0 / 64.0
55.0 / 64.0
Rating (A)
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
355
30.0 / 34.0
30.0 / 34.0
400
30.0 / 34.0
30.0 / 34.0
450
40.0 / 48.0
500
42.0 / 50.0
560
46.0 / 54.0
630
51.0 / 60.0
1000
69.0 / 79.0
1250
90.0 / 105.0
F2
A1
NIT / NITD
A2
TIA / AAO
A3
TIS / BAO
A3
OS / OSD
A4
TCP / CEO
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
100M125
13.0 / 15.0
13.0 / 15.0
100M160
17.0 / 20.0
Rating (A)
20M25
3.4 / 4.0
4.6 / 5.5
20M32
4.0 / 5.0
4.6 / 5.5
32M36
4.5 / 5.1
32M40
4.8 / 5.5
5.0 / 6.0
32M50
5.3 / 6.2
6.5 / 7.5
6.6 / 7.8
32M63
5.9 / 6.9
7.5 / 10.0
8.5 / 9.0
5.0 / 6.0
63M80
9.0 / 10.0
9.5 / 12.0
63M100
10.1 / 10.3
12.0 / 13.0
100M200
17.0 / 20.0
20.0 / 23.0
50 / 80 kA
B1
TC / CD
B2
TF / DD
B3
B4
TMF / ED
C1
TM / EF
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
50 / 80 kA
42.0 / 50.0
42.0 / 50.0
100M125
13.0 / 15.0
100M160
17.0 / 20.0
100M200
20.0 / 23.0
200M250
25.0 / 29.0
25.0 / 29.0
200M315
27.0 / 31.0
27.0 / 31.0
315M400
400M500
34.0 / 40.0
277
Industrial fuses
NFC-DIN industrial fuselinks gG and aM curves
from 0.16 to 1250 A
Fuse protection
fusib_114_b_1_cat
fusib_103_c_1_cat
fusib_116_a_1_cat
Strong points
gG fuse
from 0.5 to 125 A
gG fuse
from 6 to 315 A
Conformity to standards
>
>
>
>
>
Function
SOCOMEC industrial fuses protect installations and people from overcurrents for any low
voltage electrical circuit.
Advantages
High level performances
q High breaking capacity - 120 kA at
5J @S5
q High short-circuit
limitation capacity.
q Simple and reliable discrimination.
High reliability
q Absolute protection over time guaranteed
by the simplicity of manufacture and
function (Joule effect).
q No downgrading of fuse characteristics over
time.
278
Improved safety
The energy released whilst eliminating the fault
(fuse blowing) is contained within the cartridge
(no degassing).
IEC 60269-1
DIN EN 60269-1
NF EN 60269-1
IEC 60269-2
NF EN 60269-2
Industrial fuses
References
gG type fuses (in multiples of 10)
10 x 38
without striker
Rating (A)
Voltage
(VAC)
0.5
500
500
500
500
500
500
10
500
12
500
16
500
20
500
25
500
32
400
Reference
6012 0000
6012 0001
6012 0002
6012 0004
6012 0006
6012 0008
6012 0010
6012 0012
6012 0016
6012 0020
6012 0025
6012 0032
14 x 51
without striker
Voltage
(VAC)
6022 0001
6022 0002
6022 0004
6022 0006
6022 0008
6022 0010
6022 0012
6022 0016
6022 0020
6022 0025
6022 0032
6022 0040
6022 0050
500
40
500
50
400
Reference
14 x 51
with striker
Voltage
(VAC)
Reference
6052 0002
6052 0004
6052 0006
6052 0008
6052 0010
6052 0012
6052 0016
6052 0020
6052 0025
6052 0032
6052 0040
6052 0050
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
400
22 x 58
without striker
Voltage
(VAC)
6032 0002
6032 0004
6032 0006
6032 0008
6032 0010
6032 0012
6032 0016
6032 0020
6032 0025
6032 0032
6032 0040
6032 0050
6032 0063
6032 0080
6032 0100
6032 0125
63
500
100
500
125
400
Reference
22 x 58
with striker
Voltage
(VAC)
Reference
6062 0004
6062 0006
6062 0008
6062 0010
6062 0012
6062 0016
6062 0020
6062 0025
6062 0032
6062 0040
6062 0050
6062 0063
6062 0080
6062 0100
6062 0125
500
500
400
Description of accessories
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
6019 0000
6029 0000
6029 0000
6039 0000
6039 0000
Voltage
(VAC)
0.16
500
0.25
500
0.5
500
500
500
500
500
500
10
500
12
500
16
500
20
400
25
400
Reference
6013 0007
6013 0005
6013 0000
6013 0001
6013 0002
6013 0004
6013 0006
6013 0008
6013 0010
6013 0012
6013 0016
6013 0020
6013 0025
14 x 51
without striker
Voltage
(VAC)
32
500
40
500
50
400
Reference
6023 0005
6023 0000
6023 0001
6023 0002
6023 0004
6023 0006
6023 0008
6023 0010
6023 0012
6023 0016
6023 0020
6023 0025
6023 0032
6023 0040
6023 0050
14 x 51
with striker
Voltage
(VAC)
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
400
Reference
6053 0002
6053 0004
6053 0006
6053 0008
6053 0010
6053 0012
6053 0016
6053 0020
6053 0025
6053 0032
6053 0040
6053 0050
22 x 58
without striker
Voltage
(VAC)
63
500
100
500
125
400
Reference
6033 0002
6033 0004
6033 0006
6033 0008
6033 0010
6033 0012
6033 0016
6033 0020
6033 0025
6033 0032
6033 0040
6033 0050
6033 0063
6033 0080
6033 0100
6033 0125
22 x 58
with striker
Voltage
(VAC)
500
400
400
Reference
6063 0004
6063 0006
6063 0008
6063 0010
6063 0012
6063 0016
6063 0020
6063 0025
6063 0032
6063 0040
6063 0050
6063 0063
6063 0080
6063 0100
6063 0125
Description of accessories
Solid cylindrical link
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
6019 0000
6029 0000
6029 0000
6039 0000
6039 0000
279
Industrial fuses
References (continued)
*MHEDDCFDETRDR-'F&SXOD
000/00C
without striker
(in multiples of 3)
Rating (A)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
10
500
16
500
20
500
25
500
32
500
40
500
50
500
63
500
500
100
500
Reference
00
without striker
(in multiples of 3)
Voltage
(VAC)
Reference
6600 0006
6600 0010
6600 0016
6600 0020
6600 0025
6600 0032
6600 0040
6600 0050
6600 0063
6600 0080
6600 0100
0
without striker
(in multiples of 3)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
125
500
160
500
6692 0125
6692 0160
200
500
500
500
Reference
6702 0016
6702 0020
6702 0025
6702 0032
6702 0040
6702 0050
6702 0063
6702 0080
6702 0100
6702 0125
6702 0160
6702 0200
0
with striker
(in multiples of 3)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
500
500
Reference
6852 0032
6852 0040
6852 0050
6852 0063
6852 0080
6852 0100
6852 0125
6852 0160
6852 0200
1
without striker
(in multiples of 3)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
500
500
500
500
500
250
500
315
400
Reference
6712 0063
6712 0080
6712 0100
6712 0125
6712 0160
6712 0200
6712 0250
6712 0315
1
with striker
(in multiples of 3)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
500
Reference
6862 0080
6862 0100
6862 0125
6862 0160
6862 0200
6862 0250
6862 0315
Description of accessories
Neutral bar
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
6420 0000
6420 0000
6421 0000
6421 0000
6421 0001
6421 0001
2
without striker
(in multiples of 3)
Rating (A)
Voltage
(VAC)
100
500
125
500
160
500
200
500
250
500
315
500
400
500
500
500
Reference
6722 0100
6722 0125
6722 0160
6722 0200
6722 0250
6722 0315
6722 0400
6722 0500
2
with striker
(in multiples of 3)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
500
Reference
6872 0125
6872 0160
6872 0200
6872 0250
6872 0315
6872 0400
6872 0500
3
without striker
(to this unit)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
500
500
630
500
500
Reference
6732 0315
6732 0400
6732 0500
6732 0630
6732 0800
3
with striker
(to this unit)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
Reference
6882 0315
6882 0400
6882 0500
6882 0630
4
without striker
(to this unit)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
500
500
500
500
500
1000
500
1250
500
Reference
6746 0315
6746 0400
6746 0500
6746 0630
6746 0800
6746 0900
6746 1000
6746 1200
4
with striker
(to this unit)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
Reference
6896 0315
6896 0400
6896 0500
6896 0630
6896 0800
6896 0900
6896 1000
6896 1200
Description of accessories
Neutral bar
280
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
6421 0002
6421 0002
6421 0003
6421 0003
6441 0005
6441 0005
Industrial fuses
Voltage
(VAC)
500
10
500
16
500
20
500
25
500
32
500
40
500
50
500
63
500
500
Reference
00
without striker
(in multiples of 3)
Voltage
(VAC)
Reference
6601 0006
6601 0010
6601 0016
6601 0020
6601 0025
6601 0032
6601 0040
6601 0050
6601 0063
6601 0080
0
without striker
(in multiples of 3)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
100
500
125
500
160
500
6693 0100
6693 0125
6693 0160
200
500
500
500
500
Reference
6703 0016
6703 0020
6703 0025
6703 0032
6703 0040
6703 0050
6703 0063
6703 0080
6703 0100
6703 0125
6703 0160
6703 0200
0
with striker
(in multiples of 3)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
Reference
6853 0032
6853 0040
6853 0050
6853 0063
6853 0080
6853 0100
6853 0125
6853 0160
6853 0200
1
without striker
(in multiples of 3)
Voltage
(VAC)
Reference
1
with striker
(in multiples of 3)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
500
500
500
250
500
315
500
6713 0100
6713 0125
6713 0160
6713 0200
6713 0250
6713 0315
Reference
6863 0080
6863 0100
6863 0125
6863 0160
6863 0200
6863 0250
6863 0315
500
Description of accessories
Neutral bar
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
6420 0000
6420 0000
6421 0000
6421 0000
6421 0001
6421 0001
2
without striker
(in multiples of 3)
Rating (A)
Voltage
(VAC)
100
500
125
500
160
500
200
500
250
500
315
500
400
500
500
500
Reference
6723 0100
6723 0125
6723 0160
6723 0200
6723 0250
6723 0315
6723 0400
6723 0500
2
with striker
(in multiples of 3)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
Reference
6873 0160
6873 0200
6873 0250
6873 0315
6873 0400
6873 0500
630
3
without striker
(to this unit)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
500
500
500
Reference
6733 0315
6733 0400
6733 0500
6733 0630
3
with striker
(to this unit)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
Reference
6883 0315
6883 0400
6883 0500
6883 0630
4
without striker
(to this unit)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
500
500
500
500
1000
500
1250
500
Reference
6747 0315
6747 0400
6747 0500
6747 0630
6747 0800
6747 1000
6747 1200
4
with striker
(to this unit)
Voltage
(VAC)
500
500
500
500
500
500
500
Reference
6897 0315
6897 0400
6897 0500
6897 0630
6897 0800
6897 1000
6897 1200
Description of accessories
Neutral bar
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
6421 0002
6421 0002
6421 0003
6421 0003
6441 0005
6441 0005
281
Industrial fuses
Accessories
Solid cylindrical link
To be ordered
in multiples of
Rating (A)
Size
32
W
10
50
14 x 51
10
100
W
10
Reference
6019 0000
6029 0000
6039 0000
fusib_123_a_1_cat
Use
Solid link to be used in conjunction with the neutral pole
of cylindrical fused disconnecting switches.
RHYDRWWW
Solid links
Rating (A)
Size
Tightening
Reference
160
000/00C/00
elastic
160
elastic
315
elastic
400
elastic
630
elastic
1250
blocked
6420 0000
6421 0000
6421 0001
6421 0002
6421 0003
6441 0005
fusib_124_a_1_cat
Use
Solid link to be used in conjunction with fuse bases or knife-edge
ETRDCCHRBNMMDBSHMFRVHSBGDRFDMDQ@KKXEHSSDCNMSGDMDTSQ@KONKD
6 sizes: 000/00C/00-0-1-2-3-4.
Use
%NQHMRDQSHMF@MCDWSQ@BSHMFJMHEDDCFDETRDRRHYDRSN
282
Type
Reference
Operating handle
6401 0011
fusib_122_a_1_cat
Operating handle
Industrial fuses
Dimensions
Cylindrical fuses (NF)
Without striker - with striker
Standard dimensions (mm) as per IEC 60269-2-1
Size
W
ETRHA>>A>>W>B@S
D
A
10.3
10.5
14 x 51
14.3
51
7.5
W
22.2
16.2
7.5
C
B
H
maxi
X
mini
15
54
21
41
35
11
15
54
30
35
11
127.5
15
40
35
11
137.5
20
75
52
53
40
11
152.5
25
75
60
61
11
152.5
32
75
75
76
60
11
203
105
110
11
F
maxi
E
mini
000/00C
ETRHA>>A>>W>B@S
B
mini
00
D
F
E
A
A
maxi
Size
C
G
16
150
With striker
Standard dimensions (mm) as per IEC 60269-2-1
X
L
D
F
E
A
C K
G
Size
ETRHA>>B>>W>B@S
M1
M2
A
maxi
B
mini
F
G
H
maxi maxi maxi
M1
14
25
M2
X
mini mini
127.5
15
45
35 11.5
137.5
20
75
52
53
40
152.5
25
75
60
61
16
14.5 25.5
13
11
152.5
32
75
75
76
60
21
14.5 25.5
13
11
203
105
110
24.5 14.5
13
11
16 150
13
14.5 25.5
35
13
11
13
11
283
Industrial fuses
1,5
100 kA cr.
1250
1000
7
6
800
630
5
500
400
315
250
200
2
160
125
1,5
100
80
63
10 kA
50
8
40
7
32
20
25
16
4
12
3
10
6
2
1,5
1 kA
2
8
7
6
1
5
catec_112_f_1_gb_cat
2
1,5
100 A
1,5
3
2
1,5
6
4
10 A
8
100 A
3
2
6
4
1,5
8
1 kA
284
3
2
10 kA
6
4
8
100 kA eff.
Industrial fuses
catec_227_c_1_fr_cat
7
3
2
106
5
690 V
500 V
440 V
A2t total
at rated voltages
A2t of pre-arcing
3
2
catec_225_c_1_gb_cat
105
7
5
3
2
104
7
5
3
2
3
10
7
5
3
2
102
5
7
3
2
101
6
16
10
25
20
40
32
63
50
100
80
160
125
200
250
400
630
900 1250
315
500
800 1000
80
100
125
160
200
63
25
32
40
50
10
12
16
20
Fuse In (A)
250
315
400
500
630
800
1000
1250
224
280
355
450
560
710
900
4000
3000
2000
1500
1000
800
600
400
300
200
150
0,5
100
60
80
40
30
20
15
10
catec_111_c_1_gb_cat
8
6
4
3
2
1,5
0,25
0,8
0,6
0,4
0,3
0,2
0,15
0,1
0,07
0,05
0,025
0,015
0,01
0,007
0,004
1,5
3
2
1A
5
4
7
6 8
1,5
3
2
10 A
5
4
7
6 8
100 A
1,5
3
2
5
4
7
6 8
1,5
3
2
1 kA
5
4
7
6 8
10 kA
1,5
3
2
5
4
7
6 8
100 kA eff.
285
Industrial fuses
IC (kA)
100
9
1250
8
7
1000
630
800
400
425
355
315
250
200
160
125
100
80
63
50
10
9
40
8
7
35
25
32
20
4
16
3
10
6
aM fuse rated current
1
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
catec_114_g_1_gb_cat
0,1
286
3
2
0,1
5
4
7 9
6
5
4
7 9
6
10
5
4
7 9
6
100
Ip (kA)
Industrial fuses
catec_227_c_1_gb_cat
A2t total
at rated voltages
A2t of pre-arcing
108
5
7
3
2
107
5
7
3
2
10
0.33
00
0/0S
0.42
10
0.52
0.67
16
20
1.04
25
1.17
32
1.42
1.67
35
1.72
40
2.51
3.35
3.2
4.6
3
2
100
5.72
5.7
125
7.30
160
7.73
3
2
200
12.3
13.7
224
14.0
14.0
250
15.3
103
7
5
3
2
102
7
63
104
7
5
3
2
000
In (A)
50
106
5
Fuse size
7.6
17.0
315
26.0
20.6
355
25.2
400
26.5
425
500
630
3
2
1
6
16
10
25
20
35
32
50
40
80
63
23.5
34
70
1000
1250
1000
1000
1250
315
355
400
425
500
630
800
250
200
10
16
20
25
32
35
40
50
63
80
100
125
160
In fusibles (A)
5
2
100
5
2
10
5
2
1
5
2
catec_113_d_1_gb_cat
0,1
5
2
0,01
3
2
10
5
4
3
6
2
100
5
4
3
6
8
1000
5
4
3
6
5
4
10000
287
UR type fuses
with or without striker
DIN 43620 UR
Knife edge fuses
fusib_072_a_2_cat
fusib_066_a_2_cat
fusib_071_a_2_cat
fusib_063_a_2_cat
Fuse protection
DIN 43653
Bracket fuse
fusib_070_a_2_cat
fusib_069_a_2_cat
fusib_076_a_2_cat
fusib_075_a_2_cat
Strong points
>
>
>
>
A complete range
> Additional products are
available (FUSERBLOC,
disconnect switches,
fuse bases).
Function
High speed fuses (UR) protect power semi-conductors and DC circuits.
Advantages
High level performances
q Very high breaking capacity up to 300 kA.
q Very high limitation of short-circuit currents
(and therefore significant reduction in the
thermal and mechanical stress).
q High resistance to cyclic loads.
High reliability
q Absolute protection over time guaranteed
by the simplicity of manufacture and
function (Joule effect).
q No downgrading of fuse characteristics over
time.
288
Improved safety
The energy released whilst eliminating the fault
(fuse blowing) remains contained within the
cartridge (no degassing).
Fuse blown detection
An auxiliary contact can be adapted for fuse
blown indication.
Conformity to standards
>
>
>
>
>
IEC 60269-1
NF EN 60269-1
IEC 60269-4
NF EN 60269-4
DIN EN 60269-4
References
690 VAC UR Fuses - Size 14 x 51
Losses at In
(W)
Protection
To be ordered
in multiples of
1.6
11
1.5
aR
10
10
3.6
38.5
aR
10
15
8.6
70
5.5
aR
10
20
26
230
aR
10
25
46.5
375
aR
10
32
68
600
7.6
aR
10
40
84
750
aR
10
50
200
1800
aR
10
In rms value
(A)
14 x 51 UR
without striker
14 x 51 UR
with striker
Reference
Reference
170N 1405
170N 1410
170N 1415
170N 1420
170N 1425
170N 1432
170N 1440
170N 1450
170L 1410
170L 1415
170L 1420
170L 1425
170L 1432
170L 1440
170L 1450
Description of accessories
Fuse combination switch recommended (see page 188)
Fuse holder recommended (see page 262)
Reference
Reference
FUSERBLOC
FUSERBLOC
RM 50
RMS 50
22 x 58 UR
without striker
22 x 58 UR
with striker
Reference
Reference
170N 2220
170N 2225
170N 2232
170N 2240
170N 2250
170N 2263
170N 2280
170N 2299
170L 2220
170L 2225
170L 2232
170L 2240
170L 2250
170L 2263
170L 2280
170L 2299
Losses at In
(W)
Protection
To be ordered
in multiples of
20
19
260
aR
10
25
34
410
aR
10
32
53.5
605
aR
10
40
68
750
aR
10
10
In rms value
(A)
50
135
1600
9.5
aR
63
280
3080
11
aR
10
80
600
6600
13.5
aR
10
100(1)
1100
12500
16
aR
10
Description of accessories
Fuse combination switch recommended (see page 188)
Fuse holder recommended (see page 262)
Reference
Reference
FUSERBLOC
FUSERBLOC
RM 100
RMS 100
289
References (continued)
690 VAC UR fuses - Size 0000
DIN 43653
Brackets(1)(2)
Pre-arcing I2t when cold (As)
Losses at In (W)
Protection
Reference
10
3.8
25.5
3.5
gR
16
8.5
56.5
4.5
gR
20
15
105
gR
25
23.5
160
gR
32
43.5
290
gR
40
77.5
515
11
gR
50
135
915
12
aR
63
260
1750
13
aR
80
485
3250
17
aR
100
860
5700
18
aR
170M 0158
170M 0159
170M 0160
170M 0161
170M 0162
170M 0163
170M 0164
170M 0165
170M 0166
170M 0167
Reference
Reference
170H 1007
(1)
T/80
Brackets(1)
F/70
Brackets(1)(2)
DIN 43620
Knife-edge(3)
(1) UL / CSA.
(2) Without striker.
(3) With striker.
Description of accessories
Fuse base recommended
(1) Direct mounting on busbar.
Operating I2t at
1250 V rms (A2s)
Losses at
In (W)
Protection
Reference
Reference
Reference
10
3.8
25.5
gR
16
7.2
48
5.5
gR
20
11.5
78
gR
25
19
130
gR
32
40
270
10
gR
40
69
460
12
gR
50
115
770
15
gR
63
215
1450
16
gR
80
380
2550
19
aR
100
695
4650
24
aR
125
1200
8500
28
aR
160
2300
16000
32
aR
200
4200
28000
37
aR
250
7750
51500
42
aR
315
12000
80500
52
aR
170M 1408
170M 1409
170M 1410
170M 1411
170M 1412
170M 1413
170M 1414
170M 1415
170M 1416
170M 1417
170M 1418
170M 1419
170M 1420
170M 1421
170M 1422
170M 1508
170M 1509
170M 1510
170M 1511
170M 1512
170M 1513
170M 1514
170M 1515
170M 1516
170M 1517
170M 1518
170M 1519
170M 1520
170M 1521
170M 1522
170M 1558
170M 1559
170M 1560
170M 1561
170M 1562
170M 1563
170M 1564
170M 1565
170M 1566
170M 1567
170M 1568
170M 1569
170M 1570
170M 1571
170M 1572
Reference
Reference
Reference
In rms value
(A)
(1) UL / CSA.
(2) With striker.
(3) UL.
Description of accessories
Fuse blown auxiliary contact
Fuse base recommended
Fuse combination switch recommended (see page 188)
(1) Direct mounting on busbar.
(2) Single-pole base 160 A Size 00 (see page 266).
290
170H 0236
170H 1007
(1)
170H 0236
6500 1010(2)
FUSERBLOC
BT/60
Threaded bolted tag
Losses at In
(W)
Protection
Reference
Reference
25
19
130
gR
32
28.5
195
gR
40
50
360
gR
50
95
640
10
gR
63
170
1200
12
gR
80
310
2100
15
gR
100
620
4150
20
aR
125
1000
6950
25
aR
160
1900
13000
30
aR
200
3400
23000
35
aR
250
6250
42000
45
aR
315
10000
68500
55
aR
350
13500
91500
60
aR
400
18000
125000
70
aR
170M 2658
170M 2659
170M 2660
170M 2661
170M 2662
170M 2663
170M 2664(1)
170M 2665(1)
170M 2666(1)
170M 2667(1)
170M 2668(1)
170M 2669(1)
170M 2670(1)
170M 2671(1)
170M 2758
170M 2759
170M 2760
170M 2761
170M 2762
170M 2763
170M 2764
170M 2765
170M 2766
170M 2767
170M 2768
170M 2769
170M 2770
170M 2771
Reference
Reference
170H 0235
170H 1007
170H 0235
(1) UL.
Description of accessories
Fuse blown auxiliary contact
Fuse base recommended
(1)
Losses at In (W)
Protection
Reference
16
3.8
25.5
aR
20
7.2
48
aR
25
11.5
78
aR
32
23.5
160
aR
40
40
270
aR
50
77
515
11
aR
63
115
770
14
aR
80
185
1250
18
aR
100
360
2450
21
aR
125
550
3700
26
aR
160
1100
7500
30
aR
200
2200
15000
35
aR
170M 7908
170M 7909
170M 7910
170M 7911
170M 7912
170M 7913
170M 7914
170M 7915
170M 7916
170M 7917
170M 7918
170M 7919
Description of accessories
Reference
Fuse base recommended
170H 0236
6501 1010(1)
FUSERBLOC
291
References (continued)
690 VAC UR fuses - Size 1*
K/80
Notched
In rms
value (A)
40
50
63
80
100
125
160
200
250
315
350
400
450
500
550
630
Pre-arcing I2t
when cold (As)
40
77
115
185
360
550
1100
2200
4200
7000
10000
15000
21000
27000
34000
48500
Operating I2t
at 660 V rms (A2s)
270
515
770
1250
2 450
3 700
7 500
15000
28500
46500
68500
105000
140000
180000
230000
325000
Losses
at In (W) Protection
9
aR
11
aR
14
aR
18
aR
21
aR
26
aR
30
aR
35
aR
40
aR
50
aR
55
aR
60
aR
65
aR
70
aR
75
aR
80
aR
K/110
Notched
EK/76
Notched
BK/50
Threaded bolted
tag
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
170M 3108(1)
170M 3109(1)
170M 3110(1)
170M 3111(1)
170M 3112(1)
170M 3113(1)
170M 3114(1)
170M 3115(1)
170M 3116(1)
170M 3117(1)
170M 3118(1)
170M 3119(1)
170M 3120(1)
170M 3121(1)
170M 3122(1)
170M 3123(1)
170M 3258(1)
170M 3259(1)
170M 3260(1)
170M 3261(1)
170M 3262(1)
170M 3263(1)
170M 3264(1)
170M 3265(1)
170M 3266(1)
170M 3267(1)
170M 3268(1)
170M 3269(1)
170M 3270(1)
170M 3271(1)
170M 3272(1)
170M 3273(1)
170M 3358(1)
170M 3359(1)
170M 3360(1)
170M 3361(1)
170M 3362(1)
170M 3363(1)
170M 3364(1)
170M 3365(1)
170M 3366(1)
170M 3367(1)
170M 3368(1)
170M 3369(1)
170M 3370(1)
170M 3371(1)
170M 3458(1)
170M 3459(1)
170M 3460(1)
170M 3461(1)
170M 3462(1)
170M 3463(1)
170M 3464(1)
170M 3465(1)
170M 3466(1)
170M 3467(1)
170M 3468(1)
170M 3469(1)
170M 3470(1)
170M 3471(1)
170M 3472(1)
170M 3473(1)
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
170H 0069
170H 3004
170H 0069
170H 3006
170H 0069
170A 0601(1)
170H 0069
(1) UL / CSA.
Description of accessories
Fuse blown auxiliary contact
Fuse base recommended
Fuse combination switch recommended (see page 188)
(2)
FUSERBLOC
Losses
at In (W) Protection
4
aR
4.5
aR
6.5
aR
8.5
aR
10
aR
11
aR
12
aR
45
aR
12.5
aR
55
aR
16
aR
58
aR
20
aR
21.5
aR
60
aR
65
aR
23
aR
70
aR
72
aR
75
aR
80
aR
85
aR
95
aR
100
aR
K/80
Notched
K/110
Notched
Reference
Reference
DIN 43620
Knife-edge
EK/86
Notched
BK/50
Threaded bolted
tag
Reference
Reference
Reference
170M 4358(2)
170M 4458(2)
170M 4359(2)
170M 4459(2)
170M 4360(2)
170M 4460(2)
170M 4361(2)
170M 4362(2)
170M 4461(2)
170M 4462(2)
170M 4363(2)
170M 4364(2)
170M 4365(2)
170M 4366(2)
170M 4367(2)
170M 4368(2)
170M 4463(2)
170M 4464(2)
170M 4465(2)
170M 4466(2)
170M 4467(2)
170M 4468(2)
170M 4469(2)
170M 3808(1)
170M 3809(1)
170M 3810(1)
170M 3811(1)
170M 3812(1)
170M 3813(1)
170M 3814(1)
170M 4108(2)
170M 4258(2)
170M 3815(1)
170M 4109(2)
170M 4259(2)
170M 3816(1)
170M 4110(2)
170M 4260(2)
170M 3817(1)
170M 3818(1)
170M 4111(2)
170M 4112(2)
170M 4261(2)
170M 4262(2)
170M 4113(2)
170M 4114(2)
170M 4115(2)
170M 4116(2)
170M 4117(2)
170M 4118(2)
170M 4119(2)
170M 4263(2)
170M 4264(2)
170M 4265(2)
170M 4266(2)
170M 4267(2)
170M 4268(2)
170M 4269(2)
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
170H 0069
170H 3004
170H 0069
170H 3006
170H 0236
6501 1011(1)
170H 0069
170A 0611(2)
170H 0069
FUSERBLOC
FUSERBLOC
170M 3819(1)
Description of accessories
Fuse blown auxiliary contact
Fuse base recommended
Fuse combination switch recommended (see page 188)
(1) Single-pole base 250 A Size 1 (see page 266).
292
(3)
Losses
at In (W) Protection
50
aR
55
aR
60
aR
60
aR
65
aR
70
aR
75
aR
80
aR
90
aR
95
aR
105
aR
110
aR
115
aR
120
aR
130
aR
65
aR
70
aR
75
aR
80
aR
90
aR
95
aR
Pre-arcing I t
Operating I t
In rms
value (A) when cold (As) at 660 V rms (A2s)
200
1 200
8 200
250
2 450
16 500
315
4 950
33 000
350
7 000
46 500
400
11000
74 000
450
15 500
105 000
500
21 500
145 000
550
28 000
190 000
630
41000
275 000
700
60 500
405 000
800
86 000
575 000
900
125 000
840 000
1000
180 000
1250 000
1100
245 000
1 600 000
1250
365 000
2 400 000
400
11 000
79 000
450
16 000
115 000
500
21 500
155 000
550
29 000
215 000
630
41000
295 000
700
60 500
430 000
K/80
Notched
K/110
Notched
Reference
Reference
DIN 43620
Knife-edge
EK/91
Notched
BK/50
Threaded bolted tag
Reference
Reference
Reference
170M 5358(2)
170M 5359(2)
170M 5360(2)
170M 5361(2)
170M 5362(2)
170M 5363(2)
170M 5364(2)
170M 5365(2)
170M 5366(2)
170M 5458(2)
170M 5459(2)
170M 5460(2)
170M 5461(2)
170M 5462(2)
170M 5463(2)
170M 5464(2)
170M 5465(2)
170M 5466(2)
170M 5467(2)
170M 5468(2)
170M 5804(1)
170M 5805(1)
170M 5806(1)
170M 5807(1)
170M 5108(2)
170M 5109(2)
170M 5110(2)
170M 5111(2)
170M 5112(2)
170M 5113(2)
170M 5114(2)
170M 5115(2)
170M 5116(2)
170M 5117(2)
170M 5118(2)
170M 5258(2)
170M 5259(2)
170M 5260(2)
170M 5261(2)
170M 5262(2)
170M 5263(2)
170M 5264(2)
170M 5265(2)
170M 5266(2)
170M 5267(2)
170M 5268(2)
170M 5808(1)
170M 5809(1)
170M 5810(1)
170M 5811(1)
170M 5812(1)
170M 5813(1)
Description of accessories
Fuse blown auxiliary contact
Fuse base recommended
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
170H 0069
170H 3004
170H 0069
170H 3006
170H 0235
6501 1012(1)
170H 0069
170A 0621(2)
170H 0069
FUSERBLOC
FUSERBLOC
(3)
FUSERBLOC
In rms
Pre-arcing I2t
value (A) when cold (As)
500
14 000
550
19 500
630
31 000
700
44 500
800
69 500
900
100 000
1000
140 000
1100
190 000
1250
290 000
1400
370 000
1500
460 000
1600
580 000
1800
880 000
2000
1 150 000
Operating I2t
at 660 V
rms (A2s)
95 000
135 000
210 000
300 000
465 000
670 000
945 000
1 300 000
1 950 000
2 450 000
3 100 000
3 900 000
5 250 000
6 350 000
(1) UL / CSA.
Losses
at In (W)
95
100
105
110
115
120
125
130
140
155
160
160
165
175
Protection
aR
aR
aR
aR
aR
aR
aR
aR
aR
aR
aR
aR
aR
aR
(2) UL.
K/80
Brackets(1)
K/110
Brackets(1)
DIN 43620
Knife-edge(2)
EK/91
Brackets(1)
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
170M 6808
170M 6809
170M 6810
170M 6811
170M 6812
170M 6813
170M 6814
170M 6358
170M 6359
170M 6360
170M 6361
170M 6362
170M 6363
170M 6364
170M 6365
170M 6366
170M 6367
170M 6368
170M 6458
170M 6459
170M 6460
170M 6461
170M 6462
170M 6463
170M 6464
170M 6465
170M 6466
170M 6467
170M 6468
170M 6469
170M 6470(3)
170M 6471(4)
170M 6108
170M 6109
170M 6110
170M 6111
170M 6112
170M 6113
170M 6114
170M 6115
170M 6116
170M 6117
170M 6118
170M 6119
170M 6120(3)
170M 6121(4)
170M 6258
170M 6259
170M 6260
170M 6261
170M 6262
170M 6263
170M 6264
170M 6265
170M 6266
170M 6267
170M 6268
170M 6269
170M 6270(3)
170M 6271(4)
BK/50
Threaded bolted tag(1)
Description of accessories
Fuse blown auxiliary contact
Fuse base recommended
Fuse combination switch recommended (see page
(1) Single-pole base 630 A Size 3 (see page 266).
188)
(2) Imax = 710 A.
Reference
Reference
170H 0069
170H 3004
170H 0069
170H 3006
FUSERBLOC
Reference
170H 0236
6501 1013(1)
Reference
170H 0069
170A 0632(2)
FUSERBLOC
Reference
170H 0069
(3)
FUSERBLOC
293
References (continued)
1250 VAC UR fuses - Size 1*
K/110
Brackets(1)
BK/75
BK/80
Threaded bolted tag(1) Threaded bolted tag(1)
Pre-arcing I2t
when cold (As)
Operating I2t
@S5QLR 2s)
Losses at
In (W)
Protection
Reference
Reference
Reference
50
135
1 100
15
aR
63
215
1 750
20
aR
80
420
3 350
25
aR
100
750
5 950
30
aR
125
1 450
11 500
35
aR
160
2 600
21 000
40
aR
200
5 150
41 000
45
aR
250
9 200
73 000
55
aR
315
18 500
150 000
60
aR
350
27 000
220 000
65
aR
170M 3388
170M 3389
170M 3390
170M 3391
170M 3392
170M 3393
170M 3394
170M 3395
170M 3396
170M 3397
400
53 000
335 000
70
aR
170M 3238
170M 3239
170M 3240
170M 3241
170M 3242
170M 3243
170M 3244
170M 3245
170M 3246
170M 3247
170M 3248
170M 3438
170M 3439
170M 3440
170M 3441
170M 3442
170M 3443
170M 3444
170M 3445
170M 3446
170M 3447
170M 3448
Reference
Reference
Reference
170H 0069
170H 3006
170H 0069
170H 0069
(1)
(1)
In rms value
(A)
(1) UL.
Description of accessories
BK/75
BK/80
Threaded bolted tag(1) Threaded bolted tag(1)
Pre-arcing I2t
when cold (As)
Operating I2t
@S5QLR 2s)
Losses at
In (W)
Protection
Reference
Reference
Reference
160
1 900
15 500
45
aR
200
3 800
30 000
50
aR
250
7 750
61 500
60
aR
315
15 000
120 000
65
aR
350
20 000
165 000
70
aR
400
29 500
235 000
75
aR
450
42 000
335 000
80
aR
500
69 500
435 000
85
aR
170M 4238
170M 4239
170M 4240
170M 4241
170M 4242
170M 4243
170M 4244
170M 4245
170M 4246
170M 4247(2)
170M 4388
170M 4389
170M 4390
170M 4391
170M 4392
170M 4393
170M 4394
170M 4395(2)
170M 4396(3)
170M 4397(3)
170M 4438
170M 4439
170M 4440
170M 4441
170M 4442
170M 4443
170M 4444
170M 4445
170M 4446
170M 4447(2)
In rms value
(A)
550
95 000
590 000
95
aR
630
130 000
600 000(4)
100
aR
(1) UL.
Description of accessories
294
Reference
Reference
Reference
170H 0069
170H 3006
170H 0069
170H 0069
(1)
(1)
Operating I2t
@S5QLR 2s)
Losses at
In (W)
Protection
250
6 500
51 500
65
aR
280
9 350
74 500
70
aR
315
13 000
105 000
75
aR
350
16 500
135 000
80
aR
400
23 000
180 000
85
aR
450
34 000
270 000
90
aR
500
48 000
380 000
95
aR
550
62 000
495 000
100
aR
630
115 000
730 000
110
aR
700
160 000
1 050 000
115
aR
800
245 000
1 550 000
120
aR
900
360 000
1 750 000
125
aR
1 000
480 000
2 350 000
135
aR
(1) UL.
BK/75
BK/80
Threaded bolted tag(1) Threaded bolted tag(1)
Reference
Reference
Reference
170M 5238
170M 5239
170M 5240
170M 5241
170M 5242
170M 5243
170M 5244
170M 5245
170M 5246
170M 5247
170M 5248
170M 5249(2)
170M 5250(2)
170M 5388
170M 5389
170M 5390
170M 5391
170M 5392
170M 5393
170M 5394
170M 5395
170M 5396(2)
170M 5397(3)
170M 5398(3)
170M 5438
170M 5439
170M 5440
170M 5441
170M 5442
170M 5443
170M 5444
170M 5445
170M 5446
170M 5447(2)
170M 5448(3)
Description of accessories
Fuse blown auxiliary contact
Fuse base recommended
Reference
Reference
Reference
170H 0069
170H 3006
170H 0069
170H 0069
(1)
(1)
BK/75
BK/80
Threaded bolted tag(1) Threaded bolted tag(1)
Operating I2t at
1250 V rms (A2s)
Losses at
In (W)
Protection
Reference
Reference
Reference
315
9 500
77 500
85
aR
350
13 500
110 000
90
aR
400
19 500
160 000
95
aR
450
31 000
245 000
100
aR
500
39 000
310 000
105
aR
550
55 000
435 000
110
aR
630
83 500
665 000
115
aR
700
115 000
940 000
120
aR
800
205 000
1 300 000
125
aR
900
305 000
1 900 000
130
aR
1 000
450 000
2 750 000
135
aR
1 100
575 000
3 600 000
140
aR
170M 6338
170M 6339
170M 6340
170M 6341
170M 6342
170M 6343
170M 6344
170M 6345
170M 6346(2)
170M 6347(3)
170M 6348(3)
170M 6349(3)
170M 6538
170M 6539
170M 6540
170M 6541
170M 6542
170M 6543
170M 6544
170M 6545
170M 6546
170M 6547(2)
170M 6548(2)
170M 6549(3)
1 250
810 000
3 950 000(4)
145
aR
1 400
1 250 000
6 000 000(4)
150
170M 6238
170M 6239
170M 6240
170M 6241
170M 6242
170M 6243
170M 6244
170M 6245
170M 6246
170M 6247
170M 6248
170M 6249
170M 6250(2)
170M 6251(2)
(1) UL.
aR
Description of accessories
Fuse blown auxiliary contact
Fuse base recommended
Reference
Reference
Reference
170H 0069
170H 3006
170H 0069
170H 0069
(1)
(1)
295
Accessories
Fuse blown auxiliary contact
Voltage (VAC)
250
fusib_051_a_1_cat
Connection
6.3 x 0.8 mm fast-on connection.
Electronics principle
An auxiliary contact detects if a fuse has blown.
Electrical characteristics
fusib_016_b_1_x_cat
14 x 51 and 22 x 58
B
A
D
Size
14 x 51
51
11
59
14.3
22 x 58
58
15
66
22.2
fusib_020_b_1_x_cat
B
C
54
100
78
19
18
17
000
54
100
78
40
21
20
00
54
100
78
51
30
28
1.5
51
67
10
Size
0000
B
C
H
fusib_021_b_1_x_cat
Size
0000
54
78
65
18
13
19
10
1.5
00
54
95
70
36
32
23
10
DIN 43620
G
C
E
B
D
fusib_022_c_1_x_cat
M8
64
54
296
6
48
62
fusib_023_b_1_x_cat
30
16
BT/60
Size
000
54
79
48
21
35
15
15
68
125
60
35
35
1*
71
135
58
45
40
20
72
150
71
55
48
26
72
150
88
76
60
33
fusib_024_b_1_x_cat
C
A
D1
E
E
Size
1*
1
2
3
A
50
50
50
51
W
104
108
108
109
C
78
78
78
78
D1
59
69
77
92
E
45
53
61
76
G
6
6
6
6
H
22
25
25
30
I
11
11
11
11
A
50
50
50
51
W
134
138
138
139
C
108
108
108
108
D1
59
69
77
92
E
45
53
61
76
G
6
6
6
6
H
22
25
25
30
I
11
11
11
11
K/110
Size
1*
1
2
3
C
A
D
E
Size
1*
1
2
3
A
50
50
50
51
W
102
111
126
126
C
76
86
91
91
D
59
69
77
92
E
45
53
61
76
G
6
6
6
6
H
18
25
30
36
I
9
11
13
13
J
13
11
12
13
B
G
fusib_029_b_1_x_cat
A
F
Size
1*
1
2
3
A
50
50
50
51
W
51
51
51(1)
53(2)
D
59
59
77
92
E
45
53
61
76
F
M8
M8
M10
M12
G
5
8
10
10
H
17
20
24
30
E
D
fusib_030_b_1_x_cat
BK/50
C
A
D1
E
Size
D1
1*
80
138
108
59
45
20
11
80
138
108
69
53
25
11
80
138
108
77
61
25
11
81
139
108
92
76
30
11
B
E
fusib_163_a_1_x_cat
K/110
B
E
D
fusib_164_a_1_x_cat
Size
1*
1
2
3
A
74
74
74
74
W
75
75
75
76
D
59
69
77
92
E
45
53
61
76
F
M8
M8
M10
M12
G
5
8
10
10
H
17
20
24
30
A
80
80
80
81
W
81
81
81
83
D
59
69
77
92
E
45
53
61
76
F
M8
M8
M10
M12
G
5
8
10
10
H
17
20
24
30
BK/80
Size
1*
1
2
3
297
Photovoltaic fuses
The solution for
fusib-pv_021_a_1_cat
> Photovoltaic
SURWHFWLRQ
fusib-pv_018_a_1_cat
fusib-pv_016_a_1_cat
new
fusib_026_a_1_cat
fusib_013_a_1_cat
Fuse protection
gPV curve
1 to 600 A
Strong points
Function
SOCOMEC PV fuses protect the installation against the inverse over-currents which could
occur in the photovoltaic installation.
Large range
Advantages
Breaking capacity up to 1000 VDC
High breaking capacity at 1000 VDC.
Product dedicated to PV applications.
Operating ranges adjusted for small overcurrents specific to PV installations.
High reliability
q Absolute protection over time guaranteed
by the simplicity of manufacture and
function (Joule effect).
q No downgrading of fuse characteristics over
time.
Conformity to standards
Improved safety
The energy released whilst eliminating the fault
(fuse blowing) is contained within the cartidge
(no degassing).
298
>
>
>
>
>
,(&
,(&
,(&
1)(1
9'(
Photovoltaic fuses
gPV curve
WR$
PV panels
Fuse
protection
(10x38
and RM)
Fuse
protection
(10x38
and RM)
Level 1
Junction box
Level 1
Junction box
Disconnect
switch
Disconnect
switch
Surge arrester
fusib_179_a_1_gb_cat
+ + +
+ + +
Surge arrester
Fuse
protection
(NH and
bases)
Level 2
Junction box
Disconnect
switch
Surge arrester
Inverter
299
Photovoltaic fuses
gPV curve
WR$
References
gPV cylindrical Fuses
Rating
(A)
Rated voltage
U DC (V)
Dissipated power
W@ In
W @ 0.8 In
10 x 38
14 x 51
Breaking capacity
Reference
Reference
60PV 0001
60PV 0002
60PV 0003
60PV 0004
60PV 0006
60PV 0008
60PV 0010
60PV 0012
60PV 0015
60PV 0016
60PV 0020
1000
0.76
0.43
30 kA
1000
1.54
0.84
30 kA
1000
1.35
0.74
30 kA
1000
1.84
1.08
30 kA
1000
2.50
1.40
30 kA
1000
2.57
1.47
30 kA
10
1000
2.58
1.51
30 kA
12
1000
2.61
1.42
30 kA
15
1000
2.44
1.08
30 kA
16
1000
2.70
1.56
30 kA
20
1000
2.99
1.75
30 kA
25
1000
5.1
2.7
10 kA
32
1000
6.2
3.3
10 kA
60PV 0C25
60PV 0C25
Rated voltage
U DC (V)
Dissipated power
W@ In
W @ 0.8 In
Size 2XL
Size 3L
Breaking capacity
Reference
Reference
Reference
60PV 0032
60PV 0040
60PV 0050
60PV 0063
60PV 0080
60PV 0100
60PV 0125
60PV 0160
32
1000
8.5
4.3
50 kA
40
1000
4.6
50 kA
50
1000
10.5
5.4
50 kA
63
1000
12
6.1
50 kA
80
1000
15.5
7.9
50 kA
100
1000
16.5
8.4
50 kA
125
1000
17.5
8.9
50 kA
160
1000
24
12.2
50 kA
200
1000
50
28
33 kA
250
1000
60
34
33 kA
315
1000
66
40
33 kA
355
1000
68
42
50 kA
400
1000
82
48
50 kA
500
1000
85
50
50 kA
600
1000
118
92
50 kA
60PV 0200
60PV 0250
60PV 0315
60PV 0355
60PV 0400
60PV 0500
60PV 0600
Size NH1
Size 2XL
Size 3L
Description of accessories
Reference
Reference
Reference
56PV 9901
65PV 1011
56PV 9901
65PV 1112
56PV 9901
65PV 1113
300
Size NH1
Photovoltaic fuses
gPV curve
WR$
20
40
0.92
45
0.90
50
0.87
55
0.85
60
0.82
65
0.79
70
0.76
fusib_167_a_1_x_cat
Striker
10 x 38
without
10.3
38
10.5
14 x 51
without
14.3
51.5
10.10
C
B
G
F
fusib-pv_001_a_1_x_cat
D
A
maxi
maxi
maxi
67.7
39.65
52.9
40
5.8
123.3
59.2
59.2
47.9
122.3
73.5
73.5
60
Size
Striker
NH1
without
137
20
2XL
without
204.5
26
3L
without
204.9
32.3
maxi
C
E
15/16A
8A
10A
12A
6A
4A
3A
2A
1A
10000
1000
fusib-pv_002_a_1_gb_cat
10
10x38 gPV
100
0.1
0.01
0.001
1
10
100
1000
301
Photovoltaic fuses
gPV curve
WR$
32A
25A
10000
1000
10
14x51 gPV
100
fusib-pv_003_b_1_gb_cat
0.1
0.01
0.001
1
100
10
1000
100A
125A
40A
50A
63A
80A
32A
1000
10
NH1 gPV
100
fusib-pv_004_b_1_gb_cat
0.1
0.01
0.001
10
100
1 000
302
10 000
Photovoltaic fuses
gPV curve
WR$
200A
250A
Time-current characteristics
10000
1000
10
2XL gPV
100
fusib-pv_005_b_1_gb_cat
0.1
0.01
0.001
10
1 000
100
10 000
350A
400A
500A
630A
Time-current characteristics
10000
1000
10
3L gPV
100
fusib-pv_006_b_1_gb_cat
0.1
0.01
0.001
10
100
1 000
10 000
303
RM PV
Fuse protection
new
> 6PDOOLQVWDOODWLRQVXS
WRODUJH39IDUPV
rm-pv_004_a_1_cat
rm-pv_0045_a_1_cat
Strong points
RM PV 10x38
32 A
RM PV 10x38
50 A
Function
RM PV are modular fuse disconnect switches for cylindrical gPV fuses. They provide safety
disconnection and protection against overcurrents in any low DC voltage photovoltaic applications.
RM are fuse disconnect switches with or without light indicators for fuses without striker.
Advantages
Improved safety
q Rated voltage of 1000 VDC.
q Self-extinguishing thermoplastic material.
q Protection IP2X.
Product dedicated to PV applications.
Protection against reverse currents thanks to
gPV fuses dedicated to PV applications.
304
Conformity to standards
>
>
>
>
>
IEC 60947-3
IEC 60269
NF EN 60269-1
VDE 0636-10
DIN 43620
RM PV
Fuse disconnect switches
IRU39F\OLQGULFDOIXVHV[DQG[
References
RM PV
32 A
10 x 38
50 A
14 x 51
No. of poles
Reference
Reference
56PV 1401
1 P with signalling
56DC 0015
56PV 0L15
32 A
50 A
10 x 38
14 x 51
1000
1000
1 20
25 32
)XVHUDWLQJ
Fuse rating (A)
Power
Rated dissipated power (W)
'HVLJQFXUUHQWGHUDWLQJFRHIILFLHQWIRU1SROHVLGHE\VLGH
N=13
N=46
0.8
0.8
N=79
0.7
0.7
-
0.6
0.6
0.75
1.5
Connection
Minimum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Maximum Cu rigid cable cross-section (mm)
10
35
2.5
2.5 3
0.1
0, 15
0HFKDQLFDOFKDUDFWHULVWLFV
Weight of 1 P (kg)
Dimensions
RM PV 10 x 38
RM PV 14 x 51
100.7
76
79.5
49.5
43
110
45
35.3
3.2
10
rm-pv_003_a_1_x_cat
45
78
17.5
2.5
16.5
rm-pv_002_a_1_x_cat
61
56
49.5
26.5
305
PV Fuse bases
Fuse protection
new
socle-pv_004_a_1_cat
socle-pv_002_a_1_cat
Strong points
Conformity to standards
Base
size 1
Base
size 2
Function
SOCOMEC fuse bases provide fixed, unipolar or multipolar support for knife edge fuses
dedicated to PV applications.
Advantages
Improved safety
q Rated voltage of 1000 VDC.
q Self-extinguishing thermoplastic material.
q Kit IP2X (depending on models).
Product dedicated to PV applications.
Protection against reverse currents thanks to
gPV fuses dedicated to PV applications.
306
>
>
>
>
IEC 60269
NF EN 60269-1
VDE 0636-10
DIN 43620
PV Fuse bases
References
Back plate mounted device
Rating
Fuse size
30-160 A
NH1
200-355 A
2XL
400-600 A
3L
No. of poles
Reference
Reference
Reference
1P
65PV 1011
65PV 1112
65PV 1113
Reference
6500 0031
6500 0003
6500 0012
6500 0022
6511 1011(1)
(1) IP20 single-pole kit consisting of 2 connecting blocks, 2 phase separation shields, 2 terminal shrouds and 1 fuse cover.
Dimensions
Fuse bases 30 to 160 A - NH1 size
socle-pv_001_a_1_x_cat
A
B
N
A
socle-pv_005_a_1_x_cat
F
K
Rating
(A)
Fuse
size
30 160
NH1
200
175
200 355
2XL
287
257
400 600
3L
307
270
68
60
28
148
77.5
35
64
30
100
37
40
103
38
140
80
123
250
M10
25
140
103
M10
17.5
30
10.5
20.5
30
10.5
M12
25
30
10.5
307
Changeover switches
Safety and reliability for your switching applications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
p. 310
p. 311
p. 312
p. 314
p. 380
SIRCO M
SIRCO VM1
25 to 100 A
p. 316
25 to 125 A
p. 320
63 to 125 A
p. 324
SIRCOVER
SIRCOVER
Bypass
125 to
3200 A
p. 328
125 to
1600 A
p. 328
Enclosed changeover
switches
SOCOMEC offers a
range of pre-equipped
enclosures in steel or
polyester.
SIRCOVER
ATS Bypass
125 to 1600 A
p. 346
Enclosed
SIRCOVER
p. 625
Enclosed
ATS Bypass
p. 642
ATyS M 3s
Single-phase
ATyS M 3s
p. 366
p. 366
Enclosed
ATyS M
p. 630
ATyS M 6s
ATyS M 6
p. 366
p. 366
Enclosed
ATyS
From 40 to 3200 A
p. 636
new
new
new
ATyS S
ATyS Sd
ATyS
ATyS d
ATyS t
p. 374
p. 382
p. 384
new
new
ATyS g
ATyS p
p. 386
p. 388
Special requests
SOCOMEC develops
RODBHjBOQNCTBSR
6DVHKKGDKOXNTjMCSGD
best solution for your
application.
Please feel free to consult us.
UL range
SIRCOVER UL
p. 350
p. 404
Photovoltaic applications
SIRCOVER PV
200 to 630 A
p. 365
309
Changeover
switches
q Transformer/Transformer changeover
O
I
II
GE
II
II
O
I
II
Critical
loads
Tower/building application
Also available
A specific need?
310
tablo_028_a
coff_366_a
atys_845_a
atys_846_a_gb
atys_844_a_gb
Critical
loads
Non critical
loads
Non critical
loads
ATYS-P 001 A
ATyS M range
Modular profile
from 40 to 160 A
ATyS S range
Back-to-back
configuration
ATYS-S 018 A
ATYSM 007 A
from 40 to 125 A
ATyS S
Switching applications
with Genset(s)
ATyS
ATyS d
ATyS t
ATyS g
ATyS p
Transformer/Transformer application
Transformer/Genset application
(1)
Automatic (ATSE)
Integrated
Specific functionalities
On load and off load tests
Power management
Communication options
Terms:
qRTSE (Remote operated Transfer
Switching Equipment)
qATSE (Automatic Transfer Switching
Equipment)
311
Selection guide
Manual changeover switches
Changeover
switches
How many
poles ?
COMO C
25 to 100 A
p. 316
SIRCO M
25 to 125 A
p. 320
SIRCO VM1
63 to 125 A
p. 324
3P
4P
I-0-II
I-I+II-II
Bypass
Number of poles
Switch operation
Indication of breaking
Positive break indication
Visible contacts
Operating handle
Front direct/external operation
(1) Depending on the version. From 125 to 3200A for SIRCOVER I-0-II; from 125 to 1800A for SIRCOVER I-I+II-II and from 125 to 1600A for SIRCOVER Bypass.
312
Selection guide
What kind
of breaking
indication ?
What kind of
operations ?
SIRCOVER
125 to 3200 A(1)
p. 328
SIRCOVER PV
200 to 630 A
p. 358
SIRCOVER UL
100 to 1200 A
p. 350
313
Selection guide
Motorised and automatic changeover switches
ATyS
Which type of
transfer?
Changeover
switches
Which rating?
ATyS M 3s
p. 366
ATyS M 6s
p. 366
ATyS M 6e
p. 366
Type of transfer
Number
of poles
b3
3
b3
$7\6'UHPRWHFRQWUROLQWHUIDFH
&RQILJXUDWLRQXVLQJGLVSOD\DQGNH\ERDUG
9ROWDJHDQGIUHTXHQF\DXWRFRQILJXUDWLRQ
)L[HGIXQFWLRQLQSXWVRXWSXWV
3URJUDPPDEOH,QSXWV2XWSXWV
7UDQVIRUPHU7UDQVIRUPHUDSSOLFDWLRQ
&RQWDFWIRUSURGXFWDYDLODELOLW\
0RQLWRULQJRIYROWDJHVDQGIUHTXHQF\
3KDVHURWDWLRQFKHFN
8QEDODQFHGSKDVHFKHFNLQJ
/('LQGLFDWLRQRIVRXUFHDYDLODELOLW\
/('SRVLWLRQLQGLFDWLRQ
'LVSOD\RIFRXQWHUVDQGYROWDJHIUHTXHQF\PHDVXUHPHQWV
2QORDGDQGRIIORDGWHVW
Load shedding
'LVSOD\DQGPHDVXUHPHQWRISRZHUVDQGHQHUJ\ZKHQXWLOLVLQJ&7V
314
Selection guide
Which type of
power supply?
Which
application?
40 to 100 A
new
Need of
supervision?
125 to 3200 A
new
new
new
new
n ew
new
ATyS S
p. 374
ATyS Sd
p. 374
ATyS
p. 382
ATyS d
p. 382
ATyS t
p. 384
ATyS g
p. 386
ATyS p
p. 388
315
COMO C
Manual changeover switches
from 25 to 100 A
The solution for
como_178_a_1
como_179_a_1
Changeover
switches
Strong points
COMO C
I-I+II-II 4P 63 A
>
>
>
>
COMO C
I-0-II 3P 25 A
Function
Conformity to standards
COMO C are manual multipolar changeover switches with positive break indication. They
provide changeover, source inversion or switching under load between two low voltage power
circuits, as well as their safety isolation.
Advantages
> UL 508
Bridging bars
Bridging bars are supplied factory fitted as
standard.
Flexibility
Four types of changeover switches are
available as standard (I-II, I-0-II, I-I+II-II &
Bypass I-0-II). Other switching options are
available on request.
Compact design
With its small frame size, the COMO C can be
installed where limited space is available.
Configurations
como_168_b_1_x_cat
2
3
6
4
316
COMO C
Manual changeover switches
from 25 to 100 A
References
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Switching type
3P
I - II
4220 3002(1)
4P
I - II
4220 4002(1)
3P
I - 0 - II
4230 3002(1)(3)
4P
I - 0 - II
(1)(3)
4230 4002
3P
I - I+II - II
4240 3002(1)
4P
I - I+II - II
4240 4002(1)
3+6P
Bypass I - 0 - II
4250 3002
4+8P
Bypass I - 0 - II
4250 4002
3P
I - II
4220 3004(1)
4P
I - II
4220 4004(1)
3P
I - 0 - II
4230 3004(1)(3)
4P
I - 0 - II
4230 4004(1)(3)
25 A
40 A
Switch body
I - I+II - II
4240 3004
I - I+II - II
4240 4004(1)
3+6P
Bypass I - 0 - II
4250 3004
4+8P
Bypass I - 0 - II
4250 4004
3P
I - II
4220 3006(1)
4P
I - II
4220 4006(1)
3P
I - 0 - II
4230 3006(1)(3)
4P
I - 0 - II
4230 4006(1)(3)
3P
I - I+II - II
4240 3006(1)
4P
I - I+II - II
4240 4006(1)
3+6P
Bypass I - 0 - II
4+8P
Bypass I - 0 - II
3P
I - II
4220 3008(1)
4P
I - II
4220 4008(1)
3P
I - 0 - II
4230 3008(1)(3)
4P
I - 0 - II
(1)(3)
4230 4008
3P
I - I+II - II
4240 3008(1)
4P
I - I+II - II
4240 4008(1)
3+6P
Bypass I - 0 - II
4250 3008
4+8P
Bypass I - 0 - II
4250 4008
IP65 gasket
I - II
I - 0 - II and
Bypass
4259 3022
I - I+II - II
4259 4022
DIN rail mounted
4259 1042
200 mm
4259 9001
Red/Yellow
4259 5042
Base-mounted
4259 1043
4299 5001(2)
4259 9040
I - II
4259 2042
I - 0 - II and
Bypass
4259 3042
I - I+II - II
4259 4042
4250 3006
4250 4006
3P
I - II
4220 3010
4P
I - II
4220 4010
3P
I - 0 - II
4230 3010
4P
I - 0 - II
4230 4010
3P
I - I+II - II
4240 3010
4P
I - I+II - II
4240 4010
3+6P
Bypass I - 0 - II
4250 3010
4+8P
Bypass I - 0 - II
4250 4010
100 A
Shaft and
Back plate
escutcheon for mounting device
external handle
4259 2022
(1)
4P
80 A
IP54 nonpadlockable
white handle
Black/Grey
3P
63 A
IP54 padlockable
handle
I - II
Black/Grey
4259 1082
Red/Yellow
4259 1083
4259 2082
I - 0 - II and
Bypass
4259 3082
I - I+II - II
4259 9001
4259 5082
Base-mounted
4299 5002(2)
4259 9080
4259 4082
317
COMO C
Manual changeover switches
from 25 to 100 A
Accessories
IP54 handle
Padlockable handle
Handle colour
Black/Grey
Red/Yellow
Black/Grey
Red/Yellow
Reference
Switching type
I - II
I - 0 - II and Bypass
I - I+II - II
I - II
I - 0 - II and Bypass
I - I+II - II
I - II
I - 0 - II and Bypass
I - I+II - II
Reference
4259 1042
4259 1043
4259 1082
4259 1083
acces_110_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
25 40
25 40
63 100
63 100
Non-padlockable handle
4259 2022
4259 3022
4259 4022
4259 2042
4259 3042
4259 4042
4259 2082
4259 3082
4259 4082
acces_142_b_1_cat
Rating (A)
25
25
25
40
40
40
63 100
63 100
63 100
Rating (A)
Length (mm)
Reference
25 40
200 mm
63 100
200 mm
4259 5042
4259 5082
acces_072_a_1_cat
Use
Standard length: 200 mm.
Other lengths: Please consult us.
25 A
660
4
40 A
660
4
63 A
660
4
80 A
660
4
100 A
660
4
A/B(1)
25/25
25/25
20/20
A/B(1)
40/40
40/40
32/32
A/B(1)
63/63
63/63
63/63
A/B(1)
80/80
80/80
63/63
A/B(1)
100/100
100/100
63/63
9/9
15/15
22/22
30/30
30/30
14
18
28
37
6
25
6
40
8
63
8
80
8
100
2.6
5.8
5.8
6.5
2.5
6
2
10
16
2
16
50
3.5
16
50
3.5
16
50
3.5
100 000
0.25
0.31
100 000
0.3
0.4
100 000
0.55
0.7
100 000
0.63
0.8
100 000
0.63
0.8
Utilisation category
AC-21 A
AC-22 A
AC-23 A
Short-circuit capacity
Closing capacity on short-circuit (kA peak) (3)
Connection
Minimum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Maximum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Tightening torque min (Nm)
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
Weight of 3 P switch (kg)
Weight of 4 P switch (kg)
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer to another.
(3) For a rated operational voltage Ue = 400 VAC.
318
COMO C
Manual changeover switches
from 25 to 100 A
Dimensions
COMO C 25 A
Direct operation rear mounting
10
10
14.3
A
B
A
B
36
48
12.5
12.5
48
75 min.
10
10
L
10
48
10
48
10
64
36
A
B
como_113_e_1_x_cat
10
50
56
64
Switching type
L 3p.
L 4p.
I - II
50.5
60.5
I - 0 - II
50.5
60.5
I - I+II - II
50.5
60.5
Bypass I - 0 - II
70.5
80.5
COMO C 40 A
Direct operation rear mounting
10
18
A
B
18
A
B
18
como_114_g_1_x_cat
10
60
48
A
B
36
10
14.3
64
14.3
10
60
48
75 min.
50
56
64
10
L
Switching type
L 3p.
L 4p.
I - II
60.3
72.3
I - 0 - II
60.3
72.3
I - I+II - II
60.3
72.3
Bypass I - 0 - II
84.3
96.3
COMO C 63 to 100 A
14.5
18
10
18
75.2
71
66
48
36
10
36
A
B
75.2
71
A
B
14.5
36
como_115_g_1_x_cat
10
A
B
10
66
48
80 min.
10
L
Switching type
L 3p.
L 4p.
I - II
82
99.5
I - 0 - II
82
99.5
I - I+II - II
82
99.5
Bypass I - 0 - II
117
134.5
319
SIRCO M
Manual changeover switches
from 25 to 125 A
sircm_192_a_1_cat
Changeover
switches
Strong points
> Secured breaking.
> Modular device.
> On load switching.
sircm_191_a_1_cat
SIRCO M
(((/
Conformity to standards
> IEC 60947-3
SIRCO M
(((/
Function
SIRCO M are manually operated three or four pole modular switches with positive break indication.
They provide changeover, source inversion or switching under load between two low voltage
power circuits, as well as their safety isolation.
Advantages
Secured breaking.
SIRCO M switches include contact point
technology and double break per phase as
standard, enabling safe, optimal operation of
LV electrical circuits.
On load switching
The SIRCO M changeover switch comprises
two mechanically interlocked load break
switches which are tested in accordance with
IEC 60947-3. Its AC23 characteristics enable
it to perform on load changeover switching.
Modular device
Thanks to their modular format, SIRCO M
changeover switches can be fixed to a
#(-Q@HK@A@BJOK@SDNQ@LNCTK@QO@MDK
320
sircm_173_a_1_cat
SIRCO M
Manual changeover switches
from 25 to 125 A
References
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Switch body
3P
2230 3002
4P
2230 4002
3P
2230 3004
S000 type
I - 0 - II
Black IP65
1463 5113(1)
3P
2230 3006
4P
2230 4006
Blue
Red
S00 type
I - 0 - II
Black IP65
S01 type
I - 0 - II
Black IP65
2239 5013
1473 1113(1)
1403 2813
2239 5012
63 A
3P
2230 3008
4P
2230 4008
3P
2230 3010
1P
3P
2294 1005(2)
2299 3005
200 mm
3P
4P
2294 3005(2)
2299 4005
320 mm
1407 0532
S01 type
200 mm
S01 type
I - 0 - II
Black IP65
1404 0520
1403 2113(1)
320 mm
80 A
1404 0532
4P
2230 4010
3P
2230 3011
4P
2230 4011
Blue
Red
S00 type
I - 0 - II
Black IP65
2239 5023
1473 0113
2239 5022
M type contact
NO + NC
2299 0001
M type contact
2 NO
1P
3P
2294 1009(2)
2299 3009
3P
4P
2294 3009(2)
2299 4009
2299 0011
S00 type
150 mm
100 A
1P
1409 0615
2294 1011(2)
200 mm
3P
1409 0620
2294 3016(2)
320 mm
125 A
Bridging kit
1407 0515
1407 0520
40 A
2230 4004
Terminal
shrouds
25 A
4P
Auxiliary
contact
1409 0632
OHDBDR%NQTORSQD@LNQCNVMRSQD@LOQNSDBSHNMNMNMDRHCDNESGDBG@MFDNUDQRVHSBG
Accessories
See "SIRCO M switches", page 31.
25 A
800
8
40 A
800
8
63 A
800
8
80 A
800
8
100 A
800
8
125 A
800
8
A/B(1)
25/25
25/25
25/25
25/25
A/B(1)
40/40
40/40
40/40
40/40
A/B(1)
63/63
63/63
63/63
63/63
A/B(1)
80/80
80/80
80/80
80/80
A/B(1)
100/100
100/100
100/100
100/100
A/B(1)
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
11.3
18
28.4
35.5
45
56.3
50
25
50
40
50
63
50
80
50
100
25
125
Utilisation category
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
Circuit breaker protected short-circuit withstand with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s(4)
Rated short-time withstand current 0.3s Icw (kA rms)
2.3
2.3
2.74
2.74
1.26
1.8
1.26
1.8
1.5
2.1
1.5
2.1
2.75
3.9
2.75
3.9
1.5
16
2 / 2.2
1.5
16
2 / 2.2
2.5
35
3.5 / 3.85
2.5
35
3.5 / 3.85
10
70
4 / 4.4
10
70
4 / 4.4
10 000
0.41
0.51
10 000
0.41
0.51
10 000
0.58
0.75
10000
0.58
0.75
10 000
1.1
1.46
8 000
1.1
1.46
Connection
Minimum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Maximum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Tightening torque mini / maxi (Nm)
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
Weight of a 3 pole device (kg)
Weight of a 4 pole device (kg)
"@SDFNQXVHSGHMCDW EQDPTDMSNODQ@SHNM"@SDFNQXVHSGHMCDW!HMEQDPTDMSNODQ@SHNM
3GDONVDQU@KTDHRFHUDMENQHMENQL@SHNMNMKXSGDBTQQDMSU@KTDRU@QXEQNLNMDL@MTE@BSTQDQ
SN@MNSGDQ
%NQ@Q@SDCNODQ@SHNM@KUNKS@FD4e5 "
5@KTDENQBNNQCHM@SHNMVHSG@MXBHQBTHSAQD@JDQSG@SDMRTQDRSQHOOHMFHMKDRRSG@M
R
%NQ
BNNQCHM@SHNMVHSGRODBHEHB@AQD@JDQQDEDQDMBDRGHFGDQRGNQSBHQBTHSBTQQDMSU@KTDR@QD@U@HK@AKD
/KD@RDBNMRTKSTR
321
SIRCO M
Manual changeover switches
from 25 to 125 A
Dimensions
WR$
Direct front operation for 3/4 pole changeover switches
45
F1
F1
T
43
8,8
44
36
34,7
7,5
T
52,5
+NB@SHNMENQL@HMONKDor@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BS2DD@BBDRRNQHDRO@FD 34).
/NRHSHNMENQ@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSNMKXENQONKDBG@MFDNUDQSGDnd@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSHRENQRHFM@KHR@SHNMNMKX
Note: Maximum 4 additional blocks (3 pole changeover can be fitted with either one main pole and one A/C block,
or two A/C blocks per side; 4 pole changeover can be fitted with only one A/C block per side).
Overall dimensions
Rating (A)
25
6
8,8
80
2G@MCKD
!
2G@MCKD
"
2G@MCKD
Switch body
Switch mounting
Connection
E min
E max
F1
F2
25 40
105
372
97.5
15
45
68
48.75
30
75
15
7.5
63 80
105
372
105
17.5
52.5
76
52.5
35
85
17.5
8.75
WR$
Direct front operation for 3/4 pole changeover switches
84.5
79.6
M
36
71
68
sircm_183_d_1_x_cat
50
13.8
F1
100
8.8
79.6
F
+NB@SHNMENQL@HMONKDor@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BS2DD@BBDRRNQHDRO@FD 34).
/NRHSHNMENQ@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSNMKXSGHRBNMS@BSHRENQRHFM@KHR@SHNMNMKX
Note: Maximum 4 additional blocks (3 pole changeover can be fitted with either one main pole and one A/C block,
or two A/C blocks per side; 4 pole changeover can be fitted with only one A/C block per side).
Overall dimensions
322
Switch body
Switch mounting
Connection
Rating (A)
E min
E max
F1
100 125
105
372
159
26
124.5
52.8
131.5
26
sircm_182_a_1_x_cat
68
N
G
52,5
78
71
89
1
45
J
F2
M
SIRCO M
Manual changeover switches
from 25 to 125 A
Direction of operation
0
or
I+II
S000 type
Changeover switches
I-0-II and I - I+II - II
90
22.5
27
25
II
3.2
45
90
22
45
poign_017_b_1_gb_cat
Door drilling
3.2
13.5
36
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
S01 type
0
or
I+II
Changeover switches
I-0-II and I - I+II - II
40
90
90
II
41
80
47
28
78
poign_019_b_1_gb_cat
Door drilling
37
44
WR$
Front operation
Direction of operation
S00 type
Changeover switches
I-0-II and I - I+II - II
Door drilling
IP55 with 2 xing clips
0
or
I+II
37
22.5
90
71
poign_025_b_1_gb_cat
13.5
37
40
90
71
40
Handle type
I
36
II
28
27
28
47
323
SIRCO VM1
Manual changeover switches
from 63 to 125 A
The solution for
comut_065_b_1
Changeover
switches
Strong points
> Safety isolation.
> Modular device.
> Reduced depth.
SIRCO VM1 I-0-II 4P 100 A
Conformity to standards
Function
SIRCO VM1 changeover switches are manually operated three or four pole changeover
switches with visible breaking.
They provide changeover, source inversion or switching under load between two low voltage
power circuits, as well as their safety isolation.
Advantages
Safety isolation
SIRCO VM1 changeovers enable completely
secure switching thanks to positive break
indication and double visible breaking. The
user can assess the condition of the device
either during a preventive check or before an
operation.
Modular device
SIRCO VM1 changeover switches offer a
range of installation configurations: DIN rail,
backplate or modular panel.
Reduced depth
With its side-by-side switch arrangement, the
SIRCO VM1 changeover can be utilised in
panels with a reduced depth.
Configurations
Functional diagram (for further details see the installation
instructions supplied with the product).
comut_021_b_1_x_cat
324
SIRCO VM1
Manual changeover switches
from 63 to 125 A
References
VM1 changeover switches I-0-II
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Switch body
3P
4430 3006(1)
4P
4430 4006(1)
3P
4430 3008(1)
4P
4430 4008(1)
3P
(1)
63 A
80 A
4430 3010
100 A
Direct handle
External handle
Black
S1 type
Black IP65
4439 5012
1413 2113
IP20 bridging
bars (2)
200 mm
3P
1402 0820
4499 3006
320 mm
4P
1402 0832
4499 4006
Auxiliary contact
1 auxiliar contact
NO/NC
4439 0001
(1)
4P
4430 4010
3P
4430 3012
4P
4430 4012
125 A
No. of poles
Switch body
3P
4440 3006
4P
4440 4006
3P
4440 3008
4P
Direct handle
External handle
4440 4008
3P
1403 0820
4499 3006
3P
4440 3010
4449 5012
S1 type
Black IP65
200 mm
Black
63 A
80 A
100 A
4P
4440 4010
3P
4440 3012
4P
4440 4012
125 A
1413 2114
320 mm
4P
1403 0832
4499 4006
Accessories
Rating (A)
Switching type
Reference
63 125
I - 0 - II
63 125
I - I+II - II
4439 5012
4449 5012
acces_111_a_1_cat
padlockable
External IP(1)
Reference
63 125
I - 0 - II
1 Position
IP55
63 125
I - 0 - II
1 Position
IP65
63 125
I - 0 - II
3 Positions
IP65
63 125
I - I+II - II
1 Position
IP65
63 125
I - I+II - II
3 Positions
IP65
1411 2113
1413 2113
1413 2813
1413 2114
1413 2814
tac_2_a_941_secca
Rating (A)
325
SIRCO VM1
Manual changeover switches
from 63 to 125 A
Accessories (continued)
Use
For single lever type S1 handles.
Colour
acces_198_a_1_cat
To be ordered in multiples of
Reference
Light grey
50
Dark grey
50
1401 0001
1401 0011
Colour
To be ordered
in multiples of
External IP(1)
Reference
IP65
1493 0000
Black
acces_187_a_2_cat
Use
Enables S-type handles to be fitted in place
of existing older style SOCOMEC handles.
Adapter can also be utilised as a spacer to
acces_146_b_1_cat
Dimension X
(mm)
Reference
63 125
128 290
200 mm
63 125
128 410
320 mm
1402 0820
1402 0832
Reference
1403 0820
1403 0832
acces_202_a_1_x_cat
Switching type I - 0 - II
Rating (A)
Switching type I - I + II - II
Rating (A)
Dimension X
(mm)
63 125
128 290
200 mm
63 125
128 410
320 mm
Use
For creating a common connection
between switches I & II, on the top
or bottom side of the SIRCO VM1
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Reference
63 125
3P
63 125
4P
4499 3006
4499 4006
Characteristics
q Snaps on and is secured by a screw.
q Connector block with a maximum capacity of
up to 2 x 1.5 mm2 per terminal.
Rating (A)
Switching type
Contact(s)
Reference
63 125
I - 0 - II
4439 0001(1)
(1) Not available for the make before break changeover switch (I-I+II-II).
326
comut_005_a_1_cat
SIRCO VM1
Manual changeover switches
from 63 to 125 A
63 A
800
8
80 A
800
8
100 A
800
8
125 A
800
8
A/B(1)
63/63
63/63
63/63
63/63
63/63
63/63
40/40
25/25
63/63
63/63
63/63
63/63
A/B(1)
80/80
80/80
80/80
63/63
80/80
80/80
40/40
25/25
80/80
80/80
80/80
63/63
A/B(1)
100/100
100/100
100/100
63/63
100/100
80/80
40/40
25/25
100/100
100/100
100/100
63/63
A/B(1)
125/125
125/125
125/125
63/63
125/125
80/80
40/40
25/25
125/125
125/125
100/100
63/63
30/30
22/22
30/30
22/22
30/30
22/22
30/30
22/22
28
37
45
55
100
63
100
80
100
100
50
125
Utilisation category
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
Circuit breaker protected short-circuit withstand with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s(6)
Rated short-time withstand current 0.3s. Icw (kA rms)
4.5
4.5
4.5
4.5
2.5
3.55
2.5
3.55
2.5
3.55
2.5
3.55
4
50
6
4
50
6
4
50
6
4
50
6
10 000
1.2
1.4
10 000
1.2
1.4
10 000
1.4
1.6
10 000
1.4
1.6
Connection
Minimum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Maximum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Tightening torque mini / maxi (Nm)
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
Weight of 3 P switch (kg)
Weight of 4 P switch (kg)
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) With terminal shrouds or phase barrier.
(3) 4-pole device with 2 poles in series per polarity.
(4) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer
to another.
Dimensions
63 to 125 A
External front operation
1. Max connection
- Rigid: 50 mm2,
- Flexible: 35 mm2
2. 6 -sided 5 - Pozidriv no. 1
slot 4.5 mm.
3. Bridging bar
4. Handle mounting with
2 or 4 screws 7 mm.
0
90
90
I
1
215
75
19.5
75
II
128 mini
45
94
115.5
105
= =
90
4
78
1414
90
44
20 20
89
comut_013_e_1_x_cat
90.5
69.5
44
70
52
182.5
13
21 21 21 44.5
2
II
37
327
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
from 125 to 3200 A
The solution for
svr_099_b_1_cat
Changeover
switches
SIRCOVER
3200 A
Strong points
svr_059_a_1_cat
>
>
>
>
A complete range.
Easy connections.
Stable positions.
Improved on load switching.
Specific features
SIRCOVER AC I-0-II
> On load switching AC-33.
SIRCOVER Bypass
125 A
Conformity to standards
> ,(&
> ,(&
Function
SIRCOVER are manual multipolar changeover switches with positive break indication.
The family includes three ranges:
q SIRCOVER AC for dead time switching (I-0-II),
q SIRCOVER for overlapping contact switching (I-I+II-II), and
q SIRCOVER Bypass. This version is a combination of three interlocked switches enabling use
with 3 + 6 poles or 4 + 8 poles.
They provide switching, source inversion and changeover under load for two low voltage power
circuits, as well as their safety isolation by double breaking per pole.
Enclosed solution
> Available enclosed from
}WR$
Advantages
A complete product range
Three versions of the SIRCOVER are available
to ensure compatibility with the maximum
number of applications: SIRCOVER AC
(I-0-II) with improved on load switching
characteristics and isolation position,
SIRCOVER with overlapping contacts (I-I+II-II)
and a Bypass version.
Easy connections
A copper bar connection kit is available for
2000 to 3200 A ratings. It enables various
types of connection: Flat or edgewise
connection with top or bottom bridging.
328
Stable positions
SIRCOVERs have three stable positions
which are not affected by voltage drops or
vibrations, thus protecting your load against
network interference.
Improved on load switching
Thanks to its AC-23 and AC-33
characteristics, which are tested in
accordance with standards IEC 60947-3 and
IEC 60947-6-1, the SIRCOVER AC enables
secure and reliable switching on all types
of load, without the need for pre-breaking
upstream.
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
IURPWR$
svr_136_a_1_x_cat
q Copper bar connection kits enable the connection between the two power terminals of the same pole (fig.1 & fig.2) and the bridging of the
poles on the top or bottom side of the switch (fig.3), for ratings 2000, 2500 and 3200 A.
Fig.2
Fig. 3
acces_231_a_1_cat
acces_226_c_2_cat
acces_229_b_2_cat
Fig. 1
Edgewise connection
Top or bottom
329
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
IURPWR$
References
SIRCOVER AC I-0-II
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Switch body
3P
41AC 3013
4P
41AC 4013
3P
41AC 3016
Shaft for
Direct handle External handle external handle Bridging bars
Auxiliary
contact
Terminal
shrouds
Terminal
screens
125 A
3P
2694 3014(3)(4)
4109 0019
160 A
4P
41AC 4016
3P
41AC 3020
4P
41AC 4020
3P
41AC 3025
4P
41AC 4025
3P
41AC 3031
4P
2694 4014(3)(4)
3P
1509 3012
4P
1509 4012
200 A
250 A
315 A
J2 type
Blue
1122 1111
1421 2113
Red
Black IP65
1123 1111
4P
S2 type
Black IP55
1423 2113(1)
200 mm
4109 0025
1400 1020
3P
320 mm
2694 3021(3)(4)
1400 1032(1)
4P
41AC 4031
2694 4021(3)(4)
4109 0039
3P
41AC 3039
4P
41AC 4039
3P
41AC 3050
3P
1509 3025
4P
1509 4025
400 A
4109 0050
500 A
4P
41AC 4050
3P
41AC 3063
1st/2nd contact
NO/NC
4109 0021(2)
4P
2694 4051(3)(4)
4109 0063
630 A
4P
41AC 4063
3P
41AC 3080
4P
41AC 4080
3P
41AC 3100
4P
41AC 4100
3P
2694 3051(3)(4)
3P
1509 3063(5)
4P
1509 4063(5)
800 A
1000 A
3P
41AC 3120
1250 A
4P
41AC 4120
3P
41AC 3160
4P
41AC 4160
4109 0080
3P
1509 3080(5)
4P
J3 type
Blue
1509 4080(5)
1132 1111
S4 type
Black IP65
Red
1443 3113
1133 1111
200 mm
1401 1520
320 mm
4109 0120
1401 1532(1)
1600 A
3P
1509 3160(5)
4109 0160
3P
41AC 3180
4P
41AC 4180
4P
1509 4160(5)
1800 A
3P
41AC 3200
4P
41AC 4200
3P
41AC 3250
2000 A
2500 A
4P
41AC 4250
3P
41AC 3320
4P
41AC 4320
200 mm
S5 type
Black
S5 type
Black IP65
2799 7042
1453 8113
3200 A
(1) Standard.
(2) 2 pieces supplied, one for position I and one for position II.
(3) To fully shroud front, rear, top and bottom 4 references required.
(4) To shroud front switch top and bottom 2 references required.
(5) 2 pieces supplied, one for top side and another for bottom side.
(6) See "Copper bar connection kits" page 335.
330
2799 3015
320 mm
2799 3018(1)
450 mm
2799 3019
(6)
1st contact
NO/NC
included
included
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
IURPWR$
SIRCOVER I - I+II - II
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Switch body
3P
4190 3013(1)
4P
4190 4013(1)
3P
4190 3016(1)
Shaft for
Direct handle External handle external handle
Bridging bar
Auxiliary
contact
Terminal
shrouds
Terminal
screens
125 A
3P
2694 3014(4)(5)
4109 0019
160 A
4P
4190 4016(1)
3P
4190 3019
4P
4190 4019
3P
4190 3025(1)
4P
2694 4014(4)(5)
3P
1509 3012
4P
1509 4012
200 A
250 A
4P
4190 4025(1)
3P
4190 3039(1)
Black
(2)
4199 5012
S2 type
Black IP65
1423 2114(2)
200 mm
1400 1020
320 mm
4109 0025
3P
1400 1032(2)
2694 3021(4)(5)
4P
2694 4021(4)(5)
4109 0039
400 A
4P
4190 4039(1)
3P
4190 3050(1)
4P
4190 4050(1)
3P
4190 3063(1)
4P
4190 4063(1)
3P
4190 3080(1)
4P
4190 4080(1)
3P
4190 3120(1)
4109 0050
500 A
4109 0080
800 A
4190 4120(1)
3P
4190 3160(1)
4P
4190 4160(1)
Black
(2)
2799 7052
S4 type
Black IP65
1443 3114(2)
200 mm
4109 0120
4P
4190 4180
4P
1509 4063(6)
3P
1800 A
1509 4080(6)
1401 1520
320 mm
1401 1532(2)
3P
4109 0160
4190 3180
2694 4051(4)(5)
3P
1509 3063(6)
4P
1600 A
3P
3P
1509 3080(6)
1250 A
4P
4109 0021(3)
4P
4109 0063
4P
1509 4025
1st/2nd contact
NO/NC
2694 3051(4)(5)
630 A
3P
1509 3025
1509 3160(6)
4P
1509 4160(6)
331
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
IURPWR$
References (continued)
SIRCOVER Bypass
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Switch body
I-0-II
3+6P
4100 7013(1)
4+8P
4100 9013(1)
3+6P
4100 7016(1)
Shaft for
Direct handle External handle external handle
Bridging bar
Auxiliary
contact
Terminal
shrouds
Terminal
screens
125 A
Black
160 A
4+8P
4100 9016(1)
3+6P
4100 7019
4+8P
4100 9019
3+6P
4100 7025(1)
4+8P
4100 9025(1)
3+6P
4100 7039(1)
4+8P
4100 9039(1)
4199 5012
S2 type
Black IP55
200 mm
1421 2113(2)
1400 1020
Black IP65
1400 1032(2)
1423 2113
3P
2694 3014(4)(5)
4109 0019
320 mm
4P
2694 4014(4)(5)
3P
1509 3012
4P
1509 4012
200 A
4109 0025
250 A
3P
2694 3021(4)(5)
4P
2694 4021(4)(5)
3P
1509 3025
4P
1509 4025
4109 0039
400 A
Black
3+6P
4100 7050(1)
4+8P
4100 9050(1)
3+6P
4100 7063(1)
4+8P
4100 9063(1)
3+6P
4100 7080(1)
4+8P
4100 9080(1)
3+6P
4100 7120(1)
4+8P
4100 9120(1)
2799 7052
S3 type
Black IP65
1433 3113
200 mm
1st/2nd contact
NO/NC
1401 1520
320 mm
4109 0021(3)
1401 1532(2)
4109 0050
500 A
3P
2694 3051(4)(5)
4P
2694 4051(4)(5)
3P
1509 3063(6)
4P
1509 4063(6)
4109 0063
630 A
4109 0080
800 A
1250 A
3P
1509 3080(6)
4P
200 mm
1509 4080(6)
2799 3015
Black
Black IP65
2799 7012
4199 7146
320 mm
2799 3018(2)
4109 0120
450 mm
2799 3019
3+6P
4100 7160(1)
4+8P
4100 9160(1)
4109 0160
1600 A
332
3P
1509 3160(6)
4P
1509 4160(6)
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
IURPWR$
Accessories
Handle type
J2 type
J2 type
J3 type
J3 type
S5 type
Reference
SIRCOVER I - I+II - II
Rating (A)
Handle colour
125 630
Black
800 1800
Black
Handle type
B3 type
C1 type
Reference
SIRCOVER Bypass
Rating (A)
Handle colour
125 200
Black
250 630
Black
800 1600
Black
Handle type
B3 type
C1 type
C2 type
Reference
acces_356_a_1_cat
1122 1111
1123 1111
1132 1111
1133 1111
2799 7042(1)
4199 5012
2799 7052
J2 type handle
acces_153_a_2_cat
SIRCOVER AC I-0-II
Rating (A)
Handle colour
125 630
Blue
125 630
Red
800 1800
Blue
800 1800
Red
2000 3200
Black
acces_129_b_1_cat
C1 type handle
4199 5012
2799 7052
2799 7012(1)
C2 type handle
S2 type handle
SIRCOVER Bypass
Rating (A)
125 200
125 200
250 630
800 1600
Switching type
I - 0 - II
I - 0 - II
I - 0 - II
I - 0 - II
External
IP(1)
IP55
IP65
IP65
IP65
Handle
S2 type
S2 type
S3 type
V2 type
Reference
1421 2113
1423 2113
1433 3113
4199 7146
acces_152_a_2_cat
S3 type handle
acces_286_a_1_cat
Reference
1421 2113
1423 2113
1423 2114
1443 3113(2)
1443 3114(2)
1453 8113(2)
acces_151_a_1_cat
Handle
S2 type
S2 type
S2 type
S4 type
S4 type
S5 type
acces_150_a_2_cat
S4 type handle
S5 type handle
Colour
Light grey
Dark grey
Light grey
Dark grey
To be ordered
in multiples of
50
50
50
50
Handle
S2, S3 type
S2, S3 type
S4 type
S4 type
acces_198_a_2_cat
Use
For single lever handles S1, S2, S3 type and for double lever handle S4 type.
Other colours: Please consult us.
Reference
1401 0001
1401 0011
1401 0031
1401 0041
Colour
Black
Dimensions
Adds 12 mm to the depth.
To be ordered
in multiples of
External IP(1)
Reference
IP65
1493 0000
acces_187_a_1_cat
Use
Enables S-type handles to be fitted in place
of existing older style SOCOMEC handles.
Adapter can also be utilised as a spacer to
increase the distance between the panel
door and the handle lever.
333
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
IURPWR$
Accessories (continued)
Shaft guide for external operation
Description
Reference
Shaft guide
1429 0000
acces_260_a_2_cat
Use
To guide the shaft extension into the
external handle.
This accessory enables handle to engage
extension shaft with a misalignment of up
to 15 mm.
SIRCOVER Bypass
Rating (A)
Length (mm)
125 200
200
125 200
320
250 400
200
250 400
320
500 630
200
500 ... 630
320
800 1600
200
800 1600
320
800 1600
450
Dimension X (mm)
320 450
320 570
298 420
298 540
417 539
417 659
550 ... 680
550 800
550 930
Reference
acces_144_b_1_cat
1400 1020
1400 1032
1400 1020
1400 1032
1401 1520
1401 1532
2799 3015
2799 3018
2799 3019
Reference
1400 1020
1400 1032
1401 1520
1401 1532
1401 1520
1401 1532
2799 3015
2799 3018
2799 3019
acces_202_a_1_x_cat
acces_369_a_1_cat
Bridging bars
4109 0019
4109 0025
4109 0039
4109 0050
4109 0063
4109 0080
4109 0120
4109 0160
334
acces_208_a_2_cat
svr_068_a_1_x_cat
Reference
SIRCOVER Bypass
acces_205_a_2_cat
Section (mm)
20 x 2.5
25 x 2.5
32 x 5
32 x 5
50 x 5
50 x 6
60 x 8
90 x 10
SIRCOVER AC I-0-II
and SIRCOVER I-I+II-II
svr_124_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
125 200
250
315 400
500
630
800 1000
1250
1600 1800
acces_041_a_1_cat
Use
For creating a common connection
between switches I & II, on the top
or bottom side of the SIRCOVER, to
enable, for example, the load to be fed
from either incoming source (I or II).
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
IURPWR$
Fig. 1
acces_226_b_1_x_cat
Use
Enables:
- connection between the two power
terminals of the same pole for 2000 to
3200 A ratings (Fig. 1 and Fig 2).
- top or bottom bridging connection (Fig. 3).
3200
3200
Connection - part A
Bolt set - part B
Reference
2619 1200
2699 1200
included
2699 1200
155
Piece
Connection - part A
Bolt set - part B
74
37 60
129
Rating (A)
2000 2500
2000 2500
Quantity to order
per pole(1)
2
2
74
37
Fig.2
acces_228_b_1_x_cat
(1) Example for 3 pole device equipped upstream only: Order 3 times
the indicated quantities.
Quantity to order
per pole(1)
2
2
2
3200
3200
3200
Connection - part A
T piece - part C
Bracket- part D
2
2
Reference
2619 1200
2629 1200(2)
2639 1200(2)
30303030
132
30303030 22
acces_233_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
2000 2500
2000 2500
2000 2500
210
included
2629 1200(2)
2639 1200(2)
acces_232_a_1_cat
252
(1) Example for 3 pole device equipped upstream only: Order 3 times
the indicated quantities.
(2) Bolt set is provided with the accessories.
Fig. 3
Rating (A)
2000 2500
2000 2500
2000 2500
2000 2500
Piece
Connection - part A
Bolt set - part B
Bar - part E
T piece - part C
Quantity to order
per pole(1)
2
2
1
1
2619 1200
2699 1200
4109 0250(2)
2629 1200(2)
3200
3200
3200
3200
Connection - part A
Bolt set - part B
Bar - part E
T piece - part C
2
1
1
2699 1200
4109 0320(2)
2629 1200(2)
Reference
A
225
(1) Example for 3 pole device equipped upstream only: Order 3 times the
indicated quantities.
(2) Bolt set is provided with the accessories.
148
acces_234_a_1_cat
30303030
included
acces_230_b_1_x_cat
Auxiliary contact
svr_058_a_1_cat
Use
Pre breaking and signalling of positions I
and II: 1 or 2 NO/NC auxiliary contacts in
each position.
+NVKDUDK@TWHKH@QXBNMS@BSR/KD@RDBNMRTKSTR
Characteristics
Rating (A)
A - 250
13 VAC
400 VAC
AC-13
24 VDC
DC-13
48 VDC
DC-13
125 3200
16
12
14
acces_065_a_1_cat
Contact(s)
Reference
125 1800
1st/2nd
4109 0021
2000 3200
1st
included
335
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
IURPWR$
Accessories (continued)
Terminal shrouds
Rating (A)
No. of
poles
Position
Reference
125 200
3P
125 200
4P
250 400
3P
250 400
4P
500 630
3P
500 630
4P
2694 3014(1)(2)
2694 4014(1)(2)
2694 3021(1)(2)
2694 4021(1)(2)
2694 3051(1)(2)
2694 4051(1)(2)
acces_206_a_2_cat
Advantage
Perforations allow remote thermographic
inspection without the need to remove the
shrouds.
Use
Protection against direct contact with
terminals or connecting parts.
(1) To shroud front switch top and bottom 4 references required for a SIRCOVER
and 6 references for a SIRCOVER Bypass.
(2) To shroud front switch top and bottom 2 references required for a SIRCOVER
and a SIRCOVER Bypass.
Terminal screens
336
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Position
Reference
125 200
3P
top / bottom
125 200
4P
top / bottom
250 400
3P
top / bottom
250 400
4P
top / bottom
500 630
3P
top / bottom
500 630
4P
top / bottom
800 1250
3P
top / bottom
800 1250
4P
top / bottom
1600 1800
3P
top / bottom
1600 1800
4P
top / bottom
1509 3012
1509 4012
1509 3025
1509 4025
1509 3063
1509 4063
1509 3080
1509 4080
1509 3160
1509 4160
2000 3200
3/4P
top / bottom
included
acces_207_a_2_cat
Use
Top and bottom protection against direct contact with terminals or
connection parts.
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
IURPWR$
Rating (A)
SIRCOVER
Bypass
Operation
Figure
Reference
125 630
125 200
external
1423 2813
Rating (A)
SIRCOVER
Bypass
125 630
125 200
direct
4109 1006(1)
250 630
direct
Please consult us
800 1800
800 1600
direct
direct
4109 1004(2)
4109 2007(2)
1499 7701(2)
2799 7002(2)
2000 3200
Operation Figure
125 1800
125 630
external
2000 3200
800 1600
external
Reference
Use
q Using padlock (not supplied).This device is factory mounted in
the direct or external operation handle and allows the use of
up to 3 padlocks.
q Locking:
q - using lock (not supplied)
q - using undervoltage coil.
q The interlocking positions are either determined as standard or
configured by the user by removing the pre-formed tabs.
q Padlocking and locking can be combined.
Rating (A)
SIRCOVER
Bypass
Operation
Figure
Reference
125 630
125 200
direct
4109 1002(1)
250 630
direct
Please consult us
800 1800
800 1600
direct
direct
125 1800
125 630
external
2000 3200
800 1600
external
4109 1004(2)
4109 2007(2)
1499 7701(2)
2799 7002(2)
2000 3200
acces_001_a_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
SIRCOVER
Fig.2
acces_061_a_1_x_cat
Fig. 1
Fig. 3
Fig.4
Rating (A)
SIRCOVER
Bypass
Operation
Figure
Reference
800 3200
800 1600
direct
Please consult us
Rating (A)
SIRCOVER
Bypass
Operation
Figure
Reference
125 1800
125 630
external
external
1499 7702
2799 7003
acces_158_a_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
SIRCOVER
acces_132_a_1_x_cat
bd_03_04_01
337
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
IURPWR$
125 A
800
8
160 A
800
8
200 A
800
8
250 A
1000
12
315A
1000
12
400 A
1000
12
500 A
1000
12
630 A
1000
12
A/B(1)
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
80/80
125/125
125/125
125/125
63/80
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
A/B(1)
160/160
160/160
160/160
160/160
160/160
160/160
160/160
80/80
160/160
160/160
125/125
63/80
160/160
160/160
160/160
125/125
160/160
125/125
125/125
125/125
A/B(1)
200/200
200/200
200/200
200/200
200/200
200/200
200/200
80/80
200/200
200/200
125/125
63/80
200/200
200/200
200/200
125/125
200/200
125/125
125/125
125/125
A/B(1)
250/250
250/250
250/250
200/200
250/250
250/250
200/250
200/200
250/250
200/200
160/160
125/125
250/250
250/250
250/250
200/200
250/250
200/200
200/200
200/200
A/B(1)
315/315
315/315
315/315
315/315
315/315
315/315
200/315
200/200
315/315
200/200
160/160
125/125
315/315
250/250
250/250
200/200
315/315
200/200
200/200
200/200
A/B(1)
400/400
400/400
400/400
400/400
400/400
400/400
200/400
200/200
400/400
200/200
160/160
125/125
400/400
250/250
250/250
200/200
400/400
200/200
200/200
200/200
A/B(1)
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
400/400
500/500
500/500
400/400
400/400
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
A/B(1)
630/630
630/630
630/630
630/630
630/630
630/630
500/500
400/400
630/630
500/500
400/400
400/400
630/630
630/630
630/630
630/630
630/630
630/630
630/630
630/630
63/63
55/75
80/80
55/75
80/80
55/75
132/132
90/110
132/132
90/110
280/280
150/185
280/280
150/185
450/450
185/220
55
75
90
115
145
185
230
290
A/B(1)
160
A/B(1)
200
A/B(1)
250
200
200
A/B(1)
315
315
200
A/B(1)
400
400
200
A/B(1)
500
500
400
A/B(1)
630
500
400
50 (5)
200
50
250
50
315
50
400
50
500
50
630
Utilisation category
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
5DWHGRSHUDWLRQDOFXUUHQWV,H$DFFRUGLQJWR,(&
Rated voltage
415 VAC
415 VAC
415 VAC
Utilisation category
AC-31 A / AC-31 B
AC-32 A / AC-32 B
AC-33 A / AC-33 B
A/B(1)
125
)XVHSURWHFWHGVKRUWFLUFXLWZLWKVWDQGDVSHU,(&DW9$&
Prospective short-circuit current (kA rms)
Associated fuse rating (A)
100 (5)
125
100 (5)
160
&LUFXLWEUHDNHUSURWHFWHGVKRUWFLUFXLWZLWKVWDQGZLWKDQ\FLUFXLWEUHDNHUWKDWHQVXUHVWULSSLQJLQOHVVWKDQV
Rated short-time withstand current 0.3s Icw (kA rms)
12 (5)
12 (5)
12 (5)
15
15
15
17
17
7 (5)
11.9
8
22
8
22
8
22
10
17
10
17
10 (6)
10 (6)
10 (6)
10
12.6
6KRUWFLUFXLWZLWKVWDQGZLWKRXWSURWHFWLRQDVSHU,(&DW9$&
Rated short-time withstand current 1s Icw (kA rms)
Rated short-circuit making capacity Icm (kA peak)
Rated short-time withstand current 60ms Icw
(kA rms) as per IEC 60947-6-1 at 415 VAC
7 (5)
11.9
7 (5)
11.9
Connection
Minimum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Minimum Cu busbar cross-section (mm2)
Maximum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Maximum Cu busbar width (mm)
Tightening torque mini / maxi (Nm)
35
50
70
95
150
185
240
50
25
9/13
95
25
9/13
120
25
9/13
150
32
20/26
240
32
20/26
240
32
20/26
2 x 185
50
20/26
2 x 150
2 x 30 x 5
2 x 300
50
20/26
2.9
4.1
2.9
4.1
2.9
4.1
3.8
4.6
3.9
4.9
3.9
4.9
8.6
10.4
9.1
11.1
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
Weight of 3 P switch (kg)
Weight of 4 P switch (kg)
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) 3-pole device with 2 pole in series for the "+" and 1 pole for the "-".4-pole device with 2 pole
in series by polarity.
(3) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer
to another.
338
(4) Value for coordination with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s.
For coordination with specific circuit-breaker references, higher short-circuit current values are
available. Please consult us.
(5) Data at 415 VAC
(6) Data at 30 ms
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
IURPWR$
800 to 3200 A
Thermal current Ith at 40C
Rated insulation voltage Ui (V)
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp (kV)
800 A
1000
12
1000 A
1000
12
1250 A
1000
12
1600 A
1000
12
1800 A
1000
12
2000 A
1000
12
2500 A
1000
12
3200 A
1000
12
A/B(1)
800/800
800/800
800/800
800/800
800/800
800/800
630/630
400/400
800/800
800/800
630/630
400/400
800/800
800/800
800/800
800/800
800/800
800/800
800/800
800/800
A/B(1)
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
800/800
630/630
1000/1000
1000/1000
800/800
630/630
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
A/B(1)
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1000/1000
800/800
1250/1250
1250/1250
1000/1000
800/800
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
A/B(1)
1600/1600
1600/1600
1600/1600
1250/1250
1600/1600
1600/1600
1000/1000
800/800
1600/1600
1600/1600
1600/1600
1000/1000
1600/1600
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1600/1600
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
A/B(1)
1800/1800
1800/1800
1600/1600
1250/1250
1800/1800
1600/1600
1000/1000
800/800
1800/1800
1600/1600
1600/1600
1000/1000
1800/1800
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1800/1800
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
A/B(1)
2000/2000
-/2000
-/2000
-/1600
2000/2000
-/2000
A/B(1)
2500/2500
-/2500
-/2500
-/1600
2500/2500
-/2500
A/B(1)
3200/3200
-/3200
-/3200
-/1600
3200/3200
-/3200
2000/2000
-/2000
2500/2500
-/2500
3200/3200
-/3200
710/710
185/220
710/710
475/475
710/710
475/475
710/710
750/750
710/710
750/750
710/710
750/750
365
460
575
A/B(1)
1000
1000
800
A/B(1)
1250
1250
800
A/B(1)
1600
1600
1000
A/B(1)
1800
1600
1000
A/B(1)
2000
2000
1250
A/B(1)
2500
2000
1250
A/B(1)
3200
2000
1250
100
1250
100
2 x 800
100
2 x 800
Utilisation category
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
5DWHGRSHUDWLRQDOFXUUHQWV,H$DFFRUGLQJWR,(&
Rated voltage
415 VAC
415 VAC
415 VAC
Utilisation category
AC-31 A / AC-31 B
AC-32 A / AC-32 B
AC-33 A / AC-33 B
A/B(1)
800
800
800
)XVHSURWHFWHGVKRUWFLUFXLWZLWKVWDQGDVSHU,(&DW9$&
Prospective short-circuit current (kA rms)
Associated fuse rating (A)
50
800
100
1000
&LUFXLWEUHDNHUSURWHFWHGVKRUWFLUFXLWZLWKVWDQGZLWKDQ\FLUFXLWEUHDNHUWKDWHQVXUHVWULSSLQJLQOHVVWKDQV
Rated short-time withstand current 0.3s Icw (kA rms)
47
64
64
78
78
78
78
78
6KRUWFLUFXLWZLWKVWDQGZLWKRXWSURWHFWLRQDVSHU,(&DW9$&
Rated short-time withstand current 1s Icw (kA rms)
Rated short-circuit making capacity Icm (kA peak)
Rated short-time withstand current 60ms Icw
(kA rms) as per IEC 60947-6-1 at 415 VAC
26
48
35
73.5
35
73.5
50
110
50
110
50
110
50
110
50
110
16
20
25
32
32
40
50
50
2 x 185
2 x 40 x 5
2 x 300
63
20/26
2 x 240
2 x 50 x 5
4 x 185
63
20/26
2 x 60 x 5
4 x 185
63
20/26
2 x 80 x 5
6 x 185
100
40/45
20.5
24.8
21.0
25.6
21.6
26.2
25.7
32.0
Connection
Minimum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Minimum Cu busbar cross-section (mm2)
Maximum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Maximum Cu busbar width (mm)
Tightening torque min (Nm)
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
Weight of 3 P switch (kg)
Weight of 4 P switch (kg)
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) 3-pole device with 2 pole in series for the "+" and 1 pole for the "-".4-pole device with 2 pole
in series by polarity.
(3) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer
to another.
25.7
32.0
42.0
52.9
42.0
52.9
52.3
66.6
(4) Value for coordination with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s. For
coordination with specific circuit-breaker references, higher short-circuit current values are
available. Please consult us.
(5) Data at 415 VAC.
339
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
IURPWR$
SIRCOVER I-I+II -II and SIRCOVER Bypass - Characteristics according to IEC 60947-3
125 to 400 A
Thermal current Ith at 40C
125 A
160 A
200 A
250 A
400 A
800
800
800
800
800
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
Utilisation category
415 VAC
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
125/125
160/160
200/200
250/250
400/400
415 VAC
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
125/125
160/160
200/200
250/250
400/400
415 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
125/125
160/160
160/160
250/250
250/250
415 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
125/125
160/160
160/160
250/250
250/250
690 VAC(2)
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
125/125
160/160
200/200
250/250
400/400
690 VAC(2)
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
125/125
160/160
160/160
200/250
200/250
690 VAC(2)
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/160
125/160
690 VAC(2)
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
63/80
63/80
63/80
100/125
100/125
220 VDC
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
125/125
160/160
200/200
250/250
400/400
220 VDC
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
125/125
160/160
160/160
250/250
250/250
220 VDC
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
125/125
160/160
160/160
250/250
250/250
220 VDC
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
125/125
125/125
125/125
200/200
200/200
440 VDC
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
125/125
160/160
200/200
250/250
400/400
440 VDC
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
125(3)/125(3)
125(3)/125(3)
125(3)/125(3)
200(3)/200(3)
200(3)/200(3)
440 VDC
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
125(3)/125(3)
125(3)/125(3)
125(3)/125(3)
200(3)/200(3)
200(3)/200(3)
440 VDC
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
(4)
(4)
125 /125
(4)
(4)
125 /125
(4)
(4)
125 /125
(4)
(4)
200 /200
200(4)/200(4)
63/63
80/80
80/80
132/132
132/132
55/75
55/75
55/75
90/110
90/110
55
75
90
115
185
)XVHSURWHFWHGVKRUWFLUFXLWZLWKVWDQGDVSHU,(&DW9$&
Prospective short-circuit current (kA rms)
100
100
50
50
18
125
160
200
250
400
&LUFXLWEUHDNHUSURWHFWHGVKRUWFLUFXLWZLWKVWDQGZLWKDQ\FLUFXLWEUHDNHUWKDWHQVXUHVWULSSLQJLQOHVVWKDQV
Rated short-time withstand current 0.3s Icw (kA rms)
15
15
15
17
17
35
50
50
95
185
50
95
95
150
25
25
25
32
32
20
20
Connection
Minimum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Minimum Cu busbar cross-section (mm2)
Maximum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
10 000
10 000
10 000
10 000
10 000
2.9
2.9
2.9
3.8
3.9
4.1
4.1
4.1
4.6
4.9
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) With terminal shrouds or phase barrier.
(3) 4-pole device with 2 poles in series per polarity.
(4) 3-pole device with 2 pole in series for the "+" and 1 pole for the "-".
340
(5) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer
to another.
(6) Value for coordination with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s.
For coordination with specific circuit-breaker references, higher short-circuit current values
are available. Please consult us.
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
IURPWR$
500 to 1800 A
Thermal current Ith at 40C
500 A
630 A
800 A
1250 A
1600 A
1800 A
800
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
12
12
12
12
12
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
Utilisation category
415 VAC
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
500/500
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1600/1600
1800/1800
415 VAC
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
500/500
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1600/1600
1800/1800
415 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
500/500
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1600/1600
1800/1800
415 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
500/500
500/500
800/800
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
690 VAC(2)
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
500/500
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1600/1600
1800/1800
690 VAC(2)
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
400/400
500/500
800/800
800/800
1000/1000
1000/1000
690 VAC(2)
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
250/315
315/315
800/800
800/800
1000/1000
1000/1000
690 VAC(2)
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
160/200
160/200
200/250
200/250
500/500
500/500
220 VDC
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
500/500
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1600/1600
1800/1800
220 VDC
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
500/500
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
220 VDC
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
400/500
500/500
800/800
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
220 VDC
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
400/500
500/500
800/800
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
440 VDC
DC-20 A / DC-20 B
500/500
630/630
800/800
1250/1250
1600/1600
1800/1800
440 VDC
DC-21 A / DC-21 B
400(3)/400(3)
500(3)/500(3)
800(3)/800(3)
1250(3)/1250(3)
1250(3)/1250(3)
1250(3)/1250(3)
440 VDC
DC-22 A / DC-22 B
315(3)/400(3)
500(3)/500(3)
800(3)/800(3)
1250(3)/1250(3)
1250(3)/1250(3)
1250(3)/1250(3)
440 VDC
DC-23 A / DC-23 B
(4)
(4)
(4)
(4)
(3)
(3)
1250 /1250
1250 /1250
1250(3)/1250(3)
450/450
710/710
710/710
710/710
185/220
185/220
475/475
475/475
365
575
400 /400
500 /500
800 /800
280/280
280/280
150/185
150/185
230
290
(3)
(3)
(3)
(3)
)XVHSURWHFWHGVKRUWFLUFXLWZLWKVWDQGDVSHU,(&DW9$&
Prospective short-circuit current (kA rms)
100
70
50
100
100
100
500
630
800
1250
2 x 800
2 x 800
&LUFXLWEUHDNHUSURWHFWHGVKRUWFLUFXLWZLWKVWDQGZLWKDQ\FLUFXLWEUHDNHUWKDWHQVXUHVWULSSLQJLQOHVVWKDQV
Rated short-time withstand current 0.3s Icw (kA rms)
25
25
50
65
100
100
14
25
50
65
100
100
Connection
Minimum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
240
2 x 150
2 x 185
2 x 30 x 5
2 x 40 x 5
2 x 60 x 5
2 x 80 x 5
2 x 80 x 5
240
240
2 x 300
2 x 300
4 x 185
6 x 185
40
50
63
63
100
100
20
20
20
20
40
40
Mechanical characteristics
5 000
5 000
3 000
3 000
3 000
3 000
9.1
9.1
20.5
21.6
25.7
25.7
11.1
11.1
24.8
26.2
32
32
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) With terminal shrouds or phase barrier.
(3) 4-pole device with 2 poles in series per polarity.
(4) 3-pole device with 2 pole in series for the "+" and 1 pole for the "-".
(5) The power value is given for information only, the current values vary from one manufacturer
to another.
(6) Value for coordination with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s. For
coordination with specific circuit-breaker references, higher short-circuit current values are
available. Please consult us.
341
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
IURPWR$
Dimensions
SIRCOVER 125 to1800 A
External front operation
A
M
II
10
8.5
CA
350
125
CA
svr_072_i_1_x_cat
L1
AC
AA
BA
II
T
J
18
Rating (A)
A
3p.
A
4p.
125
221
160
221
E min
E min.
45
60
1. Terminal shrouds
2. Direct handle operation:
- 125 to 630 A: L1 = 140 mm,
- 800 to 1800 A: L1 = 210 mm.
Terminal
shrouds
Overall dimensions
HA
Switch body
Switch mounting
HA
J
3p.
J
4p.
M
3p.
M
4p.
235
148 25
182
212
156
235
148 25
182
212
156
AC
Connection
U
X
3p.
Z1
186
101 36 20
25
8.5
56
50
3.5
28
10
186
101 36 20
25
8.5
56
50
3.5
28
10
X
4p.
AA BA CA
200
221
235
148 25
182
212
156
186
101 36 20
25
8.5
56
50
3.5
28
10
250
262
280
148 25
223
273
196
246
116 50 25
30
11
61
61
3.5
30
15
315
262
280
148 25
223
273
196
246
116 50 35
35
11
61
61
3.5
30
15
400
262
280
148 25
223
273
196
246
116 50 35
35
11
61
61
3.5
30
15
500
319
401
225 25
272
332
246
306
176 65 32
37
13
70.5 65.5
43
15
630
319
400
225 25
272
332
246
306
176 65 45
50
13
70.5 65.5
43
20
800
386
459
255
336
250 80 50 60.5
15
48
48
26.5
1000
386
459
255
336
250 80 50 60.5
15
48
48
26.5
1250
386
459
255
336
250 80 60
16x11 48
48
29.5
1600
478
461
347
467
54
15
1800
478
461
347
467
54
15
65
120
120
53.5
svr_150_a_1_x_cat
120
498
498
436.5
380
51.5
461
258
250
425
425
71
71
102
653
Overall dimensions
342
Switch mounting
Rating (A)
A
3p.
A
4p.
M
3p.
M
4p.
2000 3200
478
598
347
467
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
IURPWR$
A
10
M
II
Z1
Y
CA
Z
8.5
II
CA
L1
AA
BA
AC
H
C
18
1. Terminal shrouds
2. Direct handle operation:
- 125 to 200 A: L1 = 140 mm,
- 250 to 630 A: L1 = 210 mm,
- 800 to 1600 A: L1 = 330 mm.
210
125
svr_070_i_1_x_cat
330
HA
45
103
E min.
61
Terminal
shrouds
Overall dimensions
Switch body
Switch mounting
M
J 3+6 J 4+8 M 3+6 4+8
HA
p.
p.
p.
p.
Rating
A
A
E
(A)
3+6p. 4+8p. C min
AC
125
221
235
243
25
182
212
156
160
221
235
243
25
182
212
156
Connection
X
X
3+6p. 4+8p.
Z1
Z1
186
101 36 20
25
8.5
56
50
3.5
28
124
AA BA
CA
10
186
101 36 20
25
8.5
56
50
3.5
28
124
10
200
221
235
243
25
182
212
156
186
101 36 20
25
8.5
56
50
3.5
28
124
10
250
262
280
243
25
223
273
196
246
116 50 25
30
11
61
61
3.5
30
124
10
400
262
280
243
25
223
273
196
246
116 50 35
35
11
61
61
3.5
30
124
15
500
319
401
362
25
272
332
246
306
176 65 32
37
13
70.5
65.5
43
180
15
272
332
50
43
180
630
319
400
362
25
800
386
459
479
29 306.5 386.5
246
306
176 65 45
255
335
250 80 50 60.5
65
13
70.5
65.5
15
48
48
26.5
20
1250
386
459
479
29 306.5 386.5
255
335
250 80 60
16x11
48
48
29.25
1600
478
461
479
29 388.5 518.5
347
467
54
54
15
Connection terminals
SIRCOVER and SIRCOVER
Bypass 800 A
16 x 11
50
8.5
15.75
28.5
15.75
15
12.5
12.5
5
25 25
30
30
45
45
90
svr_098_a_1_x_cat
33
svr_078_b_1_x_cat
8.5
28.5
15.25
15
svr_077_a_1_x_cat
10 33
60
343
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
IURPWR$
Door drilling
With lock
RONIS EL11AP
0
o
I+II
20 20
26
37
4 5.5
47
2 6.5
28
90
90
37
37
47
47
79
14 14
73
.5
D (1)
45
5
3.
45
45
26
14 14
24
II
1414
125
.5
28
78
With lock
CASTELL K
poign_030_a_1_gb_cat
S2 type
22
Handle type
20 20
20 20
0
or
I+II
20 20
26
4 7 (2)
1414
37
37
47
47
.5
73
45
5
3.
45
D (1)
26
14 14
24
II
20 20
60
22
90
350
2 6.5
.5
37
4 5.5
28
90
28
78
With lock
CASTELL K
79
S4 type
Door drilling
With lock
RONIS EL11AP
20 20
poign_031_a_1_gb_cat
Direction of operation
14 14
Handle type
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S5 type
With lock
CASTELL K
with V Escutcheon
50
50
96
90
28
II
31
71
102
344
4 x 6.5
31
3 x 6.5
poign_023_a_1_gb_cat
90
50
25
0
50
498
4 6,5
SIRCOVER
Manual changeover switches
IURPWR$
Door drilling
With lock
RONIS EL11AP
0
20 20
26
37
47
47
D (1)
24
45
5
3.
45
73
.5
26
14 14
125
1414
37
45
.5
28
II
2 6.5
28
47
37
4 5.5
poign_032_a_1_gb_cat
78
22
90
90
With lock
CASTELL K
79
S2 type
14 14
Handle type
20 20
20 20
S3 type
Door drilling
With lock
RONIS EL11AP
0
90
90
With lock
CASTELL K
20 20
78
26
II
37
47
20 20
61
79
14 14
26
.5
73
45
5
3.
45
D (1)
22
24
47
14 14
210
1414
37
.5
2 6.5
28
37
4 5.5
28
47
poign_033_a_1_gb_cat
Handle type
20 20
Direction of operation
Door drilling
With lock
CASTELL K
C type
50
50
II
96
28
90
90
31
4 x 6.5
31
3 x 6.5
poign_022_a_1_gb_cat
50
25
0
50
300
4 6.5
345
svr_133_a
Changeover
switches
> Industry.
> Healthcare buildings.
Strong points
>
>
>
>
Function
SIRCOVER ATS Bypass switches are manual four pole changeover switches with positive break
indication. They are designed to isolate ATS type electrical equipment (automatic transfer switch)
or UPS, with minimum interruption to the load supply. Integrating a SOCOMEC changeover switch
into the installation enables source selection when in Bypass (see operating principle below).
Stable positions.
Secured breaking.
On load switching.
A complete solution.
Conformity to standards
> IEC 60947-3
Advantages
Secured breaking
Simultaneous upstream and downstream
isolation and fully visualised breaking.
Stable positions
SIRCOVER ATS Bypass switches have 3
stable positions which are not affected by
voltage drops or vibrations.
A complete solution
The SIRCOVER ATS Bypass is a single
product offering a genuine solution
incorporating both an equipment isolation
function and a switching function.
On load switching
3G@MJRSNHSR "BG@Q@BSDQHRSHBRSDRSDC
HM@BBNQC@MBDVHSGRS@MC@QC($"
the SIRCOVER ATS Bypass enables on load
switching.
Operating principle
T2
T1
S2
S2
SIRCOVER
II2
II1
S1
atys_569_d_1_gb_cat
ATS
S2
II3
BY-PASS ATS
Load
346
In Bypass position:
q Without SIRCOVER: The load is supplied directly
by one of the two power sources (transformer T1 for example).
q With a SIRCOVER: The supply source
can be selected.
References
Rating
(A)
No. of poles
Switch body
125 A
/
4100 9813
Shaft for
Direct handle External handle external handle Bridging bars
Auxiliary
contact
Terminal
shrouds
Terminal
screens
/
4109 4019
160 A
/
4100 9816
/
200 mm
1401 1520
250 A
/
4100 9825
S3 type
Black IP65
(.((
S3 type
Black IP65
(.((
1433 3113
1433 3113
320 mm
/
1401 1532
4109 4025
/
1509 4012(4)
LL
/
1401 1540
4100 9840
630 A
/
4100 9863
800 A
/
4100 9880
/
4109 4039
/
4109 4063
/
st
1 contact
NO/NC
included
nd
2 contact
NO/NC
2694 4021(2)(3)
/
/
1509 4025(4)
/
1509 4063(4)
Please consult
us
1509 4080(4)
4109 0021(1)
/
4109 4080
1000 A
/
4100 9881
Black IP65
(((
Black
2799 7062
1250 A
/
2799 7147
/
4100 9882
/
4109 4160
1600 A
/
4100 9886
(1) 2 pieces: one for position I and one for position II.
(2) To fully shroud front, rear, top and bottom 8 references required.
(3) To shroud front switch top and bottom 4 references required.
(4) For complete front protection, order the reference twice.
Accessories
acces_001_a_1_x_cat
Operation
Figure
Reference
125 630
direct
125 630
external
800 1600
Please consult us
Fig. 1
acces_132_a_1_x_cat
Operation
Figure
Reference
125 630
direct
800 1600
direct
Please consult us
acces_158_a_1_x_cat
Fig.2
Operation
125 630
external
800 1600
external
Figure
3
Reference
1499 7702
Please consult us
Fig. 3
347
"G@Q@BSDQHRSHBR@BBNQCHMFSN($"
125 to 1600 A
Thermal current Ith at 40C
Rated insulation voltage Ui (V)
Rated impulse withstand voltage Uimp (kV)
125 A
800
8
160 A
800
8
250 A
800
8
400 A
800
8
630 A
1000
12
800 A
1000
12
1000 A
1000
12
1250 A
1000
12
1600 A
1000
12
A/B(1)
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
800/800
800/800
200/250
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
A/B(1)
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
800/800
800/800
200/250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
A/B(1)
1600/1600
1600/1600
1600/1600
1250/1250
1600/1600
1000/1000
1000/1000
500/500
1600/1600
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1600/1600
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
Utilisation category
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
125/125
160/160
250/250
630/630
800/800
125/125
160/160
250/250
630/630
800/800
125/125
160/160
250/250
630/630
800/800
125/125
160/160
250/250
250/250
500/500
800/800
125/125
160/160
250/250
630/630
800/800
125/125
160/160
200/250
200/250
500/500
800/800
125/125
125/125
125/160
125/160
315/315
800/800
63/80
63/80
100/125
100/125
160/200
200/250
125/125
160/160
250/250
630/630
800/800
125/125
160/160
250/250
250/250
630/630
800/800
125/125
160/160
250/250
250/250
500/500
800/800
125/125
125/125
200/200
200/200
500/500
800/800
125/125
160/160
250/250
630/630
800/800
125(3)/125(3) 125(3)/125(3) 200(3)/200(3) 200(3)/200(3) 500(3)/500(3) 800/800
125(3)/125(3) 125(3)/125(3) 200(3)/200(3) 200(3)/200(3) 500(3)/500(3) 800/800
125/125 125/125 200/200 200/200 500/500 800/800
63/63
80/80
132/132
90/110
132/132
90/110
280/280
150/185
185/220
185/220
185/220
55
115
185
290
365
100
160
50
250
18
630
50
800
100
1000
100
1250
100
2 x 800
100
125
Circuit breaker protected short-circuit withstand with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s(7)
1@SDCRGNQSSHLDVHSGRS@MCBTQQDMS
R(BVJ QLR
15
15
25
50
65
65
100
125 A
8
160 A
8
250 A
9
9
630 A
800 A
1000 A
36
1250 A
36
1600 A
50
35
50
95
185
25
9
50
25
9
95
32
20
150
32
20
2 x 150
2 x 30 x 5
50
20
2 x 185
WW
2 x 300
63
20
2 x 60 x 5
2 x 300
63
20
2 x 60 x 5
2 x 300
63
20
2 x 80 x 5
W
100
10 000
8.3
10.6
10 000
8.3
10.6
10 000
10
10 000
10.3
5 000
3 000
53
3 000
3 000
55.8
3 000
Connection
,HMHLTL"TB@AKDBQNRRRDBSHNMLL2)
,HMHLTL"TATRA@QBQNRRRDBSHNMLL2)
,@WHLTL"TB@AKDBQNRRRDBSHNMLL2)
Maximum Cu busbar width (mm)
Tightening torque min (Nm)
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
Weight of 3 P switch (kg)
6DHFGSNE/RVHSBGJF
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation
Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) With terminal shrouds.
(3) 3-pole device with 2 poles in series for the "+"
and 1 pole for the "-".
Connection terminals
SIRCOVER ATS Bypass 1250 to 1600 A
348
15
8.5
33
8.5
50
12.5
5
12.5
svr_098_a_1_x_cat
10 33
RUQ>>@>>W>B@S
15
25 25
30
30
45
45
90
Dimensions
SIRCOVER ATS Bypass 125 to 630 A
Direct front operation
A
M
W
6 8.5
210
210
BA
II
CA
AA
CA
@SXR>>B>>W>B@S
19
H
H
25
E min.
1
Rating
(A)
125
160
250
630
J1
Overall
dimensions
A 8p. E min
610
2601
610
2601
2601
2601
850
61
61
A. S3 type handle for external front operation: 125 to 630 A.
1. Max length with shaft extension: E min + 50 mm.
Switch
Switch body
mounting
N
H
J 8p. J1 8p. M 8p.
193
238
338
101
193
238
338
101
193
295
396
691
116
193
295
396
691
116
358
816
T
36
36
50
50
65
U
20
20
25
35
V
25
25
30
35
50
W
8.5
8.5
11
11
13
Connection
X 8p.
Y
3.5
3.5
83.5
3.5
83.5
3.5
91.5
5
Z
62
Z1
199
AA
135
135
160
235
BA
115
115
130
220
AC
10
10
10
15
20
CA
A
M
324
271.5
Z
CA
@SXR>>A>>W>B@S
T
J
J1
545
380
AA
BA
250
90
19
344
425
Rating (A)
800
1000
1250
1600
Overall
dimensions
A 8p.
1 055
1 055
1 320
1 320
Switch body
J 8p.
J1 8p.
510.5
189
510.5
189
195
195
Switch
mounting
M 8p.
1 021
1 021
1 286
1 286
T
80
80
120
120
V
60.5
60.5
E min. = 460
Connection
Y
Z
8
85.5
8
85.5
X 8p.
81.5
81.5
88
88
AA
321
321
288
288
110
BA
268
268
258
258
AC
26.5
26.5
15
15
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
Front operation
Door drilling
Handle type
90
S3 type
Direction of operation
Door drilling
V type
90
20 20
50
78
II
47
D (1)
61
4 6.5
0
50
545
90
ONHFM>>@>>FA>B@S
210
1414
II
90
ONHFM>>@>>FA>B@S
31
349
SIRCOVER UL1008/98
Changeover switches standards UL and CSA
100 to 1200 A
svr-ul_014_b_1_cat
Changeover
switches
Conformity to standards(1)
> IEC 60947-3
> UL98,
Guide WHTY,
file 201138
> UL1008,
Guide WPYV,
file 317092
> CSA 22.2#4,
Class 4651-02
svr-ul_013_a_2_cat
Function
SIRCOVER UL UL1008/98 are heavy duty manual transfer switches. They ensure switching
transfer of sources or transfer of two low voltage circuits on load as well as their safety
disconnection.
These switches are extremely durable and are tested and approved for use in the most
demanding applications, such as resitive load or total system applications.
Advantages
Stable positions
SIRCOVERs have three stable positions
which are not affected by voltage drops or
vibrations, thus protecting your load against
network interference.
svr_136_a_2_cat
Compact design
The Sircover are based on a back-to-back
switching technology, providing a compact
solution.
350
On load switching
The SIRCOVER UL enables secure and reliable
switching, without the need for pre-breaking
upstream.
SIRCOVER UL1008/98
Changeover switches standards UL and CSA
100 to 1200 A
References
UL 1008 and UL98
Rating (A)
100 A
No. of
poles
Switch body
2P
4150 2011
3P
4150 3011
4P
4150 4011
2P
200 A
3P
Direct handle
S2 type
Black
I - 0 - II
4, 4X
4P
4150 4021
2P
4150 2041
S2 type
200 mm
7.9 inches
1400 1020
142D 2113
4150 2021
4150 3021
External handle
Black
4199 4012
S2 type
Black
I - 0 - II
4, 4X
142D 2813(1)
320 mm
12.6 inches
1400 1032
Bridging bars
Auxiliary
contacts
Terminal screens
2P
4159 2021
2P & 3P
3P
4158 3021
4159 3021
4P
4P
4158 4021
4159 4021
Contact NO/NC
4159 0021
Low level
400 mm
15.7 inches
1400 1040
4159 0022
2P
400 A
3P
4P
4150 3041
S3 type
Black
I - 0 - II
4, 4X
4150 4041
143D 3113
3P
4150 3060
4199 7012
4P
S3, S4 type
200 mm
7.9 inches
320 mm
12.6 Inches
4150 4060
2P & 3P
3P
4158 3041
4159 3041
4P
4P
4158 4041
4159 4041
1401 1520
Black
600 A
4159 2041
3P
3P
4159 3063
1609 3063
4P
4P
4159 4063
1609 4063
1401 1532
3P
400 mm
15.7 Inches
4150 3080
Contact NO/NC
as standard
1401 1540
800 A
4P
4150 4080
Black
4199 7062
3P
4150 3120
4P
4150 4120
S4 type
Black
I - 0 - II
4, 4X
144D 3813(1)
3P
3P
4159 3080
1609 3080
4P
4P
4159 4080
1609 4080
1200 A
351
SIRCOVER UL1008/98
Changeover switches standards UL and CSA
100 to 1200 A
Accessories
Direct handle
Colour
Handle type
Reference
100 400
Black
1 lever
600 1200
Black
2 lever
4199 4012
2799 7042
acces_129_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
External handle
142D 2113
142E 2113
142F 2113
142G 2113
142D 2813
142E 2813
142F 2813
142G 2813
143D 3113
143E 3113
143F 3113
143G 3113
143D 3813
143E 3813
143F 3813
143G 3813
144D 3113
144E 3113
144E 3113
144G 3113
144D 3813
144E 3813
144F 3813
144G 3813
1453 8113
1454 8113
4199 7149
Use
The handle interlocking function prevents the user from opening
the door of the enclosure when the switch is in the "ON" position.
Opening the door when the switch is in the "ON" position is possible
by defeating the interlocking function (Not S5 and V handles) with the
use of a tool (authorized persons only).
The interlocking function is restored when the door is re-closed.
acces_286_a_2_cat
Reference
acces_152_a_1_cat
Lockable in
Colour
Nema type 3 positions
Black
4, 4X
no
Red/Yellow
4, 4X
no
Black
1, 3R, 12
no
Red/Yellow
1, 3R, 12
no
Black
4, 4X
yes
Red/Yellow
4, 4X
yes
Black
1, 3R, 12
yes
Red/Yellow
1, 3R, 12
yes
Black
4, 4X
no
Red/Yellow
4, 4X
no
Black
1, 3R, 12
no
Red/Yellow
1, 3R, 12
no
Black
4, 4X
yes
Red/Yellow
4, 4X
yes
Black
1, 3R, 12
yes
Red/Yellow
1, 3R, 12
yes
Black
4, 4X
no
Black
1, 3R, 12
no
Black
1, 3R, 12
no
Red/Yellow
1, 3R, 12
no
Black
4, 4X
yes
Red/Yellow
4, 4X
yes
Black
1, 3R, 12
yes
Red/Yellow
1, 3R, 12
yes
Black
1, 3R, 12(1)
no
Red/Yellow 1, 3R, 12(1)
no
Black
1, 3R, 12(1)
no
acces_150_a_1_cat
Handle
type
S2
S2
S2
S2
S2
S2
S2
S2
S3
S3
S3
S3
S3
S3
S3
S3
S4
S4
S4
S4
S4
S4
S4
S4
S5
S5
V1
acces_151_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
100 ... 200
100 ... 200
100 ... 200
100 ... 200
100 ... 200
100 ... 200
100 ... 200
100 ... 200
400 ... 600
400 ... 600
400 ... 600
400 ... 600
400 ... 600
400 ... 600
400 ... 600
400 ... 600
800 ... 1200
800 ... 1200
800 ... 1200
800 ... 1200
800 ... 1200
800 ... 1200
800 ... 1200
800 ... 1200
800 ... 1200
800 ... 1200
800 ... 1200
352
S2 type
7.9
200
10 14.3
254 362
S2 type
12.6
320
10 19
254 482
S2 type
15.7
400
10 22.1
254 562
400
S3 type
7.9
200
12 18.4
305 467
400
S3 type
12.6
320
12 23.1
305 587
400
S3 type
15.7
400
12 26.3
305 667
600
S3 type
7.9
200
20 23.4
508 594
600
S3 type
12.6
320
20 28.1
508 714
600
S3 type
15.7
400
20 31.3
508 794
S4 type
7.9
200
20 23.4
508 594
S4 type
12.6
320
20 28.1
508 714
S4 type
15.7
400
20 31.3
508 794
12.6
320
20 28.1
508 714
15.7
400
20 31.3
508 794
V1 / S5 type
Reference
1400 1020
1400 1032
1400 1040
1401 1520
1401 1532
1401 1540
1401 1520
1401 1532
1401 1540
1401 1520
1401 1532
1401 1540
4199 3018
4199 3019
acces_369_a_1_cat
Handle
type
acces_202_a_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
SIRCOVER UL1008/98
Changeover switches standards UL and CSA
100 to 1200 A
Bridging bars
Use
Creation of a common point, above or below the switch, between positions I and II.
No. bridging bar
2
3
4
2
3
4
3
4
3
4
Reference
4159 2021
4159 3021
4159 4021
4159 2041
4159 3041
4159 4041
4159 3063
4159 4063
4159 3080
4159 4080
acces_205_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
100 200
100 200
100 200
400
400
400
600
600
800 1200
800 1200
Reference
4158 3021
4158 4021
4158 3041
4158 4041
1609 3063
1609 4063
1609 3080
1609 4080
acces_207_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
100 200
100 200
400
400
600
600
800 1200
800 1200
Auxiliary contacts
Electrical characteristics
A300.
acces_065_a_1_cat
Use
Pre-break and signalisation of positions .
For low level ACs and other ACs contact us.
NO/NC auxiliary contact
Rating (A)
Contact (s)
Reference
4159 0021
4159 0022
as standard
Terminal lugs
Use
Connection of bare copper cables onto the terminals (without lugs).
Wires range
6 - 300MCM
6 - 300MCM
6 - 300MCM
4 - 600MCM
4 - 600MCM
4 - 600MCM
2x (#6 - 350MCM)
2x (#6 - 350MCM)
2x (#6 - 350MCM)
2x (#2 - 600MCM)
2x (#2 - 600MCM)
2x 2x(#2 - 600MCM)
2x 2x(#2 - 600MCM)
No wires
per lug
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Lugs
per kit
2
3
4
2
3
4
2
3
4
3
4
6
8
Wires
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Cu / Al
Reference
3954 2020
3954 3020
3954 4020
3954 2040
3954 3040
3954 4040
3954 2041
3954 3041
3954 4041
3954 3060
3954 4060
3954 3120
3954 4120
ul_032_a
Rating (A)
100 ... 200
100 ... 200
100 ... 200
400
400
400
400
400
400
600
600
800 1200
800 1200
353
SIRCOVER UL1008/98
Changeover switches standards UL and CSA
100 to 1200 A
Characteristics
Characteristics according to UL1008
100 to 1200 A
General use rating (A)
Operation voltage
Short circuit rating at 600 VAC (kA)
Type of fuse
Max. fuse rating (A)
Short circuit rating with circuit breaker (kA/ms)
100 A
600
100
J
200
10 / 25
200 A
600
100
J
400
10 / 25
400 A
600
65
J
600
14 / 50
600 A
600
100
L
800
35 / 50
800 A
600
100
L
1000
35 / 50
1200 A
600
100
L
1600
35 / 50
100
100
100
200
200
400
100
100
100
100
100
100
200
100
200
200
200
400
200
400
400
400
600
350
600
600
700
800
600
800
800
700
1200
600
1200
1200
6050
6050
6050
6050
3550
3550
#4 / 2 x #6
600MCM /
2x 350MCM
Mechanical endurance
Endurance (number of operating cycles)
Connection terminals
Min. connection section / AWG
#6
#6
300MCM
300MCM
2x #2
4x #2
4x #2
2x 600MCM
4x 600MCM
4x 600MCM
800 A
100
L
800
1200 A
100
L
1200
100 A(3)
200
J
100
200 A(3)
200
J
200
400A(3)
200
J
400
600 A
200
J
600
10 / 50
10 / 50
30 / 80
75 / 96
100 / 99
72 / 192
150 / 180
200 / 192
125 / 312
250 / 302
350 / 336
200 / 480
400 / 477
500 / 472
10 / 76
15 / 55
15 / 112
15 / 55
20 / 148
50 / 173
10000
88.5/10
8000
88.5/10
6000
128.3/14.5
6000
327.5/37
3500
442.5/50
3500
442.5/50
A300
A300
A300
A300
A300
A300
Mechanical characteristics
Endurance (number of operating cycles)
Operating torque (lbs.in/Nm)
Auxiliary contacts
Electrical characteristics
(1) With 2 poles in series
Mounting orientation
354
sirco-ul_030_a_1_x_cat
sirco-ul_029_a_1_x_cat
SIRCOVER UL1008/98
Changeover switches standards UL and CSA
100 to 1200 A
Dimensions (in/mm)
0.98
25
1.51
38.5
1.18
30
6.37
162
5.21
132.5
0.53
13.3
100 to 200 A
6.30 (3P) - 8.26 (4P)
160 (3P) - 210 (4P)
1.37
35
2.67
68
5.21
132.5
0.43
11
5.31
1.35
6.30
160
0.29
7.5
0.35
9
svr-ul_015_a_x_cat
5.21
132.5
5.21
132.5
0.27
7
1.97
50
9.60 (3P) - 11.57 (4P)
244 (3P) - 294 (4P)
6.93
176
400 A
0.49
20
1.38
45
1.96
50
2.04
52
1.37
35
0.5
13
7.67
195
10.23
260
0.29
7.5
2.70
68.5
8
203
9.41
239
7.48
190
0.35
9
6.51
165.5
svr-ul_016_a_x_cat
6.53
166
8
203
0.27
7
2.56
65
11.85 (3P) - 14.21 (4P)
301 (3P) - 361 (4P)
600 A
0.41
10.5
21
0.98
25
4.92
125
9.09
231
2.61
66.5
2.02
51.5
28.5
9.98
253.5
0.82 1.12
14.56
370
13.66
347
svr-ul_003_a_x_cat
9.05
230
9.09
231
9.84
250
13.38
340
1.96
50
3.15
80
15.19 (3P) - 18.34 (4P)
386 (3P) - 466 (4P)
355
SIRCOVER UL1008/98
Changeover switches standards UL and CSA
100 to 1200 A
0.82
21
1.49
38
13.5
343
11.65
296
4.24
107
1.49
38
1.02
26
1.02
26
2.02
51.5
11.85
301
svr-ul_004_b_x_cat
9.84
250
11.34
288
4.92
125
11.85
301
3.54
90
15.31
389
1.94
49.30
0.53
13.46
600 kcmil
0.40
10.2
sirco_116_b_1_x_cat
2.87
73
0.25
6.35
3.15
80
sirco-ul_026_b_1_cat
1.19
30.23
1.25
31.75
0.44
11.13
0.63
15.88
1.8
46
sirco_115_b_1_x_cat
2
51
0.4
4.7
2.8
71.5
300 kcmil
SIRCOVER 400 A
sirco-ul_010_a_1_x_cat
0.45
11.6
1.12
28.6
1.52
38.8
SIRCOVER 400 A
1.3
35
1
25
2 x 350 kcmil
2 x 600 kcmil
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S2 type
90
II
0.79
20
4.92
125
1.77
45
356
D (1)
0.55
14
0.55 4 0.27
14
47
svr-ul_010_a_1_gb_cat
90
0.79
20
I
3.07
78
SIRCOVER UL1008/98
Changeover switches standards UL and CSA
100 to 1200 A
Direction of operation
S3 type
Door drilling
4 0.27
47
90
3.07
78
0.79
20
D (1)
svr-ul_012_a_1_gb_cat
0.79
20
8.27
210
0
0.55
14
II
0.55
14
2.36
61
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S4 type
0.79
20
II
13.77
350
0
0.55
14
svr-ul_011_a_1_gb_cat
3.07
78
4 7 (2)
47
0.55
14
90
0.79
20
90
D (1)
I
2.36
60
Direction of operation
Door drilling
S5 type
with V Escutcheon
50
II
90
498
4 6,5
50
0
poign_023_a_1_gb_cat
90
I
31
71
102
Front operation
Direction of operation
Door drilling
50
1.97
V1 type
II
4 0.25
4 6.5
1.97
50
21.46
545
90
90
4.80
122
1.22
31
sirco-ul_031_a_1_gb_cat
Handle type
357
SIRCOVER PV
Changeover switches for photovoltaic applications
from 200 to 630 A
The solution for
svr-pv_003_a_1_cat
Changeover
switches
Strong points
> Stable positions.
> Secured breaking.
> Patented safety disconnection.
Function
Conformity to standards
SIRCOVER PV switches are manual multipolar changeover switches with positive break
indication. They ensure source inversion or changeover under load of two photovoltaic
installation circuits.
Advantages
Stable positions
SIRCOVER PV switches have three stable
positions which are not affected by voltage
drops or vibrations.
Secured breaking
Simultaneous upstream and downstream
isolation and positive break indication.
358
A compact solution.
> The products are available in
enclosures.
SIRCOVER PV
Changeover switches for photovoltaic applications
from 200 to 630 A
Application
The choice of the material cannot be separated from the concept of energy management.
Many applications may require continuous power supply during a PV generator fault, when an isolated site has been electrified, in developing
countries, in telecommunications or pumping. SIRCOVER PV changeover switches ensure source inversion or switching under load between two
circuits.
Example: Switching from DC to AC photovoltaic grid.
Load inverter : switching the power supply
from one load to another in order to guarantee
continuous power supply during maintenance
operations.
comut_037_a_1_x_cat
comut_036_a_1_x_cat
comut_035_a_1_x_cat
Functional diagram
svr_103_c_1_x_cat
4
1
359
SIRCOVER PV
Changeover switches for photovoltaic applications
from 200 to 630 A
References
SIRCOVER PV I-0-II
Rating (A)
No. of
poles
Switch body
41PV 3020
41PV 4020
41PV 3025
41PV 4025
41PV 3040
41PV 4040
41PV 3050
41PV 4050
41PV 3063
41PV 4063
3P
200 A
4P
3P
250 A
4P
3P
400 A
4P
3P
500 A
4P
3P
630 A
Shaft for
Direct handle External handle external handle
4P
S2 type
Black IP55
1421 2113
Black IP65
1423 2113(1)
Bridging bar
Auxiliary
contact
Terminal
screens
200 mm
3P
1400 1020
2P
320 mm
4109 2025
1400 1032(1)
Terminal
shrouds
1509 3025
4P
1509 4025
2nd contact
NO/NC
Black
4199 5012
S3 type
Black IP65
1433 3113
4109 0021(2)
200 mm
1401 1520
2P
320 mm
4109 2063
1401 1532(1)
3P
1509 3063(3)
4P
1509 4063(3)
3P
2694 3051(4)
4P
2694 4051(4)
(1) Standard.
(2) 2 pieces: one for position I and one for position II.
(3) 2 pieces: one for top side and another for bottom side
(4) To shroud switch top and bottom 2 references required.
Accessories
Direct operation handle
Handle colour
Handle type
Reference
200 630
Black
Single lever
4199 5012
acces_114_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
External IP(1)
Handle type
Reference
200 250
IP55
S2 type
200 250
IP65
S2 type
400 630
IP65
S3 type
1421 2113
1423 2113
1433 3113
acces_151_a_2_cat
Rating (A)
acces_150_a_1_cat
Use
Door interlocked external front operation handles include an escutcheon,
are padlockable and must be utilised with an extension shaft.
S2 type handle
S3 type handle
360
SIRCOVER PV
Changeover switches for photovoltaic applications
from 200 to 630 A
Handle colour
External IP(1)
To be ordered
in multiples of
Reference
IP65
1493 0000
Black
acces_187_a_1_cat
Dimensions
Adds 12 mm to the depth.
Use
Enables S type handles to be fitted in place
of existing older style SOCOMEC handles.
Adapter can also be utilised as a spacer to
increase the distance between the panel
door and the handle lever.
Handle
Reference
Light grey
50
S2, S3 type
Dark grey
50
S2, S3 type
1401 0001
1401 0011
Colour
acces_198_a_2_cat
Description
Reference
Shaft guide
1429 0000
acces_260_a_2_cat
Use
Standard lengths:
- 200 mm,
- 320 mm.
acces_369_a_1_cat
Dimension X
(mm)
Type
Reference
200 250
200
210 310
10 x 10
200 250
320
210 430
10 x 10
400 630
200
425 577
15 x 12
400 630
320
425 697
15 x 12
1400 1020
1400 1032
1401 1520
1401 1532
Type 10x10
acces_144_b_1_cat
Length (mm)
Type 10x10
acces_202_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
361
SIRCOVER PV
Changeover switches for photovoltaic applications
from 200 to 630 A
Accessories (continued)
Bridging bars
Mounting
Reference
200 250
25 x 2.5
client
200 250
2P
25 x 2.5
client
400 630
1P
50 x 5
client
400 630
2P
50 x 5
client
4109 0025
4109 2025
4109 0063
4109 2063
svr_124_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
acces_205_a_2_cat
Use
For creating a common connection between switches I & II, on the
top or bottom side of the SIRCOVER, to enable, for example, the
load to be fed from either incoming source (I or II).
Rating (A)
Number of
poles of the
device in
series
Pack
Reference
200 250
2(1)
1 piece
200 250
4(1)
2 pieces
400 630
2(1)
1 piece
400 630
4(1)
2 pieces
2609 0025
2609 2025
2609 0063
2609 2063
Use
Pre breaking and signalling of positions
I and II: 1 or 2 NO/NC auxiliary contacts
in each position. Low level auxiliary
contacts: please consult us.
Characteristics
400 VAC
AC-13
24 VDC
AC-13
48 VDC
AC-13
200 630
16
12
14
6
svr_058_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
Nominal
current (A)
acces_065_a_1_cat
Auxiliary contact
References
NO/NC changeover contact
Rating (A)
Contact(s)
Reference
200 630
1st/2nd
4109 0021
Advantage
Perforations allow remote thermographic
inspection without the need to remove the
shrouds.
Use
Protection against direct contact with
terminals or connecting parts.
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Position
Reference
400 630
3P
top / bottom
400 630
4P
top / bottom
2694 3051(1)
2694 4051(1)
362
acces_206_a_2_cat
Terminal shrouds
SIRCOVER PV
Changeover switches for photovoltaic applications
from 200 to 630 A
Terminal screens
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Position
Pack
Reference
200 250
3P
top / bottom
200 250
4P
top / bottom
400 630
3P
top / bottom
400 630
4P
top / bottom
1509 3025
1509 4025
1509 3063
1509 4063
acces_207_a_2_cat
Use
Top and bottom protection against direct contact with terminals or
connection parts.
Locking:
- a special handle which receives the lock
bolt on SIRCOVER CD 125 to CD 630 A
(Fig. 2)
The interlocking positions are either
determined as standard or configured by
the user by removing the pre-formed tabs.
Padlocking and locking can be combined.
acces_061_a_2_x_cat
Use
Padlocking in position I, 0 or II
Rating (A)
Operation
Figure
Reference
200 250
external
1423 2813
acces_001_a_1_x_cat
Fig. 1
Operation
Figure
200 630
direct
200 630
external
Reference
4109 1006(1)
1499 7701
Operation
Figure
200 630
direct
200 250
external
Reference
Fig.2
4109 1002(1)
1499 7701
Rating (A)
Operation
Figure
Reference
200 630
external
1499 7702
acces_158_a_1_x_cat
Fig. 3
363
SIRCOVER PV
Changeover switches for photovoltaic applications
from 200 to 630 A
200 A
250 A
400 A
500 A
630 A
1200
1200
1200
1200
1200
12
12
12
Number of poles
of the device
Number of pole(s)
in series per polarity
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
(A)
750 VDC
DC-21 B
3P
2 P + and 1 P -
200
250
400
500
630
1000 VDC
DC-21 B
4P
2 P + and 2 P -
200
250
400
500
630
95
120
240
2 x 150
2 x 185
32
32
32
40
40
20
20
20
40
40
5 000
Rated voltage
Connection
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)(1)
10 000
10 000
5 000
5 000
3,8
3,8
4,6
4,6
11
11
11
Dimensions
SIRCOVER 200 to 630 A
Direct front operation
A
M
Z
Y
II
8.5
1
V
CA
II
125
T
J
E min.
210
CA
HA
H
X
L1
AC
AA
BA
18
45
61
1. Terminal shrouds.
2. Direct handle operation:
- 200 to 400 A: L1 = 140 mm.
- 500 to 630 A: L1 = 210 mm.
Overall dimensions
Rating
(A)
200
364
A 3p. A 4p.
262
312
E min
Terminal
shrouds
Switch body
Switch mounting
AC
HA
280
148
25
223
273
196
246
Connection
X
3p.
X
4p.
116
50
25
30
11
61
61
61
61
Z1 AA BA CA
250
262
312
280
148
25
223
273
196
246
116
50
25
30
11
400
319
379
400
225
25
272
332
246
306
176
65
45
50
13 70.5 65.5
500
319
379
400
225
25
272
332
246
306
176
65
45
50
13 70.5 65.5
630
319
379
400
225
25
272
332
246
306
176
65
45
50
13 70.5 65.5
svr_072_i_1_x_cat
10
SIRCOVER PV
Changeover switches for photovoltaic applications
from 200 to 630 A
90
26
47
73
45
.5
26
14 14
24
1414
125
37
47
5
3.
45
D (1)
.5
37
45
28
II
2 6.5
28
47
poign_032_a_1_gb_cat
37
4 5.5
22
90
78
With lock
CASTELL K
79
S2 type
Door drilling
With lock
RONIS EL11AP
14 14
Handle type
20 20
20 20
Front operation
Handle type
Direction of operation
S3 type
Door drilling
With lock
RONIS EL11AP
0
90
90
With lock
CASTELL K
20 20
78
26
II
73
20 20
61
22
14 14
79
.5
26
14 14
24
47
45
D (1)
37
47
5
3.
45
poign_033_a_1_gb_cat
210
1414
37
.5
2 6.5
28
37
4 5.5
28
47
20 20
+
Load
Load
sirco_307_b_1_gb_cat
sirco_305_b_1_gb_cat
365
ATyS M
Motorised and automatic changeover switches
from 40 to 160 A
ATySm_013_a_1_cat
Changeover
switches
ATyS M 3s
I-0-II 4P
ATySm_214_a_1_cat
ATySm_007_a_1_cat
Strong points
ATyS M 6e
I-0-II 4P
>
>
>
>
ATyS M 6s
I-0-II 2P
Proven technology.
Stable positions.
Secure operation.
Choice of configuration
interface.
Conformity to standards
Function
ATyS M is a range of single-phase or three-phase modular motorised changeover switches
with positive break indication. They enable on load changeover switching of two supply sources
in remote control, automatic or manual mode. They are intended for use in low voltage power
systems where interruption of the load supply is acceptable during transfer.
Advantages
Proven technology
Two mechanically interlocked SIRCO MV
load break switches provide rapid switching,
excellent dynamic withstand and a high
number of operations.
Stable positions
The ATyS M has three stable positions
which are not affected by voltage drops or
vibrations, thus protecting your load against
network interference.
Secure operation
ATyS M provide positive break indication,
confirming switch position, and a back-up
manual operation function.
Return to position 0
Depending on its configuration, the
3X2,DDM@AKDR@QDSTQMSNONRHSHNM
if the power is cut.
AUT/MAN control
366
ATySm_016_b_1_cat
ATySm_014_b
ATySm_015_b_1_cat
Modes of operation
Padlocking facility
ATyS M
Motorised and automatic changeover switches
from 40 to 160 A
Three-phase interface
ATySm_029_b
ATySm_202_a
Single-phase interface
q Electrical control
The positions are controlled by volt-free contacts which may come
from an external automatic controller (e.g. ATyS C30) or, for example,
pushbuttons. The positions are stable, even without a supply. Two
types of control logic are available:
q Impulse logic
- A switching command of at least
60 ms is necessary to initiate
operation.
- The first command (order)
received (I or II) has priority as
long as it remains present.
q Contactor logic
- Order 0 must be maintained
to activate contactor logic
(313-317).
- If command I or II disappears,
the device returns to zero
position, if power supply is
available.
order I
order O
ATySm_042_a_1_gb_cat
On ATyS M 3s models
Power supply
order II
position I
position O
position II
Automatic control
q ATyS M 6s and M 6e are equipped with a sequence logic.
Generator start
Switch to position 0
Manual
operation
no
Switch to position 0
Switch to position II
Single-phase interface
Source 1 availability
yes
Example (generator application):
Source 1 : priority power source
Source 2 : backup power source
t : timer
atysm_030_c
ATyS M 6e
Three-phase interface
atysm_031_b
atysm_203_a
Switch to position I
ATyS M 6s
Source 2 availability
Configuration
Three-phase interface
Generator shutdown
Source 1 failure
atys_028_e_2_gb_cat
367
ATyS M
Motorised and automatic changeover switches
from 40 to 160 A
References
ATyS M 3s
Rating (A)
Power supply
voltage
230 VAC
230 VAC
230 VAC
230 VAC
230 VAC
230 VAC
230 VAC
230 VAC
230 VAC
230 VAC
230 VAC
230 VAC
No. of poles
2P
4P
2P
4P
2P
4P
2P
4P
2P
4P
2P
4P
40 A
63 A
80 A
100 A
125 A
160 A
ATyS M 3s
Voltage sensing
and power supply
tap
Bridging bars
1323 2004
1323 4004
1323 2006
1323 4006
1323 2008
1323 4008
1323 2010
1323 4010
1323 2012
1323 4012
1323 2016
1323 4016
Terminal shrouds
Auxiliary contact
block
1st A/C block
included
2P
1309 2006
4P
2 pieces
1309 4006
2 pieces
2294 4016(1)
1399 4006
1309 0001(2)
Linked common
points
1309 0011(2)
1309 2016
1309 4016
(1) For the three-phase version (4 P), for upstream and downstream protection, please order the reference twice. For the single-phase version (2 P) please order the reference once.
(2) 1 NO/NC contact block for positions I, 0 and II.
ATyS M 6s
Rating (A)
40 A
63 A
80 A
100 A
125 A
160 A
No. of poles
2P
4P
4P
2P
4P
4P
2P
4P
4P
2P
4P
4P
2P
4P
4P
Network (VAC)
230
127/230
230/400
230
127 / 230
230 / 400
230
127 / 230
230 / 400
230
127 / 230
230 / 400
230
127 / 230
230 / 400
ATyS M 6s
2P
230
1353 2016
4P
127 / 230
1353 4016
4P
230 / 400
1354 4016
1353 2004
1353 4004
1354 4004
1353 2006
1353 4006
1354 4006
1353 2008
1353 4008
1354 4008
1353 2010
1353 4010
1354 4010
1353 2012
1353 4012
1354 4012
Bridging bars
Voltage sensing
and power
supply tap
Terminal
shrouds
Auxiliary contact
block
2P
Sealable cover
1 piece
1309 2006
4P
1309 4006
2 pieces
1399 4006
Separate common
points
2 pieces
1309 0001(2)
2294 4016(1)
Linked common
points
2P
1359 2000
4P
1359 0000
1309 0011(2)
2P
1309 2016
4P
1309 4016
(1) For the three-phase version (4 P), for upstream and downstream protection, please order the reference twice. For the single-phase version (2 P) please order the reference once.
(2) 1 NO/NC contact block for positions I, 0 and II.
ATyS M 6e
Rating
(A)
40 A
63 A
80 A
100 A
125 A
160 A
No. of poles
4P
Network (VAC)
127 / 230
ATyS M 6e
1363 4004
1383 4004
4P
230 / 400
1364 4004
1384 4004
4P
127 / 230
1363 4006
1383 4006
4P
230 / 400
1364 4006
1384 4006
4P
127 / 230
1363 4008
1383 4008
4P
4P
230 / 400
1364 4008
1384 4008
1309 4006
2 pieces
1399 4006
127 / 230
1363 4010
1383 4010
4P
230 / 400
1364 4010
1384 4010
4P
127 / 230
1363 4012
1383 4012
4P
230 / 400
1364 4012
1384 4012
4P
127 / 230
1363 4016
1383 4016
4P
4P
230 / 400
1364 4016
1384 4016
1309 4016
Terminal
shrouds
Auxiliary
Remote control
interface
contact block
1 piece
4P
(1) For upstream and downstream protection please order the reference twice.
(2) 1 NO/NC contact block for positions I, 0 and II.
368
Voltage sensing
and power
Bridging bars
supply tap
ATyS M 6e +
COM
2 pieces
(1)
2294 4016
Separate
common points
1309 0001(2)
Linked common
points
1309 0011(2)
ATyS D10
1599 2010
ATyS D20
1599 2020
ATyS M
Motorised and automatic changeover switches
from 40 to 160 A
Accessories
Bridging bars
Rating (A)
40 125
160
40 125
160
No. of poles
2P
2P
4P
4P
atysm_025_a
Use
For providing a common connection between switches I & II on the incoming or outgoing
side of the ATyS M (outgoing side only for ATyS M 6), to enable, for example, the load to be
supplied from either incoming source (I or II).
The bridging bar set does not reduce the connection capacity of the ATyS Ms cage terminals.
Reference
1309 2006
1309 2016
1309 4006
1309 4016
Rating (A)
40 160
Pack
2 pieces
atysm_026_a
Use
This single-pole voltage sensing tap allows
SGDBNMMDBSHNMNEW
LLUNKS@FD
RDMRHMFNQONVDQB@AKDRSN@MX 3X2,
Reference
1399 4006
Terminal shrouds
Required quantity
For upstream and downstream protection
with a three-phase ATyS M two sets are
required. For the single-phase version only
one set is required.
atysm_027_a
Use
Protection against direct contact with
terminals or connecting parts.
Advantages of the terminal shrouds
Perforations allow remote thermographic
inspection without the need to remove the
shrouds. Tamper seals can be fitted for
increased security.
Rating (A)
Position
Reference
40 160
2294 4016(1)
Auxiliary contact
reduced (4 cables instead of 6). The ATyS M
3s is supplied as standard with one auxiliary
contact block fitted; this A/C block has
separate common points.
access_353_a
Use
Auxiliary contacts for position indication. A
maximum of two auxiliary contact blocks
can be fitted to each product. Each auxiliary
contact block integrates 3 NO/NC auxiliary
contacts, one per position (I, 0, II). There
are two versions of contact block, one with
three separate sets of connections and one
that has its three common terminals linked
internally. With the common points linked the
number of signal cables required is
Characteristics:
250 VAC / 5 A maximum.
24 VDC / 2 A maximum.
Rating (A)
Type
Reference
40 160
40 160
1309 0001
1309 0011
369
ATyS M
Motorised and automatic changeover switches
from 40 to 160 A
Accessories (continued)
Sealable cover
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Reference
40 160
2P
40 160
4P
1359 2000
1359 0000
atysm_043_a_2_cat
Use
It prevents access to the configuration panel of the ATyS M 6s.
Polycarbonate enclosure
Rating (A)
H x W x D (mm)
Reference
40 160
1309 9006
atysm_001_a
Use
Dedicated to the implementation of a three-phase ATyS M, it
enables easy access to a compact changeover solution.
Rating (A)
Reference
40 160
1309 9007
atysm_039_a_1_x_cat
Use
Combined with the polycarbonate enclosure, the extension unit provides
@CCHSHNM@KRO@BDSNSGDDMBKNRTQDHMNQCDQSNBNMMDBSLLB@AKDRSN
the ATyS M.
Residential enclosure
Rating (A)
H x W x D (mm)
Reference
40 160
1309 9056
atysm_196_a_1_cat
Use
Dedicated to the implementation of a single-phase ATyS M, it
provides a compact IP41 changeover solution with easy access.
Auto-transformer
Rating (A)
Reference
40 160
1599 4121
trafo_165_a_1
Use
For use with ATyS M 6 in 400 VAC three-phase applications without a distributed neutral. As the
ATyS M 6 has integrated measurement and power supply circuits, a neutral connection is required
for 400 VAC three-phase applications. When no neutral connection is available this autotransformer
(400/230 VAC, 400 VA) provides the 230 VAC required for the ATyS M 6 to function.
Input 1
Output
Input 2
230 VAC
0 VAC
0 VAC
230 VAC
230 VAC
230 VAC
0 VAC
0 VAC
0 VAC
370
Description of accessories
Reference
1599 4001
atys_612_a_2_cat
Input
q The input is considered active
EQNL5 "
q Maximum voltage: 288 VAC.
q Internal protection: each input is fuse
protected 3.15 A.
q Connection on terminals: max. 6 mm2.
q Modular device: 4 module width.
atys_616_a_1_cat
Use
Provides 230 VAC to both ATyS M 3s power
supply inputs, enabling remote transfer to
any position with either incoming source
available.
1 and 2. Inputs
3. Output
ATyS M
Motorised and automatic changeover switches
from 40 to 160 A
atys_565_c_1_cat
36
40
1599 2010
1599 2020
ATyS D20
20
Reference
ATyS D10
22.5
atys_161_a_1_x_cat
Description of accessories
96 x 96
atys_597_a_1_cat
ATyS D20
In addition to the functions of the ATyS
D10, the D20 displays measurements
and enables ATyS M 6e mode
control and configuration from the
front of a panel.
Protection degree: IP21
Door mounting
2 holes 22.5.
ATyS M connection via RJ45 cable,
not isolated.
Cable available as an accessory.
Use
To display source availability and
position indication on the front of a
panel.
Interfaces are powered from the
ATyS M 6e, via the RJ45 connection
cable.
Maximum connection distance: 3 m.
ATyS D10
To display source availability and
position indication on the front panel
of an enclosure.
Protection degree: IP21
atys_564_c_1_cat
Drillings
Type
Characteristics:
RJ45 8 wire straight-through, non isolated
cable. Length 3m.
Length
Reference
3m
1599 2009
RJ45 cable
acces_209_a_2_cat
Use
To connect between a remote interface
(type D10 or D20) and an ATyS M 6e.
Rating (A)
Reference
40 160
1399 4017(1)
acces_319_a_1_cat
Use
The power connection terminals allow conversion of the cage terminals into bolt-on type
BNMMDBSHNMSDQLHM@KRDM@AKHMFBNMMDBSHNMNETOSNSVNLLB@AKDRNQNMDLLB@AKD
Each power connection terminal is provided with separation screens.
Dimensions
ATyS M 40 to 160 A
Single-phase ATyS M
Three-phase ATyS M
235
52
340
116
52
104
176
116
116
222
47
224
45
131.5
245
350
143
324
46
53
73.5
18
6 x M6
46
53
73.5
47
18
atysm_034_a_1_x_cat
45
131.5
245
13 26
350
143
atysm_204_a_1_x_cat
13 26
371
ATyS M
Motorised and automatic changeover switches
from 40 to 160 A
Three-phase ATyS M 3s
1 : position I control
2 : position II control
3 : position 0 control
4 : power supply I (230 VAC)
5 : power supply II (230 VAC)
6 : voltage tap
7 : auxiliary contact block - 1 NO/NC contact
per position I , 0, II (factory fitted)
atysm_040_e_1_x_cat
atysm_205_a_1_x_cat
B
B
5
4
Single-phase ATyS M 6s
Three-phase ATyS M 6s
1 preferred source
2 alternate source
atysm_212_a_1_x_cat
atysm_206_a_1_x_cat
1
1
Three-phase ATyS M 6e
atysm_211_a_1_x_cat
RJ
372
1 preferred source
2 alternate source
RS
3
2
1 - 2 - 3 : programmable inputs
4 - 5 - 6 : programmable outputs
7 : genset start / stop control
8 : RJ 45 for connecting a ATyS D10/D20 remote interface
9 : RS485 for communication on versions with COM.
A: bridging bar (accessories)
B: auxiliary contact block - 1 NO/NC contact per position I , 0, II (accessories)
ATyS M
Motorised and automatic changeover switches
from 40 to 160 A
40 A
800
6
300
4
2.5
63 A
800
6
300
4
2.5
80 A
800
6
300
4
2.5
100 A
800
6
300
4
2.5
125 A
800
6
300
4
2.5
160 A
800
6
300
4
2.5
A/B(1)
40/40
40/40
40/40
40/40
40/40
40/40
40/40
A/B(1)
63/63
63/63
63/63
63/63
63/63
63/63
63/63
A/B(1)
80/80
80/80
80/80
80/80
80/80
80/80
63/63
A/B(1)
100/100
100/100
100/100
100/100
100/100
80/80
80/80
A/B(1)
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
100/125
80/80
A/B(1)
160/160
160/160
160/160
125/160
160/160
100/125
80/80
A/B(1)
40/40
40/40
-/40
A/B(1)
63/63
63/63
-/63
A/B(1)
80/80
80/80
-/80
A/B(1)
100/100
100/100
-/100
A/B(1)
100/125
100/125
-/125
A/B(1)
100/160
100/160
-/125
50
63
50
80
50
100
50
125
40
160
Utilisation category
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
Utilisation category
AC-31 A / AC-31 B
AC-32 A / AC-32 B
AC-33 A / AC-33 B
50
40
Circuit breaker protected short-circuit withstand with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s
Rated short-time withstand current 0.3s Icw (kA rms)
4
5.88
4
5.88
4
5.88
4
5.88
4
5.88
4
5.88
10
70
5
10
70
5
10
70
5
10
70
5
10
70
5
10
70
5
45
180
90
45
180
90
45
180
90
45
180
90
45
180
90
45
180
90
176/288
160/305
176/288
160/305
176/288
160/305
176/288
160/305
176/288
160/305
176/288
160/305
6
30
20
6
30
20
6
30
20
6
30
20
6
30
20
6
30
20
10 000
2.8
3.5
3.5
4.2
10 000
2.8
3.5
3.5
4.2
10 000
2.8
3.5
3.5
4.2
10 000
2.8
3.5
3.5
4.2
10 000
2.8
3.5
3.5
4.2
10 000
2.8
3.5
3.5
4.2
Connection
Minimum connection cross-section
Maximum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Tightening torque (Nm)
Power supply
Power supply voltage 230 VAC min / max (VAC) (ATyS M 3s and ATyS M 6s)
Power supply voltage 230 VAC min / max (VAC) (ATyS M 6e)
Mechanical characteristics
Durability (number of operating cycles)
Weight of single-phase versions - without packaging (kg)
Weight of single-phase versions - with packaging (kg)
Weight of three-phase versions - without packaging (kg)
Weight of three-phase versions - with packaging (kg)
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) For a rated operational voltage Ue = 400 VAC.
(3) Between the command given and reaching of position at Un (under nominal conditions).
(4) Value for coordination with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s. For
coordination with specific circuit-breaker references, higher short-circuit current values are
available. Please consult us.
(5) Only on ATyS M 3s.
373
ATyS S - ATyS Sd
The solution for
new
>
>
>
>
>
Generator manufacturers.
Heating.
Air conditioning.
Ventilation.
Telecommunications.
atys-s_018_a
Changeover
switches
Strong points
Function
ATyS S is a range of 4 pole motorised changeover switches with positive break indication.
They enable the on load transfer of two three-phase supplies via remote volt-free contacts, from
either an external automatic controller, using pulse logic, or a switch.
They are intended for use in low voltage power systems where interruption of the load supply is
acceptable during transfer.
Conformity to standards
> IEC 60947-6-1
> IEC 60947-3
> GB 14048-11
Advantages
Extensive power supply range
The ATyS S is available in four supply
versions, each with a broad range (+/-30%).
The four versions are:
q 230 VAC single power supply,
q 2 x 230VAC dual power supply,
q 12 VDC power supply and
q 24/48 VDC power supply.
Safety and reliability
ATyS S products use stable position
technology, ensuring constant pressure on
the contacts and preventing premature faults.
In addition, they do not require a power
supply to maintain position, thus protecting
their loads from voltage fluctuations.
Easy integration
ATyS S products can be easily installed inside
enclosures.
Their design, and in particular their compact
size, enables integration within most 200 mm
deep enclosures.
374
Simplified maintenance
Maintenance can be carried out easily under
load, with manual operation still available.
The control and motorisation section can be
replaced simply by removing 4 screws, with
no work required on the installation cabling.
ATyS Sd: Dual power supply
In addition to the functions offered by the
ATyS S, the ATyS Sd incorporates supply
redundancy without the need for additional
wiring. This is obtained by integrating a double
RTOOKXHMCDODMCDMSRTOOKHDRCHQDBSKXVHSGHM
the product.
ATyS S - ATyS Sd
Motorised changeover switches
from 40 to 125 A
References
Rating (A)
40 A
63 A
80 A
100 A
125 A
No. of poles
Power supply
ATyS S
4P
24/48 VDC
9506 4004
4P
12 VDC
9505 4004
4P
2 x 230 VAC
9513 4004
4P
230 VAC
9503 4004
Bridging bars
4P
24/48 VDC
9506 4006
12 VDC
9505 4006
4P
2 x 230 VAC
9513 4006
4P
230 VAC
9503 4006
4P
24/48 VDC
9506 4008
4P
12 VDC
9505 4008
4P
2 x 230 VAC
9513 4008
9509 4012
4P
230 VAC
9503 4008
4P
24/48 VDC
9506 4010
4P
12 VDC
9505 4010
4P
2 x 230 VAC
9513 4010
4P
230 VAC
9503 4010
4P
24/48 VDC
9506 4012
4P
12 VDC
9505 4012
4P
2 x 230 VAC
9513 4012
4P
230 VAC
9503 4012
Voltage tap
Terminal retainer
DIN rail
2 pieces
4 modules
9599 4003
9599 4002
9599 4001
4P
4P
Terminal
shrouds
9599 4001
Source side
2 pieces
9594 4012
Load side
2 pieces
9599 4001
9594 9012
9599 4001
9599 4001
375
ATyS S - ATyS Sd
Motorised changeover switches
from 40 to 125 A
Accessories
Bridging bars
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Reference
40 125
4P
9509 4012
atys-s_019_a
Use
For bridging power terminals on the top or bottom side of the switch
Voltage tap
Rating (A)
Reference
40 125
9509 4001
atys-s_022_a
Use
Enables the required power supply for ATyS S 230 VAC and ATyS Sd
products to be tapped directly from the product's incoming power
terminals. Can also be utilised in applications without neutral, to
provide 400 VAC to the autotransformer.
Terminal retainer
Rating (A)
Pack
Reference
40 125
2 pieces
9599 4003
atys-s_021_a
Use
These clips have a dual function:
- To prevent direct access to the power supply and control terminals and
- To secure these connector terminals.
Pack
Reference
40 125
2 pieces
9594 4012
Rating (A)
Pack
Reference
40 125
2 pieces
9594 9012
atys-s_020_a
Use
IP2X protection against direct contact with terminals or
connecting parts.
atys-s_020_a
Terminal shrouds
Rating (A)
Reference
40 125
9599 4004
Rating (A)
Reference
40 125
9599 4002
Rating (A)
Reference
40 125
9599 4005
DIN rail
Use
This 4-module DIN rail can be installed directly on the front of
the ATyS S and can be utilised, for example, for the installation
of a surge protection device.
376
ATyS S - ATyS Sd
Motorised changeover switches
from 40 to 125 A
40 A
63 A
80 A
100 A
125 A
800
800
800
800
800
300
300
300
300
300
Utilisation category
A/B
A/B
A/B
A/B
A/B
AC-20 A / AC-20 B
40/40
63/63
80/80
100/100
125/125
415 VAC
AC-21 A / AC-21 B
40/40
63/63
80/80
100/100
100/125
415 VAC
AC-22 A / AC-22 B
40/40
63/63
80/80
100/100
100/100
415 VAC
AC-23 A / AC-23 B
-/40
-/63
-/63
-/63
-/63
Utilisation category
A/B
A/B
A/B
A/B
A/B
415 VAC
AC-31 B
40
63
80
100
125
415 VAC
AC-32 B
40
63
80
80
80
50
50
50
25
15
40
63
80
100
125
Circuit breaker protected short-circuit withstand with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s(1)
Rated short-time withstand current 0.3s. Icw (kA rms)
3.5
3.5
3.5
3.5
3.5
2.5
2.5
2.5
2.5
2.5
4.5
4.5
4.5
4.5
4.5
Connection
Maximum Cu cable cross-section (mm2)
Tightening torque mini / maxi (Nm)
50
50
50
50
50
1.2/3
1.2/3
1.2/3
1.2/3
1.2/3
500
500
500
500
500
I - II or II - I (ms)
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
500
500
500
500
500
Power supply
Power supply 12 VDC min / max (VDC)
9/15
9/15
9/15
9/15
9/15
17/62
17/62
17/62
17/62
17/62
160/310
160/310
160/310
160/310
160/310
200/40
200/40
200/40
200/40
200/40
200/40
200/40
200/40
200/40
200/40
200/40
200/40
200/40
200/40
200/40
10 000
Mechanical characteristics
(1) Value for coordination with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s. For coordination with specific circuit-breaker references, higher short-circuit current values are available.
Please consult us.
377
ATyS S - ATyS Sd
Motorised changeover switches
from 40 to 125 A
atys_830_a_1_x_cat
101102
4
317 316 315 314
201202
04 01 24 21 14 11
1 preferred source
2 alternate source
1 : position 0 control
2 : position I control
3 : position II control
4 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in
position 0
5 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in
position II
6 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in
position I
7 : power supply kit I: 230 VAC (160-310 VAC)
8 : power supply kit II: 230 VAC (160-310 VAC)
1 2 3
301302
atys_832_a_1_x_cat
4
317 316 315 314
04 01 24 21 14 11
1 preferred source
2 alternate source
1 : position 0 control
2 : position I control
3 : position II control
4 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in
position 0
5 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in
position II
6 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in
position I
7 : power supply kit: 230 VAC (160-310 VAC)
1 2 3
ATyS S DC version
4
317 316 315 314
1 2 3
378
401402
atys_831_b_1_x_cat
04 01 24 21 14 11
DC
1 preferred source
2 alternate source
1 : position 0 control
2 : position I control
3 : position II control
4 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in
position 0
5 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in
position II
6 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in
position I
7 : power supply 12 VDC (9-15 VDC) or 24 VDC /
48 VDC (17-62 VDC) depending on the version.
ATyS S - ATyS Sd
Motorised changeover switches
from 40 to 125 A
Dimensions
104.5
15
11
113
143.5
25
72
106
94
90.6
100 100
72
37
115.2
74
44
100
198
181
42.5
14
125
atys-s_024_a_1_x_cat
6.4
45
16
M6
14
M6
16
atys-s_024_a_1_x_cat
Connection terminal
379
A complete range of motorised and automatic changeover switches from 125 to 3200 A
To meet the increasing demands of its
users, the ATyS range is constantly evolving
to offer new functions.
WEB
SERVE
OPTIONR
ATyS
Remote
Transfer
Switch
ATyS d
Remote Transfer
Switch (RTS)
ATyS t
Automatic Transfer
Switch (ATS)
ATyS g
Automatic Transfer
Switch (ATS)
Dual power
supply
Automatic controller
to manage
transformer /
transformer
applications
Automatic controller
to manage
transformer /
genset applications
Functions for
energy management
Communication options
Product description
Existing range
New range
ATyS 3s
ATyS
1523 YXXX*
9523 YXXX*
ATyS 3e
ATyS d
1533 YXXX*
9533 YXXX*
not available
not available
ATyS g
9553 YXXX*
1563 YXXX*
ATyS 6m
ATyS p
1573 YXXX*
9573 YXXX*
012: 125 A
016: 160 A
020: 200 A
025: 250 A
031: 315 A
040: 400 A
050: 500 A
063: 630 A
080: 800 A
100: 1000 A
125: 1250 A
160: 1600 A
180: 1800 A
200: 2000 A
250: 2500 A
320: 3200 A
ATyS 6e
ATyS t
9543 YXXX*
*YXXX:
Y = 3 for a 3 pole device and 4 for a 4 pole device.
XXX =
380
ATyS p
Automatic Transfer
Switch (ATS)
The advantages
Rapid
commissioning
q ATyS and ATyS d: No configuration
necessary.
q ATyS t and ATyS g: Configuration in just a
few minutes using a screwdriver.
q ATyS p: Simplified configuration (EASY
CONFIG software and LCD screen on the
device).
q ATYS t, g, p: Auto-configuration of the
network parameters.
Easy
maintenance
IEC 60947-3
q "!TOSN
Extended power supply range
qEQNLSN5 "
Also available:
ATyS S from 40 to 125 A
Specially developed for manufacturers
of small generators, the ATyS S is a
motorised changeover switch which
enables on load switching between two
ONVDQRTOOKXRNTQBDRNETOSN
(< 90 kVA).
7UDQVIRUPHUJHQHUDWRU
ATyS C30
ATyS D20
ATYS-S 027 B
Robust integrated
solution
*HQHUDWRUJHQHUDWRU
ATyS C40
ATYS-S 028 B
Intuitive
use
ATyS S
7UDQVIRUPHUWUDQVIRUPHU
ATyS C30
ATyS D10
ATYS-S 026 B
Safe
operation
ATyS Sd
381
ATyS - ATyS d
Motorised changeover switches
from 125 to 3200 A
The solution for
Changeover
switches
new
atys_d_001_a_1_cat
Strong points
> Watchdog relay to check
product availability
> Integrated auxiliary contacts.
> Extended power supply range.
> ATyS d: ATyS with integrated
DPS.
Conformity to standards
Function
The ATyS and ATyS d are three-phase motorised changeover switches with positive break
indication. They enable the on load transfer of two three-phase supplies via remote volt-free
contacts, from either an external automatic controller, using pulse logic, or a switch.
They are intended for use in low voltage power systems where interruption of the load supply
is acceptable during transfer.
Enclosed solution
> Please consult us.
Advantages
Watchdog relay to check product
availability
ATyS and ATyS d products are equipped with
a Watchdog relay which constantly monitors
the product, thereby securing your installation.
This relay informs the user of the product's
availability, i.e. whether it is operational and
ready for source switching.
Integrated auxiliary contacts
As part of the product monitoring function, the
ATyS and ATyS d enable the transmission of
information relating to their position.
This is possible thanks to the standard
integration of an auxiliary contact for each
position.
382
ATyS - ATyS d
Motorised changeover switches
from 125 to 3200 A
References
Rating (A)
No. of poles
ATyS
ATyS d(5)
3P
9523 3012
9533 3012
125 A
4P
9523 4012
9533 4012
3P
9523 3016
9533 3016
4P
9523 4016
9533 4016
3P
9523 3020
9533 3020
160 A
200 A
4P
9523 4020
9533 4020
3P
9523 3025
9533 3025
4P
9523 4025
9533 4025
3P
9523 3031
9533 3031
4P
9523 4031
9533 4031
Bridging bars
Terminal
shrouds
3P
4109 0019
2694 3014(2)
4P
2694 4014(2)
Terminal
screens
Auxiliary
contact
3 position
padlocking
1599 0002(4)
1599 0003(4)
Autotransformer
3P
1509 3012
4P
1509 4012
4109 0025
250 A
3P
2694 3021(2)
315 A
4P
4109 0039
3P
9523 3040
9533 3040
4P
9523 4040
9533 4040
3P
9523 3050
9533 3050
4P
9523 4050
9533 4050
3P
9523 3063
9533 3063
2694 4021(2)
3P
1509 3025
4P
1509 4025
400 A
4109 0050
500 A
4P
4109 0063
630 A
4P
9523 4063
9533 4063
3P
9523 3080
9533 3080
4P
9523 4080
9533 4080
3P
9523 3100
9533 3100
4P
9523 4100
9533 4100
3P
9523 3120
9533 3120
4P
9523 4120
9533 4120
3P
9523 3160
9533 3160
4P
9523 4160
9533 4160
3P
2694 3051(2)
2694 4051(2)
3P
1509 3063(3)
4P
1509 4063(3)
400/230 VAC
1599 4064
800 A
4109 0080
3P
1509 3080(3)
1000 A
4P
1509 4080(3)
1599 0032(4)
4109 0120
1250 A
1600 A
3P
1509 3160(3)
4109 0160
3P
9523 3180
9533 3180
4P
9523 4180
9533 4180
3P
9523 3200
9533 3200
4P
1599 0004(4)
(3)
1509 4160
1800 A
2000 A
4P
9523 4200
9533 4200
3P
9523 3250
9533 3250
4P
9523 4250
9533 4250
3P
9523 3320
9533 3320
4P
9523 4320
9533 4320
2500 A
included
included
3200 A
(1) See "Copper bar connection kits" page 393.
(2) To fully shroud front, rear, top and bottom 4 references required.
To shroud front switch top and bottom 2 references required.
(3) 2 pieces: one for top side and another for bottom side.
(4) Factory mounting only.
(5) An optional key operated Auto/Manual selector is available on request.
If required, this option must be requested when ordering the switch;
please refer to "Auto/Manuel key selector" in the accessory section.
Technical information
>
>
>
>
383
ATyS t
Automatic changeover switches
from 125 to 3200 A
new
> Transformer/Transformer
applications.
atys_t_001_a_1
Changeover
switches
Strong points
> Rapid commissioning.
> Functions adapted to
transformer/transformer
applications.
Conformity to standards
> IEC 60947-6-1
> IEC 60947-3
Function
Enclosed solution
ATyS t is a range of three-phase automatic changeover switches with positive break indication.
They incorporate all the functions offered by the ATyS d, as well as functions intended for
transformer/transformer applications.
In automatic mode they enable the monitoring of, and the on load changeover switching
between, two power supply sources, in accordance with the parameters configured via two
potentiometers and four DIP switches.
They are intended for use in low voltage power systems where interruption of the load supply is
acceptable during transfer.
Advantages
Rapid commissioning
ATyS t switches offer significant time saving
during commissioning (process takes 2 to
LHMTSDR
!DB@TRDSGDXG@UDNMKXSVN
potentiometers and four DIP switches, a
simple screwdriver is all you need to configure
the parameters.
For added simplicity, they also offer an
autoconfiguration function which enables
automatic adjustment of the rated voltage and
frequency.
384
Functions adapted to
transformer/transformer applications
ATyS t products are automatic changeover
switches intended specifically for transformer/
transformer applications. Their integrated
controller has been designed to provide all the
functions necessary for these applications,
including monitoring the voltage and
frequency of both sources, for three-phase
and single-phase networks.
ATyS t
Automatic changeover switches
from 125 to 3200 A
References
Rating (A)
No. of poles
ATyS t(5)
3P
9543 3012
4P
9543 4012
3P
9543 3016
Bridging bars
Terminal
shrouds
Terminal
screens
Auxiliary
contact
3 position
padlocking
1599 0002(4)
1599 0003(4)
Autotransformer
125 A
3P
4109 0019
160 A
4P
9543 4016
3P
9543 3020
4P
9543 4020
3P
9543 3025
4P
9543 4025
3P
9543 3031
4P
9543 4031
3P
2694 3014(2)
1509 3012
4P
4P
2694 4014(2)
1509 4012
200 A
4109 0025
250 A
3P
9543 3040
4P
9543 4040
3P
9543 3050
4P
9543 4050
3P
9543 3063
1509 3025
4P
4109 0039
3P
3P
2694 3021(2)
315 A
4P
2694 4021(2)
1509 4025
400 A
4109 0050
500 A
4P
9543 4063
3P
9543 3080
4P
9543 4080
3P
9543 3100
4P
9543 4100
3P
9543 3120
4P
9543 4120
3P
9543 3160
4P
9543 4160
3P
1509 3063(3)
4P
4109 0063
630 A
3P
2694 3051(2)
4P
2694 4051(2)
1509 4063(3)
400/230 VAC
1599 4064
800 A
4109 0080
3P
1509 3080(3)
1000 A
4P
1509 4080(3)
1599 0032(4)
4109 0120
1250 A
1600 A
3P
1509 3160(3)
4109 0160
3P
9543 3180
4P
9543 4180
3P
9543 3200
4P
9543 4200
3P
9543 3250
4P
9543 4250
3P
9543 3320
4P
9543 4320
4P
1599 0004(4)
(3)
1509 4160
1800 A
2000 A
2500 A
included
included
3200 A
Technical information
>
>
>
>
385
ATyS g
Automatic changeover switches
from 125 to 3200 A
The solution for
Strong points
atys_g_001_a_1
Changeover
switches
new
> Transformer/generator
applications.
Conformity to standards
> IEC 60947-6-1
> IEC 60947-3
Function
Enclosed solution
ATyS g is a range of three-phase automatic changeover switches with positive break indication.
They incorporate all the functions offered by the ATyS d, as well as functions intended for
transformer/generator applications.
In automatic mode they enable the monitoring of, and the on load changeover switching
between, two power supply sources, in accordance with the parameters configured via four
potentiometers and four DIP switches.
They are intended for use in low voltage power systems where interruption of the load supply is
acceptable during transfer.
Advantages
Rapid commissioning
ATyS g switches offer significant time saving
during commissioning (process takes
@OOQNWHL@SDKXLHMTSDR
!DB@TRDSGDX
have only four potentiometers and four DIP
switches, a screwdriver is all that is needed to
configure the parameters.
For added simplicity, they also offer an
autoconfiguration function which enables
automatic adjustment of the rated voltage and
frequency.
Functions adapted to
transformer/generator applications
ATyS g products are automatic changeover
switches intended specifically for
transformer/generator applications. Their
integrated controller has been designed to
provide all the functions necessary for these
applications, including monitoring the voltage
and frequency of both sources, for threephase and single-phase networks.
Generator test functions
To ensure compatibility with
transformer/generator applications, ATyS g
switches integrate the following generator test
functions:
Test on load and test off load.
386
ATyS g
Automatic changeover switches
from 125 to 3200 A
References
Rating (A)
No. of poles
ATyS g(5)
3P
9553 3012
4P
9553 4012
3P
9553 3016
Bridging bars
Terminal
shrouds
Terminal
screens
Auxiliary
contact
3 position
padlocking
1599 0002(4)
1599 0003(4)
Autotransformer
125 A
3P
4109 0019
160 A
4P
9553 4016
3P
9553 3020
4P
9553 4020
3P
9553 3025
4P
9553 4025
3P
9553 3031
4P
9553 4031
3P
2694 3014(2)
1509 3012
4P
4P
2694 4014(2)
1509 4012
200 A
4109 0025
250 A
3P
315 A
9553 3040
4P
9553 4040
3P
9553 3050
4P
9553 4050
3P
9553 3063
1509 3025
4P
4109 0039
3P
3P
2694 3021(2)
4P
2694 4021(2)
1509 4025
400 A
4109 0050
500 A
4P
9553 4063
3P
9553 3080
4P
9553 4080
3P
9553 3100
4P
9553 4100
3P
9553 3120
4P
9553 4120
3P
9553 3160
4P
9553 4160
3P
1509 3063(3)
4P
4109 0063
630 A
3P
2694 3051(2)
4P
2694 4051(2)
1509 4063(3)
400/230 VAC
1599 4064
800 A
4109 0080
3P
1509 3080(3)
1000 A
4P
1509 4080(3)
1599 0032(4)
4109 0120
1250 A
1600 A
3P
1509 3160(3)
4109 160
3P
9553 3180
4P
9553 4180
3P
9553 3200
4P
9553 4200
3P
9553 3250
4P
9553 4250
3P
9553 3320
4P
9553 4320
1599 0004(4)
4P
1509 4160(3)
1800 A
2000 A
2500 A
included
included
3200 A
Technical information
>
>
>
>
387
ATyS p
Automatic changeover switches
from 125 to 3200 A
The solution for
atys_003_b_1_cat
Changeover
switches
new
Strong points
> Optional communication
modules.
> Recording of events.
> Power measurements.
> Possibility to set periodic
genset startup.
Conformity to standards
Function
ATyS p is a range of three-phase automatic changeover switches with positive break indication.
They incorporate all the functions offered by the ATyS g, as well as functions designed for power
management and enabling communication.
In automatic mode they enable the monitoring of, and the on load changeover switching between,
two power supply sources, in accordance with the parameters configured via pushbuttons and an
LCD screen.
They are intended for use in low voltage power systems where interruption of the load supply is
acceptable during transfer.
388
Enclosed solution
> Please consult us.
Webserver
Advantages
Recording of events
ATyS p switches enable effective monitoring
of your installation thanks to timestamped
event recording. Events can be retrieved and
read via the communication system.
Power measurements
ATyS p products are particularly suited to
energy management and monitoring.
In addition to their integrated power
and energy measurement functions,
programmable inputs/outputs can be utilised
to control load shedding based on a load level
or tariff.
Generator periodic startup programming
(option)
ATyS p switches offer additional functions for
maintenance. They include the programmed
generator starting function which allows the
starting dates and operating times to be
configured.
ATyS p
Automatic changeover switches
from 125 to 3200 A
Front panel
3
1. Slots for optional plug-in modules.
!@BJKHS+"#CHROK@X
3. Source availability and position indication LEDs.
4. Pushbuttons for programming and mode selection.
atys-p_001x_a_1
2
4
diris_447_a_1_cat
2 inputs - 2 outputs
diris_776_a_1_cat
q 12KHMJVHSG)!42,.#!42 protocol
RODDCTOSNA@TCR
Ethernet communication
q $SGDQMDSKHMJVHSG,.#!423"/NQ
)!42,.#!42134NUDQ3"/
q Embedded Ethernet Webserver software.
Ethernet communication with RS485 JBUS/
MODBUS gateway
q $SGDQMDSKHMJVHSG,.#!423"/NQ
)!42,.#!42134NUDQ3"/
q "NMMDBSHNMNESN12)!42,.#!42RK@UDR
q Embedded Ethernet Webserver software.
Analogue outputs
diris_448_a_1_cat
diris_445_a_1_cat
diris_834_a
diris_777_a_1_cat
ATyS p
diris_449_a_1_cat
Plug-in modules
q .TSOTSR@RRHFM@AKDSN
((M54%YP, YQ, YS.
Pulse outputs
q 2 configurable pulse outputs (type, weight and
CTQ@SHNMNMJ6GJU@QG@MCJ5 G
389
ATyS p
Automatic changeover switches
from 125 to 3200 A
References
Rating (A)
No. of poles
ATyS p(5)
3P
9573 3012
4P
9573 4012
3P
9573 3016
Bridging bars
Terminal
shrouds
Terminal
screens
Optional
modules
Auxiliary
contact
Autotransformer
125 A
3P
4109 0019
160 A
4P
9573 4016
3P
9573 3020
4P
9573 4020
3P
9573 3025
4P
9573 4025
3P
9573 3031
4P
9573 4031
2694 3014(2)
4P
2694 4014(2)
3P
1509 3012
4P
1509 4012
200 A
4109 0025
250 A
3P
2694 3021(2)
315 A
4P
4109 0039
3P
9573 3040
4P
9573 4040
3P
9573 3050
4P
9573 4050
3P
9573 3063
4P
9573 4063
3P
9573 3080
4P
9573 4080
3P
9573 3100
4P
9573 4100
3P
9573 3120
2694 4021(2)
4P
1509 4025
12)!42
,.#!42
communication
400 A
4825 0092
4109 0050
500 A
4109 0063
630 A
3P
3P
2694 3051(2)
1509 3063(3)
4P
4P
2694 4051(2)
1509 4063(3)
3P
1509 3080(3)
1000 A
3P
9573 3160
4P
9573 4160
1509 4080(3)
4P
9573 4180
3P
9573 3200
4P
9573 4200
3P
9573 3250
4P
9573 4250
3P
9573 3320
4P
9573 4320
Ethernet
communication +
12,.#!42
gateway
4825 0204
Analogue outputs
Pulse outputs
1599 0032(4)
4825 0090
3P
4109 0160
9573 3180
400/230 VAC
4825 0093
1600 A
3P
Ethernet
communication
4P
4109 0120
9573 4120
4825 0094
1599 4064
4109 0080
4P
2 inputs /
2 outputs
4825 0203
800 A
1250 A
1599 0002(4)
3P
1509 3025
1509 3160(3)
4P
1509 4160(3)
1800 A
2000 A
2500 A
3200 A
390
included
included
ATyS p
Automatic changeover switches
from 125 to 3200 A
References
Rating (A)
No. of poles
ATyS p
3P
9573 3012
4P
9573 4012
3P
9573 3016
4P
9573 4016
3P
9573 3020
4P
9573 4020
3P
9573 3025
4P
9573 4025
3P
9573 3031
4P
9573 4031
3P
9573 3040
4P
9573 4040
3P
9573 3050
4P
9573 4050
3P
9573 3063
4P
9573 4063
3P
9573 3080
4P
9573 4080
3P
9573 3100
4P
9573 4100
3P
9573 3120
4P
9573 4120
3P
9573 3160
4P
9573 4160
3P
9573 3180
4P
9573 4180
DC power supply
3 position
padlocking
Key handle
interlocking
system
Door protective
surround
Mounting
spacers
1539 0012
1 set of 2 spacers
Remote control
interface
125 A
160 A
200 A
250 A
(1)
1599 0003
4RHMFKNBJ
1.-(2$+ /
in position 0
1509 0001
1509 1006(1)
315 A
400 A
500 A
1599 5012
24 VDC / 230 VAC
1599 5112
ATyS D20
630 A
9599 2020
+
RJ45 cable
connection
800 A
1599 2009
1000 A
1250 A
1600 A
1800 A
3P
9573 3200
4P
9573 4200
3P
9573 3250
4P
9573 4250
3P
9573 3320
4P
9573 4320
1599 0004(1)
4RHMFKNBJ
1.-(2$+ /
in position 0
1539 0080
1509 1004(1)
2000 A
2500 A
3200 A
391
ATyS range
ATyS, ATyS d, ATyS t, ATyS g, ATyS p
from 125 to 3200 A
Terminal shrouds
Advantages
Perforations allow remote thermographic
inspection without the need to remove the
shrouds.
Use
IP2X protection against direct contact with
terminals or connecting parts.
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Position
Reference
125 200
3P
SNOANSSNLEQNMS(QD@Q((
125 200
4P
SNOANSSNLEQNMS(QD@Q((
250 400
3P
SNOANSSNLEQNMS(QD@Q((
250 400
4P
SNOANSSNLEQNMS(QD@Q((
500 630
3P
SNOANSSNLEQNMS(QD@Q((
500 630
4P
SNOANSSNLEQNMS(QD@Q((
2694 3014(1)(2)
2694 4014(1)(2)
2694 3021(1)(2)
2694 4021(1)(2)
2694 3051(1)(2)
2694 4051(1)(2)
acces_206_a_2_cat
Changeover
switches
Accessories
Terminal screens
Rating (A)
125 200
125 200
250 400
250 400
500 630
500 630
800 1250
800 1250
1600 1800
1600 1800
2000 3200
2000 3200
No. of poles
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
Position
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
top / bottom
1509 3012
1509 4012
1509 3025
1509 4025
1509 3063
1509 4063
1509 3080
1509 4080
1509 3160
1509 4160
1509 3200
1509 4200
acces_207_a_2_cat
Use
Top and bottom protection against direct
contact with terminals or connection parts.
!QHCFHMFA@QR
Rating (A)
Section (mm)
Reference
125 200
20 x 2.5
250
25 x 2.5
400
32 x 5
500
32 x 5
630
50 x 5
800 1000
50 x 6
4109 0019
4109 0025
4109 0039
4109 0050
4109 0063
4109 0080
4109 0120
4109 0160
60 x 8
1600 1800
90 x 10
acces_041_a_1_cat
1250
acces_205_a_2_cat
Use
For bridging power terminals on the top or bottom side of the switch.
.MDOHDBDQDPTHQDCODQONKD
392
ATyS range
ATyS, ATyS d, ATyS t, ATyS g, ATyS p
from 125 to 3200 A
!NKSRDSRLTRSADNQCDQDCRDO@Q@SDKX
The technical notice for these specific
accessories can be downloaded from
www.socomec.com.
acces_226_b_1_x_cat
Use
Enables:
- connection between the two power
terminals of the same pole for 2000 to
Q@SHMFR%HF
@MC%HF
SNONQANSSNLAQHCFHMFBNMMDBSHNM%HF
For 3200 A rating, the connection pieces
O@QS @QDCDKHUDQDCAQHCFDCEQNLE@BSNQX
2000 2500
Connection - part A
2000 2500
!NKSRDSO@QS!
Reference
155
Piece
129
Rating (A)
74
37 60
2619 1200
2699 1200
acces_232_a_1_cat
252
74
37
Fig.2
!NKSRDSO@QS!
2699 1200
Quantity to order
per pole(1)
Reference
acces_228_b_1_x_cat
3200
included
2000 2500
Connection - part A
2000 2500
T piece - part C
2000 2500
!Q@BJDSO@QS#
3200
Connection - part A
3200
T piece - part C
3200
!Q@BJDSO@QS#
2619 1200
2629 1200(2)
2639 1200(2)
30303030
132
30303030 22
included
2629 1200(2)
2639 1200(2)
acces_233_a_1_cat
Piece
210
Rating (A)
Piece
Quantity to order
per pole(1)
2000 2500
Connection - part A
2000 2500
!NKSRDSO@QS!
2000 2500
!@QO@QS$
2000 2500
T piece - part C
3200
Connection - part A
3200
!NKSRDSO@QS!
Reference
Fig. 3
2619 1200
2699 1200
4109 0250(2)
2629 1200(2)
included
2
3200
!@QO@QS$
3200
T piece - part C
acces_230_b_1_x_cat
Connection - part A
2699 1200
4109 0320(2)
2629 1200(2)
30303030
148
225
(1) Example for 3 pole device equipped upstream only: Order 3 times the indicated quantities.
(2) Bolt set is provided with the accessories.
acces_234_a_1_cat
3200
393
ATyS range
ATyS, ATyS d, ATyS t, ATyS g, ATyS p
from 125 to 3200 A
BBDRRNQHDRBNMSHMTDC
Autotransformer 400/230 VAC
Use
For applications without neutral, this autotransformer provides the 230 VAC
required to power these ATyS products.
Rating (A)
Reference
125 3200
1599 4064
DC power supply
Use
Allows an ATyS to be supplied from a 12 or 24 VDC source.
To be positioned as close as possible to the DC power supply source.
Rating (A)
Operating voltage
Reference
125 1800
125 1800
1599 5012
1599 5112
atys_606_a_1_cat
Reference
125 160
1559 3012
1559 3025
1559 3040
1559 3063
1559 3080
1559 3120
1559 3160
1559 3200
250
400
630
800 1000
1250
1600 1800
2000 3200
atys_603_a_2_cat
Use
For power supply and voltage
LD@RTQDLDMSVHQDSGQDDOG@RDENQSGD
ATyS t, g and p.
Routing of the conductors is controlled,
which means that no specific protective
device is necessary for these connections.
Neutral on the
left
Rating (A)
Reference
Reference
125 160
1559 4012
1559 4025
1559 4040
1559 4063
1559 4080
1559 4120
1559 4160
1559 4200
1559 4013
1559 4026
1559 4041
1559 4064
1559 4081
1559 4121
1559 4161
1559 4201
250
400
630
800 1000
1250
1600 1800
2000 3200
Use
The ATyS DS is a voltage relay for monitoring a
single three-phase power supply source.
4ONME@HKTQDNESGDONVDQRTOOKXRNTQBDSGD
voltage relays fault contact closes.
394
Rating (A)
Reference
ATyS DS
192X 0056
atys_762_a_1_cat
ATyS range
ATyS, ATyS d, ATyS t, ATyS g, ATyS p
from 125 to 3200 A
atys_595_a_2_cat
Use
When direct access to the ATyS front face (mode selection, manual
NODQ@SHNMCHROK@X
HRQDPTHQDCSGDCNNQRTQQNTMCB@MADTSHKHRDC
to provide a clean and safe finish to the panels cut-out.
For
Rating (A)
Reference
125 630
1529 0012
1529 0080
800 1800
For ATyS d, t, g and p
Rating (A)
Reference
125 630
1539 0012
1539 0080
800 3200
Use
Pre-breaking and signalling of positions
I and II. Each reference provides a single
E@BSNQXEHSSDC-.-"BNMS@BSENQANSG
positions.
Rating (A)
125 3200
Nominal
current (A)
16
12
14
48 VDC
DC-13
6
Rating (A)
Reference
125 630
800 1800
2000 3200
1599 0002(1)
1599 0032(1)
acces_065_a_1_cat
Auxiliary contact
included
Mounting spacers
This accessory may also be used to replace
the original mounting spacers.
Rating (A)
Description of accessory
Reference
125 630
1 set of 2 spacers
1509 0001
atys_009_a_2_cat
Use
Increases the distance between the rear
ONVDQSDQLHM@KR@MCSGDA@BJOK@SDAXLL
atys_855_a_1_cat
Use
Replaces the standard Auto/Manual selector
knob with a key selector, providing added
security by preventing unauthorised use of
product.
This is a factory fitted option which must be
requested when ordering the ATyS switch
3X2 3X2CSF@MCO
3NNQCDQSGHRNOSHNM
simply add -K after the ATyS reference.
Use
Enables the ATyS to be padlocked in
ONRHSHNMR(@MC((E@BSNQXEHSSDC
Rating (A)
Reference
125 630
1599 0003
1599 0004
800 3200
atys_854_a_1_cat
ONRHSHNMO@CKNBJHMF(((
395
ATyS range
ATyS, ATyS d, ATyS t, ATyS g, ATyS p
from 125 to 3200 A
BBDRRNQHDRBNMSHMTDC
Key handle interlocking system
+NBJHMFHM@KKSGQDDONRHSHNMR(((QDPTHQDR
in addition, the "3 position padlocking"
accessory.
Rating (A)
Reference
125 630
1509 1006
1509 1004
800 3200
atys_853_a_1_cat
Use
With the product in manual mode, it enables
KNBJHMFHMONRHSHNMTRHMF@1.-(2$+ /
KNBJE@BSNQXEHSSDC
Current transformers
trafo_025_a_2_cat
Reference
See page 488.
trafo_077_b_1_cat
Description of accessories
Reference
12,.#!42BNLLTMHB@SHNM
4825 0092
4825 0094
2 inputs/2 outputs
Ethernet communication
DLADCCDC$SGDQMDSVDARDQUDQRNESV@QD
4825 0203
$SGDQMDSBNLLTMHB@SHNM
12)!42,.#!42F@SDV@X
DLADCCDC$SGDQMDSVDARDQUDQRNESV@QD
4825 0204
Analogue outputs
Pulse outputs
396
4825 0093
4825 0090
atys_016_c_1_cat
ATyS range
ATyS, ATyS d, ATyS t, ATyS g, ATyS p
from 125 to 3200 A
atys_565_d_1_cat
Door mounting
2 holes 22.5. ATyS changeover switch
connection via RJ45 cable, not isolated.
Cable available as an accessory.
Drillings
96 x 96
22.5
9599 2010
9599 2020
ATyS D20
40
Reference
ATyS D10
20
Description of accessories
atys_597_a_1_cat
36
atys_161_a_1_x_cat
Use
To display source availability and position
indication on the front of a panel.
Interfaces are powered from the ATyS
changeover switch, via the RJ45
connection cable.
Maximum connection distance: 3 m.
atys_564_d_1_cat
Remote interfaces
Use
To connect between a remote interface
SXOD#NQ#@MC@M 3X2BG@MFDNUDQ
RVHSBG 3X2CSFNQO
Length
Reference
3m
1599 2009
Sealable cover
Rating (A)
No. of poles
Reference
40 160
2P
9599 0000
atysm_043_a_2_cat
397
ATyS range
ATyS, ATyS d, ATyS t, ATyS g, ATyS p
from 125 to 3200 A
125 A
800
8
160 A
800
8
200 A
800
8
250 A
1000
12
315 A
1000
12
400 A
1000
12
500 A
1000
12
630 A
1000
12
A/B(1)
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
80/80
125/125
125/125
125/125
63/80
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
125/125
A/B(1)
160/160
160/160
160/160
160/160
160/160
160/160
160/160
80/80
160/160
160/160
125/125
63/80
160/160
160/160
160/160
125/125
160/160
125/125
125/125
125/125
A/B(1)
200/200
200/200
200/200
200/200
200/200
200/200
200/200
80/80
200/200
200/200
125/125
63/80
200/200
200/200
200/200
125/125
200/200
125/125
125/125
125/125
A/B(1)
250/250
250/250
250/250
200/200
250/250
250/250
200/250
200/200
250/250
200/200
160/160
125/125
250/250
250/250
250/250
200/200
250/250
200/200
200/200
200/200
A/B(1)
315/315
315/315
315/315
315/315
315/315
315/315
200/315
200/200
315/315
200/200
160/160
125/125
315/315
250/250
250/250
200/200
315/315
200/200
200/200
200/200
A/B(1)
400/400
400/400
400/400
400/400
400/400
400/400
200/400
200/200
400/400
200/200
160/160
125/125
400/400
250/250
250/250
200/200
400/400
200/200
200/200
200/200
A/B(1)
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
400/400
500/500
500/500
400/400
400/400
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
500/500
A/B(1)
630/630
630/630
630/630
630/630
630/630
630/630
500/500
400/400
630/630
500/500
400/400
400/400
630/630
630/630
630/630
630/630
630/630
630/630
630/630
630/630
160
200
250
200
200
315
315
200
400
400
200
500
500
400
630
500
400
100
160
50
200
50
250
50
315
50
400
50
500
50
630
Utilisation category
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
Utilisation category
"!
"!
"!
125
100
125
Circuit breaker protected short-circuit withstand with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s(4)
1@SDCRGNQSSHLDVHSGRS@MCBTQQDMS
R(BVJ QLR
12
12
12
15
15
15
17
17
7
11.9
8
22
8
22
8
22
10
17
10
17
10
10
10
10
12.6
7
11.9
7
11.9
Connection
,@WHLTL"TB@AKDBQNRRRDBSHNMLL
,HMHLTL"TATRA@QBQNRRRDBSHNMLL
,@WHLTL"TB@AKDBQNRRRDBSHNMLL
,@WHLTL"TATRA@QVHCSGLL
3HFGSDMHMFSNQPTDLHMHL@WH-L
35
50
70
95
150
185
240
50
25
9/13
95
25
9/13
120
25
9/13
150
32
20/26
240
32
20/26
240
32
20/26
2 x 185
50
20/26
2 x 150
2 x 30 x 5
2 x 300
50
20/26
0.75
0.45
0.3
0.75
0.45
0.3
0.75
0.45
0.3
1.3
0.85
0.6
1.3
0.85
0.6
1.3
0.85
0.6
1.3
0.85
0.6
1.3
0.85
0.6
166/332
166/332
166/332
166/332
166/332
166/332
166/332
166/332
184/92
206/114
184/92
206/114
184/92
206/114
276/115
298/137
276/115
298/137
276/115
298/137
276/150
298/172
276/150
298/172
5.7
6.9
6.3
7.5
6.8
8.0
5.7
6.9
6.3
7.5
6.8
8.0
5.7
6.9
6.3
7.5
6.8
8.0
6.6
7.4
7.2
8.0
7.7
8.5
6.7
7.8
7.3
8.4
7.8
8.9
6.7
7.8
7.3
8.4
7.8
8.9
11.4
13.3
12.0
13.9
12.5
14.4
11.9
14.0
12.5
14.6
13.0
15.1
Power supply
LHML@W5 "
Mechanical characteristics
#TQ@AHKHSXMTLADQNENODQ@SHMFBXBKDR
6DHFGS 3X2/JF
6DHFGS 3X2/JF
6DHFGS 3X2C/JF
6DHFGS 3X2C/JF
6DHFGS 3X2SFO/JF
6DHFGS 3X2SFO/JF
(4) Value for coordination with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s.
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
For coordination with specific circuit-breaker references, higher short-circuit current values are
(2) 3-pole device with 2 poles in series for the "+" and 1 pole for the "-".4-pole device with 2 poles
available. Please consult us.
in series by polarity.
(5) At 30ms
(3) At 415 VAC
398
ATyS range
ATyS, ATyS d, ATyS t, ATyS g, ATyS p
from 125 to 3200 A
800 to 3200 A
Thermal current Ith at 40C
1@SDCHMRTK@SHNMUNKS@FD4i5
1@SDCHLOTKRDVHSGRS@MCUNKS@FD4impJ5
800 A
1000
12
1000 A
1000
12
1250 A
1000
12
1600 A
1000
12
1800 A
1000
12
A/B(1)
800/800
800/800
800/800
800/800
800/800
800/800
630/630
400/400
800/800
800/800
630/630
400/400
800/800
800/800
800/800
800/800
800/800
800/800
800/800
800/800
A/B(1)
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
800/800
630/630
1000/1000
1000/1000
800/800
630/630
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
1000/1000
A/B(1)
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1000/1000
800/800
1250/1250
1250/1250
1000/1000
800/800
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
A/B(1)
1600/1600
1600/1600
1600/1600
1250/1250
1600/1600
1600/1600
1000/1000
800/800
1600/1600
1600/1600
1600/1600
1000/1000
1600/1600
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1600/1600
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1000
1000
800
1250
1250
800
1600
1600
1000
1800
1600
1000
100
1000
100
1250
100
2x800
100
2x800
2000 A
1000
12
2500 A
1000
12
3200 A
1000
12
Utilisation category
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
" "!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
#" #"!
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
A/B(1)
1800/1800 2000/2000 2500/2500 3200/3200
1800/1800
-/2000
-/2500
-/3200
1600/1600
-/2000
-/2500
-/3200
1250/1250
-/1600
-/1600
-/1600
1800/1800 2000/2000 2500/2500 3200/3200
1600/1600
-/2000
-/2500
-/3200
1000/1000
800/800
1800/1800 2000/2000 2500/2500 3200/3200
1600/1600
-/2000
-/2500
-/3200
1600/1600
1000/1000
1800/1800
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
1800/1800
1250/1250
1250/1250
1250/1250
Utilisation category
"!
"!
"!
800
800
800
2000
2000
1250
2500
2000
1250
3200
2000
1250
50
800
Circuit breaker protected short-circuit withstand with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s(3)
1@SDCRGNQSSHLDVHSGRS@MCBTQQDMS
R(BVJ QLR
47
64
64
78
78
78
78
78
26
48
35
73.5
35
73.5
50
110
50
110
50
110
50
110
50
110
16
20
25
32
32
40
50
50
2 x 185
2 x 40 x 5
2 x 300
63
20/26
2 x 240
2 x 50 x 5
4 x 185
63
20/26
2 x 60 x 5
4 x 185
63
20/26
2 x 80 x 5
6 x 185
100
40/45
2.6
1.6
1.5
2.6
1.6
1.5
2.6
1.6
1.5
2.6
1.6
1.6
2.6
1.6
1.6
2
1
1
2
1
1
2
1
1
166/332
166/332
166/332
166/332
166/332
166/332
166/332
166/332
460/184
482/206
460/184
482/206
460/184
482/206
460/230
482/252
460/230
482/252
812/322
834/344
812/322
834/344
812/322
834/344
27.9
32.2
28.5
32.8
29.0
33.3
28.4
32.9
29.0
33.5
29.5
34.0
28.9
33.6
29.5
34.2
30.0
34.7
33.1
39.4
33.7
40.0
34.2
40.5
33.1
39.4
33.7
40.0
34.2
40.5
50.7
61.6
51.3
62.2
51.8
62.7
50.7
61.6
51.3
62.2
51.8
62.7
61.0
75.3
61.6
75.9
62.1
76.4
Connection
,@WHLTL"TB@AKDBQNRRRDBSHNMLL
,HMHLTL"TATRA@QBQNRRRDBSHNMLL
,@WHLTL"TB@AKDBQNRRRDBSHNMLL
,@WHLTL"TATRA@QVHCSGLL
3HFGSDMHMFSNQPTDLHMHL@WH-L
Power supply
LHML@W5 "
Mechanical characteristics
#TQ@AHKHSXMTLADQNENODQ@SHMFBXBKDR
6DHFGS 3X2/JF
6DHFGS 3X2/JF
6DHFGS 3X2C/JF
6DHFGS 3X2C/JF
6DHFGS 3X2SFO/JF
6DHFGS 3X2SFO/JF
(1) Category with index A = frequent operation - Category with index B = infrequent operation.
(2) 3-pole device with 2 poles in series for the "+" and 1 pole for the "-". 4-pole device with
ONKDRHMRDQHDRAXONK@QHSX
(3) Value for coordination with any circuit breaker that ensures tripping in less than 0.3s.
For coordination with specific circuit-breaker references, higher short-circuit current values
are available. Please consult us.
399
ATyS range
ATyS, ATyS d, ATyS t, ATyS g, ATyS p
from 125 to 3200 A
301 3022
atys_825_a_1_x_cat
6
312 313 314 315 316 317
7 8 9
63A 64A 24 14 04 13
1 : position 0 control
2 : position 1 control
3 : position II control
4 : priority control position 0
5 : closure of this contact enables the position control orders
6 : product availability relay
7 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in position II
8 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in position I
9 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in position 0
5 4 3 2 1
ATyS d
1 preferred source
2 alternate source
201 2022
1022 101
1 : position 0 control
2 : position 1 control
3 : position II control
4 : priority control position 0
5 : closure of this contact enables the position control orders
6 : product availability relay
7 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in position II
8 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in position I
9 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in position 0
10 : Remote display D10
6
312 313 314 315 316 317
atys_826_a_1_x_cat
RJ
10
7 8 9
63A 64A 24 14 04 13
5 4 3 2 1
ATyS t
2
F2
F1
L1
L2
L3
L1
L3
L2
RJ
10
6
312 313 314 315 316 317
5 4 3 2 1
400
102 101
201 202
11
15
14
13
12
7 8 9
63A 64A 24 14 04 13
1 preferred source
2 alternate source
1 : position 0 control
2 : position 1 control
3 : position II control
4 : priority control position 0
5 : closure of this contact enables the
position control orders
6 : motorisation unit availability relay
7 : auxiliary contact, closed when the
switch is in position II
8 : auxiliary contact, closed when the
switch is in position I
9 : auxiliary contact, closed when the
switch is in position 0
10 : remote display D10
11 : electronic unit availability relay
12 : automatic operation inhibited
13 : manual retransfer confirmation
14 : preferred source selection
15 : operation with or without priority
ATyS range
ATyS, ATyS d, ATyS t, ATyS g, ATyS p
from 125 to 3200 A
ATyS g
2
F2
F1
L1
L3
L2
L1
L3
L2
19
11
20
102 101
201 202
16
17
15
14
13
12
RJ
atys_828_c_1_x_cat
10
6
312 313 314 315 316 317
7 8 9
63A 64A 24 14 04 13
5 4 3 2 1
1 preferred source
2 alternate source
1 : position 0 control
2 : position 1 control
3 : position II control
4 : priority control position 0
5 : closure of this contact enables the
position control orders
6 : motorisation unit availability relay
7 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch
is in position II
8 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch
is in position I
9 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch
is in position 0
10 : remote display D10
11 : electronic unit availability relay
12 : automatic operation inhibited
13 : manual retransfer confirmation
14 : 2AT time delay bypass
15 : priority for on load test
16 : remote test off load
17 : remote test on load
19 : generator starting and stopping order
-"
20 : generator starting and stopping order
-.
ATyS p
2
F2
F1
L1
L3
L2
22
19
11
20
6
312 313 314 315 316 317
15
14
13
12
10
21
RJ
atys_829_b_1_x_cat
72 71 74
L1
L2
L3
18
102 101
201 202
16
17
7 8 9
63A 64A 24 14 04 13
1 preferred source
2 alternate source
1 : position 0 control
2 : position 1 control
3 : position II control
4 : priority control position 0
5 : closure of this contact enables the position
control orders
6 : motorisation unit availability relay
7 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in
position II
8 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in
position I
9 : auxiliary contact, closed when the switch is in
position 0
10 : remote control interface D20
11 : electronic unit availability relay
12-17 : programmable inputs
18 : auxiliary power supply for the use of optional
modules
FDMDQ@SNQRS@QSHMF@MCRSNOOHMFNQCDQ-"
FDMDQ@SNQRS@QSHMF@MCRSNOOHMFNQCDQ-.
21 : 4 slots for optional modules
22 : current transformer connection
5 4 3 2 1
401
ATyS range
ATyS, ATyS d, ATyS t, ATyS g, ATyS p
from 125 to 3200 A
Dimensions
ATyS 125 to 630 A
J
M
J1
119
223
101
Fix. 180
140
CA
120
Fix. 195
AA
BA
AC
270
CA
10.5
48
Y
3
atys_837_a_1_x_cat
10
11
88
Z1
3
Z2
H
7
CA
Fix. 180
Fix. 195
C
1
Overall dimensions
Rating (A)
A 3p.
304
304
304
345
345
345
394
394
125
160
200
250
315
400
500
630
A 4p.
334
334
334
395
395
395
454
454
C
244
244
244
244
244
244
320.5
320.5
Terminal
shrouds
AC
F 3p. F 4p.
233
286.5 317
233
286.5 317
233
286.5 317
288
328 378
288
328 378
288
328 378
402
377 437
402
377 437
Body
H J 3p. J 4p.
151 154
184
151 154
184
151 154
184
152 195
245
152 195
245
152 195
245
221 244
304
221 244
304
J1
34
34
34
35
35
35
34
34
Switch
mounting
M 3p. M 4p.
120 150
120 150
120 150
160 210
160 210
160 210
210 270
210 270
Connection
T
36
36
36
50
50
50
65
65
U
20
20
20
25
25
35
45
45
V
25
25
25
30
30
35
50
50
W X 3p. X 4p.
9
28
22
9
28
22
9
28
22
11 33
33
11 33
33
11 33
33
13 42.5 37.5
13 42.5 37.5
Y
3.5
3.5
3.5
3.5
3.5
3.5
5
5
Z1
38
38
38
39.5
39.5
39.5
53
53
Z1
134
134
134
133.5
133.5
133.5
190
190
AA
135
135
135
160
160
170
260
260
BA
115
115
115
130
130
140
220
220
51.5
atys_838_a_1_x_cat
12.5
166
2
3
12.5
800
1000
1250
1600
1800
Terminal
shrouds
AC
461
461
461
531
531
94
253.5
293
391.5
Body
F 3p.
504
504
504
596
596
48
3
Z1
Rating (A)
402
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
F 4p.
584
584
584
716
716
280
166
200
250
AA
AC
169
250
J 3p.
306.5
306.5
306.5
398.5
398.5
Switch mounting
J 4p.
386.5
386.5
386.5
518.5
518.5
M 3p.
255
255
255
347
347
M 4p.
335
335
335
467
467
Connection
T
80
80
80
120
120
U
50
50
60
90
90
V
60.5
60.5
65
44
44
X
47.5
47.5
47.5
53
53
Y
7
7
7
8
8
Z1
66.5
66.5
66.5
67.5
67.5
AA
321
321
330
288
288
CA
10
10
10
15
15
15
20
20
ATyS range
ATyS, ATyS d, ATyS t, ATyS g, ATyS p
from 125 to 3200 A
A
M
51.5
90
569
0
330
380
250
461
258
125
90
atys_839_a_1_x_cat
50
4 6,5
120
120
425
53.5
50
120
31
Overall dimensions
Rating (A)
2000 3200
Switch mounting
A 3p.
A 4p.
M 3p.
M 4p.
596
716
347
467
Cut of dimensions
ATyS 125 to 630 A
ATyS
ATyS
ATyS d, t, g, p
138
138
20
20
138
20
138
214
50.5
atys_843_a_1_x_cat
50.5
150
atys_842_a_1_x_cat
165
50.5
atys_841_a_1_x_cat
50.5
101
atys_840_a_1_x_cat
20
Connection terminals
ATyS 1250 A
16 x 11
33
50
8.5
15.75
28.5
60
15.75
12.5
5
15
12.5
svr_078_b_1_x_cat
8.5
15 28.5
15
svr_077_a_1_x_cat
10 33
25 25
30
30
45
45
90
svr_098_a_1_x_cat
403
ATyS C30/C40
Control relays
ATYS_448_B
Changeover
switches
Strong points
ATyS C30 controller
ATYS_599_C
Function
ATyS C30/C40 are modular control relays. ATyS C30/C40 allows any type of motorised
changeover control: ATyS and ATyS M, contactors, circuit breakers or other motorised
switches.
General characteristics
ATyS C30
q ATyS D10 or D20 connection available.
q Inputs for auxiliary contact position
information.
q 3U measurement on network 1 and 1U on
network 2.
q 2 programmable inputs for the following
functions: test on/off load, manual
retransfer, priority source selection,
automatic inhibit
q Up to 2 programmable outputs for the
following functions: source availability
information, load shedding relay and circuit
breaker control.
q 1 relay output for generator control.
ATyS C40
q Dual genset controller with a redundant
genset application cycle (basic cycle).
q 1U measurement on each source generator 1 & generator 2.
q 3 programmable inputs for the following
functions: start/stop transfer cycle, manual
retransfer, automatic inhibit
q 1 programmable output for the following
ETMBSHNMRRNTQBD@U@HK@AHKHSXHMENQL@SHNM
and circuit breaker control.
q 2 generator control contacts
(Gen1 & Gen2).
Advantages
Auxiliary power supply
Two versions of the ATyS C30 are available.
One version with an AC supply via the
measurement inputs and another with a DC
auxiliary supply.
Modular device
The ATyS C30 and C40 are modular products
(6 modules, 105 mm wide) which can be DIN rail
mounted.
404
Conformity to standards
> IEC 61010-1
> IEC 61000-4-x
> IEC 60068-2-x
ATyS C30/C40
Control relays
Configurations
ATyS C30:
Transformer/transformer and transformer/generator applications
ATyS C40:
Generator/generator applications
4
ATyS C30
ATyS C40
ATyS
D10/D20
G1
G2
2
atys_566_c_1_x_cat
atys_149_g_1_x_cat
ATyS S
ATyS Sd
ATyS
ATyS d
ATyS M3s
ATyS S
ATyS Sd
ATyS
ATyS d
ATyS M3s
Electrical characteristics
Supplied from measurement circuit
DC power supply
9 30 VDC
v5 "
Measurement range
Frequency
50/60 Hz
Accuracy
Terminals
6 7 8 9 10
ATyS C30
6 7 8 9 10
ATyS C40
13
13
11
13 14 23 24 33 34 43 44 53
atys_567_b_1_x_cat
atys_418_c_1_x_cat
13 14 23 24 33 34 43 44 53
12
11
12
L3
L2
L1
L1
L3
L3
L1
L1
L3
103
104
105
106
203
205
104
106
203
205
References
ATyS C30
ATyS C40
Type
Reference
Reference
1599 3030
1599 3031
1599 3040
DC power supply
405
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
The benefits of the Energy Efficiency policy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
p. 408
p. 410
p. 411
p. 412
p. 414
p. 416
p. 418
Monitoring software
n ew
new
new
E0x
E1x
E2x
32 A
p. 420
63 A
p. 422
63 A
p. 424
E3x
E4x
E5x
100 A
p. 426
6000 A
p. 428
6000 A
p. 430
Power
Monitoring
Software
(PMS)
VERTELIS
VISION
p. 482
Communication
interfaces
E63
ECi2 / ECi3
100 A
p. 432
p. 434
p. 486
Measurement devices
new
A10
A17
A20
LV
p. 436
LV/HV
p. 440
LV
p. 444
A40 / A41
A60
A80
LV/HV
p. 448
LV/HV
p. 454
LV/HV
p. 460
Current
transformers
5 to 6000 A
p. 488
Measurement
shunt
p. 502
Other solutions
1 to 6000 A
p. 504
p. 464
Other
measurements
devices
p. 506
N300 / N600
LV/HV
p. 474
RETROFIT
Line
CORPO 213A
p. 468
407
Me a s ure
se
se
ly
O pti mi
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
An
VERTE 108 A
VERTE 031 A
> Industry
Up to
q
q
q
q
408
10 % energy savings
Up to
q
q
q
q
q
30 % energy savings
SITE 631 A
> Infrastructures
SYDIV 111 A
VERTE 033 A
Up to
q
q
q
q
q
q
30 % energy savings
Up to
20 % energy savings
409
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
Adapted services
DESIGN
QUICK
COMPACT
CONFIGURATION
ROBUST
Guaranteed connections:
protection against
OG@RDMDTSQ@KHMUDQRHNM
and wiring errors detection,
commissioning is faster and
the equipment is guaranteed to
operate correctly.
Intuitive ergonomics:
Socomec products are
designed to reduce the
configuration time.
RELIABLE
Specifiers
The assurance of an adapted solution that conforms to the most
stringent standards.
ADAPTED
SOLUTION
Solutions adapted to
your requirements: our
comprehensive offer helps you
find the perfect product with
the needed functions.
In addition:
- We help you to define the
right system perfectly suited
to your customer needs.
- As a specialist manufacturer
we are able to adapt our
devices to your specific
needs.
410
IEC
COMPLIANT
DIRIS N
COUNTIS
E00
DIRIS
A40
DIRIS
A10
CO
CO
UN
TIS
UN
Gateway
TCP/IP
TIS
RS485
COUNTIS
E50
E 50
E Ci3
Gateway
TCP/IP
COUNTIS
E40
DIRIS
A20
COUNTIS
E30
COUNTIS
ECi
COUNTIS
E00
PLC
RS485
mesur_112_c_fr_cat
/
S
M
B TM
C
VERTELIS software
Selection guide
A specific solution to implement each step
in your Energy Efficiency policy.
VER
TELI
S
Porta
l
)6
VERTELIS
VISION
01/03/
10
02/03/
10
03/03/
10
Power quality
analysis
Power
monitoring
Energy
metering
DIR
IS
DIRIS N
D60
0
+
DIR
IS
A20
I
TEST
F
P
OK
PF
PROG
DIRIS A
& RETROFIT Line
COUNTIS E
& RETROFIT Line
DIRIS 887 C
Supervision
411
Selection guide
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
Single-phase
Direct
up to 32 A
Which load
current?
Single-phase
Direct
up to 80 A
Single-phase
Direct
up to 63 A
Three-phase
Direct
up to 63 A
E00 / E02
p. 420
E03 / E04
p. 420
E13 / E14
p. 422
E15 / E16
p. 422
(
(
(
(
(
E20 / E21
p. 424
E23 / E24
p. 424
Main specifications
0,'(1bPRGXOH%'FHUWLILFDWLRQ
5602'%86
(
560%86
&DVH
PRGXOH
PRGXOH
PRGXOHV
PRGXOHV
PRGXOHV
PRGXOHV
PRGXOHV
,QSXWYROWDJH
9$&
9$&
9$&
9$&
9$&
9$&
9$&
((
((
(
Functions
7RWDOSDUWLDOHQHUJ\N:K
$FWLYHSRZHU5HDFWLYHSRZHU
'XDOWDULIIIRUN:K
7RWDOSDUWLDOHQHUJ\NYDUK
N9$
/RDGFXUYH
0HDVXUHPHQW,9346)DQG3)YLD
FRPPXQLFDWLRQ
&7FRQQHFWLRQLQGLFDWLRQ
%LUHFWLRQDOHQHUJ\FRQVXPSWLRQDQGSURGXFWLRQ
Accuracy
$FWLYHHQHUJ\,(&
FODVV
FODVV
FODVV
FODVV
FODVV
FODVV%(
FODVV%(
FODVV%(
FODVV%(
FODVV%(
FODVV
FODVV
5HDFWLYHHQHUJ\DFFRUGLQJWR,(&
$FWLYHHQHUJ\(1b
FODVV%(
Characteristics
0HWURORJLFDO/('
3XOVHRXWSXW
:K
:K
:K
:K
:K
:K
:K
6HDOLQJFRYHU0,'YHUVLRQRQO\
(
(
(
(
(
3KDVHQHXWUDOLQYHUVLRQSURWHFWLRQ
Pulse concentrator
Case
Logical inputs
COUNTIS ECi2
p. 434
COUNTIS ECi3
p. 434
4 modules
4 modules
Analogue inputs
412
(
212))RXWSXWDODUP
3DUWLDOWRWDOGDLO\ZHHNO\RUPRQWKO\N:KRURWKHUW\SHVRIGDWDOLWHUVP
/RDGFXUYHIURPWRPLQXWHV
5602'%86
Selection guide
Active energy meters
Which
accuracy?
MID
FHUWLFDWLRQ"
Three-phase
Direct
up to 63 A
Three-phase
Direct
up to 63 A
3 x Single-phase
Direct
up to 100 A
E25 / E26
p. 424
E33 / E34
p. 426
E35 / E36
p. 426
(
(
(
(
PRGXOHV
Communication
or pulse output?
E63
p. 432
Three-phase
CT/5 A
E43 / E44
p. 428
E45 / E46
p. 428
(
(
(
PRGXOHV
PRGXOHV
9$&
9$&
9$&
9$&
(
YLD&20(
YLD&20
((
E50
p. 430
E53
p. 430
PRGXOHV
Three-phase
CT/5 A
PRGXOHV
PRGXOHV
PRGXOHV
PRGXOHV
[
[
9$&
9'&
9$&
9'&
9$&
9$&
9$&
9$&
YLD&20(
YLD&20(
YLD&20(
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
XSWRYLD&20
XSWRYLD&20
XSWRYLD&20
XSWRYLD&20
XSWRYLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
YLD&20
(
(
(
(
FODVV
FODVV
FODVV
FODVV%(
FODVV
FODVV%(
FODVV%(
FODVV%(
:K
:K
(
(
(
(
FODVV
FODVV
FODVV
FODVV
FODVV
FODVV
FODVV
FODVV
FODVV
FODVV
FODVV
FODVV&(
FODVV&(
FODVV&(
:K
FRQILJXUDEOH
(
(
(
CO
UN
TIS
m3
kWh
485
E 63
COUNTIS E
CO
UN
TIS
E Ci3
PC
232
COUNTIS ECi
VERTELIS
Software
count_222_a_1_gb.cat
413
Selection guide
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
Multifunction meters
DIRIS
Which
application?
Which
functions?
Multifunction metering
(MFM)
Applications
n ew
DIRIS A10
p. 436
DIRIS A17
p. 440
DIRIS A20
p. 444
Multi-measurement
Currents, voltages (ph / ph and ph / n), active / reactive / apparent powers, power factor, frequency
4th CT for neutral current measurement
Voltage/current unbalance
Currents, voltages, frequency (average values)
Max. power demand
Temperatures
Internal
Tangent phi
Hour meter
Metering
kWh (+ /-), kvarh (+ /-), kVAh
1 as standard
1 as standard
1 as standard
Power management
Load curves (period 5, 8, 10, 15, 20 and 30 minutes)
Predictive power
Power quality
THD voltages, currents and neutral currents
Row 51
Row 51
Individual harmonics
Interharmonics
Vector diagram
Flicker
EN 50160
Sag, swell and outages, overcurrent
RMS 1/2 period curve backup
Plug-in modules
As standard:
As standard:
1 logical input for pulse
1 input for tariff selection/
metering or remote device
1 programmable output for
remote device status
status
pulse report, alarm report
1 programmable output for
1 programmable output for
or remote device command
pulse report, alarm report
pulse report, alarm report RS485 JBUS/MODBUS
or remote device command
or remote device command communication
RS485 JBUS/MODBUS (for
RS485 MODBUS
1 reference)
(for 2 references)
414
Selection guide
Multifunction meters
Which
communication
protocol?
Which
dimensions?
Power monitoring
(PMD)
Which
options?
DIRIS N
p. 474
DIRIS A40
p. 448
DIRIS A41
p. 448
DIRIS A60
p. 454
DIRIS A80
p. 460
by temperature sensor
by temperature sensor
by temperature sensor
optional
optional
optional
optional
Row 63
Row 63
Row 63
Row 63
Row 51
Row 63
Row 63
Row 63
Row 63
Row 51
2 pulse outputs
RS485 MODBUS communication
PROFIBUS DP communication
Ethernet communication (available with RS485 MODBUS gateway).
2 analogue outputs
2 inputs / 2 outputs
Memory
Temperature inputs
415
Selection Guide
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
Current transformers
Type
TRB 60
Range
Class
TRB 70
TRB 135
TCA
14
0.5
Primary wound
0.5
0.5
0.2S version
TCA
21
TCA
22
TCB
17-20
TCB
26-30
0.5/1
Cable-through
TCB
26-40
TCB
32-40
TCB
44-50
0.5/1
0.5/1
Bar or cable-through
0.5/1
(1)
0.5/1
T2CB
26-30
(2)
p. 489
TCB
28-30
p. 491
T2CB
32-40
p. 492 - 493
Rating (A)
0.5
5
10
15
5
to
20
20
5
to
40
25
30
40
50
25
to
150
60
75
80
*
25
to
150
40
to
150
100
60
to
300
125
150
60
to
400
160
100
to
600
200
250
300
400
*
150
to
600
50
to
750
*
150
to
750
80
to
500
100
to
750
500
75
to
1000
*
200
to
750
600
150
to
1250
750
800
1000
1200
1250
1500
1600
2000
2500
3000
4000
5000
Dimensions
Height
75.5
85.5
85
65
65
65
65
61
70
75.5
88.5
98.5
Width
61
71
135
45
45
49.5
49.5
75.5
49.9
61
71
86
Depth
35
45
60
30
30
35
50
48
68
48
58
58
14
21
22.5
17.5
26
28
26
32
44
30x10
30x10
32x18
40x10
50x12
Cable ( mm)
Bar 1
Bar 2
Bar 3
* Class 1.
/KD@RDRDD31!ENQ@OQHL@QXVNTMC
2UDQRHNM
#HLDMRHNMR@QDCHEEDQDMSEQNL31!
/KD@RDRDD3" ENQ@B@AKDSGQNTFG
2UDQRHNM
#HLDMRHNMR@QDCHEEDQDMSEQNL3"
416
20x5
20x10 (x2)
40x12
Selection Guide
Current transformers
TCB
44-63
TCB
55-80
TCD
85-100
TCB
100-125
TBA 60
TBA
80
0.5
0.5/1
0.5
Bar or cable-through
0.5
0.5
0.5
TBA 100
TBA 103
TBA 127
TO 23
TO 58
0.5
0.5
0.5
1/3
0.5/1
T2BA
100
T2BA
103
T2BA
127
Bar-through
T2CB
44-63
p. 493
TO 812
TO 816
Split-core
p. 496
0.5/1
0.5
p. 500
100
to
400
200
*
to 300
1600 to
1500
200
to
1600
400
to
2000
750
to
3000
250
to
1000
300
to
2000
1000
to
3000
400
to
*
2000 1000 400
to
600
to
4000 1200
to
1500
*
to
4000 1200
2000
to
3000
250
to
1500
1000
to
5000
105.5
123.5
184.8
184.8
129
117
167
150
175
106
158
198
243
96
120
172
172
88
96
129
99
100
93
125
155
195
58
58
52
52
48
68
78
58
55
58
58
58
79
44
55
85
100
63x10
80x10
100x10
123x30
60x30
84x34
100x55
103x41
128x38
33x23
85x55
125x85
165x85
50x10 (x2)
60x30
60x10 (x2)
417
Selection guide
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
Multifunction meters
Which
characteristics?
Which function?
Analogue devices
AC and DC measurements
p. 506
Characteristics
Type
Mounting
Dimensions
AC measurement
Direct from 1 to 100 A
Via a CT (1A or 5A)
Scale: In; 1.2 In; 5 In
Voltage measurement
Frequency measurement
Needle or reed-type
Voltage from 40 to 600 V
Direct from 50 wA to 50 A
Other measurements
Synchronisation devices
Phase meters
Temperature measurement
Threshold indicators
Current measurement
DC measurement
Current measurement
Voltage measurement
Customised solutions
Scale and calibration
Sectors and coloured marking
IP54 - IP65 - Tropicalisation
Customising
Anti vibrations
418
Selection guide
Multifunction meters
Which AC
measurement?
Which DC
measurement?
For which
purpose?
Digital devices
Transducers
Digital meters
p. 506
Transducers
p. 506
CS - CM -- CR
DG - DGM - DG2M
3 Digits to 4 Digits 1/2
Direct from 1 to 5 A
Via a CT (1A or 5A)
Direct from 1 to 5 A
Via a CT (1A or 5A)
Self-supplied or auxiliary power supply
0 cap - 1 - 0 ind
Temperature measurement
Threshold indicators
Other electrical values
Navy applications
Railway applications
Multi display
419
new
Camping sites.
Marinas.
Shopping centres.
Data centres.
count_244_a_1_cat
>
>
>
>
count_215_a_1
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
COUNTIS E0x
Strong points
>
>
>
>
COUNTIS E04
Principle diagram
Function
MID certification
420
count_211_a_1_x_cat
Advantages
Compact
The COUNTIS E0x is only 1 module wide.
Pulse output
The pulse output enables the kWh
consumption to be reported to a remote
system (PC/BMS) so that it can be analysed
for billing, energy saving or energy cost
management purposes.
MID certified B+D module
COUNTIS E products with MID certification
provide the guaranteed accuracy required for
applications in which sub-billing of the electrical
energy consumed is necessary. Module
B+D certification guarantees that the design
and manufacturing process of products are
approved by an accredited laboratory.
COUNTIS E0x
q Compact design.
q ,D@RTQDLDMS@BBTQ@BX
q LCD display.
Key functions
E00
Pulse output
E02
E03
E04
COUNTIS E0x
Common characteristics
Models
Compact.
Pulse output.
MID certified B+D module.
RS485 communication
(MODBUS)
> COUNTIS E
comply with the
MID directive,
guaranteeing
accuracy and reliability when
metering, an indispensable
function for energy billing
applications.
> COUNTIS E MID feature
tamper-proof components to
prevent fraud.
Conformity to standards
> IEC 62053-21
class 1
> IEC 62053-31
> IEC 62052-11
> EN 50470-1
> EN 50470-3
COUNTIS E0x
Active energy meters
single-phase - direct 32 A
Front panel
1. Terminal shrouds (COUNTIS E02 + E04).
2. MID Marking (COUNTIS E02 + E04).
3. Metrological LED (2000 pulses/kWh for E00/E02 and
OTKRDRJ6GENQ$$
4. kWh display.
5. Serial number (COUNTIS E02).
count_215x_a_2_cat
Electrical characteristics
Current measurement (TRMS)
Type
Input consumption
Permanent overload
Intermittent overload
Minimum current measured
Voltage measurements (TRMS)
Range of measurement
Input consumption
Permanent overload
Energy accuracy
Active (according to IEC 62053-21)
Active (according to EN 50470)
Power supply
Self-supplied
Output (pulsed)
Number
Type of optocoupler
Fixed pulse weight
Pulse duration
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
Storage temperature
Relative humidity
Communication
Link
Type
Protocol
MODBUS speed
single-phase - direct 32 A
< 2 VA
32 A
30 Imax for 10 ms
20 mA
196 264 VAC
8 VA
264 VAC
Class 1
Class B
yes
COUNTIS E00/E02
1
15 VDC max
100 Wh
100 ms
- 10 + 55 C
- 20 + 70 C
COUNTIS E03/E04
RS485
2 3 half duplex wires
MODBUS RTU
1200 38400 bauds
Case
61/63
47/49
Type
Number of modules
Dimensions W x H x D
Case degree of protection
Front degree of protection
Display type
Rigid cable cross-section
Flexible cable cross-section
Weight
45
85/87
count_212_b_x_cat
17.5 / 19
Connection
N
L
N
L
L
N
N N'
L L'
COUNTIS E00/E02
kWh
N - L: network input.
N' - L': network output.
1 - 3 : output (pulsed).
count_239_a_1_x_cat
count_213_b_1_x_cat
L
N
N N'
L L'
RS485 NC
COUNTIS E03/E04
References
Type
Direct 32 A
Direct 32 A - MID
Direct 32 A - with MODBUS communication via RS485
Direct 32 A - with MODBUS communication via RS485 - MID
COUNTIS E00
Reference
COUNTIS E02
Reference
COUNTIS E03
Reference
COUNTIS E04
Reference
4850 3019
4850 3020
4850 3029
4850 3030
421
new
> Marinas.
> Shopping centres.
> Data centres.
count_246_a_1_cat
count_216_a_1_cat
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
COUNTIS E1x
Strong points
COUNTIS E13
Function
Principle diagram
count_223_a_1_x_cat
MID certification
Common characteristics
q ,D@RTQDLDMS@BBTQ@BX
q Backlit LCD display (only E10/E11/E12).
COUNTIS E1x
COUNTIS E1x
Conformity to standards
Advantages
RS485 communication (MODBUS
or M-BUS) or pulse output
To enable the remote reporting of energy
consumption, COUNTIS E1x are provided
with either a pulse output or an RS485
communication output, with MODBUS or
M-BUS protocol. In addition to their reporting
functions, COUNTIS E1x with RS485 can be
configured remotely and enable access to
multi-measurement values.
Dual-tariff metering
Two tariffs are available and can be easily
accessed through the meters display. Each
tariff can be utilised to assign energy metering
to different time slots (high and low demand
hours) or different sources (normal/backup).
Models
E10
E11
E12
E13
E14
E15
E16
422
> COUNTIS E
comply with the
MID directive,
guaranteeing
accuracy and reliability when
metering, an indispensable
function for energy billing
applications.
> COUNTIS E MID feature
tamper-proof components to
prevent fraud.
Key functions
Pulse output
Dual tariff (2 partial counters) + Pulse output
Dual tariff + MID (Reset impossible) + Pulse output
MODBUS RS485 communication
MODBUS RS485 communication + MID (Reset impossible)
M-BUS communication
M-BUS communication + MID (Reset impossible)
COUNTIS E1x
Active energy meters
single-phase - direct 63/80 A
Front panel
1. Terminal shrouds (COUNTIS E12).
2. Backlit LCD display.
3. MID Marking (COUNTIS E12).
4. Serial number (COUNTIS E12).
5. Navigation key.
6. Metrological LED (1000 pulses/kWh).
2
count_216x_a_2_cat
5
6
Electrical characteristics
Current measurement
Type
Input consumption
Startup current (Ist)
Minimum current (Imin)
Transition current (Itr)
Reference current (Iref)
Permanent overload (Imax)
Intermittent overload
Voltage measurement
Range of measurement
Consumption (VA)
Permanent overload
Energy accuracy
Active (according to IEC 62053-21)
Power supply
Self-supplied
Frequency
COUNTIS E10E12
single-phase
direct 63 A
0.8 VA max.
40 mA
0.5 A(1)
1 A(2)
10 A(3)
63 A
1890 A max for 10 ms
COUNTIS E13E16
single-phase
direct 80 A
0.8 VA max.
20 mA
0.25 A
0.5 A
5A
80 A
2400 A max for 10 ms
5
0.5 VA max.
280 V phase-neutral
5
0.5 VA max.
300 V phase-neutral
Class 1
Class 1
Output (pulsed)
Type of optocoupler
Number
Fixed pulse weight
Pulse duration
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
Storage temperature
Relative humidity
Communication
Link
Type
Protocol
MODBUS speed
M-BUS speed
yes
50/60 Hz
COUNTIS E10/E11/E12
IEC 62053-31 Class A (20 ... 30 VDC)
1
100 Wh
100 ms
COUNTIS E10E12 COUNTIS E13E16
-10 to 55 C
-25 to 55 C
-20 to 70 C
-25 to 70 C
COUNTIS E13/E14/E15/E16
RS485
2 3 half duplex wires
MODBUS RTU
4800 38400 bauds
300 9600 bauds
Case
62.5 / 64
45
54
COUNTIS E10
45
Partial
90
count_190_b_1_x_cat
Error
COUNTIS E10E12
COUNTIS E13E16
Type
modular
modular
Number of modules
Dimensions W x H x D
54 x 90 x 62.5 mm
54 x 90 x 64 mm
IP 20
IP 20
IP 51
IP 51
Display type
LCD display
LCD display
1.5 to 16 mm2
1.5 to 50 mm2
1 to 16 mm2
1.5 to 50 mm2
Weight
170 g
170 g
RESET
230VAC 50/60Hz 0.5-10(63)A
C=1Wh/imp
63A
Connection
N
10
T1/2
COUNTIS E10/E11/E12
120 +
RS485
NC
L1
L1
T1/2*
COUNTIS E13/14
count_241_a_1_x_cat
count_240_a_1_x_cat
count_181_c_1_x_cat
L1
L1
T1/2
COUNTIS E15/16
-NS@U@HK@AKDNM".4-3(2$
References
Type
direct 63 A
direct 63 A - Dual tariff
direct 63 A - Dual tariff and MID
direct 80 A - with MODBUS communication via RS 485
direct 80 A - with MODBUS communication via RS 485 - MID
direct 80 A - wih M-BUS communication
direct 80 A - with M-BUS comminucation - MID
COUNTIS E10 COUNTIS E11 COUNTIS E12 COUNTIS E13 COUNTIS E14 COUNTIS E15 COUNTIS E16
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
4850 3000
4850 3001
4850 3002
4850 3031
4850 3032
4850 3033
4850 3034
423
new
count_248_a_1_cat
> Industry.
> Infrastructure.
> Data centres.
count_232_a
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
COUNTIS E2x
Strong points
COUNTIS E23
COUNTIS E20
Function
Principle diagram
Conformity to standards
> IEC 62053-21
class 1
> IEC 62053-31
> IEC 62052-11
> EN 50470-1
> EN 50470-3
Common characteristics
q ,D@RTQDLDMS@BBTQ@BX
q Backlit LCD display (only E20/E21)
q Detects connection errors
COUNTIS E2x
424
COUNTIS E2x
COUNTIS E2x
Key functions
Pulse output
Dual tariff (2 partial counters) + Pulse output
MODBUS RS485 communication
MODBUS RS485 communication + MID (Reset impossible)
M-BUS communication
M-BUS communication + MID (Reset impossible)
count_224_a_1_x_cat
Advantages
MID certification
> COUNTIS E
comply with the
MID directive,
guaranteeing
accuracy and reliability when
metering, an indispensable
function for energy billing
applications.
> COUNTIS E MID feature
tamper-proof components to
prevent fraud.
COUNTIS E2x
Active energy meters
three-phase - direct 63 A
Front panel
count_177x_b_1_cat
2
3
4
1
Electrical characteristics
Current measurement
Type
Input consumption
Startup current (Ist)
Minimum current (Imin)
Transition current (Itr)
Reference current (Iref)
Permanent overload (Imax)
Intermittent overload
Voltage measurement
Range of measurement
Consumption (VA)
Permanent overload
Energy accuracy
Active (according to IEC 62053-21)
Power supply
Self-supplied
Frequency
COUNTIS E20/E21
three-phase
direct 63 A
0.8 VA max. per
phase
40 mA
0.5 A(1)
1 A(2)
10 A(3)
63 A
1890 A max for 10 ms
COUNTIS E23E26
three-phase
direct 63 A
0.8 VA max. per
phase
15 mA
0.25 A
0.5 A
5A
63 A
1890 A max for 10 ms
5
2 VA max.
280 V phase-neutral /
480 V phase-phase
5
2 VA max.
276 V phase-neutral
Class 1
Output (pulsed)
Number
Type of optocoupler
Fixed pulse weight
Pulse duration
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
Storage temperature
Relative humidity
Communication
Link
Type
Protocol
COUNTIS E20/E21
1
IEC 62053-31 Class A (20 ... 30 VDC)
100 Wh
100 ms
COUNTIS E20/E21
COUNTIS E23E26
-10 to 55 C
-25 to 55 C
-20 to 70 C
-25 to 70 C
COUNTIS E23/E24/E25/E26
RS485
2 3 half duplex wires
MODBUS RTU
MODBUS speed
M-BUS speed
yes
50 Hz
Case
62.5 / 64
45
COUNTIS E20/E21
modular
4
72 x 90 x 62.5 mm
IP20
IP51
LCD display
1.5 to 16 mm2
1 to 16 mm2
245 g
Type
Number of modules
Dimensions W x H x D
Case degree of protection
Front degree of protection
Display type
Rigid cable cross-section
Flexible cable cross-section
Weight
COUNTIS E20
Partial
45
Error
90
count_191_b_1_x_cat
72
RESET
3X230(400)VAC 50/60Hz 0.5-10(63)A
C=1Wh / imp
63A
COUNTIS E23E26
modular
4
72 x 90 x 64 mm
IP20
IP51
LCD display
1.5 to 35mm2
1.5 to 35mm2
245 g
Connection
L1 L1 L2
COUNTIS E20
9 11
L2 L3 L3
N
L1
L2
L3
L1
L2
L3
120 N
1 2
+ NC
4 5 6 7
T1/2*
COUNTIS E23/E24
L1 L1 L2 L2 L3 L3
RS485
count_183_a_1_x_cat
L1
L2
L3
count_243_a_1_x_cat
count_242_a_1_x_cat
count_182_b_1_x_cat
N
L1
L2
L3
N
L1
L2
L3
L1
L2
L3
2
8 10
T1/2
COUNTIS E21
L1 L1 L2
9 11
L2 L3 L3
N
L1
L2
L3
L1
L2
L3
+
N
1 2
4 5 6 7
L1 L1 L2 L2 L3 L3
T1/2
COUNTIS E25/E26
-NS@U@HK@AKDNM".4-3(2$
References
Type
direct 63 A - three-phase
direct 63 A - three-phase - Dual tariff
direct 63 A - with MODBUS communication via RS485
direct 63 A - with MODBUS communication via RS485 - MID
direct 63 A - with M-BUS communication
direct 63 A - with M-BUS communication - MID
COUNTIS E20
Reference
COUNTIS E21
Reference
COUNTIS E23
Reference
COUNTIS E24
Reference
COUNTIS E25
Reference
COUNTIS E26
Reference
4850 3003
4850 3004
4850 3035
4850 3036
4850 3037
4850 3038
425
COUNTIS E3x
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
count_219_a
> Industry.
> Infrastructure.
> Data centres.
Strong points
Function
Principle diagram
MID certification
Common characteristics
q ,D@RTQDLDMS@BBTQ@BX
q Backlit LCD display.
q Detects connection errors.
COUNTIS E3x
COUNTIS E3x
Advantages
RS485 communication (MODBUS or M-BUS)
or pulse output
To enable the remote reporting of energy
consumption, COUNTIS E3x are provided
with either a pulse output or an RS485
communication output, with MODBUS or
M-BUS protocol.
In addition to their reporting functions,
COUNTIS E3x with RS485 can be configured
remotely and enable access to multimeasurement values.
Detection of connection errors
The product is protected against phase/
neutral inversion and detects wiring errors. This
simplifies the installation and commissioning,
thereby reducing associated costs, and
ensures that the device operates correctly.
426
Models
Key characteristics
E30
Pulse output
E31
E32
E33
E34
E35
M-BUS communication
E36
count_225_a_1_x_cat
COUNTIS E3x
> COUNTIS E
comply with the
MID directive,
guaranteeing
accuracy and reliability when
metering, an indispensable
function for energy billing
applications.
> COUNTIS E MID feature
tamper-proof components to
prevent fraud.
Conformity to standards
> IEC 62053-21
class 1
> IEC 62053-31
> IEC 62053-11
> EN 50470-1
> EN 50470-3
COUNTIS E3x
Active energy meters
three-phase - direct 100 A
Front panel
Electrical characteristics
count_179x_b_1_cat
5
6
7
1. Terminal shrouds
(COUNTIS E32, E34
and E36).
2. Backlit LCD display.
3. MID marking
".4-3(2$$
and E36).
4. Serial number
".4-3(2$$
and E36).
5. Navigation key.
6. Reset key.
7. Metrological LED.
Current measurement
Type
Input consumption
Startup current (Ist)
Minimum current (Imin)
Transition current (Itr)
Reference current (Iref)
Permanent overload (Imax)
Intermittent overload
Voltage measurement
Range of measurement
Consumption (VA)
Permanent overload
Energy accuracy
Active (according to IEC 62053-21)
Active (according to EN 50470)
Power supply
Self-supplied
Frequency
Output (pulsed)
Number
Type of optocoupler
Fixed pulse weight
Pulse duration
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
Storage temperature
Relative humidity
Communication
Link
Type
Protocol
MODBUS speed
M-BUS speed
Case
62.5
45
126
count_192_b_1_x_cat
COUNTIS E30
45
Partial
90
Error
RESET
3X230(400)VAC 50/60Hz 0.5-20(100)A
C=2Wh / imp
100A
Type
Number of modules
Dimensions W x H x D
Case degree of protection
Front degree of protection
Display type
Rigid cable cross-section
Flexible cable cross-section
Weight
modular
7
126 x 90 x 62.5 mm
IP20
IP51
backlit LCD display
2.5 to 35 mm2
2.5 to 35 mm2
490 g
L3
N
L1
L2
L3
1
1
1
+ 2
4 6
COUNTIS E30
1 3 5 7 9 11
L1
L1
L2
L2
L3
L3
L1
L2
L3
N
L1
L2
L3
1
1
1
+ 2
15 17 13
RS485
COUNTIS E33/E34/E35/E36
1 3 5 7 9 11
L1
L1
L2
L2
L3
L3
count_185_c_1_x_cat
count_184_c_1_x_cat
L1
L2
count_188_e_1_x_cat
Connection
N
L1
L2
L3
L1
L2
L3
1
1
+ 2
N
4 6 8 10
COUNTIS E31/E32
T1/2
1 3 5 7 9 11
L1
L1
L2
L2
L3
L3
References
Type
100 A direct
100 A direct - Dual tariff
100 A direct - Dual tariff - MID
100 A direct with RS485 MODBUS communication (1)
100 A direct with RS485 MODBUS communication - MID(1)
100 A direct with M-BUS communication (1)
100 A direct with M-BUS communication - MID(1)
Management software for COUNTIS
COUNTIS
E30
Reference
COUNTIS
E31
Reference
COUNTIS
E32
Reference
COUNTIS
E33
Reference
COUNTIS
E34
Reference
COUNTIS
E35
Reference
COUNTIS
E36
Reference
4850 3005
4850 3006
4850 3007
4850 3012
4850 3013
4850 3025
4850 3026
See page 464
S@QHEERSGQNTFG12BNLLTMHB@SHNM
427
COUNTIS E4x
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
Strong points
> RS485 communication
(MODBUS or M-BUS) or
pulse output.
> Detection of connection errors.
> MID certified B+D module.
> Bi-directional metering.
> Multi-measurement
and load curve.
Function
Principle diagram
MID certification
COUNTIS E4x
Common characteristics
q ,D@RTQDLDMS@BBTQ@BX
q !@BJKHS+"#CHROK@X
q Detects connection errors.
COUNTIS E4x
COUNTIS E4x
Advantages
RS485 communication (MODBUS or M-BUS)
or pulse output
To enable the remote reporting of energy
consumption, COUNTIS E4x are provided
with either a pulse output or an RS485
BNLLTMHB@SHNMNTSOTSVHSG,.#!42NQ
,!42OQNSNBNK
In addition to their reporting functions,
COUNTIS E4x with RS485 can be configured
remotely and enable access to multimeasurement values.
Detection of connection errors
The product is protected against phase/
neutral inversion and detects wiring errors. This
simplifies the installation and commissioning,
thereby reducing associated costs, and
ensures that the device operates correctly.
Models
428
Key functions
E40
Pulse output
E41
#T@KS@QHEEO@QSH@KBNTMSDQR
/TKRDNTSOTS
E42
#T@KS@QHEE
,(#1DRDSHLONRRHAKD
/TKRDNTSOTS
E43
12,.#!42BNLLTMHB@SHNM
E44
12,.#!42BNLLTMHB@SHNM
,(#1DRDSHLONRRHAKD
E45
,!42BNLLTMHB@SHNM
E46
,!42BNLLTMHB@SHNM
,(#1DRDSHLONRRHAKD
> COUNTIS E
comply with the
MID directive,
guaranteeing
accuracy and reliability when
metering, an indispensable
function for energy billing
applications.
> COUNTIS E MID feature
tamper-proof components to
prevent fraud.
Conformity to standards
> IEC 62053-21
class 1
> IEC 62053-23
class 2
> IEC 62053-31
> IEC 62053-11
> EN 50470-1
> EN 50470-3
COUNTIS E4x
Active energy meters
three-phase - via CT up to 6000 A
Front panel
Electrical characteristics
1. Terminal shrouds (COUNTIS E42, E44 and E46).
!@BJKHS+"#CHROK@X
,(#L@QJHMF".4-3(2$$@MC$
4. Serial number (COUNTIS E42, E44 and E46).
5. Navigation key.
6. Reset key.
,DSQNKNFHB@K+$#
8. Programming key.
5
6
7
8
count_218x_a_2_cat
Current measurement
Input consumption
Startup current (Ist)
,HMHLTLBTQQDMS(min)
Transition current (Itr)
Reference current (Iref)
Permanent overload (Imax)
Intermittent overload
Voltage measurement
Range of measurement
Consumption (VA)
Permanent overload
Energy accuracy
Active (according to IEC 62053-21)
Active (according to EN 50470)
Power supply
Case
62.5
45
72
COUNTIS E40
45
count_193_b_1_x_cat
Partial
90
Error
PROG
RESET
3X230(400)VAC 50/60Hz 0.05-5(6)A
C=0.1Wh/imp
Type
Number of modules
Dimensions W x H x D
Case degree of protection
Front degree of protection
Display type
Rigid cable cross-section
Flexible cable cross-section
Weight
Type
5
2 VA
280 V phase-neutral / 480 V phase-phase
Class 1
"K@RR!
Self-supplied
yes
Frequency
Output (pulsed)
Number
Type of optocoupler
Pulse weight
50 / 60 Hz
1
IEC 62053-31 Class A (20 ... 30 VDC)
100 Wh, 1 kWh, 10 kWh, 100 kWh
50 ms, 100 ms, 200 ms, 400 ms, 800 ms,
1000 ms, 1500 ms
Pulse duration
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
Storage temperature
Relative humidity
Communication
Link
Type
Protocol
,.#!42 speed
,!42RODDC
modular
4
73 x 90 x 62.5 mm
IP20
IP51
backlit LCD display
1.5 to 10 mm2
1 to 6 mm2
230 g
-10 to 55 C
-20 to 70 C
RS485
2 3 half duplex wires
,.#!42134,!42
4800 38400 bauds
300 9600 bauds
Connection
1
+
COUNTIS E40
12 14 16 2
U1
S1 S2
L1
S1
U2
U3
7
L2
9 11
S2 S1 S2
L3
N
L1
L2
L3
1
RS485
12 14 16 2
U1
S1 S2
L1
S1
U2
COUNTIS E43/E44/E45/E46
U3
7
L2
9 11
S2 S1 S2
L3
count_187_d_1_x_cat
N
L1
L2
L3
count_189_f_1_x_cat
count_186_c_1_x_cat
Recommendation:
- For IT earthing systems, it is recommended that the CT secondary is not connected to earth.
- When disconnecting the COUNTIS, the secondary of each current transformer must be short-circuited. This operation can be carried out automatically by a
2.".,$"/3(@M@BBDRRNQXVGHBGHRHMBKTCDCHMSGHRB@S@KNFTD
/KD@RDQDEDQSNO@FD428
N
L1
L2
L3
1
+
8 10 12 14 16 2
T1/2
COUNTIS E41/E42
U1
U2
U3
S1 S2
L1
S1
7
L2
9 11
S2 S1 S2
L3
References
Type
Via CT
Via CT - Dual tariff
5H@"3#T@KS@QHEE,(#
5H@"3VHSG12,.#!42BNLLTMHB@SHNM(1)
5H@"3VHSG12,.#!42BNLLTMHB@SHNM,(#(1)
5H@"3VHSG,!42BNLLTMHB@SHNM(1)
5H@"3VHSG,!42BNLLTMHB@SHNM,(#(1)
,@M@FDLDMSRNESV@QDENQ".4-3(2
COUNTIS
E40
Reference
COUNTIS
E41
Reference
COUNTIS
E42
Reference
COUNTIS
E43
Reference
COUNTIS
E44
Reference
COUNTIS
E45
Reference
COUNTIS
E46
Reference
4850 3008
4850 3009
4850 3015
4850 3017
4850 3014
4850 3027
4850 3028
See page 464
S@QHEERSGQNTFG12BNLLTMHB@SHNM
429
COUNTIS E5x
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
count_196_b_1_cat
> Industry.
> Infrastructure.
> Data centres.
Strong points
Function
Principle diagram
CO
UN
TIS
E
50
count_197_b_1_x_cat
Common characteristics
q Measurement accuracy: 0.5%.
q Large backlit LCD display.
q Direct access to multi-measurement
and metering values.
q Detects connection errors.
COUNTIS E50
CO
UN
TIS
E 50
CO
Advantages
models
Key characteristics
E50
Pulse output
E53
E 50
COUNTIS E50
430
UN
TIS
Conformity to standards
Management software
COUNTIS E50
COUNTIS E5x
Active energy meters
three-phase - via CT up to 6000 A
Front panel
References
COUNTIS E50
Reference
Type
Pulse output
RS485 MODBUS communication (1)
Management software for COUNTIS
COUNTIS E53
Reference
4850 3010
4850 3011
See page 464
Case
0.8
92 +- 0.0
86 520 VAC
< 0.1 VA
800 VAC
count_194_c_1_x_cat
Current measurement
Type
Input consumption
Startup current (Ist)
Minimum current (Imin)
Transition current (Itr)
Reference current (Iref)
Permanent overload (Imax)
Intermittent overload
Voltage measurement
Range of measurement
Input consumption
Permanent overload
Energy accuracy
Reactive (according to IEC 62053-23)
Active (according to IEC 62053-22)
Power supply
Self-supplied
Auxiliary power supply Us
Frequency
Output (pulsed)
Number
Type
Max. number of operations
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
Storage temperature
Relative humidity
count_196x_b_2_cat
Electrical characteristics
Class 2
Class 0.5S
no
110 400 VAC / 125 350 VDC +/-10 %
45 65 Hz
CO
U
96
NT
IS
E5
0.8
92 +- 0.0
20
60
96
1
100 VDC - 0.5 A - 10 VA
8
Type
Dimensions W x H x D
Case degree of protection
Front degree of protection
Display type
Voltage and current connection cross-section
Current connection cross-section
Weight
-10 55 C
-20 85 C
95 %
Panel mounting
96 x 96 x 80 mm
IP30
IP52
backlit LCD display
0.5 2.5 mm
1.5 6 mm
370 g
Connection
Recommendation:
- For IT earthing systems, it is recommended that the CT secondary is not
connected to earth.
S2
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
V1 V2 V3 VN
I1
I2
I3
P1
S1
S2
P1
S1
S2
P1
S1
N
L1
L2
L3
1
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
diris_397_d_1_x_cat
N
L1
L2
L3
diris_395_d_1_x_cat
P1
S1
diris_392_d_1_x_cat
P1
S1
L1
L2
L3
S2
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
Additional information
Communication via RS485 link
LIYCY-CY
0V -
+
ON
RS485
diris_400_h_1_x_cat
diris_398_c_1_x_cat
A U X
1. Fuses 0.5 A gG / 0.5 A class CC.
431
COUNTIS E63
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
Strong points
COUNTIS E63
Function
> Compact.
> Advanced multimeasurement functions.
> Detection of connection errors.
Principle diagram
Conformity to standards
CO
UN
TIS
E 63
COUNTIS E63
count_205_a_1_x_cat
Advantages
Compact
Due to the integration of three single-phase
meters in the same case (7 modules wide),
SGD".4-3(2$OQNUHCDRRHFMHEHB@MS
space-saving.
Advanced multi-measurement functions
Advanced multi-measurement functions are
available via RS485 MODBUS communication:
q Instantaneous currents: I1, I2, I3
q Instantaneous voltages: U1, U2, U3
q Instantaneous power: 3P, 3S
q Instantaneous power factors: 3PF
q Load curves for each of the 3 phases:
Viewing of average positive active power
consumption over a programmable period.
432
Management software
> To get the most effective
use from your Socomec
measurement and metering
devices, we offer a range of
dedicated software tools.
See page 464.
432.
COUNTIS E63
Active energy meters
3 x single-phase - Direct 100 A
Front panel
count_201x_a_1_cat
2
3
4
1
$KDBSQHB@KBG@Q@BSDQHRSHBR
Current measurement
Type
Input consumption
Startup current (Ist)
Minimum current (Imin)
Transition current (Itr)
Reference current (Iref)
Permanent overload (Imax)
Intermittent overload
Voltage measurement
Range of measurement
Consumption on inrush (VA)
Permanent overload
Energy accuracy
BSHUD@BBNQCHMFSN($"
Power supply
Self-supplied
Frequency
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
Storage temperature
Relative humidity
Communication
Link
Type
Protocol
MODBUS speed
RS485
2 3 half duplex wires
MODBUS RTU
4800 38400 bauds
Type
Number of modules
Dimensions W x H x D
Case degree of protection
Front degree of protection
Display type
Rigid cable cross-section
Flexible cable cross-section
Weight
modular
7
WW
LL
IP20
IP51
backlit LCD display
2.5 to 35 mm2
2.5 to 35 mm2
F
yes
'Y
-10 to 55 C
-20 to 70 C
Class 1
Case
62.5
45
COUNTIS E60
Partial
45
Error
90
count_203_a_1_x_cat
126
RESET / PROG
3X230(400)VAC 50/60Hz 0.5-20(100)A
C=2Wh / imp
3 x phases 100A
BNTMS>>A>>&!>B@S
Connection
N
L1
L2
L3
L1
L2
L3
+
15 17 13
RS485
COUNTIS E63
L - 1 - L
9 11
L - 2 - L
L - 3 - L
References
Type
3 x single phase - 100 A direct with RS485 MODBUS communication
COUNTIS E63
Reference
4850 3016
433
COUNTIS ECix
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
Strong points
> Up to 7 multi-utility meters
and 2 analogue sensors.
> Load curves.
> RS485 MODBUS
communication.
> Improved customisation.
COUNTIS ECi3
Principle diagram
Management software
CO
UN
TIS
E Ci3
COUNTIS ECi
CO
UN
TIS
E 63
485
232
COUNTIS E
L
m3
kWh
count_210_c_1_gb_cat
Function
PC
VERTELIS
Software
Advantages
Up to 7 multi-utility meters and
2 analogue sensors
q 7 logical inputs + 2 analogue inputs.
q Total, partial and programmable metering
(day, week, month, year).
Load curves
Load curves are available for each of the 7
logical inputs.
A history of average values are available for
the 2 analogue inputs (ECi3).
434
Models
Key characteristics
ECi2
7 insulated inputs
ECi3
COUNTIS ECix
Multi-utility pulse concentrator
Front panel
Characteristics
Auxiliary power supply
Self-supplied
Alternating voltage
Direct voltage
Tolerance
Frequency
Consumption
Insulation voltage
Communication
Link
Type
Protocol
MODBUS speed
Inputs
Number
Control voltage (integrated)
Minimum signal width
Maximum signal width
Minimum duration between 2 pulses
Edge triggering
Analogue inputs (ECi3)
Number
Current
Accuracy
Response time
Input resistance
Consumption
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
Storage temperature
Relative humidity
count_207x_b_2_cat
2
3
Case
73
67
45
90
count_208_a_1_x_cat
44
Type
Number of modules
Dimensions W x H x D
Case degree of protection
Front degree of protection
Display type
Terminal blocks type
Rigid cable cross-section
Flexible cable cross-section
Weight
no
110 / 400 VAC
120 / 300 VDC
10 %
45 / 65 Hz
5 VA
3.5 kV
RS485
2 3 half duplex wires
MODBUS RTU
9600 38400 bauds
7
1030 VDC
10 ms
2s
30 ms
rising
2
25 mA
0.5 %
500 ms
0.1 VA
-10 +55 C
-20 +70 C
95 %
modular
4
73 x 90 x 67 mm
IP20
IP51
backlit LCD display
fixed
1 10 mm2
0.5 6 mm2
215 g
Connection
Us
1
count_209_a_1_x_cat
R = 120
31 32 33 34 35 36 51 50 13 15 17
+
0V
COUNTIS ECi
+
RS485
37 5
+
9 10 20 22
+
- OUT PUT AUX
0/4...20 mA
SUPPLY
31 :
32 :
33 :
34 :
35 :
36 :
37 :
logical
logical
logical
logical
logical
logical
logical
input
input
input
input
input
input
input
n1.
n2.
n3.
n4.
n5.
n6.
n7.
1. 0.5 A gG fuses.
References
COUNTIS ECi2
COUNTIS ECi3
Reference
Reference
4853 0000
4853 0001
Reference
Reference
192J 8015
192J 8015
435
DIRIS A10
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
diris_791_c_1_cat
> Industry.
> Infrastructures.
> Data centres.
Strong points
DIRIS A10
Function
Principle diagram
Advantages
RS485
DIRIS A10
485
ETH
PC
PLC
> ,(&
> ,(&
FODVV6
> ,(&
FODVV
DIRIS A10
General
measurement
report
Curves for
current
per phase
diris_808_f_1_gb_cat
Easy to use
Five direct access pushbuttons enable all
measurements to be clearly viewed on its
backlit LCD display.
Conformity to standards
Functions
0XOWLPHDVXUHPHQW
q Currents
- instantaneous: I1, I2, I3, In
- maximum average: I1, I2, I3, In
q Voltages & frequency
- instantaneous: V1, V2, V3, U12, U23, U31, F
q Power
- instantaneous: 3P, YP, 3Q, YQ, 3S, YS
- maximum average: YP, YQ, YS
q Power factors
- instantaneous: 3PF, YPF
436
Metering
q Active energy: + kWh
q Reactive energy: + kVarh
Events
q Hours:
Harmonic analysis
q Total harmonic distortion (level 51)
- Currents: thd I1, thd I2, thd I3
- Phase-to-neutral voltage: thd U1, thd U2, thd U3
- Phase-to-phase voltage: thd U12, thd U23,
thd U31
Dual tariff function
Communications(1)
Input
Tariff selection
Remote device status
Output
q Remote command of device
q Alarm report
q Pulse report
DIRIS A10
Multifunction meters - MFM
Modular multifunction meter
diris_791x_c_1_cat
Front panel
2
3
4
5
6
7
Case
64
44
72
TEST
P PF
E
OK
PROG
C=0,1Wh/imp
45
V F
90
diris_809_a_1_x_cat
DIRIS A 10
Type
modular
Number of modules
Dimensions W x H x D
72 x 90 x 64 mm
IP 30
IP 52
Display type
4 mm2
2.5 mm2
Weight
Electrical characteristics
Current measurement on high-impedance inputs (TRMS)
Via CT primary
9 999 A
Via CT secondary
5A
Measurement range
0 11 kA
Input consumption
0.6 VA
Measurement updating period
1s
Accuracy
0.2 %
Permanent overload
6A
Intermittent overload
10 In for 1 s
Voltage measurements (TRMS)
Direct measurement between phases
50 500 VAC
Direct measurement between phase and neutral 28 289 VAC
Input consumption
5
Measurement updating period
1s
Accuracy
0.2 %
Permanent overload
800 VAC
Power measurement
Measurement updating period
1s
Accuracy
0.5 %
Power factor measurement
Measurement updating period
1s
Accuracy
0.5 %
Frequency measurement
Measurement range
45 65 Hz
Measurement updating period
1s
Accuracy
0.1 %
Energy accuracy
Active (according to IEC 62053-22)
Reactive (according to IEC 62053-23)
Auxiliary power supply
Alternating voltage
AC tolerance
Frequency
Consumption
Digital output (pulses or on/off)
Number
Type
Max. number of operations
Input (tariff)
Number
Type
Communication
Link
Type
Protocol
MODBUS speed
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
Storage temperature
Relative humidity
Class 0.5 S
Class 2
110 277 VAC
15 %
50 / 60 Hz
< 3 VA
1
20 / 30 VDC - 0.5 A - 10 VA
8
1
0 VAC: T1 / 200-277 VAC: T2
RS485
2 3 half duplex wires
MODBUS RTU
2400 38400 bauds
- 10 + 55 C
- 20 + 70 C
85 %
437
DIRIS A10
Multifunction meters - MFM
Modular multifunction meter
Connection
Recommendation:
- For IT earthing systems, it is recommended that the CT secondary is not connected to earth.
- When disconnecting the DIRIS, the secondary of each current transformer must be short-circuited. This operation can be carried out automatically by
a SOCOMEC PTI, an accessory which is included in this catalogue. Please consult us.
- It is recommended that the earthing point for the DIRIS A10 and the current transformer secondaries are not earthed at the same time.
/RZYROWDJHEDODQFHGQHWZRUN
6LQJOHSKDVH
N
L1
L2
L3
S2
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
V1 V2 V3 VN
I1
I2
I3
P1
S1
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
P1
S1
L1
N
S2
diris_811_a_1_gb_cat
diris_810_a_1_gb_cat
P1
S1
7ZRSKDVH
I2
I3
L1
L2
S2
1 1
diris_812_a_1_gb_cat
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
V1 V2 V3 VN
I1
ZLUHVZLWK&7V
ZLUHVZLWK&7V
I2
I3
/RZYROWDJHXQEDODQFHGQHWZRUN
S2
diris_813_a_1_gb_cat
P1
S1
1
S2
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
V1 V2 V3 VN
I1
I2
I3
P1
S1
N
L1
L2
L3
1
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
P1
S1
L1
L2
L3
S2
S2
P1
S1
diris_814_a_1_gb_cat
P1
S1
I3
diris_815_a_1_gb_cat
V1 V2 V3 VN
1
diris_821_d_1_x_cat
diris_820_a_1_x_cat
I3
20
22
AUX
I2
LIYCY-CY
438
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
RS485
S2
&RPPXQLFDWLRQYLD56OLQN
L1
L2
L3
Additional information
0V -
P1
S1
DIRIS A10
Multifunction meters - MFM
Modular multifunction meter
12
14
16
20
V1
V2
V3
VN
22
U
11
18
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
DIRIS A10
66 current inputs.
1 3 15 17
0V + RS485
DIRIS A10
56OLQN
OUT 1
DIRIS A10
Input terminals
diris_819_b_1_x_cat
Communication terminals
8 10
IN 1
DIRIS A10
output n1
diris_818_a_1_x_cat
diris_816_a_1_x_cat
diris_816_a_1_x_cat
Terminals
input n1
References
Basic device
Description
DIRIS A10 (available in light grey on request)
DIRIS A10 with RS485 MODBUS communication (available in light grey on request)
Description of accessories
Fuse disconnect switches for the protection of voltage inputs (type RM) 3 poles
Fuse disconnect switches for the protection of the auxiliary supply (type RM) 1 pole + neutral
Fuses type gG 10x38 0.5 A
Current transformer range
Management software for DIRIS
DIRIS A10
Reference
4825 0010
4825 0011
To be ordered in multiples of
4
6
10
1
Reference
5601 0018
5601 0017
6012 0000
See page 488
See page 464
439
new
> Industry.
> Infrastructure.
> Non critical buildings.
diris_896_a
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
DIRIS A17
Strong points
>
>
>
>
DIRIS A17
Function
Principle diagram
Conformity to standards
> ,(&
> ,(&
FODVV
> ,(&
FODVV
Advantages
DIRIS A17
RS485
Management software
485
ETH
PC
PLC
DIRIS A17
General
measurement
report
Curves for
current
per phase
Compact
The compact 72 x 72 mm panel-mount
format enables easy integration into any type
of electrical cabinet, including MCCs (Motor
Control Centres).
&RPSOLDQWZLWK,(&b
IEC 61557-12 is a high-level standard for
all PMDs (Performance Monitoring Devices)
that are designed to measure and monitor
electrical parameters in distribution networks.
Compliance with IEC 61557-12 ensures
a high level of equipment performance, in
terms of metrology, and the mechanical and
environmental aspects (EMC, temperature, etc.).
Advanced functions
The DIRIS A17 includes a programmable input
and output as standard on all versions; input/
output functions include pulse metering, alarm
report and pulse output.
An RS485 MODBUS communication output is
supplied on two versions, allowing the extraction
of data and device configuration remotely.
Compact.
&RPSOLDQWZLWK,(&}
Advanced functions.
Easy to use.
Easy to use
As well as being compact, the DIRIS A17 also
allows easy navigation via its 4 direct access
keys. Its screen displays a large amount of
information, whilst remaining easy to read.
Functions
Multi-measurement
q Currents
- instantaneous: I1, I2, I3, In
- maximum average: I1, I2, I3, In
q Voltages & frequency
- instantaneous: U1, U2, U3, U12, U23, U31, F
q Power
- instantaneous: 3P, YP, 3Q, YQ, 3S, YS
- maximum average: YP, YQ, YS
q Power factors
- instantaneous: 3PF, YPF
440
Metering
q Active energy: +/- kWh
q Reactive energy: +/- kvarh
Harmonic analysis
q Total harmonic distortion (level 31)
- Currents: thd I1, thd I2, thd I3, thd ln
- Phase-to-neutral voltage: thd U1, thd U2, thd
U3, (4 wire networks)
- Phase-to-phase voltage: thd U12, thd U23,
thd U31, (3 wire networks)
Events
Alarms on all electrical values
Communications
Digital RS485 (MODBUS)
Input
q Pulse metering
q Remote device status
Output
q Remote command of device
q Alarm report
q Pulse report
DIRIS A17
Multifunction meters - MFM
0XOWLPHDVXUHPHQWPHWHUGLPHQVLRQV[PP
Front panel
diris_743x_a_2_cat
Case
diris_894_b_1_x_cat
0.7
68 +- 0.0
72
DIR
IS
A1
0.7
68 +- 0.0
10,6
Type
panel mounting
Dimensions W x H x D
72 x 72 x 60 mm
IP30
IP52
Display type
fixed or plug-in
0.5 6 mm2
Weight
400 g
I
5/TE
ST
PF
49,4
OK
E
PR
OG
72
Accessories
trafo_077_b_2_cat
trafo_024_a_2_cat
Current transformers
(see page 488)
441
DIRIS A17
Multifunction meters - MFM
0XOWLPHDVXUHPHQWPHWHUGLPHQVLRQV[PP
Electrical characteristics
Current measurement (TRMS)
Via CT primary
Via CT secondary
Measurement range
Input consumption
Measurement updating period
Accuracy at 50 Hz
Accuracy at 60 Hz
Permanent overload
Intermittent overload
Voltage measurements (TRMS)
Direct measurement between phases
Direct measurement between phase and neutral
VT primary
VT secondary
Input consumption
Measurement updating period
Accuracy at 50 Hz
Accuracy at 60 Hz
Permanent overload
Power measurement
Measurement updating period
Accuracy at 50 Hz
Accuracy at 60 Hz
Power factor measurement
Measurement updating period
Accuracy at 50 Hz
Accuracy at 60 Hz
Frequency measurement
Measurement range
Measurement updating period
Accuracy
Energy accuracy
Active (according to IEC 62053-21) at 50 Hz
Active (according to IEC 62053-21) at 60 Hz
Reactive (according to IEC 62053-23)
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
Storage temperature
Relative humidity
Auxiliary power supply
Alternating voltage
AC tolerance
Frequency
Consumption
Digital pulse and control input
Number
Type
Minimum signal width
Minimum duration between 2 pulses
Communication
Link
Type
Protocol
MODBUS speed
Pulse, alarm and control output
Number
Power supply
Minimum signal width
Minimum duration between 2 pulses
Type of optocoupler
9 999 A
1 or 5 A
0 11 kA
0.6 VA
1s
0.5 %
1%
6A
10 In for 1 s
69 690 VAC
40 400 VAC
400 000 VAC
60, 100, 110, 173, 190 VAC
5
1s
0.5 %
1%
800 VAC
1s
1%
2%
1s
0.5 %
1%
45 65 Hz
1s
0.1 %
Pulse weight
Pulse length
Class 1
Class 2
Class 2
- 10 + 55 C
- 20 + 85 C
95 %
220 277 VAC
15 %
50 / 60 Hz
3 VA
1
optocoupler 8 to 30 VDC
10 ms
18 ms
RS485
2 3 half duplex wires
MODBUS RTU
1200 38400 bauds
1
8 to 30 VDC
10 ms
18 ms
IEC 62053-31 Class A (5 ... 30 VDC)
100 Wh,1 kWh, 10 kWh, 100 kWh,
J6GJ6G
LRLRLRvLR
diris_889_b_1_x_cat
Terminals
V1 V2 V3 VN A U X
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
DIRIS A17
Input/output
diris_891_c_1_x_cat
Communication
diris_890_a_1_x_cat
66current inputs.
I3
- NC
RS485
DIRIS A17
OUT
+
IN
DIRIS A17
Connection
Recommendation:
- For IT earthing systems, it is recommended that the CT secondary is not connected to earth.
- When disconnecting the DIRIS, the secondary of each current transformer must be short-circuited.
This operation can be carried out automatically by a SOCOMEC PTI, an accessory which is included in this catalogue. Please consult us.
diris_392_d_1_gb_cat
N
L1
L2
L3
S2
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
442
440.
DIRIS A17
Multifunction meters - MFM
0XOWLPHDVXUHPHQWPHWHUGLPHQVLRQV[PP
P1
S1
S2
S2
P1
S1
N
L1
L2
L3
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
P1
S1
L1
L2
L3
S2
S2
P1
S1
diris_396_d_1_gb_cat
diris_395_d_1_gb_cat
P1
S1
ZLUHVZLWK&7V
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
diris_397_d_1_gb_cat
ZLUHVZLWK&7V
P1
S1
L1
L2
L3
S2
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
Additional information
AC auxiliary power supply
&RPPXQLFDWLRQYLD56OLQN
- NC
RS485
diris_893_a_1_gb_cat
diris_892_a_1_x_cat
LIYCY-CY
A U X
References
Basic device
Auxiliary power supply Us
220 ... 277 VAC with pulse output
220 ... 277 VAC with RS485 MODBUS communication
220 ... 277 VAC with RS485 MODBUS communication
Accessories
Description of accessories
Fuse disconnect switches for the protection of voltage inputs (type RM) 3 poles
Fuse disconnect switches for the protection of the auxiliary supply (type RM) 1 pole + neutral
Fuses type gG 10x38 0.5 A
Current transformer range
Management software for DIRIS
DIRIS A17
Reference
4825 0101
4825 0102
4825 0103
To be ordered in multiples of
4
6
10
1
Reference
5601 0018
5601 0017
6012 0000
See page 488
See page 464
443
DIRIS A20
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
diris_750_a_1_cat
> Industry.
> Infrastructure.
> Data centres.
Strong points
Principle diagram
Conformity to standards
DIRIS A20
Advantages
RS485
485
ETH
Easy to use
Thanks to its large backlit LCD display and
its multiple viewing screens with direct
pushbutton access, DIRIS A20 provide clear
readings and are easy to use.
They directly display a number of multimeasurement and metering values : + kWh,
+ kvarh, I, U, V, F, P, Q, S, PF, etc.
&RPSOLDQWZLWK,(&b
IEC 61557-12 is a high-level standard for
all PMDs (Performance Monitoring Devices)
that are designed to measure and monitor
electrical parameters in distribution networks.
Compliance with IEC 61557-12 ensures
a high level of equipment performance, in
terms of metrology, and the mechanical and
environmental aspects (EMC, temperature, etc.).
DIRIS A20
DIRIS_576_g_1_gb_cat
Function
DIRIS A20
> ,(&
> ,(&
FODVV6
> ,(&
FODVV
General
measurement
report
Management software
PC
PLC
Curves for
current
per phase
Functions
Multi-measurement
q Currents
- instantaneous: I1, I2, I3, In
- maximum average: I1, I2, I3, In
q Voltages & frequency
- instantaneous: V1, V2, V3, U12, U23, U31, F
q Power
- instantaneous: 3P, YP, 3Q, YQ, 3S, YS
- maximum average: YP, YQ, YS
q Power factors
- instantaneous: 3PF, Y
444
Metering
q Active energy: + kWh
q Reactive energy: + kvarh
q Hours:
Harmonic analysis
q Total harmonic distortion (level 51)
- Currents: thd I1, thd I2, thd I3
- Phase-to-neutral voltage: thd V1, thd V2, thd V3
- Phase-to-phase voltage: thd U12, thd U23,
SGC4
Events
Alarms on all electrical values
Communications(1)
RS485 with MODBUS protocol
Output
q Remote command of device
q Alarm report
q Pulse report
(1 ) Available as an option (see the following pages).
DIRIS A20
Multifunction meters - MFM
0XOWLPHDVXUHPHQWPHWHUGLPHQVLRQV[PP
Front panel
DIRIS_743x_a_2_cat
Case
DIRIS_577_c_1_x_cat
0.8
92 +- 0.0
96
DIR
IS
A2
92
+ 0.8
- 0.0
I
5/TE
ST
panel mounting
Dimensions W x H x D
96 x 96 x 60 mm
IP30
IP52
Display type
Fixed or plug-in
0.5 6 mm2
Weight
400 g
20
Type
PF
OK
60
PR
OG
96
Plug-in modules
DIRIS A20
DIRIS_773_a_1_cat
DIRIS_445_a_1_cat
1 Output
1 output assignable to:
q Pulses: configurable (type, weight, duration) in kWh
or kvarh.
q Monitoring: 3I, In, 3V, 3U, F, YP, YQ, YS, YPFL/C,
THD 3I, THD 3V, THD 3U and timer.
q Remote command of device.
DIRIS_447_a_1_cat
Communication
RS485 link with JBUS / MODBUS protocol
(speed up to 38400 bauds)
Accessories
Panel mounting kit
IRUD[PPFXWRXW
DIRIS_718_b_1_cat
,3SURWHFWLRQ
DIRIS_720_a_2_cat
trafo_077_b_2_cat
trafo_024_a_2_cat
Current transformers
(see page 488)
445
DIRIS A20
Multifunction meters - MFM
0XOWLPHDVXUHPHQWPHWHUGLPHQVLRQV[PP
Electrical characteristics
Current measurement on high-impedance inputs (TRMS)
Via CT primary
9 999 A
Via CT secondary
5A
Measurement range
0 11 kA
Input consumption
0.6 VA
Measurement updating period
1s
Accuracy
0.2 %
Permanent overload
6A
Intermittent overload
10 In for 1 s
Voltage measurements (TRMS)
Direct measurement between phases
50 500 VAC
Direct measurement between phase and neutral
28 289 VAC
Input consumption
5
Measurement updating period
1s
Accuracy
0.2 %
Permanent overload
800 VAC
Power measurement
Measurement updating period
1s
Accuracy
0.5 %
Power factor measurement
Measurement updating period
1s
Accuracy
0.5 %
Frequency measurement
Measurement range
45 65 Hz
Measurement updating period
1s
Accuracy
0.1 %
Energy accuracy
Active (according to IEC 62053-22)
Reactive (according to IEC 62053-23)
Auxiliary power supply
Alternating voltage
AC tolerance
Direct voltage
DC tolerance
Frequency
Consumption
Pulse or alarm output
Number
Type
Max. number of operations
Communication
Link
Type
Protocol
MODBUS speed
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
Storage temperature
Relative humidity
Class 0.5 S
Class 2
110 400 VAC
10 %
120 350 VDC
20 %
50 / 60 Hz
10 VA
1
100 VDC - 0.5 A - 10 VA
8
RS485
2 3 half duplex wires
MODBUS RTU
1400 38400 bauds
- 10 + 55 C
- 20 + 85 C
95 %
DIRIS_578_a_1_x_cat
Terminals
S1 - S2: current inputs.
V1
V2
V3
VN
A U X
I1
I2
I3
DIRIS A20
Output or alarm module
0V -
RS485
DIRIS_580_b_1_x_cat
Communication module
DIRIS_579_a_1_x_cat
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
1
0n
R = 120
DIRIS A20
1 8 19
OUT 1
DIRIS A20
56OLQN
5 selectable internal resistance for
RS485 end of line termination.
18 - 19 : output n1
Connection
Recommendation:
- For IT earthing systems, it is recommended that the CT secondary is not connected to earth.
- When disconnecting the DIRIS, the secondary of each current transformer must be short-circuited. This operation can be carried out automatically by a SOCOMEC
PTI, an accessory which is included in this catalogue. Please consult us.
Single-phase
P1
S1
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
446
P1
S1
L1
N
S2
V1 V2 V3 VN
1
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
diris_394_d_1_x_cat
diris_393_d_1_x_cat
diris_392_d_1_x_cat
S2
Two-phase
P1
S1
N
L1
L2
L3
L1
L2
S2
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
DIRIS A20
Multifunction meters - MFM
0XOWLPHDVXUHPHQWPHWHUGLPHQVLRQV[PP
S2
diris_395_d_1_gb_cat
P1
S1
1
S2
N
L1
L2
L3
1
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
V1 V2 V3 VN
I1
I2
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
L1
L2
L3
S2
S2
P1
S1
I3
P1
S1
L1
L2
L3
S2
S2
P1
S1
diris_396_d_1_gb_cat
P1
S1
P1
S1
V1 V2 V3 VN
I3
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
diris_397_d_1_gb_cat
Additional information
&RPPXQLFDWLRQYLD56OLQN
0V -
+
ON
RS485
1
diris_400_h_1_x_cat
diris_398_c_1_x_cat
LIYCY-CY
A U X
References
Basic device
Auxiliary power supply Us
110 400 VAC / 180 350 VDC
Optional plug-in modules
1 output
RS485 MODBUS communication
Accessories
Description of accessories
IP65 protection
Panel mounting kit for a 144 x 96 mm cut-out
Fuse disconnect switches for the protection of voltage inputs (type RM) 3 poles
Fuse disconnect switches for the protection of the auxiliary supply (type RM) 1 pole + neutral
Fuse type gG 10x38 0.5 A
Ferrite to be associated with communication modules
Current transformer range
Management software for DIRIS
DIRIS A20
Reference
4825 0200
Reference
4825 0080
4825 0082
To be ordered in multiples of
1
1
4
6
10
1
1
Reference
4825 0089
4825 0088
5601 0018
5601 0017
6012 0000
4899 0011
See page 488
See page 464
447
DIRIS A40/A41
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
DIRIS A41
Strong points
Principle diagram
DIRIS A41
diris_581_f_1_gb_cat
Ethernet
Function
DIRIS A40
DIRIS A40
DIRIS A40
General
measurement
report
PC
Conformity to standards
Curves for
current
per phase
Easy to use
Thanks to its large backlit LCD display and
its multiple viewing screens with direct
pushbutton access, DIRIS A4x provide clear
readings and are easy to use.
They directly display a number of multimeasurement and metering values : +/- kWh,
+/- kvarh, kVAh, I, U, V, F, P, Q, S, PF, etc.
Detects wiring errors
An integrated test function can be utilised to
detect incorrect wiring and to automatically
correct CT installation errors.
Customisable
Thanks to the wide range of optional modules,
the product can be customised or upgraded
after installation.
Easy to use.
Detects wiring errors.
Customisable.
Webserver function.
&RPSOLDQWZLWK,(&}
RS485
VERTELIS
software solution
Advantages
>
>
>
>
>
PLC
Webserver function
Optional Ethernet communication modules
include a Webserver function for monitoring
and exploiting data remotely without additional
software.
&RPSOLDQWZLWK,(&b
IEC 61557-12 is a high-level standard for
all PMDs (Performance Monitoring Devices)
that are designed to measure and monitor
electrical parameters in distribution networks.
Compliance with IEC 61557-12 ensures
a high level of equipment performance, in
terms of metrology, and the mechanical and
environmental aspects (EMC, temperature, etc.).
> ,(&
> ,(&
FODVV6
> ,(&
FODVV
Functions
Multi-measurement
q Currents
- instantaneous: I1, I2, I3, In, Isystem
- average/maximum average:
I1, I2, I3, In
q Voltages & frequency
- instantaneous: V1, V2, V3, U12,
U23, U31, F, Vsystem, Usystem
- average/maximum average: V1, V2,
V3, U12, U23, U31, F
q Power
- instantaneous: 3P, YP, 3Q, YQ,
3S, YS
- maximum average: YP, YQ, YS
- predictive: (YP), (YQ), (YS)
q Power factors
- instantaneous: 3PF, YPF
- average/maximum average: YPF
448
q Temperatures(1)
- internal
- external via 3 PT100 sensors
Metering
q Active energy: +/- kWh
q Reactive energy: +/- kvarh
q Apparent power: kVAh
q Hours:
Harmonic analysis
q Total harmonic distortion
- Currents: thd I1, thd I2, thd I3,
thd In
- Phase-to-neutral voltage: thd V1,
thd V2, thd V3
- Phase-to-phase voltage: thd U12,
thd U23, thd U31
q Individual up to level 63
- Currents: HI1, HI2, HI3, HIn
- Phase-to-neutral voltage:
HV1, HV2, HV3,
- Phase-to-phase voltage:
HU12, HU23, HU31
Load curves(1)
q Active and reactive power: YP+/- ;
YQ+/q Voltages & frequency: V1, V2, V3,
U12, U23, U31, F
Events (1)
q Alarms on all electrical values.
Communications(1)
q RS485 MODBUS RTU & PROFIBUS DP
q Ethernet (MODBUS TCP or RTU over
TCP and Web server)
q Ethernet with RS485 gateway
MODBUS RTU over TCP
Inputs / Outputs (1)
q Pulse metering
q Remote control/command
q Alarm report
q Pulse report
Analogue output
q 0/4- 20 mA analogue output
(1) Available as an option
(see the following pages).
DIRIS A40/A41
Multifunction meters - PMD
0XOWLPHDVXUHPHQWPHWHUGLPHQVLRQV[PP
diris_744x_a_1_cat
Front panel
1. Backlit LCD display.
2. Direct access key for currents and test function.
3. Direct access key for voltages and frequency.
4. Direct access key for active, reactive, and apparent powers and power factor.
5. Direct access key for maximum and average current and power values.
6. Direct access key for harmonic values.
7. Direct access key for energies, hour meter and programming menu.
2 3
diris_775_a_1_cat
diris_777_a_1_cat
diris_449_a_1_cat
diris_774_a
DIRIS A41*
diris_448_a_1_cat
diris_776_a_1_cat
diris_773_a
DIRIS A40
diris_447_a_1_cat
diris_445_a_1_cat
Plug-in modules
diris_747_a_2_cat
diris_682_a_1_cat
Pulse outputs
2 configurable pulse outputs (type, weight and duration)
on kWh, kvarh and kVAh.
&RPPXQLFDWLRQ02'%86
RS485 link with MODBUS protocol
(speed up to 38400 bauds).
352),%86 DP communication
SUB-D9 link with PROFIBUS DP protocol (speed up to 12 Mbauds).
Ethernet communication
q Ethernet connection with MODBUS TCP or MODBUS RTU over TCP protocol.
q Embedded Webserver function (1).
(WKHUQHWFRPPXQLFDWLRQZLWK5602'%86JDWHZD\
q Ethernet connection with MODBUS TCP or MODBUS RTU over TCP protocol.
q Connection of 1 to 247 RS485 MODBUS slaves.
q Embedded Webserver function (1).
Analogue outputs
A maximum of 2 modules may be connected, providing up to 4 analogue outputs.
Per module 2 outputs assignable to:
3I, In, 3V, 3U, F, YP, YQ, YS, YPFL/C, I sys, Vsys, Usys, Ppred, Q pred,
Spred, TC internal, TC 1, TC 2, TC3 and to 17 VDC power supply.
LQSXWVRXWSXWV
A maximum of 3 modules may be connected, providing up to 6 inputs and 6 outputs.
Per module 2 outputs assignable to:
- monitoring: 3I, In, 3V, 3U, F, YP, YQ, SS, YPFL/C, THD 3I, THD In, THD 3V, THD
3U, Ppred, Qpred, Spred, internal TC, TC 1, TC2, TC3 and hour meter,
- remote control,
- timed remote control.
- 2 inputs for pulse metering.
Memory
q Storing up to a maximum of 62 days of P+, P-, Q+, Q- with an internal or
external synchronisation signal of 5, 8, 10, 15, 20, 30 and 60 minutes.
q Storing of 10 hour-dated last alarms.
q Storing of the last minimum and maximum instantaneous values for 3U, 3V, 3I,
In, F, YP, YQ, YS, THD 3U, THD 3V, THD, 3U, THD, 3V, THD, 3I, THD In.
q Storing of 3U, 3V and F average values based on synchronisation function
(maximum 60 days).
Temperature
Temperature indication:
- internal,
- external sensor PT 100 (TC 1),
- external sensor PT 100 (TC 2),
- external sensor PT 100 (TC 3),.
449
DIRIS A40/A41
Multifunction meters - PMD
0XOWLPHDVXUHPHQWPHWHUGLPHQVLRQV[PP
Accessories
diris_720_a_2_cat
trafo_077_b_2_cat
trafo_024_a_2_cat
3DQHOPRXQWLQJNLWIRUD[PPFXWRXW
diris_718_b_1_cat
,3SURWHFWLRQ
Current transformers
(see page 488)
Terminals
diris_569_a_1_x_cat
DIRIS A40
66 current inputs
V1
V2
V3
VN
A U X
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
DIRIS A40
V1
V2
V3
VN
A U X
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
IN
1
0n
R = 120
RS485
OUT 1
diris_573_a_1_x_cat
diris_572_a_1_x_cat
0V -
OUT 2
LQSXWVRXWSXWVPRGXOH
Memory module
Temperature module
OUT 1
A-Cd
OUT 2
A-Cd
1 3 14 15 16
-
+
IN 1
17 18
+
IN
synchro
IN 2
RJ45
DIRIS A40/A41
diris_751_c_1_gb_cat
10 BASE T
100 BASE T
10 BASE T
100 BASE T
RJ45
DIRIS A40/A41
sensor 1
sensor 2
27 28 29 30
sensor 3
Sensor 1
red
red
white
white
Ethernet Module
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
DIRIS A40/A41
diris_752_a_1_x_cat
+
- +
0/4-20 mA 0/4-20 mA
OUT 1
OUT 2
9 10 11 12
450
RS485 link.
5 selectable internal resistance
for RS485 end of line termination.
diris_683_a_1_x_cat
diris_571_a_1_x_cat
I3
DIRIS A41
Communication module
diris_574_b_1_x_cat
I2
diris_753_a_1_gb_cat
diris_570_a_1_x_cat
DIRIS A41
0V -
RS485
gateway
1
0n
R = 120
Sensor 2
red
red
white
white
Sensor 3
red
red
white
white
DIRIS A40/A41
Multifunction meters - PMD
0XOWLPHDVXUHPHQWPHWHUGLPHQVLRQV[PP
Electrical characteristics
Current measurement on insulated inputs (TRMS)
Via CT primary
9 999 A
Via CT secondary
1 or 5 A
Measurement range
0 11 kA
Input consumption
5
Measurement updating period
1s
Accuracy
0.2 %
Permanent overload
6A
Intermittent overload
10 In for 1 s
Voltage measurements (TRMS)
Direct measurement between phases
50 700 VAC
Direct measurement between phase and neutral 28 404 VAC
VT primary
500 000 VAC
VT secondary
60, 100, 110, 173, 190 VAC
Frequency
50 / 60 Hz
Input consumption
5
Measurement updating period
1s
Accuracy
0.2 %
Permanent overload
800 VAC
Current-voltage product
Limitation for 1A CT
10 000 000
Limitation for 5A CT
10 000 000
Power measurement
Measurement updating period
1s
Accuracy
0.5 %
Power factor measurement
Measurement updating period
1s
Accuracy
0.5 %
Frequency measurement
Measurement range
45 65 Hz
Measurement updating period
1s
Accuracy
0.1 %
Energy accuracy
Active (according to IEC 62053-22)
Class 0.5 S
Reactive (according to IEC 62053-23)
Class 2
Auxiliary power supply
Alternating voltage
110 400 VAC
AC tolerance
10 %
Direct voltage
120 350 VDC / 12 48 VDC
DC tolerance
20 % / - 6 + 20 %
Frequency
50 / 60 Hz
Consumption
5
- 10 + 55 C
Storage temperature
- 20 + 85 C
Relative humidity
95 %
Case
diris_582_d_1_x_cat
92
DIR
96
IS
+ 0.8
- 0.0
92
A4
+ 0.8
- 0.0
Type
Dimensions W x H x D
Case degree of protection
Front degree of protection
Display type
Terminal blocks type
Voltage and other connection cross-section
Current connection cross-section
Weight
panel mounting
96 x 96 x 60 mm
IP30
IP52
backlit LCD display
fixed or plug-in
0.2 2.5 mm2
0.5 6 mm2
400 g
35
60
96
451
DIRIS A40/A41
Multifunction meters - PMD
0XOWLPHDVXUHPHQWPHWHUGLPHQVLRQV[PP
Connections
5HFRPPHQGDWLRQWhen disconnecting the DIRIS, the secondary of each current transformer must be short-circuited. This operation can be carried out
automatically by a SOCOMEC PTI, an accessory which is included in this catalogue. Please consult us.
In TNC neutral systems it is recommended to use the functional earth module.
Single-phase
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
V1 V2 V3 VN
I1
I2
I3
S2
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
P1
S1
L1
N
I2
I3
diris_394_d_1_x_cat
S2
diris_393_d_1_x_cat
diris_392_d_1_x_cat
P1
S1
Two-phase
P1
S1
N
L1
L2
L3
L1
L2
S2
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
V1 V2 V3 VN
I1
I2
I3
S2
P1
S1
S2
1
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
V1 V2 V3 VN
I1
I2
I3
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
P1
S1
L1
L2
L3
S2
S2
P1
S1
diris_396_d_1_x_cat
diris_395_d_1_x_cat
P1
S1
ZLUHVZLWK&7V
P1
S1
N
L1
L2
L3
I3
diris_397_d_1_x_cat
ZLUHVZLWK&7V
P1
S1
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
P1
S1
diris_575_b_1_x_cat
P1
S1
1
N
L1
L2
L3
S2
S2
V1 V2 V3 VN S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
IN
1. Fuses 0.5 A gG / 0.5 A class CC.
Additional information
&RPPXQLFDWLRQYLD56OLQN
L1
L2
L3
+
ON
RS485
diris_399_b_1_x_cat
diris_398_c_1_x_cat
LIYCY-CY
V1 V2 V3 N
diris_400_h_1_gb_cat
0V -
A U X
452
I3
P1
S1
L1
L2
L3
S2
DIRIS A40/A41
Multifunction meters - PMD
0XOWLPHDVXUHPHQWPHWHUGLPHQVLRQV[PP
References
Basic device
DIRIS A40
Reference
DIRIS A41
with CT on the
neutral
Reference
4825 0201
4825 1201
4825 0202
4825 1202
Reference
Reference
4825 0090
4825 0092
4825 0093
4825 0094
4825 0205
4825 0097
4825 0203
4825 0204
4825 0206
4825 0090
4825 0092
4825 0093
4825 0094
4825 0205
4825 0097
4825 0203
4825 0204
4825 0206
Options
Plug-in modules(1)
Pulse outputs
RS485 MODBUS communication
Analogue outputs
2 inputs / 2 outputs
Communication Sub D9 PROFIBUSDP(2)
Memory
Embedded Webserver function (2).
Ethernet communication + RS485 MODBUS gateway (Embedded Webserver function)(2)
Temperature inputs
(1) Ease of integration for additional functions (maximum 4 slots on A40 and 3 on A41).
(2) Dimension of the plug-in module: 2 slots.
Accessories
Description of accessories
IP65 protection
Panel mounting kit for a 144 x 96 mm cut-out
Fuse disconnect switches for the protection of voltage inputs (type RM) 3 poles
Fuse disconnect switches for the protection of the auxiliary supply (type RM)
1 pole + neutral
Fuse type gG 10x38 0.5 A
Current transformer range
Ferrite to be associated with communication modules
Temperature sensor PT100 - M6 screw type
Temperature sensor PT100 - M6 eyelet type
Management software for DIRIS
To be ordered
in multiples of
1
1
4
Reference
4825 0089
4825 0088
5601 0018
To be ordered
in multiples of
1
1
4
Reference
4825 0089
4825 0088
5601 0018
5601 0017
5601 0017
10
1
1
1
1
6012 0000
10
1
6012 0000
4899 0011
4825 0208
4825 0209
1
1
4899 0011
4825 0208
4825 0209
See page 464
453
DIRIS A60
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
DIRIS A60
RIS
> Industry.
> Infrastructure.
> Data centres.
A6
0
Ethernet
DI
DIRIS A40
DIRIS A40
DIRIS A40
RS485
PC
VERTELIS
software
solution
Curves for
current
per phase
DIRIS A60
Function
PLC
CU@MS@FDR
Easy to use
3G@MJRSNHSRK@QFDA@BJKHS+"#CHROK@X@MC
HSRLTKSHOKDUHDVHMFRBQDDMRVHSGCHQDBSJDX
@BBDRRSGD#(1(2 OQNUHCDRBKD@QQD@CHMFR
and is easy to use.
(SCHQDBSKXCHROK@XR@MTLADQNELTKSH
LD@RTQDLDMS@MCLDSDQHMFU@KTDR
J6G
Management softwares
q .OSHNM@K$SGDQMDSLNCTKDVHSG6DARDQUDQ
ETMBSHNM%NQLD@RTQDLDMSLNMHSNQHMFC@S@
exploitation and the export of load curves
QDLNSDKXVHSGNTS@RODBHEHBRNESV@QDVDA
AQNVRDQ@BBDRR
q M@KXRHRRNESV@QD%NQSGD@M@KXRHRNEDUDMSR
C@S@HMNQCDQSNHLOQNUDSGDQDKH@AHKHSXNESGD
electrical installation.
q $@RX"NMEHFRNESV@QD%NQPTHBJ@MCD@RX
remote device configuration; configuration
EHKDRB@MADBNOHDCEQNL@MCRDMSSNSGD
#(1(2 NQSGDXB@MADBQD@SDCVHSGNTS
communication and sent at a later time.
,TKSHOKDCDUHBDRB@MADBNMEHFTQDCEQNL
a single file, which is especially useful for
.$,R@MCO@MDKATHKCDQR
&RQIRUPLW\WRVWDQGDUG(1
$-HR@RS@MC@QCVGHBGCDEHMDRDUDMSR
QDK@SHMFSNSGDPT@KHSXNEDKDBSQHB@KMDSVNQJR
3GD#(1(2 B@OSTQDRUNKS@FDDUDMSRHM
accordance with this standard.
CHQHR>>B>>FA>B@S
General
measurement
report
Strong points
>
>
>
>
>
Easy to use.
Detects wiring errors.
&RPSOLDQWZLWK,(&}
Management softwares.
Conformity to standard
(1}
Conformity to standards
> ,(&
> ,(&
FODVV6
> ,(&
FODVV
> (1
Functions
In addition to the functions of the
#(1(2 SGD#(1(2 @KRN
q shows the current and voltage
TMA@K@MBD
q shows the tangent
q RSNQDRSGDKN@CBTQUDRC@XR
VHSG@MHMSDQU@KNELHMTSDRENQ
the active, reactive and apparent
ONVDQYP+/- ; YQ+/-, YS
q detects and stores the last
DUDMSRBNMBDQMHMF
- overvoltage
- voltage dips
- cut-offs
- overcurrent.
For each stored event, the DIRIS
QDBNQCRSGDQDKDU@MS1,2LR
interval curves for the voltages V1, V2,
V3, U12, U23, U31 and the currents I1,
(((MFHUHMF@SNS@KNEBTQUDR
454
Other functions:
Multi-measurement
Currents
HMRS@MS@MDNTR((((M(RXRSDL
@UDQ@FDL@WHLTL@UDQ@FD((
I3, In,
TMA@K@MBD(TMA
q Voltages & frequency
HMRS@MS@MDNTR55544
U31, F, Vsystem, Usystem
@UDQ@FDL@WHLTL@UDQ@FD55
V3, U12, U23, U31, F
TMA@K@MBD4TMA
q Power
HMRS@MS@MDNTR/YP, 3Q, YQ, 3S, YS
L@WHLTL@UDQ@FDYP, YQ, YS
OQDCHBSHUDYP, YQ, YS.
q Power factor - PF, YPF
q Instantaneous total tangent
q Instantaneous, average and max.
@UDQ@FDTMA@K@MBD
q Temperatures
- internal,
DWSDQM@KUH@/3RDMRNQR
Metering
q BSHUDDMDQFX
J6G
q 1D@BSHUDDMDQFX
JU@QG
q OO@QDMSONVDQJ5 G
q 'NTQR
Harmonic analysis (level 63)
q Total harmonic distortion
"TQQDMSRSGC(SGC(SGC(
thd In
/G@RDSNMDTSQ@KUNKS@FDSGC5
thd V2, thd V3
/G@RDSNOG@RDUNKS@FDSGC4
thd U23, thd U31
q Individual
"TQQDMSR'('('('(M
/G@RDSNMDTSQ@KUNKS@FD'5
HV2, HV3,
/G@RDSNOG@RDUNKS@FD'4
HU23, HU31
Events (1)
q K@QLRNM@KKDKDBSQHB@KU@KTDR
Communications(1)
q L @M@KNFTDNTSOTS
q 12,.#!42134
q $SGDQMDS,.#!423"/NQ
,.#!42134NUDQ3"/@MC
6DARDQUDQ
q $SGDQMDS,.#!423"/NQ
,.#!42134NUDQ3"/@MC
6DARDQUDQVHSG12,.#!42
RTU gateway
Inputs / Outputs (1)
q Pulse metering
q Remote control/command
q K@QLQDONQS
q Pulse report
(1) Available as an option
(see the following pages).
DIRIS A60
Multifunction meters - PMD
(QHUJ\PRQLWRULQJDQGHYHQWDQDO\VLVGLPHQVLRQV[PP
Front panel
CHQHR>W>@>>B@S
!@BJKHS+"#CHROK@X
#HQDBS@BBDRRJDXENQBTQQDMSRSDLODQ@STQDR@MCSDRSETMBSHNM
#HQDBS@BBDRRJDXENQUNKS@FDR@MCEQDPTDMBX
#HQDBS@BBDRRJDXENQ@BSHUDQD@BSHUD@MC@OO@QDMSONVDQR@MCONVDQE@BSNQ
#HQDBS@BBDRRJDXENQL@WHLTL@MC@UDQ@FDBTQQDMSUNKS@FD@MCONVDQU@KTDR
#HQDBS@BBDRRJDXENQG@QLNMHBRU@KTDR
#HQDBS@BBDRRJDXENQDMDQFHDRGNTQLDSDQ@MCOQNFQ@LLHMFLDMT
CHQHR>>@>>B@S
CHQHR>>@>>B@S
Plug-in modules
Pulse outputs
q BNMEHFTQ@AKDOTKRDNTSOTSRSXODVDHFGS@MCCTQ@SHNM
NMJ6GJU@QG@MCJ5 G
Communication MODBUS
q 12KHMJVHSG,.#!42 protocol (speed up to
A@TCR
CHQHR>>@>>B@S
Ethernet communication
q $SGDQMDSBNMMDBSHNMVHSG,.#!423"/NQ
,.#!42134NUDQ3"/OQNSNBNK
q $LADCCDC6DARDQUDQETMBSHNM.
Ethernet communication
ZLWK5602'%86JDWHZD\
q $SGDQMDSBNMMDBSHNMVHSG,.#!423"/NQ,.#!42134
over TCP protocol.
q "NMMDBSHNMNESN12,.#!42RK@UDR
q $LADCCDC6DARDQUDQETMBSHNM.
CHQHR>>@>>B@S
Analogue outputs
CHQHR>>@>>B@S
CHQHR>>@>>B@S
CHQHR>>@
CHQHR>>@>>B@S
DIRIS A60*
L@WHLTLNELNCTKDRL@XADBNMMDBSDCOQNUHCHMF
TOSN@M@KNFTDNTSOTSR
q /DQLNCTKDNTSOTSR@RRHFM@AKDSN
3I, In, 3V, 3U, F, YP, YQ, YS, Y/%+"(RXR5RXR4RXR
Ppred, Q pred, Spred, TC internal, TC 1, TC 2, TC3
@MCSN5#"ONVDQRTOOKX
LQSXWVRXWSXWV
q L@WHLTLNELNCTKDRL@XADBNMMDBSDCOQNUHCHMFTOSNHMOTSR
and 6 outputs.
q /DQLNCTKDNTSOTSR@RRHFM@AKDSN
LNMHSNQHMF((M54%YP, YQ, YS, Y/%+"3'#(3'#(M
THD 3V, THD 3U, Ppred, Qpred, Spred, TC internal, TC 1, TC2,
TC3 and hour meter,
- remote control,
- timed remote control,
q 2 inputs for pulse metering.
Temperature
3DLODQ@STQDHMCHB@SHNM
- Internal
$WSDQM@KRDMRNQ/33"
$WSDQM@KRDMRNQ/33"
$WSDQM@KRDMRNQ/33"
(1) See "Management softwares for DIRIS" p. 464.
(2) See "External sensor PT 100" p. 505.
455
DIRIS A60
Multifunction meters - PMD
(QHUJ\PRQLWRULQJDQGHYHQWDQDO\VLVGLPHQVLRQV[PP
BBDRRNQHDR
,3SURWHFWLRQ
Split-core current
transformers
#(1(2>>A>>B@S
#(1(2>>@>>B@S
SQ@EN>>A>>B@S
SQ@EN>>@>>B@S
Current transformers
(see page 488)
Terminals
66 current inputs
V1
V2
V3
VN
A U X
I1
I2
1
0n
RS485
R = 120
DIRIS A60
#(1(2>>A>>FA>B@S
#(1(2>>@>>W>B@S
0V -
(WKHUQHWPRGXOH5602'%86JDWHZD\
Ethernet module
10 BASE T
100 BASE T
RJ45
DIRIS A60
12KHMJ
5 RDKDBS@AKDHMSDQM@KQDRHRS@MBD
ENQ12DMCNEKHMDSDQLHM@SHNM
OUT 1
OUT 2
DIRIS A60
#(1(2>>@>>W>B@S
+
- +
0/4-20 mA 0/4-20 mA
OUT 1
OUT 2
DIRIS A60
RS485
gateway
RJ45
DIRIS A60
Temperature module
#(1(2>>@>>FA>B@S
#(1(2>>@>>W>B@S
0V -
10 BASE T
100 BASE T
12F@SDV@XQDRHRSNQ
1RDKDBS@AKDHMSDQM@KQDRHRS@MBD
ENQ12DMCNEKHMDSDQLHM@SHNM
456
I3
DIRIS A60
5602'%86PRGXOH
#(1(2>>@>>W>B@S
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
LQSXWVRXWSXWVPRGXOH
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26
sensor 1
27 28 29 30
sensor 3
DIRIS A60
9 10 11 12
sensor 2
OUT 1
A-Cd
#(1(2>>A>>W>B@S
#(1(2>>@>>W>B@S
DIRIS A60
OUT 2
A-Cd
1 3 14 15 16
-
+
IN 1
+
IN 2
DIRIS A60
1
0n
R = 120
DIRIS A60
Multifunction meters - PMD
(QHUJ\PRQLWRULQJDQGHYHQWDQDO\VLVGLPHQVLRQV[PP
Electrical characteristics
Current measurement on insulated inputs (TRMS)
Via CT primary
Via CT secondary
NQ
Measurement range
vJ
Input consumption
5
Measurement updating period
1s
BBTQ@BX
Permanent overload
Intermittent overload
(n for 1 s
Voltage measurements (TRMS)
#HQDBSLD@RTQDLDMSADSVDDMOG@RDR
v5 "
#HQDBSLD@RTQDLDMSADSVDDMOG@RD@MCMDTSQ@K
v5 "
VT primary
5 "
VT secondary
5 "
Frequency
'Y
Input consumption
5
Measurement updating period
1s
BBTQ@BX
Permanent overload
5 "
Current-voltage product
+HLHS@SHNMENQ "3
+HLHS@SHNMENQ "3
Power measurement
Measurement updating period
1s
BBTQ@BX
Power factor measurement
Measurement updating period
1s
BBTQ@BX
Frequency measurement
Measurement range
v'Y
Measurement updating period
1s
BBTQ@BX
Energy accuracy
BSHUD@BBNQCHMFSN($"
"K@RR
2
1D@BSHUD@BBNQCHMFSN($"
Class 2
Auxiliary power supply
KSDQM@SHMFUNKS@FD
v5 "
"SNKDQ@MBD
Direct voltage
v5#"
DC tolerance
Frequency
'Y
Consumption
5
Case
#(1(2>>A>>W>B@S
92
DIR
IS
96
+ 0.8
- 0.0
92
A6
+ 0.8
- 0.0
Type
panel mounting
#HLDMRHNMR6W'W#
WWLL
(/
(/
Display type
A@BJKHS+"#CHROK@X
3DQLHM@KAKNBJRSXOD
fixed or plug-in
v LL2
vLL2
6DHFGS
F
35
60
96
457
DIRIS A60
Multifunction meters - PMD
(QHUJ\PRQLWRULQJDQGHYHQWDQDO\VLVGLPHQVLRQV[PP
Connection
Low voltage balanced network for DIRIS A60
Recommendation:6GDMCHRBNMMDBSHMFSGD#(1(2SGDRDBNMC@QXNED@BGBTQQDMSSQ@MRENQLDQLTRSADRGNQSBHQBTHSDC
3GHRNODQ@SHNMB@MADB@QQHDCNTS
@TSNL@SHB@KKXAX@2.".,$"/3(VGHBGB@MADENTMCHMSGD2.".,$"B@S@KNFTDOKD@RDBNMRTKSTR
3/4 wires with 1 CT
Single-phase
P1
S1
P1
S1
P1
S1
L1
N
S2
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
V1 V2 V3 VN
I1
I2
I3
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
CHQHR>>C>>W>B@S
diris_392_d_1_x_cat
S2
diris_393_d_1_x_cat
Two-phase
N
L1
L2
L3
L1
L2
S2
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
S2
S2
P1
S1
N
L1
L2
L3
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
P1
S1
L1
L2
L3
S2
S2
P1
S1
diris_396_d_1_x_cat
CHQHR>>C>>W>B@S
P1
S1
ZLUHVZLWK&7V
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
CHQHR>>C>>W>B@S
P1
S1
V1 V2 V3 VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
CCHSHNM@KHMENQL@SHNM
&RPPXQLFDWLRQYLD56OLQN
L1
L2
L3
ON
RS485
V1 V2 V3 N
CHQHR>>G>>W>B@S
CHQHR>>B>>W>B@S
CHQHR>>A>>W>B@S
LIYCY-CY
A U X
458
I3
0V -
L1
L2
L3
S2
DIRIS A60
Multifunction meters - PMD
(QHUJ\PRQLWRULQJDQGHYHQWDQDO\VLVGLPHQVLRQV[PP
References
Basic device
DIRIS A60
Reference
4825 0207
Options
Plug-in-modules(1)
Reference
Pulse outputs
4825 0090
4825 0092
4825 0093
4825 0094
4825 0203
4825 0204
4825 0206
12,.#!42 communication
M@KNFTDNTSOTSR
2 inputs / 2 outputs
$SGDQMDSBNLLTMHB@SHNMDLADCCDC$SGDQMDS6DARDQUDQ
$SGDQMDSBNLLTMHB@SHNM
12,.#!42F@SDV@XDLADCCDC$SGDQMDS6DARDQUDQ
Temperature inputs
(1) Easy integration of additional functions (maximum 3 slots per device).
(2) Dimension of the plug-in module: 2 slots.
Options
Description of accessories
(/OQNSDBSHNM
/@MDKLNTMSHMFJHSENQ@WLLBTSNTS
%TRDCHRBNMMDBSRVHSBGDRENQSGDOQNSDBSHNMNEUNKS@FDHMOTSRSXOD1,ONKDR
%TRDCHRBNMMDBSRVHSBGDRENQSGDOQNSDBSHNMNESGD@TWHKH@QXRTOOKXSXOD1,ONKD
MDTSQ@K
%TRDSXODF&W
%DQQHSDSNAD@RRNBH@SDCVHSGBNLLTMHB@SHNMLNCTKDR
Current transformer range
3DLODQ@STQDRDMRNQ/3,RBQDVSXOD
3DLODQ@STQDRDMRNQ/3,DXDKDSSXOD
Management softwares for DIRIS
To be ordered in multiples of
1
1
6
1
1
1
1
Reference
4825 0089
4825 0088
5601 0018
5601 0017
6012 0000
4899 0011
See page 488
4825 0208
4825 0209
See page 464
459
DIRIS A80
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
> Infrastructure.
> Health care buildings.
> Data centres.
Strong points
> Compact.
DIRIS A80
> &RPSOLDQWZLWK,(&}
DIRIS A80
DI
RIS
DIRIS A80
DI
RIS
A8
0
RS-485
A8
0
Main
meter panel
PC
VERTELIS
software
solution
Currents
per phase
curve
PLC
Conformity to standards
> ,(&
FODVV6
> ,(&
FODVV
> ,(&
> ,(&
> (1
Advantages
Compact
3GD#(1(2 BNLAHMDRSVNBNLOKDLDMS@QX
OQNCTBSRVHSGHM@RHMFKDWLLO@MDK
mounted case, enabling faster installation and
TSHKHRHMFKDRRRO@BD
3GD#(1(2 BNLOQHRDR
@LTKSHETMBSHNMLDSDQVHSGDMG@MBDCDUDMS
KNFFHMFETMBSHNMRVGHBGQDBNQCRBTQUDRENQ
PT@KHSXDUDMSR
- an RCM fault current monitoring device
(Residual Current Monitoring).
Conformity to standard EN 50160
$-HR@RS@MC@QCVGHBGCDEHMDR
DUDMSRQDK@SHMFSNSGDPT@KHSXNEDKDBSQHB@K
MDSVNQJR
3GD#(1(2 B@OSTQDRUNKS@FD
DUDMSRHM@BBNQC@MBDVHSGSGHRRS@MC@QC
/QHMBHOKDCH@FQ@L
CHQHR>>A>>FA>B@S
DIRIS A80HR@BNLOKDSDO@MDKLNTMSDC
LTKSHETMBSHNMLDSDQVGHBGHMBNQONQ@SDR
RCM current monitoring (Residual Current
,NMHSNQHMFENQMDSVNQJRVHSG3-2@MC
TT neutral systems, and enhanced data
logging functions for recording curves for
PT@KHSX@MC1",DUDMSR
3GD#(1(2
RTOOKHDR@KKSGDLD@RTQDLDMSRQDPTHQDC
ENQDMDQFXDEEHBHDMBXOQNIDBSRVGHKDHSR
1",ETMBSHNMOQNUHCDROQDUDMS@SHUD
D@QSGKD@J@FDHMENQL@SHNMDRRDMSH@KHM
BQHSHB@K@OOKHB@SHNMRSN@UNHCHMRS@KK@SHNM
RGTSCNVMR
Ethernet
Function
Patent pending
TSNL@SHB@CITRSLDMSNESGDKD@J@FDBTQQDMS
@K@QLSGQDRGNKCHM@BBNQC@MBDVHSGSGDKN@C
current to avoid false alarms.
&RPSOLDQWZLWK,(&b
($"HR@GHFGKDUDKRS@MC@QCENQ
all PMDs (Performance Monitoring Devices)
that are designed to measure and monitor
DKDBSQHB@KO@Q@LDSDQRHMCHRSQHATSHNMMDSVNQJR
"NLOKH@MBDVHSG($"DMRTQDR
@GHFGKDUDKNEDPTHOLDMSODQENQL@MBDHM
terms of metrology, and the mechanical and
DMUHQNMLDMS@K@RODBSR$,"SDLODQ@STQDDSB
Management softwares
q .OSHNM@K$SGDQMDSLNCTKDVHSG6DARDQUDQ
function: For measurement monitoring, data
DWOKNHS@SHNM@MCSGDDWONQSNEKN@CBTQUDR
QDLNSDKXVHSGNTS@RODBHEHBRNESV@QDVDA
AQNVRDQ@BBDRR
q M@KXRHRRNESV@QD%NQSGD@M@KXRHRNEDUDMSR
C@S@HMNQCDQSNHLOQNUDSGDQDKH@AHKHSXNESGD
electrical installation.
q $@RX"NMEHFRNESV@QD%NQPTHBJ@MCD@RX
QDLNSDCDUHBDBNMEHFTQ@SHNMBNMEHFTQ@SHNM
EHKDRB@MADBNOHDCEQNL@MCRDMSSNSGD
#(1(2 NQSGDXB@MADBQD@SDCVHSGNTS
communication and sent at a later time.
,TKSHOKDCDUHBDRB@MADBNMEHFTQDCEQNL
@RHMFKDEHKDVGHBGHRDRODBH@KKXTRDETKENQ
.$,R@MCO@MDKATHKCDQR
Functions
The DIRIS A80 offers the following
Multi-measurement
functions:
q Currents
q The monitoring of fault currents
HMRS@MS@MDNTR((((M(RXRSDL
q (Residual Current Monitoring)
@UDQ@FDL@WHLTL@UDQ@FD((((M
q Multi-measurement (current,
- unbalance: I unb
UNKS@FDEQDPTDMBXONVDQv
5NKS@FDREQDPTDMBX
q Energy metering
HMRS@MS@MDNTR55544
q Harmonic analysis
4%5RXRSDL4RXRSDL
q Event detection
@UDQ@FDL@WHLTL@UDQ@FD555
444%
Fault currents (RCM)
TMA@K@MBD4TMA
q ,D@RTQDLDMSNEBTQQDMSR(M(
(
(
(M
@MC(/$OQNSDBSHNMBNMCTBSNQ
q /NVDQ
q /DQL@MDMSLNMHSNQHMFNE(M@MC(/$
HMRS@MS@MDNTR/Y/0Y02Y2
%@TKSBTQQDMS@K@QLRCDODMCHMFNMSGD
- maximum average: YP, Y0Y2
load current
OQDCHBSHUDYP, Y0Y2
1DBNQCNEDUDMSR(M@MC(/$SHLD
RSNQHMFNEKN@CBTQUDRC@XRVHSG@M
duration and curves stored)
HMSDQU@KNELHMTSDRENQSGD@BSHUD
K@QLQDONQSNTSOTS
QD@BSHUD@MC@OO@QDMSONVDQ
Y/
Y0
Y2
460
q /NVDQE@BSNQ/%YPF
q (MRS@MS@MDNTRSNS@KS@MFDMSOGH
q Instantaneous, average and max. average
unbalance
Metering
q BSHUDDMDQFX
J6G
q 1D@BSHUDDMDQFX
JU@QG
q OO@QDMSONVDQJ5 G
q Hours
Harmonic analysis (level 63)
q Total harmonic distortion
"TQQDMSRSGC(SGC(SGC(SGC(M
- Phase-to-neutral voltage: thd V1,
SGC5SGC5
/G@RDSNOG@RDUNKS@FDSGC4
SGC4SGC4
q Individual
"TQQDMSR'('('('(M
/G@RDSNMDTSQ@KUNKS@FD'5'5'5
/G@RDSNOG@RDUNKS@FD'4'4
'4
Events
q Alarms on all electrical values
q #DSDBSHNM@MCRSNQHMFNESGDK@RSDUDMSR
- overvoltage
UNKS@FDCHOR
- cut-offs
- overloads.
%NQD@BGRSNQDCDUDMSSGD#(1(2 QDBNQCR
SGDQDKDU@MS1,2LRHMSDQU@KBTQUDRENQ
SGDUNKS@FDR555444SGD
BTQQDMSR(((@MC(M
3GDRDBTQUDRB@M
ADRXMBGQNMHRDCVHSGSGDDUDMSBTQUDR(M
and IPE.
Communications(1)
q 12,.#!42134
q $SGDQMDS,.#!423"/NQ,.#!42134
NUDQ3"/@MC6DARDQUDQ
q $SGDQMDS,.#!423"/NQ,.#!42
134NUDQ3"/@MC6DARDQUDQVHSG12
,.#!42134F@SDV@X
(1) Available as an option
(see the following pages).
DIRIS A80
Multifunction meters - PMD + RCM
0RQLWRULQJHQHUJ\DQGIDXOWFXUUHQWVGLPHQVLRQV[PP
%QNMSO@MDK
Accessories
&RUHEDODQFHWUDQVIRUPHU,&
2DDO@FD 522)
SNQD>>@
diris_876x_a_1_cat
!@BJKHS+"#CHROK@X
#HQDBS@BBDRRJDXENQSGDBTQQDMSR1",ETMBSHNM
and alarm reset.
#HQDBS@BBDRRJDXENQUNKS@FDR@MCEQDPTDMBX
#HQDBS@BBDRRJDXENQ@BSHUDQD@BSHUD@MC@OO@QDMSONVDQR
@MCONVDQE@BSNQ
#HQDBS@BBDRRJDXENQL@WHLTL@MC@UDQ@FDBTQQDMSUNKS@FD
@MCONVDQU@KTDR
#HQDBS@BBDRRJDXENQG@QLNMHBU@KTDR@MCSGDBNMMDBSHNM
and RCM test functions.
#HQDBS@BBDRRJDXENQDMDQFHDRGNTQLDSDQ
@MCOQNFQ@LLHMFLDMT
Plug-in modules
CHQHR>>@>>B@S
DIRIS A80
Communication MODBUS
Ethernet communication
q $SGDQMDSBNMMDBSHNMVHSG,.#!423"/NQ,.#!42134NUDQ3"/
OQNSNBNK
q $LADCCDC6DARDQUDQETMBSHNM(1).
diris_776_a_1_cat
#(1(2>>@>>B@S
diris_777_a_1_cat
q 12KHMJVHSG,.#!42OQNSNBNK
RODDCTOSNA@TCR
Terminals
CHQHR>>A>>W>B@S
DIRIS A80
66BTQQDMSHMOTSR
V1
V2
V3
VN
A U X
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
AUX: TWHKH@QXONVDQRTOOKX4s
99991UNKS@FDHMOTSR
IN
IN
IPE
33 34 37 38
OUT
DIRIS A80
IN
IN
IPE
CHQHR>>@>>W>B@S
Memory module
33 34 35 36
OUT1
OUT2
DIRIS A80
./,1residual current
K-L / IPE : ground fault current
33-34 :QDK@XNTSOTSR
NOSNHMOTSR
./,1residual current
K-L / IPE : ground fault current
33-34 : QDK@XNTSOTSM
35-36 :QDK@XNTSOTSM
Ethernet module
10 BASE T
100 BASE T
RJ45
DIRIS A80
10 BASE T
100 BASE T
RJ45
0V -
RS485
gateway
1
0n
R = 120
DIRIS A80
12F@SDV@XQDRHRSNQ
5 RDKDBS@AKDHMSDQM@KQDRHRS@MBDENQ12
end of line termination.
17 18
+
IN
synchro
DIRIS A80
RXWSXWV
diris_871_a_1_x_cat
RCM module
1 input / 1 output
CHQHR>>B>>FA>B@S
CHQHR>>A>>W>B@S
CHQHR>>B>>W>B@S
DIRIS A80
RCM module
0V -
1
0n
RS485
R = 120
DIRIS A80
12KHMJ
5 selectable internal resistance
ENQ12DMCNEKHMDSDQLHM@SHNM
461
DIRIS A80
Multifunction meters - PMD + RCM
0RQLWRULQJHQHUJ\DQGIDXOWFXUUHQWVGLPHQVLRQV[PP
Connections
Additional information
Communication via RS485 link
L1
L2
L3
0V -
CHQHR>>A>>W>B@S
CHQHR>>B>>W>B@S
LIYCY-CY
+
ON
RS485
CHQHR>>G>>FA>B@S
V1 V2 V3 N
A U X
S2
CHQHR>>@>>FA>B@S
P1
S1
1
PE
N
L1
L2
L3
P1
S1
P1
S1
S2
P1
S1
PE
N
L1
S2
V1 V2 V3 VN S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
IN
IN
IPE
V1 V2 V3 VN S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
IN
IN
IPE
Electrical characteristics
Current measurement on insulated inputs (TRMS)
5H@"3OQHL@QX
Via CT secondary
Measurement range
(MOTSBNMRTLOSHNM
,D@RTQDLDMSTOC@SHMFODQHNC
Accuracy
Permanent overload
Intermittent overload
Alternating voltage
v5 "
AC tolerance
Direct voltage
v5#"
DC tolerance
%QDPTDMBX
'Y
"NMRTLOSHNM
5
MODBUS communication module
+HMJ
12
3XOD
vG@KECTOKDWVHQDR
Protocol
,.#!42134
vA@TCR
,.#!42RODDC
Ethernet Communication Module
Connection
1)
2ODDC
10 base T / 100 base T
Protocol
,.#!423"/NQ,.#!42134NUDQ3"/
%@TKSBTQQDMSLNMHSNQHMFBG@Q@BSDQHRSHBR(M@MC(PE)
(MOTSR(M@MC(PE
-TLADQNEHMOTSR
Dedicated core balance transformers Q@MFD("lSQ@MRENQLDQQ@SHN
,D@RTQDLDMSNEE@TKSBTQQDMS(M(PE L v
Accuracy
K@QLR(M@MC(PE
Thresholds
@CITRSLDMSCDODMCHMFNMSGDKN@CBTQQDMSR
Time setting
0 to 10 s
+NFFHMF
values, dates, durations and curves
-TLADQNEDUDMSR
max. 1000 events
Optocoupler input
-TLADQ
RODBHEHBSNSGDQDEDQDMBD
/NVDQRTOOKX
v5#"
,HMHLTLRHFM@KVHCSG
10 ms
,HMHLTLCTQ@SHNMADSVDDMOTKRDR
LR
3XOD
NOSNBNTOKDQ
Alarm outputs
-TLADQNEQDK@XR
RODBHEHBSNSGDQDEDQDMBD
3XOD
5 "l
,@W
-NENODQ@SHNMR
10
9 999 A
NQ
vJ
5
1s
6A
10 In for 1 s
#HQDBSLD@RTQDLDMSADSVDDMOG@RDR
#HQDBSLD@RTQDLDMSADSVDDMOG@RD@MCMDTSQ@K
53OQHL@QX
VT secondary
%QDPTDMBX
(MOTSBNMRTLOSHNM
,D@RTQDLDMSTOC@SHMFODQHNC
Accuracy
Permanent overload
v5 "
v5 "
5 "
5 "
'Y
5
1s
800 VAC
Current-voltage product
+HLHS@SHNMENQ "3
+HLHS@SHNMENQ "3
10 000 000
10 000 000
Power measurement
,D@RTQDLDMSTOC@SHMFODQHNC
Accuracy
1s
,D@RTQDLDMSTOC@SHMFODQHNC
Accuracy
1s
Frequency measurement
Measurement range
,D@RTQDLDMSTOC@SHMFODQHNC
,D@RTQDLDMSTOC@SHMFODQHNC
v'Y
1s
Energy accuracy
BSHUD@BBNQCHMFSN($"
1D@BSHUD@BBNQCHMFSN($"
"K@RR
2
"K@RR
Operating conditions
.ODQ@SHMFSDLODQ@STQD
2SNQ@FDSDLODQ@STQD
Relative humidity
462
v
"
v
"
CHQHR>>@>>FA>B@S
DIRIS A80
Multifunction meters - PMD + RCM
0RQLWRULQJHQHUJ\DQGIDXOWFXUUHQWVGLPHQVLRQV[PP
Case
#(1(2>>C>>W>B@S
92
+ 0.8
- 0.0
DI
RIS
A8
0
96
92
60
3XOD
O@MDKLNTMSHMF
#HLDMRHNMR6W'W#
WWLL
"@RDCDFQDDNEOQNSDBSHNM
(/
%QNMSCDFQDDNEOQNSDBSHNM
(/
#HROK@XSXOD
A@BJKHS+"#CHROK@X
3DQLHM@KAKNBJRSXOD
EHWDCNQOKTFHM
vLL
"@AKDBQNRRRDBSHNMENQBTQQDMSR(M@MC(PE
v LL
v LL
6DHFGS
F
+ 0.8
- 0.0
35
96
References
Basic device
Type
6HSGNTSOTSR
6HSGHMOTSNTSOTS
Options
Plug-in modules
12,.#!42 communication
$SGDQMDSBNLLTMHB@SHNMDLADCCDC$SGDQMDS6DARDQUDQ(1)
$SGDQMDSBNLLTMHB@SHNM
12,.#!42F@SDV@XDLADCCDC$SGDQMDS6DARDQUDQ(1)
DIRIS A80
Reference
4825 0213
4825 0214
Reference
4825 0092
4825 0203
4825 0204
Accessories
Description of accessories
(/OQNSDBSHNM
/@MDKLNTMSHMFJHSENQ@WLLBTSNTS
%TRDCHRBNMMDBSRVHSBGDRENQSGDOQNSDBSHNMNEUNKS@FDHMOTSRSXOD1,ONKDR
%TRDCHRBNMMDBSRVHSBGDRENQSGDOQNSDBSHNMNESGD@TWHKH@QXRTOOKXSXOD1,ONKD
MDTSQ@K
%TRDRSXODF&W
%DQQHSDSNAD@RRNBH@SDCVHSGBNLLTMHB@SHNMLNCTKDR
Current transformer range
To be ordered in multiples of
1
1
6
10
1
1
Reference
Reference
"NQDA@K@MBDSQ@MRENQLDQ("
Type
("
("
("
("
("
("
("
,@M@FDLDMSRNESV@QDRENQ#(1(2
4825 0089
4825 0088
5601 0018
5601 0017
6012 0000
4899 0011
2DDO@FD488
4950 6015
4950 6030
4950 6050
4950 6080
4950 6120
4950 6200
4950 6300
2DDO@FD 464
463
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
Analysis software
COUNTIS E
Function
To get the most effective use from your Socomec measurement and metering devices, we can
provide dedicated software tools:
Easy Config software
The Easy Config software enables quick
and easy remote device configuration for
".4-3(2$".4-3(2$"H@MC#(1(2 LDSDQR
Configuration files can be copied from and sent
to these devices, or they can be created without
BNLLTMHB@SHNM@MCRDMS@S@K@SDQSHLD
Multiple devices can be configured from a single
file which is especially useful for OEMs and panel
builders, saving time when having to program
L@MXCDUHBDRVHSGSGDR@LDBNMEHFTQ@SHNM
Analysis software
On the basis of an event log and the
CHROK@XDCBTQUDRSGD M@KXRHRRNESV@QD@KKNVR
the analysis and extraction of quality data,
as well as fault current monitoring
1DRHCT@K"TQQDMS,NMHSNQHMF
Webserver function
3GD#(1(2 RNOSHNM@K$SGDQMDSLNCTKDR
integrate HTML pages, enabling the
Webserver function to be directly accessed
through a standard web browser (Internet
$WOKNQDQ%HQDENW
DKHLHM@SHMFSGDMDDCENQ
RNESV@QDHMRS@KK@SHNM
The Webserver function enables:
- monitoring of electrical values,
- viewing of energy consumption,
- managing alarms,
- configuration of the main parameters
of installation,
- viewing and extracting load curves
SGQNTFG@
"25EHKD
COUNTIS ECi
Principle diagram
DIRIS A
DIRIS A80
Ethernet
verte_885_a_1_gb_cat
COUNTIS E43
RS485
Software
Easy Cong
Software
Webserver
PC
Software
Analysis
464
An
aly
sis
rve
We
b
se
sy
".4-3(2$VHSG12BNLLTMHB@SHNM
COUNTIS ECi
#(1(2 @MC VHSG12BNLLTMHB@SHNM
#(1(2 VHSG12BNLLTMHB@SHNM
#(1(2 VHSG$SGDQMDSBNLLTMHB@SHNMLNCTKD
#(1(2 @MC VHSG12BNLLTMHB@SHNMLNCTKD
#(1(2 @MC VHSG$SGDQMDSBNLLTMHB@SHNMLNCTKD
Ea
Co
nfi
PLC
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
CHQHR>>@>>FA>B@S
diris_883_a_1_gb_cat
CHQHR>>A>>FA>B@S
465
M@KXRHRRNESV@QD
Improvement to the reliability of your electrical installation can be achieved with this software through the analysis of displayed event curves
FDMDQ@SDCEQNLSGDDUDMSKNF
It offers the following functions:
q KHRSNEUNKS@FDCHORBTSNEERNUDQUNKS@FDR@MCNUDQBTQQDMSR
q KHRSNE@K@QLR(M@MC(PEENQ#(1(2
q CHROK@XNEBTQUDR54((MKHMJDCSNSGDDUDMSVHSG@YNNLETMBSHNM@KHSX
q 3GDBK@RRHEHB@SHNMNEDUDMSR@BBNQCHMFSNSGD$-RS@MC@QC
q $WONQSHMFNEOHBSTQDRNQBTQUDEHKDR
3GHRRNESV@QDB@MADBNMMDBSDCSNSGD#(1(2TRHMFDHSGDQ@M12,.#!42NQ$SGDQMDSBNLLTMHB@SHNMLNCTKD
3GD M@KXRHRRNESV@QDB@MADCNVMKN@CDCEQNLSGD2.".,$"VDARHSDVVV
RNBNLDB
BNL
CHQHR>>@>>FA>B@S
Event log
CHQHR>>A>>FA>B@S
466
Webserver function
CHQHR>>@>>B@S
The Webserver function comprises HTML pages embedded within the optional Ethernet
BNLLTMHB@SHNMLNCTKDNESGD#(1(2 LTKSHETMBSHNMLDSDQ
3GDRDO@FDRB@MAD@BBDRRDC
UH@@MHMSDQMDSAQNVRDQRHLOKXAXDMSDQHMFSGD#(1(2 R(/@CCQDRR
3GD6DARDQUDQNEEDQRSGD
following functions:
q ,NMHSNQHMFNEDKDBSQHB@KU@KTDR
q 5HDVHMFDMDQFXBNMRTLOSHNM
q ,@M@FDLDMSNE@K@QLR
q 1DLNSDBNMEHFTQ@SHNMNESGDL@HMO@Q@LDSDQRENQLDSDQRVHSGHM
q 5HDVHMF@MCDWSQ@BSHMFKN@CBTQUDRSGQNTFG@
"25EHKD
DIRIS A Ethernet communication
module with RS485 gateway
CHQHR>>@>>FA>B@S
CHQHR>>@>>FA>B@S
Alarms
CHQHR>>@>>FA>B@S
#HROK@XENQUHDVHMFHMRS@MS@MDNTR@MC@UDQ@FDONVDQLD@RTQDLDMSR
@MCDMDQFXBNMRTLOSHNM
CHQHR>>@>>FA>B@S
#HROK@XENQUHDVHMFHMRS@MS@MDNTR@MC@UDQ@FDDKDBSQHB@KU@KTDR
3GDK@SDRS@K@QLR@QDC@SD@MCSHLDQDFHRSDQDC
3GDCTQ@SHNM@MC
U@KTDENQD@BG@K@QLKNVKHLHSU@KTDGHFGKHLHSU@KTD@RVDKK@RSGD
QDK@SDCNTSOTS@K@QLMTLADQ@QD@KRNCHROK@XDC
#@S@B@MADDWSQ@BSDCHM
BRUENQL@S
467
refit_005_a_1_cat
COUNTIS E44R
refit_010_a_1_cat
> Industry.
> Infrastructure.
> Data centres.
refit_002_a_1_cat
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
RETROFIT Line
TC0 36 400 A
DIRIS A40R
Function
Existing sites, having been built before
optimised energy consumption was a
consideration, are especially in need of a
dedicated energy efficient solution.
To meet this requirement, the 5(752),7b/LQH
allows you to easily add metering and
measurement points in electrical enclosures
which are very restricted in terms of integration.
The RETROFIT Line consists of COUNTIS
RETROFIT and DIRIS RETROFIT meters
Strong points
combined with TCO split-core current
transformers. Together they allow measuring,
metering, monitoring and analysis of single
and three-phase networks up to 600 A, even
inside the most confined cabinet spaces.
>
>
>
>
>
Conformity to standards
468
>
>
>
>
>
IEC 62053-21
IEC 62053-22
IEC 62053-23
IEC 62053-31
EN 50470
(MID - COUNTIS E42R/E44R)
DIRIS:
> IEC 61557-12
DIRIS N
DIRIS A10R
COUNTIS E42R
DIRIS A40R
COUNTIS E42R
refit_018_b_1_gb_cat
Distribution panel
+LJKRYHUDOODFFXUDF\
A global system measuring accuracy of
better than 1% in energy from 10 to 120% of
nominal current.
(DV\LQVWDOODWLRQ
TCO split-core transformers mean
the power cables do not need to be
disconnected.
Operations are quicker and minimise the
electrical disconnection time.
([WHQGHGUDQJH
The range covers energy meters and
multifunction meters in modular or panel
mounted format.
3URYHQSURGXFWV
The COUNTIS and DIRIS RETROFIT are
based on standard SOCOMEC ranges.
&RPPXQLFDWLRQWR0RQLWRULQJ
The data from RETROFIT products can be
transferred to a central monitoring system.
*XDUDQWHHGFRQQHFWLRQV
The product is protected against phase/
neutral inversion and detects wiring errors.
Commissioning has been simplified to ensure
the device operates correctly: installation costs
are therefore reduced.
COUNTIS:
Principle diagram
Loads
Advantages
RETROFIT Line
RETROFIT Packs
refit_010_a_1_cat
refit_002_a_1_cat
&RPELQDWLRQRI&2817,65(752),7PHWHUVDQG7&2VSOLWFRUHFXUUHQW
WUDQVIRUPHUV
Meter all the values of the electrical network or any other energy (via the pulse
concentrator COUNTIS ECi ) in order to:
q Optimise and share energy costs,
q Reinvoice the consumption to the user (MID versions).
refit_010_a_1_cat
refit_005_a_1_cat
&RPELQDWLRQRI',5,65(752),7PXOWLPHDVXUHPHQWPHWHUVDQG7&2VSOLW
FRUHFXUUHQWWUDQVIRUPHUV
Measure and monitor all the values of the electrical network, or any other energy
(via the pulse concentrator COUNTIS ECi), in order to:
q Analyse energy consumption and quality,
q Identify malfunctions,
q Improve the availability of the installation.
469
RETROFIT Line
Meters
Function
The &2817,6([5RIWKH5(752),7SDFNis an active electrical
energy meter designed for three-phase networks. It is connected to the
network through 3 TCO's up to 600 A.
5HIHUHQFHV
Kit
Energy meter kWh MID + 3 TCO
Energy meter kWh MID + 3 TCO
Energy meter kWh MID + 3 TCO
Energy meter kWh MID + 3 TCO
Energy meter kWh + 3 TCO
Energy meter kWh + 3 TCO
Energy meter kWh + 3 TCO
Energy meter kWh + 3 TCO
CT Ratio
100 A / 1 A
250 A / 1 A
400 A /1 A
600 A / 1 A
100 A / 1 A
250 A / 1 A
400 A /1 A
600 A / 1 A
COUNTIS E42R
RETROFIT Pack
COUNTIS E44R
RETROFIT Pack
COUNTIS E50R
RETROFIT Pack
COUNTIS E53R
RETROFIT Pack
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
4850 4915
4850 4925
4850 4935
4850 4945
4850 4916
4850 4926
4850 4936
4850 4946
4850 4917
4850 4927
4850 4937
4850 4947
4850 4918
4850 4928
4850 4938
4850 4948
Technical characteristics(1)
COUNTIS E42R
COUNTIS E44R
COUNTIS E50R
COUNTIS E53R
TC/1 A up to 600 A
0.2 VA per phase
24 A / 0.5 s
1.2 A
10 mA
TC/1 A up to 600 A
0.2 VA per phase
24 A / 0.5 s
1.2 A
10 mA
TC/1 A up to 600 A
< 0.6 VA
10 In for 1 s
1.2 A
3 mA
TC/1 A up to 600 A
< 0.6 VA
10 In for 1 s
1.2 A
3 mA
230 400 V 15 %
2 VA
280 V
230 400 V 15 %
2 VA
280 V
28 520 VAC
< 0.1 VA
800 VAC
28 520 VAC
< 0.1 VA
800 VAC
Class C
Class C
Class 0.5 S
Class 2
Class 0.5 S
Class 2
Current measurement
Type
Input consumption
Overload
Permanent overload
Minimum current measured
Voltage measurement
Range of measurement
Input consumption
Permanent overload
Energy accuracy
Active (according to EN 50470)
Active (according to IEC 62053-22)
Reactive (according to IEC 62053-23)
(1) Features not mentioned are identical to those of COUNTIS E4x and E5x standard products.
470
RETROFIT Line
Multi-measurement meters
Function
',5,6$5(752),7SDFNVinclude a multifunction meter and 3 TCO's
TOSN
The ',5,6$5SDFNincludes a modular format multifunction meter
for measuring electrical values in low voltage networks. It allows all
electrical parameters to be displayed and utilised for communication
and/or output functions.For further details on functions see the
standard DIRIS A10 pages.
5HIHUHQFHV
Kit
DIRIS A10R + 3 TCO
DIRIS A10R + 3 TCO
DIRIS A10R + 3 TCO
DIRIS A10R + 3 TCO
DIRIS A10R with COM + 3 TCO
DIRIS A10R with COM + 3 TCO
DIRIS A10R with COM + 3 TCO
DIRIS A10R with COM + 3 TCO
DIRIS A10R + 3 TCO
DIRIS A20R + 3 TCO
DIRIS A20R + 3 TCO
DIRIS A20R + 3 TCO
DIRIS A40R + 3 TCO
DIRIS A40R + 3 TCO
DIRIS A40R + 3 TCO
DIRIS A40R + 3 TCO
CT Ratio
100 A / 1 A
250 A / 1 A
400 A /1 A
600 A / 1 A
100 A / 1 A
250 A / 1 A
400 A /1 A
600 A / 1 A
100 A / 1 A
250 A / 1 A
400 A /1 A
600 A / 1 A
100 A / 1 A
250 A / 1 A
400 A /1 A
600 A / 1 A
A20R
Reference
A40R
Reference
4825 4911
4825 4921
4825 4931
4825 4941
4825 4912
4825 4922
4825 4932
4825 4942
4825 4913
4825 4923
4825 4933
4825 4943
4825 4914
4825 4924
4825 4934
4825 4944
Technical characteristics(1)
DIRIS A10R +
communication
DIRIS A20R
DIRIS A40R
600 A
1A
0.6 VA
1s
0.2 %
1.2 A
10 In for 1 s
600 A
1A
0.6 VA
1s
0.2 %
1.2 A
10 In for 1 s
600 A
1A
0.6 VA
1s
0.2 %
1.2 A
10 In for 1 s
600 A
1A
5
1s
0.2 %
1.2 A
10 In for 1 s
50 500 VAC
28 289 VAC
50 500 VAC
28 289 VAC
50 500 VAC
28 289 VAC
5
1s
0.2 %
800 VAC
5
1s
0.2 %
800 VAC
5
1s
0.2 %
800 VAC
50 700 VAC
28 404 VAC
500 000 VAC
60, 100, 110, 173, 190 VAC
5
1s
0.2 %
760 VAC
1s
0.5 %
1s
0.5 %
1s
0.5 %
1s
0.5 %
DIRIS A10R
Power measurement
Measurement updating period
Accuracy
(1) Characteristics that are not listed are identical to those of the standard DIRIS A10, A20 and A40 range.
471
RETROFIT Line
7KH5(752),7SDFNJXDUDQWHHVRYHUDOODFFXUDF\WRZLWKLQOHVV
WKDQb
Technical characteristics
TCO 24
TCO
TCO 36
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
182T 4910
182T 4925
182T 4940
182T 4960
refit_017_a_1_gb_cat
P
L
472
RETROFIT Line
Services
Take advantage of the advice offered by an energy specialist
q
q
q
q
Implementation
Training
Electrical facility audit
Project engineering.
For more details download our Service brochure available on our web site :
www.socomec.com or contact your SOCOMEC office.
sydiv_069_a_1_gb_cat
Zoom
count_207_a_1_cat
Think about it
&2817,6(&L
Communicate consumption information whatever the energy
(electricity, water, gas...) to a PC or PLC.
Please see the COUNTIS ECi catalogue pages.
9(57(/,66XSHUYLVLRQ
Opt for sustainable energy savings by choosing the fully
customisable energy efficiency solution provided by SOCOMEC.
VERTELIS is a modular offer, including a software, measuring
devices adapted to your needs, as well as pre-sales and after sales
professional services.
For further information, please contact your SOCOMEC branch.
473
DIRIS N300/N600
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
Network analysers
Network quality control and analysis system
>
>
>
>
DIRIS_754_a_1_cat
DIRIS_762_a_1_gb_cat
DIRIS_755_a_1_cat
DIRIS N
Function
DIRIS N300 / N600 are multifunction network
analysers designed for in-depth analysis
of electrical networks in order to improve
their availability and efficiency. They actively
contribute to procedures for optimising the
operation of your electrical networks.
They enable you to:
q improve the efficiency of the facility,
q reduce production costs,
q optimise operating costs,
q optimise maintenance costs,
>
>
>
>
>
Advantages
Principle diagram
Conformity to standards
Advanced multi-measurement
Measurement history
Harmonics
Monitoring
Load curves
#HOR.TS@FDR5NKS@FDRTQFDR
4MA@K@MBD
5DBSNQCH@FQ@L
Control command (options)
Interharmonics measurement
Analysis of transient states
Flicker
EN 50160 report
474
DIRIS N300
multifunction analyser
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
DIRIS N
DIRIS O
Monitoring
ETHERNET
DI
RIS
D6
00
DIRIS D
DIRIS N
Easy to use.
Customisable.
Powerful.
Accurate.
Conformity to standard
(1}
> ,(&
> ,(&
> ,(&
FODVV6
> ,(&FODVV
> (1
DIRIS N
E Ci3
DIRIS N600
qualimeter
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
DIRIS O
SOCOMEC BUS
COU
NTIS
SOCOMEC BUS
diris_801_b_1_gb_cat
RS 485
Easy to use
The DIRIS D600 interface enables easy
access to the DIRIS Ns menus and clearly
displays numerical values and graphs on its
large colour TFT screen.
Customisable
.OSHNM@KHMOTSNTSOTSLNCTKDRB@MAD
TSHKHRDCSNE@BHKHS@SDENQDW@LOKDRVHSBGAN@QC
automation control. These modules can be
installed after the initial installation, enabling
DIRIS A
the implementation of additional functions.
Powerful
The DIRIS N600 can detect transient
COUNTIS ECi
overvoltages down to 1 microsecond.
Accurate
High accuracy of the measured electrical
COUNTIS E
U@KTDR
ENQ(@MC4
Conformity to standard EN 50160
EN 50160 is a standard which defines the
characteristics and events relating to the
quality of electrical networks. The DIRIS N fully
complies to this standard.
Strong points
DIRIS D
DIRIS O
Functions
The DIRIS N is a true system made up of
functional components:
q measurement acquisition and
OQNBDRRHMF#(1(2--
q TFT graphic colour interface:
#(1(2#NOSHNMNETRHMF@RHMFKD
DIRIS D 600 for several DIRIS N)
q remote input / output modules:
#(1(2.
DIRIS N300/N600
Network analysers
Network quality control and analysis system
&DMDQ@KBG@Q@BSDQHRSHBRNESGD#(1(2-@MC-
3GDU@RSL@INQHSXNESGDETMBSHNMRADKNV@QD@U@HK@AKD@RMTLDQHB@KU@KTDRHMRS@MS@UDQ@FDLHMHLTL@MCL@WHLTL
values), graphs (wave captures and 1/2 period RMS) and logs.
DIRIS N...
Measurements:
- Currents, voltages, frequency
(instant, average, minimum
@MCL@WHLTL
- Direct, inverse and homopolar
voltages.
5NKS@FDTMA@K@MBD
- Active, reactive, apparent
and predictive power.
- Power factor.
- Fresnel diagram.
- Temperatures.
0 123
Energy management:
- Active, reactive and apparent energy
meters.
- Impulse meters (up to 20 meters).
- Timestamped meters
(up to 8 meters).
- Load curves.
Monitoring:
- Display of an alarm and status log.
- Indication of the parameter
concerned, the status at time T, the
duration and date/time of the start
and end of the event.
Control/Command
(only with the DIRIS O):
- Controls and commands the
position of the remote devices.
- Programmes the logical functions to
create automatic processes.
Communication:
12TRHMF,.#!42
!@RD3@MC!@RD3$SGDQMDS
,.#!423"/
42!ONQSRGNRSCDUHBD
.ODM" -HMSDQM@KATRENQ#(1(2.
modules).
DIRIS N600:
The user also has the following
functions:
- Flicker (Pst and Plt).
- EN 50160 report.
5NKS@FDSQ@MRHDMSRR@LOKHMFR
5NKS@FD@MCBTQQDMSHMSDQG@QLNMHBR
A hub of innovation
The DIRIS N, developed using innovative technology, has enabled some functions to reach a new level.
Installation
The DIRIS N is designed to be located
VHSGHMBKNRDOQNWHLHSXSNSGDHMRS@KK@SHNM
being monitoring in order to greatly reduce
the length of cabling for measurement
sensor connection (current and voltage
transformers).
4RHMF@QDLNSDHMSDQE@BDLNCTKD@UNHCR
having multiple cables connected on the
inside of the panel door; only an RJ45
cable is required. In the same way, power is
RTOOKHDCSNSGD@CCHSHNM@K#(1(2.LNCTKDR
directly via the communication bus, thus
avoiding the use of yet more cables.
diris_827_a_1_cat
Operation
The DIRIS D600 colour TFT interface
module gives the user easy access to all the
installation's parameters and clearly displays
both numerical values and graphs.
Data stored on the DIRIS Ns internal memory
B@MADCNVMKN@CDCNMSN@42!JDXUH@SGD
#(1(2#R42!ONQS
diris_759_a_1_gb_cat
Measurements
.OSHL@KB@KBTK@SHNMETMBSHNMR@MCR@LOKHMFHM
the range of 1 s ensuring a very high-level of
precision when measuring as shown below:
9ROWDJHVDQGFXUUHQWVLQFODVV
$FWLYHHQHUJ\LQFODVVDVSHU,(&
+DUPRQLFVLQFODVV
475
DIRIS N300/N600
Network analysers
Network quality control and analysis system
"NLLTMHB@SHNMADSVDDMSGD/"@MCSGD#(1(2-TMHSRHRUH@$SGDQMDS
RHLTKS@MDNTRCHROK@XNERDUDQ@K#(1(2-HRONRRHAKD
diris_841_a_1_cat
I1
I2
I3
In
Transformer_1
18/02/2009 10:18
270.5
303.0
305.5
0.000
A
A
A
A
P1
P2
P3
P
16.20
20.00
17.39
51.72
kW
kW
kW
kW
S1
S2
S3
S
U12 398.2
U23 399.4
U31 400.0
V
V
V
Q1
Q2
Q3
Q
15.04
19.04
18.39
59.71
kvar
kvar
kvar
kvar
FP1 +0.845
FP2
FP3
FP
50.01
Hz
21.44
17.46
20.79
56.80
kVA
kVA
kVA
kVA
diris_782_c_1_gb_cat
Multi-display of
instantaneous measurements
STOP
AVG
Active power
load curve
Transformer_1
27/11/2012 10:18
kW
600
690,0
kW
500
300
200
100
27/11/2012 10:18:05
0
12 14 16 18 20 22
INST.
476
diris_842_a_1_gb_cat
CHQHR>>@>>FA>B@S
400
Page 12/12
AVG
10 H
REFRESH
HISTO.
SAVE
DIRIS N300/N600
Network analysers
Network quality control and analysis system
diris_786_b_1_gb_cat
diris_787_b_1_gb_cat
CHQHR>>@>>FA>B@S
CHQHR>>A>>FA>B@S
CHQHR>>@>>EQ>B@S
477
DIRIS N300/N600
Network analysers
Network quality control and analysis system
Case
DIRIS N300/N600
Base-mounting
Overall dimensions
CHQHR>>@>>B@S
DIRIS N 600
123
135
148
CHQHR>>@>>W>B@S
287
150
6.5
46
61
diris_794_a_1_cat
DIN-rail mounting
DIRIS D600
Remote interface
Overall dimensions
+ 0.8
- 0.0
DIRIS D 600
+ 0.8
92
- 0.0
90
CHQHR>>@>>W>B@S
diris_796_a_1_cat
146
92
151
33
84
DIRIS O
DIN-rail mounting
Overall dimensions
45
DIRIS O
478
CHQHR>>A>>W>B@S
diris_799_a_1_cat
diris_798_a_1_cat
146
135
123
Base-mounting
7
72
44
58
DIRIS N300/N600
Network analysers
Network quality control and analysis system
.OSHNMR
diris_762_a_1_gb_cat
CHQHR>>@>>B@S
1
2
Transformer_1
Fresnel diagram
20/02/2009 15:57
100 V/div
120
diris_782_b_1_gb_cat
diris_784_a_1_gb_cat
114 A/div
I1
I2
In
I3
V1 = 220.8 V
I1 = 282.0 A
0.000
32.00
V2 = 223.1 V
I2 = 272.5 A
128.0
147.0
V3 = 220.8 V
I3 = 230.0 A
261.0
243.0
Vn =
In =
FP1=
FP2=
FP3=
P1=
P2=
P3=
0.000
32.00
54.00
9400
0,885
0,791
0,774
16.20
18.90
16.92
V
A
kW
kW
kW
20/02/2009 15:57:28
240
STOP
SAVE
diris_755_a_1_cat
Characteristics
DIRIS N300/N600
Auxiliary power supply
Alternating voltage
AC tolerance
Frequency
Direct voltage
DC tolerance
Connection
Mechanical
Consumption
Type
Number of modules
#HLDMRHNMR6W'W#
Cut-out
5HAQ@SHNMR
Protection degree
Weight
v5 "
10 %
50 / 60 Hz
v5#"
10 %
2.5 mm2 pull-out 2 point
terminal block
modular
16
WW
IEC 60068-2-6 compliant
IP40 (panel face), IP20 (unit)
F
DIRIS D600
remote interface
DIRIS O
4 inputs - 2 outputs
DIRIS O: 2 analogue
inputs 0/420 mA
DIRIS O: 2 analogue
outputs 0/420 mA
5#"(1)
10 %
2.5 mm2 pull-out 2 point
terminal block
5#"(1)
10 %
2.5 mm2 pull-out 2 point
terminal block
5#"(1)
10 %
2.5 mm2 pull-out 2 point
terminal block
5#"(1)
10 %
2.5 mm2 pull-out 2 point
terminal block
10 W
1.5 W
modular
4
WW
6
modular
4
WW
2.5 W
modular
4
WW
WW
W
IEC 60068-2-6 compliant
IP52
600 g
(1) Auxiliary supply or via DIRIS N300/N600 (limited to 15 W) or Power over Ethernet or Power over Can
DIRIS N300/N600
Communication
Link
Type
RS485
G@KECTOKDWVHQDR
,.#!42134
Protocol
,.#!42 speed
Address
Connection
DIRIS D600
remote interface
DIRIS O
4 inputs - 2 outputs
DIRIS O
2 analogue inputs
0/420 mA
DIRIS O
2 analogue outputs
0/420 mA
ETHERNET
G@KECTOKDWVHQDR
,.#!42 TCP or
proprietary
ETHERNET
!42./3(.-
!42./3(.-
!42./3(.-
Proprietary in TCP
mode
Proprietary in CAN
mode
Proprietary in CAN
mode
W1)ONHMS
straight cable
W1)ONHMS
straight cable
W1)ONHMS
straight cable
W1)ONHMS
straight cable
W1)ONHMS
straight cable
479
DIRIS N300/N600
Network analysers
Network quality control and analysis system
Characteristics
Characteristics of the PMD (IEC 61557-12)
Evaluation of the power supply quality (possible function) PMD classification
SD
Temperature
K55
Humidity + Altitude
.ODQ@SHMFODQENQL@MBDBK@RRNE@BSHUDONVDQNQ@BSHUD
0.2
energy (if possible function)
Startup duration
50 seconds
Characteristics of the functions/
Evaluation of the power supply quality (IEC 61557-12)
P (Total active power) - class 0,2
5 % In to 2 In
Qv (reactive power) - class 1
5 % In to 2 In
Sv - class 0.2
5 % In to 2 In
Ea - class 0.2
5 % In to 2 In
Erv - class 1
5 % In to 2 In
Eapv - class 0.2
5 % In to 2 In
f - class 0.02
Fnom 15 %
I - class 0.1
0.1 In to 2 In
In / Inc - class 0.1
0.1 In to 2 In
4BK@RR
PFv - class 0.5
PF = 0.5 lag. to 0.5 lead.
Pst / Pit - class 5 (complies IEC 61000-4-15)
0 20
4CHOBK@RR
4nSN4n
4RVKBK@RR
4nSN4n
4SQ
vJ5
4HMSBK@RR
v4n
4MA@BK@RR
4MABK@RR
4GBK@RR
THDu - class 1
THD-Ru - class 1
Ih - class 1
THDi - class 2
THD-Ri - class 1
Msv - class 1
Measurements
Network type
three-phase without neutral or with neutral
Number of power outlets
NQ
Measurement category
5B@S(((($"
! DWBDOSENQSDLONQ@K@FFQDF@SHNM
Measurement method class
($"
TRMS
up to level 50
10 240 Hz (at the nominal network
Measurement sampling frequency
frequency)
Transient sampling frequency
1 MHz that is 1 s
Instantaneous measurements
one second
refresh frequency
Plot refresh frequency
1 60 minutes
Event log refresh frequency
1 60 s
Voltage inputs
Number of voltage inputs
/G@RD
-DTSQ@K
$@QSG
5 "OG@RD-DTSQ@K@MC5
Nominal voltage without TP
AC (phase/phase)
OQHL@QXL@WHLTL
5NKS@FDSQ@MRENQLDQ
J5 "2DBNMC@QX
5 "
Permanent overload
5 "
Frequency
45 65 Hz
Insulation
5B@S(((
Connection
LLOTKKNTSONHMSSDQLHM@KAKNBJ
Current inputs
Number of current inputs
/G@RD
-DTSQ@K
Nominal current without CT
5A
Current transformers
OQHL@QXL@W 2DBNMC@QXNQ
Input consumption
5
Permanent overload
20 A
Intermittent overload
20 In / 1s
Insulation
main
Connection
6 mm2ONHMSEHWDCSDQLHM@KAKNBJ
USB
480
'NRSKNVONVDQL L@W
Device
Memory
Memory size
Environment
,@W
NODQ@SHMFSDLODQ@STQD
,@W
RSNQ@FDSDLODQ@STQD
Humidity
Salt spray
Protection degree
Sine vibrations
Dry heat test (operation and storage)
Wet heat cyclic test
In-operation and storage cold test
Product standards and certification
Product standard
Active energy metering
Reactive energy metering
Measurement standards and certification
Harmonics and interharmonics
measurement method
Flicker measurement method
Supply power quality measurement method
Characteristics of the voltage supplied by public
distribution networks
Communication standards and certification
RS485
Ethernet
Protocol standards and certification
RS485
Ethernet
42!
CAN
DIRIS D600 interface
Display
Dimensions
Dimension
DIRIS O 4i2o-d (4 inputs/2 outputs): inputs
Number
Type
Power supply
Minimum current
,@HMHMRTK@SHNMENQ5 "/G-MDSVNQJ
Leakage path
Number of switchings
DIRIS O 4i2o-d (4 inputs/2 outputs): outputs
Number of operations
Power supply
Number of relays
Leakage path
,@HMHMRTK@SHNMENQ5 "/G-MDSVNQJ
DIRIS O 2i-a inputs (2 analogue inputs)
Number
Scale
Accuracy
,@W
HLODC@MBDNEHMOTSR
,@HMHMRTK@SHNMENQ5 "/G-MDSVNQJ
Leakage path
DIRIS O 2o-a outputs (2 analogue outputs)
Number of outputs
Scale
Load resistance
Accuracy
,@WHLTLBTQQDMS
,@HMHMRTK@SHNMENQ5 "/G-MDSVNQJ
Leakage path
,!
-10 +55 C
-25 70 C
0 75 % RH
EN 60068-2-52
IEC 60259
IEC 60068-2-6
IEC 60068-2-2
($"
IEC 60068-2-1
IEC 61557-12 ed. 1
($"BK@RR
2
($"BK@RR
IEC 61000-4-7
IEC 61000-4-15
($"
EN 50160
TIA-485A
32!!
($$ %
>2DBSHNM
>2DBSHNM
,.#!42
,.#!42
42!
(2.
TFT
WOHWDKR
W
LL
4
phototransistors
v5#"
1 mA
J5 "QLRLHMTSD
LL
108 operations
5
5 "5#"
5 6
2
LL
J5 "QLRLHMTSD
2
0 / 4 20 mA
NEETKKRB@KDVGHBGHR
L
J5 "QLRLHMTSD
LL
2
0 / 4 20 mA
NEETKKRB@KDVGHBGHR
L
25 mA
J5 "QLRLHMTSD
LL
DIRIS N300/N600
Network analysers
Network quality control and analysis system
Terminals
DIRIS N300/N600
CHQHR>>A>>W>B@S
A U X
V1
V2
V3
VN
S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2 S1 S2
I1
I2
I3
IN
CHQHR>>@>>FA>B@S
pulse
output
1
BUS MODULES
OPTIONS
synchronisation
input
pulse
output
2
RJ45
termination resistances
0V -
0n
R = 120
RS485
10 BASE T
100 BASE T
10 BASE T
100 BASE T
RJ45
ETHERNET
RJ45
DISPLAY
DIRIS O
DQDORJXHRXWSXWVbP$
BUS MODULES
OPTIONS
BUS MODULES
OPTIONS
RJ45
RJ45
0n
R = 120
AUX
DIRIS O
CHQHR>>@>>W>B@S
diris_804_a_1_gb_cat
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
10
11
12
In 1
In 2
Out 1
Out 2
DIRIS O
In 3
In 4
Out 1
Out 2
CHQHR>>@>>W>B@S
CHQHR>>@>>W>B@S
DIRIS O
In 1
In 2
DIRIS O
References
DIRIS N300/N600
Reference
Description
#(1(2-
DIRIS N600
Optional
4826 0001
4826 0002
DIRIS D600
Description
Reference
4826 0003
Description
#(1(2.HNCCHFHS@KHMOTSRCHFHS@KNTSOTSR
#(1(2.H@@M@KNFTDHMOTSR
#(1(2.N@@M@KNFTDNTSOTSR
Accessories
Description of accessories
%TRDCHRBNMMDBSRVHSBGDRENQSGDOQNSDBSHNMNEUNKS@FDHMOTSRSXOD1,ONKDR
%TRDCHRBNMMDBSRVHSBGDRENQSGDOQNSDBSHNMNESGD@TWHKH@QXRTOOKXSXOD1,ONKD
MDTSQ@K
%TRDRSXODF&W
Current transformer range
DIRIS O
Reference
4826 0071
4826 0072
4826 0073
To be ordered in multiples of
4
6
10
Reference
5601 0018
5601 0017
6012 0000
See page 488
481
VERTELIS VISION
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
verte_027_a_1_cat
>
>
>
>
Strong points
DIRIS A40
CO
UN
TIS
verte_015_c_1_gb_cat
Function
The first step in your Energy Efficiency
approach, VERTELIS VISION is a
solution composed of an industrial PC
with embedded software (Vertelis box). Its
functionalities can be accessed from any
terminal (PC, pad, etc.) using a standard
Internet browser (Internet Explorer,
Firefox, etc.). Its purpose is to collect data
from DIRIS A, DIRIS N, COUNTIS E and
COUNTIS ECi products for report analysis
and event log or alarm management
purposes.
Communication between the Vertelis
box and the devices is achieved either by
means of the Ethernet network or a serial
RS485 port.
Industry.
Building.
Infrastructure.
Local authority.
E Ci3
RS485
COUNTIS ECi
DIRIS A20
Software
VERTELIS VISION
Ethernet
BO
X
Load curve
Single device
report
PC
>
>
>
>
Turnkey solution.
Report auto-configuration.
Dedicated box.
Display of multi-utility load
curves.
PC
General
measurement
report
Advantages
Turnkey solution
For easy and quick implementation,
our solution includes software
pre-configuration, commissioning
& maintenance.
Report auto-configuration
Only devices, their hierarchy and energy tariffs
should be defined.
Dedicated Industrial PC
The VERTELIS VISION software is pre-installed
in a dedicated industrial PC offering an
enduring and reliable solution.
Display of multi-utility load curves
Key element to check that your contract tariff
is adapted to your consumption.
Functionalities
The VERTELIS VISION solution communicates
with all SOCOMEC products included in the
installation. Thanks to manual or automatic
measurements, instantaneous or logged
data reports are accessible using an internet
browser (Internet Explorer 9, Firefox).
It offers the easy supervision of the
instantaneous energy consumed by furnaces,
manufacturing facilities, office buildings, etc.
482
VERTELIS VISION
Software for Power Monitoring System (PMS)
General characteristics
q Remotely set the date and time, the reset of
indexes and the relay status.
q Show the load or average curves (10, 15,
20 or 30 min) and the related value charts
for DIRIS A40/A60/A80 and
COUNTIS Ci / ECi.
q Set the automatic release of reports.
Check it out
Supervision software
VERTELIS HYPERVIEW
verte_016_a_1_gb_cat
483
VERTELIS VISION
Software for Power Monitoring System (PMS)
Functionalities
General instantaneous reports
Depending on the characteristics of the device selected, the following pages are
available:
- measurements,
- index,
- quality,
- inputs/outputs.
These pages are automatically updated over a defined period of time.Data can
be extracted in *.csv format.
Measurements
verte_016_a_1_gb_cat
The page presenting the measurement general report shows the following data
for the selected device:
- currents,
- phase to neutral voltages,
- phase to phase voltage,
- frequency,
- active, reactive and apparent power per phase,
- power factors,
- impulse metering inputs (DIRIS A).
verte_019_a_1_gb_cat
Measurements
Index
Digital data viewing depends on the device characteristics:
- index of electrical values,
- values ol pulse meters,
- time index,
- index per tariff category.
If data is not available for a specific device or if the network setting is not
compatible, a dash (-) is displayed in the corresponding field.
verte_017_a_1_gb_cat
Quality
For the selected DIRIS A or N, viewing of harmonic curves and distortion rate
charts:
- the 3 currents and the neutral (depending on the network type),
- the phase to phase and phase to neutral voltages
(depending on the network type).
verte_018_a_1_gb_cat
The 'Index' page shows the following data categories for all the DIRIS and
COUNTIS selected:
- partial electrical values,
- total electrical values,
- partial indexes,
- total indexes.
484
verte_020_a_1_gb_cat
Index
VERTELIS VISION
Software for Power Monitoring System (PMS)
Functions
Index report
The VERTELIS VISION software has been designed to analyse the remotely
reported data stored over a selected period, that is:
- statistics and stored data,
- reports of indexes,
- load curves.
They display a chart including the multi-utility indexes with the following
information:
- start value,
- end value,
- consumption difference in the corresponding utility unit,
- consumption difference in a unit common to all utilities,
- average cost over the period.
verte_028_a_1_gb_cat
Log file
Load curves
On this page it is possible to view the graphs and average power value charts or the
indexes over the selected period.
verte_026_a_1_gb_cat
verte_023_a_1_gb_cat
Index
Statistics on Quality
verte_024_a_1_gb_cat
The minimum, average and maximum values per day over the selected period for
analysed data are displayed. Data is displayed under curve and chart format.
Alerts
Different types of notifications can be managed:
- alarms released by the DIRIS A,
- alarms about index differences,
- value alarms about the average, minimum and maximum
currents, voltage and power values reported.
E-mail alerts are sent to users by means of a message server.
Four web pages arealso available to view:
- alarms in progress,
- alarms recorded,
- statistics on a specific alarm,
- alarm notifications.
Tools
verte_025_a_1_gb_cat
It is possible to view the graph and chart of stored measurements over the
selected period.
They give access to the various tools needed for the correct operation of the
software as well as to a specific tool to create curves from the log file.
Example:
Curve for following up electricity consumption, external temperature and load curves
over a selected period.
verte_029_a_1_gb_cat
485
Function
PC
RS232
RS485
OR
programmable
logic controllers
CO
UN
TIS
RS232 / RS485
interface
OR
other systems
inter_141_h_1_gb_cat
If the PC is equipped
with an RS232 port, this
interface will convert
RS232 signal into RS485.
4OSNCDUHBDRB@MAD
connected to the interface
over a distance of 1200 m
at 9600 bauds.
inter_043_a
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
Communication accessories
E Ci3
DIRIS A40
DIRIS A20
COUNTIS ECi
References
Auxiliary power supply Us
Frequency
Reference
50 Hz
4899 0100
Laptop
inter_002_a_2_cat
RS485
USB
CO
UN
TIS
Casing
USB / RS485
inter_142_g_1_gb_cat
Function
E Ci3
COUNTIS ECi
DIRIS A40
DIRIS A20
References
Description of accessories
Reference
4899 0110
R+
R-
LINE-B
inter_011_a
RS422/RS48
REPEATER 5
LINE-A
R-
R+
POWE
T-
T+
N
PC
RS232
OR
programmable
logic controllers
RS485
RS232 / RS485
Interface
PWR RDA
RDB BLA
BLB
T+
CO
UN
TIS
PWR RDA
RDB BLA
BLB
T-
R+
R-
LINE-B
CO
UN
TIS
R+
R-
LINE-A
POWER
T-
T-
RS422/RS485
REPEATER
E Ci3
LINE-A
R+
T+
E Ci3
LINE-B
RS422/RS485
REPEATER
R-
R-
T+
N
RS485
OR
others
systems
RS485
E Ci3
R+
T-
T+
N
RS485
DIRIS A40
CO
UN
TIS
POWER
COUNTIS ECi
DIRIS A40
CO
UN
TIS
E Ci3
COUNTIS ECi
References
Auxiliary power supply Us
95 240 VAC / 110 250 VDC
486
Frequency
Reference
50 Hz
4899 0120
inter_143_h_1_gb_cat
T-
1200 m
T+
< 1200 m
< 31 devices
1200 m
PWR RDA
RDB BLA
BLB
Communication accessories
4RHMFSGDSDKDOGNMDMDSVNQJ13",NCDL1212
Function
PC
RS232
OR
programmable
logic controllers
RS485
Modem
Modem
CO
UN
TIS
OR
other
systems
E Ci3
DIRIS A40
COUNTIS ECi
DIRIS A40
DIRIS A20
RS485
Modem
References
Auxiliary power supply Us
22 240 VAC / 12 48 VDC
Frequency
Reference
50 Hz
4899 0200
inter_144_g_1_gb_cat
inter_014_a
4RHMFSGD$SGDQMDSMDSVNQJ$SGDQMDS1212HMSDQE@BD
Function
PC
Ethernet network
RS485
OR
programmable
logic controllers
OR
other systems
CO
UN
TIS
E Ci3
COUNTIS ECi
DIRIS A40
RS485
CO
UN
TIS
E Ci3
COUNTIS ECi
inter_145_h_1_gb_cat
inter_057_a
DIRIS A40
RS485
CO
UN
TIS
References
E Ci3
COUNTIS ECi
DIRIS A40
Frequency
Reference
50 Hz
4899 0300
The accessories listed in these pages represent a selection from our range.
We can supply many other solutions upon request, such as SHDSL interfaces,
EHAQDNOSHBR12&2,&/12@MCOQNSNBNKBNMUDQSDQHMSDQE@BDR
DIRIS N
DIRIS
A40
DIRIS
A20
COUNTIS
C
E30
CO
C
UNT
TIS
Gateway
TCP/IP
E 50
Gateway
TCP/IP
COUNTIS
C
E40
RS485
COUNTIS
C
E50
PLC
RS485
/
S
M
B TM
C
diris_581_d_1_gb_cat
UNTIS
ECi
DIRIS
A10
COUNTIS
C
E00
487
Measurement devices
from 5 to 5000 A
The solution for
> Industry.
> Service sector.
trafo_012_a_1_cat
trafo_108_a_1_cat
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
Current transformers
Three-phase CT
Strong points
trafo_010_a_1_cat
trafo_077_b_1_cat
Bar-through CT
Split-core CT
Conformity to standards
> IEC 61869-2
> IEC 61439-1
Cable-through CT
Function
Advantages
Other products
SOCOMEC also offer
customised solutions:
> 1 A secondary.
> Double or triple primary ratio.
> Voltage transformer.
> Summation CTs.
Primary wound
moulded case CT
488
Bar or cable-through CT
trafo_015_b_1_cat
trafo_126_a_1_x_cat
trafo_014_b_1_cat
trafo_013_b_1_cat
Bar or cable-through
three-phase CT
Split-core CT
Current transformers
Measurement devices
from 5 to 5000 A
TRB 70
Secondary(1)
5A
5A
2.5 VA
10 A
5A
2.5 VA
15 A
5A
2.5 VA
20 A
5A
2.5 VA
25 A
5A
10 VA
30 A
5A
5 VA
40 A
5A
5 VA
50 A
5A
5 VA
60 A
5A
7.5 VA
75 A
5A
7.5 VA
80 A
5A
7.5 VA
100 A
5A
125 A
5A
7.5 VA
150 A
5A
7.5 VA
Primary
Reference
192T 0505
192T 0510
192T 0515
192T 0520
Class
0.5
T2RB 115
Class
0.5
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
Reference
192T 0521
192T 0522
192T 0523
192T 0524
192T 0525
192T 0530
192T 0540
192T 0550
Class
0.2s
7.5 VA
7.5 VA
7.5 VA
7.5 VA
Reference
TRB 135
Class
0.5
192U 0402
192U 0403
192U 0404
192U 0405
192U 0406
192U 0407
192U 0408
10 VA
192U 0412
192U 0415
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
Reference
192T 0603
192T 0607
192T 0604
192T 0605
192T 0606
192T 0608
192T 0609
192T 0610
192T 0612
192T 0615
Accessories
TRB 60
TRB 70
TRB 135
Description of accessories
Reference
Reference
Reference
DIN-rail mounting
192T 0003
192T 0105
192T 0005(1)
192T 0103
192T 0101(2)
Sealable cover
Output
Self-supplied
230 VAC
24 VDC
TRB 60
TRB 70
Reference
Reference
192Y 0015
192Y 0215
192Y 0115
TRB 70
Output
Reference
Reference
230 VAC
24 VDC
192Y 0255
192Y 0155
Power supply
Certificate of performance
Each class 0.2s current transformer is supplied with an individual certificate of performance, attesting to its accuracy.
489
Current transformers
Measurement devices
from 5 to 5000 A
TRB 70
61
71
71
40
60
50
70
T2RB115
50
67
82
50
70
TRB 135
64
43
70
trafo_037_a_1_x_cat
0.5
LH2P2
50
70
5
40
31
52
65
92
115
85
100
trafo_113_a_1_x_cat
107
trafo_162_a_1_x_cat
trafo_038_a_1_x_cat
trafo_036_a_1_x_cat
85.5
75.5
55
50
112
1 25 to 100 A: M8 x 25
135
45
Primary
wound CT
TRB 60
85.5
H x W x D (mm) 75,5 x 61 x 35
DIN-rail
mounting
T2RB 115
115 x 100 x 70
85 x 135 X 60
yes
no
no
#HLDMRHNMR@QDCHEEDQDMSENQ31!VHSG@MC Q@SHMFR
#HLDMRHNMR@QDCHEEDQDMSENQ31!VHSG@MC Q@SHMFR
35
trafo_166_a_1_x
yes
TRB 70 (1)
85,5 x 71 x 45
60
77
92
50
70
86
116
136
trafo_074_a_1_cat
UH -
+
l
k
+
-
8
7
4
3
IA
6
5
2
1
UA
+
-
490
Converter
H
trafo_071_a_1_gb_cat
Dimensions (mm)
For CT
Height (mm)
Width (mm)
Depth (mm)
Type 1
TRB 60
50.5
60
32.5
Type 2
TRB 70
50
70
43
trafo_060_a_1_x_cat
Associated transducers
Current transformers
Measurement devices
from 5 to 5000 A
Cable-through CT
References
TCA 14
TCA 21
Secondary(1)
40 A
5A
50 A
5A
60 A
5A
1.5
75 A
5A
1.5
80 A
5A
100 A
5A
2.5
125 A
5A
2.5
150 A
5A
2.5
200 A
5A
2.5 VA
250 A
5A
2.5 VA
300 A
5A
2.5 VA
400 A
5A
5 VA
500 A
5A
5 VA
600 A
5A
Primary
Reference
Class
1
192T 1404
192T 1405
192T 1406
192T 1407
1.5 VA
Class
0.5
TCA 22
Class
1
1 VA
1.5 VA
192T 1410
192T 1412
192T 1415
1.5 VA
1.5 VA
1.5 VA
Reference
192T 2006
192T 2007
192T 2008
192T 2010
192T 2012
192T 2015
192T 2020
192T 2016
192T 2017
Reference
1 VA
192T 2022
Class
0.2s
192T 2023
192T 2024
192T 2025
192T 2030
192T 2034
192T 2035(2)
192T 2036(2)
1.5 VA
2.5 VA
3.75 VA
3.75 VA
5 VA
2DBNMC@QX NMQDPTDRS
T2CA 225
Class
1
Reference
192U 2215
192U 2220
192U 2225
192U 2230
192U 2240
192U 2250
192U 2260
1.5 VA
2.5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
10 VA
10 VA
#HLDMRHNMRNE3"
Accessories
TCA 14
TCA 21
TCA 22
T2CA 225
Description of accessories
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
DIN-rail mounting
192T 0006
192T 0006
192T 0020
192T 0021
192T 0007
192T 0003
192T 0023
192T 0024
192T 0105
Sealable cover
(1) For centralising cables within the CT aperture.
Dimensions
TCA 21
45
24
44
30
47
62
K P1
24
44
65
65
21
27
K P1
trafo_039_a_1_x_cat
27
trafo_164_a_1_x_cat
14
trafo_042_a_1_x_cat
22.5
K P1
28.5
48.5
22.5
31
78.5
75.5
61
49.5
65
T2CA 225
trafo_110_a_1_x_cat
45
TCA 22
27
TCA 14
KP1
40
60
Cable-through CT
cable (mm)
H x W x D (mm)
DIN-rail mounting
T2CA 225(1)
TCA 14
TCA 21
TCA 22
14
21
22.5
22.5
65 x 45 x 30
65 x 45 x 30
65 x 49.5 x 35
78.5 x 61 x 35
yes
yes
yes
yes
491
Current transformers
Measurement devices
from 5 to 5000 A
Bar or cable-through CT
References
TCB 17-20
Primary
Secondary(1)
Class
1
50 A
5A
60 A
5A
1 VA
75 A
5A
1 VA
80 A
5A
1.25 VA
100 A
5A
1.5 VA
TCB 26-30
Class
0.5
Reference
Class
1
1 VA
125 A
5A
1.5 VA
150 A
5A
2.5 VA
160 A
5A
2.5 VA
200 A
5A
2.5 VA
250 A
5A
5 VA
192T 2106
192T 2107
192T 2108
192T 2110
192T 2112
192T 2115
192T 2116
192T 2120
192T 2125
192T 2130
192T 2140
1 VA
1.5 VA
1.5 VA
1.5 VA
1.5 VA
1.5 VA
2.5 VA
5 VA
300 A
5A
5 VA
400 A
5A
5 VA
5 VA
500 A
5A
5 VA
600 A
5A
5 VA
750 A
5A
5 VA
5 VA
T2CB 26-30
Class
0.2s
Reference
192T 2305
192T 2306
192T 2307
192T 2308
192T 2310
192T 2312
192T 2315
Reference
TCB 28-30
Class
0.5
Class
1
Reference
1.25 VA
1.5 VA
2.5 VA
192T 2320
192T 2325
192T 2330
192T 2340
192T 2350
192T 2360
192T 2375
1.5 VA
192U 2315
2.5 VA
192U 2320
192U 2325
192U 2330
192U 2340
192U 2350
192U 2360
192U 2375
2.5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
2.5 VA
192T 2408
192T 2410
192T 2412
192T 2415
192T 2420
192T 2425
192T 2430
192T 2440
192T 2450
2.5 VA
2.5 VA
2.5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
TCB 26-40
Primary
Secondary(1)
Class
1
TCB 32-40
Reference
Class
0.5
75 A
5A
100 A
5A
1.5 VA
125 A
5A
2.5 VA
150 A
5A
2.5 VA
160 A
5A
2.5 VA
200 A
5A
2.5 VA
250 A
5A
2.5 VA
300 A
5A
5 VA
400 A
5A
5 VA
500 A
5A
5 VA
600 A
5A
5 VA
750 A
5A
10 VA
800 A
5A
10 VA
1000 A
5A
10 VA
Class
1
1.5 VA
192T 3210
192T 3212
192T 3215
192T 3216
192T 3220
192T 3225
192T 3230
192T 3240
192T 3250
192T 3260
192T 3275
1.5 VA
1.5 VA
2.5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
T2CB 32-40
Reference
Class
0.2s
Reference
192T 4007
192T 4010
192T 4012
192T 4015
192T 4020
192T 4025
192T 4030
192T 4040
192T 4050
192T 4060
192T 4075
192T 4080
192T 4090
2.5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
192U 4020
192U 4025
192U 4030
192U 4040
192U 4050
192U 4060
192U 4075
Accessories
TCB 17-20
TCB 26-30
TCB 26-40
TCB 32-40
Description of accessories
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
DIN-rail mounting
192T 0007
192T 0003
192T 0105
192T 0003
192T 0105
192T 0005
192T 0103
Sealable cover
TCB 26-40
TCB 32-40
Output
Reference
Reference
Reference
Self-supplied
230 VAC
24 VDC
192Y 0015
192Y 0215
192Y 0115
192Y 0015
192Y 0215
192Y 0115
192Y 0035
192Y 0235
192Y 0135
Power supply
TCB 26-40
TCB 32-40
Output
Reference
Reference
Reference
230 VAC
24 VDC
192Y 0255
192Y 0155
192Y 0255
192Y 0155
192Y 0275
192Y 0175
Power supply
492
Current transformers
Measurement devices
from 5 to 5000 A
References
TCB 44-50
TCB 44-63
Secondary(1)
Class
0.5
150 A
5A
1.5 VA
200 A
5A
2.5 VA
250 A
5A
5 VA
300 A
5A
5 VA
400 A
5A
10 VA
500 A
5A
10 VA
600 A
5A
10 VA
750 A
5A
10 VA
800 A
5A
15 VA
1000 A
5A
15 VA
1200 A
5A
15 VA
1250 A
5A
15 VA
1500 A
5A
15 VA
1600 A
5A
15 VA
Primary
Reference
192T 5015
192T 5020
192T 5025
192T 5030
192T 5040
192T 5050
192T 5060
192T 5075
192T 5080
192T 5090
192T 5092
192T 5095
Class
0.5
T2CB 44-63
Reference
1.5 VA
1.5 VA
2.5 VA
5 VA
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
15 VA
15 VA
15 VA
192T 6420
192T 6425
192T 6430
192T 6440
192T 6450
192T 6460
192T 6475
192T 6480
192T 6490
192T 6492
192T 6493
192T 6495
192T 6494
Class
0.2s
5 VA
5 VA
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
Reference
192U 6430
192U 6440
192U 6450
192U 6460
192U 6475
192U 6490
192U 6492
192U 6493
192U 6495
TCB 55-80
TCB 85-100
Secondary(1)
400 A
5A
2.5 VA
500 A
5A
5 VA
600 A
5A
5 VA
750 A
5A
10 VA
800 A
5A
10 VA
1000 A
5A
15 VA
1200 A
5A
15 VA
1250 A
5A
15 VA
1500 A
5A
15 VA
1600 A
5A
15 VA
2000 A
5A
15 VA
2500 A
5A
30 VA
3000 A
5A
30 VA
192T 9675
192T 9680
192T 9690
192T 9692
192T 9693
192T 9695
192T 9694
192T 9696
192T 9697
192T 9698
Primary
Reference
192T 8140
192T 8150
192T 8160
192T 8175
192T 8180
192T 8190
192T 8192
192T 8193
192T 8195
192T 8194
192T 8196
Class
0.5
TCB 100-125
Class
0.5
2.5 VA
5 VA
10 VA
10 VA
15 VA
15 VA
15 VA
30 VA
Reference
Class
0.5
5 VA
10 VA
10 VA
15 VA
30 VA
30 VA
30 VA
Reference
192T 9590
192T 9592
192T 9593
192T 9595
192T 9596
192T 9597
192T 9598
Accessories
TCB 44-50
TCB 44-63
TCB 55-80
TCB 85-100
TCB 100-125
Description of accessories
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Sealable cover
192T 0102
192T 0102
192T 0102
192T 0106
192T 0106
TCB 44-50
TCB 44-63
TCB 55-80
Reference
Reference
Reference
192Y 0045
192Y 0245
192Y 0145
192Y 0045
192Y 0245
192Y 0145
TCB 44-50
TCB 44-63
TCB 55-80
Reference
Reference
Reference
192Y 0285
192Y 0185
192Y 0285
192Y 0185
Output
Self-supplied
230 VAC
24 VDC
Output
230 VAC
24 VDC
493
Current transformers
Measurement devices
from 5 to 5000 A
Bar or cable-through CT
Dimensions
2
6
33
10.5
20.5
30.5
48.25
KP1
trafo_046_a_1_x_cat
KP1
40.5
50.5
65
85
TCB 85-100
50.5
63.5
70
95
TCB 100-125
99
99
96
k
I
k
Bar (mm)
cable (mm)
H x W x D (mm)
DIN-rail mounting
Bar or cable-through CT
cable (mm)
H x W x D (mm)
82
81
95
101
122
172
TCB 17-20
TCB 26-30
T2CB 26-30
TCB 26-40
20 x 5 (x 1)
30 x 10 (x 1) /
20 x 10 (x 12)
30 x 10 (x 1) /
20 x 10 (x 12)
40 x 12 (x 1) /
32 x 18 (x 1)
31
51
10
0
184.8
31
51
trafo_049_a_1_x_cat
82
184.8
trafo_047_a_1_x_cat
60.5
80.5
95
120
Bar or cable-through CT
494
10.5
30.5
5
KP1
k-P1
Bar (mm)
58.5
trafo_048_a_1_x_cat
123.5
10.5
30.5
4
4
12.5
30.5
4
trafo_043_a_1_x_cat
TCB 55-80
98.5
43.25
16
30.5
K P1
10.5
40.5
50
70
105.5
32
K P1
32
40
60
86
75.5
29
K P1
TCB 44-50
71
36.75
k-P1
95
101
121
172
TCB 28-30
TCB 32-40
T2CB 32-40
30 x 10 (x 1)
40 x 10 (x 1) /
30 x 5 (x 12)
40 x 10 (x 1) /
30 x 5 (x 12)
17.5
26
26
26
28
32
32
65 x 49.5 x 50
75.5 x 61 x 48
75.5 x 61 x 48
75.5 x 61 x 48
70 x 49.9 x 68
88.5 x 71 x 58
88.5 x 71 x 58
yes
yes
yes
yes
no
yes
yes
TCB 44-50
TCB 44-63
T2CB 44-63
TCB 55-80
TCB 85-100
TCB 100-125
50 x 12 (x 1) /
40 x 10 (x 12)
63 x 10 (x 1) /
50 x 10 (x 12)
63 x 10 (x 1) /
50 x 10 (x 12)
80 x 10 (x 1) /
60 x 30 (x 1) /
60 x 10 (x 12)
100 x 10 (x 12) /
80 x 10 (x 13)
123 x 30 (x 1) /
100 x 10 (x 13)
44
44
44
55
85
100
98.5 x 86 x 58
105.5 x 96 x 58
105.5 x 96 x 58
123.5 x 120 x 58
184.5 x 172 x 52
184.5 x 172 x 52
18.5
70
30.5
10.5
K P1
30.5
40
60
88.5
trafo_045_a_1_x_cat
trafo_044_a_1_x_cat
32
20.5
75.5
27
20.5
28.5
48.5
15.5
trafo_040_a_1_x_cat
61
40.5
K P1
TCB 26-40
49.9
trafo_055_b_1_x_cat
17.5
65
trafo_041_a_1_x_cat
TCB 28-30
61
12.5
10.5
TCB 17-20
Current transformers
Measurement devices
from 5 to 5000 A
trafo_074_a_1_cat
UH -
+
l
k
4
3
IA
6
5
2
1
UA
+
-
Dimensions (mm)
Converter
trafo_071_a_1_gb_cat
+
-
8
7
trafo_060_a_1_x_cat
Associated transducers
For CT
Height (mm)
Width (mm)
Depth (mm)
Type 1
TCB 26-30
50.5
60
32.5
Type 1
TCB 26-40
50.5
60
32.5
Type 2
TCB 32-40
50
70
43
Type 3
TCB 44-63
50.5
95
43
Type 3
TCB 55-80
50.5
95
43
495
Current transformers
Measurement devices
from 5 to 5000 A
Bar-through CT
References
TBA 60
Primary
Secondary
Class
0.5
Class
1
TBA 80
Reference
192T 7020
192T 7025
192T 7030
192T 7040
192T 7050
192T 7060
192T 7075
192T 7080
192T 7090
192T 7092
192T 7093
192T 7095
192T 7094
2.5 VA
Class
0.5
TBA 100
Reference
Class
0.5
200 A
5A
250 A
5A
2.5 VA
300 A
5A
2.5 VA
400 A
5A
5 VA
500 A
5A
5 VA
600 A
5A
10 VA
750 A
5A
10 VA
800 A
5A
10 VA
1000 A
5A
15 VA
1200 A
5A
15 VA
1250 A
5A
15 VA
1500 A
5A
15 VA
1600 A
5A
15 VA
2000 A
5A
2500 A
5A
30 VA
3000 A
5A
30 VA
4000 A
5A
30 VA
192T 7530
192T 7540
192T 7550
192T 7560
192T 7575
192T 7580
192T 7590
192T 7592
192T 7593
192T 7595
192T 7594
192T 7596
2.5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
10 VA
15 VA
15 VA
15 VA
15 VA
15 VA
15 VA
T2BA 100
Class
0.2s
Reference
192T 8060
192T 8075
192T 8080
192T 8090
192T 8092
192T 8093
192T 8095
192T 8094
192T 8096
192T 8097
192T 8098(1)
192T 8099(1)
5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
10 VA
10 VA
15 VA
15 VA
15 VA
Reference
192U 8092
192U 8093
192U 8095
5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
192U 8096
192U 8097
192U 8098
5 VA
10 VA
10 VA
TBA 103
T2BA 103
Secondary
400 A
5A
2.5 VA
500 A
5A
2.5 VA
600 A
5A
2.5 VA
750 A
5A
2.5 VA
800 A
5A
5 VA
1000 A
5A
10 VA
1200 A
5A
10 VA
1250 A
5A
10 VA
1500 A
5A
15 VA
1600 A
5A
10 VA
2000 A
5A
15 VA
2500 A
5A
15 VA
3000 A
5A
25 VA
4000 A
5A
30 VA
Primary
Reference
192T 9340
192T 9350
192T 9360
192T 9375
192T 9380
192T 9390
192T 9392
192T 9393
192T 9395
192T 9394
192T 9396
Class
0.2s
TBA 127
Class
0.5
Reference
Class
0.5
2.5 VA
2.5 VA
2.5 VA
2.5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
5 VA
192U 9390
192U 9392
192U 9393
192U 9395
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
15 VA
15 VA
15 VA
T2BA 127
Class
0.2s
Reference
192T 9740
192T 9750
192T 9760
192T 9775
192T 9780
192T 9790
192T 9792
192T 9793
192T 9795
192T 9794
192T 9796
192T 9797
182T 9798(1)
182T 9799(1)
Reference
5 VA
192U 9792
192U 9793
192U 9795
5 VA
192U 9796
5 VA
5 VA
1DOK@BDLDMSLNCDK31 ENQSGHRQ@SHMF
Accessories
TBA 60
TBA 80
TBA 100
T2BA 100
TBA 103
T2BA 103
TBA 127
T2BA 127
Description of accessories
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Sealable cover
192T 0102
192T 0102
192T 0102
192T 0102
192T 0102
Power supply
496
TBA 100
Output
Reference
Power supply
192Y 0045
192Y 0245
192Y 0145
Self-supplied
230 VAC
24 VDC
Output
Reference
230 VAC
24 VDC
192Y 0285
192Y 0185
Current transformers
Measurement devices
from 5 to 5000 A
Dimensions
TBA 100 and T2BA 100
TBA 80
4000 A
600 to 3000 A
86
S1
96
S1
S2
S2
50
60.5
88
34
69
96
k-P1
100
100.5
129
S1
38
99
trafo_052_a_1_x_cat
41
17
LP2
trafo_054_a_1_x_cat
17.5
69
175
128
103
150
S2
S1
S2
96.5
k-P1
trafo_059_a_1_x_cat
trafo_050_a_1_x_cat
60
59
55.5
214
31
129
84
117
trafo_082_a_1_x_cat
TBA 60
17.7
42.8
100
17.7
Bar-through CT
TBA 60
TBA 80
TBA 100
T2BA 100
TBA 103
T2BA 103
TBA 127
Bar (mm)
60 x 30
84 x 34
100 x 55
100 x 55
103 x 41
103 x 41
128 x 38
128 x 38
129 x 88 x 78
117 x 96 x 68
167 x 129 x 78
150 x 99 x 58
150 x 99 x 58
175 x 100 x 55
175 x 100 x 55
H x W x D (mm)
T2BA 127
497
Current transformers
Measurement devices
from 5 to 5000 A
TCB3 22-30
Primary
Secondary(1)
Class
1
Class
1
3 x 100 A
3x5A
1 VA
3 x 150 A
3x5A
1.25 VA
3 x 200 A
3x5A
1.5 VA
3 x 250 A
3x5A
2.5 VA
3 x 300 A
3x5A
3.75 VA
3 x 400 A
3x5A
5 VA
3 x 500 A
3x5A
5 VA
3 x 600 A
3x5A
5 VA
Reference
192T 3310
192T 3315
192T 3320
192T 3325
Reference
192T 3425
192T 3430
192T 3440
192T 3450
192T 3460
2.5 VA
Dimensions
TCB3 18-20
TCB3 22-30
22
KP1
L2
L3
20
115
498
trafo_112_a_1_x_cat
5
trafo_111_a_1_x_cat
L1
45
10
65
18
45
35
75
35
TCB3 18-20
L1
KP1
L2
L3
30
150
TCB3 22-30
18
22
20 x 5
30 x 10
115 x 65 x 37
150 x 75 x 37
no
no
Current transformers
Measurement devices
from 5 to 5000 A
References
TCA 13 - 3P
Primary
Secondary(1)
Class
1
3 x 50 A
5A
1 VA
3 x 60 A
5A
1.25 VA
3 x 75 A
5A
1.5 VA
3 x 80 A
5A
1.5 VA
3 x 100 A
5A
2.5 VA
3 x 125 A
5A
2.5 VA
3 x 150 A
5A
2.5 VA
3 x 160 A
5A
2.5 VA
Reference
192T 1905
192T 1906
192T 1907
192T 1908
192T 1910
192T 1912
192T 1915
192T 1916
Dimensions
TCA 13 3P
54
44
7
K/P2
I K
K/P2
K K/P2
trafo_009_a_1_x_cat
45
64
90
K/P1
K/P1
K/P1
13.5
1
Number of modules
6
W (mm)
Mounting
IP65
IP20
105
35 mm DIN-rail
499
Current transformers
Measurement devices
from 5 to 5000 A
Split-core CT
References
TO 23
Primary
Class
1
Secondary
Class
3
TO 58
Reference
192T 4601
192T 4602
192T 4603
192T 4604
192T 4605
192T 4606
Class
0.5
Class
1
TO 812
Reference
Class
0.5
Class
1
TO 816
Reference
Class
0.5
100 A
5A
1.25 VA
150 A
5A
1.5 VA
200 A
5A
250 A
5A
1.5 VA
300 A
5A
3.75 VA
400 A
5A
5 VA
500 A
5A
2.5 VA
600 A
5A
2.5 VA
750 A
5A
2.5 VA
800 A
5A
2.5 VA
1000 A
5A
5 VA
1250 A
5A
7.5 VA
1500 A
5A
7.5 VA
1600 A
5A
10 VA
2000 A
5A
10 VA
2500 A
5A
10 VA
3000 A
5A
15 VA
4000 A
5A
15 VA
5000 A
5A
15 VA
2.5 VA
1.5 VA
2.5 VA
1 VA
192T 4625
192T 4630
192T 4640
192T 4650
192T 4660
192T 4675
192T 4680
192T 4610
1.5 VA
2.5 VA
2.5 VA
2.5 VA
2.5 VA
2.5 VA
2.5 VA
5 VA
192T 4725
192T 4730
192T 4740
192T 4750
192T 4760
192T 4775
192T 4780
192T 4710
192T 4712
192T 4715
Reference
192T 4810
192T 4812
192T 4815
192T 4814
192T 4820
192T 4825
192T 4830
192T 4840
192T 4850
10 VA
10 VA
10 VA
Dimensions
trafo_078_e_1_x_cat
Dimensions (mm)
B
D
Type
A (mm)
B (mm)
C (mm)
D (mm)
E (mm)
TO 23
106
93
58
23
33
TO 58
158
125
58
55
85
TO 812
198
155
58
85
125
TO 816
243
195
79
85
165
Fixed by M5 new
500
Split-core CT
TO 23
TO 58
TO 812
TO 816
H x W x D (mm)
106 x 93 x 58
158 x 125 x 58
198 x 155 x 58
243 x 195 x 75
Current transformers
Measurement devices
from 5 to 5000 A
Summation CT
Reference
Primary
BSA 02
BSA 03
BSA 04
Secondary
Reference
Reference
Reference
192T 0802
5 + 5/5 A
5A
5 + 5 + 5/5 A
5A
5 + 5 + 5 + 5/5 A
5A
192T 0803
192T 0904
Dimensions
BSA 02 et BSA 03
BSA 04
65
55
54
95
122
156
60
Summation CT
BSA 02
BSA 03
BSA 04
H x W x D (mm)
90 x 127 x 57
90 x 127 x 57
136.5 x 156 x 65
no
no
no
DIN-rail mounting
trafo_069_b_1_x_cat
50
80
127
trafo_073_b_1_x_cat
29.5
90
136.5
57
501
Measurement shunts
shunt_005_a_1_cat
shunt_008_a_1_cat
shunt_006_b_1_cat
shunt_007_b_1_cat
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
Measurement devices
Function
SOCOMEC shunts provide indirect measurement of direct current by creating
a standardised voltage drop.
Characteristics
q Voltage drop: 100 mV
for nominal rating.
q Accuracy class: 0.5.
q Permanent overload: 1.2 In.
q
(MRQ@SHMF
q 5 In / 5s rating 600 to 1500 A
q (MRQ@SHMF
References
Rating(1)
1A
4A
6A
10 A
15 A
25 A
40 A
60 A
100 A
150 A
200 A
250 A
300 A
400 A
600 A
1000 A
1500 A
2500 A
4000 A
6000 A
(1) Other ratings : Please consult us.
502
DIN series
Reference
192S 2101
192S 2104
192S 2106
192S 2110
192S 2112
192S 2114
192S 2116
192S 2118
192S 2120
192S 2125
192S 2220
192S 2235
192S 2230
192S 2240
192S 2250
192S 2255
192S 2260
192S 2165
192S 2170
192S 2175
Measurement shunts
Measurement devices
Dimensions
DIN Series: 1 to 25 A
Fig. 1
shunt_011_a_1_x_cat
11 F
30
C
9
135
115
A
H
Rating(1)
1A
4A
6A
10 A
15 A
25 A
40 A
60 A
100 A
150 A
200 A
250 A
300 A
400 A
600 A
1000 A
1500 A
2500 A
4000 A
6000 A
Figure
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
A
90
90
90
90
90
90
123
123
123
123
168
168
168
168
168
188
188
188
188
188
B
28
28
28
28
28
28
33
33
33
33
55
55
55
55
55
65
65
65
65
65
C
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
30
30
40
40
40
60
90
120
120
180
15
15
20
20
20
30
21
30
30
30
48
60
60
60
F
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
15
15
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
H
78
78
78
78
78
78
103
103
103
103
128
128
128
128
128
138
138
138
138
138
30
30
30
30
30
30
30
30
60
60
Fig. 2
Fig. 3
C
E
D
H
A
shunt_010_a_1_x_cat
C
D
shunt_009_a_1_x_cat
H
A
503
Other products
PTI : CT automatic short-circuiter
Use
Conformity to standards
> NF C 15-100
article 473.1.4-556.3.
> GAM EG 13.C
(military standard).
pti_005_a_2_cat
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
Measurement devices
Other regulations
References
Rating (A)
Trigger
voltage
Operating
frequency
Max. differential
voltage
21 VAC
45 400 Hz
600 VAC
25 VAC
45 400 Hz
600 VAC
Reference
4990 0521
4990 0525(1)
Characteristics
Dimensions
H1
IP55
IP20
Connection cross-section
2.5 mm2
Weight
82 g
F
9.6
32
H1
44
I
41
L
34.7
E
47
D1
4.2
pti_003_a_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
5
L
F
D1
2.5
trans_116_a_1_gb_cat
Use
1.5
1
0.5
Primary current (In)
1
3 4 5
References
Rating (A)
504
Secondary
Class 1
Reference
100
1A
150
1A
200
1A
300
1A
400
1A
500
1A
192T 0710
192T 0715
192T 0720
192T 0730
192T 0740
192T 0750
Other products
Measurement devices
References
Products
Reference
4825 0208
4825 0209
Dimensions
trans_117_a_1_x_cat
q
q
q
q
20
6,5
30
3000
10
3000
trafo_057_a_1_cat
References
Primary
1A
5A
10 A
15 A
20 A
25 A
30 A
40 A
50 A
60 A
75 A
100 A
150 A
200 A
250 A
300 A
400 A
500 A
600 A
750 A
800 A
q Output:
- 0-20 mA, 0-10 V (type CTA-VA)
- 4-20 mA and 0-10 V (type CTA-VA4).
q Self-supplied or auxiliary power supply 24 VDC or 230 VAC.
q Dimension: 135 x 80 x 50 mm.
IA
+ 230 V~ / 24 V
- UH
K
L IE < 10 A
trafo_058_b_1_x_cat
0/4-20 mA +
UA 0-10 V +
0-20 mA /
0-10 VDC
Self supplied
0-20 mA /
0-10 VDC
230 VAC
0-20 mA /
0-10 VDC
24 VDC
4-20 mA /
0-10 VDC
230 VAC
4-20 mA /
0-10 VDC
24 VDC
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
192Y 0401
192Y 0402
192Y 0501
192Y 0502
192Y 0503
192Y 0504
192Y 0505
192Y 0801
192Y 0802
192Y 0803
192Y 0804
Reference
on request
192Y 0825
192Y 0830
192Y 0840
192Y 0850
192Y 0601
192Y 0602
192Y 0603
192Y 0604
192Y 0605
192Y 0606
192Y 0607
192Y 0608
192Y 0609
192Y 0610
192Y 0611
192Y 0612
192Y 0615
192Y 0620
192Y 0625
192Y 0630
192Y 0640
192Y 0650
on request
on request
192Y 0875
192Y 0880
192Y 0675
192Y 0680
on request
192Y 0408
192Y 0409
192Y 0410
192Y 0411
192Y 0412
192Y 0415
192Y 0420
192Y 0425
192Y 0430
192Y 0440
192Y 0450
192Y 0460
192Y 0475
192Y 0480
192Y 0507
192Y 0508
192Y 0509
192Y 0510
192Y 0511
192Y 0512
on request
192Y 0520
192Y 0525
192Y 0530
192Y 0540
192Y 0550
192Y 0560
on request
192Y 0580
on request
on request
192Y 0807
on request
192Y 0809
on request
192Y 0811
192Y 0812
192Y 0815
on request
192Y 0902
on request
192Y 0904
192Y 0905
192Y 0906
192Y 0907
192Y 0908
192Y 0909
192Y 0910
192Y 0911
192Y 0912
on request
on request
192Y 0925
192Y 0930
192Y 0940
on request
192Y 0960
192Y 0975
192Y 0980
Applications
Measurement and conversion of the input
value read at the primary of a transformer in a
directly proportional voltage signal.
BTV 25 products are voltage transformers.
Recommendation
Voltage transformers are used specifically for supplying measurement
equipment, therefore it is not recommended to connect other components
which could affect accuracy. This is due to the effect of the phase shift
error. If the consumption is greater than 25 VA, another transformer must
be added.
References
Characteristics
Accuracy class
1%
Dielectric quality
3 kV for 1 min.
Operating frequency
50 - 60 Hz
Permanent overload
1.2 Un
Primary
230 VAC
400 VAC
440 VAC
500 VAC
600 VAC
660 VAC
800 VAC
Connection
Secondary
100 VAC
100 VAC
100 VAC
100 VAC
100 VAC
100 VAC
100 VAC
Power
25 VA
25 VA
25 VA
25 VA
25 VA
25 VA
25 VA
Reference
192M 2020
192M 2030
192M 2044
192M 2050
192M 2060
192M 2066
Please consult us
R
N(S)
A and B : primary connection
112
97
R 3.25
70
83
103
70
96
104
56
100
Primaire
trafo_070_a_1_x_cat
trafo_072_a_1_gb_cat
Dimensions
Secondaire
505
Metering, monitoring
& power quality
Other electrical
measurement devices
Measurement devices
Transducers
trans_071_a_2_cat
They provide conversion of an AC electrical value (A, V, Hz, Cos phi, W, Var)
into a DC signal, with standardised current or voltage.
They are available in surface-mount casings (CS range).
These devices are designed for DIN rail or back plate mounting.
Type CS transducers are available in two sizes:
q 75 mm for current, voltage and frequency converters,
q 150 mm for power or three-phase converters.
Consult us.
Modular transducers
trans_076_a_2_cat
Available in:
q 3-DIN module housings (52.5 mm) for current,
voltage and frequency converters,
q 6-DIN module housings (105 mm) for current (output 4-20 mA),
voltage (output 4-20 mA) converters,
q 9-DIN module housings (157.5 mm) for power or three-phase converters.
Consult us.
amper_033_a_2_cat
freq_002_a_1_cat
freq_003_a_3_cat
amper_027_a_1_cat
506
phase_002_b_3_cat
Analogue meters
Other electrical
measurement devices
Measurement devices
Selector switches
comut_015_b_1_cat
voltm_019_a_2_cat
freq_004_a_2_cat
cosph_001_a_2_cat
amper_032_a_2_cat
Digital meters
They measure all types of electrical values (A, V, Hz, Cos phi, P, Q...).
The range:
q 2 different types of casing: rectangular or square:
- 2 sizes of rectangular casing,
- 2 sizes of square casing.
q direct measurement or connection to a current or voltage transformer,
q 2000-point (3.5 digits) or 20000-point (4.5 digits) display,
q possibility of having 2 or 3 different types of measurement in the same square
casing (AAA-VVV-AVF...),
q multi-indicator version,
q RMS-value.
Consult us.
compt_001_a_2_cat
Hour counters
Often combined with analogue meters in an electrical panel, hour counters count
the total operating time of machines or electrical equipment.
Consult us.
507
Electronic protection
p. 510
p. 512
p. 514
Differential protection
new
new
RESYS M40
RESYS M40R
p. 516
p. 518
new
new
Core balance
transformers type A
p. 520
p. 522
CORPO 213A
RESYS P40
new
SURGYS
G51-PV
SURGYS
G100-F
SURGYS
G140-F
p. 526
p. 528
p. 530
SURGYS
G50-FE
SURGYS
G40-FE
SURGYS
G70
p. 532
p. 534
p. 536
new
n ew
SURGYS
D40
SURGYS
E10
SURGYS
Low current
p. 538
p. 540
p. 542
509
Important:
Sound knowledge of your electrical
network is essential to ensure the
successful outcome of your protection
project.
In fact, the choice of electronic
protection products and their place of
installation depend on:
qSGDSXODNESGDRTOOKXRNTQBD
qSGDKDMFSGNESGDBNMCTBSNQR
qSGDSXOD@MCM@STQDNESGDDKDBSQHB@K
receivers connected to the network.
APPLI 268 A
SITE 538 A
APPLI 146 A
510
SITE 221 A
p. 14
511
Selection Guide
Differential protection
Which
application?
Electronic
protection
Which need?
Applications
new
new
RESYS M40
p. 516
Model
RESYS P40
p. 520
Characteristics
Type of protection DDR
A type
A type
30 mA 30 A
30 mA 30 A
0 10 s
0 10 s
Pre-alarm function
Output contact
Modular
Panel mounting
44
48x48
p. 522
p. 522
p. 522
Tripping threshold
Time setting
Automatic reclosing function
Case
Dimensions (mm)
Accessories
Core balance transformers
&LUFXODUFORVHGWRURLGV,&
512
Selection Guide
Differential protection
Which type of
protection?
Isolated sites
new
RESYS M40R
p. 518
A type
30 mA 30 A
0 10s
2
Modular
44
513
Selection Guide
Protection against overvoltages
Electronic
protection
Which
application?
Applications
Photovoltaic sites
PV DC network
new
Top of installation
Top of installation
n ew
Main switchboard
equipped with sensitive
products
Main switchboard
equipped with sensitive
products
new
G51-PV
p. 526
G100-F
p.528
G100-F
p. 530
G50-FE
p. 532
G50-FE
p. 534
Type
Type 2
Types 1 and 2
Type 1
Types 1 and 2
Types 1 and 2
Mode
MC / MD (*)
MC
MC
MC
MC / MD
TT, TN, IT
TT, TN, IT
TT, TN, IT
TT, TN
400 VAC
400 VAC
400 VAC
400 VAC
1.5 kV
Model
Protection
Characteristics
Nominal voltage Un
Neutral system
Voltage UC
Level of protection UP
2 kV
2.5 kV
1.3 kV
15 kA
40 kA
50 kA
12.5 kA
20 kA
40 kA
100 kA
140 kA
50 kA
40 kA
25 kA
25 kA
12.5 kA
15 kA
Remote signalling
(*)
514
Selection Guide
Which
model?
Which level of
protection?
Which
characteristics?
Protection of RS422/485
connection, T2 digital phone
connection, Ethernet 10baseT
connection
new
G70
p. 536
Bus protection
(Profibus, Fieldbus,
LONworks, Interbus)
new
n ew
D40
p. 538
E10
p. 540
RS-3
p. 542
mA-3/mA-3x2
p. 542
TEL-3
p. 542
Type 2
Type 2
Types 2 and 3
Low currents
Low currents
Low currents
MC
MC / MD (*)
MC / MD (*)
MC / MD
MC / MD
MC / MD
6V
48 V
150 V
8V
53 V
170 V
220 V
TT, TN, IT
400 VAC
1.8 kV
25 V
70 V
30 kA
20 kA
5 kA
5 kA
5 kA
5 kA
70 kA
40 kA
10 kA
20 kA
20 kA
20 kA
515
RESYS M40
The solution for
new
>
>
>
>
resys_083_a_1_cat
Electronic
protection
Strong points
Function
RESYS M40 earth leakage relays associated with a remote trip breaking device (automatic
power breaking), provide the following functions:
- protection against indirect contact,
- limitation of leakage currents.
They also preventively monitor electrical installations via their (configurable) pre-alarm function or
when used as signalling relays.
Applications
Rapid recognition of an insulation fault
increases the availability of the distribution
network by preventing accidental power
cuts and the resulting loss of production.
RESYS M40
RESYS M40
RESYS M40
300 m A
516
BE 2
BE 3
resys_050_d_1_x_cat
Conformity to standards
>
>
>
>
Advantages
Fully configurable
q 2 relays with configurable function (alarm or
OQD@K@QL@S(M
q CITRSLDMSNE(MEQNL
SN
q Time delay 0 to 10 s.
q Positive or negative security configurable by
the user.
q Selection of toroid ratio.
Processes.
Manufacturing.
Oil, gas and petrochemistry.
Energy production.
IEC 60755
IEC 60947-2
IEC 62020
IEC 60364
RESYS M40
Type A differential relays
for motor load break
Front panel
Characteristics
5
6
resys_083x_a_1_cat
(MRDSSHMF
2. Time delay setting.
3. Configuration micro-switches (x4).
4. "ON" LED.
5. "RESET" pushbutton.
6. TRIP alarm LED.
+$#A@QFQ@OGW(M
8. "TEST" pushbutton.
1 2
General characteristics
q RESYS M40 with 2 configurable relays:
- either 2 alarm relays,
- or 1 alarm relay and 1 pre-alarm relay (50 % In).
q Adjustment sensitivity from 0.03 mA to 30 A.
q Time delay 0 to 10 s.
q Tripping accuracy by TRMS measurement.
q Automatic instantaneous tripping at 30 mA.
q Positive or negative security configurable by the user.
q Selection of toroid ratio.
q Automatic permanent relay-toroid connection test.
q Sealable cover.
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
Storage temperature
- 20 + 55 C
- 30 + 70 C
Case
resys_056_a_1_x_cat
85
45
61
Type
30
44
49.5
63.5
modular
Number of modules
2.5
Dimensions W x H x D
44 x 85 x 63.5
IP40
IP20
0.2 4 mm2
Weight
190 g
1 - 2 - 3 : external pushbuttons
5 - 6 - 7 : auxiliary power supplies Us
8 - 9 : SOCOMEC differential toroid connections
10 - 11 : alarm relay 2 or pre-alarm outputs
12 - 13 - 14 : alarm relay 1 output
RESET TEST
50 m max
L
N
Fus. 2 A gG
resys_054_b_1_x_cat
PE
Note: The earth conductor must not pass through the C.T.
For single phase applications, only the live and neutral need to be passed
through the C.T.
Cabling: for distances > 1 m, use twisted pair cable between the unit and C.T.
Do not connect the shield to earth.
9 10 11 12 13 14
230 V 115 V O
RESYS M40
References
RESYS M40
Reference
4941 3723(2)
4941 3740(2)
4941 3602(2)
(1) Other rating: Please consult us. (2) References and characteristics of closed, split core and rectangular toroids: see Core balance transformers type A p. 522.
517
RESYS M40R
new
resys_082_a_1_cat
Electronic
protection
Strong points
Function
RESYS M40R earth leakage relays
associated with a remote trip breaking device
(automatic power breaking and reclosing),
provide the following functions:
- protection against indirect contact,
- limitation of leakage currents.
- reclosing of trip breaking device after
earth leakage detection and power supply
breaking.
Advantages
Fully configurable
q CITRSLDMSNE(MEQNL
SN
q Time delay 0 to 10 s.
Applications
RESYS M40R
518
RESYS M40R
resys_080_b_1_x_cat
Automatic reclosing
This function provides protection, particularly
in isolated sites or for processes requiring
a restart in the event of transient faults
(continuity of service ensured in the absence
of a maintenance team).
The RESYS M40R relay must be combined with an automatic tripping/reclosing breaking device:
- a motorised switch
- a device fitted with an undervoltage coil
- a contactor.
Conformity to standards
> IEC 60755
> IEC 60947
> IEC 62020
RESYS M40R
Type A earth leakage relays
with automatic reclosing
Front panel
resys_078_a_1_x_cat
CITRSLDMS(M
2 - "ON" LED.
1$2$3OTRGATSSNM
4 - TRIP alarm LED.
+$#!@QFQ@OGW(M
6 - "TEST" pushbutton.
7 - Time delay setting.
Characteristics
Auxiliary power supply Us
Frequency
v'Y
"NODQ@SHMFYNMD
0.8 1.15 Us
#"NODQ@SHMFYNMD
0.8 1.05 Us
Max. consumption
5 "6#"
Insulation (according to IEC 60664-1 standard)
Rated insulation voltage
5 "
Rated impulse voltage
J55 "J55 "
Degree of pollution
"K@RR
Threshold values
(MRDSSHMF
Accuracy of tripping
v(M
Domain of network frequency
v'Y
Time delay setting
R
Reclosing
Nb of automatic reclosing attempts
6 max
Time delay between two reclosing
R
Reset of automatic reclosing counter (tCR)
15 min.
Alarm
automatic reset
(6x max, then recording)
manual by pushbutton / using terminal
2
inverter
simple
5 " 5
5 " 5
negative security(1)
positive security (1)
(1) Negative security: relay activated in case of alarm / Positive security: relay not activated in
case of alarm.
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
Storage temperature
- 20 + 55 C
v
"
45
61
85
resys_056_a_1_x_cat
Case
30
44
49.5
63.5
Type
modular
Number of modules
2.5
Dimensions W x H x D
WW
IP40
IP20
0.2 4 mm2
Weight
190 g
L1
L2
L3
N
PE
Fus. 2 A gG
resys_079_a_1_x_cat
RESET TEST
50 m max
L
N
<U
9 10 11 12 13 14
Note: The earth conductor must not pass through the C.T.
For single phase applications, only the live and neutral need to be passed
through the C.T.
Cabling: for distances > 1 m, use twisted pair cable between the unit and C.T.
Do not connect the shield to earth.
230 V 115 V O
RESYS M40R
References
RESYS M40R
Auxiliary power supply Us(1)
Reference
5 "
4941 3724
4941 3741
5 "
(1) Other rating: Please consult us.
519
RESYS P40
The solution for
new
resys_081_a_1_cat
Electronic
protection
RESYS P40
Function
RESYS P40 earth leakage relays associated with a remote trip breaking device (automatic
power breaking), provide the following functions:
- protection against indirect contact,
- limitation of leakage currents.
They also preventively monitor electrical installations via their (configurable) pre-alarm function or
when used as signalling relays.
Advantages
Instantaneous display of permanent
leakage currents.
The LED bargraph provides a real-time display
of fluctuations in leakage currents.
Fully configurable
q 2 relays with configurable function
@K@QLNQOQD@K@QL@S(M
q CITRSLDMSNE(MEQNL
SN
q Time delay 0 to 10 s.
q Positive or negative security configurable
by the user.
q Selection of toroid ratio.
Applications
Rapid recognition of an insulation
fault increases the availability of the
distribution network by preventing
accidental power cuts and the resulting
loss of production.
RESYS P40 are particularly suitable for
insertion in electricity control panels with
withdrawable compartments.
520
RESYS P40
RESYS P40
RESYS P40
resys_051_c_1_x_cat
300 mA
BE 2
BE 3
> Process.
> Manufacturing.
> Oil, gas and petrochemistry.
Strong points
> Fully configurable.
> Tripping accuracy by TRMS
measurement.
> Instantaneous display of
permanent leakage currents.
> Compact and modular case
with LED bargraph.
> Improved immunity to EMC
interferences.
Conformity to standards
>
>
>
>
IEC 60755
IEC 60947-2
IEC 62020
IEC 60364
RESYS P40
Type A earth leakage relays
for motor load break
resys_081x_a_2_cat
Front panel
5
6
7
8
1 2
(MRDSSHMF
2. Time delay setting.
"NMEHFTQ@SHNMLHBQNRVHSBGDRW
4. "ON" LED.
5. "RESET" pushbutton.
6. TRIP alarm LED.
+$#A@QFQ@OGW(M
8. "TEST" pushbutton.
3 4
"G@Q@BSDQHRSHBR
Auxiliary power supply Us
Frequency
v'Y
"NODQ@SHMFYNMD
0.8 1.15 Us
#"NODQ@SHMFYNMD
0.8 1.05 Us
"NMRTLOSHNM
5 "6#"
Insulation (according to IEC 60664-1 standard)
Rated insulation voltage
5 "
Rated impulse voltage
J55 "J55 "
Degree of pollution
"K@RR
Threshold values
(MRDSSHMF
Accuracy of tripping
v(M
Domain of network frequency
v'Y
Time delay setting
4 - 10 s
/1$ + 1,QDK@XSQHOOHMF
(M
'XRSDQDRHRNESGD/1$ + 1,QDK@X
(M
Alarm
Alarm configuration mode
RSNQ@FD@TSNL@SHBQDRDS
Alarm factory setting
storage
Reset
L@MT@KAXOTRGATSSNMTRHMFSDQLHM@K
Output contacts
Number of contacts
2
3XODNE + 1,BNMS@BS
5 " 5
3XODNE + 1,NQ/1$ + 1,BNMS@BS
5 " 5
+ 1,NODQ@SHMFLNCD
ONRHSHUDMDF@SHUDRDBTQHSX(1)
+ 1,NQ/1$ + 1,NODQ@SHMFLNCD
positive security(1)
%@BSNQXRDSSHMFNE + 1,NODQ@SHMFLNCD
negative security
%@BSNQXRDSSHMFNE + 1,NODQ@SHMFLNCD
positive security
(1) Negative security: relay activated in case of alarm / Positive security: relay not activated in
case of alarm.
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
v
"
Storage temperature
v
"
resys_057_b_1_x_cat
48
"@RD
48
18
80
Type
panel mounting
Dimensions W x H x D
48 x 48 x 107
"@RDOQNSDBSHNMHMCDW
IP40
IP20
0.2 4 mm2
Weight
190 g
"TSNTS
45 x 45 mm
L1
L2
L3
N
PE
Fus. 2 A gG
resys_055_b_1_x_cat
RESET TEST
50 m max
Note: 3GDD@QSGBNMCTBSNQLTRSMNSO@RRSGQNTFGSGD"
3
%NQRHMFKDOG@RD@OOKHB@SHNMRNMKXSGDKHUD@MCMDTSQ@KMDDCSNADO@RRDCSGQNTFGSGD"
3
"@AKHMFENQCHRS@MBDRLTRDSVHRSDCO@HQB@AKDADSVDDMSGDTMHS@MC"
3
Do not connect the shield to earth.
L
N
6
(-)
(+)
9 10 11 12
230 V
RESYS P40
References
RESYS P40
Reference
4942 3711(2)
4942 3723(2)
4942 3602(2)
(1) Other rating: Please consult us. (2) References and characteristics of closed, split core and rectangular toroids: see "Core balance transformers type A" p. 522.
Description of accessories
Soft protection cover IP65
Reference
4942 0000
521
>
>
>
>
>
Industry.
Infrastructure.
Non critical buildings.
OEM.
Renewable energy.
tore_016_a_1_cat
tore_015_a_1_cat
Electronic
protection
CORE BALANCE
TRANSFORMER (WR)
new
CORE BALANCE
TRANSFORMER (WS)
Strong points
terre_046_a_1_cat
Function
CORE BALANCE
TRANSFORMER (6IC)
Conformity to standards
The core balance transformers (toroids)
proposed by SOCOMEC meet requirements
in terms of measurement sensitivity and are
suitable for earth leakage protection relays
RESYS M40/P40 and DIRIS A80.
"KNRDCRDQHDR("61@MC3%1NQ
ROKHSBNQDRDQHDR62SXODRRTHS@KKVHQHMF
configurations.
Advantages
A patented cable locator (6IC)
q The SOCOMEC cable locator is a patented
innovation. The cable is perfectly centralised
in the core balance transformer to ensure
accurate measurement and enhanced
immunity to network interferences. It also
enables direct mounting of the core balance
transformer onto the cable.
Implementation
522
PE
N L1 L2 L3
L+ L-
isom_086_b_1_x_cat
PE
isom_087_a_1_x_cat
Characteristics
$KDBSQHB@KBG@Q@BSDQHRSHBR("
Insulation coordination
Insulation coordination
Insulation voltage
800 VAC
Insulation voltage
690 VAC
8 kV
8 kV
Dielectric quality
6 kV
Dielectric quality
6 kV
Degree of pollution
Degree of pollution
6HMCHMFQ@SHN
600 / 1
6HMCHMFQ@SHN
600 / 1
10 A
10 A
Nominal power
20 mVA
Nominal power
50 mVA
Operating temperature
-40 +80 C
Operating temperature
-10 +55 C
Flammability class
UL94V-0
Flammability class
UL94V-0
Dimensions
"KNRDCSNQNHCR("RDQHDR
Dimensions (mm)
A
Weight
(kg)
26
81
M4
0.10
26
103.5
M4
0.13
90
26
125
M5
0.18
75
105
26
142.5
M5
0.22
120
100
150
26
182.5
M6
0.38
253
200
150
175 x 41.2
51
274
M6
0.88
370
300
200
250 x 41.5
50
390
M6
1.72
tore_032_a_1_x_cat
Type
("
53
17.3
27.8
50
("
92
30
50
85
("
102.5
50
50
("
116
80
("
163
("
("
6HCSG
B. Diameter.
C. Distance between fixing centres.
D. Distance between rear fixing brackets.
C
D
1DBS@MFTK@QBKNRDCSNQNHCR61RDQHDR
E. Depth.
F. Height.
G. Diameter of fixing screws.
14
Detail A
2.5
tore_027_f_1_gb_cat
tore_024_a_1_x_cat
I
E
Dimensions (mm)
Type
G
C
Dimensions (mm)
B
Weight
(kg)
61W
70
85
22
46
2.9
61W
25
55
402 240
6.3
61W
28
55
460 285
8.2
175 225
Type
TFR 200 x 500
Weight
(kg)
200
500
140
62
585
285
7.2
523
Dimensions (continued)
2OKHSBNQDSNQNHCR62RDQHDR
45
6.3
Dimensions (mm)
C
Weight
(kg)
80
78
114
145
0.9
80
108
144
145
1.1
80
120
108
144
185
1.4
80
160
108
144
225
2.8
Type
62W
50
62W
80
62W
62W
tore_025_a_1_x_cat
32
32
E
59
References
"KNRDCSNQNHCRSXOD ("RDQHDR
Type
Reference
("
36
15
("
65
30
("
85
50
("
160
80
("
250
120
4950 6015(1)
4950 6030(1)
4950 6050(1)
4950 6080(1)
4950 6120(1)
4950 6200(1)
4950 6300(1)
("
400
200
("
630
300
(1) Toroids for RESYS relays M40 / P40 and DIRIS A80.
1DBS@MFTK@QBKNRDCSNQNHCRSXOD 61@MC3%1RDQHDR
Type
Reference
61W
70 x 175
61W
115 x 305
4795 0717(1)
4795 1130(1)
4795 1535(1)
4795 2050(1)
61W
150 x 350
200 x 500
(1) Toroids for RESYS relays M40 / P40 and DIRIS A80.
Reference
50 x 80
4795 0508(1)
4795 0808(1)
4795 0812(1)
4795 0816(1)
62W
80 x 80
62W
80 x 120
62W
80 x 160
(1) Toroids for RESYS relays M40 / P40 and DIRIS A80.
524
BBDRRNQHDRENQ("SNQNHCR
Cable locator
Description of accessories
Reference
"@AKDKNB@SNQLL
4950 0011
4950 0012
4950 0013
4950 0014
"@AKDKNB@SNQLL
"@AKDKNB@SNQLL
"@AKDKNB@SNQLL
terre_040_a_1_cat
Enables the cables to be centred in the toroids aperture. Use of this accessory allows the core
balance transformer to be directly mounted onto the cables.
Description of accessories
Reference
,NTMSHMFAQ@BJDSLL
4950 0001
4950 0002
4950 0003
4950 0003
4950 0004
4950 0005
,NTMSHMFAQ@BJDSLL
,NTMSHMFAQ@BJDSLL
,NTMSHMFAQ@BJDSLL
,NTMSHMFAQ@BJDSLL
,NTMSHMFAQ@BJDSLL
terre_038_a_1_cat
Mounting bracket
Description of accessories
Reference
4950 0041
terre_042_a_1_cat
Description of accessories
Reference
4950 0020
terre_043_a_1_cat
DIN-rail clip
Description of accessories
Reference
DIN-rail clip
4950 0031
terre_037_a_1_cat
Description of accessories
Reference
4950 0040
terre_041_a_1_cat
525
SURGYS G51-PV
The solution for
new
sgys_076_a_1_cat
Electronic
protection
Strong points
> Monobloc base with plug-in
module.
> Remote signalling.
> New 1500 VDC version.
Function
SURGYS G51-PV surge Protective Device is designed to ensure protection for photovoltaic
supply networks against transient overvoltages. It is compliant with test requirements
UTE 61-740-51 and EN 50-539-11 as well as with installation requirements UTE C 15-712-1.
Advantages
Monobloc base with plug-in module
The SURGYS is supplied complete and ready
for installation. Its Monobloc base is fitted with
replaceable plug-in modules which, at the end
of their service life, can be easily and quickly
replaced without having to disconnect the
Monobloc base.
Remote signalling
The remote plug-in signalling contact allows
alarm report to a supervision station.
New 1500 VDC version
Adapted to the protection of
high power installations.
Applications
sgys_077_a_1_x_cat
526
120
Iscw 15/0
pv 2.2/440
.4
70
SURGYS
G51-PV
120
Iscw 15/0
pv 2.2/440
.4
70
120
Iscw 15/0
pv 2.2/440
.4
70
SURGYS D40
SURGYS G51-PV
Surge arrester - Type 2
for photovoltaic installations
Front panel
Characteristics
Network
Network type
PV voltage UocSTC
5#"5#"5#"5#"5#"
5#"5#"5#"5#"5#"
600 VDC (version 500 V) / 720 VDC (version 600 V) /
5#"UDQRHNM55#"UDQRHNM5
Max. voltage UCPV
1500 VDC (version 1500 V)
Protection characteristics
,"55555
Mode of protection
,#555
J55
Level of protection (Up MD)
4,4 kV (1000 V) / 4,5 kV (1500 V)
J55J55
Level of protection MC (Up MC)
J55J55J55
1000 A
Short circuit current (ISCWPV)
Maximum discharge current
40 kA
RGNBJR(max
Nominal discharge current
15 kA
RGNBJRR(n
Associated characteristics
5
L
Residual current Ic
5L
MR
Response time tr
none
Follow current If
End of life mode
thermal disconnection
Type of disconnection indicator
mechanical
Number of disconnection indicators
1
Remote signalling contact
Contact type
inverter
AC making capacity
0.5 A
DC making capacity
3A
AC nominal voltage
250 VAC
DC nominal voltage
30 VDC
Sustained current
2A
Connection type
plug-in screw terminal
Max. cross-section of terminal connections
1.5 mm2
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
v
"
Storage temperature
v
"
sgys_076x_a_1_cat
4 1. Monobloc base.
2. End of service life indicator.
3. Remote signalling contact.
4. DIN rail mounting.
5. Plug-in module.
Connection
Common mode / differential mode protection
L+
L-
RFXR>>@>>FA>B@S
G51
G51
T : Remote contact
G51
T
12
14
11
12
11
14
Case
D
44
10.6
sgys_063_d_1_gb_cat
Type
monobloc design
LNCTKDRCHLDMRHNMR6W'W#5#"
36 x 90 x 67 mm
LNCTKDRCHLDMRHNMR6W'W#5#"
54 x 90 x 67 mm
LNCTKDRCHLDMRHNMR6W'W#5#"
54 x 90 x 77 mm
IP20
IP20
Case material
UL94-V0 thermoplastic
4 ... 25 mm2
6 ... 25 mm2
61 ( 1000 VDC)
74 ( 1500 VDC)
References
Network voltage
500 VDC
500 VDC
600 VDC
600 VDC
5#"
5#"
1000 VDC
1000 VDC
1500 VDC
1500 VDC
(1) Common mode
Description
without remote signal
with remote signal
without remote signal
with remote signal
without remote signal
with remote signal
without remote signal
with remote signal
without remote signal
with remote signal
No. of poles
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Mode of protection
MC(1)
MC(1)
MC(1)
MC(1)
MC / MD(2)
MC / MD(2)
MC / MD(2)
MC / MD(2)
MC / MD(2)
MC / MD(2)
SURGYS G51-PV
Reference
4982 2500
4982 2501
4982 2530
4982 2531
4982 2510
4982 2511
4982 2520
4982 2521
4982 2540
4982 2541
Description of accessories
Spare plug-in module m-G51 for 500 VDC
Spare plug-in module m-G51 for 600 VDC
2O@QDOKTFHMLNCTKDL&ENQ5#"
Spare plug-in module m-G51 for 1000 VDC
Spare plug-in module m-G51 for 1500 VDC
(1) Common mode
Number of modules
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
3
Mode of protection
MC(1)
MC(1)
MC / MD(2)
MC / MD(2)
MC / MD(2)
Reference
4982 2509
4982 2539
4982 2519
4982 2529
4982 2549
527
SURGYS G100-F
The solution for
new
> Industry.
> All types of buildings
(critical, non critical).
sgys_091_a
Electronic
protection
Strong points
SURGYS G100-F 1 pole
Function
The SURGYS G100-F surge arrester is designed to ensure the protection of your low voltage
distribution installations and your electrical equipment. It acts against industrial operation
overvoltages and overvoltages owing to lightning. This type of surge arrester is particularly
recommended in case of risk of direct impact of lightning strikes.
Advantages
Recommended in case of risk of direct
impact of lightning strikes
Thanks to an admitted impulse current Iimp
(surge 10/350s) of 25 kA,
it is recommended for use
on main switchboards.
Absence of follow current
The multi-varistors technology ensures
there is no follow currents and prevents
from any risk of inadvertent tripping of input
protections.
Thermal disconnection device
Guarantees the end of service life
disconnection of the surge arrester.
Applications
q Upstream location of the distribution surge
arresters.
q TGBT + building protected against lightning
either:
- through lightning conductors
- through mesh cages.
q TGBT in buildings subjected to high level
risk of lightning strikes such as classified
installations, installations located in areas
prone to high density of lightning strikes,
high-rise buildings, presence of antenna
towers, chimneys.
q Sites located at high altitude.
q Distribution board of a building with presence
of Lightning Protection Systems.
Lightning rod
G1
00-
G1
00F
sgys_086_a_1_gb_cat
528
SURGYS
G100-F
SURGYS
E10
Conformity to standards
> NF EN 61643-11
> IEC 61643-11
SURGYS G100-F
Surge arrester - Type 1 and 2
for installations with ligthning conductor and for classified sites
Front panel
Characteristics
4
2
sgys_091x_b_1_cat
Network
Network type
230 / 400 VAC
Neutral systems
TT-TN-IT
400 VAC
Nominal voltage Un
400 VAC
Maximum voltage Uc
Temporary overvoltage at industrial frequency UT
400 VAC
Protection characteristics
2 kV
Level of protection Up
Maximum discharge current (1 shock 8/20 s) Imax
100 kA
40 kA
Nominal discharge current (15 shocks 8/20 s) In
1.5 kV
Residual voltage at Iimp
25 kA
Impulse current (1 shock 10/350 s) Iimp
Mode of protection
common
Associated characteristics
< 1 mA
Residual current Ic
< 25 ns
Response time tr
none
Follow current If
Rated conditional short circuit current Icc
25 kA
Recommended disconnectors
fuses gG 125 A(1)
Type of disconnection indicator
mechanical
Number of disconnection indicators
1
Remote signalling contact
Contact type
inverter
AC making capacity
0.5 A
DC making capacity
2A
AC nominal voltage
250 VAC
DC nominal voltage
30 VDC
Sustained current
2A
Connection type
screw terminal block
Max. cross-section of terminal connections
1.5 mm2
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
-40 +85 C
Storage temperature
-40 +85 C
1. Monobloc base.
2. End of service life indicator.
3. Remote signalling contact.
4. DIN rail mounting.
5. Plug-in modules.
Case
77
sgys_083_a_1_X_cat
90
L/N
36
Type
Dimensions W x H x D in 2 poles
Dimensions W x H x D in 3 poles
Dimensions W x H x D in 4 poles
Case degree of protection
Terminal block degree of protection
Case material
Network connection cross-section
Earth connection cross-section
44
70,8
monobloc design
72 x 90 x 77 mm
108 x 90 x 77 mm
144 x 90 x 77 mm
IP20
IP20
PEI UL94-5VA thermoplastic
4 ... 25 mm2
4 ... 25 mm2
(1) Value complies with article 534.1.5.3 of standard NF C 15100: higher ratings may however
be used if reinforced continuity of service of the lightning rod branch is desired.
Connection
Series arrangement
Parallel arrangement
L1
L2
L3
N
L1
L2
L3
N
L1
L1
L2
L3
N
L2
L3
N
BT network
L/N L/N L/N L/N L/N L/N L/N L/N
11
12
11
14
12
14
sgys_085_a_1_gb_cat
T: Remote signalling
T
sgys_084_a_1_gb
DP
Installation
DP ( 125 A)
BT network
L/N L/N
L/N L/N
L/N L/N
L/N L/N
G100-F
G100-F
G100-F
G100-F
Installation
References
No. of poles
2
3
4
Description of accessories
Spare plug-in module m-G100-F
SURGYS G100-F
Reference
4981 1020
4981 1030
4981 1040
Reference
4981 1019
529
SURGYS G140-F
Surge arrester - Type 1
for installations with ligthning conductor and for classified sites
The solution for
sgys_054_b_1_cat
Electronic
protection
> Industry.
> All types of buildings
FULWLFDOQRQFULWLFDO
Strong points
Function
The SURGYS G140-F surge arrester is designed to ensure the protection of your low voltage
distribution installations and your electrical equipment. It acts against industrial operation
overvoltages and overvoltages owing to lightning.
This type of surge arrester is particularly recommended where there is a risk of direct impact of
lightning strikes.
-$6HLOTKRDBTQQDMS(imp) of 25 kA per pole.
Advantages
Remote signalling
The remote plug-in signalling contact allows
alarm report to a supervision station.
Modular design
Easy assembling.
Applications
q Upstream location of the distribution surge
arresters
q TGBT + building protected against lightning
DHSGDQSGQNTFGKHFGSMHMFBNMCTBSNQR
- through mesh cages.
q TGBT in buildings subjected to high level risk of
lightning strikes such as classified installations,
installations located in areas prone to high
density of lightning strikes, high-rise buildings,
presence of antenna towers, chimneys.
q Sites located at high altitude.
q Distribution board of a building with presence of
Lightning Protection Systems.
Lightning rod
40-
F
G1
40-
SURGYS
D40
530
SURGYS
G140-F
SURGYS
E10
sgys_016_d_1_gb_cat
G1
SURGYS G140-F
Surge arrester - Type 1
for installations with ligthning conductor and for classified sites
General characteristics
Type 1 surge arrester.
Designed to resist discharge linked to direct lightning strike.
Max. discharge current 140 kA.
Protection in common mode.
Thermal disconnection device.
End of service life indicator.
Remote signalling contact.
Absence of follow current.
Possibility of parallel or series arrangement.
%TRDBNLAHM@SHNMRVHSBGQDBNLLDMCDC
%42$1!+."RDDO@FD188).
sgys_054x_b_2_cat
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
q
Front panel
Case
1
3
Characteristics
L
sgys_011_a_1_gb_cat
35
Type
modular
2P dimensions W x H x D
70 x 90 x 67 mm
3P dimensions W x H x D
105 x 90 x 67 mm
Dimensions W x H x D in 4 poles
140 x 90 x 67 mm
IP20
IP20
Case material
polycarbonate UL94-5VA
10 50 mm2
10 50 mm2
Connection
Series arrangement
L1
L2
L3
N
L1
L2
L3
N
Installation
DP ( 125 A)
LV network
sgys_025_b_1_gb_cat
L/N L/N
L/N L/N
L/N L/N
L/N L/N
T: Remote signalling
G140-F
G140-F
G140-F
G140-F
T
11
12
14
Network
Network type
230 / 400 VAC
Neutral systems
TT-TN-IT
400 VAC
Nominal voltage Un
400 VAC
Maximum voltage Uc
Temporary surge in power line frequency UT
400 VAC
Protection characteristics
Level of protection Up
2.5 kV
140 kA
,@WHLTLCHRBG@QFDBTQQDMSRGNBJR(max
50 kA
-NLHM@KCHRBG@QFDBTQQDMSRGNBJRR(n
Residual voltage at Iimp
1.5 kV
25 kA
(LOTKRDBTQQDMSRGNBJR(imp
Mode of protection
common
Associated characteristics
Residual current Ic
< 2 mA
< 25 ns
Response time tr
none
Follow current If
Rated conditional short circuit current Icc
50 kA
Recommended disconnectors
fuses gG 125 A
Type of disconnection indicator
mechanical
Number of disconnection indicators
3
Remote signalling contact
Number of contacts per pole
1
Contact type
inverter
AC making capacity
3A
DC making capacity
2A
AC nominal voltage
125 VAC
DC nominal voltage
30 VDC
Sustained current
2A
Connection type
screw block
Max. cross-section of terminal connections
1.5 mm2
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
v
"
Storage temperature
v
"
12
11
14
(1) Value complies with article 534.1.5.3 of standard NF C 15100: higher ratings may however
be used if reinforced continuity of service of the lightning rod branch is desired.
Parallel arrangement
L1
L1
L2
L3
N
L2
L3
N
sgys_037_a_1_gb_cat
LV network
DP
L/N L/N
L/N L/N
L/N L/N
L/N L/N
G140-F
G140-F
G140-F
G140-F
Installation
References
No. of poles
2
3
4
SURGYS G100-F
Reference
4981 1521
4981 1531
4981 1541
531
SURGYS G50-FE
Surge arrester - Type 1 and 2
for installations with ligthning conductor and for classified sites
new
sgys_090_a
Electronic
protection
> Industry.
> All types of buildings (critical,
non critical).
Strong points
Function
The SURGYS G50-FE surge arrester is designed to ensure the protection of your low voltage
distribution installations and your electrical equipment. It acts against industrial operation
overvoltages and overvoltages owing to lightning. This type of surge arrester is particularly
recommended in case of risk of direct impact of lightning strikes at the main switchboard level,
containing electronic devices sensitive to overvoltages.
Advantages
Recommended in case of risk of direct
impact of lightning strikes
Thanks to an admitted impulse current
Iimp (surge 10/350s) of 12.5kA, it is
recommended for use on main switchboards.
Absence of follow current
The multi-varistors technology ensures
there is no follow currents and prevents
from any risk of inadvertent tripping of input
protections.
Thermal disconnection device
Guarantees the end of service life
disconnection of the surge arrester.
Conformity to standards
> NF EN 61643-11
> IEC 61643-11
Applications
532
Lightning rod
G5
0-F
E
G5
0-F
SURGYS
G50-FE
SURGYS
E10
sgys_089_a_1_gb_cat
SURGYS G50-FE
Surge arrester - Type 1 and 2
for installations with ligthning conductor and for classified sites
Front panel
Characteristics
sgys_090x_a_1_cat
1. Monobloc base
2. End of service life indicator
3. Remote signalling contact
4. DIN-rail mounting
5. Plug-in modules
Case
D
sgys_096_a_1_gb_cat
44
W
70.8
Type
monobloc design
2P dimensions W x H x D
36 x 99 x 77 mm
3P dimensions W x H x D
54 x 99 x 77 mm
Dimensions W x H x D in 4 poles
72 x 99 x 77 mm
IP20
Network
Network type
230 / 400 VAC
Neutral systems
TT-TN-IT
400 VAC
Nominal voltage Un
400 VAC
Maximum voltage Uc
Temporary overvoltage at industrial frequency UT
400 VAC
Protection characteristics
1.3 kV
Level of protection Up
Maximum discharge current (1 shock 8/20 s) Imax
50 kA
12.5 kA
Nominal discharge current (15 shocks 8/20 s) In
1.5 kV
Residual voltage at Iimp
12.5 kA
Impulse current (1 shock 10/350 s) Iimp
Mode of protection
common
Associated characteristics
< 1 mA
Residual current Ic
< 25 ns
Response time tr
none
Follow current If
Rated conditional short circuit current Icc
25 kA
Recommended disconnectors
fuses gG 125 A(1)
Type of disconnection indicator
mechanical
Number of disconnection indicators
1
Remote signalling contact
Contact type
inverter
AC making capacity
0.5 A
DC making capacity
2A
AC nominal voltage
250 VAC
DC nominal voltage
30 VDC
Sustained current
2A
Connection type
plug-in screw terminal
Max. cross-section of terminal connections
1.5 mm2
Operating conditions
Operating temperature
-40 +85 C
Storage temperature
-40 +85 C
Value complies with article 534.1.5.3 of standard NF C 15100: higher ratings may however be
used if reinforced continuity of service of the lightning rod branch is desired.
IP20
Case material
5 25 mm2
5 25 mm2
Connections
Parallel arrangement
L1
L2
L3
N
BT network
DP
sgys_088_b_1_gb_cat
Installation
T : Remote signalling
DP : Protection device
(Fuses)
T
11
12
14
12
11
14
References
No. of poles
2
3
4
Description of accessories
Spare plug-in module m-G50-FE
SURGYS G50-FE
Reference
4981 0520
4981 0530
4981 0540
Reference
4981 0519
533
SURGYS G40-FE
Surge arrester - Type 1 and 2
for installations with lightning conductor and for sensitive receivers
The solution for
sgys_052_b_1_cat
Electronic
protection
> Industry.
> All types of buildings
(critical, non critical).
Strong points
SURGYS G40-FE 2 poles
Function
The SURGYS G40-FE surge arrester is designed to ensure the protection of your low voltage
distribution installations and your electrical equipment. It acts against industrial operation
overvoltages and overvoltages owing to lightning.
This type of Surge Protective Device is particularly recommended in case of risk of direct impact
of lightning strikes at the main switchboard level, containing electronic devices sensitive to
overvoltages.
Conformity to standards
Advantages
Recommended in case of risk of direct
impact of lightning strikes
Thanks to an admitted impulse current (Iimp) of
15 kA (surge 10/350 s), it is suitable for use
on main switchboards.
Varistor / spark-gaps technology
This technology ensures an optimum
OQNSDBSHNMKDUDKKNVUNKS@FD4O
J5
as well as an improved type 1/type 2
coordination.
> NF EN 61643-11
> IEC 61643-11
Applications
q Main switchboard or main distribution panel of a
building, equipped with electronic devices (multifunction measurement devices, PLC, etc.) with
presence of lightning conductors or protection
through meshed cages.
q Main switchboard equipped with electronics
in buildings subjected to high level risk of
lightning strikes such as classified installations,
installations located in areas prone to high
density of lightning strikes, high-rise buildings.
q Main switchboard equipped with PLC, BMS
or CTM, remote monitoring, technical alarms,
modems...
q High-rise buildings safety main switchboard.
q Lift machinery unit located in the higher part of
the building.
q Safety inverter units.
q Main switchboard or remote sites containing
electronics.
Lightning
conductor
G4
0-FE
G4
SURGYS
G40-FE
PLC
534
DIRIS
sgys_017_d_1_gb_cat
0-FE
SURGYS G40-FE
Surge arrester - Type 1 and 2
for installations with lightning conductor and sensitive receivers
General characteristics
Front panel
sgys_052x_b_2_cat
Characteristics
Network
Network type
Neutral systems
Nominal voltage Un
Maximum voltage Uc
Temporary overvoltage at industrial frequency UT
Protection characteristics
Level of protection Up (NF EN 61643-11)
Maximum discharge current (1 shock 8/20 s) Imax
Nominal discharge current (15 shocks 8/20 s) In
Residual voltage atimp
Impulse current (1 shock 10/350 s) Iimp
Mode of protection
Associated characteristics
Residual current Ic
Response time tr
Follow current If
Rated conditional short circuit current Icc
Recommended disconnectors
Type of disconnection indicator
Number of disconnection indicators
5 "
TT-TN
5 "
5 "
5 "
J5
40 kA
20 kA
5
15 kA
common
< 10 A
< 100 ns
none
50 kA
fuses gG 125 A(1)
mechanical
1
1
inverter
3A
2A
5 "
5#"
2A
plug-in screw terminal
1.5 mm2
Operating temperature
-40 +85 C
Storage temperature
-40 +85 C
(1) Value complies with article 534.1.5.3 of standard NF C 15-100: higher ratings may however
be used if reinforced continuity of service of the lightning rod branch is desired.
Case
W
Type
sgys_035_a_1_gb_cat
35
modular
Dimensions W x H x D in 2 poles
70 x 90 x 67 mm
Dimensions W x H x D in 3 poles
105 x 90 x 67 mm
Dimensions W x H x D in 4 poles
140 x 90 x 67 mm
IP20
IP20
Case material
ONKXB@QANM@SD4+5
10 50 mm2
10 50 mm2
Connections
Parallel arrangement
Installation
L/N L/N
L/N L/N
L/N L/N
L/N L/N
G40-FE
G40-FE
G40-FE
G40-FE
T
11
12
11
14
DP
LV network
12
14
sgys_026_b_1_gb_cat
DP ( 125 A)
LV network
L1
L2
L3
N
L1
L2
L3
N
L1
L2
L3
N
L1
L2
L3
N
L/N L/N
L/N L/N
L/N L/N
L/N L/N
G40-FE
G40-FE
G40-FE
G40-FE
Installation
sgys_038_a_1_gb_cat
Series arrangement
References
No. of poles
2
3
4
SURGYS G40-FE
Reference
4981 0420
4981 0430
4981 0440
535
SURGYS G70
Surge arrester - Type 2
for sites frequently struck by lightning
The solution for
sgys_067_a_1_cat
Electronic
protection
> Industry.
> All types of buildings
(critical, non critical).
Strong points
> Monobloc base with plug-in
module.
> Remote signalling.
> End of service life indicator.
Function
The SURGYS G70 surge arrester is designed to ensure reinforced protection of single-phase
and three-phase networks. It acts against industrial operation overvoltages and overvoltages
owing to lightning.
This type of Surge Protective Device is particularly recommended in case of heightened risk of
nearby lightning strikes.
Conformity to standards
> NF EN 61643-11
> IEC 61643-11
Advantages
Monobloc base with plug-in module
The SURGYS is supplied complete and ready
for installation. Its Monobloc base is fitted with
replaceable plug-in modules which, at the end
of their service life, can be easily and quickly
replaced without having to disconnect the
Monobloc base.
Remote signalling
The remote plug-in signalling contact allows
alarm report to a supervision station.
End of service life indicator
End of service life indication for internal
components.
Applications
q
q
q
q
q
sgys_077_a_1_x_cat
SURGYS
G70
536
SURGYS
D40
SURGYS
E10
Customised solutions
> Specific shock and vibration
treatment + tropicalisation
(type W): please consult us.
SURGYS G70
Surge arrester - Type 2
for sites frequently struck by lightning
Front panel
Connections
L1
L2
L3
N
LV network
sgys_067x_a_1_cat
DP
Installation
T : Remote signalling
DP : Protection Device
(fuses)
12
14
11
12
11
14
sgys_027_b_1_gb_cat
4
2
1. Monobloc base
2. End of service life indicator
3. Remote signalling contact
4. DIN-rail mounting
5. Plug-in modules
Characteristics
Network
Network type
Contact type
inverter
Neutral systems
TT-TN-IT
AC making capacity
0.5 A
Nominal voltage Un
400 VAC
DC making capacity
2A
Maximum voltage Uc
400 VAC
AC nominal voltage
250 VAC
400 VAC
DC nominal voltage
30 VDC
Sustained current
2A
Protection characteristics
Level of protection Up
1.8 kV
Connection type
70 kA
1.5 mm2
30 kA
Operating conditions
Mode of protection
common
Operating temperature
-40 +85 C
Storage temperature
-40 +85 C
Associated characteristics
Residual current Ic
< 1 mA
Response time tr
< 25 ns
Follow current If
none
25 kA
Recommended disconnectors
mechanical
(1) Value complies with article 534.1.5.3 of standard NF C 15100: higher ratings may
however be used if reinforced continuity of service of the lightning rod branch is desired.
Case
D
sgys_012_f_1_gb_cat
Type
monobloc design
2P dimensions W x H x D
36 x 90 x 67 mm
3P dimensions W x H x D
54 x 90 x 67 mm
Dimensions W x H x D in 4 poles
72 x 90 x 67 mm
IP20
IP20
Case material
polycarbonate UL94-VO
4 25 mm2
4 25 mm2(1)
44
10.6
60.8
References
SURGYS G70
No. of poles
Reference
4982 1720
4982 1730
4982 1740
Description of accessories
Reference
4982 0719
537
SURGYS D40
Surge arrester - Type 2
for distribution boards
The solution for
sgys_069_a_1_cat
Electronic
protection
> Industry.
> Infrastructure.
> All types of buildings
(critical, non critical).
> OEM.
Strong points
SURGYS D40 2 poles
Function
The SURGYS D40 surge arrester is designed to ensure protection of LV distribution circuits
and equipment against transient overvoltages. It acts against industrial operation overvoltages
and overvoltages owing to lightning.
Conformity to standards
Advantages
Monobloc base with plug-in module
The SURGYS is supplied complete and ready
for installation. Its Monobloc base is fitted with
replaceable plug-in modules which, at the end
of their service life, can be easily and quickly
replaced without having to disconnect the
Monobloc base.
Remote signalling
The remote plug-in signalling contact allows
alarm report to a supervision station.
End of service life indicator
End of life indication for internal components.
Applications
q Power distribution unit (downstream of a main
switchboard).
q Autonomous power supply units such as
generator sets, medium power UPS.
q Machine equipment unit.
sgys_077_a_1_x_cat
SURGYS
G70
538
SURGYS
D40
SURGYS
E10
> NF EN 61643-11
> IEC 61643-11
SURGYS D40
Surge arrester - Type 2
for distribution boards
Front panel
Characteristics
sgys_069x_a_1_cat
Network
Network type
Neutral systems
Nominal voltage Un
Maximum voltage Uc
Temporary overvoltage at industrial
frequency UT
Protection characteristics
1. Monobloc base
2. End of service life indicator
3. Remote signalling contact
4. DIN rail mounting
5. Plug-in module
Case
D
400 VAC
Level of protection Up
44
10.6
sgys_012_f_1_gb_cat
(1) Value complies with article 534.1.5.3 of standard NF C 15100: higher ratings may however
be used if reinforced continuity of service of the lightning rod branch is desired.
Connection
60.8
Type
monobloc design
Dimensions W x H x D in 2 poles
36 x 90 x 67 mm
Dimensions W x H x D in 3 poles
54 x 90 x 67 mm
Dimensions W x H x D in 4 poles
72 x 90 x 67 mm
IP20
L1
L2
L3
N
LV network
IP20
Case material
polycarbonate UL94-V0
4 25 mm2
4 25 mm2
Installation
sgys_072_a_1_fr_cat
DP
T : Telesignalling
DP : Protection device
(Fuses)
T
11
12
14
12
11
14
References
No. of poles
2
3
4
2
4
Description of accessories
Spare plug-in module m-D40
Spare plug-in module m-D40
Neutral systems
TT, TN, IT
TT, TN, IT
TT, TN, IT
TT, TN
TT, TN
Mode of protection
MC(1)
MC(1)
MC(1)
MC(1) / MD(2)
MC(1) / MD(2)
SURGYS D40
Reference
4982 1422
4982 1432
4982 1442
4982 1424
4982 1444
Reference
4982 0419
4982 0418
539
SURGYS E10
Surge arrester - Type 2 and 3
for terminal receivers and sensitive loads
The solution for
sgys_070_a_1_cat
Electronic
protection
> Industry.
> Infrastructure.
> All types of buildings
(critical, non critical).
> OEM.
Strong points
> Monobloc base with plug-in
modules.
> Remote signalling.
Function
SURGYS E10 surge arrester is designed to ensure protection of installations connected to
single-phase, three-phase or DC networks against industrial operation overvoltages.
They act against transient overvoltages owing to lightning.
Advantages
Monobloc base with plug-in modules
The SURGYS is supplied complete and ready
for installation. Its Monobloc base is fitted with
replaceable plug-in modules which, at the end
of their service life, can be easily and quickly
replaced without having to disconnect the
Monobloc base.
Remote signalling
The remote plug-in signalling contact allows
alarm report to a supervision station.
Applications
q AC or DC power distribution unit
(downstream of a main switchboard).
q Protection of electrotechnical equipment
such as motors, switching devices, control
devices...
SURGYS
G70
sgys_042_e_1_x_cat
SURGYS
D40
540
PC
SURGYS
E10
PC
PC
Conformity to standards
> NF EN 61643-11
> IEC 61643-11
SURGYS E10
Surge arrester - Type 2 and 3
for terminal receivers and sensitive loads
Front panel
Characteristics
Network
1. Monobloc base
2. End of service life indicator
3. Remote signalling contact
4. DIN rail mounting
5. Plug-in module
4
2
5
Nominal voltage Un
Maximum voltage Uc
Temporary overvoltage at
industrial frequency UT
Protection characteristics
Cases
D
10.6
sgys_043_d_1_gb_cat
44
W
60.8
Type
Dimensions W x H x D (DC versions)
Dimensions W x H x Din 2 poles (AC version)
Dimensions W x H x Din 3 poles (AC version)
Dimensions W x H x D in 4 poles (AC version)
Case degree of protection
Terminal block degree of protection
Case material
Network connection cross-section
Earth connection cross-section
400 VAC
Network type
sgys_070x_a_1_cat
monobloc design
17.5 x 90 x 67 mm
36 x 90 x 67 mm
54 x 90 x 67 mm
72 x 90 x 67 mm
IP20
IP20
polycarbonate UL 94-V0
1.5 10 mm2 (E10 2p.) /
1.5 16 mm2 (E10 4p.)
4 25 mm2 (E10 2p.) /
4 16 mm2 (E10 4p.)
Connection
AC version
Common mode (MC) and differential mode (MC/MD) protection
L+
L
DP
Installation
T : Remote signalling
DP : Protection device
(Fuses)
T
11
12
14
L/N
12
11
14
sgys_041_a_1_x_cat
sgys_071_a_1_gb_cat
L1
L2
L3
N
LV network
DC version
E10
References
Applications AC
No. of poles Neutral systems Mode of protection
2
TT, TN, IT
MC(1)
3
TT, TN, IT
MC(1)
4
TT, TN, IT
MC(1)
2
TT, TN
MC(1) / MD(2)
4
TT, TN
MC(1) / MD(2)
Spare plug-in module for AC application
Mode of protection
MC(1) / MD(2)
MC(1)
SURGYS E10-AC
Reference
4983 1125
4983 1135
4983 1145
4983 1126
4983 1146
SURGYS E10-AC
Reference
4983 0198
4983 0199
Applications DC
No. of poles
Network voltage
2
12 VDC
2
24 VDC
2
48 VDC
Spare module for DC application
Network voltage
12 VDC
24 VDC
48 VDC
SURGYS E10-DC
Reference
4983 2601
4983 2602
4983 2604
SURGYS E10-DC
Reference
4983 9901
4983 9902
4983 9904
541
new
Processes.
Manufacturing.
Water treatment.
Telecom, Datacom
and broadcasting.
> Data centres.
sgys_093_a
>
>
>
>
sgys_092_a
Electronic
protection
SURGYS RS-3
Strong points
SURGYS mA-3x2
Function
For protection against transient overvoltages of equipment connected to telecommunication and
data transmission networks the SURGYS range includes 3 surge arrester models:
q SURGYS RS-3.
q SURGYS mA-3.
q SURGYS TEL-3.
Conformity to standards
> NF EN 61643-21
> IEC 61643-21
Advantages
NEW
Versions 1 pair or 2 pairs (model x2).
Ultra-compact design if multi-pair protection
is needed.
NEW
Plug-in modules
Rapid maintenance for end of service life
modules.
End of service life indicator
Indication is achieved through line interruption.
542
Direct earthing
Earth bonding is made using a DIN rail
fixing clip.
Common mode / differential mode
protection
The differential mode offers an improved
protection efficiency.
Applications
SURGYS RS-3
SURGYS mA-3
SURGYS TEL-3
q Protection of the
RS422/RS485 connections.
q Digital telephone line T2.
q ETHERNET connection (10 baseT).
q Field bus:
- Profibus (DP, PA, FMS),
- Fieldbus (H1, H2),
- LONworks,
- Interbus,
q Measurement loops, measurement acquisition
cards:
- current loops 0 / 4-20 mA,
- analog signals 0 to 10 V.
q Regulation, control loops.
q RS232 connections.
q Numeris network (RNIS-T0).
q Specialised telephone connections.
Sensor
Communicating
product
Phone line
Line 0 - 20 mA
RTC line
T2 line
SURGYS
RS-3
Connecting
g
bus
Measuring
transducer
SURGYS
TEL-3
SURGYS
RS-3
Modem
sgys_022_f_1_gb_cat
sgys_023_g_1_gb_cat
SURGYS
mA-3
sgys_024_e_1_gb_cat
SURGYS
RS-3
Modem
PC
Front panel
1. Plug-in module
2. Mounting on DIN rail ensuring earthing
3. Connection 1 pair
4. Connection 2 pairs
4
3
sgys_093x_a_1
Version 1 pair
Version 2 pairs
543
Characteristics
SURGYS
RS-3
mA-3
TEL-3
Use
12 V
48 V
Maximum voltage Uc
8V
53 V
170 V
20 MHz
20 MHz
2 kHz
Level of protection Up
30 V
70 V
220 V
Line impedance
50 - 150 Ohms
50 - 150 Ohms
600 Ohms
Characteristics
Operating conditions
2-wire or 4-wire
(x2 version)
Protected configuration
Maximum line intensity
300 mA(1)
20 kA
5 kA
Type of protection
spark-gaps / clamping
diode
End of life
Operating temperature
-40 +85 C
Storage temperature
-40 +85 C
(1) Line current of equipment to be protected greater than 200 mA or other direct current
application: please consult us
Case
Version 1 pair
65
13
Line
sgys_082_a_1_gb_cat
2
90
Type
modular
Dimensions W x H x D
13 x 90 x 65 mm
IP20
IP20
Case material
UL94-V0 thermoplastic
Connection cross-section
Load
Version 2 pairs
68
18
sgys_080_a_1_cat
Line
1
11
DIN
rail
90
10
12
Load
544
Type
modular
Dimensions W x H x D
18 x 90 x 68 mm
IP20
IP20
Case material
UL94-V0 thermoplastic
Connection cross-section
Connections
Version 1 pair
Version 2 pairs
Network
Network
L1
L2
2L1
1L2
1L2
2L2
Shield
Shield
Earth
sgys_081_a_1_gb_cat
sgys_032_ h_1_gb_cat
Earth
Shield
L1
L2
Application
Shield
2L1
1L2
1L2
2L2
Application
References
Versions 1 pair
SURGYS
Protection of high speed data and telephone networks
mA-3
TEL-3
RS-3x2
mA-3x2
TEL-3x2
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
Reference
4986 3020
4986 3021
4987 3420
Description of accessories
RS-3
4986 3029
4987 3421
4985 3170
Versions 2 pairs
RS-3
mA-3
TEL-3
4985 3171
RS-3x2
mA-3x2
TEL-3x2
4987 3429
4985 3179
4986 3028
4987 3428
4985 3178
545
p. 548
Range overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Enclosures
Busbar
For dimensioning
COMBIESTER
p. 550
Steel units
Enclosures
CADRYS
enclosures
CADRYS
DELTA
modular
p. 551
p. 552
Rigid copper
bars
p. 558
Flexible
copper bars
p. 558
new
Distribution
Insulated
copper braids
High power
p. 560
Terminals
p. 582
Mid power
Cable clamps
and cage
terminals
Distribution
blocks
p. 584
p. 586
Busbar
supports
p. 562
Distribution
blocks
Mounting accessories
p. 586
547
Enclosures
& accessories
Range overview
q Sizing a busbar
In addition to the practical guide given
in the following pages, the Mechanical
Systems software allows you to size the
busbar for your panel with the greatest of
ease: It defines the best bar section and
distance between each support for the
electrical characteristics of the panel.
corpo_154_a
p. 562
548
q A specific need?
Our teams can support you in the design
and realisation of special enclosures or
cabinets.
p. 596
Range overview
Enclosure
Busbar
Busbar supports
Copper bars
Copper braids
vign_054_c
Thermal
control
Air conditioning
Ventilation
systems
Heating systems
Mounting accessories
Rails
Profiles
Distribution
Distribution blocks
Terminals
Cable clamps
549
COMBIESTER
Enclosures
Enclosures
& accessories
COMBIESTER
with transparent cover
combi_003_a_1_cat
combi_001_a_1_cat
Strong points
COMBIESTER
constructible version
Conformity to standards
Function
COMBIESTERs are constructible insulated
enclosures. They protect all low voltage
electrical equipment against direct contact.
General characteristics
q a 960C self-extinguishable ability (polyester
glasswool loaded) : 850 C (polycarbonate);
650 C (polyamide).
q Protection degree IP65, IK9.
q Colour RAL 7035 for case and opaque
cover.
Advantages
Safety
These enclosures provide an electrical safety
with double insulation, good resistance to
creepage currents, as well as an excellent
withstanding to climatic conditions and a good
withstanding to chemical agents.
> Safety.
> Extended range.
> Protection degree:
IP65 and IK9.
> Flexibility: assembling.
Extended range
q Monobloc and constructible enclosures.
q 4 dimensions for monobloc enclosures and
CHLDMRHNMRENQBNMRSQTBSHAKDDMBKNRTQDR
q 2 types of sealable covers: transparent or
opaque (polycarbonate).
Available on request
>
>
>
>
550
CADRYS enclosures
Enclosures
kdrys_299_a_1_cat
kdrys_298_a_1_cat
Strong points
CADRYS ST with solid door
> Safety.
> Wide range.
Conformity to standards
> IEC 60439-1
> NF C 15-100
kdrys_419_a_1_cat
Enclosures
& accessories
Available on request
Function
CADRYS wall-mounted enclosures are
intended to include automation or control
equipment.
General characteristics
q Double bar locking.
q Bottom closing plate with pressed neoprene
seal,
q Concealed hinges.
q Earthing screw.
q Door profiles perforated every 25 mm.
q Casing and solid door, polyester epoxy
paint RAL 7035.
q Reversible doors.
Advantages
Safety
q These enclosures ensure electrical safety
with a degree of protection IP55 (casing
edge in channel form, robot positioned
polyurethane seal).
q A folded and welded casing provides an
improved rigidity and a high resistance
to chemicals (carbon steel FE 40 +
70 polyester epoxy paint; stainless steel
304 L brushed and polished).
> Monobloc
CADRYS cabinet
for automation
equipment
and electrical
distribution.
Available on request
> Special paint,
> Specific cutouts (enclosures,
plates...)
> Specific dimensions.
> Enclosures with top and
bottom openings.
Wide range
A wide range is available to meet any
requirement:
q 22 models for the SI range.
q 36 models for the ST range.
q 22 models for the SH range.
q 17 models for the SP range.
551
Enclosures
& accessories
kdrys_418_b_1_cat
kdrys_460_a_1_cat
Strong points
CADRYS DELTA
with integrated PC-workspace
>
>
>
>
>
>
Easy implementation.
Wide range of dimensions.
Reinforced handling feet.
Reversible hinge system.
Hinged rear panel.
Available on request.
CADRYS DELTA
Conformity to standards
Function
CADRYS DELTA enclosures are modular
steel enclosures. They are intended to include
automation or electrical equipment.
Advantages
q Thanks to its galvanised sheet structure,
&$'5<6b'(/7$ ensures the role
of a FARADAY cage, thus reducing
electromagnetic interferences and ensuring
correct earth bonding.
q CADRYS DELTA enclosures are provided
with 100 mm reinforced handling feet which
can be fitted with a bottom panel.
q Single-wing CADRYS DELTA enclosures
have left/right reversible doors requiring no
tools.
552
>
>
>
>
>
IEC 60529
IEC 61439-2
NF C 15-100
NF C 20010
IEC 62208
kdrys_471_b_2_x_cat
3
4
7
Juxtaposition in an L
kdrys_513_a_1_x_cat
kdrys_512_a_1_x_cat
kdrys_511_a_1_x_cat
kdrys_510_a_1_x_cat
kdrys_509_a_1_x_cat
kdrys_508_a_1_x_cat
Juxtaposition in an L
with busbar housings
Juxtaposition in an L with
front and rear doors
553
Busbar housing
q Fits in between the top panel
and the top of the cubicle.
q Takes bars up to 160 mm high.
kdrys_304_a_1_cat
Tripod
The frame elements are assembled
by screwing onto a tripod.
Side panels
q Thanks to a special anchoring
system, the side and back panels
are easily mounted.
q The side panel can be replaced
by a door without the addition
or removal of any accessories.
Door
The door can be reversed without
removing the handle or hinges
in 3 easy steps:
1. Remove the hinge pins.
2. Reversing of the door.
3. Replace the hinge pins.
Handle
q An ergonomic automatic locking
handle that does not require the use
of a key.
This handle cannot be locked with
the door open (CNOMO system).
q When the door is reversed, it is not
necessary to remove the handle.
kdrys_253_a_2_cat
kdrys_431_a_1_cat
kdrys_430_a_1_cat
kdrys_429_a_1_cat
Juxtaposition
The juxtaposition of cubicles side or
back to back is achieved using a kit that
guarantees IP55 sealing.
kdrys_ 407_a_1-_cat
kdrys_406_a_1_cat
Bases
q The bases have 4 removable sides
made of folded 1.2 mm steel.
The angle pieces are 3 mm steel
reinforced by welding.
q They are designed to allow several
bases to be stacked so as to
obtain the height required.
554
kdrys_428_a_1_cat
kdrys_433_a_1_cat
kdrys_432_a_2_cat
Back panel
The back panel can
be replaced by a door
without the addition
or removal of any
accessories.
kdrys_426_a_1_cat
External options
Internal options
Mounting profiles
The perforations in these profiles allow
the positioning of the nuts every 25 mm
or continuously.
kdrys_289_a_1_cat
Kdrys_439_a_1_cat
Kdrys_440_a_1_cat
Nuts
The clip-on nuts fit onto the mounting
profiles and perforated plates whilst also
providing earthing.
Structural profiles
q In 1.75 mm steel double perforated
every 25 mm so as to allow madeto-measure dimensions.
q These profiles allow the direct
mounting of SOCOMEC SBC 10
and 20 bar supports.
Kdrys_281_a_1_cat
Kdrys_442_a_1_cat
Kdrys_441_a_1_cat
Gland plate
q The closing plate is fixed in place by a knurled nut.
q It is tightened manually with no tools required.
Kdrys_282_a_1_cat
kdrys_437_a-1_cat
kdrys_438_a_1_cat
Internal door
q This allows the mounting of control
auxiliaries and measuring devices
protected by a solid
or transparent front
door.
q It is fixed onto the
frame and can be
depth-adjusted at a
pitch of 25 mm.
kdrys_314 _b_2_cat
Solid plate
A system of slides and clips facilitate the
positioning of the plates and holds them in
place during assembly.
kdrys_472_a_1_cat
kdrys_209_a
kdrys_436_a_1_cat
kdrys_435_a_1_cat
kdrys_434_a_1_cat
Perforated plate
q The placing of the plates is facilitated by an anchoring system.
q No intermediate pieces are needed to fix them in place.
555
Enclosures
& accessories
Edgewise mounting
barre_001_a_1_cat
Function
The SOCOMEC rigid copper bars are suitable for providing main or distribution connections.
556
Bar section
l x e (mm)
20 x 4
15 x 5
25 x 5
32 x 5
40 x 5
50 x 5
63 x 5
80 x 5
100 x 5
125 x 5
30 x 10
50 x 10
60 x 10
80 x 10
100 x 10
125 x 10
160 x 10
I
240
220
330
410
500
600
700
900
1100
1300
600
850
1000
1300
1550
1900
2350
II
430
390
590
700
850
1050
1250
1550
1900
2350
1050
1550
1800
2300
2750
3350
4150
III
600
540
800
1000
1200
1450
1800
2200
2650
3250
1450
2150
2400
3200
3850
4650
5800
IIII
750
650
1000
1250
1500
1850
2250
2750
3350
4100
1800
2700
3150
4000
4850
5900
7300
Flat mounting
Number of bars per phase
Bar section
l x e (mm)
20 x 4
15 x 5
25 x 5
32 x 5
40 x 5
50 x 5
63 x 5
80 x 5
100 x 5
125 x 5
30 x 10
50 x 10
60 x 10
80 x 10
100 x 10
125 x 10
160 x 10
I
210
190
280
350
420
510
620
750
900
1100
490
750
850
1100
1350
1600
2000
II
340
310
470
580
700
850
1000
1250
1500
1850
800
1200
1400
1800
2200
2700
3300
III
460
420
600
750
900
1100
1350
1700
2050
2500
1100
1650
1900
2450
2950
3600
4450
IIII
570
510
750
950
1150
1400
1700
2100
2550
3050
1350
2050
2350
3000
3650
4400
5500
References
Solid bars
Reference
Reference
4510 2004
4510 2505
4510 3205
4510 4005
4510 5005
4510 6305
4510 8005
4510 9005
4510 9205
4510 3010
4510 5010
4510 6010
4510 8010
4510 9010
4510 9210
4510 9610
4513 2004
4513 2505
4513 3205
4513 4005
4513 5005
4513 6305
4513 8005
4513 9005
4513 9205
4513 3010
4513 5010
4513 6010
4513 8010
4513 9010
4513 9210
4513 9610
4514 2004(1)
4514 2505(1)
4514 3205(1)
4514 4005(1)
4514 5005(1)
4514 6305(1)
4514 8005(2)
4514 9005(2)
4514 9205(2)
4514 3010(2)
4514 5010(2)
4514 9205(2)
4514 8010(2)
4514 9010(2)
4514 9210(2)
4514 9610(2)
Pre-punched bars
Nb de rows
To be ordered
in multiples of
25 x 5
1750
1.11
50 x 5
1750
2.22
63 x 5
1750
2.80
80 x 5
1750
3.56
100 x 5
1750
4.45
125 x 5
1750
5.56
50 x 10
1750
4.45
60 x 10
1750
5.33
80 x 10
1750
7.11
100 x 10
1750
8.89
125 x 10
1750
10.70
A (mm)
8.2
10.2
12.2
To be ordered
in multiples of
5
5
5
l x e (mm)
0
1
Reference
4511 2505
4511 5005
4511 6305
4511 8005
4511 9005
4511 9205
4511 5010
4511 6010
4511 8010
4511 9010
4511 9210
5
12.
25
l>
25
52
12.
5
12.
12.
Reference
4512 1505
4512 2005
4512 3205
= l=
=
25
barre_002_a_1_x_cat
Reference
Weight (kg/ml)
0.71
1.11
1.42
1.78
2.22
2.80
3.56
4.45
5.56
2.67
4.45
5.33
7.11
8.89
11.11
14.22
L = 5800
To be ordered in
multiples of
5 or 10 bars
barre_003_a_1_x_cat
L = 2900
To be ordered by
multiple1 bar
20
25
M6
=l
=
barre_004_a_1_x_cat
l x e (mm)
20 x 4
25 x 5
32 x 5
40 x 5
50 x 5
63 x 5
80 x 5
100 x 5
125 x 5
30 x 10
50 x 10
60 x 10
80 x 10
100 x 10
125 x 10
160 x 10
L = 1750
To be ordered by
multiple1 bar
Accessories
Use
q Allows the drill-free connection of flexible bars or
cables onto a busbar.
q Connection across 2 bars, 10 mm thick, placed
side by side, 10 mm apart.
q Compatible with busbar supports in the SBC range.
Type
Securing clamp M10
Screw M10
Screw M10
Screw M10
Screw M10
Screw M10
Screw M10
Bar (mm)
all
30
50
60
80
100
125
To be ordered in multiples of
12
100
100
100
100
100
100
Reference
barre_020_a_1_x_cat
5119 4423
5119 4503
5119 4505
5119 4506
5119 4508
5119 4510
5119 4512
557
Enclosures
& accessories
barre_011_a_1_cat
Strong points
> Easy to install.
> Increased safety by the
elimination of crimped
connections.
Conformity to standards
Function
SOCOMEC insulated flexible copper bars are mainly utilised for providing the power
connections between series of distribution busbars and the disconnection devices within an
electrical panel.
The insulated layered copper allows the flexible copper bar to be easily formed to provide a
customised solution.
>
>
>
>
>
Advantages
Available on request
Easy to install
q Compact version.
q High level of flexibility enabling easy
manipulation of the busbar.
q Reduced installation time with the
elimination of terminal lugs and their
crimping.
Characteristics
q Width of 9 to 100 mm.
q Copper layer thickness from 0.8 to 1 mm.
q Length of 2 m.
Conductor
q Layers of electrolytic copper Cu/ETP,
final annealing state.
Insulator
q High temperature co-extruded vinyl
compound on the copper strips
(insulation thickness: 1.5 to 2 mm).
q Self-extinguisher: NFC 32200 and UL 94 V0.
q Continuous temperature withstand: 105 C.
q Shore hardness A: 89 +/- 2.
q ,NCTKDDKNMF@SHNM,O@
q 1DRHRS@MBDSNDKNMF@SHNMLHMH
q Breaking stress: 20 Mpa.
q 3Q@MRUDQR@KUNKTLDQDRHRSHUHSX
q .WXFDMHMCDW
q Scratch and tear resistant.
558
>
>
>
>
Specific lengths.
Halogen-free.
UL.
Please consult us.
References
Implementation
(1)
/DQLHRRHAKD@LODQ@FDENQ3"
L (mm)
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
2000
"
113
140
187
208
142
207
242
304
358
408
228
283
331
374
415
488
380
429
475
557
331
409
591
777
398
490
703
815
915
589
838
1080
715
825
921
1041
1157
874
1119
1220
1393
1543
1211
1343
1833
1993
"
129
188
214
238
189
213
235
191
237
277
347
409
324
378
428
474
558
301
373
435
491
542
722
379
544
787
887
455
730
803
932
1045
780
873
957
1105
1234
943
1052
1187
1321
998
1149
1279
1393
1592
1383
1534
1897
2094
2277
"
143
178
209
238
180
210
237
212
308
455
519
290
421
527
705
335
414
483
708
803
421
520
751
987(1)
723
812
893
749
971
1229
1373
908
1048
1171
1324
1470
1110
1278
1422
1550
1771
1538
1707
1855
2110
2329
2531
To be ordered
in multiples of
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
400
Reference
4518 0902
4518 0903
4518 0904
4518 0905
4518 0906
4518 1303
4518 1304
4518 1305
4518 1306
4518 1502
4518 1503
4518 1504
4518 1506
4518 1508
4518 1510
4518 2002
4518 2003
4518 2004
4518 2005
4518 2006
4518 2008
4518 2010
4518 2402
4518 2403
4518 2404
4518 2405
4518 2406
4518 2408
4518 2410
4518 3202
4518 3203
4518 3204
4518 3205
4518 3206
4518 3208
4518 3210
4518 4002
4518 4003
4518 4004
4518 4005
4518 4006
4518 4008
4518 4010
4518 5003
4518 5004
4518 5005
4518 5006
4518 5008
4518 5010
4518 6303
4518 6304
4518 6305
4518 6306
4518 6308
4518 6310
4518 8003
4518 8004
4518 8005
4518 8006
4518 8008
4518 8010
4518 9004
4518 9005
4518 9006
4518 9008
4518 9010
4518 9012
amc_017_a_1_x_cat
l x N x e (mm)
9 x 2 x 0.8
9 x 3 x 0.8
9 x 4 x 0.8
9 x 5 x 0.8
WW
13 x 3 x 0.5
13 x 4 x 0.5
13 x 5 x 0.5
WW
15.5 x 2 x 0.8
15.5 x 3 x 0.8
15.5 x 4 x 0.8
WW
15.5 x 8 x 0.8
15.5 x 10 x 0.8
20 x 2 x 1
20 x 3 x 1
20 x 4 x 1
20 x 5 x 1
WW
20 x 8 x 1
20 x 10 x 1
24 x 2 x 1
24 x 3 x 1
24 x 4 x 1
24 x 5 x 1
WW
24 x 8 x 1
24 x 10 x 1
32 x 2 x 1
32 x 3 x 1
32 x 4 x 1
32 x 5 x 1
WW
32 x 8 x 1
32 x 10 x 1
40 x 2 x 1
40 x 3 x 1
40 x 4 x 1
40 x 5 x 1
WW
40 x 8 x 1
40 x 10 x 1
50 x 3 x 1
50 x 4 x 1
50 x 5 x 1
WW
50 x 8 x 1
50 x 10 x 1
WW
WW
WW
WW
WW
WW
80 x 3 x 1
80 x 4 x 1
80 x 5 x 1
WW
80 x 8 x 1
80 x 10 x 1
100 x 4 x 1
100 x 5 x 1
WW
100 x 8 x 1
100 x 10 x 1
100 x 12 x 1
400
20
350
25
200
35
100
45
70
559
Enclosures
& accessories
new
Strong points
tress_002_a_1_cat
Conformity to standards
Function
Technical characteristics
Customised solutions
q
q
q
q
q
q
Advantages
Easy to install
q Compact and flexible.
q Length and orientation are easily adapted.
q Pre-mounted connection terminals reduces
installation time.
Wide range of utilisation
q Parallel connections permit currents of up
to 1000 A.
q Adapted to various types of connection
terminals.
q Connection distance from 200 to 800 mm.
560
Compatibility
q With SOCOMEC devices.
q With most circuit-breakers on the market.
References
Connections in parallel
Admissible current at an
ambient temperature of
Facteur de correction
Dimensions
Rated current (no derating)
1
(mm)
2
(mm)
X
Fixing
centres
(mm)
220
200
180
160
140
270
180
160
140
L
e
Thickness Length
(mm)
(mm)
A
Width
(mm)
WQ@SDCBTQQDMSW
20
20
35 C
(A)
Nominal
rating
45 C
(A)
55 C
(A)
20
320
300
180
160
140
20
370
180
160
140
20
420
400
180
160
140
20
180
160
140
20
220
200
280
220
20
270
280
220
20
320
300
280
220
20
370
280
220
20
420
400
280
220
20
420
280
220
272
440
400
320
322
300
440
400
320
372
440
400
320
422
400
440
400
320
440
400
320
622
600
440
400
320
822
800
440
400
320
30
10
274
690
630
30
10
324
300
690
630
30
10
374
690
630
30
10
424
400
690
630
30
10
690
630
30
10
624
600
690
630
30
10
824
800
690
630
Reference
4516 1620
4516 1625
4516 1630
4516 1635
4516 1640
4516 1650
4516 2520
4516 2525
4516 2530
4516 2535
4516 2540
4516 2550
4516 4025
4516 4030
4516 4035
4516 4040
4516 4050
4516 4060
4516 4080
4516 6325
4516 6330
4516 6335
4516 6340
4516 6350
4516 6360
4516 6380
#HLDMRHNMR
X
B1
A
1
C1
C2
160
20
30
12
22
20
30
12
22
400
30
10
12
27
630
30
10
30
12
12
12
32
tress_001_a_1_x_cat
Nominal
rating 45 C A
e
B1
B2
C1
C2
1
2
f
h
(A)
(mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm)
B2
561
Busbar supports
Busbar
sb_077_a_1_cat
sb_103_a_1_cat
Enclosures
& accessories
Insulators
sb_195_a_1_cat
Conformity to standards
sb_084_a_1_cat
> ASEFA/LCIE
Function
SOCOMEC insulating busbar supports
allow the fixation of a copper or aluminium
bar or busbar.
Available on request
Characteristics
Insulators
q Polyester without halogene.
q UL94 VO self-extinguishable.
q Colour red RAL 3002.
q Operating temperature from
- 40C to + 130C.
q Deformation under load temperature
23,#"
q Dielectric constant (ASTM D150): 4/5.
q Arc resistance (ASTM D495): > 180 s.
q 6@SDQ@ARNQOSHNM 23,#
562
Busbar support
q High dielectric strength.
q High mechanical resistance.
q Amagnetism of assembly parts.
q High resistance to damp heat
(supplied "tropicalised").
Stair type supports
q Thermoplastic material.
q VO self-extinguishable.
q Insulation voltage: 1000 V.
Busbar supports
Busbar
Selection guide
Edgewise mounting
Busbar supports with fixed interphase
Icc up to 120 kA
(short circuit current)
Icc up to 50 kA
SB C 10 p. 564
100 A
400 A
500 A
630 A
1000 A
SB C 20
SB C 30
p. 566
p. 568
SB C 10 p. 564
1600 A
2500 A
4000 A
5800 A
7000 A
Nominal current n
SB C ER
p. 570
Icc up to 40 kA
SB C ER Power
p. 571
Icc up to 80 kA
400 A
500 A
630 A
1000 A
1600 A
SB 306 p. 572
2500 A
4000 A
5800 A
7000 A
Nominal current n
SB 7500 p. 573
Icc up to 50 kA
SB P 30 p. 574
Icc up to 80 kA
(1)
(2)
100 A
400 A
(4)
(3)
500 A
630 A
(5)
(6)
1600 A
4. SB E 44 p. 580
5. SB P 10 p. 581
6. SB P 44 p. 581
2500 A
4000 A
5800 A
7000 A
Nominal current n
Icc up to 40 kA
Icc up to 40 kA
563
Busbar supports
Busbar
B
(mm)
160
160
190
190
190
220
160
160
190
190
190
220
220
R bar
Pack
height (mm) qty
25
1
40
1
50
1
60
1
63
1
80
1
25
1
40
1
50
1
60
1
63
1
80
1
100
1
Reference
5024 6304
5024 6309
5024 6310
5024 6312
5024 6313
5024 6317
5024 6504
5024 6509
5024 6510
5024 6512
5024 6513
5024 6517
5024 6518
sb_061_b_2_cat
No. of
poles
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
Bar holder
No. of poles
3
4
Pack
qty
1
1
Reference
5024 9031(1)
5024 9041(1)
Reference
5024 9000
5024 9001
1 or 2 bars of 10 mm
Insulation
voltage (VAC)
800
800
800
800
800
800
800
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
B
(mm)
160
160
190
190
190
220
220
160
160
190
190
190
220
220
R bar
Pack
height (mm) qty
25
1
40
1
50
1
60
1
63
1
80
1
100
1
25
1
40
1
50
1
60
1
63
1
80
1
100
1
Reference
5024 6404
5024 6409
5024 6410
5024 6412
5024 6413
5024 6417
5024 6418
5024 6604
5024 6609
5024 6610
5024 6612
5024 6613
5024 6617
5024 6618
sb_174_a_2_cat
No. of
poles
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
Bar holder
No. of poles
3
4
Pack
qty
1
1
Pack
qty
1
1
Reference
5024 9034(1)
5024 9044(1)
Reference
5024 9000
5024 9001
Bar holder
564
sb_177_a_1_x_cat
sb_094_a_1_x_cat
Accessories
Busbar supports
Busbar
Characteristics
Characteristics of 3 and 4 poles with 5 mm for SB C 10
ax.
775
675
1000
950
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
475
425
625
575
700
675
775
775
800
800
950
975
1000
1000
225
200
300
275
350
325
375
375
400
400
475
475
550
575
175
160
225
225
250
250
300
300
300
300
350
375
400
425
140
125
175
170
200
200
225
225
225
225
225
275
225
325
100
130
125
130
145
130
165
130
170
125
200
125
225
d (mm)
60
60
60
60
60
60
60
60
60
60
60
60
60
60
Iz (A)(1)
330
590
500
850
600
1050
700
1200
700
1250
900
1550
1100
1900
d (mm)
65
90
65
90
65
90
65
90
65
90
65
90
65
90
Iz (A)(1)
sb_021_b_1_gb_cat
peak Isc
rms Isc
Bar x no.
25 x 5 x 1
25 x 5 x 2
40 x 5 x 1
40 x 5 x 2
50 x 5 x 1
50 x 5 x 2
60 x 5 x 1
60 x 5 x 2
63 x 5 x 1
63 x 5 x 2
80 x 5 x 1
80 x 5 x 2
100 x 5 x 1
100 x 5 x 2
Lm
d
Adhering to the maximum distances between two
supports ensures the busbar supports are able to
withstand the given short circuit current values. At
these values, deformation of the copper bars may
occur. These deformations are permitted by standard
IEC 60439-1 as long as they adhere to the insulation
distances.
(1) Admissible nominal current for a temperature in the cabinet of 45C and 80C for the bars.
Other assembly configurations: please consult us.
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
500
525
650
700
725
800
800
900
825
925
975
1000
1000
1000
375
400
475
525
550
600
625
675
625
700
725
850
850
975
275
300
375
400
425
475
475
525
475
550
550
650
650
675
200
200
250
275
300
325
325
350
350
350
400
350
400
350
850
700
1250
850
1550
1000
1800
1050
1850
1300
2300
1550
2750
sb_045_b_1_x_cat
peak Isc
rms Isc
Bar x no.
25 x 10 x 1
25 x 10 x 2
40 x 10 x 1
40 x 10 x 2
50 x 10 x 1
50 x 10 x 2
60 x 10 x 1
60 x 10 x 2
63 x 10 x 1
63 x 10 x 2
80 x 10 x 1
80 x 10 x 2
100 x 10 x 1
100 x 10 x 2
sb_054_b_1_x_cat
(1) Admissible nominal current for a temperature in the cabinet of 45C and 80C for the bars.
Other assembly configurations: please consult us.
Dimensions
Fixed interphase:
q 3 poles 2 x 5, 1 x 10: 75 mm
90
374
Fixed interphase:
q 3 poles 1 bar of 10 mm: 75 mm
2 bars of 10 mm per
pole: 90 mm
sb_178_b_1_x_cat
20
R+66
75
274
350
sb_187_b_1_x_cat
65
R+66
R+66
20
60
274
250
90
250
20
sb_112_e_1_x_cat
250
75
1 or 2 bars of 10 mm
2 bars of 5 mm or 1 bar of 10 mm
q 4 poles 1 or 2 bars of 10 mm
90 mm.
565
Busbar supports
Busbar
No. of
bars
14
14
14
14
14
14
14
14
12
12
12
12
12
12
12
12
14
14
14
14
14
14
14
14
12
12
12
12
12
12
12
12
Thickness of
the bar (mm)
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
B
(mm)
190
190
190
220
220
245
245
280
190
190
190
220
220
245
245
280
190
190
190
220
220
245
245
280
190
190
190
220
220
245
245
280
R bar height
(mm)
50
60
63
80
100
120
125
160
50
60
63
80
100
120
125
160
50
60
63
80
100
120
125
160
50
60
63
80
100
120
125
160
Pack
qty
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Reference
5024 8310
5024 8312
5024 8313
5024 8317
5024 8318
5024 8320
5024 8321
5024 8324
5024 7310
5024 7312
5024 7313
5024 7317
5024 7318
5024 7320
5024 7321
5024 7324
5024 8410
5024 8412
5024 8413
5024 8417
5024 8418
5024 8420
5024 8421
5024 8424
5024 7410
5024 7412
5024 7413
5024 7417
5024 7418
5024 7420
5024 7421
5024 7424
sb_077_a_1_cat
No. of
poles
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
Our advantages
> The details which make a
difference: SB C 20 busbar
supports have threaded holes
which allow a protective
screen to be attached.
The supports are put in place
using threaded rods and M8
nuts.
Bar holder
To be ordered in
multiples of
1
1
No. of poles
3
4
Reference
5024 9032(1)
5024 9042(1)
Type
For bar holder SB C 10 / SB C 20
For bar holder SB C 10 / 20 / 30
To be ordered in
multiples of
1
1
Reference
5024 9000
5024 9001
Bar holder
566
sb_177_a_1_x_cat
sb_093_a_1_x_cat
Accessories
Threaded rods
and M8 nuts.
SB C 20
Threaded holes
Busbar supports
Busbar
Characteristics
Characteristics of 3 and 4 poles with 5 mm for SB C 20
Lm
625
525
600
675
675
600
675
750
700
625
700
775
800
725
800
875
900
850
925
975
1000
975
1000
1000
475
400
450
525
525
450
525
575
550
475
525
600
625
550
625
675
700
650
700
750
800
750
800
825
350
300
325
375
375
325
375
400
375
350
375
425
450
400
450
475
500
475
500
525
575
550
575
575
250
225
250
275
275
250
275
300
275
250
275
325
325
300
325
350
375
350
375
400
425
400
425
425
225
200
225
250
250
225
250
275
250
225
250
275
300
275
300
325
350
325
350
375
400
375
400
400
200
175
200
225
225
200
225
250
225
200
225
250
250
250
275
300
300
275
300
325
350
325
350
350
175
155
175
175
200
175
175
200
200
175
200
200
225
200
225
250
250
225
250
275
300
275
300
300
150
130
145
160
165
145
165
175
170
150
170
175
175
175
175
200
200
200
200
225
250
225
250
250
sb_021_b_1_x_cat
Bar x no.
50 x 5 x 1
50 x 5 x 2
50 x 5 x 3
50 x 5 x 4
60 x 5 x 1
60 x 5 x 2
60 x 5 x 3
60 x 5 x 4
63 x 5 x 1
63 x 5 x 2
63 x 5 x 3
63 x 5 x 4
80 x 5 x 1
80 x 5 x 2
80 x 5 x 3
80 x 5 x 4
100 x 5 x 1
100 x 5 x 2
100 x 5 x 3
100 x 5 x 4
125 x 5 x 1
125 x 5 x 2
125 x 5 x 3
125 x 5 x 4
ax.
d
(mm) Iz (A)(1)
90
600
90
1050
90
1450
90
1850
90
700
90
1200
90
1700
90
2150
90
700
90
1250
90
1800
90
2250
90
900
90
1550
90
2200
90
2750
90
1100
90
1900
90
2650
90
3350
90
1300
90
2350
90
3 250
90
4100
d
Adhering to the maximum distances between two
supports ensures the busbar supports are able to
withstand the given short circuit current values. At
these values, deformation of the copper bars may
occur. These deformations are permitted by standard
IEC 60439-1 as long as they adhere to the insulation
distances.
sb_063_a_1_x_cat
peak Isc
rms Isc
(1) Admissible nominal current for a temperature in the cabinet of 45C and 80C for the bars.
Other assembly configurations: please consult us.
Bar x no.
50 x 10 x 1
50 x 10 x 2
60 x 10 x 1
60 x 10 x 2
63 x 10 x 1
63 x 10 x 2
80 x 10 x 1
80 x 10 x 2
100 x 10 x 1
100 x 10 x 2
125 x 10 x 1
125 x 10 x 2
160 x 10 x 1
160 x 10 x 2
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
925
850
1000
925
1000
950
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
675
600
725
675
750
675
850
775
950
850
1000
925
1000
950
500
450
550
500
550
500
625
575
700
625
800
675
900
700
450
400
500
450
525
475
575
525
650
575
725
625
825
650
400
350
450
400
450
400
525
475
575
525
650
550
725
575
350
300
375
350
375
350
425
400
475
425
550
475
625
475
275
250
300
275
325
275
350
325
400
350
450
400
500
400
d
(mm) Iz (A)(1)
90
850
90
1550
90
1000
90
1800
90
1050
90
1890
90
1300
90
2300
90
1550
90
2750
90
1900
90
3350
90
2350
90
4150
sb_045_b_1_x_cat
peak Isc
rms Isc
(1) Admissible nominal current for a temperature in the cabinet of 45C and 80C for the bars.
Other assembly configurations: please consult us.
Dimensions
sb_067_c_1_x_cat
386
Fixed interphase:
q 3 poles: 110 mm
40
90
sb_066_c_1_x_cat
R + 80
350
40
R+80
350
110
386
q 4 poles: 90 mm
567
Busbar supports
Busbar
Thickness of
the bar (mm)
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
10
Pack
B
R bar
(mm) height (mm) qty
190
50
1
190
60
1
190
63
1
190
70
1
220
80
1
220
100
1
245
120
1
245
125
1
280
160
1
325
200
1
190
50
1
190
60
1
190
63
1
190
70
1
220
80
1
220
100
1
245
120
1
245
125
1
280
160
1
325
200
1
Reference
5024 5310
5024 5312
5024 5313
5024 5315
5024 5317
5024 5318
5024 5320
5024 5321
5024 5324
5024 5325
5024 5510
5024 5512
5024 5513
5024 5515
5024 5517
5024 5518
5024 5520
5024 5521
5024 5524
5024 5525
sb_173_a_2_cat
No.
of
Insulation
poles voltage (VAC)
3
1000
3
1000
3
1000
3
1000
3
1000
3
1000
3
1000
3
1000
3
1000
3
1000
4
1000
4
1000
4
1000
4
1000
4
1000
4
1000
4
1000
4
1000
4
1000
4
1000
Bar holder
Pack
qty
1
5024 9033(1)
For enclosure D
(mm)
Pack
qty
Reference
Min 600
5024 9001
No. of poles
3/4
Reference
Bar holder
568
sb_180_a_1_x_cat
sb_122_b_1_x_cat
Accessories
Busbar supports
Busbar
Characteristics
Characteristics of 3 and 4 poles with 10 mm for SB C 30
1000
1000
725
1000
1000
825
1000
1000
850
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
900
550
1000
1000
625
1000
1000
650
1000
1000
750
1000
1000
900
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
800
650
400
875
725
450
900
725
450
1000
825
550
1000
925
650
1000
1000
750
1000
1000
900
1000
925
725
600
475
300
650
525
325
675
550
350
750
625
400
825
675
475
925
750
550
1000
750
675
1000
700
525
550
450
275
600
500
300
600
500
325
675
575
375
750
625
425
850
675
525
925
700
625
1000
625
500
475
400
225
525
425
275
550
450
275
600
500
325
675
550
375
750
600
450
825
625
550
900
550
425
400
325
200
450
375
225
450
375
225
500
425
275
575
475
325
625
500
375
700
525
475
750
475
375
350
275
175
375
300
175
375
300
200
425
350
225
475
400
275
525
425
325
575
425
375
625
400
300
sb_021_b_1_x_cat
Bar x no.
50 x 10 x 1
50 x 10 x 2
50 x 10 x 3
60 x 10 x 1
60 x 10 x 2
60 x 10 x 3
63 x 10 x 1
63 x 10 x 2
63 x 10 x 3
80 x 10 x 1
80 x 10 x 2
80 x 10 x 3
100 x 10 x 1
100 x 10 x 2
100 x 10 x 3
125 x 10 x 1
125 x 10 x 2
125 x 10 x 3
160 x 10 x 1
160 x 10 x 2
160 x 10 x 3
200 x 10 x 1
200 x 10 x 2
200 x 10 x 3
ax.
d
(mm) Iz (A)(1)
130
850
130
1550
130
2150
130
1000
130
1800
130
2500
130
1050
130
1850
130
2600
130
1300
130
2300
130 3 200
130
1550
130
2750
130
3250
130
1900
130
3350
130
4650
130
2350
130
4150
130
5800
130
2850
130
5050
130
7000
d
Adhering to the maximum distances between two
supports ensures the busbar supports are able to
withstand the given short circuit current values. At
these values, deformation of the copper bars may
occur. These deformations are permitted by standard
IEC 60439-1 as long as they adhere to the insulation
distances.
sb_162_a_1_x_cat
peak Isc
rms Isc
Lm
(1) Admissible nominal current for a temperature in the cabinet of 45C and 80C for the bars.
Other assembly configurations: please consult us.
Dimensions
525
40
R + 80
sb_157_d_1_x_cat
560
R + 80
130
185
sb_146_d_1_x_cat
40
525
560
Fixed interphase:
q 3 poles: 185 mm
q 4 poles: 130 mm
Our advantages
> The details which make a difference SB C 30 busbar supports
have threaded holes which allow a protective screen to be
attached.
569
Busbar supports
Busbar
Length
Quantity
6(1)
8(1)
6(1)
8(1)
To be
ordered
in multiples
of
8
8
4
4
2(1)
5025 5100
(1)
4
4
4
4
4
1
5025 5124
5025 5125
5025 5126
5025 5128
5025 5120
5025 5130
380
480
580
780
2000
525
2
2(1)
2(1)
2(1)
1(1)
Reference
5025 5105
5025 5105
5025 5110
5025 5110
sb_206_a_1_x_cat
No.
Thickness of of
Description of accessories the bar (mm) poles
Slot for 5 mm bars
5
3
Slot for 5 mm bars
5
4
Slot for 10 mm bars
10
3
Slot for 10 mm bars
10
4
Rod kit (bar height 25 to 200
mm)
380 mm profile
480 mm profile
580 mm profile
780 mm profile
2 m profile
Profile for Prisma cabinet(2)
Order guide
q With three poles, order: 6 x studs, 2 x rods,
2 x profiles.
q With four poles, order: 8 x studs, 2 x rods,
2 x profiles.
(1) Quantity necessary to make 1 busbar support
(2) Kit of 2 profiles and 4 square fixings.
Characteristics
Bar x no.
50 x 5 x 1
50 x 5 x 2
50 x 5 x 3
63 x 5 x 1
63 x 5 x 2
63 x 5 x 3
80 x 5 x 1
80 x 5 x 2
80 x 5 x 3
100 x 5 x 1
100 x 5 x 2
100 x 5 x 3
125 x 5 x 1
125 x 5 x 2
125 x 5 x 3
50 x 10 x 1
50 x 10 x 2
63 x 10 x 1
63 x 10 x 2
80 x 10 x 1
80 x 10 x 2
100 x 10 x 1
100 x 10 x 2
125 x 10 x 1
125 x 10 x 2
475
450
525
550
525
625
625
625
725
725
750
875
850
900
1000
975
950
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
350
325
400
425
400
475
475
475
550
550
575
650
650
675
800
700
675
725
700
750
750
800
800
850
850
275
250
300
325
300
350
375
375
425
425
425
450
500
500
500
400
400
425
400
450
425
475
450
500
500
175
200
200
200
200
225
225
225
225
225
225
250
250
250
200
200
200
200
225
225
225
225
250
250
Lm
ax.
d min.
(mm)
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
(1)
Iz (A)
600
1050
1450
700
1250
1800
900
1250
2200
1100
1900
2650
1300
2350
3250
850
1550
1050
1850
1300
2300
1550
2750
1900
3350
sb_021_b_1_x_cat
peak Isc
rms Isc
Adhering to the maximum distances between two supports ensures the busbar supports are able to withstand
the given short circuit current values. At these values,
deformation of the copper bars may occur. These deformations are permitted by standard IEC 60439-1 as long
as they adhere to the insulation distances.
(1) Admissible nominal current for a temperature in the cabinet of 45C and 80C for the bars.
Other assembly configurations: please consult us.
Dimensions
Enclosure (mm)
400
500
600
800
d
A
570
75
10.8
R
R+73
5.8
sb_198_a_1_x_cat
75
d
A
sb_199_a_1_x_cat
A (mm)
380
480
580
780
R
R+73
Mounting
q 1 to 3 bars, 5 mm thick, per pole.
q 1 or 2 bars, 10 mm thick, per pole.
q Interphase distance: min 75 mm and max 200 mm.
q Use 2 rods positioned symmetrically on the outside
of the poles or between the outermost poles.
Busbar supports
Busbar
Description of accessories
Slot for 5 mm bars
Slot for 5 mm bars
Slot for 10 mm bars
Slot for 10 mm bars
Rod kit (bar height 25 to 200 mm)
380 mm profile
480 mm profile
580 mm profile
780 mm profile
2 m profile
Profile for Prisma cabinet(2)
Length
380
480
580
780
2000
525
To be
ordered
in multiples
Quantity
of
Reference
(1)
6
8
5025 5205
8(1)
8
5025 5205
6(1)
4
5025 5210
8(1)
4
5025 5210
2(1)
4
5025 5100
2(1)
4
5025 5124
2(1)
4
5025 5125
2(1)
4
5025 5126
2(1)
4
5025 5128
4
5025 5120
1(1)
1
5025 5130
Order guide
q With three poles, order: 6 x studs,
2 x rods, 2 x profiles.
q With four poles, order: 8 x studs,
2 x rods, 2 x profiles.
(1) Quantity necessary to make 1 busbar support
(2) Kit of 2 profiles and 4 square fixings.
Characteristics
peak Isc
rms Isc
Bar x no.
50 x 5 x 1
50 x 5 x 2
50 x 5 x 3
63 x 5 x 1
63 x 5 x 2
63 x 5 x 3
80 x 5 x 1
80 x 5 x 2
80 x 5 x 3
100 x 5 x 1
100 x 5 x 2
100 x 5 x 3
125 x 5 x 1
125 x 5 x 2
125 x 5 x 3
80 x 10 x 1
80 x 10 x 2
100 x 10 x 1
100 x 10 x 2
125 x 10 x 1
125 x 10 x 2
160 x 10 x 1
160 x 10 x 2
175
200
225
225
250
250
250
300
300
300
350
350
375
425
525
525
575
550
600
600
675
675
140
165
130
150
115
135
165
175
200
200
225
225
225
275
250
275
325
300
300
300
300
325
325
375
375
155
175
135
160
175
200
200
200
250
250
250
275
250
250
250
250
275
275
325
325
160
175
175
175
200
200
225
225
200
175
200
200
225
225
250
250
Lm
ax.
d min.
(mm)
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
75
(1)
Iz (A)
600
1050
1450
700
1250
1800
900
1550
2200
1100
1900
2650
1300
2350
3250
1300
2300
1550
2750
1900
3350
2350
4150
d
Adhering to the maximum distances between two supports ensures the busbar supports are able to withstand
the given short circuit current values. At these values,
deformation of the copper bars may occur. These deformations are permitted by standard IEC 60439-1 as long
as they adhere to the insulation distances.
Dimensions
A (mm)
380
480
580
780
Enclosure (mm)
400
500
600
800
10.8
d
A
5.8
R
R+73
75
sb_198_a_1_x_cat
R
R+73
75
sb_199_a_1_x_cat
Mounting
q 1 to 3 bars, 5 mm thick, per pole.
q 1 or 2 bars, 10 mm thick, per pole.
q Interphase distance: min 75 mm and max 200 mm.
q Use 2 rods positioned symmetrically on the outside
of the poles or between the outermost poles.
d
A
571
Busbar supports
Busbar
Insulation voltage
(VAC)
No. of
bars
To be
ordered in
multiples of
SB 205
1000
13
100
SB 306
1000
13
160
Reference
5022 5110
5023 6110
48 kA
63 kA
82 kA
114 kA
152 kA
165 kA
rms Isc
23 kA
30 kA
39 kA
52 kA
69 kA
75 kA
L max.
sb_152_a_1_x_cat
Characteristics
d min.
(mm) Iz (A)(1)
Support
Bar x no.
SB 205
100 x 10 x 1
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
125
1550
SB 205
100 x 10 x 2
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
125
2750
SB 205
100 x 10 x 3
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
125
3850
SB 306
160 x 10 x 1
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
175
2350
SB 306
160 x 10 x 2
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
175
4150
SB 306
160 x 10 x 3
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
175
5800
d min.
Mounting
q SB 205: 1 to 3 bars of max. width 100 mm.
q SB 306: 1 to 3 bars of max. width 160 mm.
(1) Admissible nominal current for a temperature in the cabinet of 45C and 80C for the bars.
Other assembly configurations: please consult us.
Dimensions
99
124
35
9 11
4,5
=
8
=
75
572
5
20
100
sb_176_a_1_x_cat
sb_175_a_1_x_cat
38
38
11
35
Busbar supports
Busbar
QSB 7500 Multipolar flat mounting busbar supports with fixed interphase
No. of
poles
Insulation voltage
(VAC)
Pack qty
Reference
1000
40-50
1000
40-50
5027 5310
5027 5410
sb_136_a_3_cat
References
Characteristics
Max. L (distance between centres of supports in mm) for
peak Isc
24 kA
48 kA
63 kA
82 kA
114 kA
152 kA
rms Isc
12 kA
23 kA
30 kA
39 kA
52 kA
69 kA
50 x 5 x 1
1000
1000
950
725
525
450
75
600
50 x 5 x 2
1000
1000
1000
1000
975
850
75
1050
d (mm)
Iz (A)
L max.
sb_153_b_1_x_cat
Bar x no.
Dimensions
J
T1
T2
35
75
52.5
11
295
38
35
75
52.5
11
J
T1
M8
T2
75
sb_149_a_1_x_cat
38
220
13
7
No. of poles
75
573
Busbar supports
Busbar
Reference
sb_123_a_3_cat
5023 0310
5023 0410
Mounting bracket
Description of accessories
2 mounting brackets for SB P 30
To be ordered in multiples of
1
Reference
To be ordered in multiples of
25
25
25
Reference
5024 9002
sb_210_a_1_cat
sb_211_a_1_cat
No. of poles
3
4
5119 4601
5119 4602
5119 4603
Characteristics
d = 123 mm
peak Isc
rms Isc
Bar x no.
50 x 5 x 1
63 x 5 x 1
80 x 5 x 1
80 x 5 x 2
100 x 5 x 1
100 x 5 x 2
100 x 5 x 3
50 x 10 x 1
50 x 10 x 2
63 x 10 x 1
63 x 10 x 2
80 x 10 x 1
80 x 10 x 2
80 x 10 x 3
100 x 10 x 1
100 x 10 x 2
100 x 10 x 3
525
525
500
500
525
525
525
525
500
500
525
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
225
225
225
225
225
225
225
225
225
225
225
200
200
175
175
200
200
200
200
175
200
200
175
175
175
175
175
175
175
175
175
175
175
130
130
125
125
130
135
130
130
125
125
130
d (mm)
123
123
123
123
123
123
123
123
123
123
123
Iz (A)
600
700
900
1550
850
1550
1050
1850
1300
2 300
3 200
sb_160_a_1_x_cat
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
L max.
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
800
800
800
800
775
775
775
800
800
800
800
800
800
800
775
775
775
475
475
475
475
450
450
450
475
475
475
475
475
475
475
450
450
450
350
350
350
350
325
325
350
350
350
350
350
350
350
350
325
350
350
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
300
275
275
275
275
250
250
250
275
275
275
275
275
275
275
250
250
275
200
200
200
200
175
175
175
200
200
200
200
200
200
200
175
175
175
d (mm)
185
185
185
185
185
185
185
185
185
185
185
185
185
185
185
185
185
Iz (A)
Mounting
q 3 poles: 1 to 3 bars of max. width 100 mm per
pole, fixed interphase of 185 mm,
q 4 poles: 1 to 3 bars of max. width 80 mm
per pole, fixed interphase of 123 mm.
1100
1900
2650
1550
2750
3850
77,5
123
123
36
55
40
525
560
574
123 77,5
40
36
55
185
185
525
560
sb_154_c_1_x_cat
Dimensions
sb_200_a_1_x_cat
peak Isc
rms Isc
Bar x no.
50 x 5 x 1
63 x 5 x 1
80 x 5 x 1
80 x 5 x 2
50 x 10 x 1
50 x 10 x 2
63 x 10 x 1
63 x 10 x 2
80 x 10 x 1
80 x 10 x 2
80 x 10 x 3
Busbar supports
Busbar
Insert M
Depth
D (mm)
Diameter
E (mm)
Pack qty
Reference
20
M4
19
20
M6
19
25
M6
21
30
M6
33
30
M8
33
35
M6
33
35
M8
33
35
M10
33
40
M8
10
40
40
M10
10
40
45
M8
10
41
45
M10
10
41
50
M8
14
46
50
M10
14
46
50
M12
14
46
60
M10
14
50
65
M10
18
55
70
M12
25
55
5031 2004
5031 2006
5031 2506
5031 3006
5031 3008
5031 3506
5031 3508
5031 3510
5031 4008
5031 4010
5031 4508
5031 4510
5031 5008
5031 5010
5031 5012
5031 6010
5031 6510
5031 7012
sb_104_a_2_cat
References
Characteristics
sb_105_a_1_x_cat
Peak
5500
5500
5500
11000
11000
16000
16000
16000
21500
21500
21500
21500
21500
21500
21500
27000
27000
27000
Max.
tightening
torque
Tention
(Nm)
170
9
190
8
370
12
650
22
800
40
720
25
900
42
800
44
1200
50
1100
60
1200
55
1100
65
1800
60
1700
70
13000
130
1600
85
1600
90
1500
135
Insert M
M4
M6
M6
M6
M8
M6
M8
M10
M8
M10
M8
M10
M8
M10
M12
M10
M10
M12
Mechanical
characteristics
(daN)
Flexion
70
100
170
200
360
230
380
320
620
620
550
550
650
650
660
560
750
750
Height
H (mm)
20(1)
20
25
30
30
35
35
35
40
40
45
45
50
50
50
60
65
70
Nominal
Insulation
voltage (V) voltage (VAC)
AC/DC
50 Hz 1 min
500
3000
500
3000
500
3000
1000
6000
1000
6000
1400
9000
1400
9000
1400
9000
2000
12000
2000
12000
2000
12000
2000
12000
2000
12000
2000
12000
2000
12000
2400
12000
2400
12000
2400
12000
(1) Admissible nominal current for a temperature in the cabinet of 45C and 80C for the bars.
Other assembly configurations: please consult us.
575
Busbar supports
Busbar
Depth
D (mm)
5
5
5
5
8
8
14
14
16
Diameter
E (mm)
14
14
20
20
32
32
46
46
50
Length
W (mm)
10
10
10
10
15
30
25
30
25
Pack qty
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Reference
5038 1604
5038 1605
5038 2505
5038 2506
5038 3508
5038 3510
5038 5008
5038 5010
5038 6010
sb_106_a_2_cat
Height
H (mm)
16
16
25
25
35
35
50
50
60
Diameter
E (mm)
14
14
14
20
32
32
46
46
38
Length
W (mm)
10
10
10
10
15
30
25
30
25
Pack qty
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Reference
5039 1604
5039 1605
5039 2505
5039 2506
5039 3508
5039 3510
5039 5008
5039 5010
5039 6010
sb_107_a_2_cat
Height
H (mm)
16
16
25
25
35
35
50
50
60
(VAC)
50 Hz 1 min
3000
3000
3000
3000
9000
9000
12000
12000
12000
Peak
5500
5500
11000
11000
16000
16000
21500
21500
27000
Flexion
100
100
180
180
380
320
650
650
560
L
sb_058_b_1_x_cat
Insert M
M4
M5
M5
M6
M8
M10
M8
M10
M10
Nominal
voltage (V)
AC/DC
500
500
500
500
1400
1400
2000
2000
2400
Height
H (mm)
16
16
25
25
35
35
50
50
60
Max.
tightening
torque
Tention
(Nm)
150
3
150
6
400
6
400
12
900
42
800
44
1800
60
1700
70
1600
85
Mechanical
characteristics (daN)
Insulation voltage
Headless screw
References
576
Thread
M6
M8
M6
M8
M6
M8
M8
M10
M12
To be ordered in
multiples of
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
20
Reference
5032 2006
5032 2008
5032 2506
5032 2508
5032 3006
5032 3008
5032 4008
5032 4010
5032 5012
sb_121_a_2_cat
Length (mm)
20
20
25
25
30
30
40
40
50
Busbar supports
Busbar
L max.
d min.
sb_164_a_1_x_cat
> The indicated short-circuit withstand values will apply if the maximum distances between
two supports with hexagonal insulators are maintained. Values according to IEC 60439-1.
General characteristics
Max. L (distance between centres of supports in mm) for
Height
H (mm)
Insert
M
peak Isc
24 kA
48 kA
63 kA
82 kA
114 kA
rms Isc
12 kA
23 kA
30 kA
39 kA
52 kA
Bar x no.
d min.
(mm)
Iz (A)(1)
20
M4
15 x 5 x 1
400
100
45
220
20
M4
20 x 5 x 1
400
100
45
280
25
M6
15 x 5 x 1
550
135
45
220
25
M6
20 x 5 x 1
525
135
45
280
25
M6
25 x 5 x 1
575
145
50
330
30
M6
15 x 5 x 1
675
165
45
220
30
M6
20 x 5 x 1
650
165
45
280
30
M6
25 x 5 x 1
725
175
105
50
330
30
M8
15 x 5 x1
850
250
155
45
220
30
M8
20 x 5 x 1
1000
250
155
30
M8
25 x 5 x 1
1000
275
170
35
M6
15 x 5 x 1
700
175
100
45
220
35
M6
20 x 5 x 1
675
170
100
45
280
35
M6
25 x 5 x 1
750
175
110
50
330
35
M8
15 x 5 x 1
850
275
160
45
220
35
M8
20 x 5 x 1
1000
275
160
45
280
35
M8
25 x 5 x 1
1000
300
175
105
50
330
35
M8
32 x 5 x 1
1000
325
175
110
55
410
35
M10
20 x 5 x 1
850
200
125
45
280
100
45
280
50
330
35
M10
25 x 5 x 1
950
225
135
50
330
35
M10
32 x 5 x 1
1000
250
150
55
410
40
M8
20 x 5 x 1
1000
325
175
110
45
280
40
M8
25 x 5 x 1
1000
350
200
125
50
330
40
M8
32 x 5 x 1
1000
375
225
135
55
410
40
M10
20 x 5 x 1
1000
325
175
110
45
280
40
M10
25 x 5 x 1
1000
350
200
125
50
330
40
M10
32 x 5 x 1
1000
375
225
135
55
410
45
M8
25 x 5 x 1
1000
425
250
150
50
330
45
M8
32 x 5 x 1
1000
475
175
160
55
410
45
M8
50 x 5 x 1
1000
625
350
200
75
600
110
45
M10
25 x 5 x 1
1000
425
250
145
50
330
45
M10
32 x 5 x 1
1000
450
250
160
55
410
45
M10
50 x 5 x 1
1000
600
350
200
75
600
50
M8
25 x 5 x 1
1000
450
250
155
50
330
50
M8
32 x 5 x 1
1000
475
275
170
55
410
50
M8
50 x 5 x 1
1000
650
375
225
115
75
600
55
410
125
75
600
50
M10
32 x 5 x 1
1000
525
300
175
50
M10
50 x 5 x 1
1000
700
400
225
110
60
M10
50 x 5 x 1
1000
700
400
225
125
75
600
65
M10
50 x 5 x 1
1000
775
450
250
135
75
600
(1) Admissible nominal current for a temperature in the cabinet of 45C and 80C for the bars.
Other assembly configurations: please consult us.
577
Busbar supports
Busbar
Insulation
voltage (VAC)
No. of bars
To be ordered in
multiples of
SB 1
690
20-25
SB 2
690
32-40
Support
Reference
5021 0110
5022 0110
Order guide
SB 1: bar of max. width 25 mm
SB 2: bar of max. width 40 mm
Characteristics
Support
24 kA
48 kA
63 kA
82 kA
114 kA
rms Isc
12 kA
23 kA
30 kA
39 kA
52 kA
Bar x no.
650
325
250
175
135
d min.
(mm)
Iz (A)(1)
50
210
SB 1
20 x 3 x 1
SB 1
20 x 5 x 1
850
425
325
250
175
50
280
SB 1
25 x 5 x 1
1000
525
400
300
200
50
330
SB 2
32 x 5 x 1
1000
750
575
450
300
70
410
SB 2
40 x 5 x 1
1000
950
700
550
400
70
500
L max.
sb_014_c_1_x_cat
d min.
(1) Admissible nominal current for a temperature in the cabinet of 45C and 80C for the bars.
Other assembly configurations: please consult us.
Dimensions
B
50
23
20
34
SB 2
68
23
23.5
50
578
sb_014_c_1_x_cat
SB 1
Support
Busbar supports
Busbar
Insulation
voltage (VAC)
No. of
bars
Bar width
(mm)
To be ordered
in multiples of
SB 3 bare
690
12
32-63
SB 3 pre-equipped(1)
690
12
32-63
Reference
5023 0111
5023 0110
Order guide
SB 3: 1 to 2 bars of max. width 63 mm.
Characteristics
24 kA
48 kA
63 kA
82 kA
114 kA
rms Isc
12 kA
23 kA
30 kA
39 kA
52 kA
sb_008_a_1_x_cat
Bar x no.
32 x 5 x 2
1000
1000
925
700
500
70
580
40 x 5 x 2
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
70
700
50 x 5 x 2
1000
1000
1000
925
675
75
850
63 x 5 x 2
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
85
1000
(1) Admissible nominal current for a temperature in the cabinet of 45C and 80C for the bars.
Other assembly configurations: please consult us.
sb_023_b_1_f_cat
L maxi
d mini
Dimensions
B
65
32
28
36
SB 3 pre-equipped
65
32
28
36
sb_089_b_1_x_cat
SB 3 bare
Support
579
Busbar supports
Busbar
Pack qty
1
Pack qty
1
1
1
1
Reference
5028 0410
Reference
5028 0411
5028 0412
5028 0413
5028 0415
Characteristics
Support
Type 1
Type 1
Type 1
Type 1
Type 1
Type 1
Type 1
Type 1
Type 1
Type 1
Type 2
Type 2
Type 2
Type 2
Type 2
Type 2
Type 2
Type 2
Type 2
Type 2
63 kA
30 kA
Iz (A)(1)
160
220
250
290
210
280
310
370
410
460
160
220
250
290
210
280
310
370
410
460
150
175
200
225
200
225
225
225
175
175
(1) Admissible nominal current for a temperature in the cabinet of 45C and 80C for the bars.
Other assembly configurations: please consult us. Note: Iz is given for solid bars only.
Dimensions
25
35.5
25
L
35.5 35.5
140
180
90
580
sb_036_e_1_x_cat
35
20.5
15.5
49.5
sb_047_a_1_x_cat
sb_041_b_1_x_cat
25
6.2
70
25
35
67
50
Busbar supports
Busbar
Pack
qty
Reference
690
12-30
5026 0460
Characteristics
Max. L (distance between centres of supports in mm) for
peak Isc
10 kA
15 kA
24 kA
48 kA
6 kA
9 kA
12 kA
23 kA
rms Isc
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
475
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
175
650
650
850
1000
1000
165
160
200
250
350
d min.
(mm)
60
60
60
60
60
60
120
150
200
Iz (A)
180
280
338
390
508
580
sb_159_a_1_x_cat
Bar x no.
12 x 5 x 1
20 x 5 x 1
25 x 5 x 1
30 x 5 x 1
25 x 10 x 1
30 x 10 x 1
63 kA
30 kA
Dimensions
22
242
42
17
sb_144_a_1_x_cat
15
62.5
67.5
54
Pack
qty
Reference
1000
20-32
5026 0450
Characteristics
Bar x no.
20 x 5 x 1
25 x 5 x 1
32 x 5 x 1
25 x 10 x 1
30 x 10 x 1
32 x 10 x 1
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
800
1000
1000
1000
1000
1000
350
350
350
350
350
350
200
200
200
200
200
200
82 kA
39 kA
125
125
120
125
120
120
d min.
(mm)
50
50
50
50
50
50
Iz (A)
280
330
390
500
580
610
sb_165_b_1_x_cat
Dimensions
50
sb_147_b_1_x_cat
50
12
50
53.5
75.5
114
245
150
581
Power terminals
Distribution
born_016_a_1_cat
born_011_a_1_cat
born_013_a_1_cat
Enclosures
& accessories
Conformity to standards
> IEC 60439-1
> DIN 46206
Function
SOCOMEC power terminals provide connections for power circuits. They consist of
connection plates fixed onto insulating brackets.
Characteristics
General characteristics
q Tin-plated aluminium plates.
q High dielectric strength.
q High mechanical resistance.
q High resistance to damp heat
(supplied "tropicalised").
Type 1
46 50 50 25
4501 0003(1)
4501 0004(1)
22
15
30
11
Reference
13
B (mm)
151
201
A (mm)
142
192
28
Top
Bottom
connections by connections by No. of poles
lugs
lugs
3P
lugs
lugs
4P
160
90
60
Imax(A)
250
250
Dimensions
1
Accessories
Type
Protective cover for 3 pole terminals
Protective cover for 4 pole terminals
582
Reference
4501 1003
4501 1004
21 50 50 50
21
A
B
60
1. M6 screws mounting.
born_001_c_1_x_cat
References
Power terminals
Distribution
Type 2
67 65 65 40
B (mm)
Reference
4502 0003(1)
4502 0004(1)
630
lugs
lugs
3P
197
206
630
lugs
lugs
4P
262
271
18 6
13x15
34.5
Accessories
Type
Reference
4502 1003
4502 1004
4500 0107
13
A
(mm)
No. of
poles
36
Bottom
connections by
250
120
80
Dimensions
65 65 65
A
B
15
1
30
95
born_002_b_1_x_cat
References
1. M6 screws mounting.
Type 3
A
(mm)
B (mm)
Reference
lugs
cable clamps(1)
3P
197
206
lugs
(1)
4P
262
271
4503 0003(2)
4503 0004(2)
cable clamps
67 65 65 25 M 10
90
born_003_c_1_x_cat
400
No. of
poles
100
400
Bottom
connections by
12.5
1
2
2.5
Dimensions
250
70
References
34.5 65
Accessories
Type
Reference
4502 1003
4502 1004
4500 0106
65 65
A
B
95
Type 4
67 65 65 40
4
No. of
poles
A
(mm)
B (mm)
Reference
4504 0003(2)
4504 0004(2)
500
lugs
cable clamps(1)
3P
197
206
500
lugs
cable clamps(1)
4P
262
271
13x15
34
34,
4,5
4
, 65 65 65
A
B
Accessories
Type
Reference
4502 1003
4502 1004
4500 0107
90
150
Bottom
connections by
250
122
Dimensions
95
born_004_c_1_x_cat
References
Type 5
lugs
630
lugs
Connections by
A
(mm)
B (mm)
Reference
cable clamps(1)
3P
197
206
cable clamps(1)
4P
262
271
4505 0003(2)
4505 0004(2)
Accessories
Type
Protective cover for 3 pole terminals
Protective cover for 4 pole terminals
Inter-phase screen
13x15
34,
4,5
, 65 65 65
A
B
Reference
90
95
born_005_b_1_x_cat
Connections by
630
67 65 65 40
4
No. of
poles
250
142
82 60
Imax
(A)
Dimensions
170
References
4502 1003
4502 1004
4500 0108
583
born_034_a_1_cat
Enclosures
& accessories
serre_001_a_1_cat
Cage terminals
Conformity to standards
Cable clamps:
Cable clamps
Function
Characteristics
Cable clamps
q 3 cross-section ranges from 35 to 300 mm2
q 2 cable clamp models with bracket
mounting: single-double.
Cage terminals
q Ratings: From 160 to 630 A.
q Number of poles: 3 and 4.
q Material: tin-plated aluminium.
584
A
42
54
53
Corresponding power
terminals
Reference
4500 0013
4500 0022
4500 0028
Type 4
Type 4
Type 5
B
48
50
50
C
35
45
60
J
26
31.5
33
J
A
C
35 - 240 mm2
C
150 - 300 mm2
acces_038_a_1_x_cat
maxi
cabling (mm)
17
20
25
Dimensions
35 185
17
Type 4
95 240
20
Type 4
150 300
25
Type 5
Reference
4500 0031
4500 0032
4500 0034
5 - 10
B
Dimensions
Tightening capacity (mm2)
35 185
42
48
35
26
95 240
54
50
45
31.5
150 300
53
50
60
33
J1
J =
A
C
35 - 240 mm2
= J1 =
C
150 - 300 mm2
serre_004_c_1_x_cat
Corresponding power
terminals
Tightening capacity
(mm2)
33
No. of
poles
Tightening
torque (Nm)
16 95
160
3P
14
13
16 95
160
4P
14
13
16 185
250
3P
25
18
16 185
250
4P
25
18
50 240
400
3P
45
20
50 240
400
4P
45
20
70 300
630
3P
45
24
70 300
630
4P
45
24
Reference
born_018_a_1_cat
5400 3016
5400 4016
5400 3025
5400 4025
5400 3040
5400 4040
5400 3063
5400 4063
X1
Dimensions
Rating of switch
(A)
A1
X1
47.5
22.5
25
12
20
3.5
8.5
M12
10
250
62
31.5
31.5
16.5
25
2.5
10.5
M16
14
400
71.5
32
38
32
10.5
M20
15
630
76.5
37
38
40
12.5
M20
15
160
A1
born_019_a_1_x_cat
Tightening
capacity
(mm2)
No. of
poles
Tightening
torque (Nm)
16 95
160
3P
14
13
16 95
160
4P
14
13
16 185
250
3P
25
18
16 185
250
4P
25
18
50 240
400
3P
45
20
50 240
400
4P
45
20
70 300
630
3P
45
24
70 300
630
4P
45
24
Reference
born_020_a_1_cat
5400 3216
5400 4216
5400 3225
5400 4225
5400 3240
5400 4240
5400 3263
5400 4263
Dimensions
Rating of switch (A)
X1
A
A1
X1
160
47.5
22.5
25
12
20
3.5
8.5
M12
10
250
62
31.5
31.5
16.5
25
2.5
10.5
M16
14
400
71.5
32
38
32
10.5
M20
15
630
76.5
37
38
40
12.5
M20
15
R
E ini
Tm
C
Mini.m)
(2 m
Z
A1
A
born_021_a_1_x_cat
Tightening
capacity
(mm2)
585
Distribution blocks
Distribution
repar_008_a_1_cat
repar_020_c_1_cat
Enclosures
& accessories
Conformity to standards
repar_042_a
repar_028_a_1_cat
Function
SOCOMEC distribution blocks allow easy connection of conductors.
They are installed downstream of a load break switch, a changeover switch
or a fuse-combination switch.
Characteristics
General characteristics
q Insulation voltage:
- ferrules terminal distribution block: 500 V,
- modular row terminal distribution block:
690 V,
- wire-terminal distribution block: 1000 V.
q Impulse voltage:
- ferrules terminal distribution block: 6 kV,
- modular row terminal distribution block:
6 kV,
- wire-terminal distribution block: 8 kV.
q Self-extinguishing: 960 C.
586
Distribution blocks
Distribution
No of feeders per
section (mm2)
125
3/4 P
2x25 + 7x10
85 x 88 x 48
125
3/4 P
85 x 129 x 48
4.2
160
3/4 P
90 x 160.5 x 50
6.2
Reference
repar_027_a_2_cat
Dimensions
Icc
H x W x D (mm) (kA rms)(1)
Rating
(A)
5420 4108
5420 4112
5420 4016
Rating (A)
W (mm)
D (mm)
98
74.5
45
175
80
71.5
42.5
H (mm)
125
repar_009_a_1_x_cat
Dimensions
L
Direct or cable connection distribution blocks which can
be clipped onto a symmetric DIN rail.
No. of poles
Dimensions H x W x D (mm)
Reference
125
4P
98 x 74.5 x 45
175
3P
80 x 71.5 x 42.5
5410 4112
5410 3017
repar_039_a_1_cat
References
Reference
5410 1008
5410 1012
5410 1017
5410 1025
5410 1040
repar_008_a_2_cat
Rating (A)
Switch mounting N (mm)
80
56.5
125
65
175
60.5
250
86
400
86
Description of accessories
Connection for rating 250 A(1)
Connection for rating 400 A(1)
Reference
5410 0025
5410 0040
(1) Linking part enabling direct assembly on the connecting lugs of the switching device.
30
(1)
10.8
32
repar_010_c_1_x_cat
Dimensions H x W x D (mm)
66 x 27 x 47
74.5 x 27 x 46.5
71 x 45 x 43.5
96 x 45 x 50
96 x 45 x 50
86.5
Rating (A)
80
125
175
250
400
40
Dimensions
Connections
Rating (A)
80
125
175
250
400
125
175
6.3
29.5
L
Earth bar
Mounting No of feeders per
Material
by
section (mm2)
W
(mm)
To be ordered in
multiples of
2 self M4
10 x 16 + 2 x 35
brass
120
10
2 self M6
41 x 16 + 2 x 35
brass
470
10
barre_006_a_2_cat
References
Reference
5414 0120
5414 0470
587
Distribution blocks
Distribution
Length
With connector
leads(1)
Reference
250(2)
1 row
yes
10
250(2)
1 row
no
10
5420 2426
5421 2426
Rating (A)
repar_028_a_2_cat
References
(1) Delivered with 6 mm2 connector leads, L = 120 mm, 12 black connectors, 12 blue connectors.
(2) Preferably the terminations will be distributed over the entire number or terminals.
25
Type
Length
(mm)
Colour
To be ordered in
multiples of
40
6 mm2 cable
120
Blue
40
6 mm2 cable
120
Black
10
40
6 mm2 cable
320
Blue
10
40
6 mm2 cable
320
Black
10
63
10 mm2 cable
320
Blue
10
63
10 mm2 cable
320
Black
10
5421 1006
5421 1016
5421 1106
5421 1116
5421 1101
5421 1111
40
2.5 mm2
connector
20
5421 0025
20
5421 0125
6 mm connector
40
72.4
Rating
(A)
63
60 60
9
Cables
Reference
407.5
423
46
repar_029_a_1_x_cat
Dimensions
References
Dimensions
Rating (A)
No of
H x W x D (mm)
Phase
Neutral
Reference
80
50 x 24 modules x 40
3x8
2x8
80
50 x 36 modules x 40
3 x 12
2 x 12
5420 2408
5420 3608
To be ordered in multiples of
Reference
5420 0001
35
588
repar_042_a
Distribution blocks
Distribution
Terminal connections
Multipolar distribution blocks
References
No. of poles
160
3P
10
2 x 95 + 8 x 25
160
4P
10
2 x 95 + 8 x 25
250
3P
15
2 x 150 + 8 x 50
250
4P
15
2 x 150 + 8 x 50
400
3P
21
2 x 240 + 8 x 95
400
4P
21
2 x 240 + 8 x 95
630
3P
21
2 x 300 + 8 x 150
630
4P
21
2 x 300 + 8 x 150
Reference
5412 3016
5412 4016
5412 3025
5412 4025
5412 3040
5412 4040
5412 3063
5412 4063
repar_007_b_1_cat
Rating (A)
Dimensions
P
B
3P
154 286
36
20
160
4P
190 286
36
20
250
3P
210 307
83 57.5 50
222
50
25
250
4P
260 307
50
400
3P
270
400
4P
630
3P
630
4P
54
54
11
56
25
11
56
65
32
14.5 8.5
82
65
32
14.5 8.5
82
333
65
40
14.5 10.5 83
65
40
14.5 10.5 83
P P
==
X
8 x X1
repar_004_b_1_x_cat
160
X X1
No. of
poles
Rating
(A)
T
Y
E
R
J
=A =
=
125/160
4P
250/400
3P
250/400
4P
630/800
3P
630/800
4P
3699 3P16
3699 3P16
3699 3P39
3699 6P39
3699 3P80
3699 6P80
60
50
17.5
8
No. of poles
125/160
3P
99
20
M8
23
10
186
125/160
4P
99
20
M8
23
10
248
250/400
3P
101.5
25
M10
28
12.5
186
250/400
4P
101.5
25
M10
28
12.5
248
630/800
3P
101.5
25
M10
28
12.5
186
630/800
4P
101.5
25
M10
28
12.5
248
3 D
sb_186_a_1_x_cat
Rating (A)
Reference
3P
MIN 24
MAX 33
76
No. of poles
125/160
Rating (A)
589
Distribution blocks
Distribution
Rating
(A)
L
(mm)
No. of
Icc
poles (kA rms)
No. of
supports
160
270
4P
25
160
420
4P
17
160
620
4P
20
250
270
4P
30
250
420
4P
22
250
620
4P
18
400
270
4P
24
400
420
4P
21
400
620
4P
13
Distribution
block
Protection cover
Reference
Reference
5028 0421
5028 0451
5028 0471
5028 0423
5028 0453
5028 0473
5028 0425
5028 0455
5028 0475
5028 0411
5028 0412
5028 0413
5028 0411
5028 0412
5028 0413
5028 0411
5028 0412
5028 0413
Pack qty
Reference
5028 0415
repar_012_b_1_cat
References
Dimensions
Type
Spacer for protection cover
140
P
L
A
M6
250
150
270
15
160
160
15
400
300
420
15
160
21
600
250
620
15
250
250
10
150
270
20
250
15
400
10
300
420
20
250
21
600
10
250
620
20
400
225
12
150
270
32
400
14
375
12
300
420
32
400
20
620
12
250
620
32
180
127
Nb of terminations
repar_040_a_1_x_cat
R
Rating (A)
25
Rating (A)
Connection type
Reference
160
Terminal connections
250
Terminal connections
400
Terminal connections
630
Terminal connections
NB16 0000
NB16 0000
NB40 0000
NB63 0000
590
Width max.
(mm)
25
85
117
45
32
25
120
173
45
32
176
25
150
200
65
55
210
25
160
240
65
75
160
100
250
150
400
630
B
C
D
shunt_012_a_1_x_cat
Dimensions
Rating (A)
repar_030_a_2_cat
References
Distribution blocks
Distribution
No of feeders per
section (mm2)
160
3P
10
1 x 95 + 8 x 25
160
4P
10
1 x 95 + 8 x 25
250
3P
15
1 x 150 + 8 x 50
250
4P
15
1 x 150 + 8 x 50
400
3P
21
1 x 240 + 8 x 95
400
4P
21
1 x 240 + 8 x 95
630
3P
21
1 x 300 + 8 x 150
630
4P
21
1 x 300 + 8 x 150
Reference
5411 3016
5411 4016
5411 3025
5411 4025
5411 3040
5411 4040
5411 3063
5411 4063
repar_020_b_1_cat
No. of poles
Rating (A)
154
286
73
46.5 261.5
36
20
54
160
4P
190
286
73
46.5 261.4
36
20
54
250
3P
210
307
83
57.5
279
50
25
56
250
4P
260
307
83
57.5
279
50
25
56
400
3P
281
375
116
82.5
340
65
32
82
400
4P
346
375
116
82.5
340
65
32
82
630
3P
271
438
117
90.5 410.5
65
40
83
630
4P
346
438
117
90.5 410.5
65
40
83
repar_003_c_1_x_cat
3P
Rating (A)
No. of poles
160
Dimensions
T
Y
E
R
P
P P
A
Device
100/125/160 22x58/00
3P
FUSERBLOC
100/125/160 22x58/00
4P
FUSERBLOC
160
3P
FUSERBLOC
160
4P
FUSERBLOC
250
3P
FUSERBLOC
11 x M8
250
4P
FUSERBLOC
11 x M8
400
3P
FUSERBLOC
11 x M8
400
4P
FUSERBLOC
11 x M8
160/200
3P
SIRCO VM2
160/200
4P
SIRCO VM2
Reference
5413 3016
5413 4016
5413 3017
5413 4017
5413 3025
5413 4025
5413 3040
5413 4040
5413 3020
5413 4020
repar_013_a_2_cat
Rating (A)
FUSERBLOC 110
Device
260
61
20
233
36
20
39
100/125/160
4P
FUSERBLOC 145
260
61
20
233
36
20
39
160
3P
FUSERBLOC 150
260
61
20
233
50
20
39
160
4P
FUSERBLOC 200
260
61
20
233
50
20
39
250
3P
FUSERBLOC 185
340
67
15
300
60
32
45
250
4P
FUSERBLOC 245
340
67
15
300
60
32
45
400
3P
FUSERBLOC 210
340
67
15
300
66
32
45
400
4P
FUSERBLOC 275
340
67
15
300
66
32
45
160/200
3P
260
61
20
233
27.5
20
39
160/200
4P
260
61
20
233
27.5
20
39
R
P
P
A
repar_041_a_1_x_cat
3P
100/125/160
No. of
poles
Rating (A)
Dimensions
Y
E
591
Enclosures
& accessories
Conformity to standards
elcha_039_a_1_cat
> EN 60715
Function
SOCOMEC frame parts come in steel, 304 L stainless steel or aluminium
(profiles and accessories) and allow the fixing of any electrical equipment.
Configurations
Composition of the range:
1. Profile C 20 x 14 - 30 x 15 - 35 x 35
2. Diamond shaped nut 33 x 11 - 34 x 20
3. Bracket 45 x 60 x 25
2 oblong holes: 35 x 9 ou 25 x 9
4. Rectangular nut 28 x 35
5. Profile C 30 x 15
6. Square nut 25 x 25
7. Bracket 25 x 25 x 19
8. Square nut 15.5 x 15.5
9. Fixomega
10. Bracket 36 x 36 x 23
11. Terminal block support
12. Fixocap
13. Asymmetrical profile
14. Straddle bracket 30 x 15
15. Cable support rail
16. Straddle bracket 20 x 14
17. Straddle bracket 35 x 35
16
17
15
4
5
16
10
6
7
8
15
14
17
9
13
elcha_003_c_1_x_cat
12
11
10
592
QProfile C
References
Perforations
(mm)
Perforation
centres
(mm)
Material
Profiles
length (m)
To be ordered
in multiples of
20 x 14 x 1.5
8.2 x 40
50
Steel z-b(1)
30 m
30 x 15 x 1.5
8.2 x 40
50
Steel z-b(1)
30 m
35 x 35 x 2
8.2 x 40
50
Steel z-b(1)
12 m
35 x 35 x 2
8.2 x 40
50
Steel z-b(1)
18 m
30 x 15 x 1.5
6.3 x 18
50
Stainless steel
10 m
20 x 15 x 2
without
Aluminium
10 m
20 x 15 x 2
without
Aluminium
15 m
20 x 15 x 2
without
Aluminium
30 m
29 x 19 x 2.5
without
Aluminium
10 m
29 x 19 x 2.5
without
Aluminium
15 m
29 x 19 x 2.5
without
Aluminium
30 m
5000 0120
5000 0121
5000 0132
5000 0122
5000 1021
SA12 4202
SA13 4202
SA10 4202
SA12 4201
SA13 4201
SA10 4201
Reference
Reference
elcha_042_a_1_cat
WxHxe
(mm)
Accessories
For profiles
To be ordered
in multiples of
Rhomboidal nut
M3
15.5 x 15.5
20 x 14
100
Rhomboidal nut
M4
15.5 x 15.5
20 x 14
100
Rhomboidal nut
M5
15.5 x 15.5
20 x 14
100
Rhomboidal nut
M6
15.5 x 15.5
20 x 14
100
Rhomboidal nut
M8
15.5 x 15.5
20 x 14
100
Rhomboidal nut
M8
25 x 25
30 x 15
100
Square nut
M8
35 x 28
35 x 35
100
Square nut
M18
35 x 28
35 x 35
100
Rhomboidal nut
M3
33 x 11
30 x 15
100
Rhomboidal nut
M4
33 x 11
30 x 15
100
Rhomboidal nut
M5
33 x 11
30 x 15
100
Rhomboidal nut
M6
34 x 20
35 x 35
100
Rhomboidal nut
M8
34 x 20
35 x 35
100
Straddle bracket
8.2
20 x 14
100
Straddle bracket
8.2
30 x 15
100
Straddle bracket
8.2
35 x 35
100
5000 0023
5000 0024
5000 0025
5000 0026
5000 0028
5000 0029
5000 0037
5000 0039
5000 0033
5000 0034
5000 0035
5000 0036
5000 0038
5000 0010
5000 0011
5000 0012
Rhomboidal nut
Square nut
elcha_017_a_1_x_cat
Dimensions H x
W (mm)
elcha_018_a_1_x_cat
Insert M
Type
elcha_016_a_1_x_cat
Screws
elcha_020_a_1_x_cat
Rhomboidal nut
Straddle bracket
Type
l x e (mm)
To be ordered in multiples of
Reference
20 x 12
25 x 12
5000 0057
5000 0058
elcha_029_a_1_cat
Foam
593
Perforations
(mm)
35 x 7.5 x 1
Without
35 x 7.5 x 1
6.3 x 18
35 x 7.5 x 1
Without
Material
Profiles
length (m)
To be ordered
in multiples of
Steel z-b(1)
30 m
Steel z-b(1)
30 m
Stainless steel
10 m
25
Reference
elcha_040_a_1_cat
WxHxe
(mm)
5000 0302
5000 0042
5000 1302
Material
Profiles
length (m)
To be ordered
in multiples of
Reference
35 x 15 x 1.5
Without
Steel z-b(1)
30 m
35 x 15 x 1.5
Without
Steel z-b(1)
30 m
35 x 15 x 2.3
Without
Steel z-b(1)
20 m
35 x 15 x 2.3
Without
Steel z-b(1)
30 m
35 x 15 x 1.5
6.3 x 18
25
Steel z-b(1)
30 m
35 x 15 x 1.5
6.3 x 18
25
Steel z-b(1)
30 m
35 x 15 x 2.5
Without
Aluminium
12 m
35 x 15 x 2.5
Without
Aluminium
18 m
35 x 15 x 2.5
Without
Aluminium
36 m
5000 0301
5000 0331
5000 0017
5000 0027
5000 0043
5000 0343
SA12 4217
SA13 4217
SA10 4217
Reference
elcha_043_a_1_cat
Perforations
W x H x e (mm)
(mm)
Perforations
W x H x e (mm)
(mm)
Perforation
centres
(mm)
Material
Profiles length
(m)
To be ordered
in multiples of
32 x 15 x 1.5
Without
Steel z-b(1)
30 m
32 x 15 x 1.5
Without
Steel z-b(1)
30 m
32 x 15 x 1.5
6.3 x 18
Steel z-b(1)
30 m
32 x 15.5 x 1.5
Without
Aluminium
8m
32 x 15.5 x 1.5
Without
Aluminium
12 m
32 x 15.5 x 1.5
Without
Aluminium
24 m
25
elcha_041_a_1_cat
5000 0307
5000 0308
5000 0044
SA12 4210
SA13 4210
SA10 4210
Accessories
Type
Insert M
To be ordered in multiples of
Reference
Fixomega(1)
M4
100
Fixomega(1)
M5
100
m3/h
100
5000 0041
5000 0051
5800 0003
5800 0005
5800 0004
5800 0006
Fixocap (2)
White Fixocap(2)
M4 / M6
100
Black Fixocap(2)
m3/h
100
Grey Fixocap(2)
M4 / M6
100
elcha_019_b_1_x_cat
Fixomega / Fixocap
Fixomega
Fixocap
Type
Number of
holes
hole
(mm)
Insert M
To be ordered
in multiples of
Reference
M5
10
5000 0100
elcha_022_a_1_x_cat
Perforations
W x H x e (mm)
(mm)
594
Perforation
centres
(mm)
Material
Profiles
length (m)
To be ordered
in multiples of
30 x 15 x 1
8.2 x 14.5
16.7
Galvanised steel
15 m
50 x 12 x 1
8.2 x 14.5
16.7
Galvanised steel
20 m
Reference
5000 4325
5000 4326
elcha_033_a_1_cat
WxHxe
(mm)
30 x 30 x 2.5
30 x 50 x 2.5
30 x 30 x 2.5
40 x 40 x 2.5
perforations
(mm)
8.2
8.2
8.5 x 45
8.5 x 45
Perforation
centres (mm)
25
25
55
55
Material
Steel z-b(1)
Steel z-b(1)
Steel z-b(1)
Steel z-b(1)
Profiles
length (m)
2
2
2
2
To be ordered
in multiples of
10 m
10 m
10 m
10 m
elcha_034_a_1_cat
QL profile
Reference
5254 6401
5254 6501
5000 0003
5000 0004
perforations
(mm)
Perforation
centres (mm)
Material
Profiles
length (m)
To be ordered
in multiples of
8.2
25
Steel z-b(1)
10 m
25
Aluminium
3m
perforations
(mm)
Perforation
centres (mm)
Material
Profiles
length (m)
To be
ordered in
multiples of
Reference
8.2
25
Steel z-b(1)
10 m
5254 6601
W x H x e (mm)
perforations
(mm)
Perforation
centres (mm)
Material
Profiles
length (m)
To be
ordered in
multiples of
Reference
30 x 50 x 2.5
8.2 x 45
55
Steel z-b(1)
8m
5000 0005
W x H x e (mm)
50 x 30 x 2.5
30 x 20 x 3
elcha_035_a_1_cat
QU profile
Reference
5254 6701
5254 6901
W x H x e (mm)
30 x 30 x 2.5
elcha_036_a_1_cat
QZ profile
elcha_037_a_1_cat
QRising U
Accessories
Bracket
H x W x D (mm)
25 x 25 x 19
25 x 25 x 19
36 x 36 x 23
45 x 60 x 25
44 x 75 x 32
Characteristics
Bichromate zinc-coated steel.
Number of
holes
2
1
2
2
5
hole (mm)
Insert M
7
6
8
9x25 / 9x35
5/6
To be ordered in multiples of
Reference
25
25
25
25
1 (Set of 6)
5000 0045
5000 0046
5000 0047
5254 6101
5119 5045
M6
elcha_021_a_1_x_cat
Use
For steel profile.
Screws
Thread
M6
M8
M8
Characteristics
Bichromate zinc-coated steel.
Integrated washer
L (m)
10
12
16
Class
8.8
8.8
8.8
To be ordered in multiples of
100
100
100
elcha_038_a_1_x_cat
Use
For steel profile.
Reference
5000 0066
5000 0068
5000 0069
Washer
x e (mm)
16 x 1.5
19 x 1.5
22 x 1.5
Characteristics
Bichromate zinc-coated steel.
hole (mm)
6.5
6.5
8.5
To be ordered in multiples of
100
100
100
amc_035_a_1_x_cat
Use
For steel profile.
Reference
5000 0015
5000 0018
5000 0016
Use
PVC border for sheet metal.
Steel thickness (mm)
2
amc_036_a_1_x_cat
PVC border
Characteristics
Colour: Ligth grey
To be ordered in multiples of
Reference
25 m
7739 0025
595
p. 598
Safety enclosures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
p. 608
p. 622
Photovoltaic enclosures. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
p. 646
Enclosed switches
Switch-disconnectors
SIRCO
Polyester
SIRCO
Steel
SN
(3 / 4P)
p. 600
SN
(3 / 4P)
p. 600
Custom design
and production
of distribution
switchboards
p. 648
FUSERBLOC
Steel
SN
(3 / 4P)
p. 604
SN
(3 / 4P)
p. 604
Safety enclosures
Normal atmospheres
SIDER
Polyester
SIDER
Steel
SN
(3 / 4 / 6P)
p. 610
SN
(3 / 4 / 6P)
p. 610
SOCOMEC
L@MTE@BSTQDRRODBHjB
products in line with
BTRSNLDQReRODBHjB@SHNMR
and technical
requirements.
6DVHKKGDKOXNTjMCSGD
best solution for your
application.
Please feel free to consult us.
Explosive atmospheres
SIDER
Steel-Dust
SIDER
Steel-Gas
SN
(3 / 4 / 6P)
p. 618
SN
(3 / 4P)
p. 618
Photovoltaic
products
We will help you
jMCSGDQHFGS
solution for your
application.
Steel enclosure
SN
(3 / 4P)
p. 624
SN
(3 / 4P)
p. 624
Please feel free to consult us.
Motorised operation
32!8/ 22RNKTSHNM
Remote controlled /
Automatic
SN
(2 / 3 / 4P)
p. 630 and p. 636
SN
(3 / 4P)
p. 642
597
Integrated products
& solutions
IEC 61439
Enclosed switches
disconnection, breaking and interlocking of
the power supply for all types of load, and
can also be used as general switches for
equipment in a variety of applications.
2(3$
2(3$
Safety enclosures
598
2(3$
2(3$
Fig. 1
Fig. 2
Fig. 3
Photovoltaic enclosures
U@HK@AKDHMSGQDDUDQRHNMRQDRHCDMSH@K
buildings and solar fields), the SOCOMEC
range of photovoltaic enclosures meets a full
range of requirements with a manufacturer's
guarantee.
2(3$
599
coff_337_a_1_cat
coff_292_a_1_cat
coff_295_a_1_cat
>
>
>
>
Strong points
SIRCO
in polyester enclosure
SIRCO M
in polycarbonate enclosure
Conformity to standards
Function
SIRCO M and SIRCO enclosures incorporate three or four pole manually operated load
break switches which make and break on load and provide isolation for any low voltage
electrical circuit. The enclosure provides protection against contact with live parts as well as
environmental factors such as dust, water and other hazards.
Advantages
Safety of operations
Door interlocking and positive break indication
provide increased safety for the operator.
Inductive load breaking (AC23)
This enclosure range is provided with
2(1".,@MC2(1".SXODKN@CAQD@J
switches which are adapted to highly
inductive loads.
600
Complete range
The range offers a wide variety of variants
depending on the number of poles, rating and
enclosure type.
>
>
>
>
>
>
IEC 60947-3
IEC 60364
EN 60947-3
EN 61439
EN 60204-1
UL 508
(please consult us)
Available on request
> Customised solutions upon
request.
coff_337_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
16
16
20
20
25
25
32
32
40
40
63
63
80
80
100
100
General characteristics
q Equipped with a 3 pole SIRCO M.
q 1 removable neutral terminal and
QDLNU@AKDD@QSGSDQLHM@K
q Possibility of adding 1 additional pole.
q Possibility of adding 1 M-type auxiliary
contact module.
q Protection IP65.
No. of pole
3P
3P
3P
3P
3P
3P
3P
3P
3P
3P
3P
3P
3P
3P
3P
3P
Handle colour
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
Red
Black
Red
Enclosure colour
Grey
Yellow
Grey
Yellow
Grey
Yellow
Grey
Yellow
Grey
Yellow
Grey
Yellow
Grey
Yellow
Grey
Yellow
Reference
2215 3300
2215 3400
2215 3301
2215 3401
2215 3302
2215 3402
2215 3303
2215 3403
2215 3304
2215 3404
2215 3306
2215 3406
2215 3308
2215 3408
2215 3309(1)
2215 3409(1)
(1) No UL.
Empty enclosures
Rating (A)
No. of pole
Handle colour
Enclosure colour
Reference
16 40
3P
Black
Grey
16 40
3P
Red
Yellow
63 80
3P
Black
Grey
63 80
3P
Red
Yellow
2215 9305
2215 9405
2215 9309
2215 9409
Dimensions
SIRCO M 16 to 40 A
sircm_130_c_1_cat
0.4
3.4
111
92
162
150
152.5
68
20
99
SIRCO M 63 to 100 A
113
sircm_131_b_1_cat
0.4
111
92
186
198
210
68
15
125.5
601
References
Top/Bottom
Connection
Bottom/Bottom
Connection
No. of poles
Reference(1)
Reference(1)
125
3P
125
4P
160
3P
160
4P
250
3P
250
4P
400
3P
400
4P
500
3P
500
4P
3115 3012
3115 4012
3115 3016
3115 4016
3115 3025
3115 4025
3115 3040
3115 4040
3115 3050
3115 4050
3125 3012
3125 4012
3125 3016
3125 4016
3125 3025
3125 4025
3125 3040
3125 4040
3125 3050
3125 4050
coff_292_a_2_cat
Rating (A)
General characteristics
Dimensions
B1
Ab
N
H
coff_114_d_1_gb_cat
Ah
Z1
45
Top/Bottom
connection
602
Rating (A)
H x W x D (mm)
Connection
cross-section (mm2)
M
(mm)
N
(mm)
Z
(mm)
125
50
271
361
33
125
50
271
361
62
160
95
271
361
33
160
95
271
361
62
250
150
361
541
35
250
150
361
541
55
400
240
541
721
42
500
240
541
721
51
Z1
(mm)
Ah
(mm)
Bottom/Bottom
connection
B1 Weight Ab
(mm)
(kg)
(mm)
120
126
120
126
200
210
8
279
360
10
258
258
18
316
433
23
258
258
18
316
433
24
28
28
25
38
B1 Weight
(mm)
(kg)
166
205
166
205
coff_295_a_1_cat
603
coff_319_a_1_cat
coff_320_a_1_cat
coff_284_a_2_cat
>
>
>
>
>
OEM.
Industries.
Data centres.
Power distribution.
Solar applications.
FUSERBLOC
in steel enclosure
FUSERBLOC
in polyester enclosure
Strong points
> Safety of operations.
> Suitable for use in a variety of
applications.
FUSERBLOC
in polyester enclosure
Conformity to standards
Function
FUSERBLOC enclosures incorporate three or four pole manually operated fuse combination
switches which make and break on load and provide isolation and protection against
overcurrent for any low voltage electrical circuit. The enclosure provides protection against
contact with live parts as well as environmental factors such as dust, water and other hazards.
Advantages
Safety of operation
Enclosed FUSERBLOC provide:
q Positive break indication and door
interlocking.
q Short-circuit and overcurrent protection.
q Complete isolation of the fuse with double
breaking per pole (top and bottom of fuse).
q Protection to personnel against contact with
live parts.
q Protection against environmental factors.
604
>
>
>
>
>
IEC 60947-3
IEC 60364
EN 60947-3
EN 61439
EN 60204-1
Available on request
> Customised solutions upon
request.
> For BS88 versions please
consult us.
coff_319_a_2_x_cat
References
Rating (A)
3 x 50
4 x 50
3 x 100
4 x 100
3 x 160
4 x 160
3 x 250
4 x 250
3 x 400
4 x 400
(1)
Top/Bottom
connection
Reference
Bottom/Bottom
connection
Reference
3117 3005
3117 4005
3117 3010
3117 4010
3117 3016
3117 4016
3117 3025
3117 4025
3117 3040
3117 4040
3117 3005
3117 4005
3127 3010
3127 4010
3127 3016
3127 4016
3127 3025
3127 4025
3127 3040
3127 4040
(1) Fuses supplied separately; please see the fuse section of this catalogue or consult us.
Dimensions
B1
Ab
N
H
coff_114_d_1_gb_cat
Ah
Rating (A)
3 x 50 / 4 x 50
3 x 100 / 4 x 100
3 x 100 / 4 x 100
3 x 160
3 x 160
4 x 160
4 x 160
3 x 250 / 4 x 250(1)
3 x 400 / 4 x 400(1)
HxWxD
(mm)
270 x 270 x 171
360 x 270 x 171
540 x 270 x 201
540 x 270 x 171
540 x 270 x 201
540 x 360 x 171
540 x 360 x 201
Z1
45
Connection
cross-section
(mm2)
25
95
95
95
95
95
95
M
(mm)
271
271
N
(mm)
271
361
Z
(mm)
24
20
Z1
(mm)
(1)
(1)
(1)
(1)
271
271
361
361
541
541
541
541
20
60
20
60
Top/Bottom
connection
Ah
B1
Weight
(mm)
(mm)
(kg)
(1)
86
86
108
107
4
(1)
(1)
(1)
220
180
220
180
25
25
Bottom/Bottom
connection
Ab
B1
Weight
(mm)
(mm)
(kg)
90
90
3
(1)
(1)
(1)
220
320
220
320
10
605
coff_320_a_1_cat
References
Rating (A)
3 x 50
14 x 51
4 x 50
14 x 51
3 x 100
22 x 58
4 x 100
22 x 58
3 x 160
4 x 160
3 x 250
4 x 250
3 x 400
4 x 400
(1)
Top/Bottom
connection
Reference
Bottom/Bottom
connection
Reference
3167 3005
3167 4005
3167 3010
3167 4010
3167 3016
3167 4016
3167 3025
3167 4025
3167 3040
3167 4040
3167 3005
3167 4005
3167 3010
3167 4010
3177 3016
3177 4016
3177 3025
3177 4025
3177 3040
3177 4040
(1) Fuses supplied separately; please see the fuse section of this catalogue or consult us.
Dimensions
B1
W
Rating (A)
3 x 50 / 4 x 50
3 x 100 / 4 x 100
3 x 160
4 x 160
3 x 160 / 4 x 160
3 x 250
4 x 250
3 x 250 / 4 x 250
3 x 400 / 4 x 400
3 x 400
4 x 400
Z1
Ab
coff_119_f_1_gb_cat
N
H
Ah
45
HxWxD
(mm)
270 x 270 x171
360 x 270 x 171
540 x 270 x 171
540 x 360 x 171
540 x 360 x 201
720 x 360 x 201
720 x 360 x 201
720 x 360 x 201
720 x 540 x 201
720 x 540 x 201
754 x 750 x 312
606
Connection
cross-section
(mm2)
25
95
95
95
95
240
240
240
240
240
240
M
(mm)
271
271
271
361
361
361
361
361
541
541
801
N
(mm)
271
361
541
541
541
721
721
721
721
721
618
Z
(mm)
24
20
20
52
20
20
51
25
25
25
Z1
(mm)
Ah
(mm)
84
108
260
260
Top/Bottom
connection
B1
Weight
(mm)
(kg)
88
4
108
5
140
6
140
7
24
328
338
228
218
15
323
223
18
200
289
255
453
18
450
436
403
484
23
(1)
29
40
40
Bottom/Bottom
connection
Ab
B1
Weight
(mm)
(mm)
(kg)
84
88
4
108
108
5
(1)
coff_284_a_2_cat
References
Top/Bottom
connection
Reference
Rating (A)
3 x CD 25
4 x CD 25
3+N x CD 25
3 x CD 32
4 x CD 32
3+N x CD 32
3 x 63
4 x 63
3+N x 63
3 x 100
4 x 100
3+N x 100
3 x 160
4 x 160
3+N x 160
3 x 250
4 x 250
3+N x 250
3 x 400
4 x 400
3+N x 400
3 x 630
4 x 630
3+N x 630
3 x 800
4 x 800
3+N x 800
3033 3002
3033 4002
3033 5002
3033 3003
3033 4003
3033 5003
3033 3006
3033 4006
3033 5006
3033 3010
3033 4010
3033 5010
3033 3016
3033 4016
3033 5016
3033 3025
3033 4025
3033 5025
3033 3040
3033 4040
3033 5040
3033 3063
3033 4063
3033 5063
3033 3080
3033 4080
3033 5080
(1) Fuses supplied separately; please see the fuse section of this catalogue or consult us.
Accessories
Dimensions
Top/Bottom
connection
Ah
E
Z
B1
H
N
coff_248_f_1_gb_cat
M
W
Rating
(A)
CD 25
CD 32
63
100
160
250
400
630
800
HxWxD
(mm)(1)
300 x 300 x 150
300 x 300 x 150
300 x 300 x 150
400 x 300 x 200
400 x 300 x 200
600 x 600 x 300
600 x 600 x 300
800 x 600 x 300
800 x 600 x 300
Max. connection
cross-section
(mm2)
16
16
25
95
95
240
240
2 x 300
2 x 300
E
M
N
(mm) (mm) (mm)
208
348
259
208
348
259
208
348
259
259
348
359
259
348
359
359
648
559
359
648
559
374
648
759
374
648
759
Z
(mm)
28.5
28.5
23.8
20
20
22
22
59
59
Ah
(mm)
115
115
101.5
109.5
109.5
187
184
264
264
B1
Weight
(mm)
(kg)
(1)
87
(1)
87
(1)
101.5
(1)
149.5
(1)
149.5
(1)
247
(1)
244
(1)
276
(1)
276
607
Integrated products
& solutions
Safety enclosures
Atmosphere
Explosive
Normal
Gas
Dust
Environment
Steel enclosure
Chemical aggression
Mechanical risks
Dust risks
Polyester enclosure
Contamination risks
Atmospheric corrosion
Risk of explosion
(1) Made to order
608
ATEX Enclosure
Dust
zones 21 and 22
ATEX enclosures
Safety enclosures
Safety functions
Positive break indication
Visible breaking
COFF_036_A_2_CAT
In position 0
COFF_035_A_2_CAT
COFF_234_A_1_CAT
COFF_233_A_1_CAT
In position 1
Padlocking
COFF_042_A_2_CAT
COFF_221_A_2_CAT
COFF_043_A_2_CAT
COFF_243_A_1_X_CAT
Clear indication of the open or closed position of the switch via the
handle and its easy-to-read marking.
Flush with the viewing glass and integral with the movable bar, this
gives clear, at-a-glance indication of contact position, providing easier
visualisation of the visible breaking.
COFF_034_A_1_CAT
COFF_038_A_2_CAT
COFF_037_A_2_CAT
Double locking
COFF_156_A
Steel
COFF_047_A
Polyester
COFF_280_A
COFF_163_A
609
Safety enclosures
The solution for
>
>
>
>
>
>
Steel works.
Cement works.
Automotive.
Mining industries.
Food processing.
Chemical industry.
coff_163_a_3_cat
coff_219_a_2_cat
Integrated products
& solutions
Normal atmospheres
Polyester enclosures from 50 to 1600 A
Polyester enclosure
with front operation handle
Strong points
Polyester enclosure
with side operation handle
Function
Safety enclosures equipped with SOCOMEC switches provide emergency breaking, breaking
for mechanical maintenance and safety isolation in the vicinity of any low voltage final circuit.
Conformity to standards
> IEC 60364
> IEC 60947-3
> IEC 60204-1
Advantages
Safety of operations
q Visible contacts and positive break indication
with the possibility to add a mechanical
indicator.
q Double locked door when the switch is in
the ON position.
q Triple locking of the handle in the OFF
position.
Inductive load breaking (AC23)
Safety enclosures are designed for use with
inductive loads and are able to make and
break on load (AC23).
610
Specific requests
> SOCOMEC can offer
customised solutions to meet
your specific requirements.
Contact your Socomec office
for further information.
Safety enclosures
Normal atmospheres
Polyester enclosures from 50 to 1600 A
General characteristics
Breaking device:
All safety enclosures are equipped with
SIDER load break switches which provide
visible, reliable indication of the contacts open
position. They make and break under load
conditions and provide safety isolation for any
low voltage circuit.
Enclosure:
Enclosures are made of glass fibre reinforced
polyester and are of the following types:
q COMBIESTER from 50 to 500 A (RAL7035)
q MINIPOL from 630 to 800 A (RAL7035)
Covers on COMBIESTER enclosures are
hinged and equipped with a screw locking
system. Doors on MINIPOL enclosures can
be locked using a 3 mm double bar key.
These enclosures have good resistance to
chemical agents and are self-extinguishing
@S"
These enclosures provide a protection degree
of IP55. Wall mounting is achieved using 4
fixing lugs, supplied loose.
Visible breaking:
The contacts are visible through:
q The transparent cover of COMBIESTER
enclosures.
q A door-mounted triplex glass window on
MINIPOL enclosures.
q This enables the operator to confirm the
position of the contacts either during a
preventative check or before an operation.
Double locking:
This is ensured by a simple robust mechanism
in connection with the control shaft. Activation
with the door open remains possible by
authorised personnel.
Connection:
Polyester safety enclosures are available in
two versions:
q TB version
(top entry and bottom cable exit)
q BB version (bottom cable entry/exit).
Connection is achieved by running cables to
SGDSNOENQ @MC Q@SHMFR
%NQGHFGDQ
ratings, a copper bottom-bottom busbar
enables easy connection of incoming cables.
Miscellaneous:
q An earthing bar for connection is available in
the enclosure.
q Incoming protection screen.
Operation handle:
Polyester safety enclosures are available with
front or side operation handles. The handle
is red and made of an insulating material
(emergency breaking). The handle can be
locked in the OFF position using three padlocks.
611
Safety enclosures
Normal atmospheres
Polyester enclosures from 50 to 1600 A
References
Front operation
coff_219_a_2_cat
Front operation(1)(2)
No. of
poles
125
3P
125
4P
125
6P
200
3P
200
4P
200
6P
400
3P
400
4P
400
6P
500
3P
500
4P
630
3P
630
4P
800
3P
800
4P
1250
3P
1250
4P
1600
3P
1600
4P
Reference
Reference
3215 3012
3215 4012
3215 6012
3215 3020
3215 4020
3215 6020
3215 3040
3215 4040
3215 6040
3215 3050
3215 4050
3215 3063
3215 4063
3215 3080
3215 4080
3215 3120
3215 4120
3215 3160
3215 4160
3225 3012
3225 4012
3225 6012
3225 3020
3225 4020
3225 6020
3225 3040
3225 4040
3225 6040
3225 3050
3225 4050
3225 3063
3225 4063
3225 3080
3225 4080
3225 3120
3225 4120
3225 3160
3225 4160
coff_163_b_1_cat
Side operation
Rating
(A)
Top/Bottom
connection
Bottom/
Bottom
connection
Side operation(1)(2)
Rating
(A)
No. of
poles
50
3P
50
4P
50
6P
80
3P
80
4P
80
6P
125
3P
125
4P
125
6P
200
3P
200
4P
200
6P
400
3P
400
4P
500
3P
500
4P
630
3P
630
4P
800
3P
800
4P
1250
3P
1250
4P
1600
3P
1600
4P
Top/Bottom
connection
Bottom/
Bottom
connection
Reference
Reference
3265 3005
3265 4005
3265 6005
3265 3008
3265 4008
3265 6008
3265 3012
3265 4012
3265 6012
3265 3020
3265 4020
3265 6020
3265 3040
3265 4040
3265 3050
3265 4050
3265 3063
3265 4063
3265 3080
3265 4080
3265 3120
3265 4120
3265 3160
3265 4160
3265 3005
3265 4005
3265 6005
3265 3008
3265 4008
3265 6008
3275 3012
3275 4012
3275 6012
3275 3020
3275 4020
3275 6020
3275 3040
3275 4040
3275 3050
3275 4050
3275 3063
3275 4063
3275 3080
3275 4080
3275 3120
3275 4120
3275 3160
3275 4160
(1) For the mechanical indicator option, replace the second digit of the enclosure reference number with the letter V.
For example: 3V15 3012.
(2) Stainless steel enclosures, specific locking systems, terminal pre-wired/non pre-wired control auxiliary contacts, ventilation
and humidity evacuation systems or cable glands are available upon request. Please consult us.
Accessories
Auxiliary contacts
A/C
Factory fitted
A/C
2799 0001
2799 1001(1)
2799 0002
(1)
2799 1002
2999 0012
2999 1012
3290 6002
3290 6012
(1)
coff_177_a_1_cat
Factory fitted
low level
auxiliary:
(1)
3290 6102
12
14
11
12
612
4
1
coff_003_a_1_x_cat
Contact(s)
Mounting
q On the double locking system.
q Possibility of factory mounting
on enclosure (please provide
enclosure reference when
ordering).
coff_178_a_1_cat
Use
For pre-breaking and signalling of
positions 0 and I of the load break
switch.
11
14
Safety enclosures
Normal atmospheres
Polyester enclosures from 50 to 1600 A
Locking in
position 0
3290 7006(1)
3290 7016(1)
3290 7005
3290 7015
4409 8511
4409 8601
coff_205_c_1_cat
Type
Utilisation category
400 VAC
400 VAC
400 VAC
690 VAC
690 VAC
690 VAC
AC-21
AC-22
AC-23
AC-21
AC-22
AC-23
50 A
80 A
125 A
200 A
400 A
500 A
630 A
800 A
1250 A
1600 A
50
50
50
40
25
80
63
63
63
40
10
125
125
125
100
63
16
200
200
200
160
100
400
400
400
400
200
80
500
400
400
400
200
80
630
630
630
630
315
100
800
800
630
800
315
125
1250
1250
1000
1000
400
200
1600
1250
1000
1250
400
200
25
30
7.5
30
33
63
11
63
55
100
220
75
220
185
220
75
220
185
355
90
355
295
355
110
450
295
560
185
710
400
560
185
710
400
25
22
100
90
Dimensions
Front operation
Ab
coff_118_d_1_gb_cat
B1
Ah
Top/Bottom
connection
65
Rating
(A)
125
125
125
200
200
200
200
200
400
500
630
800
1250
1600
No. of
poles
3/4 P
3/4 P
6P
3P
3P
4P
4P
6P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
H x W x D (mm)
360 x 270 x 171
360 x 270 x 201
360 x 540 x 171
360 x 270 x 201
540 x 270 x 201
360 x 360 x 201
540 x 360 x 201
360 x 540 x 201
720 x 540 x 214
720 x 540 x 214
800 x 600 x 300
800 x 600 x 300
Please consult us
Please consult us
Bottom/Bottom
connection
Connection
cross-section Ah
B1 Weight Ab
B1 Weight
(mm2)
(mm) (mm) (kg) (mm) (mm) (kg)
50
135 110
6
50
167 205
6
50
135 110
8
167 205
9
95
145 190
8
95
260 150
7
95
145 190
8
95
257 153
9
95
257 153
13
145 190
15
185
258 257
19
330 395
24
185
258 257
20
330 390
26
2 x 300
270 270
26
330 400
36
2 x 300
266 267
27
330 394
40
4 x 185
365 365
42
515 594
60
4 x 300
360 360
47
500 580
65
Side operation
45
B1
Ab
coff_119_f_1_gb_cat
Ah
Top/Bottom
connection
Rating
(A)
50
50
80
80
125
125
200
200
200
200
200
400
500
630
800
1250
1600
No. of
poles
3/4 P
6P
3/4 P
6P
3/4 P
6P
3P
3P
4P
4P
6P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
H x W x D (mm)
270 x 180 x 171
270 x 360 x 201
270 x 180 x 171
270 x 360 x 201
360 x 270 x 171
360 x 540 x 171
360 x 270 x 171
540 x 270 x 171
360 x 360 x 171
540 x 360 x 171
540 x 540 x 171
720 x 540 x 201
720 x 540 x 201
800 x 600 x 300
800 x 600 x 300
Please consult us
Please consult us
Bottom/Bottom
connection
Connection
cross-section Ah
B1 Weight Ab
B1 Weight
(mm2)
(mm) (mm) (kg) (mm) (mm) (kg)
16
84
116
3
116
3
16
84
116
5
116
5
35
73
106
3
106
3
35
73
106
5
106
5
50
135 110
6
167 205
6
50
135 110
9
167 205
9
95
145 190
7
95
260 150
8
95
145 190
8
95
257 153
9
95
260 150
12
145 190
11
185
300 215
19
370 437
24
185
300 215
21
230 432
26
2 x 300
270 270
26
390 438
36
2 x 300
266 267
27
370 434
40
4 x 185
365 365
42
570 622
60
4 x 300
360 360
47
550 608
65
613
Safety enclosures
The solution for
>
>
>
>
>
>
coff_159_a_3_cat
Integrated products
& solutions
Normal atmospheres
Steel enclosures from 50 to 1600 A
Steel works.
Cement works.
Automotive.
Mining industries.
Agrofood industry.
Chemical industry.
coff_156_b_1_cat
Steel enclosure
with side operation handle
Strong points
Steel enclosure
with front operation handle
Function
Conformity to standards
Safety enclosures equipped with SOCOMEC switches provide emergency breaking, breaking
for mechanical maintenance and safety isolation in the vicinity of any low voltage final circuit.
Advantages
Safety of operations
q Visible contacts and positive break indication
with the possibility to add a mechanical
indicator.
q Double locked door when switch is in the
ON position.
q Triple locking of the handle in the OFF
position.
Inductive load breaking (AC23)
Safety enclosures are designed for use with
inductive loads and are able to make and
break on load (AC23).
614
Robust product
Product has been designed for industrial
environments with either mechanical risks or
non-explosive dust risks (galvanised steel,
thickness 2 mm, triplex glass, metal handle, etc.)
Specific requests
> SOCOMEC can offer you
customised solutions to meet
your specific requirements.
Contact your Socomec office
for further information.
Safety enclosures
Normal atmospheres
Steel enclosures from 50 to 1600 A
General characteristics
Breaking device:
All safety enclosures are equipped with SIDER
load break switches and visible, reliable
indication of the contacts open position.
They make and break under load conditions
and provide safety isolation for any low
voltage circuit.
Enclosure:
q Enclosures are in 2-mm thick galvanised
steel. They are assembled by welding and
are deburred.
q The anti-corrosion protection is achieved
using polyester powder which polymerises
in the oven at 180. Paint coating is 60 m
minimum and the colour is metallic grey. The
tank and door colour is RAL9001 and the
roof and/or gland plate colour is RAL7032.
q The chrome-plated zamak door is
assembled on a 180 hinge and is locked
using an 8 mm square key.
q Wall mounting is achieved using 4 fixing
lugs, supplied loose. These enclosures
provide an IP55 degree of protection.
Visible breaking:
The contacts are visible through a triplex
window, located on the enclosure door. This
enables the operator to confirm the position
of the contacts either during a preventative
check or before an operation.
Double locking:
It is ensured by a simple robust mechanism in
connection with the control shaft. Activation
with the door open remains possible by
authorised personnel.
Operation handle:
Steel safety enclosures are available with front
or side operation handles. The handle is made
of zamak and has a natural finish. It is possible
to order a red handle (emergency breaking)
to be fitted in the factory or by the customer.
The handle can be locked in the OFF position
using three padlocks.
Connections:
Steel enclosures are available in two versions:
q HB version (top entry and bottom exit)
equipped with two gland plates.
q BB version (all cables enter at the bottom)
equipped with a roof at the top and a plate at
the bottom. For the BB version, connection
is achieved by running cables to the top for
@MC Q@SHMFR
%NQGHFGDQQ@SHMFR@
copper bottom-bottom busbar enables easy
connection of incoming cables.
Miscellaneous:
q An earthing bar for connection is available in
the enclosure.
q Incoming protection screen.
615
Safety enclosures
Normal atmospheres
Steel enclosures from 50 to 1600 A
References
Front operation
Front operation(1)(2)
Bottom/
Top/Bottom
Bottom
connection
connection
coff_156_b_1_cat
Rating
(A)
50
50
80
80
125
125
125
200
200
200
400
400
400
500
500
630
630
800
800
1250
1250
1600
1600
coff_159_a_3_cat
Side operation
No. of
poles
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
6P
3P
4P
6P
3P
4P
6P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
Reference
Reference
3211 3005
3211 4005
3211 3008
3211 4008
3211 3012
3211 4012
3211 6012
3211 3020
3211 4020
3211 6020
3211 3040
3211 4040
3211 6040
3211 3050
3211 4050
3211 3063
3211 4063
3211 3080
3211 4080
3211 3120
3211 4120
3211 3160
3211 4160
3221 3005
3221 4005
3221 3008
3221 4008
3221 3012
3221 4012
3221 6012
3221 3020
3221 4020
3221 6020
3221 3040
3221 4040
3221 6040
3221 3050
3221 4050
3221 3063
3221 4063
3221 3080
3221 4080
3221 3120
3221 4120
3221 3160
3221 4160
Side operation(1)(2)
Bottom/
Top/Bottom
Bottom
connection
connection
Rating
(A)
50
50
50
80
80
80
125
125
125
200
200
200
400
400
500
500
630
630
800
800
1250
1250
1600
1600
No. of
poles
3P
4P
6P
3P
4P
6P
3P
4P
6P
3P
4P
6P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
Reference
Reference
3261 3005
3261 4005
3261 6005
3261 3008
3261 4008
3261 6008
3261 3012
3261 4012
3261 6012
3261 3020
3261 4020
3261 6020
3261 3040
3261 4040
3261 3050
3261 4050
3261 3063
3261 4063
3261 3080
3261 4080
3261 3120
3261 4120
3261 3160
3261 4160
3271 3005
3271 4005
3271 6005
3271 3008
3271 4008
3271 6008
3271 3012
3271 4012
3271 6012
3271 3020
3271 4020
3271 6020
3271 3040
3271 4040
3271 3050
3271 4050
3271 3063
3271 4063
3271 3080
3271 4080
3271 3120
3271 4120
3271 3160
3271 4160
(1) For the mechanical indicator option, replace the second digit of the enclosure reference number with the letter V.
For example: 3V11 3005.
(2) Stainless steel enclosures, specific locking systems, terminal pre-wired/non pre-wired control auxiliary contacts, ventilation and
humidity evacuation systems or cable glands are available upon request. Please consult us.
Accessories
Auxiliary contacts
2999 0012
2999 1012(1)
3290 6002
3290 6012(1)
3290 6102(1)
coff_178_a_1_cat
12
4
1
coff_003_a_1_x_cat
Factory fitted
A/C
coff_002_a_1_x_cat
A/C
Contact(s)
coff_177_a_1_cat
Mounting
q On the double locking system.
q Possibility of factory mounting
on enclosure (please provide
enclosure reference when
ordering).
Use
For pre-breaking and signalling of
positions 0 and I of the load break
switch.
14
11
12
11
14
Type
Locking using RONIS EL 11AP lock (not included)
Locking using XOP10 lock (not included)
Lock RONISEL11AP
Serv Trayvou XOP10 lock
Locking in
position 0
3290 7005
3290 7015
4409 8511
4409 8601
Locking in
position 0
3290 7006(1)
3290 7016(1)
Red handle
Rating (A)
50 80
125 500
630 1600
Front operation
Side operation
616
coff_181_a_1_cat
Use
Red steel handle for load break or emergency stop operation.
Safety enclosures
Normal atmospheres
Steel enclosures from 50 to 1600 A
Utilisation category
AC-21
AC-22
AC-23
AC-21
AC-22
AC-23
50 A
50
50
50
40
25
80 A
80
63
63
63
40
10
125 A
125
125
125
100
63
16
200 A
200
200
200
160
100
400 A
400
400
400
400
200
80
500 A
500
400
400
400
200
80
630 A
630
630
630
630
315
100
800 A
800
800
630
800
315
125
1250 A
1250
1250
1000
1000
400
200
1600 A
1600
1250
1000
1250
400
200
25
30
7.5
30
33
63
11
63
55
100
220
75
220
185
220
75
220
185
355
90
355
295
355
110
450
295
560
185
710
400
560
185
710
400
25
22
100
90
Dimensions
Front operation
Top/Bottom
connection
Rating
(A)
Ab
B1
Ah
coff_115_d_1_x_cat
80
No. of
poles
H x W x D (mm)
Connection
cross-section
(mm2)
Ah
(mm)
B1
(mm)
Bottom/Bottom
connection
Weight
(kg)
Ab
(mm)
B1
(mm)
Weight
(kg)
50
3/4 P
16
70
160
155
80
3/4 P
35
70
105
10
135
10
125
3/4 P
50
130
135
15
130
185
16
125
6P
50
195
195
18
180
235
21
200
3P
95
150
200
17
215
275
18
200
4P
95
150
200
17
215
275
18
200
6P
95
225
230
22
315
375
24
400
3/4 P
185
220
245
33
240
305
37
400
6P
185
300
300
45
340
405
60
500
3/4 P
185
215
240
34
240
300
39
630
3/4 P
2 x 300
380
500
47
320
525
84
800
3/4 P
2 x 300
380
500
52
320
525
85
1250
3P
4 x 185
375
495
70
90
1250
4P
4 x 185
375
495
74
94
1600
3P
4 x 300
360
480
80
92
1600
4P
4 x 300
360
480
85
96
Side operation
Top/Bottom
connection
80
Ab
B1
Ah
coff_117_d_1_gb_cat
Rating
(A)
50
50
80
80
125
125
200
200
200
200
400
500
630
800
1250
1250
1600
1600
No. of
poles
3/4 P
6P
3/4 P
6P
3/4 P
6P
3P
3P
4P
6P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3P
4P
3P
4P
H x W x D (mm)
300 x 200 x 150
300 x 400 x 200
300 x 200 x 150
300 x 400 x 200
400 x 300 x 200
400 x 400 x 200
400 x 300 x 200
400 x 300 x 200
500 x 400 x 200
600 x 500 x 200
700 x 400 x 250
700 x 400 x 250
900 x 500 x 300
900 x 500 x 300
1200 x 600 x 400
1200 x 700 x 400
1200 x 600 x 400
1200 x 700 x 400
Connection
cross-section
(mm2)
16
16
35
35
50
50
95
95
95
95
185
185
2 x 300
2 x 300
4 x 185
4 x 185
4 x 300
4 x 300
Bottom/Bottom
connection
Ah
(mm)
120
120
100
100
155
190
B1
(mm)
130
130
110
110
130
190
Weight
(kg)
9
10
8
10
16
17
185
185
235
270
265
320
310
465
465
445
445
185
185
235
230
225
320
310
465
465
445
445
18
21
25
30
32
47
55
70
74
75
76
Ab
(mm)
190
240
180
B1
(mm)
160
160
140
140
225
275
220
Weight
(kg)
9
10
9
10
17
21
21
250
300
345
340
455
445
670
670
650
650
295
345
405
400
540
530
770
770
790
790
22
27
35
39
55
85
90
100
100
110
617
Safety enclosures
Integrated products
& solutions
coff_280_b_1_cat
Strong points
>
>
>
>
ATEX enclosures from 50 to 630 A
Function
SOCOMEC ATEX enclosures incorporate three or four pole manually operated SIDER (ND)
load break switches which make and break on load, providing emergency breaking and
maintenance isolation for any low voltage electrical circuit which is in an area where there is a
risk of explosion due to dust.
Safety of operations.
,QGXFWLYHORDGEUHDNLQJ}$&
Robust design.
Protection degree IP65.
Conformity to standards
>
>
>
>
>
>
'LUHFWLYH&(
,(&
,(&
,(&
,(&
1)&
Advantages
Safety of operations
q Visible contacts and positive break
indication through the operating handle and
a factory fitted mechanical flag indicator,
provide guaranteed position indication of
the contacts.
q Double locked door when switch is in the
ON position.
q Triple locking of the handle in the OFF
position.
Inductive load breaking (AC23)
ATEX enclosures are designed for use with
inductive loads and are able to make and
break on load (AC23).
Robust design
Product has been specifically designed
for industrial environments with the risk of
explosion due to dust (galvanised steel,
thickness 2 mm, triplex glass, S-type handle
metal padlocking lever).
Protection degree IP65
Protection degree of ATEX enclosures is IP65.
Other regulations
> 'HFUHH
Machine safety
> 'HFUHHQ
IURP
protection of workers
> 'HFUHHQ
IURP
> 'HFUHH
machine compliance
Specific requests
> 62&20(&FDQRIIHU
customised solutions to meet
your specific requirements.
Please contact your
Socomec office for further
information.
618
Safety enclosures
General characteristics
Breaking device:
q All safety enclosures are equipped with load
break switches that provide visible, reliable
indication of the contacts open position.
q SIDER for 50 A, 80 A and 630 A ratings
q SIDER ND 80 A (6P) to 400 A ratings
q They make and break under load
conditions and provide safety isolation for
any low voltage circuit. They are factory
fitted with a mechanical flag indicator
(SIDER) which provides guaranteed
position indication of the contacts.
Mechanical flag indicator:
q As far as I am aware this option is only
possible with SIDER and not the SIDER ND.
If we are utilising both switch types, and the
ND cannot have a flag indicator, then we
need to advise this. This is why I made the
point to the right (mechanical flag indicator
(SIDER)). Please just confirm this point.
Double locking:
q This function is achieved through a simple
and robust mechanism using an extension
shaft. Activation with the door open remains
possible by authorised personnel.
Enclosure:
q Enclosures are made of a 2 mm thick
galvanised steel. They are assembled by
welded and deburred.
q The anti-corrosion protection is achieved
using an epoxy polyester powder which
polymerises in the oven at 180. Paint
coating is 60 m minimum and colour is
metallic gray.
q The chrome-plated zamak door is
assembled on an invisible hinge and is
locked using an 8 mm square key.
q Wall mounting is achieved using 4 fixing lugs
(factory mounted).
Connection:
q Steel safety enclosures are available with
bottom cable entry and exit.
q Enclosures are fitted with a top roof and a
bottom closing plate in the bottom part.
q Connection is achieved by running cables to
SGDSNOSDQLHM@KRENQ @MC Q@SHMFR
For higher ratings, a copper bottom-bottom
busbar enables easy connection of incoming
cables.
Miscellaneous:
q Two earthing bars for connection are
available in the enclosure.
q Fuse protection screen.
Visible breaking:
q The contacts are visible through a triplex
window, located on the enclosure door. This
enables the operator to confirm the position
of the contacts either during a preventative
check or before an operation.
Operation handle:
q ATEX enclosures are provided with a red
S-type operating handle. It is made of an
insulating material and includes a metal
padlocking lever. The handle can be locked
in the OFF position using three padlocks.
619
Safety enclosures
References
coff_280_b_1_cat
Rating (A)
50
50
80
80
80
125
125
160
200
200
400
400
630
630
No. of poles
3P
4P
3P
4P
6P
3P
4P
6P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
Bottom/bottom connection
Reference
3V41 3005
3V41 4005
3V41 3008
3V41 4008
3V41 6008
3V51 3012
3V51 4012
3V51 6020
3V51 3020
3V51 4020
3V51 3040
3V51 4040
3V51 3063
3V51 4063
Accessories
ATEX cable glands
Black polyamide
Min. cable diameter (mm)
3.5
5
6
8
10
13
18
24
29
12
6.5
16
4.5
10
20
13
25
10
18
32
16
24.5
40
22
32
3240 1012
3240 1016
3240 1017
3240 1020
3240 1021
3240 1025
3240 1032
3240 1040
3240 1050
3240 3012
3240 3016
3240 3020
3240 3025
3240 3032
3240 3040
3240 3050
coff_283_a_1_cat
Diameter (mm)
12
16
16
20
20
25
32
40
50
Diameter (mm)
620
3240 2012
3240 2016
3240 2020
3240 2025
3240 2032
3240 2040
3240 4012
3240 4016
3240 4020
3240 4025
3240 4032
3240 4040
coff_329_a_1_cat
Crude brass
Safety enclosures
Characteristics
50 A
3/4 P
80 A
3/4 P
80 A
6P
125 A
3/4 P
160 A
6P
200 A
3/4 P
400 A
3/4 P
630 A
3/4 P
415 VAC
AC-21 A/B
50/50
63/63
/80
125/125
/160
200/200
/315
/500
415 VAC
AC-22 A/B
50/50
63/63
/80
125/125
/160
200/200
/315
/500
415 VAC
AC-23 A/B
25/25
40/40
/80
125/125
/160
200/200
/315
11/
18.5/15
40/
60/
80/
100/
160/
25/
30/25
40/
60/
80/
100/
160/
Rated voltage
(1)
Ab
coff_289_c_1_fr_cat
B1
Dimensions
(1) 50 400 A: 45 mm
630 A: 61 mm
Bottom/bottom connection
No. of poles
H x W x D (mm)
Max. connection
cross-section (mm2)
Ab (mm)
B1 (mm)
Weight (kg)
50
3/4 P
16
288
198
8.2
80
3/4 P
35
288
198
8.4
80
6P
35
288
198
125
3/4 P
120
225
160
6P
120
242
275
25
200
3/4 P
120
242
275
21.5
Rating (A)
25
15
400
3/4 P
2 x 150
340
385
34.5
630
3/4 P
2 x 300
262
313
47
621
Integrated products
& solutions
q132$1DLNSD3Q@MREDQ
Switch Equipment).
Terms:
q,32$,@MT@K3Q@MREDQ
Switch Equipment).
Typical applications
Earthing
SITE 493 A
Source transfer
SITE 483 A
SITE 499 A
Fig. 1
622
Fig.2
Load switching
Fig. 3
Fig.4
Manual switching
Motorised solution:
Source changeover switch
controlled remotely by an external
controller using pulse logic or
maintained contact (contactor).
Automatic solution: Autocontrolled source changeover
switch. This comprises a break
switch, a motor component
and a microprocessor control
component.
COFF_390_A
p. 636
p. 630
TABLO_036_A_1_CAT
COFF_339_A_2_CAT
COFF_305_B_1_CAT
COFF_293_B_1_CAT
p. 624
623
Manual operation
MTSE* - Polyester enclosures from 25 to 630 A
The solution for
coff_299_a_1_cat
coff_339_a_1_cat
Strong points
> On load operation (AC22/AC23).
> Robust product.
Conformity to standards
Function
Advantages
>
>
>
>
IEC 60947-6-1
IEC 60364
IEC 61439
EN 60204-1
COMO C range
General characteristics
References
coff_339_a_2_cat
Dimensions
129
113
106
36
64
como_078_b_x_cat
Rating
(A)
25
25
25
25
25
25
40
40
40
40
40
40
63
63
63
63
63
63
80
80
80
80
80
80
No. of
poles
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
Switching
type
I - II
I - II
I - 0 - II
I - 0 - II
I - I+II - II
I - I+II - II
I - II
I - II
I - 0 - II
I - 0 - II
I - I+II - II
I - I+II - II
I - II
I - II
I - 0 - II
I - 0 - II
I - I+II - II
I - I+II - II
I - II
I - II
I - 0 - II
I - 0 - II
I - I+II - II
I - I+II - II
624
A (mm)
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
B (mm)
135
135
135
180
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
135
180
180
180
180
180
180
180
180
180
180
180
180
Reference
4221 3C02
4221 4C02
4231 3C02
4231 4C02
4241 3C02
4241 4C02
4221 3C04
4221 4C04
4231 3C04
4231 4C04
4241 3C04
4241 4C04
4221 3C06
4221 4C06
4231 3C06
4231 4C06
4241 3C06
4241 4C06
4221 3C08
4221 4C08(1)
4231 3C08
4231 4C08(1)
4241 3C08
4241 4C08(1)
Manual operation
MTSE - Polyester enclosures from 25 to 630 A
SIRCOVER range
References
coff_299_a_1_cat
Rating (A)
125
125
160
160
250
250
400
400
630
630
4215 3012
4215 4012
4215 3016
4215 4016
4215 3025
4215 4025
4215 3040
4215 4040
4215 3063
4215 4063
Dimensions
Ah
N
H
B1
No. of poles
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
coff_121_h_1_gb_cat
General characteristics
Top/Bottom
connection
I - 0 - II
Reference
(1)
Connection
Top/Bottom
Rating
(A)
125
125
160
160
250
250
400
400
630
630
No. of
poles
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
H x W x D (mm)
540 x 270 x 233
540 x 360 x 233
540 x 270 x 233
540 x 360 x 233
540 x 360 x 233
540 x 360 x 233
800 x 600 x 300
800 x 600 x 300
800 x 600 x 300
800 x 600 x 300
Max. connection
cross-section
(mm2)
50
50
95
95
150
150
240
240
2 x 300
2 x 300
M
N
Z
Ah
B1
(mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm)
272
542
28
210
210
362
542
28
210
210
272
542
28
210
210
362
542
28
210
210
362
542
29
205
205
362
542
29
205
205
620
796
29
330
330
620
796
29
330
330
620
796
45
297
297
620
796
45
297
297
Weight
(kg)
9
10
9
10
11
12
30
31
38
40
625
Manual operation
MTSE* and Bypass - Steel enclosures from 63 to 3200 A (3/4P)
The solution for
coff_298_b_1_cat
coff_293_b_1_cat
Strong points
SIRCOVER
in steel enclosure
Function
Advantages
Conformity to standards
>
>
>
>
IEC 60947-6-1
IEC 60364
IEC 61439
EN 60204-1
Specific requests
> SOCOMEC can provide
a wide range of specific
requirements.
Please consult us.
626
atys_570_a_1_x_cat
Manual operation
MTSE and Bypass - Steel enclosures from 63 to 3200 A (3/4P)
References
Top/Bottom
connection
Rating (A)
63
63
80
80
100
100
No. of poles
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
Reference
4413 3006
4413 4006
4413 3008
4413 4008
4413 3010
4413 4010
Dimensions
300
258
105.5
348
300
105.5
coff_317_a_1_x_cat
coff_293_b_1_cat
150
Rating (A)
3 x 63 / 4 x 63
3 x 80 / 4 x 80
3 x 100 / 4 x 100
58
Weight (kg)
9
10
16
627
Manual operation
MTSE and Bypass - Steel enclosures from 63 to 3200 A (3/4P)
coff_298_b_2_cat
Rating (A)
125
125
160
160
250
250
400
400
500
500
630
630
800
800
1250
1250
1600
1600
General characteristics
4212 3012
4212 4012
4212 3016
4212 4016
4212 3025
4212 4025
4212 3040
4212 4040
4212 3050
4212 4050
4212 3063
4212 4063
4212 3080
4212 4080
4212 3120
4212 4120
4212 3160
4212 4160
4116 3012
4116 4012
4116 3016
4116 4016
4116 3025
4116 4025
4116 3040
4116 4040
4116 3050
4116 4050
4116 3063
4116 4063
4116 3080
4116 4080
4116 3120
4116 4120
4116 3160
4116 4160
H
N
Ah
M
L
B1
Rating
(A)
125
160
250
400
500
630
800
1250
1600
628
I - I+II - II
Reference
Dimensions
coff_318_a_1_x_cat
No. of poles
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
3P
4P
I - 0 - II
Reference
No. of
poles
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
HxWxD
(mm)
500 x 400 x 250
500 x 400 x 250
500 x 400 x 250
800 x 600 x 300
800 x 600 x 300
800 x 600 x 300
1200 x 700 x 500
1200 x 700 x 500
1200 x 700 x 500
(1)
Max. connection
M
N
Z
cross-section
(mm) (mm) (mm)
(mm2)
50
448
458
28
95
448
458
28
150
448
458
29.3
240
758
552
29.3
240
648
658
45
2 x 300
648
658
45
2 x 300
740 1152
24
4 x 185
740 1152
24
4 x 300
740 1152
Top/Bottom connection
Ah
(mm)
190
190
185
330
298
290
465
465
470
B1
(mm)
190
190
185
330
298
290
465
465
470
Weight
(kg)
23
23
23
45
55
55
78
88
94
Manual operation
MTSE and Bypass - Steel enclosures from 63 to 3200 A (3/4P)
coff_298_b_2_cat
Rating (A)
125
125
160
160
250
250
400
400
500
500
630
630
800
800
1250
1250
1600
1600
General characteristics
I - 0 - II
Reference
4119 7012
4119 9012
4119 7016
4119 9016
4119 7025
4119 9025
4119 7040
4119 9040
4119 7050
4119 9050
4119 7063
4119 9063
4119 7080
4119 9080
4119 7120
4119 9120
4119 7160
4119 9160
Dimensions
H
N
Ah
M
L
B1
coff_276_c_1_x_cat
No. of poles
3+6 P
4+8 P
3+6 P
4+8 P
3+6 P
4+8 P
3+6 P
4+8 P
3+6 P
4+8 P
3+6 P
4+8 P
3+6 P
4+8 P
3+6 P
4+8 P
3+6 P
4+8 P
Rating
(A)
125
160
250
400
500
630
800
1250
1600
No. of
poles
3+6 / 4+8 P
3+6 / 4+8 P
3+6 / 4+8 P
3+6 / 4+8 P
3+6 / 4+8 P
3+6 / 4+8 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
3/4 P
HxWxD
(mm)
500 x 400 x 350
500 x 400 x 350
800 x 600 x 500
800 x 600 x 500
800 x 600 x 550
800 x 600 x 550
1200 x 700 x 500
1200 x 700 x 500
1200 x 700 x 500
(1)
Top/Bottom connection
Max. connection
M
N
Z
Ah
B1
Weight
cross-section
(mm) (mm) (mm) (mm) (mm)
(kg)
(mm2)
(1)
50
448
452
47
192
192
(1)
95
448
452
47
192
192
(1)
150
640
752
48
335
335
(1)
240
640
752
48
330
330
(1)
240
640
752
64
297
297
(1)
2 x 300
640
752
64
290
290
2 x 300
740 1152 24
465
465
78
4 x 185
740 1152 24
465
465
88
4 x 300
740 1152
470
470
94
629
Motorised operation
RTSE* - remote controlled from 40 to 3200 A
The solution for
Single-phase ATyS M 3s
in polycarbonate enclosure
coff_305_b_1_cat
atysm_251_a_1_cat
>
>
>
>
>
>
Three-phase ATyS 3s
in steel enclosure
Strong points
Function
q RTSE in enclosures provide a remote
controlled transfer between sources using
an external controller in order to ensure the
continuity of supply to critical applications.
q Manual operation is also possible with this
solution.
Advantages
Dedicated solution
The integrated RTSE is a solution which
has been designed and tested to provide
a reliable, and safe solution that is easy to
install and utilise.
630
Conformity to standards
>
>
>
>
IEC 61439-2
IEC 60947-6-1
IEC 60947-3
BS 60947-6-1
Motorised operation
RTSE - remote controlled from 40 to 3200 A
Three-phase interface
atysm_202_a
atysm_029_b
Electrical control
q The switching operation can be driven by external volt-free contacts, which
may come from an external control relay (ATyS C30 for example).
The positions are stable in case of loss of supply. There are two types of
control logic available:
Power supply
Maintained logic
(contactor type)
Impulse logic
ATyS M 3s is equipped with two independent 230 VAC power inputs (176-288 VAC),
50/60 Hz (45/65 Hz).
q These two power supplies can be connected individually one to switch I and
the other to switch II:
- Power supply I must be available to reach position I
- Power supply II must be available to reach position II.
q The 0 position is a stable transition position.
q The use of a dual power supply (DPS), or an external supply module, provides
full security of the 3 position commands with the availability of either supply.
In this case, both the supply inputs must be connected in parallel in order for
them both to be supplied from the output of the DPS.
order I
atysm_042_a_1_gb_cat
order O
order II
position I
position O
position II
ATyS 3s
General
q The switching operation can be driven by an external volt-free contact, using
a pulse or a maintained contact logic.
q On ATyS 3e, it is possible to inhibit the electrical control (volt-free contact
closed between terminal n 313 and 317).
q The first order received has priority as long as it remains. A zero command
always has priority, except in the case of control inhibition.
Impulse logic
- The switching command is a pulsed
volt-free contact (100 ms minimum).
- When the order disappears, the
product remains in position. The
impulse can be of infinite duration
without causing any disturbance.
svrmo_079_b_1_gb_cat
atys_030_a_1_cat
ATyS 3e
order I
order 0
order II
position I
position 0
position II
Maintained logic
(contactor type)
- The transfer command is a
maintained volt-free contact.
- If command I or II disappears, the
device returns to zero position, if
power supply is available.
- A zero command drives the device
into position 0, irrespective of the
status of the I and II commands.
atys_024_a_1_gb_cat
atys_029_a_1_cat
Operation
order I
order 0
order II
position I
position 0
position II
631
atysm_251_a_1_cat
q From 40 to 160 A.
q Network 230 VAC [176-288 VAC] /
'Y'Y:'Y'Y<
q Protection degree: IP 55, IK08.
q Colour RAL 7035.
References
Single-phase ATyS M 3s model (2P)
Rating (A)
40
63
80
100
125
160
Reference
1823 2004
1823 2006
1823 2008
1823 2010
1823 2012
1823 2016
Accessories
Customer fit
Auxiliary contact
Description
Auxiliary contact(1)
Voltage sensing and power supply tap (2 per reference)(1)
Voltage tap
Reference
1309 0001
1399 4006
(1) For more details please refer to the ATyS M section of this catalogue.
Factory fitted.
Description
ATyS C30 control relay (1)
ATyS C40 control relay (1)
Dual power supply (1)
DPS
Reference
1599 3030
1599 3040
1599 4001
(1) For more details please refer to the ATyS M section of this catalogue.
Dimensions
150
atysm_208_a_1_x_cat
410
305
632
Motorised operation
RTSE - remote controlled from 40 to 3200 A
From 40 to 160 A.
Network 230/400 VAC +/-20 % in standard
For applications 4 poles / 3 poles optional.
Integrated bridging bar.
Protection degree: IP3X or IP54.
Colour RAL 7035.
Cable gland plates: Top and bottom.
Material: steel, thickness 1.2 mm.
Coating: epoxy polyester powder.
References
Three-phase ATyS M 3s model (4P)
Rating (A)
40
63
80
100
125
160
No. of poles
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
IP 3X
Reference
IP 54
Reference
1823 4004
1823 4006
1823 4008
1823 4010
1823 4012
1823 4016
1823 4005
1823 4007
1823 4009
1823 4011
1823 4013
1823 4017
Accessories
Customer fit
Voltage tap
Auxiliary contact
Description
Auxiliary contact (1)
Voltage sensing and power supply tap (2 per reference) (1)
Solid neutral kit (2)
Kit IP54 (for IP3X enclosure conversion)
Power connection terminals (1)
Reference
1309 0001
1399 4006
1309 9008
1399 4016
1399 4017
(1) For more details please refer to the ATyS M section of this catalogue.
(2) Solid neutral kit provides a maintained connection between both incoming and outgoing neutral terminals,
thereby providing an unswitched neutral.
Dimensions
atysm_210_a_1_x_cat
coff_366_a_1_cat
General characteristics
400
450
12.5
200
16
633
coff_305_b_1_cat
General characteristics
q ATyS 3s from 125 to 1600 A.
q ATyS 3e for ratings 2000, 2500 and 3200A.
q Adapted to mechanical risk and dust
hazard.
q Protection degree: IP54.
q Colour: RAL 7035.
q Cable gland plate: top and bottom.
q Connection of cables: Top or bottom from
125 to 250 A, bottom from 400 to 3200 A.
q The auxiliary contacts are wired to a
terminal block.
References
Standard device - 230 VAC
Rating (A)
125
160
250
400
630
800
1000
1250
1600
2000
2500
3200
No. of poles
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
Reference
1723 4012
1723 4016
1723 4025
1723 4040
1723 4063
1723 4080
1723 4100
1723 4120
1723 4160
1723 4200
1723 4250
1723 4320
Accessories
Factory fitted
Description
Dual power supply
2nd auxiliary contact: from 125 to 630 A
2nd auxiliary contact: from 800 to 1600 A
Autotransformer 400/230 VAC for three-phase networks without neutral
Terminal shrouds
3 position padlocking (I-0-II)
Reference
1599 9001
1599 9002
1599 9012
see ATyS pages
see ATyS pages
1599 9003
Customer fit
Description: Conducting neutral
125 160 A
250 A
400 A
630 A
800 A
1000 A
1250 A
1600 A
634
Reference
1599 1006
1599 1025
1599 1040
1599 1063
1599 1080
1599 1100
1599 1120
1599 1160
Motorised operation
RTSE - remote controlled from 40 to 3200 A
Dimensions
M
W
10.5
Z1
Z2
12.5
atys_619_d_1_gb_cat
223
H
N
Recommended
connection
cross-section (mm2)
H (mm)
W (mm)
D (mm)
M (mm)
N (mm)
Z1 (mm)
Z2 (mm)
Weight (kg)
125
50
650
400
300
448
608
38
134
25
160
70
650
400
300
448
608
38
134
25
250
120
1000
650
475
698
958
39.5
134.5
45
400
240
1000
650
475
698
958
39.5
134.5
50
630
2 x 185
1000
650
475
53
190
70
800
2 x 240
1200
800
660
66.5
253.5
135
1000
4 x 150
1200
800
660
66.5
253.5
140
1250
4 x 185
1600
1000
830
66.5
253.5
270
1600
4 x 240
1600
1000
830
67.5
253.5
375
2000
8 x 150
2000
1000
1000
400
2500
8 x 185
2000
1000
1000
400
3200
8 x 240
2000
1000
1000
400
Rating (A)
635
Automatic operation
ATSE* - Automatic equipment from 40 to 3200 A
The solution for
High Rise Buildings.
Data centres.
Energy production.
Healthcare buildings.
Banking and Insurances.
Transportation
(Airports, tunnels).
coff_366_a_1_cat
coff_305_b_1_cat
>
>
>
>
>
>
Three-phase ATyS M 6e
in steel enclosure
Three-phase ATyS 6e
in steel enclosure
Strong points
Function
q Automatic Transfer Switch Equipment
(ATSE) in enclosures provides an
autonomous and complete management in
the continuity of the power supply to critical
loads.
q From 40 to 160 A, enclosures are equipped
with ATyS M 6s (2P/4P - Simplified control
system) or ATyS M 6e (4P - extended
control system), which are modular units
enabling optimised integration.
Conformity to standards
>
>
>
>
Advantages
Dedicated solution
The integrated ATSE has been designed
and tested to provide a reliable, safe and
autonomous solution that is easy to install
and commission.
636
IEC 61439-2
IEC 60947-6-1
IEC 60947-3
BS 60947-6-1
Automatic operation
ATSE* - Automatic equipment from 40 to 3200 A
Configuration
ATyS M 6s
ATyS M 6e
atysm_203_a
atysm_031_b
Three-phase interface
Three-phase interface
atysm_030_c
Single-phase interface
On ATyS 6e models
Operation
atys_032_c
ATyS 6e
Characteristics
ATyS 6e are equipped with 2 power inputs (same
as ATyS 3e): one for supply from power source 1
and the other for supply from power source 2.
They allow the device to be controlled electrically
and automatically into any of the 3 positions when
either of the 2 supply sources is present.
637
atysm_251_a_1_cat
q From 40 to 160 A.
q Network 230 VAC [176-288 VAC] /
'Y'Y:'Y'Y<
q Protection degree: IP 55, IK08.
q Colour RAL 7035.
References
Single-phase ATyS M 6s model (2P): 230 VAC network
Rating (A)
40
63
80
100
125
160
No. of poles
2P
2P
2P
2P
2P
2P
Reference
1854 2004
1854 2006
1854 2008
1854 2010
1854 2012
1854 2016
Accessories
Auxiliary contact
Customer fit
Description
Auxiliary contact (1)
Voltage sensing and power supply tap (2 per reference) (1)
Sealable cover (1)
Voltage tap
Reference
1309 0001
1399 4006
1359 2000
(1) For more details please refer to the ATyS M section of this catalogue.
Dimensions
atysm_208_a_1_x_cat
410
305
638
150
Automatic operation
ATSE* - Automatic equipment from 40 to 3200 A
q From 40 to 160 A.
q -DSVNQJ5 "
@R
RS@MC@QC'Y'Y:'Y'Y<
q Network 127/230 VAC on request for
3X2,R@MC 3X2,D'Y'Y
:'Y'Y<
q For 4 pole applications as standard and
ONKD@OOKHB@SHNMR@R@MNOSHNM
q Integrated bridging bar.
q Protection degree: IP3X or IP54.
q Colour RAL 7035.
q Cable gland plates: top and bottom.
References
Three-phase ATyS M 6s model (4P): 230/400 VAC network
Rating (A)
No. of poles
IP 3X
Reference(1)
IP 54
Reference(1)
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
1854 4004
1854 4006
1854 4008
1854 4010
1854 4012
1854 4016
1854 4005
1854 4007
1854 4009
1854 4011
1854 4013
1854 4017
40
63
80
100
125
160
(1) Network 127/230 VAC, on request.
No. of poles
IP 3X
Reference(1)
IP 54
Reference(1)
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
1884 4004
1884 4006
1884 4008
1884 4010
1884 4012
1884 4016
1884 4005
1884 4007
1884 4009
1884 4011
1884 4013
1884 4017
40
63
80
100
125
160
(1) Network 127/230 VAC, on request.
Accessories
Customer fit
Description
Auxiliary contact(3)
Voltage sensing and power supply tap (2 per reference) (3)
Solid neutral kit (4)
Sealable cover (3)
Kit IP54 (for IP3X enclosure conversion)
Power connection terminals (3)
(1) For ATyS M 6s.
(2) For fully equipped product, order the reference 3 times.
(3) For more details please refer to the ATyS M section of
this catalogue.
Reference
1309 0001
1399 4006
1309 9008
1359 0000(1)
1399 4016
1399 4017(2)
(4) Solid neutral kit provides a maintained connection between
both incoming and outgoing neutral terminals, thereby providing an unswitched neutral.
Dimensions
600
560
coff_366_a_1_cat
General characteristics
400
450
12.5
200
16
639
coff_306_b_1_cat
General characteristics
q Adapted to mechanical risk and dust
hazard.
q Protection degree: IP54.
q Colour: RAL 7035.
q Connection of cables: Top or bottom from
125 to 3200 A, bottom from 400 to 3200 A.
q The auxiliary contacts are wired to a
terminal block.
q Material: XC steel, thickness 2 mm.
References
Standard device - 230 VAC
Rating (A)
125
160
250
400
630
800
1000
1250
1600
2000
2500
3200
No. of poles
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
Reference
1763 4012
1763 4016
1763 4025
1763 4040
1763 4063
1763 4080
1763 4100
1763 4120
1763 4160
1763 4200
1763 4250
1763 4320
Accessories
Factory fitted
Description
2nd auxiliary contact from 125 to 630 A
2nd auxiliary contact from 800 to 1600 A
Autotransformer 400 / 230 VAC for three-phase networks without neutral
Terminal shrouds
3 position padlocking (I-0-II)
Reference
1599 9022
1599 9032
see ATyS pages
see ATyS pages
1599 9003
Customer fit
Description
Solid neutral 125 160 A
Solid neutral 250 A
Solid neutral 400 A
Solid neutral 630 A
Solid neutral 800 A
Solid neutral 1000 A
Solid neutral 1250 A
Solid neutral 1600 A
ATyS D10
ATyS D20
RJ45 connecting cable
RS485 MODBUS communication module
2 inputs / 2 outputs module
(1) Necessary to connect an ATyS D10 or D20.
640
Reference
1599 1006
1599 1025
1599 1040
1599 1063
1599 1080
1599 1100
1599 1120
1599 1160
1599 2010
1599 2020
1599 2009(1)
1599 2000
1599 2001
Automatic operation
ATSE* - Automatic equipment from 40 to 3200 A
Dimensions
M
W
280
H
N
atys_621_c_1_gb_cat
Z1
Z2
1
2
12.5
Recommended
connection
cross-section (mm2)
H (mm)
W (mm)
D (mm)
M (mm)
N (mm)
Z1 (mm)
Z2 (mm)
Weight (kg)
125
50
650
400
300
448
608
38
134
25
160
70
650
400
300
448
608
38
134
25
250
120
1000
650
475
698
958
39.5
134.5
45
400
240
1000
650
475
698
958
39.5
134.5
50
630
2 x 185
1000
650
475
53
190
70
800
2 x 240
1200
800
660
66.5
253.5
135
1000
4 x 150
1200
800
660
66.5
253.5
140
1250
4 x 185
1600
1000
830
66.5
253.5
270
1600
4 x 240
1600
1000
830
67.5
253.5
375
2000
8 x 150
2000
1000
1000
400
2500
8 x 185
2000
1000
1000
400
3200
8 x 240
2000
1000
1000
400
Rating (A)
641
tablo_036_a_1_cat
tablo_035_a_1_cat
>
>
>
>
>
>
Data centres.
Power production.
Healthcare buildings.
High-rise buildings.
Banking and Insurance.
Transportation.
Strong points
> No-break load transfer in
Bypass mode.
> Solution certified by a
manufacturer.
> Optional accessories available.
Function
q Automatic transfer of two supply sources to
ensure continuity of supply to critical loads
such as sprinklers, elevators, water pumps...
q Guaranteed continuity of the power supply
during maintenance and test operations.
q Complete isolation of the Automatic Transfer
Switch ensuring maintenance safety.
General characteristics
q From 40 to 3200 A - 4 poles.
q 230/400 VAC +/- 20%, 50/60 Hz,
self-supplied from incoming sources.
q Normal/Emergency logic control sequence.
q Voltage and frequency checking of
networks I and II.
q Control of phase rotation.
q 1 configurable output relay for generator
start/stop command.
q Position I, 0, II control by external dry
contact.
q Manual emergency operation.
q Auxiliary contacts.
q MODBUS communication
(factory fitted).
642
Conformity to standards
>
>
>
>
IEC 61439-2
IEC 60947-6-1
IEC 60947-3
BS 60947-6-1
2 versions
Single Line ATS Bypass
q It consists of 2 functions: an automatic changeover switch and a
single Bypass line connected to the preferred supply source.
Disconnectors
Disconnectors
Automatic Transfer
Switch
Automatic Transfer
Switch
Q2
Q2
Disconnectors
Disconnectors
Q1
ATS By-Pass
Load
atys_801_a_1_gb _cat
atys_800_a_1_gb _cat
Overlapping Function
Overlapping Function
Q1
Selection Source
Q3
ATS By-Pass
Load
Use
Normal Position:
q The load is supplied by the supply source
defined as the preferred source. In
case of primary source failure, the ATS
automatically transfers the load to the
alternate source when available.
Test Position:
q From the Bypass position, changeover
switch Q2 can be closed to supply the
ATS and achieve operational checks,
without jeopardizing the supply to the load.
Transfer to the normal position can then be
achieved.
Bypass position:
q ATS seamless transfer to the Bypass mode
is achieved using the bypss line via Q1 to
ensure continuity in the power supply to
the load. Changeover switch Q2 is then
open to provide complete isolation from the
power supply sources and to ensure safe
interventions.
References
Standard product - 230 VAC for ATyS M 6e
Rating (A)
40
63
80
100
125
No. of poles
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
Single Line
Reference(1)
Double Line
Reference(1)
1785 4004
1785 4006
1785 4008
1785 4010
1785 4012
1786 4004
1786 4006
1786 4008
1786 4010
1786 4012
Rating (A)
160
250
400
630
800
1000
1250
1600
2000
2500
3200
No. of poles
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
4P
Single Line
Reference(1)
Double Line
Reference(1)
1785 4016
1785 4025
1785 4040
1785 4063
1785 4080
1785 4100
1785 4120
1785 4160
1785 4200
1785 4250
1785 4320
1786 4016
1786 4025
1786 4040
1786 4063
1786 4080
1786 4100
1786 4120
1786 4160
1786 4200
1786 4250
1786 4320
643
Accessories
Customer fit
Description
2 inputs / 2 outputs module (ATyS 6e only)
Reference
1599 2001
Extension cabinet
kdrys_504_a_2_cat
Use
From 1250A to 3200 A, the standard enclosed ATS Bypass is supplied with connections to
allow for Bottom/Bottom or Bottom/Top cable entry.
In order to facilitate the wiring, we propose the use of an extension cabinet, which can be mounted
to the side of the standard ATS Bypass enclosure, when utilising all other types of connections
(TT/TB/BT). The extension cabinet also enables any necessary future adaptation.
Reference
1599 9004
1599 9005
Rating (A)
40 125
250 400
630 3200
Reference
sgys_069_a_1_cat
Use
In order to ensure protection against
overvoltages of the equipment, type 1 and 2
surge protection is available.
1599 9016
1599 9017
1599 9018
Multifunction meter
For more information, please see pages
436 to 460.
diris_750_a_1_cat
Use
Multifunction meters are now available for
the display and monitoring of all the electrical
parameters.
Engine Exerciser
Description
Engine Exerciser
access_276_a_1_cat
Use
The enclosed ATS Bypass can be supplied with a genset exerciser.
(configure generator Start/Stop times, enable/disable routines, etc....).
Reference
1599 9006
Tinned Busbars
Use
Tinned busbar option for severe
environmental conditions.
644
Description
250
400
630
800
1000
1250 1600
2000
2500 3200
Reference
1599 9007
1599 9008
1599 9009
1599 9010
1599 9011
1599 9013
1599 9014
1599 9015
Description
Remote control module
Alarm
management
Data
logging
Remote
control
atys_761_a_1_fr_cat
Use
A serial RS485 connection with MODBUS
protocol is factory fitted.
Alarm
Reference
4899 0400
Signalling
Use
To get a global overview of the system status, an optional 16 LED mimic panel is available (voltage
availability per phase and device positions).
LOAD
Q3
P2
P1
Q2
ATS
Mimic panel
Single Line Double Line
Reference Reference
1599 9033
acces_275_b_1_x_cat
Description
40 3200
S2 S1
Q1
1599 9034
Normal
By-Pass
S1
S2
Dimensions
from 40 to 160 A
M
12.5
12.5
0
P2
P1
P1
D 20
Q3
D 20
N
H
Q3
Normal
atys_749_c_1_gb_cat
0
0
OFF
ON
By-Pass
Q1
Q2
H
(mm)
800
800
800
1000
1000
1000
Normal
OFF
By-Pass
ON
Q1
atys_759_c_1_gb_cat
P2
Q2
D
(mm)
300
300
300
300
300
400
M
(mm)
848
848
848
848
848
848
N
Weight
(mm)
(kg)
752
80
752
80
752
80
752
80
752
80
752
160
Rating (A)
250
400
630
v(2)
Recommended
connection
cross-section
(mm2)
70
240
2x185
H
(mm)
1200 (1)
1200 (1)
1600 (1)
L
(mm)
1000
1000
1200
D
(mm)
550
550
600
Weight
(kg)
180
200
600
645
Types of installations
Main architectures
DC protection
AC protection
Network
Production
Conversion
Connection to
mains network
Multi-inverter installations
This architecture is designed for high-power industrial installations from a few hundred
kWc to several MWc. If there is a fault or maintenance is required, the loss of production is
limited to the machine in question.
q Individually managed multi-inverter installation
This architecture is used to reduce the power of the PV inverters, splitting the PV
generators and inverters over several lines.
CATEC-PV_054_A_GB
Integrated products
& solutions
Photovoltaic enclosures
AC
Connection to
protection mains network
Production
DC
protection
Conversion
CATEC-PV_055_A_GB
AC
Connection to
protection mains network
Conversion
Production
646
DC
protection
Photovoltaic enclosures
Main functions
Photovoltaic generator
q PV panels.
DC side,
upstream of the inverter
q Switching and breaking.
q Short circuit and voltage
surge (lightning) protection.
q Integration in double
insulation (Class 2
components).
AC side,
downstream of the inverter
q Switching and breaking.
q Short circuit and voltage
surge (lightning) protection.
q Differential protection and
control.
Network synchronisation
q Metering.
q Switching and breaking.
q HV/LV transformation
depending on the installed
power.
Inverter
DC/AC converter
q Conversion of the
DCcurrent produced by
the photovoltaic panels
into AC current.
q Automatic disconnection
(loss of insulation, mains
power, etc.).
site_408_a
COFF-PV_065_A
COFF_380_A_1_CAT
site_317_a
647
Strong points
Advantages
Multi-field expertise and complete
business management
Support throughout the project by our
business account managers, accompanied by
specialist mechanical, electro-technical and
logistics teams in order to study all of your
needs.
An adapted response
Integration of customer needs and local
constraints concerning each country and
product:
q Customer standard or specific certifications
& approvals (SNCF, EDF, etc.).
q Technical validation by an inspection body.
q Part number creation for specific ranges.
q Batch production.
648
Customised solutions
Possibility of adapting our enclosures and
switching devices to provide the best solution
to the needs of our customers.
Certified and qualified
manufacturer solutions
Integrated solutions that comply with the
installation and product standards in force:
q IEC 61439
q NF C 15-100
q NF C 15-211 (Hospitals)
q NF C 17-200 (Public lighting), etc.
q IEC 60364
q EN 60204
We can also perform specific tests in our
COFRAC accredited laboratory.
Enclosure
selection
Safety
device
selection
Connection
type
Switching
device
selection
4
Steel enclosure
Chemical damage
Mechanical risks
Risk of dust
Risk of contamination
Polyester enclosure
q
q
q
q
Atmospheric corrosion
ATEX enclosure
q
q
q
q
649
Port environment
Rail application
coff_382_a
Urban environment
coff_125_a_3
coff_393_a
appli_228_a
650
appli_372_a
coff_044_b
coff_145_c_1_cat
appli_372_a
coff_040_a_2_cat
coff_391_a
Photovoltaic application
coff-pv_087_a
tablo_021_a
coff_392_a
tablo_039_a
tablo_020_a
coff-pv_088_a
Hospital environment
tablo_025_a
tablo_017_a
dp_020_a
ua_005_b
dp_008_a
651
References list
References
111x xxxx
112x xxxx
113x xxxx
114x xxxx
121x xxxx
122x xxxx
123x xxxx
124x xxxx
126x xxxx
127x xxxx
128x xxxx
1290 xxxx
1295 9001
1299 00xx
1299 0121
1299 5001
1299 501x
1299 502x
1299 503x
1299 6xxx
1299 8xxx
1309 0001
1309 001x
1309 2xxx
1309 4xxx
1309 9006
1309 9007
1309 9008
1309 9056
132x xxxx
1353 xxxx
1354 xxxx
1359 0000
1359 2000
136x xxxx
138x xxxx
1399 4006
1399 4016
1399 4017
1400 1020
1400 1025
1400 1032
1400 1040
1400 1050
1400 1075
1400 1220
1400 1232
1400 1240
1400 1250
1400 15xx
1401 000x
1401 001x
652
Pages
55, 57, 117, 118, 120
330, 333
117 to 120, 330, 333
55, 57, 117 to 120
47
47
47
47
46
46
46
46
46, 49
46, 47, 49
49
46, 47, 49
46 to 48
47, 48
46 to 48
46, 48
46, 47, 49
368, 369, 632, 633, 638, 639
368, 369
368, 369
368, 369
370
370
633, 639
370
368
368
368
368, 370, 639
368, 370, 638
368
368
35, 368, 369, 632,
633, 638, 639
633, 639
371, 633, 639
54 to 56, 58, 75, 76,
78, 117, 118, 121, 151, 152,
159, 160, 170, 171, 179, 200,
201, 227, 249, 250, 253,
330 to 332, 334, 351,
352, 360, 361
58
54 to 56, 58, 78, 117, 118,
121, 151, 152, 159, 160, 170,
171, 179, 190, 191, 194, 195,
200, 225, 227, 229, 249,
250, 253, 330 to 332, 334,
351, 352, 360, 361
151, 152, 159, 160, 170,
171, 179, 253, 351, 352
54, 55, 58, 75, 78, 117,
118, 121, 200
58
200, 201, 227, 228, 250, 253
191, 195, 200,
227 to 229, 250, 253
253
200
58
59, 78, 90, 121, 152, 160,
171, 199, 232, 242, 253,
326, 333, 361
59, 78, 90, 121, 152, 160,
171, 199, 232, 242, 253,
326, 333, 361
References
1401 003x
1401 004x
1401 0520
1401 0532
1401 0540
1401 06xx
1401 1520
1401 1532
1401 1540
1402 xxxx
1403 0xxx
1403 1520
1403 2111
1403 2113
1403 2114
1403 2813
1403 2814
1404 052x
1404 053x
1404 0540
1404 1520
1404 2111
1405 xxxx
1407 xxxx
1409 xxxx
1411 2111
1411 2113
1413 2111
1413 2113
1413 2114
1413 2115
1413 2311
1413 28xx
1414 2111
1414 2113
1414 2115
1415 2111
1417 2111
1418 2111
1419 0000
141A xxxx
141B xxxx
141D 2111
141D 2115
141D 2911
141D 2915
141E 2111
141E 2115
141E 2911
141E 2915
141F 2111
141G 2111
141H 6111
141H 6911
141I 6111
141I 6911
Pages
59, 78, 152, 160, 171,
199, 242, 253, 333
59, 78, 152, 160, 171,
199, 242, 253, 333
200, 201, 249, 253
190, 194, 200, 249, 253
200, 249, 253
32, 111, 112
54 to 56, 58, 78, 89, 90,
117 to 119, 121, 151, 152, 159,
160, 170, 171, 232, 239, 240,
242, 330 to 332, 334, 347,
351, 352, 360, 361
54 to 56, 58, 75, 78, 89, 90,
117 to 119, 121, 151, 152,
159, 160, 170, 171, 231, 232,
239, 240, 242, 330 to 332,
334, 347, 351, 352, 360, 361
54, 55, 58, 75, 78,
117 to 119, 121, 151, 152, 159,
160, 171, 347, 351, 352
325, 326
325, 326
89, 90, 239, 241, 242
31
31, 321
31
31, 321
31
32, 321
32, 321
32
76, 78
31
249, 253
28, 32, 135, 137, 145, 146, 321
30, 32, 111, 112, 321
32, 111, 112, 190, 194,
198, 199, 225
190, 194, 325
32, 111, 112, 198
325
325
190, 194, 198
198
325
32, 111, 112, 190, 194,
198, 199, 225
190, 194
190, 194, 198
32, 190, 194, 198, 225
198
32, 190, 194, 198, 225
33, 138, 146, 254
32
32
179, 249, 252
249, 252
199, 252
252
179, 252
252
199, 252
252
179, 249, 252
179, 252
249, 252
252
249, 252
252
References
1421 2111
1421 2113
1423 2111
1423 2113
1423 2114
1423 2115
1423 2311
1423 2813
1424 2111
1424 2113
1424 2115
1425 2111
1427 2111
1428 2111
1429 0000
1429 7xxx
142D 2111
142D 2113
142D 2115
142D 2813
142D 2911
142D 2915
142E 2111
142E 2113
142E 2115
142E 2813
142E 2911
142E 2915
142F 2111
142F 2113
142F 28xx
142G 2111
142G 2113
142G 28xx
142H 6111
142H 6911
142I 6111
142I 6911
1431 3111
1431 35xx
1432 xxxx
1433 3111
1433 3113
1434 3111
1435 xxxx
1436 xxxx
1437 3111
1437 7911
1438 3111
143D 3111
143D 3113
143D 3813
143D 3911
Pages
54 to 57, 75, 77, 117, 118,
120, 190, 191, 194, 195,
198, 199, 225, 227, 229
190, 191, 194, 195, 330,
332, 333, 360
54, 55, 57, 75, 77, 117,
118, 120, 198
330, 332, 333, 360
331, 333
190, 191, 194, 195, 198
198
337, 363
54 to 57, 75, 77, 117, 118,
120, 190, 191, 194, 195,
198, 199, 225, 227, 229
190, 191, 194, 195
190, 191, 194, 195, 198
76, 77, 190, 191, 194, 1
95, 198, 225, 227, 229
76, 198
76, 77, 190, 191, 194,
195, 198, 225, 227, 229
33, 59, 77, 121, 153, 172,
200, 254, 334, 361
199
151, 152, 159, 170,
171, 250, 252
351, 352
250, 252
351, 352
152, 159, 171, 199, 252
252
151, 152, 159, 170, 171, 252
352
252
352
152, 159, 171, 199, 252
252
151, 152, 159, 170,
171, 250, 252
352
352
151, 152, 159, 170, 171, 252
352
352
250, 252
252
250, 252
252
117 to 120
89, 90, 231, 232,
239, 240, 242
89, 90, 231, 232,
239, 240, 242
117 to 120, 191, 195,
198, 227, 229
332, 333, 347, 360
117 to 120, 191, 195,
198, 227, 229
89, 90, 239, 241, 242
89, 90, 239, 241, 242
76, 77, 191, 195,
198, 227, 229
198, 228
76, 77, 191, 195,
198, 227, 229
151, 152, 159, 170,
171, 250, 252
351, 352
352
152, 159, 171, 199, 252
References
143E 3111
143E 3113
143E 38xx
143E 3911
143F 3111
143F 3113
143F 38xx
143G 3111
143G 3113
143G 38xx
1443 3111
1443 3113
1443 3114
1444 3111
144D 3111
144D 3113
144D 3813
144D 3911
144E 3111
144E 3113
144E 38xx
144E 3911
144F xxxx
144G xxxx
1453 8111
1453 8113
1454 8111
1454 8113
145F 8113
1461 5111
1463 5111
1463 5113
1463 5114
1464 5111
1471 0111
1471 1111
1473 0111
1473 0113
1473 0114
1473 1111
1473 1113
1473 1114
1474 0111
1474 1111
147A xxxx
147B xxxx
147D xxxx
147E xxxx
1481 1111
1483 xxxx
1484 xxxx
148A xxxx
148B xxxx
148D xxxx
148E xxxx
1491 0111
1493 0000
1493 0111
1494 0111
1499 7701
1499 7702
1499 7703
149A xxxx
149B xxxx
149D 0111
Pages
151, 152, 159, 170, 171, 252
352
352
152, 159, 171, 199, 252
250, 252
352
352
252
352
352
54 to 57, 75, 77, 117 to 120,
191, 195, 198, 228, 229
330, 333
331, 333
54 to 57, 75, 77, 117 to 120,
195, 198, 228, 229
152, 159
352
351, 352
152, 159, 199
152, 159
352
352
152, 159, 199
352
352
55, 57, 117 to 120
330, 333, 352
55, 57, 117 to 120
352
171
102
31, 102
31, 321
31
31, 102
31
28, 31
31
31, 321
31
28, 31, 135, 137, 146
28, 31, 137, 321
28, 31, 137
31
28, 31, 135, 137, 146
28, 31
28, 31
135, 137, 145, 146
135, 137, 145, 146
28, 31
28, 31, 135, 137, 146
28, 31, 135, 137, 146
28, 31
28, 31
135, 137, 145, 146
135, 137, 145, 146
30, 32, 111, 112
59, 77, 90, 121, 152, 160,
170, 199, 242, 253,
326, 333, 361
30, 32, 111, 112, 249, 252
30, 32, 111, 112, 252
64, 81, 93, 123, 205, 234,
245, 337, 347, 363
64, 81, 205, 245,
337, 347, 363
64, 81, 205
30, 32
30, 32
249, 252
References
149E 0111
1509 0001
1509 1004
1509 1006
1509 3012
1509 302x
1509 306x
1509 3080
1509 3160
1509 3200
1509 4012
1509 402x
1509 406x
1509 4080
1509 4160
1509 4200
1517 2111
152x xxxx
153x xxxx
155x xxxx
1599 0002
1599 0003
1599 0004
1599 0032
1599 1xxx
1599 2000
1599 2001
1599 2009
1599 201x
1599 202x
1599 3030
1599 3031
1599 3040
1599 4001
1599 4064
1599 4121
1599 5xxx
1599 9001
1599 9002
1599 9003
1599 9012
1599 902x
1599 903x
1609 3063
1609 3080
1609 4063
1609 4080
170A 060x
170A 061x
170A 062x
170A 063x
170A 6080
170H 0069
170H 0235
170H 0236
170H 1007
Pages
252
391, 395
391, 396
132, 391, 396
56, 62, 330 to 332, 336,
383, 385, 387, 390, 392
56, 62, 123, 129, 131,
330 to 332, 336, 360, 363,
383, 385, 387, 390, 392
56, 62, 123, 129, 131,
330 to 332, 336, 360, 363,
383, 385, 387, 390, 392
56, 62, 123, 330 to 332,
336, 383, 385, 387, 390, 392
56, 62, 330 to 332, 336,
383, 385, 387, 390, 392
392
56, 62, 330 to 332, 336,
347, 383, 385, 387, 390, 392
56, 62, 123, 129, 131,
330 to 332, 336, 347, 360,
363, 383, 385, 387, 390, 392
56, 62, 123, 129, 131,
330 to 332, 336, 347, 360,
363, 383, 385, 387, 390, 392
56, 62, 123, 330 to 332,
336, 347, 383, 385,
387, 390, 392
56, 62, 330 to 332, 336,
383, 385, 387, 390, 392
55, 62, 392
32
395
391, 395
394
383, 385, 387, 390, 395
131, 383, 385, 387, 391, 395
383, 385, 387, 391, 395
383, 385, 387, 390, 395
634, 640
640
640
371, 391, 397, 640
368, 371, 640
368, 371, 640
405, 632
405
405, 632
370, 632
383, 385, 387, 390, 394
370
391, 394
634
634
634, 640
634
640
640
172, 351, 353
351, 353
172, 351, 353
351, 353
292
292
293
293
271
292 to 295
291, 293
290 to 293
271, 290, 291
References
170H 3004
170H 3006
170L xxxx
170M 0xxx
170M 1xxx
170M 2xxx
170M 31xx
170M 323x
170M 324x
170M 325x
170M 326x
170M 327x
170M 335x
170M 336x
170M 337x
170M 338x
170M 339x
170M 343x
170M 344x
170M 345x
170M 346x
170M 347x
170M 38xx
170M 41xx
170M 423x
170M 424x
170M 425x
170M 426x
170M 435x
170M 436x
170M 438x
170M 439x
170M 443x
170M 444x
170M 445x
170M 446x
170M 51xx
170M 523x
170M 524x
170M 5250
170M 5258
170M 5259
170M 526x
170M 535x
170M 536x
170M 538x
170M 539x
170M 543x
170M 544x
170M 545x
170M 546x
170M 58xx
170M 61xx
170M 623x
170M 624x
170M 6250
170M 6251
170M 6258
170M 6259
170M 626x
170M 627x
170M 633x
170M 634x
170M 635x
170M 636x
170M 64xx
170M 65xx
170M 68xx
170M 7xxx
170N xxxx
172x xxxx
Pages
271, 292, 293
271, 292 to 295
289
290
290
291
292
294
294
292
292
292
292
292
292
294
294
294
294
292
292
292
292
292
294
294
292
292
292
292
294
294
294
294
292
292
293
295
295
295
293
293
293
293
293
295
295
295
295
293
293
293
293
295
295
295
295
293
293
293
293
295
295
293
293
293
295
293
291
289
634
References
176x xxxx
1823 2xxx
1823 4xxx
182T 4xxx
182T 9xxx
1854 2xxx
1854 4xxx
188x xxxx
191x xxxx
1923 xxxx
192J 8015
192M xxxx
192S xxxx
192T 0003
192T 0005
192T 0006
192T 0007
192T 002x
192T 0101
192T 0102
192T 0103
192T 0105
192T 0106
192T 05xx
192T 06xx
192T 07xx
192T 08xx
192T 09xx
192T 14xx
192T 19xx
192T 20xx
192T 21xx
192T 23xx
192T 24xx
192T 32xx
192T 33xx
192T 34xx
192T 40xx
192T 46xx
192T 47xx
192T 48xx
192T 5xxx
192T 6xxx
192T 7xxx
192T 80xx
192T 81xx
192T 93xx
192T 95xx
192T 96xx
192T 97xx
192U 0xxx
192U 22xx
192U 23xx
192U 4xxx
192U 6xxx
192U 8xxx
192U 9xxx
192X 0056
192Y 0015
192Y 0025
192Y 0035
192Y 0045
192Y 0115
192Y 0125
192Y 0135
192Y 0145
192Y 0155
192Y 0165
192Y 0175
192Y 0185
192Y 0215
Pages
640
632
633
472
496
638
639
639
181
181
435
505
502
489, 491, 492
489, 492
491
491, 492
491
489
493, 496
489, 492
489, 491, 492
493
489
489
504
501
501
491
499
491
492
492
492
492
498
498
492
500
500
500
493
493
496
496
493
496
493
493
496
489
491
492
492
493
496
496
394
489, 492
489
492
493, 496
489, 492
489
492
493, 496
489, 492
489
492
493, 496
489, 492
References
192Y 0225
192Y 0235
192Y 0245
192Y 0255
192Y 0265
192Y 0275
192Y 0285
192Y 04xx
192Y 05xx
192Y 06xx
192Y 08xx
192Y 09xx
19Px xxxx
2107 0515
2107 0516
2107 052x
2107 053x
2119 0001
2119 001x
2119 1xxx
2119 3xxx
2129 0001
2129 01xx
213x xxxx
219x xxxx
21PV 21xx
21PV 22xx
21PV 23xx
21PV 3124
21PV 3184
21PV 32xx
21PV 33xx
21PV 3421
21PV 3722
21PV 38xx
21PV 39xx
21PV 4754
21PV 48xx
21PV 49xx
21PV 5102
21PV 52xx
21PV 53xx
21PV 6xxx
2200 1000
2200 1001
2200 1002
2200 1003
2200 1004
2200 1006
2200 1008
2200 1010
2200 1011
2200 300x
2200 3010
2200 3011
2200 3012
2200 3016
2200 31xx
2200 4xxx
2200 500x
2200 5011
2200 5013
2200 503x
2200 900x
2200 9011
2201 1xxx
2201 3xxx
2205 xxxx
2209 0xxx
2209 2xxx
2209 3409
Pages
489
492
493, 496
489, 492
489
492
493, 496
505
505
505
505
505
129
103
100, 103
103
103
100, 104
100, 102
100, 102
100, 102
101, 104
101, 102
101, 102
103
100, 108
101, 109
101, 109
100
100, 108
101, 109
101, 109
108
100, 108
101
101
100, 108
101, 109
101, 109
100, 108
101, 109
101, 109
100, 108
28, 33, 135, 138
28, 33, 135, 138
28, 33, 135, 138
28, 33, 135, 136, 138
28, 33, 135, 138
28, 33, 135, 136, 138
28, 33, 135, 138
28, 33, 145, 147
28, 33
28, 29, 135
28, 29, 145
28, 29
30
30
30
30
29, 33, 136, 138
29, 33, 145, 147
31
31
29, 33, 136, 138
29, 33, 145, 147
145, 147
145
28, 29, 135
111, 113
111, 113
29
653
References list
References
2209 6009
2209 6011
2214 3503
2215 xxxx
222x xxxx
223x xxxx
2269 6009
2269 6011
2294 100x
2294 1011
2294 300x
2294 3016
2294 4016
2299 0xxx
2299 30xx
2299 3309
2299 3409
2299 3609
2299 4xxx
2299 5012
2299 5013
2299 5022
2299 5032
2299 5042
2299 6009
2299 6011
2299 9xxx
22Px xxxx
2600 xxxx
2601 xxxx
2609 0025
2609 0063
2609 0080
2609 1100
2609 1160
2609 1200
2609 2025
2609 2050
2609 2063
2609 208x
2609 4xxx
261x xxxx
262x xxxx
263x xxxx
2694 3014
2694 3021
2694 3051
2694 4014
2694 4021
2694 4051
2698 3012
2698 302x
2698 305x
2698 308x
2698 312x
2698 3199
2698 3200
2698 4012
2698 402x
2698 405x
654
Pages
34, 139
34
136
601
136
321
34, 139
34
29, 33, 135, 136, 138, 321
29, 33, 145, 147, 321
29, 33, 135, 136, 138, 321
29, 30, 33, 113, 145, 147, 321
30, 33, 113, 368, 369
29, 30, 34, 111, 113, 135,
136, 139, 145, 147, 321
321
29, 35
35, 135, 139
29, 35
321
28, 31, 135, 137
28
30, 31, 111, 112
28, 145, 146
30, 31, 111, 112
34, 139
34
35
111
54
56
117, 123, 129, 130, 362
129, 130, 362
117, 119, 123
117 to 119, 123
117, 118, 123
117 to 119, 123
118, 119, 129, 130, 362
117, 123
129, 130, 362
118, 119, 123
118, 119, 123
63, 335, 393
63, 335, 393
63, 335, 393
54, 56, 61, 179, 330 to 332,
336, 383, 385, 387, 390, 392
54 to 56, 61, 122, 129, 131,
330 to 332, 336, 383,
385, 387, 390, 392
54 to 56, 61, 122, 129,
131, 330 to 332, 336, 360, 362,
383, 385, 387, 390, 392
54, 56, 61, 179, 330 to 332, 336,
347, 383, 385, 387, 390, 392
54 to 56, 61, 122, 129, 131,
330 to 332, 336, 347, 383,
385, 387, 390, 392
54 to 56, 61, 122, 129, 131,
330 to 332, 336, 347, 360, 362,
383, 385, 387, 390, 392
54, 62
54, 55, 62, 123
54, 55, 62, 123
54, 55, 62, 123
54, 55, 62, 123
123
54, 55, 62
54, 62
54, 55, 62, 123
54, 55, 62, 123
References
2698 408x
2698 412x
2698 4199
2698 4200
2699 003x
2699 006x
2699 0101
2699 0122
2699 0141
2699 0142
2699 0143
2699 03xx
2699 1200
2699 504x
2699 5052
2699 5053
2699 6008
2699 601x
2699 602x
2699 9xxx
26Ax xxxx
26PV 3xxx
26PV 4xxx
26PV 6xxx
26PV 8xxx
2700 3011
2700 3017
2700 302x
2700 304x
2700 306x
2700 308x
2700 31xx
2700 4011
2700 4017
2700 402x
2700 404x
2700 406x
2700 408x
2700 41xx
2709 0021
2709 0025
2709 0040
2709 0041
2709 0061
2709 0062
2709 0081
2709 0121
272x xxxx
2798 3xxx
2798 4xxx
2798 6120
2798 6122
2798 80xx
2798 8120
2798 8122
2799 0001
2799 0002
2799 0005
2799 001x
2799 002x
2799 0111
2799 0121
2799 0122
2799 1xxx
2799 3015
2799 3018
2799 3019
2799 7002
Pages
54, 55, 62, 123
54, 55, 62, 123
123
54, 55, 62
54, 55, 60, 122
56, 60, 122
78
153
60, 122
60
122
60, 122
63, 335, 393
54, 57, 179
54, 57, 120, 151, 159
54, 57, 120
64, 123
64
64
64, 123
55
117
118
117, 119
118, 119
151
179
151
151
151
151
151
151
179
151
151
151
151
151
159, 161, 170, 173
159, 161
161, 173
159, 161, 170, 173
159, 170
161, 173
159, 161, 170, 173
159, 161, 170
162, 172
151, 153, 161
151, 153, 161
172
161
151, 153, 161
172
161
75, 78, 612
75, 78, 612
78
76, 79
151, 153, 161
79
153, 161
161
612
54, 55, 58, 117 to 119,
121, 330, 332, 334
54 to 56, 58, 117 to 119,
121, 330, 332, 334
54, 55, 58, 117 to 119,
121, 330, 332, 334
64, 337
References
2799 7003
2799 7007
2799 7012
2799 7013
2799 7042
2799 7043
2799 7052
2799 7053
2799 7062
2799 7070
2799 7072
2799 7074
2799 713x
2799 7145
2799 7147
2799 7155
27DC 3xxx
27DC 4xxx
27DC 6xxx
27DC 8xxx
27PV 3xxx
27PV 4xxx
27PV 6060
2900 xxxx
2905 xxxx
291x xxxx
292x xxxx
2998 000x
2998 001x
2998 002x
2998 003x
2998 3080
2998 3120
2998 3180
2998 4080
2998 4120
2998 4180
2999 0xxx
2999 1xxx
2999 8707
30xx xxxx
3115 xxxx
3117 xxxx
3125 xxxx
3127 xxxx
316x xxxx
317x xxxx
3211 xxxx
3215 xxxx
3221 xxxx
3225 xxxx
324x xxxx
3261 xxxx
3265 xxxx
3271 xxxx
3275 xxxx
3290 6xxx
3290 7xxx
350x xxxx
352x xxxx
3615 2005
3615 2006
3615 2010
3615 2011
3615 2012
3615 2015
3615 2016
3615 202x
3615 203x
3615 3005
Pages
64, 337
81
54, 56, 57, 75, 77, 120,
159, 332, 333
54, 56, 57, 75, 77, 120
55, 57, 330, 333, 352
55, 57
56, 57, 76, 77, 120, 331 to 333
56, 57, 76, 77, 120
159, 347
76, 77
54, 55, 57
117 to 120
54, 57
56, 57, 159, 170, 171
347
54, 55, 57
159
159
170
170
159
159
170
75
76
75, 76
75, 76
80, 89, 92, 231, 234, 239 to 241
60, 123
60, 123
60
80
80, 89, 92, 231, 234
231, 234
80
80, 89, 92, 231, 234
231, 234
612, 616
612, 616
64
607
602
605
602
605
606
606
616
612
616
612
620
616
612
616
612
612, 616
613, 616
89
231
196, 225
196
196
196, 225
196
197, 226
197, 226
197, 226
197, 226
196, 225
References
3615 3006
3615 3010
3615 3011
3615 3012
3615 3015
3615 3016
3615 302x
3615 303x
3615 6005
3615 6006
3615 6010
3615 6011
3615 6012
3615 6015
3615 6016
3615 602x
3615 603x
3625 200x
3625 2010
3625 2014
3625 2015
3625 2016
3625 2019
3625 202x
3625 203x
3625 300x
3625 3010
3625 3014
3625 3015
3625 3016
3625 3019
3625 302x
3625 303x
3625 600x
3625 6010
3625 6014
3625 6015
3625 6016
3625 6019
3625 602x
3625 603x
3629 4012
3629 4013
3629 7900
3629 7901
3629 7903
3629 7910
3629 7913
3629 9xxx
363x xxxx
364x xxxx
3650 xxxx
3655 xxxx
366x xxxx
367x xxxx
3680 300x
3680 308x
3680 31xx
3680 4xxx
3680 6xxx
369x xxxx
36Ux xxxx
371x xxxx
3729 40xx
3729 4532
3729 7540
3729 7544
3729 755x
3729 8xxx
3729 900x
Pages
196
196
196, 225
196
197, 226
197, 226
197, 226
197, 226
196, 225
196
196
196, 225
196
197, 226
197, 226
197, 226
197, 226
192
192
192
192
192
193
193
193
192
192
192
192
192
193
193
193
192
192
192
192
192
193
193
193
192, 196, 198
198
192, 196, 198, 225
75 to 77, 192, 193, 196 to 198,
225, 226, 228
192, 196, 205
198, 249, 250, 252
81, 192, 193, 196, 197, 205
201
194, 196
190, 192
240
241
239
194
190
228
228
190
228
588
228
249
249, 252
249, 251
249 to 251
250, 251
250, 251
255
251
References
3729 901x
3729 902x
3729 904x
3729 906x
3729 908x
3729 99xx
3799 6012
3799 8xxx
3799 9xxx
3811 2063
3811 208x
3811 21xx
3811 3063
3811 308x
3811 31xx
3811 6063
3811 608x
3811 61xx
3819 1120
3821 xxxx
3829 7923
3829 9120
3829 9308
3829 9310
3829 9312
3829 9320
3829 9325
3829 933x
3831 2005
3831 2006
3831 2010
3831 2011
3831 2012
3831 2015
3831 2016
3831 202x
3831 203x
3831 3005
3831 3006
3831 3010
3831 3011
3831 3012
3831 3015
3831 3016
3831 302x
3831 303x
3831 6005
3831 6006
3831 6010
3831 6011
3831 6012
3831 6015
3831 6016
3831 602x
3831 603x
3841 200x
3841 2010
3841 2014
3841 2015
3841 2016
3841 2019
3841 202x
3841 203x
3841 300x
3841 3010
3841 3014
3841 3015
3841 3016
3841 3019
3841 302x
3841 303x
Pages
255
255
255
255
255
251
151
255
255
195, 197, 226, 227
195, 197
195, 197
195, 197, 226, 227
195, 197
195, 197
195, 197, 226, 227
195, 197
195, 197
204
191, 193
205
204
191, 195, 201
190, 194, 201
191, 195, 201
190, 191, 195, 201
191, 195, 201
191, 195, 201
194, 225
194
194
194, 225
194
195, 227
195, 227
195, 227
195, 227
194, 225
194
194
194, 225
194
195, 227
195, 227
195, 227
195, 227
194, 225
194
194
194, 225
194
195, 227
195, 227
195, 227
195, 227
190
190
190
190
190
191
191
191
190
190
190
190
190
191
191
191
References
3841 600x
3841 6010
3841 6014
3841 6015
3841 6016
3841 6019
3841 602x
3841 603x
3850 xxxx
3859 6011
3861 2004
3861 2005
3861 2006
3861 201x
3861 202x
3861 203x
3861 3004
3861 3005
3861 3006
3861 301x
3861 302x
3861 303x
3861 6004
3861 6005
3861 6006
3861 601x
3861 602x
3861 603x
3870 300x
3870 3010
3870 3011
3870 3015
3870 3016
3870 302x
3870 303x
3870 600x
3870 6010
3870 6011
3870 6015
3870 6016
3870 602x
3870 603x
3880 300x
3880 3010
3880 3014
3880 3015
3880 3016
3880 3019
3880 302x
3880 303x
3880 600x
3880 6010
3880 6014
3880 6015
3880 6016
3880 6019
3880 602x
3880 603x
3890 2xxx
3890 3xxx
3890 8xxx
3890 9xxx
3894 xxxx
3898 202x
3898 203x
3898 2080
3898 2120
3898 302x
3898 303x
Pages
190
190
190
190
190
191
191
191
250
250, 252
249
249
250
250
250
250
249
249
250
250
250
250
249
249
250
250
250
250
194
194
194
195
195
195
195
194
194
194
195
195
195
195
190
190
190
190
190
191
191
191
190
190
190
190
190
191
191
191
228, 229
228, 229
226, 227
226, 227
204
250, 255
250, 255
191, 193, 195, 197, 203,
228, 229, 250, 255
191, 193, 195, 197,
203, 228, 229
250, 255
250, 255
References
3898 3080
3898 3120
3898 402x
3898 403x
3898 4080
3898 4120
3899 0400
3899 1xxx
3899 2xxx
3899 31xx
3899 33xx
3899 3U12
3899 6011
3899 7011
3899 7911
3899 8xxx
3899 9xxx
38U1 202x
38U1 203x
38U1 205x
38U1 206x
38U1 208x
38U1 21xx
38U1 302x
38U1 303x
38U1 305x
38U1 306x
38U1 308x
38U1 31xx
3954 2020
3954 2025
3954 204x
3954 2060
3954 302x
3954 3040
3954 3041
3954 3060
3954 3120
3954 402x
3954 4040
3954 4041
3954 4060
3954 4120
3990 1xxx
3990 2012
3990 202x
3990 204x
3990 22xx
3990 2839
3990 30xx
3990 31xx
3990 32xx
3990 33xx
3990 3839
3990 4xxx
3990 7xxx
3990 8xxx
3990 9xxx
3991 xxxx
3992 xxxx
3993 xxxx
3994 0xxx
3994 13xx
3994 14xx
3994 1901
3994 1902
3998 2016
Pages
191, 193, 195, 197, 203,
228, 229, 250, 255
191, 193, 195, 197,
203, 228, 229
250, 255
250, 255
191, 193, 195, 197,
203, 250, 255
191, 193, 195, 197, 203
200
204
229
204
204
229
193, 197, 198, 226, 228
193, 197, 198, 228
193, 197
227
227
229
229
228, 229
228, 229
228, 229
228, 229
229
229
228, 229
228, 229
228, 229
228, 229
153, 161, 172, 255, 353
161, 172
153, 161, 172, 255, 353
153, 161, 172, 255
151, 153, 255, 353
151, 153, 255, 353
153, 255, 353
151, 153, 161, 172, 255, 353
151, 153, 353
151, 153, 255, 353
151, 153, 255, 353
153, 255, 353
151, 153, 255, 353
151, 153, 353
91, 233, 243
233, 243
91, 233, 243
91, 233, 243
91, 233, 243
228, 229
91, 233, 243
91, 233, 243
91, 233, 243
91, 233, 243
228, 229
91, 233, 243
226, 227
226, 227
226, 227
91, 233, 243
233, 243
91
204
240, 241, 244
240, 241, 244
204, 269
204, 244
190 to 197, 203, 269
References
3998 2025
3998 3016
3998 3025
3998 3040
3998 3063
3998 3120
3998 4016
3998 4025
3998 4040
3998 4063
3998 4120
3999 0001
3999 0002
3999 0003
3999 0021
3999 0022
3999 0031
3999 0041
3999 0042
3999 0043
3999 0044
3999 005x
3999 0103
3999 011x
3999 014x
3999 02xx
3999 0600
3999 070x
3999 0710
3999 0720
3999 2839
3999 31xx
3999 32xx
3999 34xx
3999 3839
3999 4110
3999 6012
3999 6013
3999 6107
3999 6117
3999 6201
3999 6203
3999 7007
3999 701x
3999 702x
3999 703x
3999 80xx
3999 8104
3999 82xx
3999 83xx
3999 84xx
3999 8906
3999 8912
3999 9xxx
3999 Uxxx
3Vxx xxxx
4100 7xxx
4100 90xx
4100 91xx
Pages
191, 193, 195, 197, 203,
228, 229, 269
79, 190 to 197, 203, 269
79, 191, 193, 195, 197,
203, 228, 229, 269
89, 92, 239 to 241, 244
89, 92, 231, 234,
239 to 241, 244
239 to 241, 244
79, 190 to 197, 203, 269
79, 191, 193, 195,
197, 203, 269
89, 92, 239 to 241, 244
89, 92, 231, 234,
239 to 241, 244
239 to 241, 244
192, 196, 202
192, 196, 202
203
75, 76, 78, 79, 192, 193,
196, 197, 202, 225, 226, 228
75, 76, 78, 79, 192, 193,
196, 197, 202, 225, 226
89, 92, 231, 233,
239 to 241, 243
79, 203
79
79
79
89, 92, 231, 233,
239 to 241, 243
203
92, 233, 243
203
203
194, 195, 202
30, 34, 75, 76, 78, 79,
111, 113, 151, 153, 190,
191, 193, 197, 202,
225 to 229, 249, 250, 254
194, 202, 254
151, 153
229
91, 232, 244
91, 232, 244
91, 232, 244
229
91, 232, 244
89, 90, 239 to 242
89, 90, 242
93
234, 245
239, 240, 242
89, 90, 231, 232
93, 234
227
227
227
227
93, 234, 245
197, 203
197, 203
197, 203
196, 203
196, 197, 203
227
254
620
332
332
332
655
References list
References
4100 98xx
4109 0019
4109 0021
4109 0025
4109 003x
4109 005x
4109 0063
4109 008x
4109 012x
4109 0160
4109 02xx
4109 03xx
4109 1002
4109 1004
4109 1006
4109 160
4109 2007
4109 202x
4109 206x
4109 4xxx
4109 8507
4116 xxxx
4119 xxxx
4150 xxxx
4158 xxxx
4159 0021
4159 0022
4159 2xxx
4159 3xxx
4159 4xxx
4190 xxxx
4199 3018
4199 3019
4199 4012
4199 5012
4199 70xx
4199 7146
4199 7149
41Ax xxxx
41Px xxxx
4212 xxxx
4215 xxxx
4220 xxxx
4221 xxxx
4230 xxxx
4231 xxxx
4240 xxxx
4241 xxxx
4250 xxxx
4259 1xxx
4259 2xxx
4259 3xxx
4259 4xxx
4259 5xxx
4259 9xxx
429x xxxx
440x xxxx
441x xxxx
4430 xxxx
4439 0001
4439 5xxx
444x xxxx
656
Pages
347
330 to 332, 334, 383, 385,
387, 390, 392
129, 130, 330 to 332, 335,
347, 360, 362
330 to 332, 334, 362, 383,
385, 387, 390, 392
330 to 332, 334, 383, 385,
387, 390, 392
330 to 332, 334, 383, 385,
387, 390, 392
330 to 332, 334, 362, 383,
385, 387, 390, 392
330 to 332, 334, 383, 385,
387, 390, 392
330 to 332, 334, 383, 385,
387, 390, 392
330 to 332, 334, 383,
385, 390, 392
335, 393
335, 393
337, 347, 363
337
337, 347, 363
387
337
360, 362
360, 362
347
64
628
629
351
172, 351, 353
161, 172, 353
161, 172, 351, 353
351, 353
351, 353
351, 353
331
159, 160, 170, 171, 352
160, 171, 352
351, 352
56, 57, 331 to 333, 360
351
332, 333
352
330
360
628
625
317
624
317
624
317
624
317
317, 318
317, 318
317, 318
317, 318
317, 318
317
317
613, 616
627
325
325, 326
325
325
References
449x xxxx
4500 001x
4500 002x
4500 003x
4500 01xx
4501 xxxx
4502 xxxx
4503 xxxx
4504 xxxx
4505 xxxx
4510 xxxx
4511 xxxx
4512 xxxx
4513 xxxx
4514 xxxx
4516 xxxx
4518 xxxx
47xx xxxx
4825 001x
4825 0080
4825 0082
4825 0088
4825 0089
4825 0090
4825 0092
4825 0093
4825 0094
4825 0097
4825 01xx
4825 0200
4825 0201
4825 0202
4825 0203
4825 0204
4825 0205
4825 0206
4825 0207
4825 0208
4825 0209
4825 021x
4825 1xxx
4825 4xxx
4826 xxxx
4850 3000
4850 3001
4850 3002
4850 3003
4850 3004
4850 3005
4850 3006
4850 3007
4850 3008
4850 3009
4850 3010
4850 3011
4850 3012
4850 3013
4850 3014
4850 3015
4850 3016
4850 3017
4850 3019
4850 3020
4850 3025
4850 3026
4850 3027
4850 3028
4850 3029
4850 3030
4850 3031
4850 3032
Pages
325, 326
584
584
585
583
582
583
583
583
583
557
557
557
557
557
561
559
524
439
447
447
447, 453, 459, 463
447, 453, 459, 463
390, 396, 453, 459
390, 396, 453, 459, 463
390, 396, 453, 459
390, 396, 453, 459
453
443
447
453
453
390, 396, 453, 459, 463
390, 396, 453, 459, 463
453
453, 459
459
453, 459, 505
453, 459, 505
463
453
471
481
423
423
423
425
425
427
427
427
429
429
431
431
427
427
429
429
433
429
421
421
427
427
429
429
421
421
423
423
References
4850 3033
4850 3034
4850 3035
4850 3036
4850 3037
4850 3038
4850 4xxx
4853 xxxx
4899 0011
4899 01xx
4899 02xx
4899 03xx
4941 36xx
4941 3723
4941 3724
4941 3740
4941 3741
4942 xxxx
4950 0xxx
4950 6xxx
4981 04xx
4981 05xx
4981 10xx
4981 15xx
4982 04xx
4982 0719
4982 14xx
4982 17xx
4982 2xxx
4983 xxxx
4985 xxxx
4986 xxxx
4987 xxxx
499x xxxx
5000 000x
5000 0010
5000 0011
5000 0012
5000 0015
5000 0016
5000 0017
5000 0018
5000 0023
5000 0024
5000 0025
5000 0026
5000 0027
5000 0028
5000 0029
5000 003x
5000 0041
5000 0042
5000 0043
5000 0044
5000 0045
5000 0046
5000 0047
5000 0051
5000 0057
5000 0058
5000 006x
5000 0100
5000 012x
5000 013x
5000 03xx
5000 1021
5000 13xx
5000 4xxx
5021 xxxx
5022 0xxx
5022 5110
Pages
423
423
425
425
425
425
470
435
447, 453, 459, 463
486
487
487
517
517
519
517
519
521
525
463, 524
535
533
529
531
539
537
539
537
527
541
545
545
545
504
595
593
593
593
595
595
594
595
593
593
593
593
594
593
593
593
35, 594
594
594
594
595
595
595
35, 594
593
593
595
594
593
593
594
593
594
594
578
578
572
References
5023 01xx
5023 03xx
5023 04xx
5023 6110
5024 5xxx
5024 6xxx
5024 7xxx
5024 8xxx
5024 9000
5024 9001
5024 9002
5024 9031
5024 9032
5024 9033
5024 9034
5024 9041
5024 9042
5024 9044
5025 5100
5025 5105
5025 511x
5025 512x
5025 513x
5025 52xx
5026 xxxx
5027 xxxx
5028 0410
5028 0411
5028 0412
5028 0413
5028 0415
5028 042x
5028 045x
5028 047x
5031 xxxx
5032 xxxx
5038 xxxx
5039 xxxx
5119 44xx
5119 45xx
5119 46xx
5119 5xxx
52xx xxxx
5400 3016
5400 302x
5400 304x
5400 3063
5400 32xx
5400 4016
5400 402x
5400 404x
5400 4063
5400 42xx
5410 xxxx
5411 3xxx
5411 4016
5411 402x
5411 404x
5411 406x
5411 6016
5412 xxxx
5413 xxxx
5414 xxxx
5420 0xxx
5420 2xxx
Pages
579
574
574
572
568
564
566
566
564, 566
564, 566, 568
574
564
566
568
564
564
566
564
570, 571
570
570
570, 571
570, 571
571
581
573
580
580, 589
580, 589
580, 589
580, 589
589
589
589
575
576
576
576
557
557
574
595
595
62, 80, 192, 193, 196,
197, 205, 585
62, 80, 93, 193, 197,
205, 245, 585
62, 80, 93, 193, 197,
205, 245, 585
62, 80, 93, 245, 585
585
62, 80, 192, 193, 196,
197, 205, 585
62, 80, 93, 193, 197,
205, 245, 585
62, 80, 93, 193, 197,
205, 245, 585
62, 80, 93, 245, 585
585
586
61, 590
590
61, 590
61, 590
61, 590
61
588
590
586
587
587
References
5420 3xxx
5420 4xxx
5421 xxxx
5601 0xxx
5601 5005
56Dx xxxx
56PV 0xxx
56PV 1xxx
56PV 9901
5701 0xxx
5701 9xxx
5702 0xxx
5702 5xxx
5702 9xxx
5703 0xxx
5703 5xxx
5703 9xxx
5704 xxxx
58xx xxxx
5Axx xxxx
5Fxx xxxx
6012 0000
6012 0001
6012 0002
6012 0004
6012 0006
6012 0008
6012 001x
6012 002x
6012 003x
6013 xxxx
6019 0000
6022 xxxx
6023 xxxx
6029 0000
6032 xxxx
6033 xxxx
6039 0000
605x xxxx
Pages
587
586
587
439, 443, 447, 453,
459, 463, 481
263
305
305
305
300
263
264
263
263
264
263
263
264
264
594
275
275
279, 439, 443, 447, 453,
459, 463, 481
279
279
279
279
279
279
279
279
279
279, 282
279
279
201, 279, 282
279
279
201, 279, 282
279
References
606x xxxx
60Px xxxx
63xx xxxx
6401 0011
642x xxxx
643x xxxx
6441 0005
6500 0001
6500 0002
6500 0003
6500 0004
6500 0010
6500 0011
6500 0012
6500 0013
6500 0014
6500 0020
6500 0021
6500 0022
6500 0023
6500 0030
6500 0031
6500 0032
6500 0033
6500 004x
6500 1010
6500 103x
6500 11xx
6501 1010
6501 1011
6501 1012
6501 1013
6501 103x
6501 111x
6501 113x
6510 xxxx
6511 1010
6511 1011
6511 1012
6511 1013
6511 103x
Pages
279
300
269
282
201, 280 to 282
270
201, 280 to 282
267
267
267, 307
267
267
267
267, 307
267
267
267
267
267, 307
267
267
267, 307
267
267
268
267, 290
267
267
267, 268, 291
267, 268, 292
267, 268, 293
267, 268, 293
267
267, 268
267
267
267
267, 307
267
267
267
References
Pages
References
Pages
65Px xxxx
6600 xxxx
6601 xxxx
6692 xxxx
6693 xxxx
6702 xxxx
6703 xxxx
6712 xxxx
6713 xxxx
6722 xxxx
6723 xxxx
6732 xxxx
6733 xxxx
6746 xxxx
6747 xxxx
6852 xxxx
6853 xxxx
6862 xxxx
6863 xxxx
6872 xxxx
6873 xxxx
6882 xxxx
6883 xxxx
6896 xxxx
6897 xxxx
6A10 xxxx
6A1M xxxx
6A20 xxxx
6A2M xxxx
6A30 xxxx
6A3M xxxx
6A4x xxxx
6B1x xxxx
6B20 xxxx
6B2M xxxx
6B30 xxxx
6B3M 0400
6B40 xxxx
6B4M 0500
6C10 01xx
6C10 02xx
300, 307
280
281
280
281
280
281
280
281
280
281
280
281
280
281
280
281
280
281
280
281
280
281
280
281
273
274
273
274
273
274
273
273
273
274
273
274
273
274
273
273
6C10 031x
6C10 035x
6C10 04xx
6C1M xxxx
6C2x xxxx
6C3x xxxx
6Dxx xxxx
6F10 xxxx
6F1M xxxx
6F20 xxxx
6F2M xxxx
73xx xxxx
7739 0025
7769 9999
9503 xxxx
9505 xxxx
9506 xxxx
9509 4001
9509 4012
951x xxxx
952x xxxx
953x xxxx
954x xxxx
955x xxxx
957x xxxx
9594 xxxx
9599 0xxx
9599 201x
9599 2020
9599 4001
9599 4002
9599 4003
9599 4004
9599 4005
Nxxx xxxx
SA10 420x
SA10 421x
SA12 420x
SA12 421x
SA13 420x
SA13 421x
273
274
274
274
274
274
274
273
274
273
274
270
595
205, 245
375
375
375
376
375, 376
375
383
383
385
387
390, 391
375, 376
397
397
391, 397
375
375, 376
375, 376
376
376
589
593
594
593
594
593
594
657
Note
658
Model: SOCOMEC
Production: SOCOMEC
Photography: Martin Bernhart et Studio Objectif
Printing: PVA, Druck und Medien-Dienstleistungen GmbH
Industriestrae 15 - D-76829 Landau/Pfalz - GERMANY
Socomec worldwide
ThE UnITED KInGDOM
In ASIA
In MIDDLE EAST
In nORTh AMERICA
BELGIUM
B - 1070 Anderlecht
Tel. +32 (0)2 340 02 30
info.be@socomec.com
Dubai, U.A.E.
Tel. +971 (0)4 29 98 441
info.scp.ae@socomec.com
FRANCE
Singapore 408723
Tel. +65 6506 7600
info.scp.sg@socomec.com
GERMANY
SOUTh ASIA
D - 76275 Ettlingen
Tel. +49 (0)7243 65 29 2 0
info.scp.de@socomec.com
ITALY
I - 20098 San Giuliano Milanese (MI)
Tel. +39 02 9849821
info.scp.it@socomec.com
NEThERLANDS
NL - 3991 CD Houten
Tel. +31 (0)30 760 0901
info.scp.nl@socomec.com
POLAND
01-625 Warszawa
Tel. +48 91 442 64 11
info.scp.pl@socomec.com
SLOVENIA
SI - 1000 Ljubljana
Tel. +386 1 5807 860
info.scp.si@socomec.com
SPAIN
E - 08329 Tei (Barcelona)
Tel. +34 93 540 75 75
info.scp.es@socomec.com
TURKEY
34775 Istanbul
Tel. +90 (0)216 540 71 20
info.scp.tr@socomec.com
hEAD OffICE
InTERnATIOnAL SALES
DEpARTMEnT
SOCOMEC GROUP
SOCOMEC
www.socomec.com
YOUR DISTRIBUTOR
Non contractual document. 2013, Socomec SA. All rights reserved. - To help protect the environment, this document has been printed on PEFC paper (Programme for the Endorsement of Forest Certification)
In EUROpE
SOCOMEC Ltd
UK - Knowl Piece - Wilbury Way
Hitchin Hertfordshire SG4 0TY
Tel. 01462 440033
Fax 01462 431143
info.scp.uk@socomec.com